false
0001705012
0001705012
2024-11-21
2024-11-21
0001705012
FAT:ClassCommonStockMember
2024-11-21
2024-11-21
0001705012
FAT:ClassBCommonStockMember
2024-11-21
2024-11-21
0001705012
FAT:SeriesBCumulativePreferredStockMember
2024-11-21
2024-11-21
0001705012
FAT:WarrantsToPurchaseCommonStockMember
2024-11-21
2024-11-21
iso4217:USD
xbrli:shares
iso4217:USD
xbrli:shares
UNITED
STATES
SECURITIES
AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON,
D.C. 20549
FORM
8-K
CURRENT
REPORT
Pursuant
to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
Date
of Report (Date of earliest event reported): November 21, 2024
FAT
Brands Inc.
(Exact
name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)
Delaware |
|
001-38250 |
|
82-1302696 |
(State
or Other Jurisdiction
of
Incorporation) |
|
(Commission
File
Number) |
|
(IRS
Employer
Identification
No.) |
9720
Wilshire Blvd., Suite 500
Beverly
Hills, CA |
|
90212 |
(Address
of Principal Executive Offices) |
|
(Zip
Code) |
Registrant’s
Telephone Number, Including Area Code: (310) 319-1850
Not
Applicable
(Former
Name or Former Address, if Changed Since Last Report)
Check
the appropriate box below if the Form 8-K filing is intended to simultaneously satisfy the filing obligation of the registrant under
any of the following provisions (see General Instructions A.2. below):
☐ |
Written
communications pursuant to Rule 425 under the Securities Act (17 CFR 230.425) |
|
|
☐ |
Soliciting
material pursuant to Rule 14a-12 under the Exchange Act (17 CFR 240.14a-12) |
|
|
☐ |
Pre-commencement
communications pursuant to Rule 14d-2(b) under the Exchange Act (17 CFR 240.14d-2(b)) |
|
|
☐ |
Pre-commencement
communications pursuant to Rule 13e-4(c) under the Exchange Act (17 CFR 240.13e-4(c)) |
Securities
registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title
of each class |
|
Trading
Symbol(s) |
|
Name
of each exchange on which registered |
Class
A Common Stock |
|
FAT |
|
The
Nasdaq Stock Market LLC |
Class
B Common Stock |
|
FATBB |
|
The
Nasdaq Stock Market LLC |
Series
B Cumulative Preferred Stock |
|
FATBP |
|
The
Nasdaq Stock Market LLC |
Warrants
to purchase Common Stock |
|
FATBW |
|
The
Nasdaq Stock Market LLC |
Indicate
by check mark whether the registrant is an emerging growth company as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act of 1933 (§ 230.405
of this chapter) or Rule 12b-2 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (§ 240.12b-2 of this chapter).
Emerging
growth company ☐
If
an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying
with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. ☐
Item
1.01 Entry Into a Material Definitive Agreement.
| A. | Twin
Hospitality Refinancing |
On
November 21, 2024 (the “Closing Date”), FAT Brands Inc. (“FAT Brands” or the “Company”)
completed the refinancing of the whole business securitization credit facility of its Twin Peaks
and Smokey Bones restaurant brands, and restructured those brands under a new holding company,
Twin Hospitality Group Inc., a Delaware corporation and direct subsidiary of the Company (“Twin Hospitality”), in
anticipation of the planned listing of Twin Hospitality as a standalone public company. The aggregate principal balance of the
new Series 2024-1 fixed rate notes (the “Notes”) is $416,711,000 across four tranches, with a weighted average interest
rate of 9.5% per annum. The issuer of the new Notes is Twin Hospitality I, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company and wholly-owned
subsidiary of Twin Hospitality (the “Issuer”),
formerly known as FAT Brands Twin Peaks I, LLC. The following are the tranches of newly-issued Notes:
Closing
Date |
|
Class |
|
Seniority |
|
Principal
Balance |
|
Coupon |
|
Anticipated
Repayment Date |
|
Final
Legal Maturity Date |
11/21/2024 |
|
A-2-I |
|
Super
Senior |
|
$12,124,000 |
|
9.00% |
|
10/25/2027 |
|
10/26/2054 |
11/21/2024 |
|
A-2-II |
|
Senior |
|
$269,257,000 |
|
9.00% |
|
10/25/2027 |
|
10/26/2054 |
11/21/2024 |
|
B-2 |
|
Senior
Subordinated |
|
$57,619,000 |
|
10.00% |
|
10/25/2027 |
|
10/26/2054 |
11/21/2024 |
|
M-2 |
|
Subordinated |
|
$77,711,000 |
|
11.00% |
|
10/25/2027 |
|
10/26/2054 |
The
new financing repaid in full the notes previously issued under the Base Indenture, dated as of October 1, 2021 (the “Prior Indenture”),
as amended by the Series 2021-1 Supplement, dated October 1, 2021, Series 2023-1 Supplement, dated September 8, 2023, and Series 2024-1
Supplement, dated March 21, 2024, all of which were terminated in their entirety on the Closing Date.
At
the option of the holders, any of the Notes may be exchanged for a proportionate interest in Exchangeable Notes in two tranches, referred
to as Class A2IIB2 Notes (up to $326,876,000) and Class A2IIB2M2 Notes (up to $404,587,000), which will reflect in the aggregate the
characteristics of the corresponding exchanged Notes.
The
Notes were offered and sold to qualified institutional buyers through Jefferies LLC, as the initial purchaser, pursuant to the exemptions
from registration provided by Rule 144A under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
Terms
of the Notes
The
Notes were issued pursuant to a Base Indenture, dated as of the Closing Date (the “TWNP Indenture”), as amended by
the Series 2024-1 Supplement, dated as of the Closing Date, each of which is by and among the Issuer and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee (in
such capacity, the “TWNP Trustee”) and as securities intermediary. The Notes were issued in four tranches and in such
amounts set forth in the table above.
Scheduled
payments of principal and interest on the Notes are required to be made on a quarterly basis, in each case from amounts that are available
for payment thereon under the TWNP Indenture. The legal final maturity of the Notes is October 26, 2054, but it is anticipated that,
unless earlier prepaid to the extent permitted under the TWNP Indenture, the Notes will be repaid on October 25, 2027 (the “Anticipated
Repayment Date”). If the Issuer has not repaid or refinanced the Notes by the Anticipated Repayment Date, additional interest
equal to 5.0% per annum will accrue on each tranche of Notes.
In
addition, the TWNP Indenture requires that, upon a “Qualified Equity Offering” of Twin Hospitality (defined as an offering
of common stock of Twin Hospitality, subject to certain limitations), Twin Hospitality is required to deposit 75% of the net proceeds
of such offering towards repayment of the Notes until an aggregate of $75,000,000 has been repaid in that manner. If at least $25,000,000
of the proceeds of Qualified Equity Offerings are not used to prepay the Notes on or prior to each of April 25, 2025, July 25, 2025 or
October 27, 2025, or at least $75,000,000 of proceeds of Qualified Equity Offerings are not used to prepay the Notes on or prior to January
26, 2026, then a “Cash Flow Sweeping Event” would occur upon which 50% of certain excess cash flows from operations will
be used towards amortization of the three most senior tranches of Notes.
Guarantee
and Collateral Agreement
The
Notes are generally secured by a security interest in substantially all of the assets of the Issuer and its subsidiaries (the “Guarantors”
and, together with the Issuer, the “Securitization Entities”). Under the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, dated
November 21, 2024, by and among the Guarantors in favor of the TWNP Trustee, the Guarantors have guaranteed the obligations of the Issuer
under the TWNP Indenture and related documents and secured the guarantee by granting a security interest in substantially all of their
assets (the “Securitized Assets”). On the Closing Date, the Securitized Assets included all of the revenue-generating
assets of the Guarantors.
The
Notes are the obligations only of the Issuer pursuant to the TWNP Indenture and are unconditionally and irrevocably guaranteed by the
Guarantors pursuant to the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement. Except as described below and except for a Limited Guaranty provided
by Twin Hospitality in favor of the TWNP Trustee in respect of certain “bad boy” acts including, but, not limited to, fraud,
consensual encumbrances and certain insolvency events, neither Twin Hospitality or FAT Brands, or any of their respective subsidiaries,
other than the Securitization Entities, will guarantee or in any way be liable for the obligations of the Issuer under the TWNP Indenture
or the Notes.
Management
Agreement
Under
the terms of the Management Agreement, dated November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality, the Securitization Entities and the TWNP
Trustee, Twin Hospitality will act as the manager with respect to the Securitized Assets (in such capacity, the “Manager”).
The primary responsibilities of the Manager under the Management Agreement are to perform certain management, franchising, distribution,
intellectual property and operational functions on behalf of the Securitization Entities with respect to the Securitized Assets. The
Management Agreement provides for a management fee payable monthly by the Issuer to the Manager in the amount of $291,667.66, subject
to three percent (3%) annual increases.
The
Manager will manage and administer the Securitized Assets in accordance with the terms of the Management Agreement and, except as otherwise
provided in the Management Agreement, the management standards set forth in the Management Agreement. Subject to limited exceptions set
forth in the Management Agreement, the Management Agreement does not require the Manager to expend or risk its funds or otherwise incur
any financial liability in the performance of any of its rights or powers under the Management Agreement if the Manager has reasonable
grounds for believing that repayment of such funds or adequate indemnity against such risk or liability is not compensated by payment
of the management fee or is otherwise not reasonably assured or provided to it.
Subject
to limited exceptions set forth in the Management Agreement, the Manager will indemnify each Securitization Entity, the TWNP Trustee
and certain other parties, and their respective officers, directors, employees and agents for all claims, penalties, fines, forfeitures,
losses, liabilities, obligations, damages, actions, suits and related costs and judgments and other costs, fees and reasonable expenses
that any of them may incur as a result of (a) failure of the Manager to perform or observe its obligations under the Management Agreement,
(b) the breach by the Manager of any representation, warranty or covenant under the Management Agreement, or (c) the Manager’s
negligence, bad faith or willful misconduct in the performance of its duties under the Management Agreement.
Covenants
and Restrictions
The
Notes are subject to covenants and restrictions customary for transactions of this type, including: (i) that the Issuer maintain specified
reserve accounts to be used to make required payments in respect of the Notes; (ii) provisions relating to optional and mandatory prepayments,
and the related payment of specified amounts; (iii) certain indemnification payments in the event, among other things, the transfers
of the assets pledged as collateral for the Notes are in stated ways defective or ineffective; and (iv) covenants relating to recordkeeping,
access to information and similar matters. The Notes are subject to customary rapid amortization events provided for in the TWNP Indenture,
including events tied to failure of the Securitization Entities and Manager to maintain the stated debt service coverage ratio and leverage
ratios, the sum of systemwide sales for all restaurants being below certain levels on certain measurement dates, certain Manager termination
events, certain events of default and the failure to repay or refinance the Notes on the anticipated repayment dates. The Notes are also
subject to certain customary events of default, including events relating to non-payment of required interest, principal or other amounts
due on or with respect to the Notes, failure of the Securitization Entities to maintain the stated debt service coverage ratio, failure
to comply with covenants within certain time frames, certain bankruptcy events, breaches of specified representations and warranties
and certain judgments.
Other
Agreements
In
connection with the transactions discussed above, FAT Brands and Twin Hospitality also entered
into a letter agreement (the “Letter Agreement”) under which Twin Hospitality agreed to issue to investors in the
Notes warrants to acquire an aggregate of 5.0% of its issued and outstanding Class A Common Stock at the time of its listing as
a standalone public company. The warrants will be exercisable beginning on October 25, 2025 for a period of five years from the date
of issuance at an exercise price of $0.01 per share (subject to certain customary adjustments), and will include registration rights
for the underlying shares. The warrants and underlying shares will be subject to a lockup on transfers until Twin Hospitality has used
at least $75,000,000 of the proceeds of Qualified Equity Offerings to prepay the Notes.
Under
the Letter Agreement, Twin Hospitality also granted to the holders of the Notes the right
to appoint one observer to its Board of Directors, who will have the right to attend and participate in Board and Committee meetings
but will not have any voting rights. The observer will be subject to customary confidentiality obligations and may be excused from certain
meetings if attendance of the observer would jeopardize attorney-client privilege.
Under
the Letter Agreement, FAT Brands agreed not to sell, transfer, dividend or distribute any
of its shares in Twin Hospitality (other than in connection with the planned public spin-off of 5% of Twin Hospitality), until at least
$75,000,000 of the proceeds of Qualified Equity Offerings or other proceeds have been used to prepay the Notes. In addition, FAT Brands
agreed not to dividend out any of its ownership interests in Twin Hospitality for the next 24 months following the expiration of such
restriction if, with respect to any securitization transaction sponsored by FAT Brands or Twin Hospitality, a Rapid Amortization Event,
Manager Termination Event or an “event of default” (as such terms are defined in the applicable securitization transaction
documents) has occurred and is continuing or with the giving of notice or the passage of time would occur.
FAT
Brands also agreed not to pay a common equity dividend until at least $25,000,000 in proceeds from Qualified Equity Offerings have been
used to prepay the Notes, other than (a) a one-time stock dividend or distribution of approximately 5% of Class A common stock of Twin
Hospitality, (b) monthly dividends on FAT Brands’s preferred stock, and (c) the dividends already declared by FAT Brands.
The
above descriptions of the TWNP Indenture, Series 2024-1 Supplement, Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and Management Agreement do not
purport to be complete and are qualified in their entirety by reference to the full text of such agreements filed herewith as Exhibits
4.1, 4.2, 10.1 and 10.2, respectively, and incorporated herein by reference.
| B. | Modification
of FB Resid Holdings I, LLC |
Omnibus
Amendment
In
connection with the Twin Hospitality refinancing, on the Closing Date the Company also modified the outstanding credit facility of its
special purpose, wholly-owned subsidiary, FB Resid Holdings I, LLC (“FBRH”), pursuant to an Omnibus Amendment, dated
as of the Closing Date (the “Omnibus Amendment”), by and among the Company, FBRH, each of FAT Brands Royalty I, LLC,
FAT Brands GFG Royalty I, LLC, Twin Hospitality I, LLC (f/k/a FAT Brands Twin Peaks I, LLC) and FAT Brands Fazoli’s Native I, LLC
(the “Existing Issuers”), 3|5|2 Capital ABS Master Fund LP, as Noteholder, TW Equity Investors, L.P., as Noteholder,
and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee (in such capacity, the “FBRH Trustee”). The Omnibus Amendment amended the Base Indenture,
dated as of July 10, 2023 (the “FBRH Indenture”), by and between FBRH and the FBRH Trustee, and the Irrevocable Payment
Direction Letter, dated July 10, 2023, from each of FAT Brands Royalty I, LLC, FAT Brands GFG Royalty I, LLC, FAT Brands Twin Peaks I,
LLC and FAT Brands Fazoli’s Native I, LLC, as issuers, and the Company, as manager of FBRH, to the FBRH Trustee.
The
Omnibus Amendment amended the FBRH Indenture by replacing all references to the Prior Indenture with the new TWNP Indenture, and all
references to FAT Brands as the Manager of the TWNP Indenture with Twin Hospitality, until the occurrence of the “Twin Peaks Listing
Event”, which is defined as (i) the dividend or distribution of approximately 5% of the Class A Common Stock of Twin Hospitality
to the shareholders of FAT Brands, (ii) commencing of trading of the Class A Common Stock of Twin Hospitality on an Acceptable Exchange
(as defined in the Omnibus Amendment), (iii) all filings related with respect to the foregoing required pursuant to the rules and regulations
of the Securities and Exchange Commission are effective, (iv) the deposit of the Pledged Shares into the account specified in the Pledge
Agreement (as such terms are defined in the Omnibus Amendment) and (v) the Pledge Agreement is in full force and effect.
The
Omnibus Amendment also amended the treatment of “Excess Amounts” under the current securitization transactions for each Existing
Issuer upon (i) the occurrence of an Event of Default under the FBRH Indenture or (ii) if the Controlling Class Representative (currently
3|5|2 Capital ABS Master Fund LP) has notified the FBRH Trustee that certain Excess Amounts are required to satisfy clauses (i) through
(xiii) of the Priority of Payments on the next applicable Monthly Allocation Date under the FBRH Indenture. In such event, all such Excess
Amounts must be deposited into a segregated account to be included in Retained Collections and deposited in the Collection Account under
the FBRH Indenture for application in accordance with the waterfall of payments under Section 5.10 of the FBRH Indenture.
In
addition, the Omnibus Amendment amended the FBRH Indenture to provide that with respect to (i) any Mandatory Prepayment Amount and/or
(ii) from and after the occurrence of any Event of Default (as such terms are defined in the FBRH Indenture), payments of interest and
principal with respect to the Class A-1 Notes and the Class A-2 Notes shall be made in accordance with the Applicable Class A Payment
Priority (defined in the Omnibus Amendment), and no amounts may be paid on the Class A-1B Notes or Class A-2B Notes until amounts then
due and owing to the Class A-1A Notes and the Class A-2A Notes shall have been paid in full in cash.
In
addition, under the Omnibus Amendment, FAT Brands and FBRH agreed not to permit (i) any equity interests of any Existing Issuer to be
sold, transferred or disposed, other than the transactions contemplated by the Twin Peaks Listing Event, or (ii) any Specified Additional
Issuance (as defined in the FBRH Indenture). In addition, the Omnibus Amendment added a new Event of Default under the FBRH Indenture
if the Issuer should fail, by July 31, 2026, to have prepaid or purchased at least $20,000,000 of Class A-1A Notes and Class A-2A Notes
held by the Controlling Class Representative or its managed funds.
Also
under the Omnibus Amendment, FAT Brands agreed not to sell or otherwise dispose of any of its equity interests of Twin Hospitality until
Twin Hospitality has used at least $75,000,000 of aggregate Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds or other proceeds to prepay the new Notes
issued under the TWNP Indenture. FAT Brands also agreed not to declare or pay any dividend or distribution in the form of equity interests
in Twin Hospitality (i) until the third anniversary of the Closing Date (ii) or if any Potential Rapid Amortization Event, Rapid Amortization
Event, Default or Event of Default has occurred or would result therefrom under the indentures of any Existing Issuer.
Pledge
Agreement / Control Agreement
On
the Closing Date, FAT Brands also entered into a Pledge and Security Agreement (the “Pledge Agreement”) and Securities
Account Control Agreement (the “Control Agreement”) with UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee under the FBRH Indenture and as
securities intermediary (in such capacities, the “Pledge Trustee”). Under the Pledge Agreement, FAT Brands pledged
all of its shares of Class A Common Stock of Twin Hospitality (other than shares distributed to its shareholders at the time of the Twin
Peaks Listing Event) (the “Pledged Shares”) along with all proceeds of the Pledged Shares for the payment and performance
of all obligations of FBRH under the FBRH Indenture.
In
addition, FAT Brands agreed that the “Applicable Percentage” (a formula that is defined in the Pledge Agreement) of any (i)
proceeds of the sale or other disposal of Pledged Shares, (ii) dividend, distribution, rights, warrants or other consideration with respect
to the Pledged Shares, and (iii) proceeds of any loan secured by the Pledged Shares (collectively, the “Proceeds”),
will be applied to purchase first the Class A-2A Notes, and then the Class A-1A Notes, issued under the FBRH Indenture at par plus any
accrued and unpaid interest thereon and interest paid in kind. FAT Brands also agreed that, if Twin Hospitality has not raised at least
$25,000,000 in Qualified Equity Proceeds and is sold, then so long as either (i) the Issuer has repaid its debt in full under the TWNP
Indenture or (ii) the Issuer’s noteholders have otherwise waived such payment and approved the sale in writing, then 50% of the
Proceeds from the sale of Twin Hospitality will be applied to purchase first the Class A-2A Notes, and then the Class A-1A Notes, issued
under the FBRH Indenture at par plus any accrued and unpaid interest thereon and interest paid in kind.
Also
under the Pledge Agreement, upon the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default and following the Grace Period, if
applicable, under the FBRH Indenture, all rights of FAT Brands to vote or give consent with respect to the Pledged Shares shall be vested
in the Pledge Trustee.
Under
the Control Agreement, FAT Brands will deposit all of the Pledged Shares at the time of the Twin Peaks Listing Event into a controlled
account maintained by the Pledge Trustee, and the Pledge Trustee will distribute Proceeds of the Pledged Shares held in such account
according to the Pledge Agreement. FAT Brands will be entitled to enter any market order to sell Pledged Shares in a brokers’ transaction
on an approved trading market, and may enter orders to sell Pledged Shares other than on a permitted trading market (i) with the prior
written consent of the Pledge Trustee or (ii) in a trade to be executed within 5% of the 5-trading day volume weighted average price
and with a value of at least $15,000,000. Upon an Event of Default under the FBRH Indenture, the Controlling Class Representative will
be entitled to exercise sole control of the Pledged Shares and direct sales or other dispositions of the Pledged Shares held in the controlled
account.
The
above descriptions of the Omnibus Amendment, Pledge Agreement and Control Agreement do not purport to be complete and are qualified in
their entirety by reference to the full text of such agreements filed herewith as Exhibits 4.3, 10.3 and 10.4, respectively, each of
which is incorporated herein by this reference.
Item
1.02 Termination of a Material Definitive Agreement
The
information set forth in Item 1.01 is incorporated by reference into this Item 1.02.
Item
2.03 Creation of a Direct Financial Obligation or an Obligation under an Off-Balance Sheet Arrangement of a Registrant.
The
information set forth in Item 1.01 is incorporated by reference into this Item 2.03.
Item
9.01. Financial Statements and Exhibits.
(d)
Exhibits.
Exhibit
No. |
|
Description |
4.1 |
|
Base Indenture, dated November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality I, LLC, and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee and securities intermediary. |
4.2 |
|
Series 2024-1 Supplement to Base Indenture, dated November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality I, LLC, and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee and securities intermediary. |
4.3 |
|
Omnibus
Amendment, dated November 21, 2024, by and among FAT Brands Inc., FB Resid Holdings I, LLC, each of FAT Brands Royalty I, LLC,
FAT Brands GFG Royalty I, LLC, Twin Hospitality I, LLC (f/k/a FAT Brands Twin Peaks I, LLC) and FAT Brands Fazoli’s Native
I, LLC, 3|5|2 Capital ABS Master Fund LP, as Noteholder, TW Equity Investors, L.P., as Noteholder, and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee. |
10.1 |
|
Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, dated November 21, 2024, by and among the Guarantors named therein in favor of UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee. |
10.2 |
|
Management Agreement, dated November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality Group Inc., Twin Hospitality I, LLC, each of the Guarantors named therein and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee. |
10.3 |
|
Pledge and Security Agreement, dated November 21, 2024, by and among FAT Brands Inc. and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee and securities intermediary.
|
10.4 |
|
Securities Account Control Agreement, dated November 21, 2024, by and among FAT Brands Inc. and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee and securities intermediary. |
104 |
|
Cover
Page Interactive Data File (embedded within the Inline XBRL document) |
SIGNATURES
Pursuant
to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by
the undersigned thereunto duly authorized.
Date:
November 25, 2024
|
FAT
Brands Inc. |
|
|
|
|
By:
|
/s/
Kenneth J. Kuick |
|
|
Kenneth
J. Kuick |
|
|
Chief
Financial Officer |
Exhibit
4.1
TWIN
HOSPITALITY I, LLC,
as
Issuer
and
UMB
BANK, N.A.,
as
Trustee and Securities Intermediary
BASE
INDENTURE
Dated
as of November 21, 2024
Table
of Contents
|
|
Page |
Article I DEFINITIONS AND INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE |
|
1 |
|
Section
1.1 |
Definitions. |
|
1 |
|
Section
1.2 |
Cross-References. |
|
1 |
|
Section
1.3 |
Accounting
and Financial Determinations; No Duplication. |
|
1 |
|
Section
1.4 |
Rules
of Construction. |
|
2 |
|
|
|
|
|
Article II THE NOTES |
|
4 |
|
Section
2.1 |
Designation
and Terms of Notes. |
|
4 |
|
Section
2.2 |
Notes
Issuable in Series. |
|
4 |
|
Section
2.3 |
Series
Supplement. |
|
6 |
|
Section
2.4 |
Execution
and Authentication. |
|
7 |
|
Section
2.5 |
Note
Registrar and Paying Agent. |
|
8 |
|
Section
2.6 |
Paying
Agent to Hold Money in Trust. |
|
8 |
|
Section
2.7 |
Noteholder
List. |
|
9 |
|
Section
2.8 |
Transfer
and Exchange. |
|
10 |
|
Section
2.9 |
Persons
Deemed Owners. |
|
12 |
|
Section
2.10 |
Replacement
Notes. |
|
12 |
|
Section
2.11 |
Treasury
Notes. |
|
13 |
|
Section
2.12 |
Book-Entry
Notes. |
|
13 |
|
Section
2.13 |
Definitive
Notes. |
|
14 |
|
Section
2.14 |
Cancellation. |
|
15 |
|
Section
2.15 |
Principal
and Interest. |
|
15 |
|
Section
2.16 |
Tax
Treatment. |
|
16 |
|
Section
2.17 |
Securities
Law Restrictions. |
|
17 |
|
Section
2.18 |
Exchangeable
Notes. |
|
17 |
|
|
|
|
|
Article III SECURITY |
|
18 |
|
Section
3.1 |
Grant
of Security Interest. |
|
18 |
|
Section
3.2 |
Certain
Rights and Obligations of the Issuer Unaffected. |
|
19 |
|
Section
3.3 |
Performance
of Collateral Documents. |
|
20 |
|
Section
3.4 |
Stamp,
Other Similar Taxes and Filing Fees. |
|
21 |
|
Section
3.5 |
Authorization
to File Financing Statements. |
|
21 |
Table
of Contents
(continued)
|
|
Page |
Article IV REPORTS |
|
22 |
|
Section
4.1 |
Reports
and Instructions to Trustee. |
|
22 |
|
Section
4.2 |
[Reserved]. |
|
24 |
|
Section
4.3 |
Rule
144A Information. |
|
24 |
|
Section
4.4 |
Reports,
Financial Statements and Other Information to Noteholders. |
|
24 |
|
Section
4.5 |
Manager. |
|
25 |
|
Section
4.6 |
No
Constructive Notice. |
|
25 |
|
|
|
|
|
Article V ALLOCATION AND APPLICATION OF COLLECTIONS |
|
26 |
|
Section
5.1 |
Management
Accounts and Additional Accounts. |
|
26 |
|
Section
5.2 |
Reserve
Account. |
|
27 |
|
Section
5.3 |
Permitted
Uses Account. |
|
28 |
|
Section
5.4 |
Collection
Account. |
|
28 |
|
Section
5.5 |
Collection
Account Administrative Accounts. |
|
29 |
|
Section
5.6 |
Eligible
Investments. |
|
31 |
|
Section
5.7 |
Trustee
as Securities Intermediary. |
|
32 |
|
Section
5.8 |
Establishment
of Series Accounts; Legacy Accounts. |
|
33 |
|
Section
5.9 |
Collections
and Investment Income. |
|
34 |
|
Section
5.10 |
Application
of Retained Collections and any Reserve Account Withdrawal Amount on Monthly Allocation Dates. |
|
36 |
|
Section
5.11 |
Quarterly
Payment Date Applications. |
|
41 |
|
Section
5.12 |
Other
Amounts. |
|
49 |
|
Section
5.13 |
Determination
of Quarterly Interest. |
|
50 |
|
Section
5.14 |
Determination
of Quarterly Principal. |
|
50 |
|
Section
5.15 |
Prepayment
of Principal. |
|
50 |
|
Section
5.16 |
Replacement
of Ineligible Accounts. |
|
50 |
|
Section
5.17 |
Instructions
and Directions. |
|
51 |
|
Section
5.18 |
Qualified
Equity Offering. |
|
51 |
|
|
|
|
|
Article VI DISTRIBUTIONS |
|
52 |
|
Section
6.1 |
Distributions
in General. |
|
52 |
Table
of Contents
(continued)
|
|
Page |
Article VII REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES |
|
53 |
|
Section
7.1 |
Existence
and Power. |
|
53 |
|
Section
7.2 |
Company
and Governmental Authorization. |
|
53 |
|
Section
7.3 |
No
Consent. |
|
53 |
|
Section
7.4 |
Binding
Effect. |
|
54 |
|
Section
7.5 |
Litigation. |
|
54 |
|
Section
7.6 |
[Reserved]. |
|
54 |
|
Section
7.7 |
Tax
Filings and Expenses. |
|
54 |
|
Section
7.8 |
Disclosure. |
|
55 |
|
Section
7.9 |
1940
Act. |
|
55 |
|
Section
7.10 |
Regulations
T, U and X. |
|
55 |
|
Section
7.11 |
Solvency. |
|
55 |
|
Section
7.12 |
Ownership
of Equity Interests; Subsidiaries. |
|
55 |
|
Section
7.13 |
Security
Interests. |
|
56 |
|
Section
7.14 |
Transaction
Documents. |
|
57 |
|
Section
7.15 |
Non-Existence
of Other Agreements. |
|
57 |
|
Section
7.16 |
Compliance
with Contractual Obligations and Laws. |
|
57 |
|
Section
7.17 |
Other
Representations. |
|
57 |
|
Section
7.18 |
No
Employees. |
|
58 |
|
Section
7.19 |
Reserved. |
|
58 |
|
Section
7.20 |
Environmental
Matters; Real Property. |
|
58 |
|
Section
7.21 |
Intellectual
Property. |
|
59 |
|
Section
7.22 |
Exchange
Act |
|
59 |
|
|
|
|
|
Article VIII COVENANTS |
|
59 |
|
Section
8.1 |
Payment
of Notes. |
|
59 |
|
Section
8.2 |
Maintenance
of Office or Agency. |
|
60 |
|
Section
8.3 |
Payment
and Performance of Obligations. |
|
60 |
|
Section
8.4 |
Maintenance
of Existence. |
|
61 |
|
Section
8.5 |
Compliance
with Laws. |
|
61 |
|
Section
8.6 |
Inspection
of Property; Books and Records. |
|
61 |
Table
of Contents
(continued)
|
|
Page |
|
Section
8.7 |
Actions
under the Collateral Documents and Transaction Documents. |
|
62 |
|
Section
8.8 |
Notice
of Defaults and Other Events. |
|
63 |
|
Section
8.9 |
Notice
of Material Proceedings. |
|
64 |
|
Section
8.10 |
Further
Requests. |
|
64 |
|
Section
8.11 |
Further
Assurances. |
|
64 |
|
Section
8.12 |
Liens. |
|
66 |
|
Section
8.13 |
Other
Indebtedness. |
|
66 |
|
Section
8.14 |
[Reserved]. |
|
66 |
|
Section
8.15 |
Mergers. |
|
66 |
|
Section
8.16 |
Asset
Dispositions. |
|
67 |
|
Section
8.17 |
Acquisition
of Assets. |
|
69 |
|
Section
8.18 |
Dividends,
Officers’ Compensation, etc. |
|
69 |
|
Section
8.19 |
Legal
Name, Location Under Section 9-301 or 9-307. |
|
69 |
|
Section
8.20 |
Charter
Documents. |
|
70 |
|
Section
8.21 |
Investments. |
|
70 |
|
Section
8.22 |
No
Other Agreements. |
|
70 |
|
Section
8.23 |
Other
Business. |
|
70 |
|
Section
8.24 |
Maintenance
of Separate Existence. |
|
70 |
|
Section
8.25 |
Covenants
Regarding the Securitization IP. |
|
72 |
|
Section
8.26 |
Investment
Company Act. |
|
74 |
|
Section
8.27 |
Real
Property |
|
74 |
|
Section
8.28 |
No
Employees. |
|
74 |
|
Section
8.29 |
Insurance. |
|
74 |
|
Section
8.30 |
Litigation. |
|
75 |
|
Section
8.31 |
Environmental. |
|
75 |
|
Section
8.32 |
Enhancements. |
|
75 |
|
Section
8.33 |
Derivatives. |
|
75 |
|
Section
8.34 |
Additional
Guarantor. |
|
76 |
|
Section
8.35 |
Guarantor
Distributions. |
|
77 |
Table
of Contents
(continued)
|
|
Page |
|
Section
8.36 |
Tax
Lien Reserve Amount. |
|
77 |
|
Section
8.37 |
Bankruptcy
Proceedings. |
|
77 |
|
Section
8.38 |
Mortgages. |
|
78 |
|
|
|
|
|
Article IX REMEDIES |
|
79 |
|
Section
9.1 |
Rapid
Amortization Events. |
|
79 |
|
Section
9.2 |
Events
of Default. |
|
80 |
|
Section
9.3 |
Rights
of the Control Party and Trustee upon Event of Default. |
|
84 |
|
Section
9.4 |
Waiver
of Appraisal, Valuation, Stay and Right to Marshaling. |
|
87 |
|
Section
9.5 |
Limited
Recourse. |
|
88 |
|
Section
9.6 |
Optional
Preservation of the Collateral. |
|
88 |
|
Section
9.7 |
Waiver
of Past Events. |
|
88 |
|
Section
9.8 |
Control
by the Control Party. |
|
89 |
|
Section
9.9 |
Limitation
on Suits. |
|
89 |
|
Section
9.10 |
Unconditional
Rights of Noteholders to Receive Payment. |
|
90 |
|
Section
9.11 |
The
Trustee May File Proofs of Claim. |
|
90 |
|
Section
9.12 |
Undertaking
for Costs. |
|
90 |
|
Section
9.13 |
Restoration
of Rights and Remedies. |
|
91 |
|
Section
9.14 |
Rights
and Remedies Cumulative. |
|
91 |
|
Section
9.15 |
Delay
or Omission Not Waiver. |
|
91 |
|
Section
9.16 |
Waiver
of Stay or Extension Laws. |
|
91 |
|
|
|
|
|
Article X THE TRUSTEE |
|
92 |
|
Section
10.1 |
Duties
of the Trustee. |
|
92 |
|
Section
10.2 |
Rights
of the Trustee. |
|
95 |
|
Section
10.3 |
Individual
Rights of the Trustee. |
|
98 |
|
Section
10.4 |
Notice
of Events of Default and Defaults. |
|
98 |
|
Section
10.5 |
Compensation
and Indemnity. |
|
98 |
|
Section
10.6 |
Replacement
of the Trustee. |
|
99 |
|
Section
10.7 |
Successor
Trustee by Merger, etc. |
|
100 |
|
Section
10.8 |
Eligibility
Disqualification. |
|
101 |
|
Section
10.9 |
Appointment
of Co-Trustee or Separate Trustee. |
|
101 |
|
Section
10.10 |
Representations
and Warranties of Trustee. |
|
102 |
Table
of Contents
(continued)
|
|
Page |
Article XI CONTROLLING CLASS REPRESENTATIVE AND CONTROL PARTY |
|
103 |
|
Section
11.1 |
Controlling
Class Representative. |
|
103 |
|
Section
11.2 |
Resignation
or Removal of the Controlling Class Representative. |
|
103 |
|
Section
11.3 |
Expenses
and Liabilities of the Controlling Class Representative. |
|
104 |
|
Section
11.4 |
Control
Party. |
|
105 |
|
Section
11.5 |
Noteholder
List. |
|
106 |
|
|
|
|
|
Article XII DISCHARGE OF INDENTURE |
|
106 |
|
Section
12.1 |
Termination
of the Issuer’s and Guarantors’ Obligations. |
|
106 |
|
Section
12.2 |
Application
of Trust Money. |
|
110 |
|
Section
12.3 |
Repayment
to the Issuer. |
|
111 |
|
Section
12.4 |
Reinstatement. |
|
111 |
|
|
|
|
|
Article XIII AMENDMENTS |
|
111 |
|
Section
13.1 |
Without
Consent of the Control Party or the Noteholders. |
|
111 |
|
Section
13.2 |
With
Consent of the Control Party or the Noteholders. |
|
113 |
|
Section
13.3 |
Supplements. |
|
114 |
|
Section
13.4 |
Revocation
and Effect of Consents. |
|
114 |
|
Section
13.5 |
Notation
on or Exchange of Notes. |
|
115 |
|
Section
13.6 |
The
Trustee to Sign Amendments, etc. |
|
115 |
|
Section
13.7 |
Amendments
and Fees. |
|
115 |
|
|
|
|
|
Article XIV MISCELLANEOUS |
|
116 |
|
Section
14.1 |
Notices. |
|
116 |
|
Section
14.2 |
Communication
by Noteholders With Other Noteholders. |
|
118 |
|
Section
14.3 |
Officer’s
Certificate as to Conditions Precedent. |
|
118 |
|
Section
14.4 |
Statements
Required in Certificate. |
|
119 |
|
Section
14.5 |
Rules
by the Trustee. |
|
119 |
|
Section
14.6 |
Benefits
of Indenture. |
|
119 |
|
Section
14.7 |
Timing
of Payment or Performance. |
|
119 |
Table
of Contents
(continued)
|
|
Page |
|
Section
14.8 |
Governing
Law. |
|
120 |
|
Section
14.9 |
Successors. |
|
120 |
|
Section
14.10 |
Severability. |
|
120 |
|
Section
14.11 |
Counterpart
Originals. |
|
120 |
|
Section
14.12 |
Table
of Contents, Headings, etc. |
|
121 |
|
Section
14.13 |
No
Bankruptcy Petition Against the Securitization Entities. |
|
121 |
|
Section
14.14 |
Recording
of Indenture. |
|
121 |
|
Section
14.15 |
Waiver
of Jury Trial. |
|
121 |
|
Section
14.16 |
Submission
to Jurisdiction; Waivers. |
|
121 |
|
Section
14.17 |
Permitted
Asset Dispositions; Release of Collateral. |
|
122 |
|
Section
14.18 |
Calculation
of Senior Leverage Ratio. |
|
122 |
ANNEXES |
|
|
Annex
A |
|
Base
Indenture Definitions List |
|
|
|
EXHIBITS |
|
|
Exhibit
A |
|
Form
of Monthly Manager’s Certificate |
Exhibit
B |
|
Form
of Investor Request Certification |
Exhibit
C |
|
Release
Request |
Exhibit
D |
|
[Reserved] |
Exhibit
E |
|
[Reserved] |
Exhibit
F |
|
[Reserved] |
Exhibit
G |
|
Form
of Noteholder Certification |
Exhibit
H |
|
Form
of Transferee Certification |
Exhibit
I-1 |
|
Form
of Notice of Grant of Security Interest in Trademarks |
Exhibit
I-2 |
|
Form
of Notice of Grant of Security Interest in Patents |
Exhibit
I-3 |
|
Form
of Notice of Grant of Security Interest in Copyrights |
Exhibit
J-1 |
|
Form
of Supplemental Notice of Grant of Security Interest in Trademarks |
Exhibit
J-2 |
|
Form
of Supplemental Notice of Grant of Security Interest in Patents |
Exhibit
J-3 |
|
Form
of Supplemental Notice of Grant of Security Interest in Copyrights |
|
|
|
SCHEDULES |
|
|
Schedule
7.3 |
|
-
Consents |
Schedule
7.7 |
|
-
Proposed Tax Assessments |
Schedule
7.13 |
|
-
Non-Perfected Liens |
Schedule
7.21 |
|
-
Pending Actions or Proceedings Relating to the Securitization IP |
Schedule
8.11 |
|
-
Liens |
BASE
INDENTURE, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality I, LLC (f/k/a Fat Brands Twin Peaks I, LLC), a Delaware limited
liability company, (the “Issuer”), and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee (in such capacity, the “Trustee”),
and as securities intermediary.
W
I T N E S S E T H:
WHEREAS,
the Issuer has duly authorized the execution and delivery of this Base Indenture (as may be amended, modified or supplemented from time
to time, the “Base Indenture”) and the issuance of a series of asset-backed notes (the “Notes”)
under this Base Indenture, as provided in this Base Indenture and in Supplements hereto; and
WHEREAS,
all things necessary to make this Base Indenture a legal, valid and binding agreement of the Issuer, in accordance with its terms, have
been done, and the Issuer proposes to do all the things necessary to make the Notes, when executed by the Issuer and authenticated and
delivered by the Trustee hereunder and duly issued by the Issuer, the legal, valid and binding obligations of the Issuer as hereinafter
provided;
NOW,
THEREFORE, for and in consideration of the premises and the receipt of the Notes by the Noteholders, it is mutually covenanted and agreed,
for the equal and proportionate benefit of all Noteholders (in accordance with the priorities set forth herein and in any Series Supplement),
as follows:
Article
I
DEFINITIONS
AND INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE
Section
1.1 Definitions.
Capitalized
terms used herein (including the preamble and the recitals hereto) and not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned
to such terms in the Base Indenture Definitions List attached hereto as Annex A (the “Base Indenture Definitions List”),
as such Base Indenture Definitions List may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time in accordance with the provisions
hereof.
Section
1.2 Cross-References.
Unless
otherwise specified, references in the Indenture and in each other Transaction Document to any Article or Section are references to such
Article or Section of the Indenture or such other Transaction Document, as the case may be, and, unless otherwise specified, references
in any Article, Section or definition to any clause are references to such clause of such Article, Section or definition.
Section
1.3 Accounting and Financial Determinations; No Duplication.
(a)
All accounting terms not specifically or completely defined in the Indenture or the Transaction Documents shall be construed in conformity
with GAAP.
(b)
Where the character or amount of any asset or liability or item of income or expense is required to be determined, or any accounting
computation is required to be made, for the purpose of the Indenture or any other Transaction Document, such determination or calculation
shall be made, to the extent applicable and except as otherwise specified in the Indenture or such other Transaction Document, in accordance
with GAAP. When used herein, the term “financial statement” shall include the notes and schedules thereto. All accounting
determinations and computations hereunder or under any other Transaction Documents shall be made without duplication. Notwithstanding
any provision contained in this Base Indenture or any other Transaction Document to the contrary, all terms of an accounting or financial
nature used herein shall be construed, and all computations of amounts and ratios referred to herein shall be made (i) without giving
effect to any election under Accounting Standards Codification 825-10-25 (or any other Accounting Standards Codification or Financial
Accounting Standard having a similar result or effect) to value any Indebtedness or other liabilities of any Twin Hospitality TP Entities
at “fair value,” as defined therein, (ii) without giving effect to any change to, or modification of, GAAP (including any
future phase-in of changes to GAAP that have been approved as of December 1, 2018) which would require the capitalization of leases characterized
as “operating leases” as of December 1, 2018 (it being understood and agreed, for the avoidance of doubt, financial statements
delivered pursuant hereto shall be prepared without giving effect to this clause) and (iii) without giving effect to the one-time adjustment
to implement Accounting Standards Update 2016-13, Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments.
Section
1.4 Rules of Construction.
In
the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents, unless the context otherwise requires:
(a)
the singular includes the plural and vice versa;
(b)
reference to any Person includes such Person’s successors and assigns but, if applicable, only if such successors and assigns are
permitted by the Indenture and the other applicable Transaction Documents, as the case may be, and reference to any Person in a particular
capacity only refers to such Person in such capacity;
(c)
reference to any gender includes the other gender;
(d)
reference to any Requirements of Law means such Requirements of Law as amended, modified, codified or reenacted, in whole or in part,
and in effect from time to time;
(e)
“including” (and with correlative meaning “include”) means including without limiting the generality of any description
preceding such term;
(f)
the word “or” is always used inclusively herein (for example, the phrase “A or B” means “A or B or both,”
not “either A or B but not both”), unless used in an “either . . . or” construction;
(g)
reference to any Transaction Document or other contract or agreement means such Transaction Document, contract or agreement as amended,
amended and restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time in accordance with the terms hereof and thereof, except (i)
with respect to defined terms that define such Transaction Document or other contract or agreement as of certain amendments or other
modifications thereto and (ii) as the context requires otherwise;
(h)
with respect to the determination of any period of time, except as otherwise specified, “from” means “from and including”
and “to” means “to but excluding”;
(i)
the use of Subclass designations, Tranche designations or other designations to differentiate Note characteristics within a Class will
not alter priority of the requirement to pay among the Class pro rata unless expressly provided for in the Series Supplement for
such Subclass or Tranche;
(j)
if (i) any funds deposited to an Account are to be paid or allocated, or any action described in a Monthly Manager’s Certificate
is to be taken, on (or prior to) the “following Monthly Allocation Date”, the “Monthly Allocation Date immediately
following” or the “immediately following Monthly Allocation Date”, such payment, allocation or action shall occur on
(or prior to, if applicable) the Monthly Allocation Date related to the Monthly Collection Period in which such deposit occurs or the
Monthly Allocation Date to which the Monthly Manager’s Certificate relates, as applicable, and (ii) an action or event is to occur
with respect to a Monthly Fiscal Period immediately preceding a Monthly Allocation Date, such action or event shall occur with respect
to the most recent Monthly Fiscal Period ending prior to such Monthly Allocation Date;
(k)
if any payment is due, or any action described in a Quarterly Noteholders’ Report is to be taken, on (or prior to) the “related
Quarterly Payment Date”, the “following Quarterly Payment Date”, the “immediately succeeding Quarterly Payment
Date”, the “next succeeding Quarterly Payment Date” or the “immediately following Quarterly Payment Date”,
such payment shall be due, or such action shall occur, as applicable, either (i) on (or prior to, if applicable) the Quarterly Payment
Date related to the Quarterly Collection Period in which such payment accrues or the Quarterly Payment Date to which such Quarterly Noteholders’
Report relates or (ii) on (or prior to, if applicable) the Quarterly Payment Date related to the applicable Quarterly Calculation Date
on which such payment is calculated;
(l)
references to (i) the “preceding Monthly Collection Period” means the most recent Monthly Collection Period ending prior
to the indicated date, (ii) the “immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period” means the most recent Quarterly Collection
Period ending prior to the indicated date and (iii) “immediately preceding Quarterly Calculation Date” means the most recent
Quarterly Calculation Date; and
(m)
to the broadest extent possible, a Majority of Controlling Class may operate as the Controlling Class Representative under this Base
Indenture and the other Transaction Documents, and any rights, powers, remedies or privileges of the Controlling Class Representative
under this Base Indenture and the other Transaction Documents may also be exercised, enforced, enjoyed and received by the Majority of
Controlling Class, including but not limited to, the authority to make decisions, provide consents, give directions, and take any other
actions that the Controlling Class Representative is authorized or permitted to undertake under this Base Indenture and the other Transaction
Documents.
Article
II
THE
NOTES
Section
2.1 Designation and Terms of Notes.
Each
Series of Notes shall be substantially in the form specified in the Series Supplement and shall bear, upon its face, the designation
for such Series to which it belongs as selected by the Issuer, with such appropriate insertions, omissions, substitutions and other variations
as are required or permitted hereby or by the Series Supplement and may have such letters, numbers or other marks of identification and
such legends or endorsements placed thereon as may, consistently herewith, be determined to be appropriate by the Authorized Officers
of the Issuer executing such Notes, as evidenced by execution of such Notes by such Authorized Officers. All Notes of any Series shall,
except as specified in the Series Supplement and in this Base Indenture, be equally and ratably entitled as provided herein to the benefits
hereof without preference, priority or distinction on account of the actual time or times of authentication and delivery, all in accordance
with the terms and provisions of this Base Indenture and any Series Supplement. The aggregate principal amount of Notes which may be
authenticated and delivered under this Base Indenture is unlimited. The Notes of each Series shall be issued in the denominations set
forth in the Series Supplement; provided, however, in no event shall Notes of any Series have a minimum denomination of less than $100,000.
Section
2.2 Notes Issuable in Series.
(a)
The Notes shall be issued as a single Series of Notes, including any Class, Subclass or Tranche of such Notes. The Series of Notes shall
be issued pursuant to a Series Supplement. For the avoidance of doubt, the Series 2024-1 Notes will be the only Series of Notes to be
issued by the Issuer pursuant to this Base Indenture or the Series Supplement.
(b)
In accordance with the Series Supplement, the Notes may from time to time be executed by the Issuer and delivered to the Trustee for
authentication and thereupon, subject to Section 2.2(c), the same shall be authenticated and delivered by the Trustee upon the
performance or delivery by the Issuer to the Trustee and the Control Party, and receipt by the Trustee and the Control Party, of the
following:
(i)
a Company Order authorizing and directing (A) the authentication and delivery of such Notes by the Trustee and specifying the designation
of such Notes, the Initial Principal Amount of such Notes to be authenticated and the Note Rate with respect to such Notes and (B) the
use of proceeds to repay all existing Indebtedness of the Issuer under the Base Indenture, dated as of October 1, 2021, between the Issuer
and UMB Bank, N.A, and each of the series supplements executed thereunder (the “Previous Indenture”);
(ii)
the Series Supplement for such Notes satisfying the criteria set forth in Section 2.3 executed by the Issuer and the Trustee and
specifying the Principal Terms of such Notes;
(iii)
[reserved];
(iv)
a Tax Opinion dated the Series Closing Date for the Super Senior Notes, the Senior Notes and the Senior Subordinated Notes;
(v)
one or more Opinions of Counsel, subject to the assumptions and qualifications stated therein, and in a form reasonably acceptable to
the Control Party, dated the Series Closing Date, substantially to the effect that:
(A)
all of the instruments described in this Section 2.2(b) furnished to the Trustee and the Control Party conform to the requirements
of this Base Indenture and the Series Supplement and the Notes are permitted to be authenticated by the Trustee pursuant to the terms
of this Base Indenture and the Series Supplement (except that no such Opinion of Counsel shall be required to be delivered in connection
with the issuance of Notes on the Closing Date);
(B)
the Series Supplement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by the Issuer and constitutes a legal, valid and binding agreement
of the Issuer, enforceable against the Issuer in accordance with its terms;
(C)
such Notes have been duly authorized by the Issuer, and, when such Notes have been duly authenticated and delivered by the Trustee, such
Notes will be legal, valid and binding obligations of the Issuer, enforceable against the Issuer in accordance with their terms;
(D)
none of the Securitization Entities is required to be registered as an “investment company” under the 1940 Act;
(E)
the Lien and the security interests created by this Base Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement on the Collateral remain
perfected as required by this Base Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and such Lien and security interests extend to
any assets transferred to the Securitization Entities in connection with the issuance of such Notes;
(F)
based on a reasoned analysis, the assets of a Securitization Entity as a debtor in bankruptcy would not be substantively consolidated
with the assets and liabilities of FAT Brands or the Manager in a manner prejudicial to Noteholders;
(G)
neither the execution and delivery by the Issuer of such Notes and the Series Supplement nor the performance by the Issuer of its obligations
under each of the Notes and the Series Supplement, conflicts with the Charter Documents of the Issuer;
(H)
neither the execution and delivery by the Issuer of such Notes and the Series Supplement nor the performance by the Issuer of their payment
obligations under each of such Notes and the Series Supplement: (i) violates any law, rule or regulation of any relevant jurisdiction,
or (ii) requires the consent, approval, licensing or authorization of, or any filing, recording or registration with, any governmental
authority under any law, rule or regulation of any relevant jurisdiction except for those consents, approvals, licenses and authorizations
already obtained and those filings, recordings and registrations already made;
(I)
unless such Notes are being offered pursuant to a registration statement that has been declared effective under the 1933 Act, it is not
necessary in connection with the offer and sale of such Notes by the Issuer to the initial purchaser(s) thereof or by the initial purchaser(s)
to the initial investors in such Notes to register such Notes under the 1933 Act; and
(J)
all conditions precedent to such issuance have been satisfied and that the Series Supplement is authorized or permitted pursuant to the
terms and conditions of the Indenture; and
(vi)
such other documents, instruments, certifications, agreements or other items as the Trustee or the Control Party may reasonably require.
(c)
Upon receipt of a Company Order in accordance with, and subject to, Section 2.2(b), the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver,
as provided above, such Notes upon execution thereof by the Issuer. Notwithstanding anything contained herein or in any Supplement to
the contrary, the Trustee shall be entitled to conclusively rely on, and shall be fully protected in so relying on, the Issuer’s
delivery of the executed Notes as evidence that the conditions set forth in Section 2.2(b) have been satisfied and the Trustee
shall in no event be required to make inquiry or investigation as to whether the conditions set forth in Section 2.2(b) have been
satisfied or waived. The closing of the issuance of Notes may (but shall not be required to) be effected through an escrow arrangement
on terms acceptable to the Trustee, the Control Party and Issuer.
Section
2.3 Series Supplement.
In
conjunction with the issuance of the Notes, subject to the applicable terms and provisions of Article XIII, the parties hereto
shall execute a Series Supplement for such Notes, which shall specify the relevant terms with respect to such Notes, which may include,
without limitation:
(a)
its name or designation;
(b)
the Initial Principal Amount with respect to such Notes;
(c)
the Note Rate with respect to such Notes;
(d)
the Series Closing Date;
(e)
the Series Anticipated Repayment Date, if any;
(f)
the Series Legal Final Maturity Date;
(g)
the principal amortization schedule with respect to such Notes, if any;
(h)
[reserved];
(i)
the names of the Series Distribution Accounts and any other Series Accounts to be used with respect to such Notes and the terms governing
the operation of any such account and the use of moneys therein;
(j)
the method of allocating amounts deposited into any Series Distribution Account with respect to such Notes and/or the method of remitting
payments from the applicable Indenture Trust Accounts to the Holders of such Series;
(k)
whether such Notes will be issued in multiple Classes, Subclasses or Tranches and the rights and priorities of each such Class, Subclass
or Tranche;
(l)
any deposit of funds to be made in any Indenture Trust Account or any Series Account on the Series Closing Date;
(m)
whether such Notes may be issued as either Definitive Notes or Book-Entry Notes and any limitations imposed thereon;
(n)
whether such Notes include the Super Senior Notes, Senior Notes, Senior Subordinated Notes and/or Subordinated Notes;
(o)
[Reserved];
(p)
the terms of any related Enhancement and the Enhancement Provider thereof, if any;
(q)
any other relevant terms of such Notes (all such terms, the “Principal Terms” of such Series).
Section
2.4 Execution and Authentication.
(a)
Each Note shall, upon issuance pursuant to Section 2.2, be executed on behalf of the Issuer by an Authorized Officer of the Issuer
and delivered by the Issuer to the Trustee for authentication and redelivery as provided herein. The signature of each such Authorized
Officer on the Notes may be manual or facsimile. If an Authorized Officer of the Issuer whose signature is on a Note no longer holds
that office at the time the Note is authenticated, the Note shall nevertheless be valid.
(b)
At any time and from time to time after the execution and delivery of this Base Indenture, the Issuer may deliver Notes of any particular
Series (issued pursuant to Section 2.2) executed by the Issuer to the Trustee for authentication, together with one or more Company
Orders for the authentication and delivery of such Notes, and the Trustee, in accordance with such Company Order and this Base Indenture,
shall authenticate and deliver such Notes.
(c)
No Note shall be entitled to any benefit under the Indenture or be valid for any purpose unless there appears on such Note a certificate
of authentication substantially in the form provided for below, duly executed by the Trustee by the manual signature of a Trust Officer.
Such signatures on such certificate shall be conclusive evidence, and the only evidence, that the Note has been duly authenticated under
this Base Indenture. The Trustee may appoint an authenticating agent acceptable to the Issuer to authenticate Notes. Unless limited by
the term of such appointment, an authenticating agent may authenticate Notes whenever the Trustee may do so. Each reference in this Base
Indenture to authentication by the Trustee includes authentication by such authenticating agent. The Trustee’s certificate of authentication
shall be in substantially the following form:
“This
is one of the Notes of a Series issued under the within mentioned Indenture.
|
UMB
Bank, N.A., as Trustee |
|
|
|
By: |
|
|
Authorized
Signatory” |
(d)
Each Note shall be dated and issued as of the date of its authentication by the Trustee.
Section
2.5 Note Registrar and Paying Agent.
(a)
The Issuer shall (i) maintain an office or agency where Notes may be presented for registration of transfer or for exchange (the “Note
Registrar”) and (ii) appoint a paying agent (which shall satisfy the eligibility criteria set forth in Section 10.8(a))
(the “Paying Agent”) at whose office or agency Notes may be presented for payment. The Note Registrar shall keep a
register of the Notes (including the name and address of each such Noteholder) and of their transfer and exchange. The Trustee shall
indicate in its books and records the principal amount owing to each Noteholder from time to time. The Issuer may appoint one or more
co-registrars and one or more additional paying agents. The term “Paying Agent” shall include any additional paying agent
and the term “Note Registrar” shall include any co-registrars. The Issuer may change the Paying Agent or the Note Registrar
without prior notice to any Noteholder. The Issuer shall notify the Trustee in writing of the name and address of any Agent not a party
to this Base Indenture. The Trustee is hereby initially appointed as the Note Registrar and the Paying Agent. Upon any resignation or
removal of the Note Registrar, the Issuer shall promptly appoint a successor Note Registrar or, in the absence of such appointment, the
Issuer shall assume the duties of the Note Registrar.
(b)
The Issuer shall enter into an appropriate agency agreement with any Agent not a party to this Base Indenture. Such agency agreement
shall implement the provisions of this Base Indenture that relate to such Agent. If the Issuer fails to maintain a Note Registrar or
Paying Agent, the Trustee hereby agrees to act as such, and shall be entitled to appropriate compensation in accordance with this Base
Indenture until the Issuer shall appoint a replacement Note Registrar or Paying Agent, as applicable.
Section
2.6 Paying Agent to Hold Money in Trust.
(a)
The Issuer will cause the Paying Agent (if the Paying Agent is not the Trustee) to execute and deliver to the Trustee an instrument in
which the Paying Agent shall agree with the Trustee (and if the Trustee is the Paying Agent, it hereby so agrees), subject to the provisions
of this Section 2.6, that the Paying Agent will:
(i)
hold all sums held by it for the payment of amounts due with respect to the Notes in trust for the benefit of the Persons entitled thereto
until such sums shall be paid to such Persons or otherwise disposed of as herein provided and pay such sums to such Persons as herein
provided;
(ii)
give the Trustee written notice of any default by the Issuer of which it has Actual Knowledge in the making of any payment required to
be made with respect to the Notes;
(iii)
at any time during the continuance of any such default, upon the written request of the Trustee, forthwith pay to the Trustee all sums
so held in trust by the Paying Agent;
(iv)
immediately resign as the Paying Agent and forthwith pay to the Trustee all sums held by it in trust for the payment of Notes if at any
time it ceases to meet the standards required to be met by a Trustee hereunder at the time of its appointment; and
(v)
comply with all requirements of the Code and other applicable tax law (including, for the avoidance of doubt, FATCA) with respect to
the withholding from any payments made by it on any Notes of any applicable withholding taxes imposed thereon and with respect to any
applicable reporting requirements in connection therewith.
(b)
The Issuer may at any time, for the purpose of obtaining the satisfaction and discharge of the Indenture or for any other purpose, by
Company Order direct the Paying Agent to pay to the Trustee all sums held in trust by the Paying Agent, such sums to be held by the Trustee
in trust upon the same terms as those upon which the sums were held in trust by the Paying Agent. Upon such payment by the Paying Agent
to the Trustee, the Paying Agent shall be released from all further liability with respect to such money.
(c)
Subject to applicable laws with respect to escheat of funds, any money held by the Trustee or the Paying Agent in trust for the payment
of any amount due with respect to any Note and remaining unclaimed for two years after such amount has become due and payable shall be
discharged from such trust and be paid to the Issuer upon delivery of a Company Request. The Holder of such Note shall thereafter, as
an unsecured general creditor, look only to the Issuer for payment thereof (but only to the extent of the amounts so paid to the Issuer),
and all liability of the Trustee or the Paying Agent with respect to such trust money paid to the Issuer shall thereupon cease; provided,
however, that the Trustee or the Paying Agent, before being required to make any such repayment, may, at the expense of the Issuer,
cause to be published once, in a newspaper published in the English language, customarily published on each Business Day and of general
circulation in New York City, and in a newspaper customarily published on each Business Day and of general circulation in London, if
applicable, notice that such money remains unclaimed and that, after a date specified therein, which shall not be less than thirty (30)
days from the date of such publication, any unclaimed balance of such money then remaining will be repaid to the Issuer. The Trustee
may also adopt and employ, at the expense of the Issuer, any other commercially reasonable means of notification of such repayment.
Section
2.7 Noteholder List.
(a)
The Trustee will furnish, or the Issuer will cause to be furnished by the Note Registrar, to the Issuer, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager,
the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative or the Paying Agent, within five (5) Business Days after receipt by the Trustee
or the Issuer, as the case may be, of a request therefor from the Issuer, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager, the Control Party, the Controlling
Class Representative or the Paying Agent, respectively, in writing, the names and addresses of the Noteholders of each Series as of the
most recent Record Date for payments to such Noteholders. Every Noteholder, by receiving and holding a Note, agrees with the Trustee
that neither the Trustee, the Note Registrar, the Issuer, the Control Party, the Back-Up Manager, the Controlling Class Representative
nor any of their respective agents shall be held accountable by reason of the disclosure of any such information as to the names and
addresses of the Noteholders hereunder, regardless of the source from which such information was obtained.
(b)
The Trustee shall preserve in as current a form as is reasonably practicable the most recent list available to it of the names and addresses
of Noteholders of each Series of Notes. If the Trustee is not the Note Registrar, the Issuer shall furnish to the Trustee at least seven
(7) Business Days before each Quarterly Payment Date and at such other time as the Trustee may request in writing, a list in such form
and as of such date as the Trustee may reasonably require of the names and addresses of Noteholders of each Series of Notes.
Section
2.8 Transfer and Exchange.
(a)
Upon surrender for registration of transfer of any Note at the office or agency of the Note Registrar, if the requirements of Section
2.8(f) and Section 8-401(a) of the New York UCC are met (as determined by the Issuer), the Issuer shall execute and, after the Issuer
has executed, the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver to the Noteholder, in the name of the designated transferee or transferees,
one or more new Notes, in any authorized denominations, of the same Series and Class (and, if applicable, Subclass or Tranche) and a
like original aggregate principal amount of the Notes so transferred. At the option of any Noteholder, Notes may be exchanged for other
Notes of the same Series and Class (and, if applicable, Subclass or Tranche) in authorized denominations of like original aggregate principal
amount of the Notes so exchanged, upon surrender of the Notes to be exchanged at any office or agency of the Note Registrar maintained
for such purpose. Whenever Notes of any Series are so surrendered for exchange, if the requirements of Section 2.8(f) and (g)
and Section 8-401(a) of the New York UCC are met (as determined by the Issuer), the Issuer shall execute, and after the Issuer has
executed, the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver to the Noteholder, the Notes which the Noteholder making the exchange is entitled
to receive.
(b)
Every Note presented or surrendered for registration of transfer or exchange shall be (i) duly endorsed by, or be accompanied by a written
instrument of transfer in form satisfactory to the Trustee, the Issuer and the Note Registrar duly executed by, the Holder thereof or
such Holder’s attorney duly authorized in writing with a medallion signature guarantee and (ii) accompanied by such other documents
as the Trustee or the Note Registrar may require, including evidence reasonably satisfactory to it to document the identities and/or
signatures of the transferor, and the transferee (including but not limited to the applicable Internal Revenue Service Form W-8 or W-9).
The Issuer shall execute and deliver to the Trustee or the Note Registrar, as applicable, Notes in such amounts and at such times as
are necessary to enable the Trustee to fulfill its responsibilities under the Indenture and the Notes.
(c)
All Notes issued and authenticated upon any registration of transfer or exchange of the Notes shall be the valid obligations of the Issuer,
evidencing the same indebtedness, and entitled to the same benefits under the Indenture, as the Notes surrendered upon such registration
of transfer or exchange.
(d)
The preceding provisions of this Section 2.8 notwithstanding, (i) the Trustee, the Issuer or the Note Registrar, as the case may
be, shall not be required (A) to issue, register the transfer of or exchange of any Note of any Series for a period beginning at the
opening of business fifteen (15) days preceding the selection of any Series of Notes for redemption and ending at the close of business
on the day of the mailing of the relevant notice of redemption or (B) to register the transfer of or exchange any Note so selected for
redemption, and (ii) no assignment or transfer of a Note or any commitment in respect thereof shall be effective until such assignment
or transfer shall have been recorded in the Note Register and in the books and records of the Trustee, as applicable, pursuant to Section
2.5(a).
(e)
Unless otherwise provided in the Series Supplement, no service charge shall be payable for any registration of transfer or exchange of
Notes, but the Issuer, the Note Registrar or the Trustee, as the case may be, may require payment by the Noteholder of a sum sufficient
to cover any Tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in connection with any transfer or exchange of Notes.
(f)
Unless otherwise provided in the Series Supplement, registration of transfer of Notes containing a legend relating to the restrictions
on transfer of such Notes (which legend shall be set forth in the Series Supplement) shall be effected only if the conditions set forth
in such Series Supplement are satisfied. Notwithstanding anything contained herein or in a Series Supplement to the contrary, neither
the Trustee nor the Note Registrar shall be responsible for ascertaining whether any transfer or exchange of a Note or any insertion
or removal of a legend on a Note complies with the terms of this Base Indenture or a Series Supplement or any applicable laws; provided
that if a transfer certificate or opinion is specifically required by the express terms of this Base Indenture or a Series Supplement
to be delivered to the Trustee or the Note Registrar in connection with a transfer, the Trustee or the Note Registrar, as the case may
be, shall be under a duty to receive the same but shall not be required to determine (but may rely on a determination made by the Issuer
with respect to) the sufficiency of any such transfer certificate or opinion; and provided further that the Issuer shall confirm to the
Trustee in writing its approval of any proposed transfer of Notes, upon which approval the Trustee may conclusively rely as to compliance
of such transfer with the terms of this Base Indenture, the Series Supplement, and all applicable laws.
(g)
Each transferee of a Note shall provide to the Issuer and the Trustee a transferee certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit
H (a “Transferee Certificate”) in connection with such transfer. If the transferee is unable to provide a Transferee
Certificate, or would otherwise cause the Issuer to be unable to rely on the “private placement” safe harbor of Treasury
Regulation Section 1.7704-1(h), such transfer will be void and of no force or effect and shall not bind or be recognized by the Issuer
or any other Person; provided, however, that a Transferee Certificate that omits one or more of paragraphs (2)-(4) of Exhibit H
shall be acceptable if the Issuer receives written advice of Katten Muchin Rosenman LLP or an opinion of other nationally recognized
U.S. tax counsel experienced in such matters, to the effect that the acquisition or transfer will not cause the Issuer to be treated
as a publicly traded partnership taxable as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
Section
2.9 Persons Deemed Owners.
Prior
to due presentment for registration of transfer of any Note, the Trustee, the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative, any
Agent and the Issuer may deem and treat the Person in whose name any Note is registered (as of the day of determination) as the absolute
owner of such Note for the purpose of receiving payment of principal of and interest on such Note and for all other purposes whatsoever,
whether or not such Note is overdue, and none of the Trustee, the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative, any Agent nor
the Issuer shall be affected by notice to the contrary.
Section
2.10 Replacement Notes.
(a)
If (i) any mutilated Note is surrendered to the Trustee, or the Trustee receives evidence to its reasonable satisfaction of the destruction,
loss or theft of any Note and (ii) there is delivered to the Issuer and the Trustee such security or indemnity as may be required by
them to hold the Issuer and the Trustee harmless then, provided that the requirements of Section 2.8(f) and Section 8-405
of the New York UCC are met (as determined by the Issuer), the Issuer shall execute and upon their request the Trustee or an authenticating
agent appointed by the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver, in exchange for or in lieu of any such mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen
Note, a replacement Note; provided, however, that if any such destroyed, lost or stolen Note, but not a mutilated Note,
shall have become, or within seven (7) days shall be, due and payable, instead of issuing a replacement Note, the Issuer may pay such
destroyed, lost or stolen Note when so due or payable without surrender thereof. If, after the delivery of such replacement Note or payment
of a destroyed, lost or stolen Note pursuant to the preceding sentence, a protected purchaser (within the meaning of Section 8-303 of
the New York UCC) of the original Note in lieu of which such replacement Note was issued presents for payment such original Note, the
Issuer and the Trustee shall be entitled to recover such replacement Note (or such payment) from the Person to whom it was delivered
or any Person taking such replacement Note from such Person to whom such replacement Note was delivered or any assignee of such Person,
except a Protected Purchaser, and shall be entitled to recover upon the security or indemnity provided therefor to the extent of any
loss, damage, cost or expense incurred by the Issuer or the Trustee in connection therewith.
(b)
Upon the issuance of any replacement Note under this Section 2.10, the Issuer may require the payment by the Holder of such Note
of a sum sufficient to cover any Tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in relation thereto and any other reasonable expenses
(including the fees and expenses of the Trustee and the Note Registrar) connected therewith.
(c)
Every replacement Note issued pursuant to this Section 2.10 in replacement of any mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Note shall
constitute an original additional contractual obligation of the Issuer and such replacement Note shall be entitled to all the benefits
of the Indenture equally and proportionately with any and all other Notes duly issued under the Indenture (in accordance with the priorities
and other terms set forth herein and in each Series Supplement).
(d)
The provisions of this Section 2.10 are exclusive and shall preclude (to the extent lawful) all other rights and remedies with
respect to the replacement or payment of mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Notes.
Section
2.11 Treasury Notes.
In
determining whether the Noteholders of the required Aggregate Outstanding Principal Amount of Notes or the required Outstanding Principal
Amount of any Series or any Class, Subclass or Tranche of any Series of Notes, as the case may be, have concurred in any direction, waiver
or consent, Notes owned, legally or beneficially, by the Issuer or any Affiliate of the Issuer shall be considered as though they are
not Outstanding, except that for the purpose of determining whether the Trustee shall be protected in relying on any such direction,
waiver or consent, only Notes of which a Trust Officer has received written notice of such ownership shall be so disregarded.
Section
2.12 Book-Entry Notes.
(a)
Unless otherwise provided in any Series Supplement, the Notes of each Class, Subclass or Tranche of each Series, upon original issuance,
shall be issued in the form of typewritten Notes representing Book-Entry Notes and delivered to the depository (or its custodian) specified
in such Series Supplement (the “Depository”) which shall be the Clearing Agency on behalf of such Series or such Class,
Subclass or Tranche. The Notes of each Class, Subclass or Tranche of each Series shall, unless otherwise provided in the Series Supplement,
initially be registered on the Note Register in the name of the Clearing Agency or the nominee of the Clearing Agency. No Note Owner
will receive a definitive note representing such Note Owner’s interest in the related Series of Notes, except as provided in Section
2.13. Unless and until definitive, fully registered Notes of any Series or any Class, Subclass or Tranche of any Series (“Definitive
Notes”) have been issued to Note Owners pursuant to Section 2.13:
(i)
the provisions of this Section 2.12 shall be in full force and effect with respect to each of such Notes;
(ii)
the Issuer, the Paying Agent, the Note Registrar, the Trustee, the Control Party and the Controlling Class Representative may deal with
the Clearing Agency and the applicable Clearing Agency Participants for all purposes (including the payment of principal of, premium,
if any, and interest on the Notes and the giving of instructions or directions hereunder or under the Series Supplement) as the sole
Holder of the Notes, and shall have no obligation to the Note Owners;
(iii)
to the extent that the provisions of this Section 2.12 conflict with any other provisions of the Indenture, the provisions of
this Section 2.12 shall control with respect to each such Class, Subclass, Tranche or Series of the Notes;
(iv)
subject to the rights of the Manager and the Controlling Class Representative under the Indenture, the rights of Note Owners of each
such Class or Series of Notes shall be exercised only through the Clearing Agency and the applicable Clearing Agency Participants and
shall be limited to those established by law and agreements between such Note Owners and the Clearing Agency and/or the Clearing Agency
Participants, and all references in the Indenture to actions by the Noteholders shall refer to actions taken by the Clearing Agency upon
instructions from the Clearing Agency Participants, and all references in the Indenture to distributions, notices, reports and statements
to the Noteholders shall refer to distributions, notices, reports and statements to the Clearing Agency, as registered holder of the
Notes of such Series for distribution to the Note Owners in accordance with the Applicable Procedures of the Clearing Agency; and
(v)
subject to the rights of the Manager and the Controlling Class Representative under the Indenture, whenever the Indenture requires or
permits actions to be taken based upon instructions or directions of Noteholders evidencing a specified percentage of the Aggregate Outstanding
Principal Amount of Notes or the Outstanding Principal Amount of a Series or Class, Subclass or Tranche of a Series of Notes, the Clearing
Agency shall be deemed to represent such percentage only to the extent that it has received instructions to such effect from Note Owners
and/or their related Clearing Agency Participants owning or representing, respectively, such required percentage of the beneficial interest
in the Outstanding Notes or such Series or such Class, Subclass or Tranche of such Series of Notes Outstanding, as the case may be, and
has delivered such instructions in writing to the Trustee.
(b)
Unless and until Definitive Notes of such Series are issued pursuant to Section 2.13, the Clearing Agency will make book-entry
transfers among the Clearing Agency Participants and receive and transmit distributions of principal, premium, if any, and interest on
the Notes to such Clearing Agency Participants.
(c)
Whenever notice or other communication to the Noteholders is required under the Indenture, unless and until Definitive Notes shall have
been issued to Note Owners pursuant to Section 2.13, the Trustee and the Issuer shall give all such notices and communications
specified herein to be given to Noteholders to the Clearing Agency for distribution to the Note Owners in accordance with the Applicable
Procedures of the Clearing Agency.
Section
2.13 Definitive Notes.
(a)
The Notes of any Series or Class, Subclass or Tranche of any Series, to the extent provided in the Series Supplement, upon original issuance,
may be issued in the form of Definitive Notes. The Series Supplement shall set forth the legend relating to the restrictions on transfer
of such Definitive Notes and such other restrictions as may be applicable.
(b)
With respect to the Notes of any Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of any Series issued in the form of typewritten Notes representing
Book-Entry Notes, if (i) (A) the Issuer advises the Trustee in writing that the Clearing Agency is no longer willing or able to discharge
properly its responsibilities with respect to any such Series of Notes and (B) the Issuer is unable to locate a qualified successor,
(ii) the Issuer, at its option, advises the Trustee in writing that it elects to terminate the book-entry system through the Clearing
Agency with respect to any Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of any Series of Notes Outstanding issued in the form of Book-Entry Notes
or (iii) after the occurrence of a Rapid Amortization Event, with respect to any Series of Notes Outstanding, Note Owners holding a beneficial
interest in excess of 50% of the aggregate Outstanding Principal Amount of such Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes advise the
Trustee and the applicable Clearing Agency through the applicable Clearing Agency Participants in writing that the continuation of a
book-entry system through the applicable Clearing Agency is no longer in the best interests of such Note Owners, the Trustee shall notify
all Note Owners of such Series, through the applicable Clearing Agency Participants, of the occurrence of any such event and of the availability
of Definitive Notes to Note Owners of such Series. Upon surrender to the Trustee of the Notes of such Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche
by the applicable Clearing Agency, accompanied by registration instructions from the applicable Clearing Agency for registration, the
Issuer shall execute and the Trustee shall authenticate, upon receipt of a Company Order, and deliver an equal aggregate principal amount
of Definitive Notes in accordance with the instructions of the Clearing Agency. Neither the Issuer nor the Trustee shall be liable for
any delay in delivery of such instructions and may each conclusively rely on, and shall be protected in relying on, such instructions.
Upon the issuance of Definitive Notes of such Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes all references herein to obligations imposed
upon or to be performed by the applicable Clearing Agency shall be deemed to be imposed upon and performed by the Trustee, to the extent
applicable with respect to such Definitive Notes, and the Trustee shall recognize the Holders of the Definitive Notes of such Series,
Class, Subclass or Tranche of such Series as Noteholders of such Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of such Series hereunder and under
the Series Supplement.
Section
2.14 Cancellation.
The
Issuer may at any time deliver to the Trustee for cancellation any Notes previously authenticated and delivered hereunder which the Issuer
or an Affiliate thereof may have acquired in any manner whatsoever, and all Notes so delivered shall be promptly cancelled by the Trustee.
The Note Registrar and the Paying Agent shall forward to the Trustee any Notes surrendered to them for registration of transfer, exchange
or payment. The Trustee shall cancel all Notes surrendered for registration of transfer, exchange, payment, replacement or cancellation.
The Issuer may not issue new Notes to replace Notes that they have redeemed or paid or that have been delivered to the Trustee for cancellation.
All cancelled Notes held by the Trustee shall be disposed of in accordance with the Trustee’s standard disposition procedures unless
the Issuer shall direct that cancelled Notes be returned to them for destruction pursuant to a Company Order. No cancelled Notes may
be reissued. No provision of this Base Indenture or any Supplement that relates to prepayment procedures, penalties, fees, make-whole
payments or any other related matters shall be applicable to any Notes cancelled pursuant to and in accordance with this Section 2.14.
Section
2.15 Principal and Interest.
(a)
The principal of and premium, if any, on each Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes shall be due and payable at the times and in
the amounts set forth in the Series Supplement and in accordance with the Priority of Payments.
(b)
Each Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes shall accrue interest as provided in the Series Supplement and such interest shall be
due and payable for such Series on each Quarterly Payment Date in accordance with the Priority of Payments.
(c)
Except as provided in the following sentence, the Person in whose name any Note is registered at the close of business on any Record
Date with respect to a Quarterly Payment Date for such Note shall be entitled to receive the principal, premium, if any, and interest
payable on such Quarterly Payment Date notwithstanding the cancellation of such Note upon any registration of transfer, exchange or substitution
of such Note subsequent to such Record Date. Any interest payable at maturity shall be paid to the Person to whom the principal of such
Note is payable.
(d)
Pursuant to the authority of the Paying Agent under Section 2.6(a)(v), the Paying Agent shall make all payments of interest on
the Notes net of any applicable withholding taxes and Noteholders shall be treated as having received as payments of interest any amounts
withheld with respect to such withholding taxes.
Section
2.16 Tax Treatment.
(a)
The Issuer has structured this Base Indenture and the Exchange Notes have been (or will be) issued with the intention that the Exchange
Notes (other than any Class M-2 Notes or Notes that are owned for United States federal income tax purposes by the Manager or an affiliate
of the Manager) be treated for United States federal income tax purposes (and, to the extent permitted by Requirements of Law, for state
and local income and franchise tax purposes) as indebtedness of the Issuer or, if the Issuer is treated as a division of another entity
for United States federal income tax purposes, such other entity. Any Person acquiring any direct or indirect interest in any such Note
(including through an Exchangeable Note) by acceptance of such Notes (or Exchangeable Notes) agrees to treat such Notes for purposes
of all Taxes in a manner consistent with the foregoing characterization, unless otherwise required by Requirements of Law.
(b)
Each Noteholder (and each other person that is a beneficial owner of an interest in a Note), by its acceptance of a Note, agrees to provide
and shall provide to the Trustee, the Paying Agent and/or the Issuer (or other Person responsible for withholding of taxes) with its
Tax Information, and will update or replace such Tax Information as necessary at any time required by law or promptly upon request. Further,
each Noteholder (and each other person that is a beneficial owner of an interest in a Note) is deemed to understand, acknowledge and
agree that the Paying Agent and the Issuer (or other Person responsible for withholding of taxes) have the right to withhold on payments
with respect to a Note (without any corresponding gross-up) where an applicable party fails to comply with the requirements set forth
in the preceding sentence or the Trustee, the Paying Agent or the Issuer (or other Person responsible for withholding of taxes) is otherwise
required to so withhold under applicable law.
(c)
The Issuer intends to treat Noteholders of Exchangeable Notes as directly owning the separate classes of Exchange Notes corresponding
to such Exchangeable Notes for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Each Noteholder (and each other person that is a beneficial owner of
an interest in an Exchangeable Note), by its acceptance of an Exchangeable Note, agrees to treat such Exchangeable Note for purposes
of all Taxes in a manner consistent with the foregoing characterization, unless otherwise required by Requirements of Law.
(d)
Each Noteholder (and each other person that is a beneficial owner of an interest in an Exchange Note or Exchangeable Note, as applicable),
by its acceptance of such Exchange Note or Exchangeable Note, acknowledges and agrees that such Exchange Note or Exchangeable Note is
subject to transfer restrictions and each such Noteholder (and each other person that is a beneficial owner of an interest in an Exchange
Note or Exchangeable Note, as applicable), other than the Issuer or an Affiliate of the Issuer, by its acceptance of such Exchange Note
or Exchangeable Note, will be deemed to have made the representations and certifications listed on Exhibit H, and each such Noteholder
that is the Issuer or an Affiliate of the Issuer, by its acceptance of such an Exchange Note or Exchangeable Note, will be deemed to
have made the representations and certifications listed in paragraphs (2) through (6) on Exhibit H.
Section
2.17 Securities Law Restrictions.
(a)
The Notes have not been registered under the 1933 Act or registered or qualified under any state securities laws or the securities laws
of any other jurisdiction. Neither the Issuer nor any other person is required to so register or qualify the Notes or to provide registration
rights to any investor therein.
(b)
Subject to any additional restrictions or deemed representations set forth in the Series Supplement, each Note Owner and purchaser of
Notes will be deemed to have represented to the Issuer and agreed that it is (i) a “qualified institutional buyer” within
the meaning of Rule 144A under the 1933 Act or a non-“U.S. person” within the meaning of Regulation S under the 1933 Act,
(ii) not purchasing the Notes with a view to the distribution thereof in violation of applicable securities laws and (iii) aware that
the sale of the Notes to it is being made in reliance on Regulation D, Rule 144A and/or Regulation S. After the initial placement of
the Notes to the Depository or to investors, as applicable, pursuant to an offering made under the Issuer’s applicable offering
memorandum, no interest or participation in the Notes may be reoffered, resold, pledged or otherwise transferred unless the Notes are
registered pursuant to the 1933 Act and registered or qualified pursuant to any applicable securities laws or subject to an exemption
therefrom.
Section
2.18 Exchangeable Notes.
The
issuer may issue Exchangeable Notes pursuant to the Series Supplement. The Exchangeable Notes are not separate legal obligations of the
Issuer but are Notes issued by the Issuer which represent a combination (as described in the Series Supplement) of Classes of Exchange
Notes with the payment, voting and consent rights and obligations of such Exchange Notes. The characteristics of the Exchangeable Notes
will generally reflect the characteristics of the corresponding Exchange Notes and vice versa. Such Exchangeable Notes may be exchanged
for Exchange Notes in accordance with the combinations specified in the Series Supplement. To the extent Exchangeable Notes are issued
on the Closing Date, Exchange Notes with an initial outstanding principal amount equal to the initial outstanding principal amount of
such Exchangeable Notes issued on the Closing Date will be deemed to have been exchanged for such Exchangeable Notes on the Closing Date
in a permissible exchange combination.
Article
III
SECURITY
Section
3.1 Grant of Security Interest.
(a)
To secure the Obligations, the Issuer hereby pledges, assigns, conveys, delivers, transfers and sets over to the Trustee, for the benefit
of the Secured Parties, and hereby grants to the Trustee, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest in the Issuer’s
right, title and interest in, to and under all of the following property to the extent now owned or at any time hereafter acquired by
the Issuer (collectively, the “Indenture Collateral”):
(i)
the Equity Interests of any Person owned by the Issuer and all rights as a member or shareholder of each such Person under the Charter
Documents of each such Person;
(ii)
each Account and all amounts or other property on deposit in or otherwise credited to such Accounts;
(iii)
the books and records (whether in physical, electronic or other form) of the Issuer;
(iv)
the rights, powers, remedies and authorities of the Issuer under each of the Transaction Documents (other than the Indenture and the
Notes) to which it is a party and under the Contingent Value Rights Agreement;
(v)
any and all other property of the Issuer now or hereafter acquired, including, without limitation, all accounts, chattel paper, commercial
tort claims, deposit accounts, documents, equipment, fixtures, general intangibles, instruments, inventory, securities, securities accounts
and other investment property and letter-of-credit rights (in each case, as defined in the New York UCC); and
(vi)
all payments, proceeds, supporting obligations and accrued and future rights to payment with respect to the foregoing;
provided,
that (A) the Issuer shall not be required to pledge, and the Collateral shall not include, more than 65% of the Equity Interests (and
any rights associated with such Equity Interests) of any foreign Subsidiary of the Issuer that is a corporation for United States federal
income tax purposes and in no circumstance will any such foreign Subsidiary be required to pledge any assets, become a Guarantor or otherwise
guarantee the Notes and (B) the security interest in (1) each Series Distribution Account and the funds or securities deposited therein
or credited thereto will only secure the related Class of Notes as set forth herein and (2) the Reserve Account and the funds or securities
deposited therein or credited thereto shall only be for the benefit of the Super Senior Noteholders, Senior Noteholders, the Senior Subordinated
Noteholders and the Trustee, in its capacity as trustee for the Super Senior Noteholders, the Senior Noteholders and the Senior Subordinated
Noteholders.
The
Trustee shall have no security interest in any Collateral Exclusions.
(a)
The foregoing grant is made in trust to secure the Obligations and to secure compliance with the provisions of this Base Indenture and
any Series Supplements, all as provided in this Base Indenture. The Trustee, on behalf of the Secured Parties, acknowledges such grant,
accepts the trusts under this Base Indenture in accordance with the provisions of this Base Indenture and agrees, subject to the other
terms and provisions of the Indenture, to perform its duties required in this Base Indenture. The Indenture Collateral shall secure the
Obligations equally and ratably without prejudice, priority or distinction (except, with respect to any Series of Notes, as otherwise
stated in the Series Supplement or in the applicable provisions of this Base Indenture).
(b)
In addition, pursuant to and within the time periods specified in Section 8.38, the Guarantors shall execute and deliver to the
Control Party (with a copy to the Trustee), for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a Mortgage with respect to each Owned Real Property
and New Owned Real Property owned by such Guarantor, which shall be delivered to the Control Party (with a copy to the Trustee) or its
agent to be held in escrow; provided that upon the occurrence of a Mortgage Preparation Event, the Control Party or its agent
shall, within five (5) Business Days of receiving direction of the Controlling Class Representative, be required to deliver the Mortgages
to the applicable recording office for recordation in the event that any Rapid Amortization Event occurs (or is continuing) on or following
the 120th day following the occurrence of a Mortgage Preparation Event (unless such recordation requirement is waived by the
Control Party, acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) in accordance with Section 8.38.
(c)
The parties hereto agree and acknowledge that each certificated Equity Interest and each Mortgage constituting Indenture Collateral may
be held by a custodian on behalf of the Trustee or the Control Party, as applicable.
Section
3.2 Certain Rights and Obligations of the Issuer Unaffected.
(a)
Notwithstanding the grant of the security interest in the Indenture Collateral hereunder to the Trustee, on behalf of the Secured Parties,
the Issuer acknowledges that the Manager, on behalf of the Guarantors, shall, subject to the terms and conditions of the Management Agreement,
nevertheless have the right, subject to the Trustee’s right to revoke such right, in whole or in part, in the event of the occurrence
of an Event of Default, (i) to give, in accordance with the Managing Standard, all consents, requests, notices, directions, approvals,
extensions or waivers, if any, which are required or permitted to be given by the Issuer under the Collateral Documents, and to enforce
all rights, remedies, powers, privileges and claims of the Issuer under the Collateral Documents, (ii) to give, in accordance with the
Managing Standard, all consents, requests, notices, directions and approvals, if any, which are required or permitted to be given by
the Issuer under any IP License Agreement to which the Issuer is a party and (iii) to take any other actions required or permitted under
the terms of the Management Agreement.
(b)
The grant of the security interest by the Issuer in the Indenture Collateral to the Trustee on behalf of the Secured Parties shall not
(i) relieve the Issuer from the performance of any term, covenant, condition or agreement on the Issuer’s part to be performed
or observed under or in connection with any of the Collateral Documents or otherwise with respect to the Indenture Collateral or (ii)
impose any obligation on the Trustee or any of the Secured Parties to perform or observe any such term, covenant, condition or agreement
on the Issuer’s part to be so performed or observed or impose any liability on the Trustee or any of the Secured Parties for any
act or omission on the part of the Issuer or from any breach of any representation or warranty on the part of the Issuer.
(c)
The Issuer hereby agrees to indemnify and hold harmless the Trustee and each Secured Party (including their respective directors, officers,
employees and agents) from and against any and all losses, liabilities (including liabilities for penalties), claims, demands, actions,
suits, judgments, reasonable and documented out-of-pocket costs and expenses arising out of or resulting from the security interest granted
hereby, whether or not arising by virtue of any act or omission on the part of the Issuer, including, without limitation, the reasonable
and documented out-of-pocket costs, expenses and disbursements (including reasonable and documented attorneys’ fees and expenses)
incurred by the Trustee or any Secured Party in enforcing the Indenture or any other Transaction Document or preserving any of its rights
to, or realizing upon, any of the Collateral; provided, however, that the foregoing indemnification shall not extend to
any action by the Trustee or any Secured Party which constitutes gross negligence, bad faith or willful misconduct by the Trustee or
any Secured Party or any other indemnified person hereunder. The indemnification provided for in this Section 3.2 shall survive
the removal of, or a resignation by, such Person as Trustee as well as the termination of this Base Indenture or any Series Supplement.
Section
3.3 Performance of Collateral Documents.
Upon
the occurrence of a default or breach (after giving effect to any applicable grace or cure periods) by any Person party to a (i) Collateral
Transaction Document or (ii) Collateral Franchise Business Document (only if a Manager Termination Event or an Event of Default has occurred
and is continuing), promptly following a request from the Trustee to do so and at the Issuer’s expense, the Issuer agrees to take
all such lawful action as permitted under this Base Indenture as the Trustee (acting at the direction of the Control Party (acting at
the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)) may reasonably request to compel or secure the performance and observance by
such Person of its obligations to the Issuer, and to exercise any and all rights, remedies, powers and privileges lawfully available
to the Issuer to the extent and in the manner directed by the Trustee (acting at the direction of the Control Party (acting at the direction
of the Controlling Class Representative)), including, without limitation, the transmission of notices of default and the institution
of legal or administrative actions or proceedings to compel or secure performance by such Person of its obligations thereunder. If (i)
the Issuer shall have failed, within fifteen (15) Business Days of receiving such direction of the Trustee, to take commercially reasonable
action to accomplish such directions of the Trustee, (ii) the Issuer refuses to take any such action, as reasonably determined by the
Control Party in good faith, or (iii) the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) reasonably
determines that such action must be taken immediately, in any such case the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling
Class Representative) may, but shall not be obligated to, take, and the Trustee, subject to the other terms and provisions of the Indenture,
shall take (if so directed by the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)), at the expense of
the Issuer, such previously directed action and any related action permitted under this Base Indenture which the Control Party (acting
at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) thereafter determines is appropriate (without the need under this provision
or any other provision under this Base Indenture to direct the Issuer to take such action), on behalf of the Issuer and the Secured Parties.
Section
3.4 Stamp, Other Similar Taxes and Filing Fees.
The
Issuer shall indemnify and hold harmless the Trustee and each Secured Party from any present or future claim for liability for any stamp,
documentary or other similar tax and any penalties or interest and expenses with respect thereto, that may be assessed, levied or collected
by any jurisdiction in connection with the Indenture, any other Transaction Document or any Indenture Collateral. The Issuer shall pay,
and indemnify and hold harmless each Secured Party against, any and all amounts in respect of all search, filing, recording and registration
fees, taxes, excise taxes and other similar imposts that may be payable or determined to be payable in respect of the execution, delivery,
performance and/or enforcement of the Indenture or any other Transaction Document.
Section
3.5 Authorization to File Financing Statements.
(a)
The Issuer hereby irrevocably authorizes the Control Party or its agents on behalf of the Secured Parties (acting at the direction of
the Controlling Class Representative) at any time and from time to time to file or record in any filing office in any applicable jurisdiction
financing statements and other filing or recording documents or instruments (or, with respect to the Mortgages, upon the occurrence of
a Mortgage Recordation Event, unless such Mortgage Recordation Event is waived by the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling
Class Representative)) with respect to the Indenture Collateral, including, without limitation, any and all Securitization IP (to the
extent set forth in Section 8.25(c) and Section 8.25(e)), to perfect the security interests of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured
Parties under this Base Indenture. The Issuer authorizes the filing of any such financing statement naming the Trustee as secured party
and indicating that the Indenture Collateral (a) includes “all assets” or words of similar effect or import regardless of
whether any particular assets comprised in the Indenture Collateral fall within the scope of Article 9 of the UCC including, without
limitation, any and all Securitization IP, or (b) as being of an equal or lesser scope or with greater detail. The Issuer agrees to furnish
any information necessary to accomplish the foregoing promptly upon the Control Party’s request. The Issuer also hereby ratifies
and authorizes the filing on behalf of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, of any financing statement with respect to
the Indenture Collateral made prior to the date hereof.
(b)
The Issuer acknowledges that the Indenture Collateral may include certain rights of the Issuer as secured party under the Transaction
Documents. To the extent the Issuer is a secured party under the Transaction Documents, the Issuer hereby irrevocably appoints the Trustee
as its representative with respect to all financing statements filed to perfect such security interests and authorizes the Control Party
on behalf of the Secured Parties (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) to make such filings it deems necessary
to reflect the Trustee as secured party of record with respect to such financing statements.
Article
IV
REPORTS
Section
4.1 Reports and Instructions to Trustee.
(a)
Monthly Manager’s Certificates. By 10:00 a.m. (New York City time) on the fifth Business Day prior to each Monthly Allocation
Date commencing with the Monthly Allocation Date immediately following the Monthly Collection Period ending in November 2024, the Issuer
shall furnish, or cause the Manager to furnish, to the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party a certificate substantially
in the form of Exhibit A specifying the allocation of Collections on the following Monthly Allocation Date (each a “Monthly
Manager’s Certificate”), including the Manager’s statement specified in such form. The initial Monthly Manager’s
Certificate delivered after the Closing Date may include allocations of amounts received prior to the Closing Date.
(b)
[Reserved].
(c)
Quarterly Noteholders’ Reports. On or before the third (3rd) Business Day prior to each Quarterly Payment Date,
the Issuer shall furnish, or cause the Manager to furnish, a statement substantially in the form of the applicable exhibit to the Series
Supplement with respect to each Series of Notes (each, a “Quarterly Noteholders’ Report”), including the Manager’s
statement specified in such form, to the Trustee, the Control Party and each Paying Agent, with a copy to the Back-Up Manager.
(d)
Quarterly Compliance Certificates. On or before the third (3rd) Business Day prior to each Quarterly Payment Date,
the Manager shall deliver to the Trustee (with a copy to each of the Control Party and the Back-Up Manager) an Officer’s Certificate
(each, a “Quarterly Compliance Certificate”) to the effect that, except as provided in a notice delivered pursuant
to Section 8.8, no Potential Rapid Amortization Event, Rapid Amortization Event, Default or Event of Default has occurred or is
continuing.
(e)
Scheduled Principal Payments Deficiency Notices. On the Quarterly Calculation Date with respect to any Quarterly Collection Period,
the Issuer shall furnish, or cause the Manager to furnish, to the Trustee (with a copy to each of the Control Party and the Back-Up Manager)
written notice of any Scheduled Principal Payments Deficiency Event with respect to any Class or Series of Notes that occurred with respect
to such Quarterly Collection Period (any such notice, a “Scheduled Principal Payments Deficiency Notice”).
(f)
Annual Accountants’ Reports. Within one hundred and twenty (120) days after the end of each fiscal year, commencing with
the fiscal year ending in December 2024, the Issuer shall furnish, or cause the Manager to furnish, to the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager
and the Control Party the reports of the Independent Auditors or the Back-Up Manager required to be delivered to the Issuer by the Manager
pursuant to Section 3.3 of the Management Agreement.
(g)
Securitization Entity Financial Statements. The Manager on behalf of the Securitization Entities shall provide to the Trustee,
the Control Party and the Back-Up Manager with respect to each Series of Notes Outstanding the following financial statements:
(i)
within sixty (60) days after the end of each of the first three fiscal quarters of each fiscal year (and, solely for fiscal year 2024,
the fourth fiscal quarter of such fiscal year), commencing with the fiscal quarter ending in December 2024, an unaudited condensed combined
consolidated balance sheet of the Securitization Entities as of the end of such fiscal quarter and unaudited condensed combined consolidated
statements of operations and comprehensive income, changes in members’ equity and cash flows of the Securitization Entities for
such fiscal quarter and for the fiscal year-to-date period then ended (in the case of the second and third fiscal quarters of each fiscal
year), which financial statements may be accompanied by supplemental schedules combining and consolidating each of the Securitization
Entities; and
(ii)
within one hundred and twenty (120) days after the end of each fiscal year, commencing with the fiscal year ending in December 2025,
an audited combined consolidated balance sheet of the Securitization Entities as of the end of such fiscal year and audited combined
consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income, changes in members’ equity and cash flows of the Securitization
Entities for such fiscal year, setting forth in comparative form (where appropriate) the comparable amounts for the previous fiscal year,
which financial statements may be accompanied by supplemental schedules combining and consolidating each of the Securitization Entities,
prepared in accordance with GAAP and accompanied by an opinion thereon of the Independent Auditors stating that such audited financial
statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Securitization Entities and the results of their operations
and cash flows in accordance with GAAP.
(h)
Twin Hospitality Group Inc. Financial Statements. So long as Twin Hospitality is the Manager, the Manager on behalf of the Issuer
shall provide to the Trustee, the Control Party and the Back-Up Manager with respect to each Series of Notes Outstanding the following
financial statements:
(i)
within sixty (60) days after the end of each of the first three fiscal quarters of each fiscal year (and, solely for fiscal year 2024,
the fourth fiscal quarter of such fiscal year), commencing with the fiscal quarter ending in December 2024, an unaudited condensed consolidated
balance sheet of Twin Hospitality and its Subsidiaries as of the end of such fiscal quarter and unaudited condensed consolidated statements
of operations and comprehensive income and cash flows of Twin Hospitality and its Subsidiaries for such fiscal quarter and for the fiscal
year-to-date period then ended (in the case of the second and third fiscal quarters of each fiscal year); and
(ii)
within one hundred and twenty (120) days after the end of each fiscal year, commencing with the fiscal year ending in December 2025,
an audited consolidated balance sheet of Twin Hospitality and its Subsidiaries as of the end of each fiscal year and audited consolidated
statements of operations and comprehensive income, changes in stockholders’ equity and cash flows of Twin Hospitality and its Subsidiaries
for such fiscal year, setting forth in comparative form (where appropriate) the comparable amounts for the previous fiscal year, prepared
in accordance with GAAP and accompanied by an opinion thereon of the Independent Auditors stating that such audited consolidated financial
statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Twin Hospitality and its Subsidiaries and the results
of its operations and cash flows in accordance with GAAP.
(i)
Additional Information. Subject to the Disclosure Exception, the Issuer will furnish, or cause to be furnished, from time to time
such additional information regarding the financial position, results of operations or business of Twin Hospitality and its Subsidiaries
or any Securitization Entity as the Trustee, the Control Party, the Manager or the Back-Up Manager may reasonably request and the Trustee
may furnish any such information received by it to a Holder requesting the same that has delivered an Investor Request Certification
in the form of Exhibit B.
(j)
Instructions as to Withdrawals and Payments. The Issuer will furnish, or cause to be furnished, to the Trustee or the Paying Agent,
as applicable (with a copy to each of the Control Party, the Manager and the Back-Up Manager), written instructions to make withdrawals
and payments from the Collection Account and any other Base Indenture Account or Series Account and to make drawings under any Enhancement,
as contemplated herein and in any Series Supplement. The Trustee and the Paying Agent shall, subject to the terms hereof, promptly follow
any such written instructions.
Section
4.2 [Reserved].
Section
4.3 Rule 144A Information.
For
so long as any of the Notes are “restricted securities” within the meaning of Rule 144(a)(3) under the 1933 Act, the Issuer
agrees to provide to any Noteholder or Note Owner and to any prospective purchaser of Notes designated by such Noteholder or Note Owner
upon the request of such Noteholder or Note Owner or prospective purchaser, any information required to be provided to such holder, owner
or prospective purchaser to satisfy the conditions set forth in Rule 144A(d)(4) under the 1933 Act.
Section
4.4 Reports, Financial Statements and Other Information to Noteholders.
Subject
to the other terms of this Section 4.4, the Trustee will make available this Base Indenture, the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement,
each Series Supplement, any other Transaction Document, each offering memorandum in respect of the offer and sale of Notes, the Quarterly
Noteholders’ Reports, the Quarterly Compliance Certificates, the financial statements referenced in Section 4.1(g) and Section
4.1(h) and, to the extent authorized by the Independent Auditors, the reports referenced in Section 4.1(f), to (a) Noteholders
(and to any prospective investor that provides the Trustee with an Investor Request Certification in the form of Exhibit B) and
(b) the Control Party, the Manager and the Back-Up Manager in a password-protected area of the Trustee’s internet website at www.debtx.com
(or such other address as the Trustee may specify from time to time). The Trustee shall require each party (other than the Control Party,
the Manager and the Back-Up Manager) accessing such password-protected area to register as a Noteholder, Note Owner or a prospective
investor and to make, for the benefit of the Issuer, the applicable representations and warranties described below in a written confirmation
in the form of Exhibit B hereto (an “Investor Request Certification”). The Trustee may disclaim responsibility
for any information distributed by it for which the Trustee was not the original source. Each Person to whom a report or other information
is required to be made available pursuant to this Section 4.4 will be required to comply with the applicable internal procedures
and requirements of the Trustee in effect from time to time (which, as of the date hereof, include such Person contacting the Trustee
in order to request access) and shall be subject to the terms and other restrictions contained on the Trustee’s website. Each time
a Noteholder or other Person who has provided an Investor Request Certification as contemplated herein accesses such internet website,
it will be deemed to have confirmed such representations and warranties as of the date thereof. The Trustee shall provide the Control
Party and the Manager with copies of such Investor Request Certifications, including the identity, contact information, e-mail address
and telephone number of such Noteholders, Note Owners or prospective purchasers upon request, but shall have no responsibility for any
of the information contained therein or liability in connection with disclosure of such information. The Trustee shall have the right
to change the way any such information is made available in order to make such distribution more convenient and/or more accessible to
the Noteholders and the Trustee shall provide timely and adequate notification to all above parties regarding any such changes.
The
Trustee will (or will request that the Manager) make available, upon reasonable advance notice and at the expense of the requesting party,
copies of the Quarterly Noteholders’ Reports, the Quarterly Compliance Certificates, the financial statements referenced in Section
4.1(g) and Section 4.1(h) and the reports referenced in Section 4.1(f) to any Noteholder (or Note Owner) and to any
prospective investor that provides the Trustee with an Investor Request Certification in the form of Exhibit B to the effect that
such party (i) is a Noteholder (or Note Owner) or prospective investor, as applicable, (ii) understands that the materials contain confidential
information, (iii) is requesting the information solely for use in evaluating such party’s investment or potential investment,
as applicable, in the Notes and will keep such information strictly confidential (provided that such party may disclose such information
only (A) to (1) those personnel employed by it who need to know such information, (2) its attorneys and outside auditors that have agreed
to keep such information confidential and to treat the information as confidential information, or (3) a regulatory or self-regulatory
authority pursuant to applicable Requirements of Law or (B) by judicial process), and (iv) is not a Competitor. Notwithstanding the foregoing,
a recipient of such materials may disclose to any and all persons, without limitation of any kind, the tax treatment and tax structure
of the transactions and any related tax strategies to the extent necessary to prevent the transaction from being described as a “confidential
transaction” under U.S. Treasury Regulations Section 1.6011-4(b)(3).
Section
4.5 Manager.
Pursuant
to the Management Agreement, the Manager has agreed to provide certain reports, notices, instructions and other services on behalf of
the Issuer. The Noteholders by their acceptance of the Notes consent to the provision of such reports and notices to the Trustee by the
Manager in lieu of the Issuer. The Trustee shall have no obligation whatsoever to verify, reconfirm or recalculate any information or
material contained in any of the reports, financial statements or other information delivered to it pursuant to this Article IV
or the Management Agreement. All distributions, allocations, remittances and payments to be made by the Trustee or the Paying Agent hereunder
or under any Supplement shall be made based solely upon the most recently delivered written reports and instructions provided to the
Trustee or Paying Agent, as the case may be, by the Manager.
Section
4.6 No Constructive Notice.
Notwithstanding
anything herein to the contrary, delivery of reports, information, Officer’s Certificates and documents to the Trustee is for informational
purposes only and the Trustee’s receipt of such reports, information, Officer’s Certificates or documents shall not constitute
constructive notice to the Trustee of any information contained therein or determinable from information contained therein or otherwise
create any obligation on the part of the Trustee to review any such reports, information, Officer’s Certificates or documents,
including any Issuer’s, the Manager’s or any other Person’s compliance with any of its covenants under the Indenture,
the Notes or any other Transaction Document (as to which the Trustee is entitled to rely exclusively on the most recent Quarterly Compliance
Certificate described above).
Article
V
ALLOCATION
AND APPLICATION OF COLLECTIONS
Section
5.1 Management Accounts and Additional Accounts.
(a)
Establishment of the Management Accounts. The Concentration Account is owned by the Issuer and, as of the date hereof, has been
established as an Eligible Account that has not been established with the Trustee. Such account, as of the Closing Date and at all times
thereafter, shall be (A) pledged to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties pursuant to this Indenture and Section 3.1 of
the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, as applicable, and (B) subject to an Account Control Agreement. Each Management Account shall
be an Eligible Account and, in addition, from time to time, the Issuer may establish additional accounts for the purpose of depositing
Collections or funds necessary to meet large-franchisor exemptions or similar exemptions under applicable franchise laws therein (each
such account and any investment accounts related thereto into which funds are transferred for investment purposes pursuant to Section
5.1(b), an “Additional Management Account”); provided that each such Additional Management Account is (A)
an Eligible Account that has not been established with the Trustee, and (B) any such account owned by the Issuer is (x) pledged by the
Issuer to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties pursuant to this Indenture and Section 3.1 of the Guarantee and Collateral
Agreement, as applicable, and (y) subject to an Account Control Agreement. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this paragraph
(a), in the case of any Management Account which is owned by the Issuer and established after the Closing Date, the Issuer shall
be permitted a period of five (5) Business Days after the establishment of such deposit account to cause such deposit account to be subject
to an Account Control Agreement. The Issuer shall inform Trustee in writing of the details of the Concentration Account or any Additional
Management Account, including the name of the financial institution at which such account is established and the account number.
(b)
Administration of the Management Accounts. The Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) may invest any amounts held in the Management
Accounts in Eligible Investments and such amounts may be transferred by the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) into an investment
account for the sole purpose of investing in Eligible Investments so long as such investment account is (A) an Eligible Account that
is not established with the Trustee, and (B) if owned by Issuer is (x) pledged by the Issuer to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured
Parties pursuant to this Indenture and Section 3.1 of the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, as applicable, and (y) subject to an Account
Control Agreement; provided, however, that any such investment in any Management Account (or in any such investment account)
shall mature not later than the Business Day prior to the next succeeding Monthly Allocation Date. Notwithstanding anything herein or
in any other Transaction Document, the Issuer and Manager shall not transfer any funds into any such investment account until such time
as an Account Control Agreement is entered into with respect thereto (if such account is not established with the Trustee), it being
agreed that the execution and delivery of such Account Control Agreements shall not be required as a condition precedent to the issuance
of Notes on the Closing Date. All income or other gain from such Eligible Investments shall be credited to the related Management Account,
and any loss resulting from such investments shall be charged to the related Management Account. The Issuer shall not direct (or permit)
the disposal of any Eligible Investments prior to the maturity thereof if such disposal would result in a loss of any portion of the
initial purchase price of such Eligible Investment.
(c)
Earnings from the Management Accounts. All interest and earnings (net of losses and investment expenses) paid on funds on deposit
in the Management Accounts owned by the Issuer shall be deemed to be Investment Income on deposit for distribution to the Collection
Account in accordance with Section 5.9.
(d)
No Duty to Monitor. The Trustee shall have no duty or responsibility to monitor the amounts of deposits into or withdrawals from
any Management Account.
Section
5.2 Reserve Account.
(a)
Establishment of the Reserve Account. The Issuer hereby instructs the Trustee to establish a Reserve Account, which account the
Trustee has established as of the Closing Date, and the Issuer hereby agrees that it shall maintain such account with the Trustee for
the benefit of the Super Senior Noteholders, Senior Noteholders, the Senior Subordinated Noteholders and the Trustee. The Reserve Account
shall be an Eligible Account. Amounts to be deposited by the Issuer in the Reserve Account shall be as set forth in the Supplement for
each Series and Class of Super Senior Notes, Senior Notes and Senior Subordinated Notes.
(b)
Administration of the Reserve Account. All amounts held in the Reserve Account shall be invested in Eligible Investments at the
written direction (which may be standing directions) of the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf); provided, however, that
any such investment in the Reserve Account shall mature not later than the Business Day prior to the next succeeding Quarterly Payment
Date. In the absence of written investment instructions hereunder, funds on deposit in the Reserve Account shall remain uninvested with
no liability to the Trustee or the Securities Intermediary. All income or other gain from such Eligible Investments shall be credited
to the Reserve Account, and any loss resulting from such investments shall be charged to the Reserve Account. The Issuer shall not direct
(or permit) the disposal of any Eligible Investments prior to the maturity thereof if such disposal would result in a loss of any portion
of the initial purchase price of such Eligible Investment.
(c)
Earnings from the Reserve Account. All interest and earnings (net of losses and investment expenses) paid on funds on deposit
in the Reserve Account shall be deemed to be Investment Income on deposit for distribution to the Collection Account in accordance with
Section 5.9.
(d)
On each Monthly Allocation Date, the Trustee shall (based on the information contained in the Monthly Manager’s Certificate delivered
on or prior to the related Monthly Allocation Date) withdraw the Reserve Account Withdrawal Amount from the Reserve Account and deposit
such amounts in the Collection Account for further distribution pursuant to the Priority of Payments for such Monthly Allocation Date.
Section
5.3 Permitted Uses Account.
(a)
Establishment of Permitted Uses Account. The Issuer hereby instructs the Trustee to establish the Permitted Uses Account, which
account the Trustee has established as of the Closing Date, and the Issuer hereby agrees that it shall maintain such account with the
Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties.
(b)
Funding of Permitted Uses Account. On the Closing Date, the Manager shall deposit into the Permitted Uses Account all net proceeds
of the issuance and sale of the Series Notes remaining after funding the Reserve Account, paying fees and expenses related to the offering
of the Series Notes and satisfying and discharging the obligations of the Issuer under the Previous Indenture.
(c)
Administration of the Permitted Uses Account.
(i)
Funds in the Permitted Uses Account shall be released by the Trustee to the Manager solely for Permitted Uses and upon receipt by the
Trustee of a Release Request.
(ii)
All amounts held in the Permitted Uses Account shall be invested in Eligible Investments at the written direction (which may be standing
directions) of the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf); provided, however, that any such investment in the Permitted Uses Account
shall mature not later than the Business Day prior to the next succeeding Monthly Allocation Date. In the absence of written investment
instructions hereunder, funds on deposit in the Permitted Uses Account shall remain uninvested with no liability to the Trustee or the
Securities Intermediary. All income or other gain from such Eligible Investments shall be credited to the Permitted Uses Account, and
any loss resulting from such investments shall be charged to the Permitted Uses Account. The Issuer shall not direct (or permit) the
disposal of any Eligible Investments prior to the maturity thereof if such disposal would result in a loss of any portion of the initial
purchase price of such Eligible Investment.
(d)
Earnings from Permitted Uses Account. All interest and earnings (net of losses and investment expenses) paid on funds on deposit
in the Permitted Uses Account shall be deemed to be Investment Income on deposit for distribution in accordance with Section 5.9.
Section
5.4 Collection Account.
(a)
Establishment of Collection Account. The Issuer hereby instructs the Trustee to establish the Collection Account, which account
the Trustee has established as of the Closing Date, and the Issuer hereby agrees that it shall maintain such account with the Trustee
for the benefit of the Secured Parties.
(b)
Administration of the Collection Account. All amounts held in the Collection Account shall be invested in Eligible Investments
at the written direction (which may be standing directions) of the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf); provided, however, that any
such investment in the Collection Account shall mature not later than the Business Day prior to the next succeeding Monthly Allocation
Date. In the absence of written investment instructions hereunder, funds on deposit in the Collection Account shall remain uninvested
with no liability to the Trustee or the Securities Intermediary. All income or other gain from such Eligible Investments shall be credited
to the Collection Account, and any loss resulting from such investments shall be charged to the Collection Account. The Issuer shall
not direct (or permit) the disposal of any Eligible Investments prior to the maturity thereof if such disposal would result in a loss
of any portion of the initial purchase price of such Eligible Investment.
(c)
Earnings from Collection Account. All interest and earnings (net of losses and investment expenses) paid on funds on deposit in
the Collection Account shall be deemed to be Investment Income on deposit for distribution in accordance with Section 5.9.
Section
5.5 Collection Account Administrative Accounts.
(a)
Establishment of Collection Account Administrative Accounts. The Issuer hereby instructs the Trustee to establish the following
accounts (collectively, the “Collection Account Administrative Accounts”), each of which accounts the Trustee has
established as of the Closing Date, and the Issuer hereby agrees that it shall maintain such accounts with the Trustee for the benefit
of the Secured Parties:
(i)
the Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account, for the deposit of the Super Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount;
(ii)
the Senior Notes Interest Payment Account, for the deposit of the Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount;
(iii)
the Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account for the deposit of the Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount;
(iv)
the Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account for the deposit of the Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount;
(v)
the Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account for the deposit of the amounts allocable to the payment of principal of the Super Senior
Notes;
(vi)
the Senior Notes Principal Payment Account for the deposit of the amounts allocable to the payment of principal of the Senior Notes;
(vii)
the Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account for the deposit of the amounts allocable to the payment of principal of the Senior
Subordinated Notes;
(viii)
the Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account for the deposit of the amounts allocable to the payment of principal of the Subordinated
Notes;
(ix)
the Super Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account for the deposit of the Super Senior Notes Quarterly
Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest amount;
(x)
the Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account for the deposit of the Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest amount;
(xi)
the Senior Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account for the deposit of the Senior Subordinated
Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest amount;
(xii)
the Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account for the deposit of the Subordinated Notes Quarterly
Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest amount;
(xiii)
the Securitization Operating Expense Account for the deposit of Securitization Operating Expenses;
(xiv)
the Super Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account for the deposit of Super Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly
Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount;
(xv)
the Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account for the deposit of Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity
Offering Additional Interest Amount;
(xvi)
the Senior Subordinated Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account for the deposit of Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued
Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount; and
(xvii)
the Tax Lien Reserve Account for the deposit of any Tax Lien Reserve Amounts.
(b)
Administration of the Collection Account Administrative Accounts. All amounts held in each Collection Account Administrative Account
shall be invested in Eligible Investments at the written direction (which may be standing directions) of the Issuer (or the Manager on
its behalf); provided, however, that any such investment in the Collection Account Administrative Accounts shall mature
not later than the Business Day prior to the next succeeding Quarterly Payment Date (or, in the case of the Securitization Operating
Expense Account, the next succeeding Monthly Allocation Date). In the absence of written investment instructions hereunder, funds on
deposit in each Collection Account Administrative Account shall remain uninvested with no liability to the Trustee or the Securities
Intermediary. All income or other gain from such Eligible Investments shall be credited to the relevant Collection Account Administrative
Account, and any loss resulting from such investments shall be charged to the relevant Collection Account Administrative Account. The
Issuer shall not direct (or permit) the disposal of any Eligible Investments prior to the maturity thereof if such disposal would result
in a loss of any portion of the initial purchase price of such Eligible Investment.
(c)
Earnings from the Collection Account Administrative Accounts. All interest and earnings (net of losses and investment expenses)
paid on funds on deposit in each of the Collection Account Administrative Accounts shall be deposited in such account and shall be deemed
to be Investment Income on deposit for distribution in accordance with Section 5.9.
(d)
Establishment of the Distribution Account. The Issuer hereby instructs the Trustee to establish the Distribution Account, which
account the Trustee has established as of the Closing Date, and the Issuer hereby agrees that it shall maintain such account with the
Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties. All amounts held in the Distribution Account shall remain uninvested with no liability
to the Trustee or the Securities Intermediary. The Distribution Account shall be established for the purpose of receiving funds pursuant
to Section 5.11(a). Upon the transfer of any amounts to the Distribution Account in accordance with Section 5.11(a), the
Trustee shall distribute such amounts on each Quarterly Payment Date to the parties and in the amounts specified in the Quarterly Noteholders’
Report in accordance with Section 5.11(a).
Section
5.6 Eligible Investments.
In
connection with investments and reinvestments of funds by the Trustee or the Securities Intermediary at the direction of the Issuer (or
the Manager on its behalf) holding each Indenture Trust Account (as the case may be):
(a)
Neither the Trustee nor the Securities Intermediary shall be liable for any loss, including without limitation any loss of principal
or interest, or for any breakage fees or penalties in connection with the purchase or liquidation of any investment made in accordance
with the written instructions of the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf). The Trustee or the Securities Intermediary, as applicable,
shall make such investments and reinvestments in accordance with, and the written instructions of the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf)
to the Trustee or the Securities Intermediary shall, as applicable, be in accordance with, the terms of the following provisions:
(i)
If any funds to be invested are not received in an Indenture Trust Account by 2:00 p.m. (New York time) on any Business Day, such funds
shall be invested in accordance herewith, subject to the terms and provisions hereof, on the next succeeding Business Day; provided
that neither the Trustee nor the Securities Intermediary shall be liable for any losses incurred in respect of the failure to invest
funds not thereby received;
(ii)
If the Eligible Investments in which the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) has directed the Trustee or the Securities Intermediary
to invest any funds in any Indenture Trust Account ceases to be an Eligible Investment pursuant to the definition thereof, the Issuer
(or the Manager) on its behalf shall provide the Trustee or the Securities Intermediary with new specific written investment directions
pursuant to the applicable provisions of this Section 5.6. Neither the Trustee nor the Securities Intermediary shall have any
duty or obligation to monitor whether an investment meets the requirements of an Eligible Investment nor have any liability with respect
to any investment which ceases to be an Eligible Investment.
(b)
The Trustee and the Securities Intermediary and their affiliates are permitted to receive additional compensation that could be deemed
to be in its respective economic self-interests for (i) serving as an investment advisor, administrator, shareholder, servicing agent,
custodian or sub custodian with respect to certain Eligible Investments, (ii) using affiliates to effect transactions in certain Eligible
Investments and (iii) effecting transactions in certain Eligible Investments. Neither the Trustee nor the Securities Intermediary guarantees
the performance of any Eligible Investments.
Section
5.7 Trustee as Securities Intermediary.
(a)
The Trustee or other Person holding any Base Indenture Account held for the benefit of the Secured Parties (collectively the “Trustee
Accounts”) shall be the “Securities Intermediary”. If the Securities Intermediary in respect of any Trustee
Account is not the Trustee, the Issuer shall obtain the express agreement of such other Person to the obligations of the Securities Intermediary
set forth in this Section 5.7.
(b)
The Securities Intermediary agrees, in respect of assets held by it, that:
(i)
the Trustee Accounts are accounts to which “financial assets” within the meaning of Section 8-102(a)(9) (“Financial
Assets”) of the UCC in effect in the State of New York (the “New York UCC”) will or may be credited;
(ii)
the Trustee Accounts are “securities accounts” within the meaning of Section 8-501 of the New York UCC and the Securities
Intermediary qualifies as a “securities intermediary” under Section 8-102(a) of the New York UCC;
(iii)
all securities or other property (other than cash) underlying any Financial Assets credited to any Trustee Account shall be registered
in the name of the Securities Intermediary, indorsed to the Securities Intermediary or in blank or credited to another securities account
maintained in the name of the Securities Intermediary and in no case will any Financial Asset credited to any Trustee Account be registered
in the name of the Issuer, payable to the order of the Issuer or specially indorsed to the Issuer;
(iv)
subject to the other terms and provisions hereof, all property delivered to the Securities Intermediary pursuant to this Base Indenture
will be promptly credited to the appropriate Trustee Account;
(v)
each item of property (whether investment property, security, instrument or cash) credited to a Trustee Account shall be treated as a
Financial Asset under Article 8 of the New York UCC;
(vi)
if at any time the Securities Intermediary shall receive any entitlement order from the Trustee or the Control Party (including those
directing transfer or redemption of any Financial Asset) relating to the Trustee Accounts, the Securities Intermediary shall comply with
such entitlement order without further consent by the Issuer or any other Person;
(vii)
the Trustee Accounts shall be governed by the laws of the State of New York, regardless of any provision of any other agreement. For
purposes of all applicable UCCs, New York shall be deemed to be the Securities Intermediary’s jurisdiction and the Trustee Accounts
(as well as the “securities entitlements” (as defined in Section 8-102(a)(17) of the New York UCC) related thereto) shall
be governed by the laws of the State of New York;
(viii)
the Securities Intermediary has not entered into, and until termination of this Base Indenture, will not enter into, any agreement with
any other Person relating to the Trustee Accounts and/or any Financial Assets credited thereto pursuant to which it has agreed to comply
with entitlement orders (as defined in Section 8-102(a)(8) of the New York UCC) of such other Person and the Securities Intermediary
has not entered into, and until the termination of this Base Indenture will not enter into, any agreement with the Issuer purporting
to limit or condition the obligation of the Securities Intermediary to comply with entitlement orders as set forth in Section 5.7(b)(vi);
and
(ix)
except for the claims and interest of the Trustee, the Secured Parties and the Issuer in the Trustee Accounts, neither the Securities
Intermediary nor, in the case of the Trustee, any Trust Officer has Actual Knowledge of any claim to, or interest, in the Trustee Accounts
or in any Financial Asset credited thereto. If the Securities Intermediary or, in the case of the Trustee, a Trust Officer has Actual
Knowledge of the assertion by any other person of any Lien, encumbrance, or adverse claim (including any writ, garnishment, judgment,
warrant of attachment, execution or similar process) against any Trustee Account or in any Financial Asset carried therein, the Securities
Intermediary will promptly notify the Trustee, the Control Party, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager and the Issuer thereof.
(c)
At any time after the occurrence and during the continuation of an Event of Default, the Trustee shall possess all right, title and interest
in all funds on deposit from time to time in the Trustee Accounts and in all Proceeds thereof, and (acting at the direction of the Control
Party) shall be the only Person authorized to originate entitlement orders in respect of the Trustee Accounts; provided, however,
that at all other times the Issuer shall, subject to the terms of the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents, be authorized to
originate entitlement orders in respect of the Trustee Accounts.
Section
5.8 Establishment of Series Accounts; Legacy Accounts.
(a)
Establishment of Series Accounts. To the extent specified in the Series Supplement with respect to any Series of Notes, the Trustee
may establish and maintain one or more Series Accounts in accordance with the terms of such Series Supplement.
(b)
Legacy Accounts. In the case of any mandatory or optional redemption in full of any Class or Series of Notes issued pursuant to
this Base Indenture, on the Notes Discharge Date with respect to such Class or Series of Notes, the Issuer may (but are not required
to) elect to have all or any portion of the funds held in any Legacy Account with respect to such Class, Subclass, Tranche or Series
of Notes transferred to the applicable distribution account for such Class, Subclass, Tranche or Series of Notes, for application toward
the prepayment of such Class or Series of Notes; provided that the foregoing shall not limit any provisions set forth in the Series
Supplement. If the Issuer does not elect to have such funds so transferred, or if the Issuer elect to have only a portion of such funds
so transferred, any funds remaining in the applicable Legacy Account after the applicable Notes Discharge Date shall be deposited into
the Collection Account for application in accordance with the Priority of Payments. When the balance of any Legacy Account has been reduced
to zero, the Trustee may close such account. The Trustee shall make the distributions and transfers and shall close any accounts as contemplated
by this Section 5.8 pursuant to instructions delivered by the Issuer to the Trustee.
Section
5.9 Collections and Investment Income.
(a)
Deposits to the Concentration Account. Until the Indenture is terminated pursuant to Section 12.1, the Issuer shall deposit
(or cause to be deposited) the following amounts to the Concentration Account to the extent owed to it or its direct or indirect Subsidiaries
and upon receipt (unless otherwise specified below):
(i)
all Guarantor Collections shall be deposited in the Concentration Account in accordance with Section 8.35 (or, in the case of
any misdirected payments, will deposit such amounts to a Concentration Account within three (3) Business Days following the earlier of
(x) Actual Knowledge by the Manager or any Securitization Entity of such misdirected payments and (y) the end of the week in which such
misdirected payments are received);
(ii)
within five (5) Business Days of receipt, amounts repaid to the related Guarantor from any tax escrow account held by a landlord under
a lease with such Guarantor;
(iii)
within three (3) Business Days of receipt, all amounts, including Company Restaurant License fees, received under the IP License Agreements
and all other license fees and other amounts received in respect of the Securitization IP, including recoveries from the enforcement
of the Securitization IP;
(iv)
within three (3) Business Days of receipt, equity contributions, if any, made by any Non-Securitization Entity to the Issuer to the extent
such equity contributions are directed to be made to the Concentration Account; and
(v)
within five (5) Business Days of receipt, all other amounts constituting Collections not referred to in the preceding clauses other than
Indemnification Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds, Asset Disposition Proceeds, Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds and any amounts
required to be deposited directly to other Management Accounts or to the Collection Account.
(b)
Withdrawals from the Concentration Account. The Manager may (and in the case of sub-clause (iv) below, shall) withdraw
available amounts on deposit in the Concentration Account to make the following payments and deposits:
(i)
on a monthly basis (and on any day of such week as the Manager so determines for any given week), as necessary, to the extent of amounts
deposited to the Concentration Account that the Manager determines were required to be deposited to another account or were deposited
to the Concentration Account in error;
(ii)
on a daily basis, as necessary, to pay or distribute, as applicable, any Excluded Amounts and any Excess Amounts;
(iii)
on a daily basis, as necessary, to make payments of any refunds, credits or other amounts owing to Franchisees; and
(iv)
on a monthly basis at or prior to 10:00 a.m. (New York City time) on the last Business Day of the calendar month immediately preceding
each Monthly Allocation Date, all Retained Collections with respect to the preceding Monthly Collection Period then on deposit in the
Concentration Account to the Collection Account (which, for the avoidance of doubt, will include any Investment Income with respect thereto)
for application to make payments and deposits in the order of priority set forth in the Priority of Payments.
(c)
Deposits to the Collection Account. The Manager (and/or with respect to (iv) and (v) below, the Trustee upon written instruction
from the Control Party) will deposit or cause to be deposited to the Collection Account the following amounts, in each case promptly
after receipt (unless otherwise specified below):
(i)
the amounts required to be withdrawn from the Concentration Account and deposited to the Collection Account pursuant to and in accordance
with Section 5.9(b)(iv);
(ii)
Indemnification Amounts¸ Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds, Asset Disposition Proceeds and Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds within
two (2) Business Days following either (i) the receipt by the Manager of such amounts if Twin Hospitality is not the Manager or (ii)
if Twin Hospitality is the Manager, the date such amounts become payable by the Manager under the Management Agreement or any other Transaction
Document;
(iii)
amounts obtained by the Trustee or the Control Party on account of or as a result of the exercise by the Trustee or the Control Party
of any of their rights under the Indenture, including without limitation, under Article IX hereof;
(iv)
upon receipt of any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds for further distribution pursuant to the Priority of Payments for the related
Monthly Allocation Date; and
(v)
any other amounts required to be deposited to the Collection Account hereunder or under any other Transaction Documents.
(d)
Investment Income. The Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) shall, as set forth in the Monthly Manager’s Certificate relating
to each Monthly Allocation Date, instruct the Trustee in writing to transfer any Investment Income on deposit in the Indenture Trust
Accounts (other than the Collection Account) to the Collection Account for application as Collections on that Monthly Allocation Date.
(e)
Payment Instructions. In accordance with and subject to the terms of the Management Agreement, the Issuer shall cause the Manager
to instruct (i) each Guarantor to distribute to Issuer all Guarantor Collections by depositing such Guarantor Collections in the Concentration
Account, (ii) each Distributor obligated at any time to make any Product Sourcing Payments to make such payment to the Concentration
Account and (iii) any other Person (not an Affiliate of the Issuer) obligated at any time to make any payments with respect to the Collateral,
including, without limitation, the Securitization IP, to make such payment to the Concentration Account or the Collection Account, as
determined by the Issuer or the Manager.
(f)
Misdirected Collections. The Issuer agrees that if any Collections shall be received by the Issuer or any other Securitization
Entity in an account other than an Account or in any other manner, such monies, instruments, cash and other proceeds will not be commingled
by the Issuer or such other Securitization Entity with any of their other funds or property, if any, but will be held separate and apart
therefrom and shall be held in trust by the Issuer or such other Securitization Entity for, and, within one (1) Business Day of the identification
of such payment, paid over to, the Trustee, with any necessary endorsement. The Trustee shall withdraw from the Collection Account any
monies on deposit therein that the Manager certifies to it and the Control Party are not Retained Collections and pay such amounts to
or at the direction of the Manager.
Section
5.10 Application of Retained Collections and any Reserve Account Withdrawal Amount on Monthly Allocation Dates.
On
each Monthly Allocation Date (unless the Trustee shall not have received by 10:00 a.m. (New York City time) on the Business Day prior
to such Monthly Allocation Date the Monthly Manager’s Certificate relating to such Monthly Allocation Date, in which case the application
of Retained Collections, plus any Reserve Account Withdrawal Amount, plus any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds, plus any Indemnification
Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds, Asset Disposition Proceeds or Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds relating to such Monthly Allocation
Date shall occur on the Business Day immediately following the day on which such Monthly Manager’s Certificate is delivered), the
Trustee shall, based solely on the information contained in such Monthly Manager’s Certificate, withdraw Retained Collections,
plus any Reserve Account Withdrawal Amount, plus any Indemnification Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds, Asset Disposition Proceeds
or any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds relating to such Monthly Allocation Date on deposit in the Collection Account as of 10:00 a.m.
(New York City time) on such Monthly Allocation Date in respect of the preceding Monthly Collection Period for deposit or payment in
the following order of priority, subject to the next succeeding sentence in the event Exchange Notes have been exchanged for Exchangeable
Notes; provided, any Indemnification Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds or Asset Disposition Proceeds shall be applied solely as
provided in priorities (vii)(B), (ix)(B), (xi)(B) and (xviii)(B), and any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds shall
be applied solely as provided in priorities (vii)(C), (ix)(C), (xi)(C) and (xviii)(C):
(i)
first, to reimburse (A)(i) the Trustee, for any fees, expenses, Mortgage Recordation Fees and indemnities due and owing to it;
and (ii) the Control Party, for any fees, expenses and indemnities due and owing to it, pro rata based on the amount due; provided
that, prior to the occurrence of an Event of Default, the expenses and indemnities payable to the Trustee and the Control Party pursuant
to this priority (A)(other than any Mortgage Recordation Fees) shall not exceed $250,000 in the aggregate per calendar year; and then
(B) expenses or indemnities due and owing to the Control Party if it is required to take any material discretionary action without
direction from the Controlling Class Representative or the Noteholders, provided further that the expenses and indemnities payable to
the Control Party pursuant to this priority (B) shall not exceed $200,000 in the aggregate per calendar year;
(ii)
second, to reimburse the Manager for any unreimbursed Manager Advances;
(iii)
third, to pay Successor Manager Transition Expenses, if any;
(iv)
fourth, to pay the Monthly Management Fee to the Manager;
(v)
fifth, pro rata, (A) to deposit to the Securitization Operating Expense Account, any previously accrued and unpaid Securitization
Operating Expenses together with any Securitization Operating Expenses that are expected to be payable prior to the immediately following
Monthly Allocation Date, in an aggregate amount not to exceed the Capped Securitization Operating Expense Amount with respect to the
annual period in which such Monthly Allocation Date occurs after giving effect to all deposits previously made to the Securitization
Operating Expense Account in such annual period, to be distributed pro rata based on the amount of each type of Securitization
Operating Expense payable on such Monthly Allocation Date pursuant to this priority (v); provided, that the deposit to the Securitization
Operating Expense Account of an amount equal to all accrued and unpaid fees, expenses and indemnities payable to the Back-Up Manager,
in each such case, will not be subject to the Capped Securitization Operating Expense Amount if and for so long as an Event of Default
has occurred and is continuing; provided, further, that the payment of any such fees, expenses and indemnities payable to the Back-Up
Manager, in each such case, that were incurred during any period while an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing will not be
subject to the Capped Securitization Operating Expense Amount, regardless of whether or not an Event of Default exists at the time of
such payment; (B) to reimburse the Controlling Class Representative, for any fees, expenses and indemnities due and owing to it; and
(C) after a Mortgage Recordation Event, to the Control Party all Mortgage Recordation Fees due and owing to it;
(vi)
sixth, pro rata, (A) to deposit to the Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account, the Super Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly
Interest Amount and (B) to allocate and deposit to the Super Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account any Super
Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount for the Super Senior Notes for such Monthly Allocation
Date;
(vii)
seventh, to deposit to the Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account, for allocation (A) pro rata, to (1) any Super
Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment Amount, and (2) any Super Senior Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount
of each Class of Super Senior Notes, an amount equal to the sum of (x) any Super Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment Amount
and (y) any Super Senior Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount, (B) in the case of any Indemnification Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation
Proceeds or Asset Disposition Proceeds, up to the amount necessary to reduce the Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class of Super
Senior Notes to zero and (C) in the case of any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds, up to the amount necessary to reduce the Outstanding
Principal Amount of each Class of Super Senior Notes to zero;
(viii)
eighth, pro rata, (A) to deposit to the Senior Notes Interest Payment Account, the Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest
Amount and (B) to allocate and deposit to the Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account any Senior Notes Accrued
Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount for the Senior Notes for such Monthly Allocation Date;
(ix)
ninth, to deposit to the Senior Notes Principal Payment Account, for allocation (A) pro rata to (1) any Senior Notes Accrued
Scheduled Principal Payment Amount, and (2) any Senior Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount of each Class of Senior Notes,
an amount equal to the sum of (x) any Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment Amount and (y) any Senior Notes Scheduled Principal
Payment Deficiency Amount, (B) in the case of any Indemnification Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds or Asset Disposition Proceeds,
up to the amount necessary to reduce the Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class of Senior Notes to zero and (C) in the case of any
Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds, up to the amount necessary to reduce the Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class of Senior Notes
to zero;
(x)
tenth, to deposit to the Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account the Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest
Amount;
(xi)
eleventh, to deposit to the Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account, for allocation (A) pro rata to (1) any
Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment Amount, and (2) any Senior Subordinated Notes Scheduled Principal Payment
Deficiency Amount of each Class of Senior Subordinated Notes, an amount equal to the sum of (x) the Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued
Scheduled Principal Payment Amount, and (y) the Senior Subordinated Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount, (B) in the case
of any Indemnification Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds or Asset Disposition Proceeds up to the amount necessary to reduce the
Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class of Senior Subordinated Notes to zero and (C) in the case of any Qualified Equity Offering
Proceeds, up to the amount necessary to reduce the Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class of Senior Subordinated Notes to zero;
(xii)
twelfth, to deposit in the Reserve Account, any Reserve Account Deficit Amount; provided, however, that no amounts,
with respect to a Series of Notes, will be deposited into the Reserve Account pursuant to this priority (xii) on any Monthly Allocation
Date that occurs during the Quarterly Collection Period immediately preceding the Series Legal Final Maturity Date relating to such Series
of Notes;
(xiii)
thirteenth, if such Monthly Allocation Date occurs during a Cash Flow Sweeping Period, to deposit to the Super Senior Notes Principal
Payment Account for allocation pro rata to (1) any Super Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment Amount, and (2) any Super Senior
Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount after giving effect to priorities (i) through (xii) above, of each Class of Super
Senior Notes, an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the product of the Cash Flow Sweeping Percentage and the amount of funds available
in the Collection Account after the application of priorities (i) through (xii) above and (b) the aggregate Outstanding Principal Amount
of each Class of Super Senior Notes;
(xiv)
fourteenth, if such Monthly Allocation Date occurs during a Cash Flow Sweeping Period, to deposit to the Senior Notes Principal
Payment Account for allocation pro rata to (1) any Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment Amount, and (2) any Senior Notes
Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount after giving effect to priorities (i) through (xii) above, of each Class of Senior Notes
an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the product of the Cash Flow Sweeping Percentage and the amount of funds available in the Collection
Account after the application of priorities (i) through (xii) above, subtracted by the amount paid in priority (xiii), if any, and (b)
the aggregate Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class of Senior Notes;
(xv)
fifteenth, if such Monthly Allocation Date occurs during a Cash Flow Sweeping Period, to deposit to the Senior Subordinated Notes
Principal Payment Account for allocation pro rata to (1) any Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment Amount, and
(2) any Senior Subordinated Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount after giving effect to priorities (i) through (xii) above,
of each Class of Senior Subordinated Notes an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the product of the Cash Flow Sweeping Percentage and
the amount of funds available in the Collection Account after the application of priorities (i) through (xii) above, subtracted by the
amount paid in priorities (xiii) and (xiv), if any, and (b) the aggregate Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class of Senior Subordinated
Notes;
(xvi)
sixteenth, if a Rapid Amortization Event has occurred and is continuing, to deposit 100% of the amounts remaining on deposit in
the Collection Account first, to the Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account, to each Class of Super Senior Notes pro rata
to (1) any Super Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment Amount, and (2) any Super Senior Notes Scheduled Principal Payment
Deficiency Amount after giving effect to priorities (i) through (xv) above, of each Class of Super Senior Notes, in each case until the
Outstanding Principal Amount of each such Class of Super Senior Notes will be reduced to zero on the next Quarterly Payment Date after
giving effect to all deposits in the Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account, then second, to the Senior Notes Principal
Payment Account to each Class of Senior Notes pro rata to (1) any Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment Amount, and (2) any
Senior Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount, after giving effect to priorities (i) through (xv) above, of each Class of
Senior Notes, in each case until the Outstanding Principal Amount of each such Class of Senior Notes will be reduced to zero on the next
Quarterly Payment Date after giving effect to all deposits in the Senior Notes Principal Payment Account,; and then third, to
the Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account to each Class of Senior Subordinated Notes pro rata to (1) any Senior Subordinated
Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment Amount, and (2) any Senior Subordinated Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount,
after giving effect to priorities (i) through (xv) above, of each Class of Senior Subordinated Notes, in each case until the Outstanding
Principal Amount of each such Class will be reduced to zero on the next Quarterly Payment Date after giving effect to all deposits in
the Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account;
(xvii)
seventeenth, to deposit to the Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account an amount equal to the Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly
Interest Amount;
(xviii)
eighteenth, to deposit for allocation (A) pro rata to (1) any Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment Amount,
and (2) any Subordinated Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount of each Class of Subordinated Notes, to the Subordinated
Notes Principal Payment Account an amount equal to the sum of (x) the Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment Amount,
if any, and (y) the Subordinated Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount, if any, (B) in the case of any Indemnification
Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds or Asset Disposition Proceeds up to the amount necessary to reduce the Outstanding Principal
Amount of each Class of Subordinated Notes to zero and (C) in the case of any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds, up to the amount necessary
to reduce the Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class of Subordinated Notes to zero;
(xix)
nineteenth, to pay the Supplemental Management Fee to the Manager;
(xx)
twentieth, if a Rapid Amortization Event has occurred and is continuing, to deposit for allocation pro rata to (1) any
Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment Amount, and (2) any Subordinated Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency
Amount of each Class of Subordinated Notes, 100% of the amounts remaining on deposit in the Collection Account to the Subordinated Notes
Principal Payment Account (sequentially, in alphanumerical order of the Subordinated Notes) until the Outstanding Principal Amount of
each such Class will be reduced to zero on the next Quarterly Payment Date after giving effect to all deposits in the Subordinated Notes
Principal Payment Account;
(xxi)
twenty-first, pro rata, to (A) pay to the Trustee and the Control Party any expenses and indemnities due and owing to it
in excess of the expenses and indemnities paid pursuant to priority (i) above, and (B) deposit to the Securitization Operating Expense
Account, an amount equal to any accrued and unpaid Securitization Operating Expenses (together with any Securitization Operating Expenses
that are expected to be payable prior to the immediately following Monthly Allocation Date) in excess of the Capped Securitization Operating
Expense Amount after giving effect to priority (v) above;
(xxii)
twenty-second, to allocate to the Super Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account any Super Senior
Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount for the Super Senior Notes for such Monthly Allocation
Date;
(xxiii)
twenty-third, to allocate to the Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account any Senior Notes Accrued
Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount for the Senior Notes for such Monthly Allocation Date;
(xxiv)
twenty-fourth, pro rata, (A) to allocate to the Senior Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest
Account any Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount for the Senior Subordinated
Notes for such Monthly Allocation Date and (B) to allocate to the Senior Subordinated Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest
Account any Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount for the Senior Subordinated
Notes for such Monthly Allocation Date;
(xxv)
twenty-fifth, to allocate to the Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account any Subordinated
Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount for the Subordinated Notes for such Monthly Allocation
Date; and
(xxvi)
twenty-sixth, to pay the Residual Amount at the direction of the Issuer.
In
the event that any Exchange Notes have been exchanged for the related Class of Exchangeable Notes in an Exchangeable Combination, such
Class of Exchangeable Notes received in such an exchange shall be entitled to a proportionate share of the interest, principal and other
payments, as applicable, otherwise allocable to the Exchange Notes that were exchanged for Exchangeable Notes, in accordance with the
payment priorities set forth above.
(b)
Securitization Operating Expenses. On each Monthly Allocation Date, as set forth in each Monthly Manager’s Certificate,
or on any Business Day in accordance with specific written instructions of the Manager, the Trustee shall withdraw from the Securitization
Operating Expense Account an amount equal to the lesser of (i) the sum of all Securitization Operating Expenses then due and payable
and (ii) the amount on deposit in the Securitization Operating Expense Account after giving effect to any deposits thereto pursuant to
the Priority of Payments on such date and apply such funds to pay any Securitization Operating Expenses then due and payable.
Section
5.11 Quarterly Payment Date Applications.
(a)
Based solely on the information contained in the applicable Quarterly Noteholders’ Report, (i) on the Business Day prior to each
Quarterly Payment Date (unless the Trustee shall not have received by 10:00 a.m. (New York City time) on the third Business Day prior
to such Quarterly Payment Date the Quarterly Noteholders’ Report relating to such Quarterly Payment Date, in which case the transfers
to the Distribution Account set forth below relating to such Quarterly Payment Date shall occur on the second Business Day immediately
following the day on which such Quarterly Noteholders’ Report is delivered), the Trustee shall make the transfers to the Distribution
Account in the amounts and from the accounts set forth below and (ii) on each Quarterly Payment Date (unless the Trustee shall not have
received by 10:00 a.m. (New York City time) on the third Business Day prior to such Quarterly Payment Date the Quarterly Noteholders’
Report relating to such Quarterly Payment Date, in which case the payments set forth below relating to such Quarterly Payment Date shall
occur on the third Business Day immediately following the day on which such Quarterly Noteholders’ Report is delivered), the Trustee
shall make such further distributions from the Distribution Account in the amounts and to the Persons set forth below, in the case of
each of clauses (i) through (iii), based upon such information as further specified in the Quarterly Noteholders’
Report:
(i)
transfer from the Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account to the Distribution Account for further distribution to the Super Senior
Noteholders the accrued and unpaid Super Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount;
(ii)
transfer from the Senior Notes Interest Payment Account to the Distribution Account for further distribution to the Senior Noteholders
the accrued and unpaid Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount;
(iii)
transfer from the Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account to the Distribution Account for further distribution to the Senior
Subordinated Noteholders the accrued and unpaid Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount;
(iv)
transfer from the Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account to the Distribution Account for further distribution to the Noteholders
of each applicable Class of Super Senior Notes in the order of priority set forth in the Priority of Payments with respect to such priorities
(vii), (xiii) and (xvi);
(v)
(v) transfer from the Senior Notes Principal Payment Account to the Distribution Account for further distribution to the Noteholders
of each applicable Class of Senior Notes in the order of priority set forth in the Priority of Payments with respect to such priorities
(ix), (xiv) and (xvi);
(vi)
transfer from the Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account to the Distribution Account for further distribution to the Noteholders
of each applicable Class of Senior Subordinated Notes in the order of priority set forth in the Priority of Payments with respect to
such priorities (xi), (xv) and (xvi);
(vii)
transfer from the Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account to the Distribution Account for further distribution to the Noteholders
of the Subordinated Notes the accrued and unpaid Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount;
(viii)
transfer from the Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account to the Distribution Account for further distribution to the Noteholders
of each applicable Class of Subordinated Notes in the order of priority set forth in the Priority of Payments with respect to such priorities
(xviii) and (xx);
(ix)
transfer from the Super Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account to the Distribution Account for further
distribution to the Noteholders of each applicable Class of Super Senior Notes the accrued and unpaid Super Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest due on such Quarterly Payment Date;
(x)
transfer from the Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account to the Distribution Account for further distribution
to the Noteholders of each applicable Class of Senior Notes the accrued and unpaid Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest due on such Quarterly Payment Date;
(xi)
transfer from the Senior Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account to the Distribution Account for
further distribution to the Noteholders of each applicable Class of Senior Subordinated Notes the accrued and unpaid Senior Subordinated
Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest due on such Quarterly Payment Date;
(xii)
transfer from the Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account to the Distribution Account for further
distribution to the Noteholders of each applicable Class of Subordinated Notes the accrued and unpaid Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest due on such Quarterly Payment Date;
(xiii)
transfer from the Super Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account to the Distribution Account (x) if a Qualified
Equity Offering Trigger Event has occurred and is continuing as of such Quarterly Payment Date, for further distribution to the Noteholders
of each applicable Class of Super Senior Notes the accrued and unpaid Super Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional
Interest due on such Quarterly Payment Date and (y) if a Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event has not occurred and is not continuing
as of such Quarterly Payment Date, as Retained Collections for distribution in accordance with the Priority of Payments;
(xiv)
transfer from the Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account to the Distribution Account (x) if a Qualified Equity
Offering Trigger Event has occurred and is continuing as of such Quarterly Payment Date, for further distribution to the Noteholders
of each applicable Class of Senior Notes the accrued and unpaid Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest
due on such Quarterly Payment Date and (y) if a Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event has not occurred and is not continuing as of
such Quarterly Payment Date, as Retained Collections for distribution in accordance with the Priority of Payments; and
(xv)
transfer from the Senior Subordinated Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account to the Distribution Account (x) if
a Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event has occurred and is continuing as of such Quarterly Payment Date, for further distribution
to the Noteholders of each applicable Class of Senior Subordinated Notes the accrued and unpaid Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Qualified
Equity Offering Additional Interest due on such Quarterly Payment Date and (y) if a Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event has not occurred
and is not continuing as of such Quarterly Payment Date, as Retained Collections for distribution in accordance with the Priority of
Payments.
In
the event that any Exchange Notes have been exchanged for the related Class of Exchangeable Notes in an Exchangeable Combination, such
Class of Exchangeable Notes received in such an exchange shall be entitled to a proportionate share of the interest and principal payments,
as applicable, otherwise allocable to the Exchange Notes that were exchanged for the Exchangeable Notes, in accordance with the payment
priorities set forth above.
(b)
In connection with its preparation and delivery of the Quarterly Noteholders’ Report with respect to each Quarterly Payment Date,
the Manager shall make all calculations and determinations required in order to give effect to the terms of Section 5.11(a), including
without limitation the following calculations and determinations in accordance with the provisions set forth below:
(i)
Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account. As set forth in each Quarterly Noteholders’ Report, the Issuer (or the Manager
on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing on the next Quarterly Payment Date to withdraw the funds deposited in the Super
Senior Notes Interest Payment Account on each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection
Period, to be paid for the benefit of the Super Senior Noteholders, up to the accrued and unpaid Super Senior Notes Quarterly Interest
Amount due on such Quarterly Payment Date, pro rata among each Class of Super Senior Notes based upon the amount of the Super Senior
Notes Quarterly Interest Amount payable with respect to each such Class, and, in accordance with Section 6.1 of the Indenture, remit
such funds to the Super Senior Noteholders, pro rata in accordance with Super Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount due to each Super
Senior Noteholder on such Quarterly Payment Date.
(ii)
Senior Notes Interest Payment Account. As set forth in each Quarterly Noteholders’ Report, the Issuer (or the Manager on
its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing on the next Quarterly Payment Date to withdraw the funds deposited in the Senior Notes
Interest Payment Account on each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period, to be
paid for the benefit of the Senior Noteholders, up to the accrued and unpaid Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount due on such Quarterly
Payment Date, pro rata among each Class of Senior Notes based upon the amount of the Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount payable with
respect to each such Class, and, in accordance with Section 6.1 of the Indenture, remit such funds to the Senior Noteholders, pro rata
in accordance with Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount due to each Senior Noteholder on such Quarterly Payment Date.
(iii)
Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account.
(A)
To the extent any Series of Senior Subordinated Notes has been issued, as set forth in each Quarterly Noteholders’ Report, the
Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing on the next Quarterly Payment Date to withdraw the funds
deposited in the Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account, on each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to the immediately
preceding Quarterly Collection Period, and, if applicable, funds deposited in the Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account
pursuant to subclause (B), to be paid for the benefit of the Senior Subordinated Noteholders, up to the accrued and unpaid Senior
Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount due on such Quarterly Payment Date, pro rata among each Class of Senior Subordinated
Notes based upon the amount of the Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount payable with respect to each such Class, and,
in accordance with Section 6.1, remit such funds to the Senior Subordinated Noteholders, pro rata in accordance with Senior
Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount due to each Senior Subordinated Noteholder on such Quarterly Payment Date.
(B)
If, as determined on any Quarterly Calculation Date, the result of (A) the accrued and unpaid Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest
Amount due on such Quarterly Payment Date over (B) the amount that shall be available to make payments of interest on the Senior
Subordinated Notes on such Quarterly Payment Date in accordance with subclause (A) above, is greater than zero (a “Senior
Subordinated Notes Interest Shortfall Amount”), then such amount available to be distributed on such Quarterly Payment Date
to the Senior Subordinated Notes shall be paid to the Senior Subordinated Notes, pro rata among each Class of Senior Subordinated
Notes based upon the amount of the Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount payable with respect to each such Class; provided
that such reduction shall not be deemed to be a waiver of any default caused by the existence of such Senior Subordinated Notes Interest
Shortfall Amount. An additional amount of interest may accrue on the Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Shortfall Amount for each subsequent
Interest Accrual Period until the Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Shortfall Amount is paid in full, as set forth in the Series Supplement.
(iv)
Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account.
(A)
As set forth in each Quarterly Noteholders’ Report, the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing
on the next Quarterly Payment Date to withdraw the funds deposited in the Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account on each Monthly
Allocation Date with respect to the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period, to be paid for the benefit of, in the case of
funds deposited pursuant to priorities (vii), (xiii) and (xvi) of the Priority of Payments, the Noteholders of each applicable Class
of Super Senior Notes in the order of priority set forth in the Priority of Payments with respect to such priorities (vii), (xiii) and
(xvi), in each case and pro rata among each such applicable Class of Super Senior Notes based upon the Outstanding Principal Amount of
the Super Senior Notes of such Class, and, in accordance with Section 6.1 of the Indenture, remit such funds to the Super Senior Noteholders,
pro rata in accordance with the Outstanding Principal Amount of Super Senior Notes due to each Super Senior Noteholder on such Quarterly
Payment Date.
(B)
Payment of principal of any Series of Notes shall be distributed in accordance with the Series Supplement to the holders of the such
Series of Notes.
(v)
Senior Notes Principal Payment Account.
(A)
As set forth in each Quarterly Noteholders’ Report, the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing
on the next Quarterly Payment Date to withdraw the funds deposited in the Senior Notes Principal Payment Account on each Monthly Allocation
Date with respect to the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period, to be paid for the benefit of, in the case of funds deposited
pursuant to priorities (ix), (xiv) and (xvi) of the Priority of Payments, the Noteholders of each applicable Class of Senior Notes in
the order of priority set forth in the Priority of Payments with respect to such priorities (ix), (xiv) and (xvi), in each case and pro
rata among each such applicable Class of Senior Notes based upon the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Senior Notes of such Class,
and, in accordance with Section 6.1 of the Indenture, remit such funds to the Senior Noteholders, pro rata in accordance with the Outstanding
Principal Amount of Senior Notes due to each Senior Noteholder on such Quarterly Payment Date.
(B)
Payment of principal of any Series of Notes shall be distributed in accordance with the Series Supplement to the holders of the such
Series of Notes.
(vi)
Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account.
(A)
To the extent any Series of Senior Subordinated Notes has been issued, as set forth in each Quarterly Noteholders’ Report, the
Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing to withdraw on the next Quarterly Payment Date the funds
deposited in the Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account on each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to the immediately
preceding Quarterly Collection Period, to be paid for the benefit of, in the case of funds deposited pursuant to priorities (xi), (xv)
and (xvi) of the Priority of Payments, the Holders of each applicable Class of Senior Subordinated Notes in the order of priority set
forth in the Priority of Payments with respect to such priorities (xi), (xv) and (xvi), in each case sequentially in order of alphanumerical
designation and pro rata among each such Class of Senior Subordinated Notes of the same alphanumerical designation based upon the Outstanding
Principal Amount of the Senior Subordinated Notes of such Class, and, in accordance with Section 6.1 of the Indenture, remit such funds
to the Senior Subordinated Noteholders, pro rata in accordance with the Outstanding Principal Amount of Senior Subordinated Notes due
to each Senior Subordinated Noteholder on such Quarterly Payment Date.
(B)
Payment of principal of any Series of Notes shall be distributed in accordance with the Series Supplement to the holders of the applicable
Series of Notes.
(vii)
Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account.
(A)
To the extent any Series of Subordinated Notes has been issued, as set forth in each Quarterly Noteholders’ Report, the Issuer
(or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing on the next Quarterly Payment Date to withdraw the funds deposited
in the Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account on each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to the immediately preceding Quarterly
Collection Period, to be paid for the benefit of the Holders of the Subordinated Notes, up to the accrued and unpaid Subordinated Notes
Quarterly Interest Amount, pro rata among each Class of Subordinated Notes based upon the amount of the Subordinated Notes Quarterly
Interest Amount payable with respect to each such Class, and, in accordance with Section 6.1, remit such funds to the Subordinated
Noteholders, pro rata in accordance with Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount due to each Subordinated Noteholder on such
Quarterly Payment Date.
(B)
If, as determined on any Quarterly Calculation Date, the result of (A) the accrued and unpaid Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amounts
due on such Quarterly Payment Date over (B) the amount that shall be available to make payments of interest on the Subordinated Notes
in accordance with subclause (A) above on such Quarterly Payment Date, is greater than zero (the “Subordinated Notes
Interest Shortfall Amount”), then such amount available to be distributed on such Quarterly Payment Date to the Subordinated
Notes shall be paid to each Class of Subordinated Notes, pro rata among each Class of Subordinated Notes based upon the amount
of the Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount payable with respect to each such Class; provided that such reduction shall
not be deemed to be a waiver of any default caused by the existence of such Subordinated Notes Interest Shortfall Amount. An additional
amount of interest may accrue on the Subordinated Notes Interest Shortfall Amount for each subsequent Interest Accrual Period until the
Subordinated Notes Interest Shortfall Amount is paid in full, as set forth in the Series Supplement.
(viii)
Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account.
(A)
To the extent any Series of Subordinated Notes has been issued, as set forth in each Quarterly Noteholders’ Report, the Issuer
(or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing to withdraw on the next Quarterly Payment Date the funds deposited
in the Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account on each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to the immediately preceding Quarterly
Collection Period, to be paid for the benefit of, in the case of funds deposited pursuant to priorities (xviii) and (xx) of the Priority
of Payments, the Holders of each applicable Class of Subordinated Notes in the order of priority set forth in the Priority of Payments
with respect to such priorities (xviii) and (xx), in each case pro rata among each such Class of Subordinated Notes based upon the Outstanding
Principal Amount of the Subordinated Notes of such Class and, in accordance with Section 6.1 of the Indenture, remit such funds to the
Subordinated Noteholders, pro rata in accordance with the Outstanding Principal Amount of Subordinated Notes due to each Subordinated
Noteholder on such Quarterly Payment Date.
(B)
Payment of principal of any Series of Notes shall be distributed in accordance with the Series Supplement to the holders of the applicable
Series of Notes.
(ix)
Super Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account. As set forth in each Quarterly Noteholders’
Report, the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing on the next Quarterly Payment Date to withdraw
the funds deposited in the Super Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account on each Monthly Allocation
Date with respect to the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period, to be paid for the benefit of the Noteholders of each applicable
class of Super Senior Notes, up to the accrued and unpaid Super Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest
due on such Quarterly Payment Date, pro rata among each such applicable Class of Super Senior Notes based upon the Super Senior Notes
Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest payable with respect to each such Class, and, in accordance with Section
6.1 of the Indenture, remit such funds to the Super Senior Noteholders, pro rata in accordance with the Super Senior Notes Quarterly
Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest due to each Super Senior Noteholder on such Quarterly Payment Date.
(x)
Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account. As set forth in each Quarterly Noteholders’ Report,
the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing on the next Quarterly Payment Date to withdraw the funds
deposited in the Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account on each Monthly Allocation Date with respect
to the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period, to be paid for the benefit of the Noteholders of each applicable class of Senior
Notes, up to the accrued and unpaid Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest due on such Quarterly
Payment Date, pro rata among each such applicable Class of Senior Notes based upon the Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest payable with respect to each such Class, and, in accordance with Section 6.1 of the Indenture, remit such funds
to the Senior Noteholders, pro rata in accordance with the Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest
due to each Senior Noteholder on such Quarterly Payment Date.
(xi)
Senior Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account. As set forth in each Quarterly Noteholders’
Report, the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing on the next Quarterly Payment Date to withdraw
the funds deposited in the Senior Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account on each Monthly Allocation
Date with respect to the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period, to be paid for the benefit of the Noteholders of each applicable
class of Senior Subordinated Notes, up to the accrued and unpaid Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date
Additional Interest due on such Quarterly Payment Date, pro rata among each such applicable Class of Senior Subordinated Notes
based upon the Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest payable with respect to each such
Class, and, in accordance with Section 6.1 of the Indenture, remit such funds to the Senior Subordinated Noteholders, pro rata
in accordance with the Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest due to each Senior
Subordinated Noteholder on such Quarterly Payment Date.
(xii)
Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account. As set forth in each Quarterly Noteholders’
Report, the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing on the next Quarterly Payment Date to withdraw
the funds deposited in the Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account on each Monthly Allocation
Date with respect to the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period, to be paid for the benefit of the Noteholders of each applicable
class of Subordinated Notes, up to the accrued and unpaid Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest
due on such Quarterly Payment Date, pro rata among each such applicable Class of Subordinated Notes based upon the Subordinated
Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest payable with respect to each such Class, and, in accordance with
Section 6.1 of the Indenture, remit such funds to the Subordinated Noteholders, pro rata in accordance with the Subordinated
Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest due to each Subordinated Noteholder on such Quarterly Payment Date.
(xiii)
Super Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account. As set forth in each applicable Quarterly Noteholders’
Report, the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing on the next Quarterly Payment Date to withdraw
the funds deposited in the Super Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account on each applicable Monthly Allocation
Date with respect to the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period, to be (x) if a Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event has
occurred and is continuing as of such Quarterly Payment Date, paid for the benefit of the Noteholders of each applicable class of Super
Senior Notes, up to the accrued and unpaid Super Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest due on such Quarterly
Payment Date, pro rata among each such applicable Class of Super Senior Notes based upon the Super Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity
Offering Additional Interest payable with respect to each such Class, and, in accordance with Section 6.1 of the Indenture, remit such
funds to the Super Senior Noteholders, pro rata in accordance with the Super Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional
Interest due to each Super Senior Noteholder on such Quarterly Payment Date and (y) if a Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event has
not occurred and is not continuing as of such Quarterly Payment Date, distributed as Retained Collections in accordance with the Priority
of Payments.
(xiv)
Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account. As set forth in each applicable Quarterly Noteholders’
Report, the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing on the next Quarterly Payment Date to withdraw
the funds deposited in the Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account on each applicable Monthly Allocation Date
with respect to the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period, to be (x) if a Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event has occurred
and is continuing as of such Quarterly Payment Date, paid for the benefit of the Noteholders of each applicable class of Senior Notes,
up to the accrued and unpaid Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest due on such Quarterly Payment Date,
pro rata among each such applicable Class of Senior Notes based upon the Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional
Interest payable with respect to each such Class, and, in accordance with Section 6.1 of the Indenture, remit such funds to the Senior
Noteholders, pro rata in accordance with the Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest due to each Senior
Noteholder on such Quarterly Payment Date and (y) if a Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event has not occurred and is not continuing
as of such Quarterly Payment Date, distributed as Retained Collections in accordance with the Priority of Payments.
(xv)
Senior Subordinated Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account. As set forth in each applicable Quarterly Noteholders’
Report, the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing on the next Quarterly Payment Date to withdraw
the funds deposited in the Senior Subordinated Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account on each applicable Monthly
Allocation Date with respect to the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period, to be (x) if a Qualified Equity Offering Trigger
Event has occurred and is continuing as of such Quarterly Payment Date, paid for the benefit of the Noteholders of each applicable class
of Senior Subordinated Notes, up to the accrued and unpaid Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest
due on such Quarterly Payment Date, pro rata among each such applicable Class of Senior Subordinated Notes based upon the Senior
Subordinated Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest payable with respect to each such Class, and, in accordance
with Section 6.1 of this Base Indenture, remit such funds to the Senior Subordinated Noteholders, pro rata in accordance
with the Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest due to each Senior Subordinated Noteholder
on such Quarterly Payment Date and (y) if a Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event has not occurred and is not continuing as of such
Quarterly Payment Date, distributed as Retained Collections in accordance with the Priority of Payments.
Section
5.12 Other Amounts.
(a)
Reserve Account. On any date on which no Super Senior Notes, Senior Notes and Senior Subordinated Notes are Outstanding, the Issuer
(or the Manager on its behalf) shall instruct the Trustee in writing to withdraw on such date any funds then on deposit in the Reserve
Account and to deposit all remaining funds into the Collection Account.
(b)
Optional Prepayments. The Issuer shall have the right to optionally prepay the Outstanding Principal Amount of any Series, Class,
Subclass or Tranche of Notes, in whole or in part in accordance with the Series Supplement; provided that following a Series Anticipated
Repayment Date for any Series of Notes that remains Outstanding, all optional prepayments must be applied first, to Super Senior Notes,
second, to Senior Notes, third, to Senior Subordinated Notes and fourth, to Subordinated Notes. The Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf)
(x) will provide prior written notice to the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and such other parties as required pursuant to the Series Supplement
of the making of any optional prepayment in accordance with the Series Supplement, (y) will deposit the amount of such optional prepayment
in the relevant Principal Payment Account and (z) shall instruct the Trustee pursuant to the Quarterly Noteholders’ Report to withdraw
on the applicable prepayment date the funds so deposited in the relevant Principal Payment Account, to be paid for the benefit of the
Holders of each applicable Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes and, in accordance with Section 6.1, remit such funds to
the relevant Noteholders, pro rata in accordance with the Outstanding Principal Amount of such Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche
of Notes due to each Noteholder.
Section
5.13 Determination of Quarterly Interest.
Quarterly
payments of interest and fees on each Series of Notes shall be determined, allocated and distributed in accordance with the procedures
set forth in the Series Supplement.
Section
5.14 Determination of Quarterly Principal.
Quarterly
payments of principal, if any, of each Series of Notes shall be determined, allocated and distributed in accordance with the procedures
set forth in the Series Supplement.
Section
5.15 Prepayment of Principal.
Mandatory
prepayments of principal, if any, of each Series of Notes shall be determined, allocated and distributed in accordance with the procedures
set forth in the Series Supplement, if not otherwise described herein.
Section
5.16 Replacement of Ineligible Accounts.
If,
at any time, any Management Account or any of the Reserve Account, the Collection Account or any Collection Account Administrative Account
shall cease to be an Eligible Account (each, an “Ineligible Account”), the Issuer shall (i) within five (5) Business
Days of obtaining knowledge thereof, notify the Control Party thereof and (ii) within sixty (60) days of obtaining knowledge thereof,
(A) establish, or cause to be established, a new account that is an Eligible Account in substitution for such Ineligible Account, (B)
with the exception of any Management Account, following the establishment of such new Eligible Account, transfer, or with respect to
the Indenture Trust Accounts maintained at the Trustee, instruct the Trustee in writing to transfer, all cash and investments from such
Ineligible Account into such new Eligible Account, (C) in the case of a Management Account, following the establishment of such new Eligible
Account, transfer or cause to be transferred to such new Eligible Account, all cash and investments from such Ineligible Account into
such new Eligible Account, (D) in the case of a Management Account, transfer or cause to be transferred all items deposited in the lock-box
related to such Ineligible Account to a new lock-box related to such new Eligible Account, and (E) pledge, or cause to be pledged, such
new Eligible Account to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties and, if such Ineligible Account is required to be subject
to an Account Control Agreement in accordance with the terms of the Indenture, cause such new Eligible Account to be subject to an Account
Control Agreement in form and substance reasonably acceptable to the Control Party and the Trustee. In the event that any of the Collection
Account, any Management Account or any Collection Account Administrative Account becomes an Ineligible Account, the Manager shall, promptly
following the establishment of such related new Eligible Account, notify each Franchisee of a change in payment instructions, if any.
Section
5.17 Instructions and Directions.
Any
instructions or directions to be provided by the Issuer or the Manager referenced in this Article V (a) with respect to a Quarterly
Calculation Date or Quarterly Payment Date, respectively, will be contained in the applicable Quarterly Noteholders’ Report for
such Quarterly Calculation Date or Quarterly Payment Date, as applicable, and (b) with respect to a Monthly Allocation Date will be contained
in the Monthly Manager’s Certificate for such Monthly Allocation Date. All such instructions or directions shall include the specific
amounts to be withdrawn or deposited by the Trustee from or to each account or to be paid to any Person, and shall also include all payment
instructions. The Trustee shall be entitled to rely on such instructions or directions without further investigation. In the event the
Issuer or the Manager fails to make any instructions or directions by the time periods set forth in Article V, the Controlling
Class Representative shall be permitted to direct the Trustee in respect of such items.
Section
5.18 Qualified Equity Offering.
(a)
Within two (2) Business Days of the Manager’s receipt of Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds following the completion of a Qualified
Equity Offering, the Manager shall deposit 75% of any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds into the Collection Account, until an aggregate
amount equal to $75,000,000 has been deposited thereto, for further distribution as set forth below. Such requirement shall be memorialized
under the Contingent Value Rights Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date (the “Contingent Value Rights Agreement”),
between the Manager and the Issuer. For the avoidance of doubt, any funds deposited into the Collection Account pursuant to the Contingent
Value Rights Agreement shall be treated as Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds, for further distributed as set forth below.
(b)
Following the completion of a Qualified Equity Offering, the Issuer shall apply the Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds deposited into
the Collection Account to prepay the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes on the related Additional Payment Date plus the accrued
interest on the Outstanding Principal Amount to be prepaid on such Additional Payment Date. The Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf)
(i) will provide prior written notice to the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and such other parties as required pursuant to the applicable
Series Supplement of the making of such prepayment in accordance with the applicable Series Supplement, (ii) will deposit the amount
of such prepayment in the relevant Principal Payment Account and Interest Payment Account and (iii) shall instruct the Trustee pursuant
to the Monthly Manager’s Certificate or the Quarterly Noteholders’ Report, as applicable, to withdraw on the related Additional
Payment Date the funds so deposited in the relevant Principal Payment Account and Interest Payment Account, to be paid for the benefit
of the Holders of each Class of Notes and, in accordance with Section 6.1 of this Indenture, remit such funds to the relevant Noteholders,
sequentially in accordance with the Outstanding Principal Amount of such Class of Notes due to each Noteholder.
(c)
A Cash Flow Sweeping Event, as further described under “Cash Flow Sweeping Percentage”, shall occur if (i) $25,000,000 of
aggregate Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds are not used to prepay the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes on or prior to any
Level I QEO Quarterly Payment Date or (ii) $75,000,000, inclusive of any amounts prepaid in accordance with the foregoing clause (i),
of aggregate Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds are not used to prepay the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes on or prior to any
Level II QEO Quarterly Payment Date.
Article
VI
DISTRIBUTIONS
Section
6.1 Distributions in General.
(a)
Unless otherwise specified in the Series Supplement, on each Quarterly Payment Date, the Paying Agent shall pay to the Noteholders of
each Series of record on the preceding Record Date the amounts payable thereto (A) in the case of Book-Entry Notes, by wire transfer
in immediately available funds released by the Paying Agent from the applicable Indenture Trust Account and (B) in the case of Definitive
Notes (i) by wire transfer in immediately available funds released by the Paying Agent from the applicable Indenture Trust Account on
such Quarterly Payment Date if a Noteholder has provided to the Paying Agent and the Trustee wiring instructions at least five (5) Business
Days prior to the applicable Quarterly Payment Date or (ii) by check mailed first-class postage prepaid to such Noteholder at the address
for such Noteholder appearing in the Note Register if such Noteholder has not provided wire instructions pursuant to clause (B)(i)
above; provided, however, that the final principal payment due on a Note shall only be paid upon due presentment and
surrender of such Note for cancellation in accordance with the provisions of such Note at the applicable Corporate Trust Office, which
surrender shall also constitute a general release by the applicable Noteholder from any claims against the Securitization Entities, the
Manager, the Trustee and their affiliates.
(b)
Unless otherwise specified in the Series Supplement or in this Base Indenture, all distributions to Noteholders of all Classes within
a Series of Notes shall be made from amounts allocated in accordance with the Priority of Payments among each Class of Notes in alphanumerical
order (i.e., A-2, B-1, B-2 and not B-1, A-2, B-2) and pro rata among Holders of Notes within each Class of the same alphanumerical
designation; for the avoidance of doubt, any roman-numeral-denominated Tranche within an alphanumerical Class of Notes shall be paid
in roman-numeral order (i.e., Class A-2-I Notes will be paid before Class A-2-II Notes) except to the extent otherwise specified in this
Base Indenture or the Series Supplement, including in connection with an optional prepayment in whole or in part of one or more Tranches
within such alphanumerical Class of Notes independently of other Tranches; provided, further, that unless otherwise specified
in the Series Supplement or in this Base Indenture, all distributions to Noteholders of all Classes within a Series of Notes having the
same alphabetical designation (without giving effect to any numerical designation) shall be pari passu with each other with respect
to the distribution of Collateral proceeds resulting from the exercise of remedies upon an Event of Default.
Article
VII
REPRESENTATIONS
AND WARRANTIES
The
Issuer hereby represents and warrants, for the benefit of the Trustee and the Noteholders, as follows as of (i) the Series Closing Date
and (ii) each date on which Excess Amounts or Residual Amounts are distributed by the Issuer to the Manager or its Affiliates:
Section
7.1 Existence and Power.
Each
Securitization Entity (a) is duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of organization,
(b) is duly qualified to do business as a foreign entity and in good standing under the laws of each jurisdiction where the character
of its property, the nature of its business or the performance of its obligations under the Transaction Documents make such qualification
necessary, except to the extent that the failure to so qualify is not reasonably likely to result in a Material Adverse Effect, and (c)
has all limited liability company, corporate or other powers and all governmental licenses, authorizations, consents and approvals required
to carry on its business as now conducted and for purposes of the transactions contemplated by the Indenture and the other Transaction
Documents.
Section
7.2 Company and Governmental Authorization.
The
execution, delivery and performance by the Issuer of this Base Indenture and any Series Supplement and by the Issuer and each other Securitization
Entity of the other Transaction Documents to which it is a party (a) is within such Securitization Entity’s limited liability company,
corporate or other powers and has been duly authorized by all necessary limited liability company, corporate or other action, (b) requires
no action by or in respect of, or filing with, any Governmental Authority which has not been obtained (other than any actions or filings
that may be undertaken after the Closing Date pursuant to the terms of this Base Indenture or any other Transaction Document) and (c)
does not contravene, or constitute a default under, any Requirements of Law with respect to such Securitization Entity or any Contractual
Obligation with respect to such Securitization Entity or result in the creation or imposition of any Lien on any property of any Securitization
Entity, except for Liens created by this Base Indenture or the other Transaction Documents, except in the case of clauses (b)
and (c) above, solely with respect to the Contribution Agreement, the violation of which could not reasonably be expected to have
a Material Adverse Effect. This Base Indenture and each of the other Transaction Documents to which each Securitization Entity is a party
has been executed and delivered by a duly Authorized Officer of such Securitization Entity.
Section
7.3 No Consent.
Except
as set forth on Schedule 7.3, no consent, action by or in respect of, approval or other authorization of, or registration, declaration
or filing with, any Governmental Authority or other Person is required for the valid execution and delivery by the Issuer of this Base
Indenture and any Series Supplement and by the Issuer and each other Securitization Entity of any Transaction Document to which it is
a party or for the performance of any of the Securitization Entities’ obligations hereunder or thereunder other (a) than such consents,
approvals, authorizations, registrations, declarations or filings as shall have been obtained or made by such Securitization Entity prior
to the Closing Date or as are permitted to be obtained subsequent to the Closing Date in accordance with Section 7.13 or Section
8.25 and (b) such consents, approvals, authorizations, registrations, declarations or filings the failure of which to be obtained
or made would not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.
Section
7.4 Binding Effect.
This
Base Indenture and each other Transaction Document to which a Securitization Entity is a party is a legal, valid and binding obligation
of each such Securitization Entity enforceable against such Securitization Entity in accordance with its terms (except as may be limited
by bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization, moratorium and other similar laws affecting creditors’ rights
generally or by general equitable principles, whether considered in a proceeding at law or in equity or by an implied covenant of good
faith and fair dealing).
Section
7.5 Litigation.
There
is no action, suit, proceeding or investigation pending against or, to the knowledge of the Issuer, threatened in writing against or
affecting any Securitization Entity or of which any property or assets of such Securitization Entity is the subject before any court
or arbitrator or any Governmental Authority that would, individually or in the aggregate, affect the validity or enforceability of this
Base Indenture or any Series Supplement, materially adversely affect the performance by the Securitization Entities of their obligations
hereunder or thereunder or which is reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.
Section
7.6 [Reserved].
Section
7.7 Tax Filings and Expenses.
Each
Securitization Entity has filed, or caused to be filed, all federal, state, local and foreign Tax returns and all other Tax returns which,
to the knowledge of the Issuer, are required to be filed by, or with respect to the income, properties or operations of, such Securitization
Entity (whether information returns or not), and has paid, or caused to be paid, all Taxes due, if any, pursuant to said returns or pursuant
to any assessment received by any Securitization Entity or otherwise, except such Taxes, if any, as are being contested in good faith
and by appropriate action and for which adequate reserves have been set aside in accordance with GAAP. As of the Closing Date, except
as set forth on Schedule 7.7, the Issuer is not aware of any proposed Tax assessments against any Twin Hospitality TP Entity.
Except as would not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, no tax deficiency has been determined adversely to any
Securitization Entity, nor does any Securitization Entity have any knowledge of any tax deficiencies. Each Securitization Entity has
paid all fees and expenses required to be paid by it in connection with the conduct of its business, the maintenance of its existence
and its qualification as a foreign entity authorized to do business in each state and each foreign country in which it is required to
so qualify, except to the extent that the failure to pay such fees and expenses is not reasonably likely to result in a Material Adverse
Effect.
Section
7.8 Disclosure.
All
certificates, written reports, written statements, written notices, documents and other written information furnished to the Trustee
or the Noteholders by or on behalf of the Securitization Entities pursuant to any provision of the Indenture or any other Transaction
Document, or in connection with or pursuant to any amendment or modification of, or waiver under, the Indenture or any other Transaction
Document, are, at the time the same are so furnished, complete and correct in all material respects (when taken together with all other
information furnished by or on behalf of the Twin Hospitality TP Entities to the Trustee or the Noteholders, as the case may be), and
give the Trustee or the Noteholders, as the case may be, true and accurate knowledge of the subject matter thereof in all material respects,
and the furnishing of the same to the Trustee or the Noteholders, as the case may be, shall constitute a representation and warranty
by the Issuer made on the date the same are furnished to the Trustee or the Noteholders, as the case may be, to the effect specified
herein.
Section
7.9 1940 Act.
No
Securitization Entity is required to register as an “investment company” under the 1940 Act.
Section
7.10 Regulations T, U and X.
The
proceeds of the Notes will not be used to purchase or carry any “margin stock” (as defined or used in the regulations of
the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, including Regulations T, U and X thereof) in such a way that could cause the transactions
contemplated by the Transaction Documents to fail to comply with the regulations of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System,
including Regulations T, U and X thereof. No Securitization Entity owns or is engaged in the business of extending credit for the purpose
of purchasing or carrying any margin stock.
Section
7.11 Solvency.
Both
before and upon giving effect to the transactions contemplated by the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents, the Securitization
Entities, taken as a whole, are solvent within the meaning of the Bankruptcy Code and any applicable state law and no Securitization
Entity is the subject of any voluntary or involuntary case or proceeding seeking liquidation, reorganization or other relief with respect
to itself or its debts under any bankruptcy or Insolvency Law and no Event of Bankruptcy has occurred with respect to any Securitization
Entity.
Section
7.12 Ownership of Equity Interests; Subsidiaries.
(a)
All of the issued and outstanding limited liability company interests of the Issuer are directly owned by Twin Hospitality, have been
duly authorized and validly issued, are fully paid and non-assessable and are owned of record by Twin Hospitality free and clear of all
Liens other than Permitted Liens.
(b)
All of the issued and outstanding limited liability company interests of the Guarantors are directly owned by the Issuer, have been duly
authorized and validly issued, are fully paid and non-assessable and are owned of record by the Issuer, free and clear of all Liens other
than Permitted Liens.
(c)
The Issuer has no subsidiaries and owns no Equity Interests in any other Person, other than, directly or indirectly, the Guarantors and
any Additional Guarantors. The Guarantors have no subsidiaries and own no Equity Interests in any Person other than in the case of certain
Guarantors, certain other Guarantors.
Section
7.13 Security Interests.
(a)
The Issuer and each Guarantor owns and has good title to its Collateral, free and clear of all Liens other than Permitted Liens. Except
in the case of New Real Estate Assets included in the Collateral, this Base Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement constitute
a valid and continuing Lien on the Collateral in favor of the Trustee on behalf of and for the benefit of the Secured Parties, which
Lien on the Collateral has been perfected and is prior to all other Liens (other than Permitted Liens), and is enforceable as such as
against creditors of and purchasers from the Issuer and each Guarantor in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may
be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization, moratorium and other similar laws affecting creditors’
rights generally or by general equitable principles, whether considered in a proceeding at law or in equity and by an implied covenant
of good faith and fair dealing. Except as set forth on Schedule 7.13, the Issuer and each Guarantor has received all consents
and approvals required by the terms of the Collateral to the pledge of the Collateral to the Trustee hereunder and under the Guarantee
and Collateral Agreement. The Issuer and each Guarantor has filed, or shall have caused, the filing of all appropriate financing statements
in the proper filing office in the appropriate jurisdictions under applicable law in order to perfect the first-priority security interest
(subject to Permitted Liens) in the Collateral (other than the Owned Real Property and the New Owned Real Property) granted to the Trustee
hereunder or under the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement no later than ten (10) days after the Closing Date or the Series Closing Date
provided that with respect to the Real Estate Assets and the New Real Estate Assets included in the Collateral, the Issuer shall only
take such action necessary to perfect such first priority security interest consistent with and subject to the obligations and time periods
set forth in Section 8.38.
(b)
Other than the security interest granted to the Trustee hereunder, pursuant to the other Transaction Documents or any other Permitted
Lien, none of the Issuer or any Guarantor has pledged, assigned, sold or granted a security interest in the Collateral. All action necessary
(including the filing of UCC-1 financing statements and filings with the PTO and the United States Copyright Office) to protect and evidence
the Trustee’s security interest in the Collateral in the United States has been, or shall be, duly and effectively taken, consistent
with and subject to the obligations set forth in Section 7.13(a). No security agreement, financing statement, equivalent security
or lien instrument or continuation statement authorized by the Issuer or any Guarantor and listing the Issuer or any Guarantor as debtor
covering all or any part of the Collateral is on file or of record in any jurisdiction, except in respect of Permitted Liens or such
as may have been filed, recorded or made by the Issuer or such Guarantor in connection with a Contribution Agreement or in favor of the
Trustee on behalf of the Secured Parties in connection with this Base Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, and none
of the Issuer or any Guarantor has authorized any such filing.
(c)
All authorizations in this Base Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement for the Trustee to endorse checks, instruments and
securities and to execute financing statements, continuation statements, security agreements and other instruments with respect to the
Collateral and to take such other actions with respect to the Collateral authorized by this Base Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral
Agreement are powers coupled with an interest and are irrevocable.
(d)
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein or in the other Transaction Documents (other than the Mortgages, if applicable), none
of the Issuer nor any Guarantor makes any representation as to the validity, effectiveness, priority or enforceability of any grant of
security interest in any real property assets under Article III hereof or Section 3 of the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement,
including in each case the Real Estate Assets and the New Real Estate Assets, or the perfection thereof, which in each case shall be
governed by the Mortgages, if applicable.
Section
7.14 Transaction Documents.
The
Transaction Documents, the Collateral Transaction Documents, the Account Agreements, any Swap Contract and any Enhancement Agreement
with respect to each Series of Notes are in full force and effect. There are no outstanding defaults thereunder nor have events occurred
which, with the giving of notice, the passage of time or both, would constitute a default thereunder.
Section
7.15 Non-Existence of Other Agreements.
Other
than as permitted by Section 8.22 (a) no Securitization Entity is a party to any contract or agreement of any kind or nature and
(b) no Securitization Entity is subject to any material obligations or liabilities of any kind or nature in favor of any third party,
including, without limitation, Contingent Obligations. The Issuer has not engaged in any activities since its formation (other than those
incidental to its formation, the authorization and the issuance of any Series of Notes, the execution of the Transaction Documents to
which the Issuer is a party and the performance of the activities referred to in or contemplated by such agreements).
Section
7.16 Compliance with Contractual Obligations and Laws.
No
Securitization Entity is in violation of (a) its Charter Documents, (b) any Requirements of Law with respect to such Securitization Entity
or (c) any Contractual Obligation with respect to such Securitization Entity except, solely with respect to clauses (b) and (c),
to the extent such violation could not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.
Section
7.17 Other Representations.
All
representations and warranties of each Securitization Entity made in each Transaction Document to which it is a party are true and correct
(i) if qualified as to materiality, in all respects, and (ii) if not qualified as to materiality, in all material respects (unless stated
to relate solely to an earlier date, in which case such representations and warranties were true and correct in all respects or in all
material respects, as applicable, as of such earlier date), and are repeated herein as though fully set forth herein.
Section
7.18 No Employees.
Notwithstanding
any other provision of the Indenture or any Charter Documents of any Securitization Entity to the contrary, no Securitization Entity
(other than the Employer Guarantors), has any employees.
Section
7.19 Reserved.
Section
7.20 Environmental Matters; Real Property.
(a)
None of the Securitization Entities is subject to any liabilities or obligations pursuant to any Environmental Law or with respect to
any Materials of Environmental Concern that could, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse
Effect.
(b)
Other than exceptions to any of the following that could not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material
Adverse Effect:
(i)
The Securitization Entities: (i) are, and within the period of all applicable statutes of limitation have been, in compliance with all
applicable Environmental Laws, (ii) hold all Environmental Permits (each of which is in full force and effect) required for any of their
current or intended operations or for any property owned, leased, or otherwise operated by any of them and have obtained all Environmental
Permits for any intended operations when such Environmental Permits are required and (iii) are, and within the period of all applicable
statutes of limitation have been, in compliance with all of their Environmental Permits.
(ii)
Materials of Environmental Concern are not present at, on, under, in, or about any Real Estate Assets or New Real Estate Assets now or
formerly owned, leased or operated by any Securitization Entity, or at any other location (including, without limitation, any location
to which Materials of Environmental Concern have been sent for re-use or recycling or for treatment, storage or disposal) which could
reasonably be expected to (i) give rise to liability of any Securitization Entity under any applicable Environmental Law or otherwise
result in costs to any Securitization Entity, (ii) interfere with any Securitization Entity’s continued operations or (iii) impair
the fair saleable value of any real property owned by any Securitization Entity.
(iii)
There is no judicial, administrative, or arbitral proceeding (including, without limitation, any notice of violation or alleged violation)
under or relating to any Environmental Law to which any Securitization Entity is, or to the knowledge of the Securitization Entities
will be, named as a party that is pending or, to the knowledge of the Securitization Entities, threatened in writing.
(iv)
No Securitization Entity has received any written request for information, or been notified that it is a potentially responsible party
under or relating to the federal Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act, as amended, or any other Environmental
Law, or with respect to any Materials of Environmental Concern.
(v)
No Securitization Entity has entered into or agreed to any consent decree, order, or settlement or other agreement, or is subject to
any judgment, decree, or order or other agreement, in any judicial, administrative, arbitral, or other forum for dispute resolution,
relating to compliance with or liability under any Environmental Law.
Section
7.21 Intellectual Property.
(a)
All of the registrations and applications included in the Securitization IP are subsisting, unexpired and have not been abandoned in
any applicable jurisdiction except where such expiration or abandonment could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.
(b)
Except as set forth on Schedule 7.21, (i) the use of the Securitization IP and the operation of the Twin Hospitality TP Systems
do not infringe, misappropriate or otherwise violate the rights of any third party in a manner that could reasonably be expected to have
a Material Adverse Effect, (ii) there is no action or proceeding pending or, to the Issuer’s knowledge, threatened in writing,
alleging the same that could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, and (iii) to the Issuer’s knowledge, the
Securitization IP is not being infringed, misappropriated or otherwise violated by any third party in a manner that could reasonably
be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.
(c)
Except as set forth on Schedule 7.21, no action or proceeding is pending or, to the Issuer’s knowledge, threatened in writing,
that seeks to limit, cancel or challenge the validity of any Securitization IP, or the use thereof, that could reasonably be expected
to have a Material Adverse Effect.
(d)
Each Guarantor is the exclusive owner of the Securitization IP related to the business operated or intended to be operated under the
applicable Brand, in each case, other than IP licenses granted in the ordinary course of business, free and clear of all Liens, other
than Permitted Liens.
(e)
The Issuer has not made and will not hereafter make and has not caused or permitted and will not cause or permit any Guarantor to make,
any assignment, pledge, mortgage, hypothecation or transfer of any of the Securitization IP other than Permitted Liens and Permitted
Asset Dispositions under Section 8.12 and Section 8.16.
Section
7.22 Exchange Act
Payments
on the Notes will not depend primarily on cash flow from self-liquidating financial assets within the meaning of Section 3(a)(79)
of the Exchange Act.
Article
VIII
COVENANTS
Section
8.1 Payment of Notes.
(a)
The Issuer shall pay or cause to be paid the principal of, and premium, if any, and interest, subject to Section 2.15(d), on the
Notes when due pursuant to the provisions of this Base Indenture and any Series Supplement. Principal, premium, if any, and interest
shall be considered paid on the date due if the Paying Agent holds on that date money designated for and sufficient to pay all principal,
premium, if any, and interest then due. Except as otherwise provided pursuant to any Transaction Document, amounts properly withheld
under the Code or any Requirements of Law by any Person from a payment to any Noteholder of interest or principal or premium, if any,
shall be considered as having been paid by the Issuer to such Noteholder for all purposes of the Indenture and the Notes.
(b)
By acceptance of its Notes, each Noteholder agrees that the failure to provide the Paying Agent with appropriate Tax Information (which
includes (i) an Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) Form W-9 for United States persons (as defined under Section 7701(a)(30)
of the Code) or any applicable successor form or (ii) an applicable IRS Form W-8 (including all required attachments), for Persons other
than such United States persons, or applicable successor form) may result in amounts being withheld from payments to such Noteholder
under this Base Indenture and any Series Supplement (without any corresponding gross-up) and that amounts withheld pursuant to applicable
laws shall be considered as having been paid by the Issuer as provided in clause (a) above.
Section
8.2 Maintenance of Office or Agency.
(a)
The Issuer will maintain an office or agency (which, with respect to the surrender for registration of, or transfer or exchange or the
payment of principal and premium, may be an office of the Trustee, the Note Registrar or Paying Agent) where Notes may be surrendered
for registration of transfer or exchange, notices may be served, and where, at any time when the Issuer is obligated to make a payment
of principal of, and premium, if any, on the Notes, the Notes may be surrendered for payment. The Issuer will give prompt written notice
to the Trustee and the Control Party of the location, and any change in the location, of such office or agency. If at any time the Issuer
shall fail to maintain any such required office or agency or shall fail to furnish the Trustee and the Control Party with the address
thereof, such presentations and surrenders may be made or served at the Corporate Trust Office and notices and demands may be made at
the address set forth in Section 14.1 hereof.
(b)
The Issuer may also from time to time designate one or more other offices or agencies where the Notes may be presented or surrendered
for any or all such purposes and may from time to time rescind such designations. The Issuer will give prompt written notice to the Trustee
and the Control Party of any such designation or rescission and of any change in the location of any such other office or agency. The
Issuer hereby designates the applicable Corporate Trust Office as one such office or agency of the Issuer.
Section
8.3 Payment and Performance of Obligations.
The
Issuer will, and will cause the other Securitization Entities to, pay and discharge and fully perform, at or before maturity, all of
their respective material obligations and liabilities, including, without limitation, Tax liabilities and other governmental claims levied
or imposed upon the Securitization Entity or upon the income, properties or operations of any Securitization Entity, judgments, settlement
agreements and all obligations of each Securitization Entity under the Collateral Documents, except where the same may be contested in
good faith by appropriate action (and without derogation from the material obligations of the Issuer hereunder and the Guarantors under
the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement regarding the protection of the Collateral from Liens (other than Permitted Liens)), and will
maintain, in accordance with GAAP, reserves as appropriate for the accrual of any of the same.
Section
8.4 Maintenance of Existence.
The
Issuer will, and will cause each other Securitization Entity to, maintain its existence as a limited liability company or corporation
validly existing and in good standing under the laws of its state of organization and duly qualified as a foreign limited liability company
or corporation licensed under the laws of each state in which the failure to so qualify would be reasonably likely to result in a Material
Adverse Effect. The Issuer will, and will cause each other Securitization Entity (other than any Additional Guarantor that is a corporation)
to, be treated as a disregarded entity within the meaning of Treasury Regulation Section 301.7701-2(c)(2) and the Issuer will not, nor
will it permit any other Securitization Entity (other than any Additional Guarantor that is a corporation) to, be classified as a corporation
or as an association taxable as a corporation or a publicly traded partnership taxable as a corporation for United States federal income
tax purposes.
Section
8.5 Compliance with Laws.
The
Issuer will, and will cause each other Securitization Entity to, comply in all respects with all Requirements of Law with respect to
the Issuer or such other Securitization Entity except where such noncompliance would not be reasonably likely to result in a Material
Adverse Effect; provided, however, such non-compliance will not result in a Lien (other than a Permitted Lien) on any of the Collateral
or any criminal liability on the part of any Securitization Entity, the Manager or the Trustee.
Section
8.6 Inspection of Property; Books and Records.
The
Issuer will, and will cause each other Securitization Entity to, keep books of record and account to enable the preparation of financial
statements in accordance with GAAP. Subject to the Disclosure Exceptions and to reasonable requirements of confidentiality, including
requirements imposed by law or by contract, the Issuer will, and will cause each other Securitization Entity to, permit, at reasonable
times upon reasonable notice, the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative and the Trustee or any Person appointed by any
of them to act as its agent to visit and inspect any of its properties, to examine and make abstracts from any of its books and records
and to discuss its affairs, finances and accounts with its officers, directors, managers, employees and independent certified public
accountants (so long as the Issuer has the opportunity to participate in any such discussions with the accountants), and up to one (1)
such visit and inspection by the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative, the Trustee, or any Person appointed by the Control
Party, shall be reimbursable as a Securitization Operating Expense per calendar year, with any additional visit or inspection being at
such Person’s sole cost and expense; provided, however, that during the continuance of any event that causes a Cash
Flow Sweeping Period to begin and that has occurred and continued for at least two consecutive Quarterly Calculation Dates, a Rapid Amortization
Event or an Event of Default, or to the extent expressly required without the instruction of any other party under the terms of any Transaction
Documents, any such of such Persons may visit and conduct such activities at any time and all such visits and activities shall constitute
a Securitization Operating Expense.
Section
8.7 Actions under the Collateral Documents and Transaction Documents.
(a)
Except as otherwise provided in Section 8.7(d), the Issuer will not, nor will it permit any Securitization Entity to, take any
action that would permit any Twin Hospitality TP Entity or any other Person party to a Transaction Document to have the right to refuse
to perform any of its respective obligations under any of the Transaction Documents or that would result in the amendment, waiver, hypothecation,
subordination, termination or discharge of, or impair the validity or effectiveness of, any Transaction Document.
(b)
Except as otherwise provided in Section 3.2(a) or Section 8.7(d), the Issuer will not, nor will it permit any Securitization
Entity to, take any action that would permit any other Person party to a Franchise Document to have the right to refuse to perform any
of its respective obligations under such Franchise Document or that would result in the amendment, waiver, hypothecation, subordination,
termination or discharge of, or impair the validity or effectiveness of, such Franchise Document if such action when taken on behalf
of any Securitization Entity by the Manager would constitute a breach by the Manager of the Management Agreement.
(c)
Except as otherwise provided in Section 3.2(a), the Issuer agrees that it will not, and will cause each Securitization Entity
not to, exercise any right, remedy, power or privilege available to it with respect to any obligor under a Collateral Document or under
any instrument or agreement included in the Collateral, take any action to compel or secure performance or observance by any such obligor
of its obligations to the Issuer or such other Securitization Entity or give any consent, request, notice, direction or approval with
respect to any such obligor if such action when taken on behalf of any Securitization Entity by the Manager would constitute a breach
by the Manager of the Management Agreement.
(d)
The Issuer agrees that it will not, and will cause each Securitization Entity not to, without the prior written consent of the Control
Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), amend, modify, waive, supplement, terminate or surrender, or
agree to any amendment, modification, waiver, supplement, termination or surrender of, the terms of any of the Transaction Documents
(other than the Transaction Documents, which may be amended in accordance with Article XIII hereof); provided, however,
that the Securitization Entities may agree to any amendment, modification, supplement or waiver of any such term of such Transaction
Document without any such consent (and if the Trustee or the Control Party is a party to such Transaction Document and in such capacity
is required to consent or agree to any such amendment, modification, supplement or waiver, such consent or agreement shall not be subject
to the satisfaction of any condition or requirement other than as specified under such Transaction Document) for the following purposes:
(i)
to add to the covenants of any Securitization Entity for the benefit of the Secured Parties, or to add to the covenants of any Twin Hospitality
TP Entity for the benefit of any Securitization Entity;
(ii)
to terminate any such Transaction Document if any party thereto (other than a Securitization Entity) becomes, in the reasonable judgment
of the Issuer, unable to pay its debts as they become due, even if such party has not yet defaulted on its obligations under such Transaction
Document, so long as the Issuer enters into a replacement agreement with a new party within ninety (90) days of the termination of such
Transaction Document;
(iii)
to make such other provisions in regard to matters or questions arising under such Transaction Documents as the parties thereto may deem
necessary or desirable, which are not inconsistent with the provisions thereof and which shall not materially and adversely affect the
interests of any Noteholder, any Note Owner or any other Secured Party; provided that an Opinion of Counsel from outside counsel
and an Officer’s Certificate shall be delivered to the Trustee and the Control Party to such effect; or
(iv)
to amend the definition of “Monthly Management Fee” pursuant to Section 8.3(a) of the Management Agreement with the
consent of the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) and the Manager, which consent shall not
be subject to the satisfaction of any other condition to an amendment hereunder.
Promptly
after the effectiveness of any such amendment, modification, supplement or waiver, the Issuer shall send to the Trustee (who shall make
such amendment available to the Noteholders), the Control Party and the Back-Up Manager a copy of such consent or agreement, but the
failure to do so shall not impair or affect its validity.
(e)
Upon the occurrence of a Manager Termination Event under the Management Agreement, (i) the Issuer will not, and will cause each other
Securitization Entity not to, without the prior written consent of the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class
Representative), terminate the Manager and appoint any successor Manager in accordance with the Management Agreement and (ii) the Issuer
will, and will cause each other Securitization Entity to, terminate the Manager and appoint one or more successor Managers in accordance
with the Management Agreement if and when so directed by the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative).
Section
8.8 Notice of Defaults and Other Events.
Promptly
(and in any event within three (3) Business Days) upon becoming aware of (i) any Potential Rapid Amortization Event, (ii) any Rapid Amortization
Event, (iii) any Potential Manager Termination Event, (iv) any Manager Termination Event, (v) any Default, (vi) any Event of Default
or (vii) any default under any Collateral Transaction Document, the Issuer shall give the Trustee, the Control Party, the Manager, the
Back-Up Manager, the Controlling Class Representative with respect to each Series of Notes Outstanding notice thereof, together with
an Officer’s Certificate setting forth the details thereof and any action with respect thereto taken or contemplated to be taken
by the Issuer. Subject to the Disclosure Exceptions, the Issuer shall, at its expense, promptly provide to the Control Party, the Manager,
the Back-Up Manager, the Controlling Class Representative and the Trustee such additional information as the Control Party, the Manager,
the Back-Up Manager, the Controlling Class Representative or the Trustee may reasonably request from time to time in connection with
the matters so reported, and the actions so taken or contemplated to be taken.
Section
8.9 Notice of Material Proceedings.
Without
limiting Section 8.30 or Section 8.25(b), promptly (and in any event within five (5) Business Days) upon the determination
by either the chief financial officer or the chief legal officer of Twin Hospitality that the commencement or existence of any litigation,
arbitration or other proceeding with respect to any Twin Hospitality TP Entity would be reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse
Effect, the Issuer shall give written notice thereof to the Trustee, the Control Party, the Back-Up Manager and the Manager.
Section
8.10 Further Requests.
Subject
to the Disclosure Exceptions, the Issuer will, and will cause each other Securitization Entity to, promptly furnish to the Trustee such
other information as, and in such form as, the Trustee may reasonably request in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby
or by any Series Supplement. Notwithstanding anything in this Base Indenture or any other Transaction Document to the contrary, in no
event shall the Issuer, any other Securitization Entity or any Non-Securitization Entity be required to disclose or discuss, or permit
the inspection, examination or making of extracts of, any records, books, information or account or other matter (a) in respect of which
disclosure to the Trustee, the Control Party, any Noteholder or any other Person is then prohibited by applicable law or any agreement
binding on any Twin Hospitality TP Entity, (b) that is protected from disclosure by the attorney-client privilege or the attorney work
product privilege, or (c) that constitutes trade secrets or other proprietary information (including, without limitation, know how, ideas,
techniques, recipes, formulas, customer lists, customer information, financial information, business methods and processes, marketing
plans, specifications, and other similar information as well as internal materials prepared by the owner of such information containing
or based, in whole or in part, on any such information) that is confidential to its owner other than such information as is explicitly
required to be disclosed by this Indenture or a Series Supplement (the “Disclosure Exceptions”).
Section
8.11 Further Assurances.
(a)
The Issuer will, and will cause each other Securitization Entity to, do such further acts and things, and execute and deliver to the
Trustee, the Control Party and the Controlling Class Representative such additional assignments, agreements, powers and instruments,
as are necessary or desirable to obtain or maintain the security interest of the Trustee in the Collateral on behalf of the Secured Parties
as a perfected security interest subject to no prior Liens (other than Permitted Liens), to carry into effect the purposes of the Indenture
or the other Transaction Documents or to better assure and confirm unto the Trustee, the Control Party, the Noteholders or the other
Secured Parties their rights, powers and remedies hereunder including, without limitation, the filing of any financing or continuation
statements or amendments under the UCC in effect in any jurisdiction with respect to the liens and security interests granted hereby
and by the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, except as set forth on Schedule 8.11. The Issuer and each Guarantor intends the
security interests granted pursuant to the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement in favor of the Secured Parties to be
prior to all other Liens (other than Permitted Liens) in respect of the Collateral, and the Issuer will, and will cause each other Securitization
Entity to, take all actions necessary to obtain and maintain, in favor of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a first
lien on and a first priority perfected security interest in the Collateral (except with respect to Permitted Liens and except as set
forth on Schedule 8.11 and subject to Section 8.25). If the Issuer fails to perform any of its agreements or obligations
under this Section 8.11(a), then the Control Party may (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) perform
such agreement or obligation, and the expenses of the Control Party incurred in connection therewith shall be payable by the Issuer upon
the Control Party’s demand therefor. The Control Party is hereby authorized to execute and file any financing statements, continuation
statements, amendments or other instruments necessary or appropriate to perfect or maintain the perfection of the Trustee’s security
interest in the Collateral.
(b)
If any debt with an outstanding principal amount of greater than $100,000 individually shall be or become evidenced by any promissory
note, chattel paper or other instrument and such note, chattel paper or instrument constitutes Collateral, such note, chattel paper or
instrument shall be deemed to be held in trust and immediately pledged in favor of the Trustee, for the benefit of the Secured Parties,
and within ten (10) Business Days physically delivered to the Trustee hereunder, and shall, subject to the rights of any Person in whose
favor a prior Lien has been perfected, be duly endorsed in a manner satisfactory to the Trustee.
(c)
Notwithstanding the provisions set forth in clauses (a) and (b) above, none of the Issuer nor any Guarantor shall be required
to perfect any security interest in any fixtures (other than through a central filing of a UCC financing statement), any Franchisee promissory
notes or, except as provided in Section 8.38, any Real Estate Assets or New Real Estate Assets.
(d)
If during any Quarterly Collection Period, the Issuer or Guarantor shall obtain an interest in any commercial tort claim or claims (as
such term is defined in the New York UCC) and such commercial tort claim or claims (when added to any past commercial tort claim or claims
that were obtained by any Securitization Entity prior to such Quarterly Collection Period that are still outstanding) have an aggregate
value equal to or greater than $5,000,000 as of the last day of such Quarterly Collection Period, the Issuer or Guarantor shall notify
the Control Party on or before the third Business Day prior to the next succeeding Quarterly Payment Date that it has obtained such an
interest and shall sign and deliver documentation acceptable to the Control Party granting a security interest under the Base Indenture
or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, as the case may be, in and to such commercial tort claim or claims whether obtained during
such Quarterly Collection Period or prior to such Quarterly Collection Period.
(e)
The Issuer will, and will cause each other Securitization Entity to, warrant and defend the Trustee’s right, title and interest
in and to the Collateral and the income, distributions and Proceeds thereof, for the benefit of the Trustee on behalf of the Secured
Parties, against the claims and demands of all Persons whomsoever.
(f)
On or before the time when the Manager, acting on behalf of the Securitization Entities, is required to provide annual financials pursuant
to Section 4.1(g)(ii) with respect to the preceding fiscal year, the Issuer shall furnish to the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager
and the Control Party an Opinion of Counsel from outside counsel (i) stating substantially to the effect that, in the opinion of such
counsel, such action has been taken with respect to the recording, filing, re-recording and refiling of this Base Indenture, any indentures
supplemental hereto, the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and any other requisite documents and with respect to the execution and filing
of any financing statements, continuation statements and amendments to financing statements and such other documents as are, subject
to clause (c) above, necessary to maintain the perfection of the Lien and security interest created by this Base Indenture and
the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement under Article 9 of the New York UCC in the United States and reciting the details of such action
or referencing to prior Opinions of Counsel in which such details are given; or (ii) to the effect that, in the opinion of such counsel,
no such action is necessary to maintain the perfection of such Lien and security interest; provided that with respect to financing
statements, the foregoing shall apply solely to financing statements naming a Securitization Entity as debtor and the Trustee as secured
party (or any continuations thereof) and shall not, for the avoidance of doubt, apply to any financing statements assigned to the Trustee
by a Securitization Entity); provided further, that the Trustee shall not be required to determine the sufficiency of any such opinion.
Section
8.12 Liens.
The
Issuer will not, nor will it permit any other Securitization Entity to, create, incur, assume or permit to exist any Lien upon any of
its property (including the Collateral), other than (i) Liens in favor of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties and (ii)
other Permitted Liens.
Section
8.13 Other Indebtedness.
The
Issuer will not, nor will it permit any other Securitization Entity to, create, assume, incur, suffer to exist or otherwise become or
remain liable in respect of any Indebtedness other than (i) Indebtedness hereunder or under the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement or
any other Transaction Document, (ii) any guarantee by any Securitization Entity of the obligations of any other Securitization Entity,
(iii) Indebtedness of a Securitization Entity owed to a Securitization Entity, (iv) any purchase money Indebtedness incurred in order
to finance the acquisition, lease or improvement of assets or property in the ordinary course of business, (v) any Indebtedness incurred
in order to finance any Prospective Company Restaurant Property or Company Restaurant Build-Out (provided that, solely in the
case of this Section 8.13(v), the prior approval of the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)
shall be required for any such Indebtedness that is equal to more than $5,000,000 per property or $25,000,000 in aggregate for all properties),
or (vi) amounts paid by Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie, LLC and Twin Restaurant Burleson, LLC representing contractual obligations to
pay up to 3% of net taxable income of Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie, LLC and Twin Restaurant Burleson, LLC, respectively, to third party
investors in the stores pursuant to the Profits Interest Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date, between Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie,
LLC and FAT Brands Development 5, LLC, and the Profits Interest Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date, between Twin Restaurant Burleson,
LLC and FAT Brands Development 3, LLC, respectively.
Section
8.14 [Reserved].
Section
8.15 Mergers.
On
and after the Closing Date, the Issuer will not, and will not permit any other Securitization Entity to, merge or consolidate with or
into any other Person or divide into two or more Persons (whether by means of a single transaction or a series of related transactions)
other than any merger or consolidation of any Securitization Entity with any other Securitization Entity or any division in which each
resulting Person will be a Securitization Entity or any merger or consolidation of any Securitization Entity with any other entity or
any division of any Securitization Entity to which the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)
has given prior written consent.
Section
8.16 Asset Dispositions.
The
Issuer shall not, and shall not permit any other Securitization Entity to, direct the Manager to sell, transfer, lease, license, liquidate
or otherwise dispose of any of its property (whether by means of a single transaction or a series of related transactions), including
any Equity Interests of any other Securitization Entity, except in the case of the following (each, a “Permitted Asset Disposition”):
(a)
any disposition of obsolete, damaged, surplus or worn out property, and any abandonment, cancellation, or lapse of IP registrations or
applications that are no longer commercially reasonable to maintain;
(b)
any disposition of (i) Eligible Investments and (ii) inventory in the ordinary course of business;
(c)
any disposition of equipment or real property to the extent that (x) such property is exchanged for credit against the purchase price
or other payment obligations in respect of similar replacement property or other Eligible Assets (including, without limitation, credit
against rental obligations under a real estate lease) or (y) the proceeds thereof are applied to the purchase price of such replacement
property or other Eligible Assets in accordance with the Base Indenture;
(d)
(i) licenses to the Manager, in connection with the performance of its services under the Management Agreement and (ii) other non-exclusive
licenses of Securitization IP (A) granted in the ordinary course of business, (B) that when effected on behalf of any Securitization
Entity by the Manager would not constitute a breach by the Manager of the Management Agreement acting in accordance with the Managing
Standard and (C) that would not reasonably be expected to materially and adversely impact the Securitization IP (taken as a whole);
(e)
dispositions pursuant to the sale, sale-leaseback or other disposition of Owned Real Property or New Owned Real Property or Company Restaurants
and Company Restaurant Assets;
(f)
dispositions of (x) equipment leased to Franchisees in accordance with or upon termination of the related Equipment Leases or used in
a Company Restaurant or (y) dispositions of Equipment Leases and dispositions of property of a Securitization Entity to any other Securitization
Entity not otherwise prohibited under the Transaction Documents;
(g)
(i) leases or subleases of Real Estate Assets to Franchisees or (in the case of the location of a Company Restaurant) a Company Restaurant
Guarantor and assignments and terminations of leases and subleases that do not materially interfere with the business of the Securitization
Entities or materially decrease ongoing Collections from such Real Estate Assets and (ii) dispositions pursuant to the foregoing clause
(i) which result in materially decreasing ongoing Collections from such Real Estate Assets;
(h)
dispositions of property relating to repurchases of Contributed Assets in exchange for the payment of Indemnification Amounts;
(i)
investments, Liens and distributions permitted under the Indenture;
(j)
transfers of properties subject to condemnation or casualty events;
(k)
dispositions of Franchisee Notes or accounts receivable in connection with the collection or compromise thereof;
(l)
terminations, non-renewals, expirations, amendments or other modifications of any Collateral Franchise Business Document or Franchised
Restaurant Lease that when effected on behalf of any Securitization Entity by the Manager would not constitute a breach by the Manager
of the Management Agreement;
(m)
any other sale, lease, license, transfer or other disposition of property, including, without limitation, the equity in or all or substantially
all of the assets of a Guarantor, to which the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) has given
the relevant Securitization Entity prior written consent;
(n)
any decision to abandon, fail to pursue, settle, or otherwise resolve any claim or cause of action to enforce or seek remedy for the
infringement, misappropriation, dilution or other violation of any Securitization IP, or other remedy against any third party, in each
such case, where it is not commercially reasonable to pursue such claim or remedy in light of the cost, potential remedy, or other factors;
provided that such action (or failure to act) would not reasonably be expected to materially and adversely impact the Securitization
IP (taken as a whole);
(o)
any surrender or waiver of contractual rights or the settlement, release or surrender of contractual rights or other litigation claims
in the ordinary course of business, in each case that would not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect; and
(p)
any other sale, lease, license, liquidation, transfer or other disposition of property not directly or indirectly constituting any asset
dispositions permitted by the foregoing clauses and so long as such disposition when effected on behalf of any Securitization Entity
by the Manager does not constitute a breach by the Manager of the Management Agreement and does not exceed an aggregate amount of $1,000,000
per annum.
Upon
any sale, transfer, lease, license, liquidation or other disposition of any property by any Securitization Entity permitted by this Section
8.16, all Liens with respect to such property created in favor of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties under this Base
Indenture and the other Transaction Documents shall be automatically released, and the Trustee, upon written request of the Issuer, at
the direction of the Control Party, shall provide evidence of such release as set forth in Section 14.17.
Section
8.17 Acquisition of Assets.
The
Issuer will not, nor will it permit any other Securitization Entity to, acquire, by long-term or operating lease or otherwise, any property
(i) if such acquisition when effected on behalf of any Securitization Entity by the Manager would constitute a breach by the Manager
of the Management Agreement or (ii) that is a lease, license, or other contract or permit, if the grant of a lien or security interest
in any of the Securitization Entities’ right, title and interest in, to or under such lease, license, contract or permit in the
manner contemplated by the Base Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement (a) would be prohibited by the terms of such lease,
license, contract or permit, (b) would constitute or result in the abandonment, invalidation or unenforceability of any right, title
or interest of the applicable Securitization Entity therein or (c) would otherwise result in a breach thereof or the termination or a
right of termination thereof, except to the extent that any such prohibition, breach, termination or right of termination is rendered
ineffective pursuant to the UCC or any other applicable law.
Section
8.18 Dividends, Officers’ Compensation, etc.
Except
as described in the 2024-1 Series Supplement dated as of the date hereof, the Issuer will not declare or pay any distributions on any
of its limited liability company interests; provided, however, that so long as no Potential Rapid Amortization Event, Rapid
Amortization Event, Default or Event of Default has occurred and is continuing with respect to any Series of Notes Outstanding or would
result therefrom, the Issuer may declare and pay distributions to the extent permitted under Section 18-607 of the Delaware Limited Liability
Company Act and the Issuer’s Charter Documents.
Without
limiting Section 8.28, the Issuer will not, nor will it permit any other Securitization Entity to, pay any wages or salaries or
other compensation to its officers, directors, managers or other agents except out of earnings computed in accordance with GAAP or except
for the fees paid to its Independent Managers. The Issuer will not, nor will it permit any other Securitization Entity to, redeem, purchase,
retire or otherwise acquire for value any Equity Interest in or issued by such Securitization Entity or set aside or otherwise segregate
any amounts for any such purpose except as expressly permitted by the Indenture or as consented to by the Control Party (acting at the
direction of the Controlling Class Representative).
Section
8.19 Legal Name, Location Under Section 9-301 or 9-307.
The
Issuer will not, nor will it permit any other Securitization Entity to, change its location (within the meaning of Section 9-301 or 9-307
of the applicable UCC) or its legal name without at least thirty (30) days’ prior written notice to the Trustee, the Control Party,
the Manager and the Back-Up Manager with respect to each Series of Notes Outstanding. In the event that the Issuer or other Securitization
Entity desires to so change its location or change its legal name, the Issuer will, or will cause such other Securitization Entity to,
make any required filings and prior to actually changing its location or its legal name the Issuer will, or will cause such other Securitization
Entity to, deliver to the Trustee and the Control Party (i) an Officer’s Certificate and Opinion of Counsel from outside counsel
stating substantially to the effect that (a) all required filings have been made to continue the perfected interest of the Trustee on
behalf of the Secured Parties in the Collateral under Article 9 of the applicable UCC in respect of the new location or new legal name
of the Issuer or other Securitization Entity and (b) such change in location or change in legal name will not adversely affect the Lien
under any Mortgage required to be delivered and recorded pursuant to Section 8.38 and (ii) copies of all such required filings
with the filing information duly noted thereon by the office in which such filings were made.
Section
8.20 Charter Documents.
The
Issuer will not, nor will it permit any other Securitization Entity to, amend, or consent to the amendment of, any of its Charter Documents
to which it is a party as a member or shareholder unless, prior to such amendment, the Control Party (acting at the direction of the
Controlling Class Representative) shall have consented thereto. The Control Party may rely on an Officer’s Certificate of the Issuer
to seek discretion from the Controlling Class Representative to make such determination.
Section
8.21 Investments.
The
Issuer will not, nor will it permit any other Securitization Entity to, make, incur, or suffer to exist any loan, advance, extension
of credit or other investment in any Person if such investment when made on behalf of any Securitization Entity by the Manager would
constitute a breach by the Manager of the Management Agreement.
Section
8.22 No Other Agreements.
The
Issuer will not, nor will it permit any other Securitization Entity to, enter into or be a party to any agreement or instrument if such
agreement when effected on behalf of any Securitization Entity by the Manager would constitute a breach by the Manager of the Management
Agreement.
Section
8.23 Other Business.
The
Issuer will not, nor will it permit any other Securitization Entity to, engage in any business or enterprise or enter into any transaction
other than the incurrence and payment of ordinary course operating expenses, the issuing and selling of the Notes and other activities
related to or incidental to any of the foregoing or any other transaction which when effected on behalf of any Securitization Entity
by the Manager would not constitute a breach by the Manager of the Management Agreement.
Section
8.24 Maintenance of Separate Existence.
(a)
The Issuer will, and will cause each other Securitization Entity to:
(i)
maintain their own deposit and securities account, as applicable, or accounts, separate from those of any of its Affiliates (other than
the other Securitization Entities), with commercial banking institutions and ensure that the funds of the Securitization Entities will
not be diverted to any Person who is not a Securitization Entity or for other than the use of the Securitization Entities, nor will such
funds be commingled with the funds of any of its Affiliates (other than the other Securitization Entities) other than as provided in
the Transaction Documents;
(ii)
ensure that all transactions between it and any of its Affiliates (other than the other Securitization Entities), whether currently existing
or hereafter entered into, shall be only on an arm’s length basis, it being understood and agreed that the transactions contemplated
in the Transaction Documents meet the requirements of this clause (ii);
(iii)
to the extent that any Securitization Entity and any of its Affiliates (other than the other Securitization Entities) have offices in
the same location, fairly and appropriately allocate overhead costs among them, and each such entity shall bear its fair share of such
expenses;
(iv)
(A) issue separate financial statements from any of its Affiliates (other than the other Securitization Entities) prepared at least quarterly
and prepared in accordance with GAAP and (B) file its own tax returns, if any, as may be required under applicable law, to the extent
not part of a consolidated group filing a consolidated return or returns and not treated as a division or a disregarded entity for tax
purposes of another taxpayer, and pay any U.S. federal and material state and local taxes required to be paid by it under applicable
law, except as otherwise expressly provided in the Transaction Documents;
(v)
(A) conduct its affairs in its own name and in accordance with its Charter Documents and observe all necessary, appropriate and customary
limited liability company or corporate formalities (as applicable), including, but not limited to, holding all regular and special meetings
appropriate to authorize all of its actions, keeping separate and accurate minutes of its meetings, passing all resolutions or consents
necessary to authorize actions taken or to be taken, and maintaining accurate and separate books, records and accounts, including, but
not limited to, payroll and intercompany transaction accounts, (B) hold all of the its assets in its own name and in such a manner that
it will not be costly or difficult to segregate, ascertain or identify its assets from those of any other Affiliate or any other Person
and (C) be, and at all times hold itself out to the public as, a legal entity separate and distinct from any other Person and, to the
extent known by it, correct any misunderstanding regarding its separate identity;
(vi)
(A) not assume or guarantee any of the liabilities of any other Person, become obligated for the debts of any other Person or hold out
its credit as being available to pay the obligations of any other Person (other than the other Securitization Entities), (B) remain solvent
and pay its debts and liabilities from its assets as the same become due, and (C) except as arising under or expressly permitted by the
Transaction Documents, not incur, create or assume any Indebtedness and not make any loans or advances to, or pledge its assets for the
benefit of, any other Person or entity;
(vii)
take, or refrain from taking, as the case may be, all other actions that are necessary to be taken or not to be taken in order to (A)
ensure that the assumptions and factual recitations set forth in the Specified Bankruptcy Opinion Provisions remain true and correct
in all material respects with respect to it and (B) comply in all material respects with those procedures described in such provisions
which are applicable to it;
(viii)
maintain at least one Independent Manager or Independent Director, as applicable, on its board of managers or its board of directors,
as the case may be;
(ix)
to the fullest extent permitted by law, so long as any Obligation remains outstanding, remove any Independent Manager or Independent
Director only for Cause and only after providing the Trustee and the Control Party (with a copy to the Back-Up Manager) with no less
than five (5) days’ prior written notice of (A) any proposed removal of such Independent Manager or Independent Director, as applicable,
and (B) the identity of the proposed replacement Independent Manager or Independent Director, as applicable, together with a certification
that such replacement satisfies the requirements for an Independent Manager or an Independent Director set forth in the Charter Documents
of the applicable Securitization Entity; and
(x)
(A) provide, or cause the Manager to provide, to the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party, a copy of the executed agreement
with respect to the appointment of any replacement Independent Director or Independent Manager, as the case may be, and (B) provide,
or cause the Manager to provide, to the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party, written notice of the identity and contact
information for each Independent Director or Independent Manager, as applicable, on an annual basis and at any time such information
changes.
(b)
The Issuer, on behalf of itself and each of the other Securitization Entities, confirms that the statements relating to the Issuer and/or
any other Securitization Entity referenced in the opinion of Katten Muchin Rosenman LLP regarding substantive consolidation matters delivered
to the Trustee on the most recent Series Closing Date are true and correct with respect to itself and each other Securitization Entity,
and that the Issuer will, and will cause each other Securitization Entity to, comply with any covenants or obligations assumed to be
complied with by it therein as if such covenants and obligations were set forth herein.
Section
8.25 Covenants Regarding the Securitization IP.
(a)
The Issuer will not, nor will it permit any other Securitization Entity to, take or omit to take any action with respect to the maintenance,
enforcement and defense of any Guarantor’s rights in and to the Securitization IP that would constitute a breach by the Manager
of the Management Agreement if such action were taken or omitted by the Manager on behalf of any Securitization Entity.
(b)
The Issuer will notify the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party in writing within ten (10) Business Days of the Issuer’s
first knowing or having reason to know that any application or registration relating to any material Securitization IP (now or hereafter
existing) may become abandoned or dedicated to the public domain, or of any material adverse determination or development (including
the institution of, or any such determination or development in, any proceeding in the PTO, the United States Copyright Office, similar
offices or agencies in any foreign countries in which the Securitization IP is located, or any court, but excluding office actions in
the course of prosecution and any non-final determinations (other than in an adversarial proceeding) of the PTO or any similar office
or agency in any such foreign country) regarding the validity or any Securitization Entity’s ownership of any material Securitization
IP, its right to register the same, or to keep and maintain the same.
(c)
With respect to the Securitization IP, each Guarantor, to the extent it has not already done so, agrees to, and the Issuer agrees to
cause each Guarantor to, execute, deliver and file (within ten (10) Business Days of the Closing Date as to the PTO) instruments substantially
in the form of Exhibit I-1 hereto with respect to Trademarks, Exhibit I-2 hereto with respect to Patents and Exhibit I-3 hereto with
respect to Copyrights or otherwise in form and substance satisfactory to the Control Party, and any other instruments or documents as
may be reasonably necessary or, in the Control Party’s opinion, desirable to perfect or protect the Trustee’s security interest
granted under this Base Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement in the Patents and Trademarks included in the Securitization
IP in the United States.
(d)
[Reserved].
(e)
If the Issuer or any Guarantor, either itself or through any agent, licensee or designee, files or otherwise acquires an application
for the registration of any Patent, Trademark or Copyright with the PTO, the United States Copyright Office or any similar office or
agency in any foreign country in which Securitization IP is located, the Issuer or such Guarantor in a reasonable time after such filing
(and in any event within ninety (90) days) (i) shall give the Trustee and the Control Party written notice thereof and (ii) solely with
respect to such applications filed in the United States, upon reasonable request of the Control Party, shall execute and deliver all
instruments and documents, and take all further action, that the Control Party may so reasonably request in order to continue, perfect
or protect the security interest granted hereunder or under the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement in the United States, including, without
limitation, executing and delivering (x) the Supplemental Notice of Grant of Security Interest in Trademarks substantially in the form
attached as Exhibit J-1 hereto, (y) the Supplemental Notice of Grant of Security Interest in Patents substantially in the form
attached as Exhibit J-2 hereto and/or (z) the Supplemental Notice of Grant of Security Interest in Copyrights substantially in
the form attached as Exhibit J-3 hereto, as applicable.
(f)
In the event that any material Securitization IP is infringed upon, misappropriated or diluted by a third party in a manner that would
reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, the Issuer and the Manager upon becoming aware of such infringement, misappropriation
or dilution shall promptly notify the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party in writing. The Issuer, or the Manager on behalf
of the Issuer, shall cause the applicable Guarantor or Additional IP Holder to take all reasonable and appropriate actions, at its expense,
to protect or enforce such Securitization IP, including, if reasonable, suing for infringement, misappropriation or dilution and seeking
an injunction (including, if appropriate, temporary and/or preliminary injunctive relief) against such infringement, misappropriation
or dilution, unless the failure to take such actions on behalf of the applicable Guarantor or Additional IP Holder by the Manager would
not constitute a breach by the Manager of the Management Agreement; provided that if the applicable Guarantor or Additional IP
Holder decides not to take any action with respect to an infringement, misappropriation or dilution that would reasonably be expected
to have a Material Adverse Effect, the Issuer shall deliver written notice to the Trustee, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager and the Control
Party setting forth in reasonable detail the basis for its decision not to act, and none of the Manager, the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager
or the Control Party will be required to take any actions on its behalf to protect or enforce the Securitization IP against such infringement,
misappropriation or dilution; provided, further, that the Manager will be required to act if failure to do so would constitute
a breach of the Managing Standard.
(g)
With respect to licenses of third-party Intellectual Property entered into after the Closing Date by the Securitization Entities (including,
for the avoidance of doubt, to the Manager acting on behalf of the Securitization Entities, as applicable), the Securitization Entities
(or the Manager on their behalf) shall use commercially reasonable efforts to include terms permitting the grant by the Securitization
Entities of a security interest therein to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties and to allow the Manager (and any Successor
Manager and the Interim Successor Manager) the right to use such Intellectual Property in the performance of its duties under the Management
Agreement.
Section
8.26 Investment Company Act.
The
Issuer shall take or omit to take action as necessary in order for the Issuer to remain excluded from the definition of “investment
company” set forth in section 3(a)(1)(C) of the 1940 Act, as such section may be amended from time to time.
Section
8.27 Real Property
The
Issuer shall not and shall not permit any other Securitization Entity to, enter into any lease of real property (other than or in connection
with any Permitted Asset Disposition, Franchised Restaurant Lease, New Franchised Restaurant Lease, Prospective Company Restaurant Property
or Company Restaurant Build-Out). The Issuer shall not, or shall not permit any other Securitization Entity to, acquire any fee interest
in real property (other than any fee interest in real property acquired by any Guarantor).
Section
8.28 No Employees.
The
Issuer and the other Securitization Entities (other than the Employer Guarantors) shall have no employees.
Section
8.29 Insurance.
The
Securitization Entities maintain, or cause to be maintained, the insurance coverages in such amounts and covering such risks as is adequate
for the conduct of their respective businesses and the value of their respective properties and as is customary for companies engaged
in similar businesses in similar industries. All such policies of insurance of the Securitization Entities are in full force and effect
and the Securitization Entities are in compliance with the terms of such policies in all material respects. None of the Securitization
Entities has reason to believe that it will not be able to renew its existing insurance coverage, in all material respects, as and when
such coverage expires or to obtain similar coverage, in all material respects, from similar insurers as may be necessary to continue
its business at a cost that would not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect. The Issuer shall cause the Manager to
have each Securitization Entity named as an insured or listed as an “additional insured” or “loss payee,” as
may apply, on any insurance maintained by the Manager for the benefit of such Securitization Entity pursuant to the Management Agreement.
Section
8.30 Litigation.
If
Twin Hospitality is not then subject to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act, the Issuer shall, on each Quarterly Payment Date, provide
a written report to the Control Party, the Manager and the Back-Up Manager that sets forth all outstanding litigation, arbitration or
other proceedings against any Twin Hospitality TP Entity that would have been required to be disclosed in Twin Hospitality’s annual
reports, quarterly reports and other public filings which Twin Hospitality would have been required to file with the Securities and Exchange
Commission pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act if Twin Hospitality were subject to such Sections.
Section
8.31 Environmental.
The
Issuer shall, and shall cause each other Securitization Entity to, promptly notify the Control Party, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager
and the Trustee, in writing, upon receipt of any written notice pursuant to which any Securitization Entity becomes aware from any source
(including but not limited to a governmental entity) of any possible material liability of any Securitization Entity pursuant to any
Environmental Law that could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect. In addition, other than exceptions to any of the
following that could not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect, the Issuer
shall, and shall cause each other Securitization Entity to:
(a)
(i) comply with all applicable Environmental Laws, (ii) hold all Environmental Permits (each of which is in full force and effect) required
for any of their current operations or for any property owned, leased, or otherwise operated by any of them and obtain all Environmental
Permits for any intended operations when such Environmental Permits are required and (iii) comply with all of their Environmental Permits;
and
(b)
undertake all investigative and remedial action required by Environmental Laws with respect to any Materials of Environmental Concern
present at, on, under, in, or about any Real Estate Assets or New Real Estate Assets owned, leased or operated by the Issuer or any Securitization
Entity, or at any other location (including, without limitation, any location to which Materials of Environmental Concern have been sent
for re-use or recycling or for treatment, storage or disposal) which could reasonably be expected to (i) give rise to liability of the
Issuer or any Securitization Entity under any applicable Environmental Law or otherwise result in costs to the Issuer or any Securitization
Entity, (ii) interfere with the Issuer’s or any Securitization Entity’s continued operations or (iii) impair the fair saleable
value of any Real Estate Assets or New Real Estate Assets owned by the Issuer or any Securitization Entity.
Section
8.32 Enhancements.
No
Enhancement shall be provided in respect of any Series of Notes, nor will any Enhancement Provider have any rights hereunder, as third-party
beneficiary or otherwise, unless the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) has provided its
prior written consent to such Enhancement, such consent not to be unreasonably withheld.
Section
8.33 Derivatives.
Without
the prior written consent of the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), the Issuer will not,
nor will it permit any other Securitization Entity to, enter into any derivative contract, swap, option, hedging contract, forward purchase
contract or other similar agreement or instrument (other than forward purchase agreements entered into with third-party vendors on behalf
of the Securitization Entities in the ordinary course of business), if any such contract, agreement or instrument requires the Issuer
to expend any financial resources to satisfy any payment obligations owed in connection therewith.
Section
8.34 Additional Guarantor.
(a)
The Issuer, in accordance with and as permitted under the Transaction Documents, may purchase, acquire, form or cause to be formed one
or more Additional Guarantors without the consent of the Control Party; provided that any such Additional Guarantor has adopted,
or substantially contemporaneously with the closing of an applicable transaction pursuant to which such Additional Guarantor is purchased,
acquired or otherwise designated as an Additional Guarantor hereunder, will adopt, Charter Documents substantially similar to the Charter
Documents of the existing Franchise Entities; provided, further, that such Additional Guarantor holds Guarantor Assets, Product
Sourcing Assets, New Real Estate Assets or Securitization IP or is being established, purchased or acquired in order to act as a franchisor
with respect to New Franchise Agreements.
(b)
If the Issuer desires to create, incorporate, form or otherwise organize an Additional Guarantor that does not comply with the provisos
set forth in clause (a) above, the Issuer shall first obtain the prior written consent of the Control Party (acting at the direction
of the Controlling Class Representative), such consent not to be unreasonably withheld.
(c)
In connection with the organization of any Additional Guarantor in conjunction with clause (a) or (b) above, the Issuer shall, if such
Additional Guarantor owns Securitization IP, designate such Additional Guarantor as an Additional IP Holder.
(d)
The Issuer shall cause each Additional Guarantor to promptly execute an assumption agreement in form set forth as Exhibit A to the Guarantee
and Collateral Agreement (the “Assumption Agreement”) pursuant to which such Additional Guarantor shall become jointly
and severally obligated under the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement with the other Guarantors.
(e)
Upon the execution and delivery of an Assumption Agreement as required in clause (d) above, any Additional Guarantor party thereto will
become a party to the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement with the same force and effect as if originally named therein as a Guarantor
and, without limiting the generality of the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, will assume all Obligations and liabilities of a Guarantor
thereunder.
(f)
The Control Party will have the right to direct that After-Acquired Securitization IP in the nature of a Trademark be held by one or
more newly formed Additional IP Holders if the Control Party reasonably believes that such After-Acquired Securitization IP could impair
the Collateral if it were held by an existing Guarantor and that separating the ownership of such After-Acquired Securitization IP from
the rest of the Securitization IP will not impair the enforceability of the Securitization IP. In making any determination with respect
to such After-Acquired Securitization IP, the Control Party will have the right to consult with third-party experts.
Section
8.35 Guarantor Distributions.
The
Issuer shall, and shall cause the Manager to, cause each Guarantor to deposit all Guarantor Collections into the Concentration Account
within one Business Day after receipt (or calculation, in the case of Monthly Fiscal Period Company Restaurant Profits True-up Amounts
and Monthly Fiscal Period Estimated Company Restaurant Profits Amounts) as a distribution by such Guarantor to the Issuer.
Section
8.36 Tax Lien Reserve Amount.
Upon
receipt of any Tax Lien Reserve Amount by any Securitization Entity, such recipient will distribute such Tax Lien Reserve Amount to the
Issuer and the Issuer shall remit such Tax Lien Reserve Amount to the Tax Lien Reserve Account after providing prior written notice to
the Trustee of such remittance (including, without limitation, the amount that will be remitted); provided that the Trustee will
not release such Tax Lien Reserve Amount from the Tax Lien Reserve Account unless: (a) the Control Party (acting at the direction of
the Controlling Class Representative) instructs the Trustee in writing to withdraw and pay all of such Tax Lien Reserve Amount in accordance
with the written instructions of the Issuer (or the Manager on its behalf) upon receipt by the Trustee, the Control Party, the Manager,
the Back-Up Manager and the Controlling Class Representative of evidence reasonably satisfactory to the Control Party that the Lien for
which such Tax Lien Reserve Amount was established has been released by the IRS; (b) the Issuer, or the Manager on behalf of the Issuer,
delivers written instructions to the Trustee to withdraw and pay all or a portion of such Tax Lien Reserve Amount to the IRS on behalf
of the Twin Hospitality TP Entities; provided that the Issuer shall deliver, or cause to be delivered, prior written notice of
any such written instruction to the Control Party; or (c) the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)
instructs the Trustee in writing to withdraw and pay all or a portion of such Tax Lien Reserve Amount to the IRS (i) upon the occurrence
and during the continuation of an Event of Default or (ii) upon receipt of written notice by any Securitization Entity stating that the
IRS intends to execute on the Lien for which such Tax Lien Reserve Amount was established in respect of any assets of any Securitization
Entity; provided that the Issuer shall deliver a copy of any such written instruction to Twin Hospitality. Any distributions from
the Tax Lien Reserve Account shall be made on the Business Day following receipt by Trustee of instructions set forth in clauses (a),
(b) or (c) above, and Trustee shall be entitled to rely on any such instructions delivered to it.
Section
8.37 Bankruptcy Proceedings.
The
Issuer shall, and shall cause each other Securitization Entity to, promptly object to the institution of any bankruptcy proceeding against
it and take all necessary or advisable steps to cause the dismissal of any such proceeding (including, without limiting the generality
of the foregoing, to timely file an answer and any other appropriate pleading objecting to (i) the institution of any proceeding to have
any Securitization Entity, as the case may be, adjudicated as bankrupt or Insolvent or (ii) the filing of any petition seeking relief,
reorganization, arrangement, adjustment or composition or in respect of any Securitization Entity, as the case may be, under applicable
bankruptcy law or any other applicable Requirements of Law).
Section
8.38 Mortgages.
Each
Guarantor shall, within ninety (90) days following the occurrence of a Mortgage Preparation Event with respect to any Owned Real Property
and New Owned Real Property acquired by such Guarantor, execute and deliver to the Control Party (with a copy to the Trustee), for the
benefit of the Secured Parties, a mortgage or deed of trust in form reasonably acceptable to the Issuer, the Control Party and the Trustee
and suitable for recordation under applicable law with respect to each such Owned Real Property and New Owned Real Property, to be held
in escrow by the Control Party or its agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties and recorded by the Control Party or its agent solely
upon the occurrence of a Mortgage Recordation Event (subject to Section 3.1(c) hereof); provided and notwithstanding any other
provision of this Agreement, that any Prospective Company Restaurant Properties or Company Restaurant Build-Outs valued at less than
or equal to $5,000,000 per property will not be subject to such requirements in this Section 8.38 (for the avoidance of doubt,
such requirements shall apply to any Prospective Company Restaurant Properties or Company Restaurant Build-Outs valued at more than $5,000,000
per property). The Control Party within five (5) Business Days of receiving direction of the Controlling Class Representative will be
required to deliver the Mortgages to the applicable recording office for recordation in the event that any Rapid Amortization Event occurs
(or is continuing) on or following the 120th day following the occurrence of a Mortgage Preparation Event, unless such Mortgage Recordation
Event is waived by the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative). The Control Party may engage a third-party
service provider (which shall be reasonably acceptable to the Control Party) to assist in delivering the Mortgages to the applicable
Governmental Authority with respect to such Mortgage for recordation. In addition, within twenty (20) Business Days of a Mortgage Recordation
Event (or such additional time as my be required if the Guarantors are pursuing such items with commercially reasonable efforts), the
Guarantors shall exercise commercially reasonable efforts to deliver to the Control Party and the Trustee (i) updates to the Closing
Title Reports, (ii) lender’s Title Policies for those properties for which Closing Title Reports were previously obtained, and
(iii) local counsel enforceability opinions with respect to the Mortgages delivered on properties in those states where a material amount
of Owned Real Property and New Owned Real Property is located, as reasonably determined by the Securitization Entities. The Control Party
shall be reimbursed by the Issuer for any and all reasonable costs and expenses in connection with such Mortgage Recordation Event, including
all Mortgage Recordation Fees, all premiums, fees and all other costs (including reasonable attorney’s fees) incurred in connection
with delivery of the Title Policies and all fees and costs incurred in connection with local counsel enforceability opinions, pursuant
to and in accordance with the Priority of Payments. For the avoidance of doubt, the Guarantors shall not be required to, and the Control
Party may not, record or cause to be recorded any Mortgage or cause the issuance of any Title Policy or local counsel enforceability
opinion until the occurrence of a Mortgage Recordation Event. Neither the Trustee nor any custodian on behalf of the Trustee shall be
under any duty or obligation to inspect, review or examine any such Mortgages or to determine that the same are valid, binding, legally
effective, properly endorsed, genuine, enforceable or appropriate for the represented purpose or that they are in recordable form. Neither
the Trustee nor any agent on its behalf shall in any way be liable for any delays in the recordation of any Mortgage, for the rejection
of a Mortgage by any recording office or for the failure of any Mortgage to create in favor of the Trustee, for the benefit of the Secured
Parties, legal, valid and enforceable first priority Liens on, and security interests in, the Guarantors’ right, title and interest
in and to each Owned Real Property and New Owned Real Property, and the Proceeds thereof. Upon the request of the applicable Guarantor,
and at the direction of the Manager, the Trustee shall execute and deliver a release of mortgage to be held in escrow pending a closing
of a sale of any Owned Real Property or New Owned Real Property; provided that if such closing shall not occur, such release of
mortgage shall be returned by the escrow agent directly to the Trustee.
Article
IX
REMEDIES
Section
9.1 Rapid Amortization Events.
The
Notes will be subject to rapid amortization in whole and not in part following the occurrence of any of the following events as declared
by the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) by written notice to the Issuer (with a copy to
the Manager, the Back-Up Manager and the Trustee) (each, a “Rapid Amortization Event”); provided, that a Rapid
Amortization Event described in clause (f) will occur automatically without any declaration thereof by the Control Party unless
the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) and each Noteholder of the applicable Notes that
have not been repaid or refinanced in full on or prior to the applicable Series Anticipated Repayment Date have agreed to waive such
event in accordance with Section 9.7:
(a)
the failure to maintain a P&I DSCR greater than 1.20x as calculated on any Quarterly Calculation Date;
(b)
the occurrence of a Manager Termination Event;
(c)
the occurrence of an Event of Default;
(d)
Twin Hospitality TP Systemwide Sales as calculated on any Quarterly Calculation Date are less than $450,000,000; provided, that
such threshold may be increased or decreased at the request of the Issuer subject to approval by the Control Party (acting at the direction
of the Controlling Class Representative);
(e)
the Senior Leverage Ratio is greater than 7.00x as calculated on any Quarterly Calculation Date;
(f)
the occurrence of a Series Anticipated Repayment Date; or
(g)
the Controlling Class Representative determines that any of the Issuer, the Manager or FAT Brands has failed to perform or comply in
any material respect with any of its obligations under the Side Letter.
Upon
the occurrence of a Rapid Amortization Event, the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) will
deliver, to the applicable recording office for recordation, any Mortgage granted by a Securitization Party and held in escrow by the
Control Party for the benefit of the Secured Parties, unless such requirement to record is waived by the Control Party, acting at the
direction of the Controlling Class Representative.
Section
9.2 Events of Default.
If
any one of the following events shall occur (each an “Event of Default”):
(a)
the Issuer defaults in the payment of interest on any Series of Notes Outstanding when the same becomes due and payable and such default
continues for two (2) Business Days (or in the case of a failure to pay such interest when due resulting solely from an administrative
error or omission by the Trustee, such failure continues for a period of two (2) Business Days after the earlier of the date on which
the Trustee receives written notice or an Authorized Officer of the Trustee has Actual Knowledge of such administrative error or omission);
provided, that failure to pay any interest on any Series of Notes (including, but not limited to, the Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest and Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest) other than on the Series Legal Final Maturity Date will not
be an Event of Default;
(b)
the Issuer (i) defaults in the payment of any principal of any Series of Notes on a Series Legal Final Maturity Date for such Series
of Notes or as and when due in connection with any mandatory or optional prepayment (including any failure to make a payment required
in accordance with Section 5.10 for a Cash Flow Sweeping Event) or (ii) fails to make any other principal payments due from funds
available in the Collection Account in accordance with the Priority of Payments on any Monthly Allocation Date; provided that
in the case of a failure to pay principal under either clause (i) or (ii) resulting solely from an administrative error
or omission by the Trustee, such failure continues for a period of two (2) Business Days after the earlier of the date on which the Trustee
receives written notice or an Authorized Officer of the Trustee has Actual Knowledge of such administrative error or omission; provided,
further, that the failure to pay any prepayment premium on any prepayment of principal made during any Rapid Amortization Period
occurring prior to the related Series Anticipated Repayment Date will not be an Event of Default;
(c)
any Securitization Entity fails to perform or comply in any material respect with any of the covenants (other than those covered by clause
(a) or clause (b) above) (including any covenant to pay any amount other than interest on or principal of the Notes when due
in accordance with the Priority of Payments), or any of its representations or warranties contained in any Transaction Document to which
it is a party proves to be incorrect in any material respect as of the date made or deemed to be made, and such default, failure or breach
continues for a period of thirty (30) consecutive days or, in the case of a failure to comply with any of the agreements, covenants or
provisions of the IP License Agreements, such longer cure period as may be permitted under the IP License Agreements (or, solely with
respect to a failure to comply with (i) any obligation to deliver a notice, financial statement, report or other communication within
the specified time frame set forth in the applicable Transaction Document, such failure continues for a period of five (5) consecutive
Business Days after the specified time frame for delivery has elapsed or (ii) Sections 8.7, 8.12, 8.13, 8.14,
8.15, 8.17, 8.18, 8.19, 8.20, 8.21, 8.22, 8.23, 8.24, 8.25, 8.27
and 8.28, such failure continues for a period of ten (10) consecutive Business Days), in each case, following the earlier
to occur of the Actual Knowledge of such Securitization Entity of such breach or failure and the default caused thereby or written notice
to such Securitization Entity by the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager or the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class
Representative) of such default, breach or failure; provided, that no Event of Default shall occur pursuant to this clause (c) if, with
respect to any such representation deemed to have been false in any material respect when made which can be remedied by making a payment
of an Indemnification Amount, (i) the Manager has paid the required Indemnification Amount in accordance with the terms of the Transaction
Documents and (ii) such Indemnification Amount has been deposited into the Collection Account;
(d)
the occurrence of an Event of Bankruptcy with respect to any Securitization Entity;
(e)
the Interest-Only DSCR as calculated as of any Quarterly Calculation Date is less than or equal to 1.10x;
(f)
the SEC or other regulatory body having jurisdiction reaches a final determination that any Securitization Entity is required to register
as an “investment company” under the 1940 Act or is under the “control” of a Person that is required to register
as an “investment company” under the 1940 Act;
(g)
any of the Transaction Documents or any material portion thereof ceases to be in full force and effect or enforceable in accordance with
its terms (other than in accordance with the express termination provisions thereof) or any Securitization Entity or Non-Securitization
Entity so asserts in writing;
(h)
the Trustee ceases to have for any reason a valid and perfected first priority security interest in the Collateral (subject to Permitted
Liens) in which perfection can be achieved under the UCC or other applicable Requirements of Law in the United States to the extent required
by the Transaction Documents or the Issuer or any Affiliate thereof so asserts in writing;
(i)
any Securitization Entity fails to perform or comply with any material provision of its organizational documents or any provision of
Section 8.24 relating to legal separateness of the Securitization Entities, which failure is reasonably likely to cause the contribution
of the Collateral to such Securitization Entity pursuant to the related Contribution Agreement to fail to constitute a “true contribution”
or other absolute transfer of such Collateral pursuant to the related Contribution Agreement or is reasonably likely to cause a court
of competent jurisdiction to disregard the separate existence of such Securitization Entity relative to any Person other than another
Securitization Entity and, in each case, such failure continues for more than thirty (30) consecutive days following the earlier to occur
of the Actual Knowledge of such Securitization Entity or written notice to such Securitization Entity from the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager
or the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) of such failure;
(j)
a final non-appealable ruling has been made by a court of competent jurisdiction that the contribution of the Collateral (other than
any immaterial portion of the Collateral and any Collateral that has been disposed of to the extent permitted or required under the Transaction
Documents) pursuant to the related Contribution Agreement does not constitute a “true contribution” or other absolute transfer
of such Collateral pursuant to such agreement;
(k)
an outstanding final non-appealable judgment for an amount exceeding $2,000,000 (when aggregated with the amount of all other outstanding
final non-appealable judgments) (to the extent not covered by independent third-party insurance as to which the insurer is rated at least
“A” by A.M. Best Company, has been notified of the potential claim and does not dispute coverage) is rendered against any
Securitization Entity, and either (i) enforcement proceedings are commenced by any creditor upon such judgment or order or (ii) there
is any period of thirty (30) consecutive days during which such judgment remains unsatisfied or a stay of enforcement of such judgment
or order, by reason of a pending appeal or otherwise, will not be in effect;
(l)
the failure of (i) the Manager to own, directly or indirectly, 100% of the Equity Interests of the Issuer; or (ii) the Issuer to own,
directly or indirectly, 100% of the Equity Interests of each Guarantor; provided, the 3% contractual profits interest from operations
of Twin Restaurant Burleson, LLC payable to FAT Brands Development 3, LLC pursuant to the Profits Interest Agreement, dated as of the
Closing Date, between Twin Restaurant Burleson, LLC and FAT Brands Development 3, LLC and the 3% contractual profits interest from operations
of Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie Beverage Holding, LLC payable to FAT Brands Development 5, LLC pursuant to the Profits Interest Agreement,
dated as of the Closing Date, between Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie, LLC and FAT Brands Development 5, LLC shall not be considered to
be in violation of either of the foregoing clauses (i) or (ii);
(m)
other than as permitted under the Indenture or the other Transaction Documents, the Guarantors and any Additional IP Holders collectively
fail to have good title to any material portion of the Securitization IP or the Issuer shall fail to have good title in or to any material
portion of the Collateral;
(n)
the IRS files notice of a lien pursuant to Section 6323 of the Code with regard to the assets of any Securitization Entity and such lien
has not been released within sixty (60) days, unless (i) Twin Hospitality or a Subsidiary thereof has provided evidence that payment
to satisfy the full amount of the asserted liability has been provided to the IRS, and the IRS has released such asserted lien within
sixty (60) days of such payment, or (ii) such lien or the asserted liability is being contested in good faith and Twin Hospitality has
contributed to the Securitization Entities funds in the amount necessary to satisfy the asserted liability (the “Tax Lien Reserve
Amount”), which such funds are set aside and remitted to a collateral deposit account as provided in Section 8.36;
(o)
following the completion of a Qualified Equity Offering, the Issuer has not received 75% of any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds in
the Collection Account within four (4) Business Days of the Manager’s receipt, until (i) an aggregate amount of Qualified Equity
Offering Proceeds equal to $75,000,000 has been deposited and (ii) an aggregate amount of Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds equal to
$25,000,000 has been made available to the Manager as working capital;
(p)
if either the Back-Up Manager or Control Party is terminated or resigns and is not replaced in accordance with the time periods set forth
in the applicable Transaction Documents;
(q)
(i) any Securitization Entity engages in any non-exempt “prohibited transaction” (as defined in Section 406 of ERISA or Section
4975 of the Code) involving any Pension Plan, (ii) any failure to meet the “minimum funding standard” (as defined in Section
302 of ERISA), whether or not waived, exists with respect to any Pension Plan and is not discharged within thirty (30) days thereafter,
(iii) any Lien in an amount equal to at least $1,000,000 in favor of the PBGC or a Pension Plan arises on the assets of any Securitization
Entity and is not discharged within thirty (30) days thereafter, (iv) a Reportable Event occurs with respect to, or proceedings are commenced
in writing (pursuant to Section 4042 of ERISA) to have a trustee appointed, or a trustee is appointed, to administer or to terminate,
any Pension Plan, which Reportable Event or commencement of proceedings in writing or appointment of a trustee would reasonably be expected
to result in the termination of such Pension Plan for purposes of Title IV of ERISA, (v) any Pension Plan terminates (pursuant to Section
4041(c) of ERISA), or (vi) any Securitization Entity incurs any liability in connection with a complete or partial withdrawal from, or
the insolvency (pursuant to Section 4245 of ERISA) or termination (pursuant to Section 4041A of ERISA) of, a Multiemployer Plan; and
in each case in clauses (i) through (vi) above, such event or condition, together with all other such events or conditions, if any, would
reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect on any Securitization Entity;
(r)
a final non-appealable non-monetary judgment has been made by a court of competent jurisdiction that materially impairs (i) the Securitization
Entities’ ability to conduct their business as of such date, taken as a whole, or (ii) the exercise of the Securitization Entities’
or of the Trustee’s rights with respect to the Collateral;
(s)
an Advance Period has continued for ninety (90) or more consecutive days; or
(t)
the failure to repay the Notes in connection with any change of control in accordance with the Side Letter;
then
(i) in the case of any event described in each clause above (except for clause (d) thereof) that is continuing the Trustee, at
the direction of the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) and on behalf of the Noteholders,
by written notice to the Issuer (unless no written notice is required under this Indenture), will accelerate and declare the Outstanding
Principal Amount of all Series of Notes Outstanding to be immediately due and payable, and upon any such declaration, such Outstanding
Principal Amount, together with accrued and unpaid interest thereon through the date of acceleration, and all other amounts due to the
Noteholders and the other Secured Parties under the Transaction Documents shall become immediately due and payable or (ii) in the case
of any event described in clause (d) above that has occurred and is continuing, the Outstanding Principal Amount of all Series
of Notes Outstanding, together with interest accrued but unpaid thereon through the date of acceleration, and all other amounts due to
the Noteholders and the other Secured Parties under the Indenture, shall immediately and without further act accelerate and become due
and payable.
If
any Securitization Entity obtains Actual Knowledge that a Default or an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, such Securitization
Entity shall promptly notify the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party. Promptly following the Trustee’s receipt of
written notice hereunder of any Event of Default, the Trustee shall send a copy thereof to the Issuer, the Control Party, the Controlling
Class Representative, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager, each Noteholder and each other Secured Party.
At
any time after such a declaration of acceleration with respect to the Notes has been made and before a judgment or decree for payment
of the money due has been obtained by the Trustee, as hereinafter provided in this Article IX, the Control Party (acting at the
direction of the Controlling Class Representative), by written notice to the Issuer and to the Trustee, may rescind and annul such declaration
and its consequences, if (i) the Issuer has paid or deposited with the Trustee a sum sufficient to pay (a) all overdue installments of
interest and principal on the Notes (excluding principal amounts due solely as a result of the acceleration), and (b) all unpaid taxes,
administrative expenses and other sums paid by the Trustee or paid by the Control Party under the Transaction Documents and the reasonable
compensation, expenses and disbursements of the Trustee and the Control Party, their respective agents and counsel, as applicable, and
any unreimbursed Manager Advances, fees and expenses due and payable to the Control Party and any fees, expenses and other amounts due
and payable to the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the Controlling Class Representative and (ii) all existing Events of Default, other
than the non-payment of the principal of the Notes which has become due solely by such declaration of acceleration, have been cured or
waived as provided in Section 9.7. No such rescission shall affect any subsequent default or impair any right consequent thereon.
Any Default or Event of Default described in clause (d) above will not be subject to waiver without the consent of the Control
Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) and each Noteholder. Any other Default or Event of Default may
be waived by the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) by notice to the Trustee.
Section
9.3 Rights of the Control Party and Trustee upon Event of Default.
(a)
Payment of Principal and Interest. The Issuer covenants that if (i) default is made in the payment of any interest on any Series
of Notes Outstanding when the same becomes due and payable, (ii) the Notes are accelerated following the occurrence of an Event of Default
or (iii) default is made in the payment of the principal of, or premium, if any, on any Series of Notes Outstanding when due and payable,
the Issuer will, upon demand by the Trustee (and, in the case of any default that is made in the payment of any interest on any Series
of Notes Outstanding when the same becomes due and payable (other than on the Series Legal Final Maturity Date or on any other date on
which the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes of such Series is required to be paid in full), to the extent of funds available)
at the direction of the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), pay to the Trustee, for the
benefit of the Noteholders, the whole amount then due and payable on the Notes for principal, premium, if any, and interest, and, to
the extent payment at such rate of interest shall be legally enforceable, upon overdue installments of interest, at the applicable Note
Rate and any default rate, as applicable, and in addition thereto such further amount as shall be sufficient to cover costs and expenses
of collection, including the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee and its agents and counsel.
(b)
Proceedings To Collect Money. In case the Issuer shall fail forthwith to pay such amounts upon such demand, the Trustee at the
direction of the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), in its own name and as trustee of an
express trust, may institute a Proceeding for the collection of the sums so due and unpaid, and may prosecute such Proceeding to judgment
or final decree, and may enforce the same against the Issuer and collect in the manner provided by law out of the property of the Issuer,
wherever situated, the moneys adjudged or decreed to be payable.
(c)
Other Proceedings. If and whenever an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Trustee, at the direction of
the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) shall be entitled to take one or more of the following
actions:
(i)
proceed to protect and enforce its rights and the rights of the Noteholders and the other Secured Parties, by such appropriate Proceedings
as the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) shall deem most effective to protect and enforce
any such rights, whether for the specific enforcement of any covenant or agreement in the Indenture or any other Transaction Document
or in aid of the exercise of any power granted therein, or to enforce any other proper remedy or legal or equitable right vested in the
Trustee by the Indenture or any other Transaction Document or by law, including any remedies of a secured party under applicable Requirements
of Law;
(ii)
(A) direct the Issuer to exercise (and the Issuer agrees to exercise) all rights, remedies, powers, privileges and claims of the Issuer
against any party to any Collateral Document arising as a result of the occurrence of such Event of Default or otherwise, including the
right or power to take any action to compel performance or observance by any such party of its obligations to the Issuer, and any right
of the Issuer to take such action independent of such direction shall be suspended, and (B) if (x) the Issuer shall have failed, within
ten (10) Business Days of receiving the direction of the Trustee (given at the direction of the Control Party (acting at the direction
of the Controlling Class Representative)), to take commercially reasonable action to accomplish such directions of the Trustee, (y) the
Issuer refuses to take such action or (z) the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) reasonably
determines that such action must be taken immediately, take (or the Control Party on behalf of the Trustee shall take) such previously
directed action (and any related action as permitted under the Indenture thereafter determined by the Trustee or the Control Party to
be appropriate without the need under this provision or any other provision under the Indenture to direct the Issuer to take such action);
(iii)
institute Proceedings from time to time for the complete or partial foreclosure of the Indenture or, to the extent applicable, any other
Transaction Document, with respect to the Collateral; provided that the Trustee will not be required to take title to any real
property in connection with any foreclosure or other exercise of remedies hereunder or under such Transaction Documents and title to
such property will instead be acquired in an entity designated and (unless owned by a third party) controlled by the Control Party; and/or
(iv)
sell all or a portion of the Collateral at one or more public or private sales called and conducted in any manner permitted by law; provided,
however, that the Trustee shall not proceed with any such sale without the prior written consent of the Control Party (acting
at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) and the Trustee will provide notice to the Issuer and each Holder of Senior
Notes, Subordinated Notes and Senior Subordinated Notes of a proposed sale of Collateral.
(d)
Sale of Collateral. In connection with any sale of the Collateral hereunder, under the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement (which
may proceed separately and independently from the exercise of remedies under the Indenture), under any Mortgage or under any judgment,
order or decree in any judicial proceeding for the foreclosure or involving the enforcement of the Indenture, the Guarantee and Collateral
Agreement or any other Transaction Document:
(i)
any of the Trustee, any Noteholder and/or any other Secured Party may bid for and purchase the property being sold, and upon compliance
with the terms of the sale may hold, retain, possess and dispose of such property in its own absolute right without further accountability;
(ii)
the Trustee (acting at the direction of the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)) may make
and deliver to the purchaser or purchasers a good and sufficient deed, bill of sale and instrument of assignment and transfer of the
property sold;
(iii)
all right, title, interest, claim and demand whatsoever, either at law or in equity or otherwise, of any Securitization Entity of, in
and to the property so sold shall be divested; and such sale shall be a perpetual bar both at law and in equity against such Securitization
Entity, its successors and assigns, and against any and all Persons claiming or who may claim the property sold or any part thereof from,
through or under such Securitization Entity or its successors or assigns;
(iv)
the receipt of the Trustee or of the officer thereof making such sale shall be a sufficient discharge to the purchaser or purchasers
at such sale for its or their purchase money, and such purchaser or purchasers, and its or their assigns or personal representatives,
shall not, after paying such purchase money and receiving such receipt of the Trustee or of such officer thereof, be obliged to see to
the application of such purchase money or be in any way answerable for any loss, misapplication or non-application thereof; and
(v)
any amounts obtained by the Trustee or the Control Party on account of or as a result of the exercise by the Trustee or the Control Party
of any of its rights under the Indenture or under the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, other than with respect to amounts owed to
a depository bank or securities intermediary under the related Account Control Agreement, will be held by the Trustee as additional collateral
for the repayment of the Obligations, shall be deposited in the Collection Account and, other than with respect to amounts owed to a
depository bank or securities intermediary under the related Account Control Agreement, shall be applied in the priority set forth in
this Section 5.10 hereof; provided that, unless otherwise provided in the Indenture, with respect to any distribution to any Class
of Notes, such amounts will be distributed sequentially in order of alphabetical (as opposed to alphanumerical) designation and pro
rata among each Class of Notes of the same alphabetical designation based upon the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes of each
such Class.
(e)
Application of Proceeds. Any amounts obtained by the Trustee or the Control Party on account of or as a result of the exercise
by the Trustee or the Control Party of any right hereunder or under the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement shall be held by the Trustee
as additional Collateral for the repayment of the Obligations, shall be deposited into the Collection Account and shall be applied as
provided in the priority set forth in the Priority of Payments; provided, however, that unless otherwise provided in this
Article IX, with respect to any distribution to any Class of Notes, notwithstanding the provisions of Article V, such amounts
shall be distributed sequentially in order of alphabetical (as opposed to alphanumerical) designation and pro rata among each
Class of Notes of the same alphabetical designation based upon the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes of each such Class.
(f)
Additional Remedies. In addition to any rights and remedies now or hereafter granted hereunder or under applicable law with respect
to the Collateral, the Trustee shall have all of the rights and remedies of a secured party under the UCC as enacted in any applicable
jurisdiction.
(g)
Proceedings. The Trustee may maintain a Proceeding even if it does not possess any of the Notes or does not produce any of them
in the Proceeding, and any such Proceeding instituted by the Trustee shall be in its own name as trustee. All remedies are cumulative
to the extent permitted by law.
(h)
Power of Attorney. The Issuer hereby grants to the Trustee an absolute power of attorney to sign, upon the occurrence and during
the continuance of an Event of Default, any document which may be required by the PTO, United States Copyright Office, any similar office
or agency in each foreign country in which any Securitization IP is located, or any other Governmental Authority in order to effect an
absolute assignment of all right, title and interest in or to any Securitization IP, and record the same.
Section
9.4 Waiver of Appraisal, Valuation, Stay and Right to Marshaling.
To
the extent it may lawfully do so, the Issuer for itself and for any Person who may claim through or under it hereby:
(a)
agrees that neither it nor any such Person will step up, plead, claim or in any manner whatsoever take advantage of any appraisal, valuation,
stay, extension or redemption laws, now or hereafter in force in any jurisdiction, which may delay, prevent or otherwise hinder (i) the
performance, enforcement or foreclosure of the Indenture or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, (ii) the sale of any of the Collateral
or (iii) the putting of the purchaser or purchasers thereof into possession of such property immediately after the sale thereof;
(b)
waives all benefit or advantage of any such laws;
(c)
waives and releases all rights to have the Collateral marshaled upon any foreclosure, sale or other enforcement of the Indenture; and
(d)
consents and agrees that, subject to the terms of the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, all the Collateral may at
any such sale be sold by the Trustee as an entirety or in such portions as the Trustee may (upon direction by the Control Party (acting
at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)) determine.
Section
9.5 Limited Recourse.
Notwithstanding
any other provision of the Indenture, the Notes or any other Transaction Document or otherwise, the liability of the Issuer to the Noteholders
and any other Secured Parties under or in relation to the Indenture, the Notes or any other Transaction Document or otherwise, is limited
in recourse to the assets of the Issuer and the Guarantors. The proceeds of such assets having been applied in accordance with the terms
hereof, none of the Noteholders or any other Secured Parties shall be entitled to take any further steps against Issuer to recover any
sums due but still unpaid hereunder, under the Notes or under any of the other agreements or documents described in this Section 9.5,
all claims in respect of which shall be extinguished.
Section
9.6 Optional Preservation of the Collateral.
If
the maturity of the Outstanding Notes of each Series has been accelerated pursuant to Section 9.2 following an Event of Default
and such declaration and its consequences have not been rescinded and annulled, the Trustee, at the direction of the Control Party (acting
at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), subject to the other terms and provisions hereof, shall elect to maintain
possession of such portion, if any, of the Collateral as the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)
shall in its discretion determine.
Section
9.7 Waiver of Past Events.
Prior
to the declaration of the acceleration of the maturity of each Series of Notes Outstanding as provided in Section 9.2 and subject
to Section 13.2, the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) by notice to the Trustee
and the Back-Up Manager, may waive any existing Default or Event of Default described in any clause of Section 9.2 (except clause
(d) thereof) and its consequences; provided, however, that before any waiver may be effective, the Trustee, the Back-Up
Manager and the Control Party must have received any amounts then due to the Control Party, the Back-Up Manager or the Trustee hereunder
or under the Transaction Documents; provided, further, that the Control Party shall provide written notice of any such waiver to the
Issuer. Upon any such waiver, such Default shall cease to exist and any Event of Default arising therefrom shall be deemed to have been
cured for every purpose of the Indenture, but no such waiver shall extend to any subsequent or other Default or impair any right consequent
thereon. A Default or an Event of Default described in Section 9.2(d) shall not be subject to waiver without the consent of the
Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) and each Noteholder. Subject to Section 13.2,
the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), by notice to the Trustee and the Back-Up Manager,
may waive any existing Potential Rapid Amortization Event or any existing Rapid Amortization Event; provided however, that a Rapid
Amortization Event pursuant to Section 9.1(d) relating to a particular Series of Notes (or Class, Subclass or Tranche thereof)
shall not be permitted to be waived by any party unless each Noteholder of such Series of Notes (or Class, Subclass or Tranche thereof)
that have not been repaid or refinanced in full prior to the applicable Series Anticipated Payment Date has consented to such waiver.
Section
9.8 Control by the Control Party.
Notwithstanding
any other provision hereof, the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) may, subject to the terms
hereof, cause the institution of and direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee
or exercise any trust or power conferred on the Trustee; provided that:
(a)
such direction of time, method and place shall not be in conflict with any rule of law or with the Indenture;
(b)
the Control Party may take any other action deemed proper by the Control Party that is not inconsistent with the direction of the Controlling
Class Representative (as such direction may be modified by the Controlling Class Representative); and
(c)
such direction shall be in writing.
Notwithstanding
anything herein to the contrary, the Trustee need not take any action that it determines might involve it in liability unless it has
received an indemnity for such liability as provided herein.
Section
9.9 Limitation on Suits.
Any
other provision of the Indenture to the contrary notwithstanding, a Holder of Notes may pursue a remedy with respect to the Indenture
or any other Transaction Document only if:
(a)
the Noteholder gives to the Trustee, the Control Party and the Controlling Class Representative written notice of a continuing Event
of Default;
(b)
the Noteholders of at least 25% of the Aggregate Outstanding Principal Amount of all then Outstanding Notes make a written request to
the Trustee, the Control Party and the Controlling Class Representative to pursue the remedy;
(c)
such Noteholder or Noteholders offer and, if requested, provide to the Trustee, the Control Party and the Controlling Class Representative
an indemnity satisfactory to the Trustee, the Control Party and the Controlling Class Representative against any loss, liability or expense;
(d)
the Trustee does not comply with the request within sixty (60) days after receipt of the request and the offer and, if requested, the
provision of indemnity reasonably satisfactory to it;
(e)
during such sixty (60) day period, the Majority of Super Senior Noteholders do not give the Trustee a direction inconsistent with the
request; and
(f)
the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) has consented to the pursuit of such remedy.
A
Noteholder may not use the Indenture or any other Transaction Document to prejudice the rights of another Noteholder or to obtain a preference
or priority over another Noteholder.
Section
9.10 Unconditional Rights of Noteholders to Receive Payment.
Notwithstanding
any other provision of the Indenture, the right of any Holder of a Note to receive payment of principal of, and premium, if any, and
interest on the Note, on or after the respective due dates expressed in the Note, or to bring suit for the enforcement of any such payment
on or after such respective dates, is absolute and unconditional and shall not be impaired or affected without the consent of the Holder
of the Note.
Section
9.11 The Trustee May File Proofs of Claim.
The
Trustee is authorized to file such proofs of claim and other papers or documents as may be necessary or advisable in order to have the
claims of the Trustee (including any claim for the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its
agents and counsel), the Noteholders and any other Secured Party (as applicable) allowed in any judicial proceedings relative to the
Issuer (or any other obligor upon the Notes), its creditors or its property, and shall be entitled and empowered to collect, receive
and distribute any money or other property payable or deliverable on any such claim and any custodian in any such judicial proceeding
is hereby authorized by each Noteholder and each other Secured Party to make such payments to the Trustee and, in the event that the
Trustee shall consent to the making of such payments directly to the Noteholders or any other Secured Party, to pay the Trustee any amount
due to it for the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel, and any other
amounts due the Trustee under Section 10.5. To the extent that the payment of any such compensation, expenses, disbursements and
advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel, and any other amounts due the Trustee under Section 10.5 out of the estate in
any such proceeding, shall be denied for any reason, payment of the same shall be secured by a Lien on, and shall be paid out of, any
and all distributions, dividends, money and other properties which any of the Noteholders or any other Secured Party may be entitled
to receive in such proceeding whether in liquidation or under any plan of reorganization or arrangement or otherwise. Nothing herein
contained shall be deemed to authorize the Trustee to authorize or consent to or accept or adopt on behalf of any Noteholder or any other
Secured Party any plan of reorganization, arrangement, adjustment or composition affecting the Obligations or the rights of any Noteholder
or any other Secured Party, or to authorize the Trustee to vote in respect of the claim of any Noteholder or any other Secured Party
in any such proceeding.
Section
9.12 Undertaking for Costs.
In
any suit for the enforcement of any right or remedy under the Indenture or in any suit against the Trustee for any action taken or omitted
by it as a Trustee, a court in its discretion may require the filing by any party litigant in the suit of any undertaking to pay the
costs of the suit, and the court in its discretion may assess reasonable costs, including reasonable attorneys’ fees, against any
party litigant in the suit, having due regard to the merits and good faith of the claims or defenses made by the party litigant. This
Section 9.12 does not apply to a suit by the Trustee, a suit by a Noteholder pursuant to Section 9.9 or a suit by Noteholders
of more than 10% of the Aggregate Outstanding Principal Amount of all Series of Notes.
Section
9.13 Restoration of Rights and Remedies.
If
the Trustee, any Noteholder or any other Secured Party has instituted any Proceeding to enforce any right or remedy under the Indenture
or any other Transaction Document and such Proceeding has been discontinued or abandoned for any reason or has been determined adversely
to the Trustee or to such Noteholder or other Secured Party, then and in every such case the Trustee and the Noteholders shall, subject
to any determination in such proceeding, be restored severally and respectively to their former positions hereunder, and thereafter all
rights and remedies of the Trustee, the Noteholders and the other Secured Parties shall continue as though no such Proceeding had been
instituted.
Section
9.14 Rights and Remedies Cumulative.
No
right or remedy herein conferred upon or reserved to the Trustee or to the Holders of Notes or any other Secured Party is intended to
be exclusive of any other right or remedy, and every right or remedy shall, to the extent permitted by law, be cumulative and in addition
to every other right and remedy given under the Indenture or any other Transaction Document or now or hereafter existing at law or in
equity or otherwise. The assertion or employment of any right or remedy under the Indenture or any other Transaction Document, or otherwise,
shall not prevent the concurrent assertion or employment of any other appropriate right or remedy.
Section
9.15 Delay or Omission Not Waiver.
No
delay or omission of the Trustee, the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative, any Holder of any Note or any other Secured
Party to exercise any right or remedy accruing upon any Potential Rapid Amortization Event, Rapid Amortization Event, Default or Event
of Default shall impair any such right or remedy or constitute a waiver of any such Potential Rapid Amortization Event, Rapid Amortization
Event, Default or Event of Default or an acquiescence therein. Every right and remedy given by this Article IX or by law to the
Trustee, the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative, the Holders of Notes or any other Secured Party may be exercised from
time to time to the extent not inconsistent with the Indenture, and as often as may be deemed expedient, by the Trustee, the Control
Party, the Controlling Class Representative, the Holders of Notes or any other Secured Party, as the case may be.
Section
9.16 Waiver of Stay or Extension Laws.
The
Issuer covenants (to the extent that it may lawfully do so) that it will not at any time insist upon, or plead, or in any manner whatsoever
claim or take the benefit or advantage of, any stay or extension law wherever enacted, now or at any time hereafter in force, that may
affect the covenants or the performance of the Indenture or any other Transaction Document; and the Issuer (to the extent that it may
lawfully do so) hereby expressly waives all benefit or advantages of any such law, and covenants that it will not hinder, delay or impede
the execution of any power herein granted to the Trustee, the Control Party or the Controlling Class Representative, but will suffer
and permit the execution of every such power as though no such law had been enacted.
Article
X
THE
TRUSTEE
Section
10.1 Duties of the Trustee.
(a)
If an Event of Default or a Rapid Amortization Event of which a Trust Officer of the Trustee shall have Actual Knowledge has occurred
and is continuing, the Trustee shall (except in the case of the receipt of directions with respect to such matter from the Control Party
in accordance with the terms of this Base Indenture or any other Transaction Document in which event the Trustee’s sole responsibility
will, subject to the term hereof, be to await such directions and act or refrain from acting in accordance with such directions) provide
notice thereof to the Control Party and the Back-Up Manager and exercise the rights and powers vested in it by this Base Indenture and
the other Transaction Documents, and use the same degree of care and skill in its exercise, as a prudent Person would exercise or use
under the circumstances in the conduct of such Person’s own affairs; provided that the Trustee will have no liability in
connection with any action or inaction taken, or not taken, by it upon the deemed occurrence of an Event of Default, a Rapid Amortization
Event, a Manager Termination Event or a Control Party Termination Event of which a Trust Officer has not received written notice; provided,
further, that the Trustee will have no liability in connection with any action or inaction due to the acts or failure to act of
the Control Party or the Controlling Class Representative in connection with any Event of Default, Rapid Amortization Event, Manager
Termination Event or Control Party Termination Event, or for acting or failing to act due to any direction or lack of direction from
the Control Party or the Controlling Class Representative. The preceding sentence shall not have the effect of insulating the Trustee
from liability arising out of the Trustee’s negligence, fraud, bad faith or willful misconduct. The Trustee, upon receipt of all
resolutions, certificates, statements, opinions, reports, documents, orders or other instruments furnished to the Trustee which are specifically
required to be furnished pursuant to any provision of the Indenture, shall examine them to determine whether they conform on their face
to the requirements of this Base Indenture; provided that the Trustee shall not be responsible for the accuracy or content of
any resolution, certificate, statement, opinion, report, document, order or other instrument furnished by the Issuer under the Indenture.
The Issuer and, by its acceptance of a Note, each Holder directs the Trustee to execute and deliver the Transaction Documents to which
it is a party.
(b)
Except during the occurrence and continuance of an Event of Default or a Rapid Amortization Event of which the Trustee shall have Actual
Knowledge:
(i)
The Trustee undertakes to perform only those duties that are specifically set forth in the Indenture or any other Transaction Document
to which it is a party and no others, the Trustee shall not be liable except for the performance of such duties and obligations as are
specifically set forth in this Base Indenture or any other Transaction Documents to which it is a party, and no other duties or implied
covenants or obligations shall be read into the Indenture or any other Transaction Document against the Trustee; and
(ii)
In the absence of bad faith on its part, the Trustee may conclusively rely, as to the truth of the statements and the correctness of
the opinions expressed therein, upon certificates or opinions furnished to the Trustee and conforming to the requirements of the Indenture
and any other applicable Transaction Document; provided, however, in the case of any such certificates or opinions which
by any provision hereof are specifically required to be furnished to the Trustee, the Trustee shall be under a duty to examine such certificates
or opinions to determine whether or not they conform to the requirements of the Indenture.
(c)
The Trustee may not be relieved from liability for its own negligence, fraud, bad faith or willful misconduct, except that:
(i)
This clause (c) does not limit the effect of clause (a) of this Section 10.1.
(ii)
The Trustee shall not be liable for any error of judgment made in good faith by a Trust Officer, unless it is conclusively determined
by a court of competent jurisdiction no longer subject to appeal that the Trustee was grossly negligent in ascertaining the pertinent
facts.
(iii)
The Trustee shall not be liable with respect to any action it takes, suffers or omits to take in good faith at the direction of the Manager,
the Issuer, the Control Party and/or any Noteholder if direction from such Person is contemplated by the Transaction Documents; provided
that the Trustee shall have no responsibility for determining whether any such party is authorized to provide such direction hereunder
or under any other Transaction Document.
(iv)
The Trustee shall not be charged with knowledge of any Mortgage Recordation Event, Default, Event of Default, Potential Rapid Amortization
Event, Rapid Amortization Event, Manager Termination Event, Potential Manager Termination Event or Control Party Termination Event or
the commencement and continuation of a Cash Flow Sweeping Period until such time as a Trust Officer shall have Actual Knowledge or have
received written notice thereof. In the absence of such Actual Knowledge or receipt of such notice, the Trustee may conclusively assume
that no such event has occurred or is continuing.
(d)
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in the Indenture or any of the other Transaction Documents, no provision of the Indenture
or the other Transaction Documents shall require the Trustee to expend or risk its own funds or incur any liability, financial or otherwise,
in the performance of any of its duties or exercise of its rights or powers hereunder, if it has reasonable grounds for believing that
repayment of such funds or adequate security or indemnity against such risk or liability is not reasonably assured to it. The Trustee
may refuse to perform any duty or exercise any right or power unless it receives indemnity satisfactory to it against any risk, loss,
liability or expense.
(e)
In the event that the Paying Agent or the Note Registrar shall fail to perform any obligation, duty or agreement in the manner or on
the day required to be performed by the Paying Agent or the Note Registrar, as the case may be, under the Indenture, the Trustee shall
be obligated as soon as practicable upon Actual Knowledge of a Trust Officer thereof and receipt of appropriate records and information,
if any, to perform such obligation, duty or agreement in the manner so required.
(f)
Subject to Section 10.3, all moneys received by the Trustee shall, until used or applied as herein provided, be held in trust
for the purposes for which they were received, but need not be segregated from other funds except to the extent required by law or the
Indenture or any of the other Transaction Documents to which the Trustee is a party.
(g)
Whether or not therein expressly so provided, every provision of the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents relating to the conduct
of, affecting the liability of, or affording protection to, the Trustee shall be subject to the provisions of this Section 10.1.
(h)
The Trustee shall not be responsible (i) for the existence, genuineness or value of any of the Collateral, (ii) for the validity, perfection,
priority or enforceability of the Liens in any of the Collateral, whether impaired by operation of law or by reason of any action or
omission to act on its part hereunder, (iii) for the validity or sufficiency of the Collateral or any agreement or assignment contained
therein, (iv) for the validity of the title of the Securitization Entities to the Collateral, (v) for insuring the Collateral or (vi)
for the payment of Taxes, charges, assessments or Liens upon the Collateral or otherwise as to the maintenance of the Collateral. The
Trustee shall have no duty to inquire as to the performance or observance of any of the terms of the Indenture or the other Transaction
Documents by the Securitization Entities.
(i)
The Trustee shall not be liable with respect to any action taken, suffered or omitted to be taken by it in good faith in accordance with
the Indenture or at the direction of the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative or the Holders of the requisite percentage
of Notes, relating to the time, method and place for conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee, exercising any
trust or power conferred upon the Trustee under this Base Indenture or any other circumstances in which such direction is required or
permitted by the terms of this Base Indenture.
(j)
The Trustee shall have no duty (i) to see to any recording, filing or depositing of this Base Indenture or any agreement referred to
herein or any financing statement or continuation statement evidencing a security interest, or to see to the maintenance of any such
recordings or filing or depositing or to any rerecording, refiling or redeposition of any thereof; (ii) to see to any insurance, (iii)
except as otherwise provided by Section 10.1(e), to see to the payment or discharge of any tax, assessment or other governmental
charge or any lien or encumbrance of any kind or (iv) to confirm or verify the contents of any reports or certificates, or other documents
of the Manager, the Control Party, the Back-Up Manager or any other Person delivered to the Trustee pursuant to this Base Indenture or
any other Transaction Document believed by the Trustee to be genuine and to have been signed or presented by the proper party or parties;
provided that the Trustee may conclusively rely upon such documents and shall be fully protected in acting or refraining from acting
thereon.
(k)
The Trustee shall not be liable for special, indirect, consequential or punitive loss or damage of any kind whatsoever (including but
not limited to lost profits), even if the Trustee has been advised of the likelihood of such loss or damage and regardless of the form
of action.
Section
10.2 Rights of the Trustee.
Except
as otherwise provided by Section 10.1:
(a)
The Trustee may conclusively rely and shall be fully protected in acting or refraining from acting based upon any resolution, Officer’s
Certificate, Opinion of Counsel, certificate, instrument, report, consent, order, document or other paper reasonably believed by it to
be genuine and to have been signed by or presented by the proper person.
(b)
The Trustee may consult with counsel of its selection and the advice of such counsel or any Opinion of Counsel shall be full and complete
authorization and protection from liability in respect of any action taken, suffered or omitted by it hereunder in good faith and in
reliance thereon.
(c)
The Trustee may act through agents, custodians and nominees and shall not be liable for any misconduct or negligence on the part of,
or for the supervision of, any such non-affiliated agent, custodian or nominee so long as such agent, custodian or nominee is appointed
with due care; provided, however, the Trustee shall have received the consent of the Control Party prior to the appointment
of any agent, custodian or nominee performing any material obligation of the Trustee hereunder.
(d)
The Trustee shall not be liable for any action it takes, suffers or omits to take in the absence of gross negligence, fraud, bad faith
and willful misconduct which it believes to be authorized or within the discretion or rights or powers conferred upon it by the Indenture
or the applicable Transaction Documents.
(e)
The Trustee shall be under no obligation to exercise any of the rights or powers vested in it by this Base Indenture, any Series Supplement
or any other Transaction Document, or to institute, conduct or defend any litigation hereunder or thereunder or in relation hereto or
thereto, at the request, order or direction of the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative, any of the Noteholders or any
other Secured Party pursuant to the provisions of this Base Indenture, any Series Supplement or any other Transaction Document, unless
the Trustee has been offered security or indemnity reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee against the costs, expenses and liabilities
that may be incurred by it in compliance with such request, order or direction.
(f)
The Trustee shall not be bound to make any investigation into the facts of matters stated in any resolution, certificate, statement,
instrument, opinion, report, notice, request, consent, order, approval, bond or other paper or document, unless requested in writing
so to do by the Noteholders of at least 25% of the Aggregate Outstanding Principal Amount of all then Outstanding Notes. If the Trustee
is so requested or determines in its own discretion to make such further inquiry or investigation into such facts or matters as it sees
fit, the Trustee shall be entitled to examine the books, records and premises of the Securitization Entities, personally or by agent
or attorney, at the sole cost of the Issuer and the Trustee shall incur no liability by reason of such inquiry or investigation.
(g)
The right of the Trustee to perform any discretionary act enumerated in this Base Indenture shall not be construed as a duty, and the
Trustee shall be not be liable in the absence of negligence, fraud, bad faith or willful misconduct for the performance of such act.
(h)
In accordance with Section 326 of the U.S.A. Patriot Act, to help fight the funding of terrorism and money laundering activities, the
Trustee will obtain, verify, and record information that identifies individuals or entities that establish a relationship or open an
account with the Trustee. The Trustee will ask for the name, address, tax identification number and other information that will allow
the Trustee to identify the individual or entity who is establishing the relationship or opening the account. The Trustee may also ask
for formation documents such as articles of incorporation, an offering memorandum, or other identifying documents to be provided.
(i)
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, any and all communications (both text and attachments) by or from the Trustee that the
Trustee in its sole discretion deems to contain confidential, proprietary or sensitive information and sent by electronic mail will be
encrypted. The recipient of the email communication will be required to complete a one-time registration process.
(j)
The Trustee shall not be responsible or liable for any failure or delay in the performance of its obligations under this Base Indenture
arising out of or caused, directly or indirectly, by circumstances beyond its reasonable control, including without limitation, acts
of God; earthquakes; fires; floods; wars; civil or military disturbances; sabotage; epidemics; riots; interruptions, loss or malfunctions
of utilities, computer (hardware or software) or communications service, accidents; labor disputes; acts of civil or military authority
or governmental actions (it being understood that the Trustee shall use commercially reasonable efforts to resume performance as soon
as practicable under the circumstances).
(k)
The Trustee shall not be required to give any bond or surety in respect of the execution of the trust created hereby or the powers granted
hereunder.
(l)
All rights of action and claims under this Base Indenture may be prosecuted and enforced by the Trustee without the possession of any
of the Notes or the production thereof in any proceeding relating thereto, any such proceeding instituted by the Trustee shall be brought
in its own name or in its capacity as Trustee. Any recovery of judgment shall, after provision for the payments to the Trustee provided
for in Section 10.5, be distributed in accordance with the Priority of Payments.
(m)
The Trustee may request written direction from any applicable party any time the Indenture provides that the Trustee may be directed
to act.
(n)
Any request or direction of the Issuer mentioned herein shall be sufficiently evidenced by a Company Order.
(o)
Whenever in the administration of the Indenture the Trustee shall deem it desirable that a matter be proved or established prior to taking,
suffering or omitting any action hereunder, the Trustee may, in the absence of bad faith, gross negligence or willful misconduct on its
part, rely upon an Officer’s Certificate of the Issuer, the Manager or the Control Party and shall incur no liability for its reliance
thereon.
(p)
The Trustee shall not be responsible for the accuracy of the books or records of, or for any acts or omissions of DTC, any transfer agent
(other than the Trustee itself acting in that capacity), any calculation agent (other than the Trustee itself acting in that capacity),
or any agent appointed by it with due care or any Paying Agent (other than the Trustee itself acting in that capacity).
(q)
The Trustee and its Affiliates are permitted to receive additional compensation that could be deemed to be in the Trustee’s economic
self-interest for (i) serving as an investment advisor, administrator, shareholder servicing agent, custodian or sub-custodian with respect
to certain Eligible Investments, (ii) using Affiliates to effect transactions in certain Eligible Investments and (iii) effecting transactions
in certain Eligible Investments. The Trustee does not guarantee the performance of any Eligible Investments.
(r)
The Trustee shall have no obligation to invest and reinvest any cash held in the absence of timely and specific written investment direction
from the Control Party or the Issuer. In no event shall the Trustee be liable for the selection of investments or for investment losses
incurred thereon. The Trustee shall have no liability in respect of losses incurred as a result of the liquidation of any investment
prior to its stated maturity or the failure of the Control Party or the Issuer to provide timely written investment direction.
(s)
The Trustee shall have no obligation to calculate nor shall it be responsible or liable for any calculation of the P&I DSCR or the
Interest-Only DSCR.
(t)
The rights, privileges, protections, immunities and benefits given to the Trustee, including, without limitation, its right to be indemnified,
are extended to, and shall be enforceable by, the Bank, in each case, with respect to each of its capacities hereunder, and each agent,
custodian and other Person employed to act hereunder.
(u)
The Trustee shall be afforded, in each Transaction Document, all of the rights, powers, immunities and indemnities granted to it in this
Base Indenture as if such rights, powers, immunities and indemnities were specifically set out in each such Transaction Document.
(v)
For any purpose under the Transaction Documents, the Trustee may conclusively assume without incurring liability therefor that no Notes
are held by any of the Securitization Entities, any other obligor upon the Notes, the Manager or any Affiliate of any of them unless
a Trust Officer has received written notice at the Corporate Trust Office that any Notes are so held by any of the Securitization Entities,
any other obligor upon the Notes, the Manager or any Affiliate of any of them.
(w)
The Trustee shall not have any responsibility to make any inquiry or investigation as to, and shall have no obligation in respect of,
the terms of an engagement of Independent Auditors by the Issuer (or the Manager on behalf of the Issuer) or the terms of any agreed
upon procedures in respect of such engagement; provided that the Trustee shall be authorized, upon receipt of a Company Order
directing the same, to execute any acknowledgment or other agreement with the Independent Auditors required for the Trustee to receive
any of the reports or instructions provided herein, which acknowledgment or agreement may include, among other things, (i) acknowledgment
that the Issuer has agreed that the procedures to be performed by the Independent Auditors are sufficient for the Issuer’s purposes,
(ii) releases by the Trustee (on behalf of itself and the Holders) of claims against the Independent Auditors, and (iii) restrictions
or prohibitions on the disclosure of information or documents provided to it by such firm of Independent Auditors (including to the Holders).
Notwithstanding the foregoing, in no event shall the Trustee be required to execute any agreement in respect of the Independent Auditors
that the Trustee reasonably determines adversely affects it.
(x)
UMB Bank, N.A. (in each of its capacities, the “Bank”) agrees to accept and act upon instructions or directions pursuant
to this Base Indenture, the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement or any documents executed in connection herewith or therewith sent by
unsecured email, facsimile transmission or other similar unsecured electronic methods; provided, however, that any person providing
such instructions or directions shall provide to the Bank an incumbency certificate listing persons designated to provide such instructions
or directions (including the email addresses of such persons), which incumbency certificate shall be amended whenever a person is added
or deleted from the listing. If such person elects to give the Bank email (or .pdf or similar files) or facsimile instructions (or instructions
by a similar electronic method) and the Bank in its discretion elects to act upon such instructions, the Bank’s reasonable understanding
of such instructions shall be deemed controlling. The Bank shall not be liable for any losses, costs or expenses arising directly or
indirectly from the Bank’s reliance upon and compliance with such instructions notwithstanding such instructions conflicting with
or being inconsistent with a subsequent written instruction. Any person providing such instructions or directions agrees to assume all
risks arising out of the use of such electronic methods to submit instructions and directions to the Bank, including without limitation
the risk of the Bank acting on unauthorized instructions, and the risk of interception and misuse by third parties.
Section
10.3 Individual Rights of the Trustee.
The
Trustee in its individual or any other capacity may become the owner or pledgee of Notes and may otherwise deal with the Securitization
Entities or an Affiliate of the Securitization Entities with the same rights it would have if it were not Trustee. Any Agent may do the
same with like rights.
Section
10.4 Notice of Events of Default and Defaults.
If
an Event of Default, a Default, a Rapid Amortization Event or a Potential Rapid Amortization Event occurs and is continuing of which
the Trustee has Actual Knowledge or written notice of the existence thereof has been delivered to a Trust Officer of the Trustee at the
Corporate Trust Office, the Trustee shall promptly provide the Noteholders, the Control Party, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager and the
Issuer with notice of such Event of Default, Default, Rapid Amortization Event or Potential Rapid Amortization Event by e-mail or first
class mail.
Section
10.5 Compensation and Indemnity.
(a)
The Issuer shall promptly pay to the Trustee from time to time compensation for its acceptance of the Indenture and services hereunder
and under the other Transaction Documents to which the Trustee is a party as the Trustee and the Issuer shall from time to time agree
in writing. The Trustee’s compensation shall not be limited by any law on compensation of a trustee of an express trust. The Issuer
shall reimburse the Trustee promptly upon request for all reasonable disbursements, advances and expenses incurred or made by it in addition
to the compensation for its services in accordance with the provisions of the Indenture (including, without limitation, the Priority
of Payments). Such expenses shall include the reasonable compensation, disbursements and expenses of the Trustee’s agents and outside
counsel. When the Trustee incurs expenses or renders services after an Event of Default or Rapid Amortization Event occurs, the expenses
and the compensation for the services are intended to constitute expenses of administration under the Bankruptcy Code.
(b)
The Issuer shall indemnify and hold harmless the Trustee or any predecessor Trustee and their respective directors, officers, agents
and employees from and against any loss, liability, claim, expense (including taxes, other than taxes based upon, measured by or determined
by the income of the Trustee or such predecessor Trustee), damage or injury suffered or sustained by reason of any acts, omissions or
alleged acts or omissions arising out of or in connection with (i) the activities of the Trustee or such predecessor Trustee pursuant
to this Base Indenture, any Series Supplement or any other Transaction Documents to which the Trustee is a party and any activities contemplated
hereby or thereby and (ii) the security interest granted hereby, whether arising by virtue of any act or omission on the part of the
Issuer or otherwise, including but not limited to any judgment, award, settlement, reasonable and documented attorneys’ fees and
other costs or expenses reasonably incurred in connection with the defense of any actual or threatened action, proceeding, claim (whether
asserted by the Issuer, the Control Party or any Noteholder or any other Person), liability in connection with the exercise or performance
of any of its powers or duties hereunder or under any Transaction Document, the preservation of any of its rights to, or the realization
upon, any of the Collateral, or in connection with enforcing the provisions of this Section 10.5(b); provided, however,
that the Issuer shall not indemnify the Trustee, any predecessor Trustee or their respective directors, officers, employees or agents
if such acts, omissions or alleged acts or omissions constitute willful misconduct, bad faith or negligence by the Trustee or such predecessor
Trustee, as the case may be.
(c)
The provisions of this Section 10.5 shall survive the termination of the Indenture and the resignation and removal of the Trustee.
Section
10.6 Replacement of the Trustee.
(a)
A resignation or removal of the Trustee and appointment of a successor Trustee shall become effective only upon the successor Trustee’s
acceptance of appointment as provided in this Section 10.6.
(b)
The Trustee may, after giving not less than thirty (30) days’ prior written notice to the Issuer, the Noteholders, the Control
Party, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager and the Controlling Class Representative, resign at any time from its office and be discharged
from the trust hereby created; provided, however, that no such resignation of the Trustee shall be effective until a successor
trustee has assumed the obligations of the Trustee hereunder. At any time, the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling
Class Representative) or, prior to a Manager Termination Event, Rapid Amortization Event or Event of Default, the Issuer may remove the
Trustee by delivering written notice of such removal to the Trustee, or any Noteholder may, on behalf of itself and all others similarly
situated, petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the removal of the Trustee and the appointment of a successor Trustee, if
at any time:
(i)
the Trustee fails to comply with Section 10.8;
(ii)
the Trustee is adjudged a bankrupt or an insolvent or an order for relief is entered with respect to the Trustee under the Bankruptcy
Code;
(iii)
the Trustee fails generally to pay its debts as such debts become due; or
(iv)
the Trustee becomes incapable of acting.
If
the Trustee resigns or is removed or if a vacancy exists in the office of the Trustee for any reason, the Issuer shall promptly, with
the prior written consent of the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), appoint a successor
Trustee. Within one year after the successor Trustee takes office, the Majority of Controlling Class (with the prior written consent
of the Control Party, acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) may appoint a successor Trustee to replace the
successor Trustee appointed by the Issuer.
(c)
If a successor Trustee is not appointed and an instrument of acceptance by a successor Trustee is not delivered to the Trustee within
thirty (30) days after the retiring Trustee resigns or is removed, at the direction of the Control Party (acting at the direction of
the Controlling Class Representative), the retiring Trustee, at the expense of the Issuer, may petition any court of competent jurisdiction
for the appointment of a successor Trustee.
(d)
[Reserved].
(e)
A successor Trustee shall deliver a written acceptance of its appointment to the retiring Trustee or removed Trustee and to the Control
Party, the Back-Up Manager and the Issuer. Thereupon the resignation or removal of the retiring Trustee shall become effective, and the
successor Trustee shall have all the rights, powers and duties of the Trustee under this Base Indenture, any Series Supplement and any
other Transaction Document to which the Trustee is a party. The successor Trustee shall mail a notice of its succession to Noteholders.
The retiring Trustee shall promptly transfer all property held by it as Trustee to the successor Trustee; provided, however,
that all sums owing to the retiring Trustee hereunder have been paid. Notwithstanding replacement of the Trustee pursuant to this Section
10.6 the Issuer’s obligations under Section 10.5 shall continue for the benefit of the retiring Trustee.
(f)
No successor Trustee may accept its appointment unless at the time of such acceptance such successor is qualified and eligible under
this Base Indenture and the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) has provided its consent
with respect to such appointment.
Section
10.7 Successor Trustee by Merger, etc.
Subject
to Section 10.8, if the Trustee consolidates, merges or converts into, or transfers all or substantially all of its corporate
trust business to, another corporation, the successor corporation without any further act shall be the successor Trustee; provided
that written notice of such consolidation, merger or conversion shall be provided to the Issuer, the Control Party and the Noteholders
after completion thereof; provided further that the resulting or successor corporation is eligible to be a Trustee under Section
10.8.
Section
10.8 Eligibility Disqualification.
(a)
There shall at all times be a Trustee hereunder which shall (i) be a bank or trust company organized and doing business under the laws
of the United States of America or of any state thereof authorized under such laws to exercise corporate trustee power, (ii) be subject
to supervision or examination by federal or state authority, (iii) have a combined capital and surplus of at least $250,000,000 as set
forth in its most recent published annual report of condition, (iv) be reasonably acceptable to the Control Party and (v) have a long-term
unsecured debt rating of at least “BBB+” by S&P’s and Fitch.
(b)
At any time the Trustee shall cease to satisfy the eligibility requirements of Section 10.8(a), the Trustee shall resign after
written request that it do so by the Issuer, or by the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative),
in the manner and with the effect specified in Section 10.6.
Section
10.9 Appointment of Co-Trustee or Separate Trustee.
(a)
Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Base Indenture, any Series Supplement or any other Transaction Document, at any time, for
the purpose of meeting any legal requirements of any jurisdiction in which any part of the Collateral may at the time be located, the
Trustee shall have the power upon notice to the Control Party, the Back-Up Manager and the Issuer and may execute and deliver all instruments
to appoint one or more Persons to act as a co-trustee or co-trustees, or separate trustee or separate trustees, for all or any part of
the Collateral, and to vest in such Person or Persons, in such capacity and for the benefit of the Noteholders and the other Secured
Parties, such title to the Collateral, or any part thereof, and, subject to the other provisions of this Section 10.9, such powers,
duties, obligations, rights and trusts as the Trustee may consider necessary or desirable. Any co-trustee or separate trustee hereunder
shall be required to meet the terms of eligibility as a successor trustee under Section 10.8 or shall be otherwise acceptable
to the Control Party. No notice to Noteholders of the appointment of any co-trustee or separate trustee shall be required under Section
10.6. No co-trustee shall be appointed without the consent of the Control Party and the Issuer unless such appointment is required
as a matter of state law or to enable the Trustee to perform its functions hereunder.
(b)
Every separate trustee and co-trustee shall, to the extent permitted by law, be appointed and act subject to the following provisions
and conditions:
(i)
the Notes of each Series shall be authenticated and delivered solely by the Trustee or an authenticating agent appointed by the Trustee;
(ii)
all rights, powers, duties and obligations conferred or imposed upon the Trustee shall be conferred or imposed upon and exercised or
performed by the Trustee and such separate trustee or co-trustee jointly (it being understood that such separate trustee or co-trustee
is not authorized to act separately without the Trustee joining in such act), except to the extent that under any law of any jurisdiction
in which any particular act or acts are to be performed, the Trustee shall be incompetent or unqualified to perform such act or acts,
in which event such rights, powers, duties and obligations (including the holding of title to the Collateral or any portion thereof in
any such jurisdiction) shall be exercised and performed singly by such separate trustee or co-trustee;
(iii)
no trustee hereunder shall be personally liable by reason of any act or omission of any other trustee hereunder and such appointment
shall not, and shall not be deemed to, constitute any such trustee or co-trustee as an agent of the Trustee; and
(iv)
the Trustee may at any time accept the resignation of or remove any separate trustee or co-trustee.
(c)
Any notice, request or other writing given to the Trustee shall be deemed to have been given to each of the then separate trustees and
co-trustees, as effectively as if given to each of them. Every instrument appointing any separate trustee or co-trustee shall refer to
this Base Indenture and the conditions of this Article X. Each separate trustee and co-trustee, upon its acceptance of the trusts
conferred, shall be vested with the estates or property specified in its instrument of appointment, either jointly with the Trustee or
separately, as may be provided therein, subject to all the provisions of this Base Indenture, any Series Supplement and any other Transaction
Documents to which the Trustee is a party, specifically including every provision of this Base Indenture, any Series Supplement, or any
other Transaction Document which the Trustee is a party relating to the conduct of, affecting the liability of, or affording protection
to, the Trustee. Every such instrument shall be filed with the Trustee and a copy thereof given to the Control Party and the Issuer.
(d)
Any separate trustee or co-trustee may at any time constitute the Trustee, its agent or attorney-in-fact with full power and authority,
to the extent not prohibited by law, to do any lawful act under or in respect to this Base Indenture, any Series Supplement or any other
Transaction Document on its behalf and in its name. If any separate trustee or co-trustee shall die, become incapable of acting, resign
or be removed, all of its estates, properties, rights, remedies and trusts shall vest in and be exercised by the Trustee, to the extent
permitted by law, without the appointment of a new or successor trustee.
Section
10.10 Representations and Warranties of Trustee.
The
Trustee represents and warrants to the Issuer and the Noteholders that:
(a)
the Trustee is a national banking association, organized, existing and in good standing under the laws of the United States;
(b)
the Trustee has full power, authority and right to execute, deliver and perform this Base Indenture, any Series Supplement issued concurrently
with this Base Indenture and each other Transaction Document to which it is a party and to authenticate the Notes, and has taken all
necessary action to authorize the execution, delivery and performance by it of this Base Indenture, any Series Supplement issued concurrently
with this Base Indenture and any such other Transaction Document and to authenticate the Notes;
(c)
this Base Indenture and each other Transaction Document to which it is a party has been duly executed and delivered by the Trustee; and
(d)
the Trustee meets the requirements of eligibility as a trustee hereunder set forth in Section 10.8(a).
Article
XI
CONTROLLING
CLASS REPRESENTATIVE AND CONTROL PARTY
Section
11.1 Controlling Class Representative.
(a)
The Majority of Controlling Class shall initially act as Controlling Class Representative until a successor Controlling Class Representative,
if any, is appointed in accordance with Section 11.1(d). Notwithstanding the foregoing, upon the appointment of a successor Controlling
Class Representative, the Majority of Controlling Class shall retain its rights hereunder and under the other Transaction Documents to
exercise the rights, powers, remedies or privileges of the Controlling Class Representative as set forth in Section 1.4(m).
(b)
Within two (2) Business Days of any change in the name or address of the Controlling Class Representative of which the Trustee has received
written notice from the Controlling Class Representative, the Trustee will deliver to each Noteholder, the Issuer, the Manager, and the
Back-Up Manager and the Control Party a notice setting forth the name and address of the new Controlling Class Representative.
(c)
The Control Party and the Back-Up Manager will be entitled to rely on the identity of the Controlling Class Representative provided by
the Trustee or the Majority of Controlling Class, as applicable, with respect to any obligation or right hereunder or under any other
Transaction Document that the Control Party and the Back-Up Manager may have to deliver information or otherwise communicate with the
Controlling Class Representative or any of the Noteholders of the Controlling Class, with no liability to it for such reliance.
(d)
Upon the resignation or removal of a Controlling Class Representative, the Majority of Controlling Class may appoint a successor Controlling
Class Representative in accordance with the definition of “Controlling Class Representative” in this Base Indenture and shall
provide written notice to the Issuer, the Trustee, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party of any such appointment upon
the successor Controlling Class Representative’s acceptance.
(e)
The Majority of Controlling Class shall have all privileges of and may assume and exercise all of the rights and remedies of the Controlling
Class Representative at any time. Upon any dispute between the Controlling Class Representative and the Majority of Controlling Class,
a written direction from the Majority of Controlling Class shall control.
Section
11.2 Resignation or Removal of the Controlling Class Representative.
The
Controlling Class Representative may at any time resign by giving written notice to the Trustee, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager, the
Control Party and to each Noteholder of the Controlling Class. As of any Record Date, a Majority of Controlling Class shall be entitled
to remove any existing Controlling Class Representative by giving written notice to the Trustee, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager, the
Control Party and such existing Controlling Class Representative. No resignation or removal of the Controlling Class Representative shall
become effective until a successor Controlling Class Representative has been appointed and the Majority of Controlling Class has delivered
written notice of such successor Controlling Class Representative’s acceptance of such appointment, in each case, pursuant to Section
11.1(d). Thereupon, the resignation or removal of the retiring Controlling Class Representative shall become effective, and the successor
Controlling Class Representative shall have all the rights, powers and duties of the Controlling Class Representative under this Base
Indenture and the other Transaction Documents. In addition to the foregoing, within two (2) Business Days of the selection, resignation
or removal of the Controlling Class Representative, the Trustee shall notify the Control Party and the Back-Up Manager of such event.
Section
11.3 Expenses and Liabilities of the Controlling Class Representative.
(a)
The Controlling Class Representative shall have no liability to the Noteholders or Note Owners for any action taken, or for refraining
from the taking of any action, in good faith or for errors in judgment; provided, however, that the Controlling Class Representative
shall not be protected against any liability that would otherwise be imposed by reason of willful misfeasance, gross negligence or reckless
disregard of its obligations or duties under the Indenture. Each Noteholder and Note Owner acknowledges and agrees, by its acceptance
of its Notes or interests therein, that (i) the Controlling Class Representative may have special relationships and interests that conflict
with those of Noteholders or Note Owners of one or more Classes of Notes, or that conflict with other Noteholders or Note Owners, (ii)
the Controlling Class Representative may act solely in the interests of the Controlling Class Members or in its own interest, (iii) the
Controlling Class Representative does not have any duties to Noteholders or Note Owners other than the Controlling Class Members, (iv)
the Controlling Class Representative may take actions that favor the interests of the Controlling Class Members over the interests of
Holders of one or more other Classes of Notes, or that favor its own interests over those of other Noteholders, Note Owners or other
Controlling Class Members, (v) the Controlling Class Representative shall not be deemed to have been grossly negligent or reckless, or
to have acted in bad faith or engaged in willful misfeasance, by reason of its having acted solely in the interests of the Controlling
Class Members or in its own interests, and (vi) the Controlling Class Representative shall have no liability whatsoever for having so
acted pursuant to clauses (i) through (v), and no Noteholder or Note Owner may take any action whatsoever against the Controlling
Class Representative for having so acted or against any director, officer, employee, agent or principal thereof for having so acted.
(b)
Any and all expenses of the Controlling Class Representative for acting in its capacity as Controlling Class Representative shall be
borne by the Issuer and paid in accordance with the Priority of Payments. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if a claim is made against the
Controlling Class Representative and the Control Party or the Trustee are also named parties to the same action and, in the sole judgment
of the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative had acted in good faith, without gross negligence or willful misconduct, with
regard to the particular matter at issue, and there is no potential for the Control Party or the Trustee to be an adverse party in such
action as regards the Controlling Class Representative, the Control Party shall be required to assume the defense of any such claim against
the Controlling Class Representative.
Section
11.4 Control Party.
(a)
The Control Party is authorized to consent to and implement, subject to the Control Party Agreement, any Consent Request that does not
require the consent of any Noteholder or the Controlling Class Representative.
(b)
For any Consent Request that expressly requires, pursuant to the terms of this Base Indenture and the other Transaction Documents, the
consent or direction of the Controlling Class Representative, the Control Party shall review such Consent Request and shall formulate
and present a Consent Recommendation to the Controlling Class Representative whether to approve or reject such Consent Request. Notwithstanding
anything herein to the contrary, the Controlling Class Representative shall have the sole discretion to approve or reject any Consent
Request and the Control Party shall have no liability for any Consent Recommendation that is made in good faith. The Control Party is
not authorized to implement any such Consent Request until the Control Party receives the consent of the applicable Noteholders or the
Controlling Class Representative; provided that if the Controlling Class Representative fails to approve or reject a Consent Request
within ten (10) Business Days following delivery of a Consent Request and the related Consent Recommendation to the Controlling Class
Representative or if there is no Controlling Class Representative at such time, the Control Party shall be authorized (but not required)
to implement such Consent Request in accordance with the Control Party Agreement, whether or not this Indenture or any Transaction Document
indicates that the Control Party is required to act with the consent or at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative with
respect to any specific matter relating to such Consent Request, other than with respect to Control Party Termination Events.
(c)
For any Consent Request that expressly requires the consent or direction of affected Noteholders or 100% of the Noteholders pursuant
to the terms of the Indenture or other Transaction Documents, including pursuant to Section 13.2, the Control Party will review
such Consent Request and will formulate and present a Consent Recommendation to the Trustee, which will forward such Consent Request
and Consent Recommendation to the applicable Noteholders. The Control Party will be required to obtain the consent of the applicable
Noteholders with respect to such Consent Request, as required under the Transaction Documents, to implement such Consent Requests.
(d)
The Control Party shall promptly notify the Trustee, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager, the Issuer and the Controlling Class Representative
if the Control Party determines, in accordance with the Control Party Agreement, not to implement a Consent Request or it has not received
the requisite consent of, or direction from, the Controlling Class Representative or the Noteholders, if applicable, to implement a Consent
Request. The Trustee shall promptly notify the Control Party, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager, the Issuer and the Controlling Class
Representative if the Trustee has not received the requisite consent of the required percentage of Noteholders to implement a Consent
Request.
(e)
Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, no advice, direction or objection from or by the Controlling Class Representative may
(i) require or cause the Trustee or the Control Party to violate applicable Requirements of Law, the terms of this Base Indenture, the
Notes, the Control Party Agreement or the other Transaction Documents, including, without limitation with respect to the Control Party,
the Control Party’s obligation to act in accordance with the Control Party Agreement, (ii) expose the Control Party or the Trustee,
or any of their respective Affiliates, officers, directors, members, managers, employees, agents or partners, to any claim, suit or material
liability, or (iii) materially expand the scope of the Control Party’s responsibilities under the Control Party Agreement or the
Trustee’s responsibility under this Base Indenture, the Notes and the other Transaction Documents. Neither the Trustee nor the
Control Party shall be required to follow any such advice, direction or objection.
(f)
The Control Party shall not be liable with respect to any action it takes, suffers or omits to take in good faith at the direction of
the Controlling Class Representative and/or any Noteholder; provided that the Control Party shall have no responsibility for determining
whether any such Person is authorized to provide such direction hereunder or under any other Transaction Document. If there is no Controlling
Class Representative, the Control Party shall not be liable with respect to any action it takes, suffers or omits to take in good faith
in accordance with the Indenture.
Section
11.5 Noteholder List.
Any
Noteholders holding not less than $5,000,000 in aggregate principal amount of Notes that wish to communicate with the other Noteholders
with respect to their rights under the Indenture or under the Notes may request in writing that the Trustee deliver a notice or communication
to the other Noteholders. If such request and transmission states that such Noteholders desire to communicate with other Noteholders
with respect to their rights under the Indenture or under the Notes and is accompanied by (i) a certificate substantially in the form
of Exhibit G certifying that such Noteholders hold not less than $5,000,000 in aggregate principal amount of Notes (each, a “Noteholder
Certificate”) (upon which the Trustee may conclusively rely) and (ii) a copy of the communication which such Noteholders propose
to transmit, then the Trustee, after having been adequately indemnified by such Noteholders for its costs and expenses, shall transmit
the requested communication to all other Noteholders, and shall give the Issuer, the Control Party and the Controlling Class Representative
notice that such request and transmission has been made, within five (5) Business Days after receipt of the request. The Trustee shall
have no obligation of any nature whatsoever with respect to any requested communication other than to transmit it and to give notice
thereof to the Issuer, the Control Party and the Controlling Class Representative in accordance with this Section 11.5.
Article
XII
DISCHARGE
OF INDENTURE
Section
12.1 Termination of the Issuer’s and Guarantors’ Obligations.
(a)
Satisfaction and Discharge. The Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement shall be discharged and cease to be of further
effect when all Outstanding Notes theretofore authenticated and issued (other than destroyed, lost or stolen Notes which have been replaced
or paid) have been delivered to the Trustee for cancellation, the Issuer has paid all sums payable hereunder and under each other Transaction
Document; except that (i) the Issuer’s obligations under Section 10.5 and Section 10.11 and the Guarantors’
guaranty thereof, (ii) the Trustee’s and the Paying Agent’s obligations under Sections 12.2 and 12.3 and (iii)
the Noteholders’ and the Trustee’s obligations under Section 14.13 shall survive. The Trustee, on demand and at the
expense of the Issuer, will execute proper instruments acknowledging confirmation of, and discharge under, the Indenture and the Guarantee
and Collateral Agreement, prepared by the Issuer or Manager.
Upon
the termination of the last Series Supplement under which Notes are Outstanding, at the election of the Issuer, the Indenture, the Guarantee
and Collateral Agreement and all other Transaction Documents shall be discharged and cease to be of further effect; except that (i) the
rights and obligations of the Trustee hereunder, including, without limitation, the Trustee’s rights to compensation and indemnity
under Section 10.5 and the Guarantor’s guaranty thereof, (ii) the Trustee’s and the Paying Agent’s obligations
under Section 12.2 and Section 12.3, and (iii) the Noteholders’ and the Trustee’s obligations under Section
14.13 shall survive. The Trustee, on demand and at the expense of the Securitization Entities, shall execute proper instruments acknowledging
confirmation of and discharge under the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, prepared by the Securitization Entities.
(b)
Indenture Defeasance. The Issuer may terminate all of its obligations and the obligations of the Guarantors under the Transaction
Documents if:
(i)
the Issuer irrevocably deposits in trust with the Trustee or at the option of the Trustee, with a trustee reasonably satisfactory to
the Control Party, the Trustee and the Issuer under the terms of an irrevocable trust agreement in form and substance satisfactory to
the Trustee, U.S. Dollars and/or Government Securities in an amount sufficient, in the opinion of a nationally recognized firm of independent
certified public accountants expressed in a written certification thereof delivered to the Trustee, to pay (without consideration of
any reinvestment), when due, principal, premiums, make-whole prepayment consideration, if any, and interest on the Outstanding Notes
(including additional interest that accrues after a Series Anticipated Repayment Date, if applicable) to prepayment, redemption or maturity,
as the case may be, and to pay all other sums payable by them hereunder and under each other Transaction Document; provided that
any Government Securities deposited in trust shall provide for the scheduled payment of all principal and interest thereon not later
than the Business Day prior to the applicable prepayment date, redemption date or maturity date, as the case may be; and provided,
further, that if (x) the deposit is held by a trustee of an irrevocable trust other than the Trustee, such trustee shall have
been irrevocably instructed by the Issuer to pay such money or the proceeds of such U.S. Government Securities to the Trustee on or prior
to the prepayment date, redemption date or maturity date, as applicable, and (y) the Trustee shall have been irrevocably instructed by
the Issuer to apply such money or the proceeds of such U.S. Government Securities to the payment of said principal, premiums, make-whole
prepayment consideration, if any, and interest with respect to the Notes and such other obligations;
(ii)
the Issuer delivers notice of such deposit to the Noteholders of Outstanding Notes no more than twenty (20) Business Days prior to such
deposit and such notice is expressly stated to be, or as of the date of the deposit has become, irrevocable;
(iii)
the Issuer delivers notice of such deposit to the Control Party, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party, on or before
the date of the deposit; and
(iv)
an Opinion of Counsel from outside counsel is delivered to the Trustee and the Control Party by the Issuer to the effect that all conditions
precedent set forth herein with respect to such termination have been satisfied.
Upon
satisfaction of such conditions, the Indenture, the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and all other Transaction Documents shall be discharged
and cease to be of further effect; except that (i) the rights and obligations of the Trustee hereunder, including, without limitation,
the Trustee’s rights to compensation and indemnity under Section 10.5 and the Guarantor’s guaranty thereof, (ii) the
Trustee’s and the Paying Agent’s obligations under Section 12.2 and Section 12.3, (iii) the Noteholders’
and the Trustee’s obligations under Section 14.13, (iv) this Section 12.1(b) and (v) the Noteholders’ rights
to registration of transfer and exchange under Section 2.8 and to replacement or substitution of mutilated, destroyed, lost or
stolen Notes under Section 2.10(a) shall survive. The Trustee, on demand of and at the expense of the Issuer, shall execute proper
instruments acknowledging confirmation of and discharge under the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement.
(c)
Series Defeasance. Subject to the terms of each Series Supplement, the Issuer, solely in connection with the payment in full (whether
optional or mandatory) or a redemption in full of all Outstanding Notes of a particular Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes (the
“Defeased Series”) or in connection with the Series Legal Final Maturity Date of a particular Series of Notes, may
terminate all of their obligations and the obligations of the Guarantors under the Transaction Documents with respect to such Series,
Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes on and as of any Business Day (the “Series Defeasance Date”), provided:
(i)
the Issuer irrevocably deposits in trust with the Trustee, or at the option of the Trustee, with a trustee reasonably satisfactory to
the Control Party, the Trustee and the Issuer under the terms of an irrevocable trust agreement in form and substance satisfactory to
the Trustee, U.S. Dollars or Government Securities (or any combination thereof) in an amount sufficient, in the opinion of a nationally
recognized firm of independent certified public accountants expressed in a written certification thereof delivered to the Trustee, to
pay (without consideration of any reinvestment) without duplication:
(A)
all principal, interest, contingent interest, premiums, make-whole prepayment consideration on the Outstanding Notes of such Series,
Class, Subclass or Tranche (including additional interest that accrues after a Series Anticipated Repayment Date or renewal date, if
applicable) and any other Series Obligations that will be due and payable by the Issuer solely with respect to the Defeased Series as
of the applicable prepayment date, redemption date or Series Legal Final Maturity Date, as the case may be, and to pay other sums payable
by them under the Base Indenture and each other Transaction Document with respect to the Defeased Series of Notes;
(B)
all Monthly Management Fees, Supplemental Management Fees, unreimbursed Manager Advances (and outstanding interest thereon) and Manager
Advances (and outstanding interest thereon), all fees, indemnities, reimbursements and expenses due to the Trustee, the Manager, the
Control Party and the Back-Up Manager, and all Successor Manager Transition Expenses and Successor Control Party Transition Expenses,
in each case that will be due and payable on or as of the following Monthly Allocation Date or Quarterly Payment Date, as applicable;
and
(C)
all Securitization Operating Expenses for the Defeased Series that are due and unpaid as of the Series Defeasance Date to the Actual
Knowledge of the Manager;
provided,
that the terms of each Government Security deposited in trust shall provide for the scheduled payment of all principal and interest thereon
not later than the Business Day prior to the prepayment date, redemption date or Series Legal Final Maturity of the Defeased Series,
as applicable; and provided, further, that (x) if the deposit is held by a trustee of an irrevocable trust other than Trustee,
such trustee shall have been irrevocably instructed by the Issuer to pay such money or the proceeds of such Government Securities to
the Trustee on or prior to the prepayment date, redemption date, or Series Legal Final Maturity Date, as applicable and (y) the Trustee
shall have been irrevocably instructed by the Issuer to apply such money or the proceeds of such Government Securities to the payment
of the Series Obligations with respect to the Notes of such Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche and to the payment of other fees and expenses,
as applicable;
(ii)
[reserved];
(iii)
the Issuer delivers notice of prepayment, redemption or maturity in full of such Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes in full
to the Noteholders of the Defeased Series, the Manager, the Trustee, the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative, the Back-Up
Manager and the Control Party not more than twenty (20) Business Days prior to the Series Defeasance Date, and such notice is expressly
stated to be, or as of the date of the deposit has become, irrevocable;
(iv)
if, after giving effect to the deposit, any other Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes is Outstanding, the Issuer delivers to
the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate of the Issuer stating that no Potential Rapid Amortization Event, Rapid Amortization Event,
Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing on the date of such deposit;
(v)
the Issuer delivers to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate stating that the defeasance was not made by the Issuer with the intent
of preferring the holders of the Defeased Series over other creditors of the Issuer or with the intent of defeating, hindering, delaying
or defrauding other creditors;
(vi)
the Issuer delivers notice of such deposit to the Control Party, the Manager and the Back-Up Manager on or before the date of the deposit;
(vii)
such defeasance will not result in a breach or violation of, or constitute a default under, the Indenture or any other Transaction Documents;
and
(viii)
the Issuer delivers to the Trustee an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that all conditions precedent set forth herein with respect to
such termination have been satisfied.
Upon
satisfaction of such conditions, the Indenture, the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and the other Transaction Documents shall cease
to be of further effect with respect to such Defeased Series, the Issuer and the Guarantors shall be deemed to have paid and been discharged
from their Series Obligations with respect to such Defeased Series and thereafter such Defeased Series shall be deemed to be “Outstanding”
only for purposes of (1) the Issuer’s obligations under Section 10.5, (2) the Trustee’s and the Paying Agent’s
obligations under Section 10.11, Section 12.2 and Section 12.3, (3) the Noteholders’ and the Trustee’s
obligations under Section 14.13 and (4) the Noteholders’ rights to registration of transfer and exchange under Section
2.8 and to replacement or substitution of mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Notes under Section 2.10(a). The Trustee, on
demand of and at the expense of the Issuer, shall execute proper instruments acknowledging confirmation of and discharge under the Indenture
and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement of such Series Obligations.
For
the avoidance of doubt, upon the termination of a Series Supplement in accordance with the terms thereof, such Series of Notes shall
be a “Defeased Series” and all Series Obligations with respect to such Series of Notes and all Obligations of the Guarantors
under the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement in respect of such Series of Notes shall terminate and such date of termination shall be
a “Series Defeasance Date”. Upon such termination of the Series Supplement in accordance with its terms, the Indenture, the
Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and the other Transaction Documents shall cease to be of further effect with respect to such Defeased
Series, the Issuer and the Guarantors shall be deemed to have paid and been discharged from their Series Obligations with respect to
such Defeased Series and thereafter such Defeased Series shall no longer be deemed Outstanding hereunder.
(d)
After the conditions set forth in Section 12.1(a) have been met, or after the irrevocable deposit is made pursuant to Section
12.1(b) and satisfaction of the other conditions set forth therein have been met, the Trustee upon request of the Securitization
Entities shall reassign (without recourse upon, or any warranty whatsoever by, the Trustee) and deliver all Collateral and documents
then in the custody or possession of the Trustee promptly to the applicable Securitization Entities.
Section
12.2 Application of Trust Money.
The
Trustee or a trustee satisfactory to the Control Party, the Trustee and the Issuer shall hold in trust money or Government Securities
deposited with it pursuant to Section 12.1. The Trustee shall apply the deposited money and the money from Government Securities
through the Paying Agent in accordance with this Base Indenture and the other Transaction Documents to the payment of principal, premium,
if any, and interest on the Notes and the other sums referred to above. The provisions of this Section 12.2 shall survive the
expiration or earlier termination of the Indenture.
Section
12.3 Repayment to the Issuer.
(a)
The Trustee and the Paying Agent shall promptly pay to the Issuer upon written request any excess money or, pursuant to Sections 2.10
and 2.14, return any cancelled Notes held by them at any time.
(b)
Subject to Section 2.6(c), the Trustee and the Paying Agent shall pay to the Issuer upon written request any money held by them
for the payment of principal, premium or interest that remains unclaimed for two years after the date upon which such payment shall have
become due.
(c)
The provisions of this Section 12.3 shall survive the expiration or earlier termination of the Indenture.
Section
12.4 Reinstatement.
If
the Trustee is unable to apply any funds received under this Article XII by reason of any proceeding, order or judgment of any
court or governmental authority enjoining, restraining or otherwise prohibiting such application, the Issuer’s obligations under
the Indenture or the other Transaction Documents and in respect of the Notes and the Guarantors’ obligations under the Guarantee
and Collateral Agreement shall be revived and reinstated as though no deposit had occurred, until such time as the Trustee is permitted
to apply all such funds or property in accordance with this Article XII. If the Issuer or Guarantors make any payment of principal,
premium or interest on any Notes or any other sums under the Transaction Documents while such obligations have been reinstated, the Issuer
and the Guarantors shall be subrogated to the rights of the Noteholders, Note Owners or other Secured Parties who received such funds
or property from the Trustee to receive such payment in respect of the Notes.
Article
XIII
AMENDMENTS
Section
13.1 Without Consent of the Control Party or the Noteholders.
(a)
Without the consent of any Noteholder, the Control Party or any other Secured Party, the Issuer, the Controlling Class Representative
(except as provided below) and the Trustee, at any time and from time to time, may enter into one or more Supplements hereto or amendments,
modifications or supplements to any Supplement, the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement or any other Indenture Document, in form satisfactory
to the Controlling Class Representative and the Trustee (or solely with respect to clause (xiv) below so long as such Supplement,
amendment, modification or supplement to any Supplement or any other Indenture Document does not adversely affect the rights or obligation
of the Trustee, upon notice thereof from the Issuer to the Controlling Class Representative, the Trustee and the Control Party), for
any of the following purposes:
(i)
to add to the covenants of the Securitization Entities for the benefit of any Noteholders or any other Secured Parties or to surrender
for the benefit of the Noteholders and the other Secured Parties any right or power herein conferred upon the Securitization Entities;
(ii)
to mortgage, pledge, convey, assign and transfer to the Trustee any property or assets as security for the Obligations and to specify
the terms and conditions upon which such property or assets are to be held and dealt with by the Trustee and to set forth such other
provisions in respect thereof as may be required by the Indenture or as may, consistent with provisions of this Base Indenture, be deemed
appropriate by the Issuer, or to correct or to amplify the description of any such property or assets at any time so mortgaged, pledged,
conveyed and transferred to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties;
(iii)
to correct any demonstrable error or defect or to cure any ambiguity or to correct or supplement any provisions herein or any Series
Supplement which may be inconsistent with any other provision therein, in each case that has been agreed to by the Controlling Class
Representative;
(iv)
to provide for uncertificated Notes in addition to certificated Notes;
(v)
to evidence and provide for the acceptance of appointment hereunder by a successor Trustee with respect to the Notes of one or more Series
and to add to or change any of the provisions of the Indenture, the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement or the Limited Guaranty as shall
be necessary to provide for or facilitate the administration of the trusts hereunder or thereunder by more than one Trustee;
(vi)
to make any changes that in the Opinion of Counsel are necessary to comply with Requirements of Law (as evidenced by such Opinion of
Counsel);
(vii)
to facilitate the transfer of Notes in accordance with applicable Requirements of Law (as evidenced by an Opinion of Counsel stating
that such amendment, revision or modification is required or desirable for such purpose); provided that the Trustee shall not be required
to determine (but may rely on a determination by the Issuer with respect to) the sufficiency of such Opinion of Counsel;
(viii)
to take any action reasonably necessary to avoid the imposition, under and in accordance with applicable Requirements of Law, of any
Tax, including withholding Tax;
(ix)
to take any action necessary and appropriate in the opinion of the Controlling Class Representative to facilitate the origination of
Franchise Documents or the management and preservation of the Franchise Documents, in each case, in accordance with the Managing Standard;
or
(x)
to provide for mechanical provisions in respect of the issuance of Senior Subordinated Notes or Subordinated Notes;
provided,
however, that such Supplement, amendment, modification or supplement to any Supplement shall, as evidenced by an Opinion of Counsel
from outside counsel and an Officer’s Certificate delivered to the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party, not reasonably
be expected to adversely affect in any material respect the interests of any Noteholder, Note Owner, the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager,
the Control Party or any other Secured Party.
(b)
Upon the request of the Issuer and receipt by the Control Party and the Trustee of the documents described in Section 2.2 and
delivery by the Control Party of its consent thereto to the extent required by Section 2.2, the Trustee shall join with the Issuer
in the execution of any Series Supplement authorized or permitted by the terms of this Base Indenture and shall make any further appropriate
agreements and stipulations which may be therein contained, but the Trustee shall not be obligated to enter into such Series Supplement
which affects its own rights, duties or immunities under this Base Indenture or otherwise.
Section
13.2 With Consent of the Control Party or the Noteholders.
(a)
Except as provided in Section 13.1, the provisions of this Base Indenture, the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, any Supplement
and any other Indenture Document to which the Trustee is a party (unless otherwise provided in such Supplement) may from time to time
be amended, modified or waived, if such amendment, modification or waiver is in writing in a Supplement and consented to in writing by
the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative); provided, that:
(i)
any such amendment, waiver or other modification pursuant to this Section 13.2 that would reduce the percentage of the Aggregate
Outstanding Principal Amount or the Outstanding Principal Amount of any Series of Notes, the consent of the Noteholders of which is required
for any Supplement under this Section 13.2 or the consent of the Noteholders of which is required for any waiver of compliance
with the provisions of the Indenture or any other Transaction Document or defaults hereunder or thereunder and their consequences provided
for in herein and therein or for any other action hereunder or thereunder shall require the consent of each affected Noteholder;
(ii)
any such amendment, waiver or other modification pursuant to this Section 13.2, that would permit the creation of any Lien ranking
prior to or on a parity with the Lien created by the Indenture, the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement or any other Transaction Documents
with respect to any material portion of the Collateral or except as otherwise permitted by the Transaction Documents, terminate the Lien
created by the Indenture, the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement or any other Transaction Documents on any material portion of the Collateral
at any time subject thereto or deprive any Secured Party of any material portion of the security provided by the Lien created by the
Indenture, the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement or any other Transaction Documents shall, in each case, require the consent of each
affected Noteholder and each other affected Secured Party;
(iii)
any amendment, waiver or other modification that would (A) extend the due date for, or reduce the amount of any scheduled repayment or
prepayment of principal of, premium, if any, or interest on any Note and the other Obligations (or reduce the principal amount of, premium,
if any, or rate of interest on any Note and the other Obligations); (B) affect adversely the interests, rights or obligations of any
Noteholder individually in comparison to any other Noteholder; (C) change the provisions of the Priority of Payments; (D) change any
place of payment where, or the coin or currency in which, any Notes and the other Obligations or the interest thereon is payable; (E)
impair the right to institute suit for the enforcement of the provisions of the Indenture requiring the application of funds available
therefor, as provided in Article V, to the payment of any such amount due on the Notes and the other Obligations owing to Noteholders
on or after the respective due dates thereof, (F) subject to the ability of the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling
Class Representative) to waive certain events or modify thresholds as set forth in Section 9.7, amend or otherwise modify any
of the specific language of the following definitions: “Default,” “Event of Default,” “Potential Rapid
Amortization Event,” “Rapid Amortization Event” or “Outstanding” (as defined in the Base Indenture or any
Series Supplement); provided, that the addition to any such definitions of additional such events, and the subsequent amendment
thereof, shall not be deemed to violate this provision, or (G) amend, waive or otherwise modify this Section 13.2, in each case,
shall require the consent of each affected Noteholder and each other affected Secured Party (this clause (iii), the “Specified
Payment Amendment Provisions”); and
(iv)
any such amendment, waiver or other modification pursuant to this Section 13.2, that would change the time periods with respect
to any requirement to deliver to Noteholders notice with respect to any repayment, prepayment or redemption shall require the consent
of each affected Noteholder.
(b)
No failure or delay on the part of any Noteholder, the Trustee or any other Secured Party in exercising any power or right under the
Indenture or any other Transaction Document shall operate as a waiver thereof, nor shall any single or partial exercise of any such power
or right preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other power or right.
Section
13.3 Supplements.
Each
amendment or other modification to the Indenture, the Notes or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement shall be set forth in a Supplement,
a copy of which shall be delivered to the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative, the Manager, the Back-Up Manager, the
Trustee and the Issuer. The initial effectiveness of each Supplement shall be subject to the delivery to the Control Party and the Trustee
of an Opinion of Counsel from outside counsel that such Supplement is authorized or permitted by this Base Indenture and the conditions
precedent set forth herein with respect thereto have been satisfied. In addition to the manner provided in Sections 13.1 and 13.2,
each Series Supplement may be amended as provided in such Series Supplement.
Section
13.4 Revocation and Effect of Consents.
Until
an amendment or waiver becomes effective, a consent to it by a Noteholder of a Note is a continuing consent by the Noteholder and every
subsequent Noteholder of a Note or portion of a Note that evidences the same debt as the consenting Noteholder’s Note, even if
notation of the consent is not made on any Note. Any such Noteholder or subsequent Noteholder, however, may revoke the consent as to
their Note or portion of a Note if the Trustee receives written notice of revocation before the date the amendment or waiver becomes
effective. An amendment or waiver becomes effective in accordance with its terms and thereafter binds every Noteholder. The Issuer may
fix a record date for determining which Noteholders must consent to such amendment or waiver.
Section
13.5 Notation on or Exchange of Notes.
The
Trustee may place an appropriate notation about an amendment or waiver on any Note thereafter authenticated. The Issuer, in exchange
for all Notes, may issue and the Trustee shall authenticate new Notes that reflect the amendment or waiver. Failure to make the appropriate
notation or issue a new Note shall not affect the validity and effect of such amendment or waiver.
Section
13.6 The Trustee to Sign Amendments, etc.
The
Trustee shall sign any Supplement authorized pursuant to this Article XIII if the Supplement does not adversely affect the rights,
duties, liabilities or immunities of the Trustee. If it does, the Trustee may, but need not, sign it. In signing any Supplement, amendment,
modification or supplement to any Supplement or to any other Indenture Document, the Trustee shall be entitled to receive, if requested,
an indemnity reasonably satisfactory to it and to receive and shall be fully protected in relying upon, an Officer’s Certificate
of the Issuer and an Opinion of Counsel from outside counsel as conclusive evidence that such Supplement, amendment, modification or
supplement to any Supplement or to any other Indenture Document, is authorized or permitted by this Base Indenture and the Transaction
Documents and that all conditions precedent have been satisfied, and that it will be valid and binding upon the Issuer in accordance
with its terms.
Section
13.7 Amendments and Fees.
The
Issuer, the Control Party and the Controlling Class Representative shall negotiate any amendments, waivers or modifications to the Indenture
or the other Transaction Documents that require the consent of the Control Party or the Controlling Class Representative in good faith,
and any consent required to be given by the Control Party or the Controlling Class Representative shall not be unreasonably denied or
delayed. The Control Party and the Controlling Class Representative shall be entitled to be reimbursed by the Issuer for any reasonable
counsel fees and expenses incurred by the Control Party or the Controlling Class Representative in reviewing and approving any amendment
or in providing any consents, and except as provided in the Control Party Agreement, neither the Control Party nor the Controlling Class
Representative shall be entitled to any additional compensation in connection with any amendments or consents to this Base Indenture
or to any Transaction Document.
Article
XIV
MISCELLANEOUS
Section
14.1 Notices.
Any
notice or communication by the Issuer, the Manager or the Trustee to any other party hereto or the Control Party shall be in writing
and delivered in person, delivered by email, posted on a password protected website (for information specified in Section 4.4
only) or mailed by first-class mail (registered or certified, return receipt requested) facsimile or overnight air courier guaranteeing
next day delivery, to such other party’s address; provided, however, any notice or communication to be delivered
to the Trustee shall, if delivered by email, be delivered as a .pdf or other attachment to email including a manual authorized signature
on such attached notice or communication:
If
to the Issuer:
Twin
Hospitality I, LLC
5151
Belt Line Road, Suite 1200
Dallas,
Texas 75254
Attention:
Rob Rosen and Ken Kuick
Email:
Phone:
With
a copy (which shall not constitute notice) to:
Katten
Muchin Rosenman LLP
1919
Pennsylvania Ave. NW, Suite 800
Washington,
DC 20006
Attention:
Seth M. Messner
Email:
Phone:
If
to the Manager:
Twin
Hospitality Group Inc.
5151
Belt Line Road, Suite 1200
Dallas,
Texas 75254
Attention:
Rob Rosen and Ken Kuick
Email:
Phone:
With
a copy (which shall not constitute notice) to:
Katten
Muchin Rosenman LLP
1919
Pennsylvania Ave. NW, Suite 800
Washington,
DC 20006
Attention:
Seth M. Messner
Email:
Phone:
If
to the Back-Up Manager:
FTI
Consulting, Inc.
1168
Avenue of the Americas, 15th Floor
New
York, NY 10036
Attention:
Michael Baumkirchner
Email:
and
FTI
Consulting, Inc.
1500
Walnut Street, Suite 1515
Philadelphia,
PA 19102
Attention:
Back-Up Manager c/o Edmund Tedeschi
Facsimile:
If
to the Control Party:
Citadel
SPV LLC
85
Broad Street, 18th Floor
New
York, New York 10004
Attention:
Dewen Tarn
Email:
If
to the Trustee:
UMB
Bank, N.A.
100
William Street, Suite 1850
New
York, NY 10038
Attention:
Michele Voon
Email:
Phone:
If
to the Securitization Entities:
c/o
Twin Hospitality Group Inc.
5151
Belt Line Road, Suite 1200
Dallas,
Texas 75254
Attention:
Rob Rosen and Ken Kuick
Email:
Phone:
If
to an Enhancement Provider: At the address provided in the applicable Enhancement Agreement.
(a)
The Issuer or the Trustee by notice to each other party may designate additional or different addresses for subsequent notices or communications;
provided, however, the Issuer may not at any time designate more than a total of three (3) addresses to which notices must
be sent in order to be effective.
(b)
Any notice (i) given in person shall be deemed delivered on the date of delivery of such notice, (ii) given by first class mail shall
be deemed given five days after the date that such notice is mailed, (iii) delivered by facsimile shall be deemed given on the date of
delivery of such notice, (iv) delivered by overnight air courier shall be deemed delivered one (1) Business Day after the date that such
notice is delivered to such overnight courier, (v) when posted on a password-protected website shall be deemed delivered after notice
of such posting has been provided to the recipient and (vi) delivered by email shall be deemed delivered on the date of delivery of such
notice.
(c)
Notwithstanding any provisions of the Indenture to the contrary, the Trustee shall have no liability based upon or arising from the failure
to receive any notice required by or relating to the Indenture, the Notes or any other Transaction Document.
(d)
If the Issuer delivers a notice or communication to Noteholders, it shall deliver a copy to the Back-Up Manager, the Control Party, the
Controlling Class Representative and the Trustee at the same time.
(e)
[Reserved].
(f)
Where the Indenture provides for notice to Noteholders of any event, such notice shall be sufficiently given (unless otherwise herein
expressly provided) if sent in writing and mailed, first-class postage prepaid, to each Noteholder affected by such event, at its address
as it appears in the Note Register, not later than the latest date, and not earlier than the earliest date, prescribed (if any) for the
giving of such notice. In any case where notice to a Noteholder is given by mail, neither the failure to mail such notice, nor any defect
in any notice so mailed, to any particular Noteholder shall affect the sufficiency of such notice with respect to other Noteholders,
and any notice which is mailed in the manner herein provided shall be conclusively presumed to have been duly given. Where the Indenture
provides for notice in any manner, such notice may be waived in writing by any Person entitled to receive such notice, either before
or after the event, and such waiver shall be the equivalent of such notice. Waivers of notice by Noteholders shall be filed with the
Trustee, but such filing shall not be a condition precedent to the validity of any action taken in reliance upon such waiver. In the
case by reason of the suspension of regular mail service or by reason of any other cause it shall be impracticable to give such notice
by mail, then such notification as shall be made that is satisfactory to the Trustee shall constitute a sufficient notification for every
purpose hereunder.
(g)
Notwithstanding any other provision herein, for so long as Twin Hospitality is the Manager, any notice, communication, certificate, report,
statement or other information required to be delivered by the Manager to the Issuer, or by the Issuer to the Manager, shall be deemed
to have been delivered to both the Issuer and the Manager if the Manager has prepared or is otherwise in possession of such notice, communication,
certificate, report, statement or other information, and in no event shall the Manager or the Issuer be in breach of any delivery requirements
hereunder for constructive delivery pursuant to this Section 14.1(g).
Section
14.2 Communication by Noteholders With Other Noteholders.
Noteholders
may communicate with other Noteholders with respect to their rights under the Indenture or the Notes.
Section
14.3 Officer’s Certificate as to Conditions Precedent.
Upon
any request or application by the Issuer to the Controlling Class Representative, the Control Party or the Trustee to take any action
(other than, in the case of the Control Party or the Controlling Class Representative, any action expressly excluded from the satisfaction
of such requirement) under the Indenture or any other Transaction Document, the Issuer to the extent requested by the Controlling Class
Representative, the Control Party or the Trustee shall furnish to the Controlling Class Representative, the Control Party and the Trustee
(a) an Officer’s Certificate of the Issuer in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Controlling Class Representative,
the Control Party or the Trustee, as applicable (which shall include the statements set forth in Section 14.4), stating that all
conditions precedent and covenants, if any, provided for in the Indenture or such other Transaction Documents relating to the proposed
action have been complied with and (b) an Opinion of Counsel from outside counsel confirming the same. Such Opinion of Counsel shall
be at the expense of the Issuer.
Section
14.4 Statements Required in Certificate.
Each
Officer’s Certificate with respect to compliance with a condition or covenant provided for in the Indenture or any other Transaction
Document shall include:
(a)
a statement that the Person giving such certificate has read such covenant or condition;
(b)
a brief statement as to the nature and scope of the examination or investigation upon which the statements contained in such certificate
are based;
(c)
a statement that, in the opinion of such Person, he or she has made such examination or investigation as is necessary to enable him or
her to reach an informed opinion as to whether or not such covenant or condition has been complied with; and
(d)
a statement as to whether or not such condition or covenant has been complied with.
Section
14.5 Rules by the Trustee.
The
Trustee may make reasonable rules for action by or at a meeting of Noteholders.
Section
14.6 Benefits of Indenture.
Except
as set forth in a Series Supplement, nothing in this Base Indenture or in the Notes, expressed or implied, shall give to any Person,
other than the parties hereto and their successors hereunder and the Holders and the other Secured Parties, any benefit or any legal
or equitable right, remedy or claim under the Indenture.
Section
14.7 Timing of Payment or Performance.
In
any case where any Quarterly Payment Date, redemption date or maturity date of any Note shall not be a Business Day, then (notwithstanding
any other provision of the Indenture) payment of interest or principal (and premium, if any), as the case may be, need not be made on
such date but may be made on the next succeeding Business Day with the same force and effect as if made on the Quarterly Payment Date,
redemption date or maturity date; provided, however, that no interest shall accrue for the period from and after such Quarterly
Payment Date, redemption date or maturity date, as the case may be. In addition, if the performance of any other covenant, duty or obligation
is stated to be due or performance required on a day which is not a Business Day, the date of such performance shall extend to the next
succeeding Business Day.
Section
14.8 Governing Law.
THIS
BASE INDENTURE SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED AND INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK WITHOUT REGARD
TO CONFLICTS OF LAW PRINCIPLES (OTHER THAN SECTIONS 5-1401 AND 5-1402 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATIONS LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK).
Section
14.9 Successors.
All
agreements of the Issuer in the Indenture, the Notes and each other Transaction Document to which it is a party shall bind its successors
and assigns; provided, however, the Issuer may not assign its obligations or rights under the Indenture or any other Transaction
Document, except with the written consent of the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative). All
agreements of the Trustee in the Indenture shall bind its successors.
Section
14.10 Severability.
In
case any provision in the Indenture, the Notes or any other Transaction Document shall be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the validity,
legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions shall not in any way be affected or impaired thereby.
Section
14.11 Counterpart Originals.
The
parties may sign any number of copies of this Base Indenture. Each signed copy shall be an original, but all of them together represent
the same agreement. The exchange of copies of this Base Indenture and of signature pages by facsimile or electronic transmission shall
constitute effective execution and delivery of this Base Indenture as to the parties. Signatures of the parties hereto transmitted by
facsimile or electronic transmission shall be deemed to be their original signatures for all purposes. Facsimile, documents executed,
scanned and transmitted electronically and electronic signatures shall be deemed original signatures for purposes of this Base Indenture
and any related document, with such facsimile, scanned and electronic signatures having the same legal effect as original signatures.
The parties agree that this Base Indenture, any addendum or amendment hereto or any related document necessary may be accepted, executed
or agreed to through the use of an electronic signature in accordance with the Electronic Signatures in Global and National Commerce
Act (“E-Sign Act”), Title 15, United States Code, Sections 7001 et seq., the Uniform Electronic Transaction Act (“UETA”)
and any applicable state law. Electronic signature shall mean any electronic symbol or process attached to, or associated with, a contract
or other record and adopted by a person with the intent to sign, authenticate or accept such contract or record. Any document accepted,
executed or agreed to in conformity with such laws will be binding on all parties hereto to the same extent as if it were physically
executed and each party hereby consents to the use of any third party electronic signature capture service providers as may be reasonably
chosen by a signatory hereto.
Section
14.12 Table of Contents, Headings, etc.
The
Table of Contents and headings of the Articles and Sections of the Indenture have been inserted for convenience of reference only, are
not to be considered a part hereof, and shall in no way modify or restrict any of the terms or provisions hereof.
Section
14.13 No Bankruptcy Petition Against the Securitization Entities.
Each
of the Noteholders, the Trustee and the other Secured Parties hereby covenants and agrees that, prior to the date which is one year and
one day after the payment in full of the latest maturing Note, it will not institute against, or join with any other Person in instituting
against, any Securitization Entity any arrangement or any Insolvency proceedings, or other proceedings, under any federal or state bankruptcy
or similar law; provided, however, that nothing in this Section 14.13 shall constitute a waiver of any right to
indemnification, reimbursement or other payment from the Securitization Entities pursuant to the Indenture or any other Transaction Document.
In the event that any such Noteholder or other Secured Party or the Trustee takes action in violation of this Section 14.13, each
affected Securitization Entity shall file or cause to be filed an answer with the bankruptcy court or otherwise properly contesting the
filing of such a petition by any such Noteholder or Secured Party or the Trustee against such Securitization Entity or the commencement
of such action and raising the defense that such Noteholder or other Secured Party or the Trustee has agreed in writing not to take such
action and should be estopped and precluded therefrom and such other defenses, if any, as its counsel advises that it may assert. The
provisions of this Section 14.13 shall survive the termination of the Indenture and the resignation or removal of the Trustee.
Nothing contained herein shall preclude participation by any Noteholder or any other Secured Party or the Trustee in the assertion or
defense of its claims in any such proceeding involving any Securitization Entity.
Section
14.14 Recording of Indenture.
If
the Indenture is subject to recording in any appropriate public recording offices, such recording is to be effected by the Issuer and
at its expense.
Section
14.15 Waiver of Jury Trial.
THE
ISSUER, THE TRUSTEE AND BY ITS ACCEPTANCE OF A NOTE, EACH NOTEHOLDER, HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE
LAW, ANY AND ALL RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY LEGAL PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS BASE INDENTURE, THE NOTES, THE OTHER
TRANSACTION DOCUMENTS OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY AND THEREBY.
Section
14.16 Submission to Jurisdiction; Waivers.
The
Issuer and the Trustee hereby irrevocably and unconditionally:
(a)
submits for itself and its property in any legal action or proceeding relating to the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents to
which it is a party, or for recognition and enforcement of any judgment in respect thereof, to the non-exclusive general jurisdiction
of the courts of the State of New York, sitting in New York County, the courts of the United States for the Southern District of New
York, and appellate courts from any thereof;
(b)
consents that any such action or proceeding may be brought in such courts and waives any objection that it may now or hereafter have
to the venue of any such action or proceeding in any such court or that such action or proceeding was brought in an inconvenient court
and agrees not to plead or claim the same;
(c)
solely in the case of the Issuer, agrees that service of process in any such action or proceeding may be effected by mailing a copy thereof
by registered or certified mail (or any substantially similar form of mail), postage prepaid, to the Issuer at its address set forth
in Section 14.1 or at such other address of which the Trustee shall have been notified pursuant thereto;
(d)
agrees that nothing herein shall affect the right to effect service of process in any other manner permitted by law or shall limit the
right to sue in any other jurisdiction; and
(e)
(without limiting the Issuer’s obligations pursuant to Section 10.5) waives, to the maximum extent not prohibited by law,
any right it may have to claim or recover in any legal action or proceeding referred to in this Section 14.16 any special, exemplary,
punitive or consequential damages.
Section
14.17 Permitted Asset Dispositions; Release of Collateral.
After
consummation of a Permitted Asset Disposition, upon request of the Issuer (together with an Officer’s Certificate and an Opinion
of Counsel, each stating that such release is authorized or permitted by the terms of the Transaction Documents and that all conditions
precedent with respect thereto have been satisfied), the Trustee, at the written direction of the Control Party (acting at the direction
of the Controlling Class Representative), shall execute and deliver to the Securitization Entities any and all documentation reasonably
requested and prepared by the Securitization Entities at their expense to effect or evidence the release by the Trustee of the Secured
Parties’ security interest in the property disposed of in connection with such Permitted Asset Disposition.
Section
14.18 Calculation of Senior Leverage Ratio.
(a)
Senior Leverage Ratio and DSCR. In the event that the Securitization Entities incur, repay, repurchase or redeem any Super Senior
Notes, Senior Notes and/or Senior Subordinated Notes subsequent to the commencement of the period for which the Senior Leverage Ratio,
P&I DSCR or Interest-Only DSCR is being calculated but prior to the event for which the calculation of such ratio is made, then such
ratio shall be calculated giving pro forma effect to such incurrence, repayment, repurchase or redemption of Super Senior Notes, Senior
Notes and/or Senior Subordinated Notes, as if the same had occurred at the beginning of the applicable preceding four Quarterly Fiscal
Periods (including in the case of any incurrence or issuance, a pro forma application of the net proceeds therefrom).
For
purposes of making the computation of the Senior Leverage Ratio, P&I DSCR or Interest-Only DSCR (including, without limitation, the
calculation of Net Cash Flow used therein), investments, acquisitions, dispositions, mergers, amalgamations, consolidations and discontinued
operations (as determined in accordance with GAAP), in each case with respect to an operating unit of a business, and any restructurings
or reorganizations that any of the Securitization Entities has made during the preceding four Quarterly Fiscal Periods or subsequent
to such preceding four Quarterly Fiscal Periods and on or prior to or simultaneously with the date as of which such computation is made
(each, for purposes of this Section 14.18(a), a “pro forma event”) shall be calculated on a pro forma basis
assuming that all such investments, acquisitions, dispositions, mergers, amalgamations, consolidations, discontinued operations, restructurings
and reorganizations (and the change in Net Cash Flow resulting therefrom) had occurred on the first day of such preceding four Quarterly
Fiscal Periods. If since the beginning of such period any Person that subsequently became (or was merged into) a Securitization Entity
since the beginning of such preceding four Quarterly Fiscal Periods shall have made any investment, acquisition, disposition, merger,
consolidation, discontinued operation, restructurings or reorganizations, in each case with respect to an operating unit of a business,
that would have required adjustment pursuant to this Section 14.18(a), then the Senior Leverage Ratio, P&I DSCR or Interest-Only
DSCR (including, without limitation, the calculation of Net Cash Flow used therein), as applicable, shall be calculated giving pro forma
effect thereto for such period as if such investment, acquisition, disposition, merger, consolidation, restructurings or reorganizations
had occurred at the beginning of the applicable preceding four Quarterly Fiscal Periods.
For
purposes of making the computation of the Senior Leverage Ratio, P&I DSCR or Interest-Only DSCR (including, without limitation, the
calculation of Net Cash Flow used therein), whenever pro forma effect is to be given to any pro forma event, the pro forma calculations
shall be made in good faith by a responsible financial or accounting officer of the Manager. Any such pro forma calculation may include
adjustments appropriate, in the reasonable good faith determination of the Manager as set forth in an Officer’s Certificate delivered
to the Trustee (with respect to which the Trustee shall have no obligation of any nature whatsoever) to reflect appropriate adjustments
including (1) operating expense reductions and other operating improvements or synergies, reasonably expected to result from the applicable
pro forma event and (2) all appropriate adjustments to the calculation of “Net Cash Flow,” in the good faith determination
of the Manager. For the avoidance of doubt, if any of the calculations of the Senior Leverage Ratio, P&I DSCR or Interest-Only DSCR
described in this Section 14.18(a) is not completed by the applicable Quarterly Calculation Date, the Issuer may grant a grace
period for such calculation in its sole reasonable discretion.
[Signature
Pages Follow]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the Issuer, the Trustee and the Securities Intermediary have caused this Base Indenture to be duly executed by its respective
duly authorized officer as of the day and year first written above.
|
TWIN
HOSPITALITY I, LLC (f/k/a FAT BRANDS TWIN PEAKS I, LLC), |
|
as the Issuer |
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Robert G. Rosen |
|
Name: |
Robert
G. Rosen |
|
Title: |
Chief
Executive Officer |
|
UMB
BANK, N.A., in its capacity as Trustee and as Securities Intermediary |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Michele Voon |
|
Name: |
Michele
Voon |
|
Title: |
Senior
Vice President |
Twin
Hospitality I, LLC - Base Indenture
CONSENT
OF CONTROL PARTY:
Citadel
SPV LLC, as Control Party, hereby consents to the execution and delivery of this Indenture by the parties hereto, and as Control Party
hereby directs the Trustee to execute and deliver this Indenture.
|
Citadel
SPV LLC, in its capacity as Control Party |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Orlando Figueroa |
|
|
Name:
Orlando Figueroa |
|
|
Title:
President |
Twin
Hospitality I, LLC - Base Indenture
ANNEX
A
BASE
INDENTURE DEFINITIONS LIST
“1933
Act” means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
“1940
Act” means the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.
“Account
Agreement” means each agreement governing the establishment and maintenance of any Management Account or any other Base Indenture
Account or Series Account to the extent that any such account is not held at the Trustee.
“Account
Control Agreement” means each control agreement, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Control Party and Trustee,
pursuant to which the Trustee is granted the right to control deposits and withdrawals from, or otherwise to give instructions or entitlement
orders in respect of, a deposit and/or securities account and any lock-box related thereto.
“Accounts”
mean, collectively, the Indenture Trust Accounts, the Management Accounts and any other account subject to an Account Control Agreement.
In any instance where an Account is held at the Bank, such account shall be a segregated, non-interest bearing trust account.
“Actual
Knowledge” means the actual knowledge of (i) in the case of Twin Hospitality, in its individual capacity, any Authorized Officer
of Twin Hospitality, (ii) in the case of any Securitization Entity, any manager or director (as applicable other than an independent
director or manager) or officer of such Securitization Entity who is also an officer of Twin Hospitality described in clause (i) above,
(iii) in the case of the Manager, the Back-Up Manager or any Securitization Entity, with respect to a relevant matter or event, an Authorized
Officer of the Manager, the Back-Up Manager or such Securitization Entity, as applicable, directly responsible for managing the relevant
asset or for administering the transactions relevant to such matter or event, (iv) with respect to the Trustee, an Authorized Officer
of the Trustee responsible for administering the transactions relevant to the applicable matter or event or (v) with respect to any other
Person, any member of senior management of such Person.
“Additional
Guarantor” means an Additional Guarantor that is designated pursuant to Section 8.34 of the Base Indenture.
“Additional
IP Holder” means any entity that after the Closing Date is designated as an “Additional IP Holder” pursuant to
Section 8.34 of the Base Indenture.
“Additional
Management Account” has the meaning set forth in Section 5.1(a) of the Base Indenture.
“Additional
Payment Date” means, following the completion of a Qualified Equity Offering, the earlier to occur of (i) the immediately following
Monthly Allocation Date and (ii) the immediately following Quarterly Payment Date.
“Advance
Period” means the period (x) commencing on the date that the Manager makes a Manager Advance and (y) ending on the date the
Manager is reimbursed in full (from amounts other than Manager Advances) for all outstanding Manager Advances with interest thereon.
“Advertising
Fees” means any fees payable by Franchisees and Company Restaurant Guarantors to fund the national marketing and advertising
activities with respect to the Brands.
“Affiliate”
or “Affiliated” means, with respect to any specified Person, any other Person that, directly or indirectly through
one or more intermediaries, controls or is controlled by, or is under common control with, such specified Person. For the purposes of
this definition, “control” when used with respect to any specified Person means the power to direct the management and policies
of such Person, directly or indirectly, whether through the ownership of voting securities or other ownership or beneficial interests,
by contract or otherwise; and the terms “controlling” and “controlled” have the meanings correlative to the meaning
of “control.”
“After-Acquired
Securitization IP” means Securitization IP acquired by a Guarantor after the Closing Date pursuant to an IP License Agreement
or otherwise.
“Agent”
means any Note Registrar or Paying Agent.
“Aggregate
Outstanding Principal Amount” means the sum of the Outstanding Principal Amounts with respect to all Series of Notes.
“Allocated
Note Amount” means, as of any date of determination, an amount determined by the Manager, in its reasonable discretion taking
into account historical cash flows related to assets disposed or for which indemnified payments are due relative to the cash flows of
all other, and agreed to by the Control Party.
“Applicable
Procedures” means the provisions of the rules and procedures of DTC, the “Operating Procedures of the Euroclear System”
and “Terms and Conditions Governing Use of Euroclear” and the “General Terms and Conditions of Clearstream Banking”
and “Customer Handbook” of Clearstream, as in effect from time to time.
“ASC
842, Leases” means FASB Accounting Standards Codification Topic 842, Leases.
“Asset
Disposition Proceeds” means, the proceeds of any Permitted Asset Disposition (including all cash and cash equivalents received
as payments of the purchase price for such disposition, including, without limitation, any cash or cash equivalents received in respect
of deferred payment, or monetization of a note receivable, received as consideration for such disposition), other than (i) any proceeds,
up to $250,000 per annum, that are reinvested in Eligible Assets within three months of receipt and (ii) any proceeds resulting from
a sale-lease back transaction.
“Assumption
Agreement” has the meaning specified in Section 8.34(c) of this Base Indenture.
“Authorized
Officer” means, with respect to (i) Issuer, any officer who is authorized to act for Issuer in matters relating to Issuer,
including an Authorized Officer of the Manager or Back-Up Manager authorized to act on behalf of Issuer; (ii) Twin Hospitality, in its
individual capacity, the Chief Executive Officer, the President, the Chief Financial Officer, the General Counsel or any Senior Vice
President of Twin Hospitality or any other officer of Twin Hospitality who is directly responsible for managing the Contributed Assets
or otherwise authorized to act with respect to the subject matter of the request, certificate or order in question; (iii) the Manager,
the Chief Executive Officer, the President, the Chief Financial Officer, the General Counsel or any Senior Vice President of Twin Hospitality
or any other officer of Twin Hospitality who is directly responsible for managing the Contributed Assets or otherwise authorized to act
for the Manager in matters relating to, and binding upon, the Manager with respect to the subject matter of the request, certificate
or order in question, (iv) the Trustee or any other bank or trust company acting as trustee of an express trust or as custodian, a Trust
Officer; or (v) the Controlling Class Representative, any officer of the Controlling Class Representative who is duly authorized to act
for the Controlling Class Representative with respect to the relevant matter. Each party may receive and accept a certification of the
authority of any other party as conclusive evidence of the authority of any Person to act, and such certification may be considered as
in full force and effect until receipt by such other party of written notice to the contrary.
“Back-Up
Management Agreement” means the Back-Up Management Agreement, dated November 21, 2024, by and among the Back-Up Manager, the
Manager, the Issuer, the other Securitization Entities and the Trustee, as amended, restated, amended and restated, supplemented or otherwise
modified from time to time.
“Back-Up
Manager” means FTI Consulting, Inc., a Maryland corporation, in its capacity as Back-Up Manager (together with its permitted
successors and/or assigns in such capacity) pursuant to the Back-Up Management Agreement, and any successor Back-Up Manager.
“Back-Up
Manager Consultation Fees” has the meaning set forth in the Back-Up Management Agreement.
“Back-Up
Manager Fees” has the meaning set forth in the Back-Up Management Agreement.
“Bank”
has the meaning set forth in Section 10.2(x) of this Base Indenture.
“Bankruptcy
Code” means the Bankruptcy Reform Act of 1978, as amended from time to time, and as codified as 11 U.S.C. Section 101 et seq.
“Base
Indenture” means the Base Indenture, dated as of the Closing Date, by and among the Issuer and the Trustee, as amended, supplemented
or otherwise modified from time to time, exclusive of any Series Supplements.
“Base
Indenture Account” means any account or accounts authorized and established pursuant to the Base Indenture for the benefit
of the Secured Parties, including, without limitation, each account established pursuant to Article V of this Base Indenture.
“Base
Indenture Definitions List” has the meaning set forth in Section 1.1 of this Base Indenture.
“Beer
Distributor” means Ben E. Keith Company, a Texas corporation.
“Book-Entry
Notes” means beneficial interests in the Notes of any Series, ownership and transfers of which will be evidenced or made through
book entries by a Clearing Agency as described in Section 2.12 of this Base Indenture; provided that, after the occurrence
of a condition whereupon book-entry registration and transfer are no longer permitted and Definitive Notes are issued to the Note Owners,
such Definitive Notes will replace Book-Entry Notes.
“Branded
Restaurants” means collectively, as of any date of determination, any restaurant operated under the Twin Peaks brand or Smokey
Bones brand, including the Franchised Restaurants and the Company Restaurants.
“Brands”
means the Trademarks (words and/or design including applicable logos), alone or in combination with other words or symbols, and any variations
or derivatives, owned and/or used by each of the Guarantors.
“Business
Day” means any day other than Saturday or Sunday or other day on which commercial banks are authorized to close under the laws
of, or are in fact closed in, New York, New York, Los Angeles, California or the city in which the Corporate Trust Office of any successor
Trustee is located if so required by such successor.
“Capitalized
Lease Obligations” means the obligations of a Person to pay rent or other amounts under any lease of (or other arrangement
conveying the right to use) real or personal property, or a combination thereof, which obligations are required to be classified and
accounted for as finance leases under ASC 842, Leases on a balance sheet of such Person under GAAP and, for the purposes of the
Indenture, the amount of such obligations will be the capitalized amount thereof determined in accordance with GAAP; provided,
however, that any obligations of a Person under any lease that would have been accounted for as “operating leases”
under GAAP as in effect on December 1, 2018 shall not constitute “Capitalized Lease Obligations” hereunder irrespective of
any change to, or modification of, GAAP (including any future phase-in of changes to GAAP that have been approved as of December 1, 2018)
subsequent to December 1, 2018.
“Capped
Securitization Operating Expense Amount” means, for any Monthly Allocation Date that occurs (x) during the period beginning
on the Closing Date and ending on the date on which 12 full and consecutive Monthly Collection Periods have occurred since the Closing
Date and (y) each successive period of 12 consecutive Monthly Collection Periods after the period in (x), the amount by which $500,000
exceeds the aggregate Securitization Operating Expenses already paid during such period, provided, however, that during
any period that the Back-Up Manager is required to provide Warm Back-Up Management Duties or Hot Back-Up Management Duties pursuant to
the Back-Up Management Agreement, such amount shall automatically be increased by an additional $750,000 solely in order to provide for
the reimbursement of any increased fees and expenses incurred by the Back-Up Manager associated with the provision of such services and
the Control Party, acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative, may further increase the Capped Securitization Operating
Expense Amount as calculated above in order to take account of any additional increased fees and expenses associated with the provision
of such services; provided, further, that, in no event shall accrued and unpaid fees, expenses and indemnities payable
to the Back-Up Manager be subject to the Capped Securitization Operating Expense Amount limit if and for so long as an Event of Default
has occurred and is continuing nor shall the payment of any such fees, expenses and indemnities payable to the Back-Up Manager that were
incurred, in any such case, during any period while an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, in any such event, be subject
to the Capped Securitization Operating Expense Amount limit, regardless of whether or not an Event of Default exists at the time of such
payment.
“Carryover
Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount” means (a) for the first Monthly Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly
Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period the amount, if
any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Senior Notes Interest Payment Account with respect to the Senior Notes on the immediately
preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period was less than (ii) the Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly
Interest Amount for such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date; provided that for the first Monthly Allocation Date after the
Series Closing Date, the Carryover Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount shall equal the aggregate amount of interest accrued
on the Senior Notes for the period from the Series Closing Date until such Monthly Allocation Date.
“Carryover
Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount” means (a) for the first Monthly
Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to
such Quarterly Collection Period the amount, if any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest Account with respect to the Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest on the
immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period was less than (ii) the Senior Notes Accrued
Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount for such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date.
“Carryover
Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount” means (a) for the first Monthly Allocation
Date with respect to any Quarterly Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly
Collection Period the amount, if any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest
Account with respect to the Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest on the immediately preceding Monthly
Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period was less than (ii) the Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity
Offering Additional Interest Amount for such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date.
“Carryover
Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount” means (a) for the first Monthly Allocation Date with respect to any
Quarterly Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period the
amount, if any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Senior Notes Principal Payment Account with respect to the Senior Notes Scheduled
Principal Payment Amounts on the immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period was less
than (ii) the Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount for such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date.
“Carryover
Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount” means (a) for the first Monthly Allocation Date with respect to
any Quarterly Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period
the amount, if any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account with respect to the Senior
Subordinated Notes on the immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period was less than
(ii) the Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount for such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date; provided
that for the first Monthly Allocation Date after the applicable Series Closing Date, the Carryover Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued
Quarterly Interest Amount shall equal the aggregate amount of interest accrued on the Senior Subordinated Notes for the period from such
Series Closing Date until such Monthly Allocation Date.
“Carryover
Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount” means (a) for the first
Monthly Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect
to such Quarterly Collection Period the amount, if any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Senior Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest Account with respect to the Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional
Interest on the immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period was less than (ii) the
Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount for such immediately preceding
Monthly Allocation Date.
“Carryover
Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount” means (a) for the first Monthly
Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to
such Quarterly Collection Period the amount, if any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Senior Subordinated Notes Qualified Equity
Offering Additional Interest Account with respect to the Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest
on the immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period was less than (ii) the Senior Subordinated
Notes Accrued Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount for such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date.
“Carryover
Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount” means (a) for the first Monthly Allocation Date with
respect to any Quarterly Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection
Period the amount, if any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account with respect
to the Senior Subordinated Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts on the immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect
to such Quarterly Collection Period was less than (ii) the Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount for
such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date.
“Carryover
Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount” means (a) for the first Monthly Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly
Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period the amount, if
any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account with respect to the Subordinated Notes on the
immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period was less than (ii) the Subordinated Notes
Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount for such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date; provided that for the first Monthly Allocation
Date after the applicable Series Closing Date, the Carryover Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount shall equal the aggregate
amount of interest accrued on the Subordinated Notes for the period from such Series Closing Date until such Monthly Allocation Date.
“Carryover
Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount” means (a) for the first Monthly
Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to
such Quarterly Collection Period the amount, if any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest Account with respect to the Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest
on the immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period was less than (ii) the Subordinated
Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount for such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation
Date.
“Carryover
Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount” means: (a) for the first Monthly Allocation Date with respect
to any Quarterly Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period
the amount, if any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account with respect to the Subordinated
Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts on the immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection
Period was less than (ii) the Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount for such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation
Date.
“Carryover
Super Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount” means (a) for the first Monthly Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly
Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period the amount, if
any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account with respect to the Super Senior Notes on the
immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period was less than (ii) the Super Senior Notes
Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount for such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date; provided that for the first Monthly Allocation
Date after the applicable Series Closing Date, the Carryover Super Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount shall equal the aggregate
amount of interest accrued on the Super Senior Notes for the period from such Series Closing Date until such Monthly Allocation Date.
“Carryover
Super Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount” means (a) for the first Monthly
Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to
such Quarterly Collection Period the amount, if any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Super Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest Account with respect to the Super Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest
on the immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period was less than (ii) the Super Senior
Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount for such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation
Date.
“Carryover
Super Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount” means (a) for the first Monthly
Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to
such Quarterly Collection Period the amount, if any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Super Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering
Additional Interest Account with respect to the Super Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest on the immediately
preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period was less than (ii) the Super Senior Notes Accrued
Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount for such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date.
“Carryover
Super Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount” means (a) for the first Monthly Allocation Date with respect
to any Quarterly Collection Period, zero, and (b) for any other Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period
the amount, if any, by which (i) the amount allocated to the Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account with respect to the Super Senior
Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts on the immediately preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection
Period was less than (ii) the Super Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount for such immediately preceding Monthly Allocation
Date.
“Cash
Flow Sweeping Event” means:
(a)
any Quarterly Payment Date from the Closing Date until the Quarterly Payment Date occurring in January 2026 on which the P&I DSCR
is less than or equal to 1.35x;
(b)
any Quarterly Payment Date after the Quarterly Payment Date occurring in January 2026 on which the P&I DSCR is less than or equal
to 1.40x;
(c)
any Quarterly Payment Date from the Closing Date until the Quarterly Payment Date occurring in July 2025 on which the P&I DSCR is
less than or equal to 1.40x and greater than 1.35x;
(d)
any Quarterly Payment Date after the Quarterly Payment Date occurring in July 2025 until the Quarterly Payment Date occurring in January
2026 on which the P&I DSCR is less than or equal to 1.60x and greater than 1.35x;
(e)
any Quarterly Payment Date after the Quarterly Payment Date occurring in January 2026 on which the P&I DSCR is less than or equal
to 1.85x and greater than 1.40x;
(f)
if no other Cash Flow Sweeping Event has occurred and is continuing, the occurrence of a Level I Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event;
or
(g)
if no other Cash Flow Sweeping Event has occurred and is continuing, the occurrence of a Level II Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event.
“Cash
Flow Sweeping Period” means:
(a)
with respect to the Cash Flow Sweeping Event described in clause (a) of the definition thereof, any period that begins on any Quarterly
Payment Date on which such Cash Flow Sweeping Event occurs and ends on the first Quarterly Payment Date on which either (x) a Rapid Amortization
Period commences or (y) the P&I DSCR is greater than 1.35x;
(b)
with respect to the Cash Flow Sweeping Event described in clause (b) of the definition thereof, any period that begins on any Quarterly
Payment Date on which such Cash Flow Sweeping Event occurs and ends on the first Quarterly Payment Date on which either (x) a Rapid Amortization
Period commences or (y) the P&I DSCR is greater than 1.40x;
(c)
with respect to the Cash Flow Sweeping Event described in clause (c) of the definition thereof, any period that begins on any Quarterly
Payment Date on which such Cash Flow Sweeping Event occurs and ends on the first Quarterly Payment Date on which either (x) a Rapid Amortization
Period commences or (y) the P&I DSCR is greater than 1.40x;
(d)
with respect to the Cash Flow Sweeping Event described in clause (d) of the definition thereof, any period that begins on any Quarterly
Payment Date on which such Cash Flow Sweeping Event occurs and ends on the first Quarterly Payment Date on which either (x) a Rapid Amortization
Period commences or (y) the P&I DSCR is greater than 1.60x;
(e)
with respect to the Cash Flow Sweeping Event described in clause (e) of the definition thereof, any period that begins on any Quarterly
Payment Date on which such Cash Flow Sweeping Event occurs and ends on the first Quarterly Payment Date on which either (x) a Rapid Amortization
Period commences or (y) the P&I DSCR is greater than 1.85x;
(f)
with respect to the Cash Flow Sweeping Event described in clause (f) of the definition thereof, any period that begins on the date on
which such Cash Flow Sweeping Event occurs and ends on the date on which $25,000,000 in aggregate Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds
is used to prepay the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes; and
(g)
with respect to the Cash Flow Sweeping Event described in clause (g) of the definition thereof, any period that begins on the date on
which such Cash Flow Sweeping Event occurs and ends on the date on which $75,000,000 in aggregate Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds
is used to prepay the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes.
“Cash
Flow Sweeping Percentage” means exact portion retained for amortization on the Notes, which is dependent on the occurrence
of a Cash Flow Sweeping Event as follows:
Cash
Flow Sweeping Event | |
Cash
Flow Sweeping Percentage | |
From the Closing Date to the Quarterly
Payment Date in January 2026, P&I DSCR less than or equal to 1.35x
| |
| 100.00% | |
From and after the Quarterly Payment Date in
January 2026, P&I DSCR less than or equal to 1.40x | |
| 100.00% | |
From the Closing Date to the Quarterly Payment
Date in July 2025, P&I DSCR less than or equal to 1.40x and greater than 1.35x
| |
| 50.00% | |
From the Quarterly Payment Date in July 2025
to the Quarterly Payment Date in January 2026, P&I DSCR less than or equal to 1.60x and greater than 1.35x | |
| 50.00% | |
From and after the Quarterly Payment Date in
January 2026, P&I DSCR less than or equal to 1.85x and greater than 1.40x
| |
| 50.00% | |
If no other Cash Flow Sweeping Event has occurred
and is continuing, the occurrence and continuation of a Level I Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event | |
| 50.00% | |
If no other Cash Flow Sweeping Event has occurred
and is continuing, the occurrence and continuation of a Level II Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event | |
| 50.00% | |
“Cause”
means, with respect to an Independent Manager or Independent Director, (i) acts or omissions by such Independent Manager or Independent
Director, as applicable, constituting fraud, dishonesty, negligence, misconduct or other similar deliberate action which causes injury
to any Securitization Entity or an act by such Independent Manager or Independent Director, as applicable, involving moral turpitude
or a serious crime, (ii) that such Independent Manager or Independent Director, as the case may be, no longer meets the definition of
“Independent Manager” or “Independent Director”, as applicable, as set forth in the applicable Securitization
Entity’s Charter Documents, (iii) the death or incapacity of such Independent Manager or Independent Director, as the case may
be, or (iv) any other reason for which the prior written consent of Trustee (acting at the written direction of the Control Party) shall
have been obtained.
“Charter
Document” means, with respect to any entity and at any time, the certificate of incorporation, certificate of formation, operating
agreement, limited liability company agreements, by-laws, memorandum of association, articles of association, or such other similar document,
as applicable to such entity in effect at such time.
“Class”
means, with respect to any Series of Notes, any one of the classes of Notes of such Series as specified in the Series Supplement.
“Class
A-2-I Notes” means any Notes alphanumerically designated as “Class A-2-I” pursuant to the Series Supplement applicable
to such Class of Notes.
“Class
A-2-II Notes” means any Notes alphanumerically designated as “Class A-2-II” pursuant to the Series Supplement applicable
to such Class of Notes.
“Class
B-2 Notes” means any Notes alphanumerically designated as “Class B-2” pursuant to the Series Supplement applicable
to such Class of Notes.
“Class
M-2 Notes” means any Notes alphanumerically designated as “Class M-2” pursuant to the Series Supplement applicable
to such Class of Notes.
“Clearing
Agency” means an organization registered as a “clearing agency” pursuant to Section 17A of the Exchange Act or
any successor provision thereto or Euroclear or Clearstream.
“Clearing
Agency Participant” means a broker, dealer, bank, other financial institution or other Person for whom from time to time a
Clearing Agency effects book-entry transfers and pledges of securities deposited with the Clearing Agency.
“Clearstream”
means Clearstream Luxembourg.
“Closing
Date” means November 21, 2024.
“Closing
Title Reports” means title commitments for each New Owned Real Property.
“Code”
means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.
“Collateral”
means, collectively, the Indenture Collateral, the “Collateral” as defined in the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and
any property subject to any other Indenture Document that grants a Lien to secure any Obligations.
“Collateral
Documents” means, collectively, the Collateral Franchise Business Documents and the Collateral Transaction Documents.
“Collateral
Exclusions” means the following property of the Securitization Entities: (i) the Franchised Restaurant Leases, (ii) any other
any lease, sublease, license, or other contract or permit, in each case if the grant of a lien or security interest in any of the Securitization
Entities’ right, title and interest in, to or under such lease, sublease, license, contract or permit in the manner contemplated
by this Indenture (a) is prohibited by the terms of such lease, sublease, license, contract or permit or would require the consent of
a third party, (b) would constitute or result in the abandonment, invalidation or unenforceability of any right, title or interest of
the applicable Securitization Entity therein or (c) would otherwise result in a breach thereof or the termination or a right of termination
thereof, except to the extent that any such prohibition, breach, termination or right of termination is rendered ineffective pursuant
to the UCC or any other applicable law and (iii) the Excluded Amounts; provided, further, that the Issuer and the Guarantors will not
be required to pledge more than 65% of the Equity Interests (and any rights associated with such Equity Interests) of any foreign subsidiary
of any of the Issuer or the Guarantors that is a corporation for United States federal income tax purposes and in no circumstance will
any such foreign subsidiary be required to pledge any assets, serve as Guarantor, or otherwise guarantee the Notes; provided further
that the security interest in (A) each Series Distribution Account and the funds or securities deposited therein or credited thereto
will only secure the related Class of Notes as set forth in the Indenture and (B) the Reserve Account and the funds or securities deposited
therein or credited thereto shall only be for the benefit of the Super Senior Noteholders, Senior Noteholders, the Senior Subordinated
Noteholders and the Trustee, in its capacity as trustee for the Super Senior Noteholders, the Senior Noteholders and the Senior Subordinated
Noteholders.
“Collateral
Franchise Business Documents” means, collectively, the Franchise Documents, the Franchisee Notes, the Equipment Leases, the
Product Sourcing Agreements and the Company Restaurant Licenses.
“Collateral
Transaction Documents” means the Contribution Agreement, the equity interests (including any certificates evidencing such interests)
issued under the Charter Documents of each Securitization Entity, the Control Party Agreement, the Account Control Agreements, the Management
Agreement, the Back-Up Management Agreement and the IP License Agreements.
“Collection
Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o the Secured
Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Collection Account” maintained by the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties pursuant
to Section 5.4 of this Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.4 of this Base
Indenture.
“Collection
Account Administrative Accounts” has the meaning set forth in Section 5.5 of this Base Indenture.
“Collections”
means, with respect to each Monthly Collection Period, all amounts received by or for the account of (or in the case of ACH or similar
transactions, amounts remitted via ACH or similar transactions to or for the account of but net of any Reversed ACH Remittance) the Issuer
during such Monthly Collection Period, including (without duplication):
(i)
distributions from the Guarantors (including all Guarantor Collections);
(ii)
all license fees and other amounts received in respect of the Securitization IP, including recoveries from the enforcement of the Securitization
IP;
(iii)
Product Sourcing Payments, Indemnification Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds, Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds, Asset Disposition
Proceeds, and (without duplication) all other amounts received upon the disposition of the Collateral, including proceeds received upon
the disposition of property expressly excluded from the definition of Asset Disposition Proceeds, in each case that are required to be
deposited into the Concentration Account or the Collection Account;
(iv)
Investment Income earned on amounts on deposit in the Accounts;
(v)
equity contributions made to the Issuer by the Manager or any other Person;
(vi)
to the extent not otherwise included above, payments from Guarantors or any other Person (except in respect of Excluded Amounts) deposited
in the Concentration Account or otherwise included in Collections;
(vii)
amounts released from the Reserve Account; and
(vii)
any other payments or proceeds received with respect to the Collateral.
“Company
Order” and “Company Request” mean a written order or request signed in the name of the Issuer by any Authorized
Officer of the Issuer and delivered to the Trustee, the Control Party or the Paying Agent, as applicable.
“Company
Restaurant Account” has the meaning set forth in the Management Agreement.
“Company
Restaurant Asset” means all of the assets owned by a Company Restaurant Guarantor associated with owning and operating the
Company Restaurants (such as furnishings, cooking equipment, cooking supplies and computer equipment).
“Company
Restaurant Collections” means all cash revenues (including gift card redemption amounts, but excluding proceeds of the initial
sale of gift cards), credit card and debit card proceeds generated by Company Restaurants including Pass-Through Amounts.
“Company
Restaurant Build-Out” means, with respect to any Real Estate Asset, Company Restaurant or Prospective Company Restaurant Property,
any construction, refurbishment or conversion activities and costs, fees and expenses and any related financings incurred in connection
therewith.
“Company
Restaurant Guarantors” means (i) TP Franchise Austin, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (ii) TP Franchise Round Rock,
LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (iii) Twin Restaurant Amarillo, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (iv) Twin Restaurant
Broomfield, LLC, a Colorado limited liability company; (v) Twin Restaurant Burleson, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (vi) Twin
Restaurant Centennial, LLC, a Colorado limited liability company; (vii) Twin Restaurant Denver, LLC, a Colorado limited liability company;
(viii) Twin Restaurant Denver, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (ix) Twin Restaurant El Paso, LLC, a Texas limited liability company;
(x) Twin Restaurant Frisco, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xi) Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie, LLC, a Texas limited liability
company; (xii) Twin Restaurant Lewisville, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xiii) Twin Restaurant Little Rock, LLC, an Arkansas
limited liability company; (xiv) Twin Restaurant Live Oak, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xv) Twin Restaurant LV -2, LLC, a
Nevada limited liability company; (xvi) Twin Restaurant Midland, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xvii) Twin Restaurant N Irving,
LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xviii) Twin Restaurant Oakbrook, LLC, an Illinois limited liability company; (xix) Twin Restaurant
Odessa, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xx) Twin Restaurant Park North, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxi) Twin Restaurant
S Fort Worth, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxii) Twin Restaurant San Angelo, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxiii)
Twin Restaurant San Antonio, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxiv) Twin Restaurant San Marcos, LLC, a Texas limited liability
company; (xxv) Twin Restaurant Sunland Park, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxvi) Twin Restaurant Warrenville, LLC, an Illinois
limited liability company; (xxvii) Twin Restaurant Western Center, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxviii) Twin Restaurant Westover,
LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxix) TPJV2, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xxx) Twin Restaurant Brandon, LLC,
a Delaware limited liability company; (xxxi) Twin Restaurant JV Management, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xxxii) Twin Restaurant
Lakeland, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xxxiii) Twin Restaurant McKinney, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xxxiv)
Twin Restaurant Northlake, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxxv) Twin Restaurant Plano, LLC, a Texas limited liability company;
(xxxvi) Twin Restaurant Terrell, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xxxvii) Barbeque Integrated, Inc., a Delaware corporation;
(xxxviii) Twin Restaurant Sarasota, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; and (xxxix) any Additional Guarantor that is designated
as a “Company Restaurant Guarantor.”
“Company
Restaurant Leases” means the leases from landlords related to properties on which Company Restaurants are located that were
contributed to, distributed to or otherwise acquired by a Company Restaurant Guarantor on or prior to the Series 2024-1 Closing Date.
“Company
Restaurant Licenses” means any IP license granted by a Franchise Entity with respect to a Company Restaurant.
“Company
Restaurant Royalty Payments” means the royalty payments paid by the Company Restaurant Guarantors to the Concentration Account
pursuant to the Management Agreement in an amount equal to 5% of Company Restaurant Collections.
“Company
Restaurants” means any Branded Restaurant(s) that are owned and operated by one or more Securitization Entity, including Branded
Restaurants that a Securitization Entity reacquires from Franchisees from time to time.
“Competitor”
means any Person that is a direct or indirect franchisor, franchisee, owner or operator of a large regional or national casual dining
or family dining restaurant concept (including a Franchisee); provided, however, that (i) a Person will not be a Competitor
solely by virtue of its direct or indirect ownership of less than 5% of the Equity Interests in a “Competitor,” (ii) a Person
will not be a “Competitor” if such Person has policies and procedures that prohibit such Person from disclosing or making
available any confidential information that such Person may receive as a Holder of the Notes or prospective investor in the Notes, to
individuals involved in the business of buying, selling, holding or analyzing the Equity Interests of a “Competitor” or in
the business of being a franchisor, franchisee, owner or operator of a large regional or national casual dining or family dining restaurant
concept and (iii) a franchisee will only be a “Competitor” if it, or its Affiliates, directly or indirectly, owns, franchises
or licenses, in the aggregate, ten or more individual locations of a particular concept.
“Concentration
Account” means the account maintained in the name of Issuer and pledged to the Trustee into which the Manager causes amounts
to be deposited pursuant to Section 5.9(a) of the Base Indenture or any successor or additional such account established for Issuer
by the Manager for such purpose pursuant to the Base Indenture and the Management Agreement, including any investment accounts related
thereto into which funds are transferred for investment purposes pursuant to Section 5.1(b) of the Base Indenture.
“Consent
Agreements” mean, collectively, the (i) Sysco Approved Distributor Agreement; (ii) Lease Agreement, effective as of July 27,
2012, by and between CNL Net Lease Funding 2001, LP and Twin Restaurant Centennial LLC, as amended by the First Amendment of Lease Agreement,
made effective as of May 2017, by and between SCF RC Funding I LLC and Twin Restaurant Centennial, LLC and the Assignment and Assumption
of Lease Documents, effective as of June 16, 2016, by and between CNL APF Partners, LP and SCFRC-HW-G LLC; (iii) Lease Agreement, made
and entered into as of November 1, 2012, by and between the Fountains at Farah, LP and Twin Restaurant Investment Company, LLC; (iv)
Lease, entered into on November 9, 2011, by and between DDR Flatiron LLC and Twin Restaurant Broomfield, LLC; (v) Shopping Center Retail
Lease, dated April 23, 2013, by and between Park Place III, LLC and Twin Restaurant LV -2 LLC; and (vi) Lease Agreement, effective as
of April 12, 2012, by and between DDR MDT MacArthur Marketplace LP and Twin Restaurant North Irving, LLC, as terminated by that certain
termination notice, as reinstated by that certain Agreement Reinstating and Amending Lease dated June 26, 2012, as amended by that certain
Second Amendment to Lease dated August 16, 2012, as further amended by that certain Third Amendment to Lease dated October 4, 2012, as
further amended by that certain Fourth Amendment to Lease dated December 14, 2012, as further amended by that certain Fifth Amendment
to Lease dated April 24, 2013, as further amended by that certain Sixth Amendment to Lease dated May 1, 2013, as further amended by that
certain Seventh Amendment to Lease dated December 11, 2017 and as further amended by that certain Eighth Amendment to Lease dated April
16, 2020.
“Consent
Recommendation” means the action recommended by the Control Party in writing with respect to any Consent Request.
“Consent
Request” means any request for directions, waivers, amendments, consents and other actions under the Transaction Documents.
“Consolidated
Interest Expense” means, with respect to Twin Hospitality for any period, consolidated interest expense, whether paid or accrued,
of Twin Hospitality and the Securitization Entities, as determined in accordance with GAAP for such period.
“Consolidated
Net Income” means, with respect to Twin Hospitality for any period, the consolidated net income of Twin Hospitality and the
Securitization Entities (whether positive or negative), determined in accordance with GAAP, for such period, including, without limitation,
Twin Hospitality’s equity in the net income of any of its Subsidiaries that are not Securitization Entities to the extent of cash
actually distributed by such Subsidiaries during such period to Twin Hospitality as a dividend or other distribution.
“Contingent
Obligation” means, as applied to any Person, any direct or indirect liability, contingent or otherwise, of that Person, without
duplication, (a) with respect to any indebtedness, lease, declared but unpaid dividends, letter of credit or other obligation of another
if the primary purpose or intent thereof by the Person incurring the Contingent Obligation is to provide assurance to the obligee of
such obligation of another that such obligation of another will be paid or discharged, or that any agreements relating thereto will be
complied with, or that the holders of such obligation will be protected (in whole or in part) against loss in respect thereof or (b)
under any letter of credit issued for the account of that Person or for which that Person is otherwise liable for reimbursement thereof.
Contingent Obligation will include (x) the direct or indirect guarantee, endorsement (otherwise than for collection or deposit in the
ordinary course of business), co-making, discounting with recourse or sale with recourse by such Person of the obligation of another
and (y) any liability of such Person for the obligations of another through any agreement (contingent or otherwise) (i) to purchase,
repurchase or otherwise acquire such obligation or any security therefor, or to provide funds for the payment or discharge of such obligation
(whether in the form of loans, advances, stock purchases, capital contributions or otherwise), (ii) to maintain the solvency of any balance
sheet item, level of income or financial condition of another or (iii) to make take-or-pay or similar payments if required regardless
of non-performance by any other party or parties to an agreement, if in the case of any agreement described under subclause (i)
or (ii) of this clause (y) the primary purpose or intent thereof is as described in the preceding sentence. The amount
of any Contingent Obligation will be equal to the amount of the obligation so guaranteed or otherwise supported. The amount of any Person’s
obligation under any Contingent Obligation shall (subject to any limitation set forth therein) be deemed equal to the lesser of (1) the
stated or determinable amount of the primary obligation in respect of which such Contingent Obligation is made or, if not stated or if
indeterminable, the maximum reasonably anticipated liability in respect thereof, and (2) the stated amount of the guaranty.
“Contractual
Obligation” means, with respect to any Person, any provision of any security issued by that Person or of any indenture, mortgage,
deed of trust, contract, undertaking, agreement or other instrument to which that Person is a party or by which it or any of its properties
is bound or to which it or any of its properties is subject.
“Contributed
Assets” means all assets sold and/or contributed under the Contribution Agreement (TP Buyer), the Contribution Agreement (SB
Equity) or the Sale and Contribution Agreement (Issuer).
“Contribution
Agreement” or “Contribution Agreements” means the Contribution Agreement (TP Buyer), Contribution Agreement
(SB Equity) and/or the Sale and Contribution Agreement (Issuer), as applicable.
“Contribution
Agreement (SB Equity)” means the Contribution Agreement, dated as of March 21, 2024, between FAT Brands and the Issuer, pertaining
to the equity of Barbeque Integrated, Inc., a Delaware corporation.
“Contribution
Agreement (TP Buyer)” means the Contribution Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2021, between the Issuer and FAT Brands, pertaining
to Twin Peaks Buyer, LLC.
“Controlled
Group” means any group of trades or businesses (whether or not incorporated) under common control within the meaning of Section
4001(b)(1) of ERISA that is treated as a single employer for purposes of Section 302 or Title IV of ERISA.
“Control
Party” means, Citadel SPV LLC or its successors and permitted assigns, as Control Party under the Control Party Agreement,
and any successor thereto.
“Control
Party Agreement” means the Control Party Agreement, dated November 21, 2024, by and among the Control Party and the Issuer,
as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.
“Control
Party Termination Event” means the resignation or removal of the Control Party in its capacity as Control Party pursuant to
the terms of the Control Party Agreement.
“Controlling
Class” means the most senior Class of Notes by alphanumeric designation then Outstanding among all Series of Notes then Outstanding
for which purpose the Super Senior Notes and the Senior Notes as the initial Controlling Class will be treated as a single Class.
“Controlling
Class Member” means, with respect to a Note issued in book-entry form of the Controlling Class, a Note Owner of such Note and,
with respect to a Note issued in physical, definitive form of the Controlling Class, a Noteholder of such Note issued in physical, definitive
form (excluding, in each case, any Securitization Entity or Affiliate thereof; provided that the Trustee shall not be deemed to have
knowledge of the identity of any Noteholder or Note Owner unless the Trustee has Actual Knowledge of such ownership or a Trust Officer
of the Trustee has received written notice of such ownership).
“Controlling
Class Representative” means a representative of the Noteholders of the Controlling Class selected by the Majority of Controlling
Class; provided, that the Majority of Controlling Class shall have all privileges of and may assume and exercise all of the rights and
remedies of the Controlling Class Representative at any time; provided further that, upon any dispute between the Controlling Class Representative
and the Majority of Controlling Class, a written direction from the Majority of Controlling Class shall control. For the avoidance of
doubt, “Controlling Class Representative” shall be deemed to include under this Base Indenture and the other Transaction
Documents the Majority of Controlling Class acting in its capacity pursuant to Section 1.4(m) hereof.
“Copyrights”
has the meaning set forth in the definition of “Intellectual Property.”
“Corporate
Trust Office” means the corporate trust office of the Trustee (a) for Note transfer purposes and presentment of the Notes for
final payment thereon, UMB Bank, N.A., 928 Grand Blvd., Mailstop 1010903, Kansas City, MO 64106, Attention: Corporate Trust Bond Ops
and (b) for all other purposes, UMB Bank, N.A., 100 William Street, Suite 1850, New York, NY 10038, Attention: Michele Voon, Email: xxxxxxxx
or such other address as the Trustee may designate from time to time by notice to the Holders and the Issuer or the principal corporate
trust office of any successor Trustee.
“Covenant-Adjusted
EBITDA” means, with respect to Twin Hospitality for any period, the Consolidated Net Income Twin Hospitality and the Securitization
Entities for such period:
(a)
plus, without duplication, the following to the extent deducted in calculating such Consolidated Net Income:
(i)
Consolidated Interest Expense;
(ii)
net loss attributable to asset dispositions not in the ordinary course of business or early extinguishment of Indebtedness or Swap Contracts;
(iii)
stock based compensation expense;
(iv)
closure and impairment losses on assets;
(v)
depreciation and amortization expense;
(vi)
Transaction Expenses;
(vii)
expenses or charges related to any actual or contemplated acquisition or disposition (excluding de minimis acquisitions or dispositions),
issuance of Equity Interests, recapitalization or incurrence or repayment of Indebtedness (in each case, whether or not successful);
(viii)
net losses (or similar charges) resulting from currency translation;
(ix)
charges, fees, expenses, costs, accruals or reserves of any kind arising from litigation or claim settlement, including, without limitation,
all related legal fees, disbursements and expenses and costs of defense;
(x)
costs incurred in connection with franchise conventions;
(xi)
board of directors fees and expenses;
(xii)
closed store expenses, lease buy-out expenses, remodel reopening expenses, and new restaurant opening and pre-opening expenses;
(xiii)
current and/or deferred taxes based on income, profits or capital of such Person and its Subsidiaries, including without limitation U.S.
federal, state, local, foreign, franchise, excise, withholding and similar taxes and foreign withholding taxes (including penalties and
interest related to such taxes or arising from tax examination);
(xiv)
net losses related to any brand national advertising fund deficit;
(xv)
all noncash losses, charges and expenses; and
(xvi)
other extraordinary, unusual or nonrecurring losses, expenses or charges, including without limitation:
(A)
any severance, relocation, reorganization or other restructuring expenses,
(B)
any expenses related to reconstruction, decommissioning, recommissioning or reconfiguration of fixed assets for alternative uses,
(C)
inventory optimization programs,
(D)
facility, office, store, restaurant or business unit closures or consolidations,
(E)
systems establishment costs,
(F)
contract termination costs,
(G)
curtailments or modifications to pension and post-retirement employee benefit plans,
(H)
excess pension charges,
(I)
acquisition integration costs,
(J)
business optimization costs,
(K)
signing, retention or recruiting bonuses and expenses, or
(L)
any losses, expenses or charges related to liability or casualty events or business interruption, and
(b)
minus, without duplication, to the extent added in calculating such Consolidated Net Income,
(i)
net gain attributable to asset dispositions not in the ordinary course of business or early extinguishment of Indebtedness or Swap Contracts;
(ii)
net gain (or similar credits) resulting from currency translation;
(iii)
net gain related to any brand national advertising fund excess and
(iv)
other unusual or nonrecurring items;
provided,
however, that items that would have been accounted for as “operating leases” under GAAP as in effect on December 1,
2018 will continue to be treated as “operating leases” for purposes of this definition irrespective of any change to, or
modification of, GAAP (including any future phase-in of changes to GAAP that have been approved as of December 1, 2018) subsequent to
December 1, 2018.
“Debt
Service” means, with respect to any Quarterly Payment Date, the sum of (A) the Super Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount
plus of (B) the Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount plus (C) the Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount
plus (D) with respect to each Class of Super Senior Notes, Senior Notes and Senior Subordinated Notes Outstanding, the aggregate
amount of Scheduled Principal Payments that would be due and payable on such Quarterly Payment Date, as ratably reduced by the aggregate
amount of any payments of Indemnification Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds, Asset Disposition Proceeds or Qualified Equity Offering
Proceeds, after giving effect to any optional or mandatory prepayment of principal of any such Super Senior Notes, Senior Notes or Senior
Subordinated Notes or any repurchase and cancellation of such Super Senior Notes, Senior Notes or Senior Subordinated Notes. For the
purposes of calculating the P&I DSCR as of the first Quarterly Payment Date after the Closing Date, Debt Service will be deemed to
be the sum of (1) the product of (x) the sum of the amounts referred to in clauses (A) through (D) of the preceding
sentence multiplied by (y) a fraction the numerator of which is 90 and the denominator of which is the actual number of days elapsed
during the period commencing on and including the Closing Date and ending on but excluding the first Quarterly Payment Date, plus
(2) the amount referred to in clause (D) of the preceding sentence.
“Default”
means any Event of Default or any occurrence that with notice or the lapse of time or both would become an Event of Default.
“Defeased
Series” has the meaning set forth in Section 12.1(c) of this Base Indenture.
“Definitive
Notes” has the meaning set forth in Section 2.12(a) of this Base Indenture.
“Depository”
has the meaning set forth in Section 2.12(a) of this Base Indenture.
“Development
Agreement” means a development agreement for Branded Restaurants pursuant to which a Franchisee, developer or other Person
obtains the rights to develop (in order to operate as a Franchisee) one or more Branded Restaurants within a designated geographical
area.
“Disclosure
Exceptions” has the meaning set forth in Section 8.10 of the Base Indenture.
“Distribution
Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o the Secured
Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Distribution Account” maintained by the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties pursuant
to Section 5.5(d) of this Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5(d) of this
Base Indenture.
“Distribution
Center Expenses” means real estate taxes, lease payments or other expenses with respect to the Brewery or any similar facility
owned or leased by any Securitization Entity.
“Distribution
Operating Expenses” means all reasonable operating expenses related to the distribution of Products by any Distributor that
have not been previously reimbursed or paid.
“Distributor”
means any distributor (including the Beer Distributor) of Products to Franchisees, Company Restaurants or any other Persons.
“Distributor
Costs of Goods Sold” means, with respect to any Monthly Collection Period, any costs of goods sold actually paid by any Distributor
during such Monthly Collection Period.
“Distributor
Franchisee Rebates” means, with respect to any Monthly Collection Period, any rebates actually paid by any Distributor to a
Franchisee in respect of the purchase of Products during such Monthly Collection Period.
“Dollar”
and the symbol “$” or “U.S.$” or “U.S. Dollar” means the lawful currency of the United States.
“DTC”
means the Depository Trust Company.
“E-Sign
Act” has the meaning set forth in Section 14.11 of this Base Indenture.
“Eligible
Account” means (a) a segregated identifiable trust account established in the trust department of a Person meeting the criteria
set forth in Section 10.8(a) or (b) a separately identifiable deposit or securities account established at a Qualified Institution.
“Eligible
Assets” means any real property or other asset used or useful to the Securitization Entities in the operation of its business
or their other assets, including, without limitation, (i) capital assets, capital expenditures, renovations and improvements and (ii)
assets intended to generate revenue for the Securitization Entities.
“Eligible
Investments” means (a) time deposits with, or insured certificates of deposit or bankers’ acceptances of, any commercial
bank or trust company that (i) is organized under the laws of the United States of America, any state thereof or the District of Columbia
or is the principal banking subsidiary of a bank holding company organized under the laws of the United States of America, any state
thereof or the District of Columbia, and is a member of the Federal Reserve System, (ii) whose short-term debt is rated at least “P-1”
(or then equivalent grade) by Moody’s and at least “A 1+” (or then equivalent grade) by S&P and (iii) has combined
capital and surplus of at least $1,000,000,000, in each case with maturities of not more than one year from the date of acquisition thereof;
(b) readily marketable obligations issued or directly and fully guaranteed or insured by the United States of America or any agency or
instrumentality thereof having maturities of not more than one year from the date of acquisition thereof; provided, that the full
faith and credit of the United States of America is pledged in support thereof; (c) commercial paper issued by any Person organized under
the laws of any state of the United States of America and rated at least “P-1” (or the then equivalent grade) by Moody’s
and at least “A 1+” (or the then equivalent grade) by S&P, with maturities of not more than 180 days from the date of
acquisition thereof; (d) repurchase obligations with a term of not more than 30 days for underlying securities of the type described
in clauses (a) and (b) above entered into with any financial institution meeting the qualifications specified in clause
(a) above and (e) investments, classified in accordance with GAAP as current assets of the relevant Person making such investment,
in money market investment programs registered under the 1940 Act, which have the highest rating obtainable from either Moody’s
or S&P, and the portfolios of which are invested primarily in investments of the character, quality and maturity described in clauses
(a) though (d) of this definition. Notwithstanding the foregoing, all Eligible Investments must either (A) be at all times
available for withdrawal or liquidation at par (or for commercial paper issued at a discount, at the applicable purchase price) or (B)
mature on or prior to the Business Day prior to the immediately succeeding Monthly Allocation Date or Quarterly Payment Date, as applicable.
“Employer
Guarantors” means (i) Twin Restaurant Investment Company, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, (ii) Twin Restaurant Investment
Company II, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, (iii) Twin Restaurant, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, (iv) Twin Restaurant
Warrenville, LLC, an Illinois limited liability company, (v) Twin Restaurant LV -2, LLC, a Nevada limited liability company, (vi) Twin
Restaurant Little Rock, LLC, an Arkansas limited liability company, (vii) Twin Peaks Buyer, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company,
(viii) Twin Restaurant FL Payroll, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, and/or (ix) Barbeque Integrated, Inc., a Delaware corporation.
“Enhancement”
means, with respect to any Series of Notes, the rights and benefits provided to the Noteholders of such Series of Notes pursuant to any
letter of credit, surety bond, cash collateral account, spread account, guaranteed rate agreement, maturity guaranty facility, tax protection
agreement, interest rate swap or any other similar arrangement entered into by the Issuer in connection with the issuance of such Series
of Notes as provided for in the Series Supplement in accordance with the terms of this Base Indenture.
“Enhancement
Agreement” means any contract, agreement, instrument or document governing the terms of any Enhancement or pursuant to which
any Enhancement is issued or outstanding.
“Enhancement
Provider” means the Person providing any Enhancement as designated in the Series Supplement.
“Environmental
Law” means any and all applicable laws, rules, orders, regulations, statutes, ordinances, binding guidelines, codes, decrees,
agreements or other legally enforceable requirements (including common law) of any international authority, foreign government, the United
States, or any state, local, municipal or other governmental authority, regulating, relating to or imposing liability or standards of
conduct concerning protection of the environment or of human health (as it relates to exposure to Materials of Environmental Concern),
or employee health and safety (as it relates to exposure to Materials of Environmental Concern), as has been, is now, or may at any time
hereafter be, in effect.
“Environmental
Permits” means any and all permits, licenses, approvals, registrations, notifications, exemptions and other authorizations
required under any Environmental Law.
“Equipment
Lease” means any equipment lease pursuant to which a Franchisee leases from a Securitization Entity equipment used to operate
a Branded Restaurant, together with any residual interest in the related equipment and any security interest in such equipment.
“Equipment
Lease Payments” means all amounts payable to a Guarantor by a Franchisee pursuant to an Equipment Lease.
“Equity
Interests” means any (a) membership interest in any limited liability company, (b) general or limited partnership interest
in any partnership, (c) common, preferred or other stock interest in any corporation, (d) share, participation, unit or other interest
in the property or enterprise of an issuer that evidences ownership rights therein, (e) ownership or beneficial interest in any trust,
(f) option, warrant or other right to convert any interest into or otherwise receive any of the foregoing or (g) any other interest or
participation that confers the right to receive a share of the profits and losses of, or distributions of assets of, the applicable issuer.
“ERISA”
means the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended.
“Euroclear”
means Euroclear Bank, S.A./N.V., or any successor thereto, as operator of the Euroclear System.
“Event
of Bankruptcy” means an event that will be deemed to have occurred with respect to a Person if:
(a)
a case or other proceeding is commenced, without the application or consent of such Person, in any court, seeking the liquidation, reorganization,
debt arrangement, dissolution, winding up, or composition or readjustment of debts of such Person, the appointment of a trustee, receiver,
custodian, liquidator, assignee, sequestrator or the like for such Person or all or any substantial part of its assets, or any similar
action with respect to such Person under any law relating to bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, winding up or composition or adjustment
of debts, and such case or proceeding continues undismissed, or unstayed and in effect, for a period of sixty (60) consecutive days;
or an order for relief in respect of such Person is entered in an involuntary case under the federal bankruptcy laws or other similar
laws now or hereafter in effect; or
(b)
such Person commences a voluntary case or other proceeding under any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, debt arrangement,
dissolution or other similar law now or hereafter in effect, or consents to the appointment of or taking possession by a receiver, liquidator,
assignee, trustee, custodian, sequestrator (or other similar official) for such Person or for any substantial part of its property, or
makes any general assignment for the benefit of creditors; or
(c)
the board of directors or board of managers (or similar body) of such Person votes to implement any of the actions set forth in clause
(b) above.
“Event
of Default” means any of the events set forth in Section 9.2 of this Base Indenture.
“Excess
Amounts” means, as of any date of determination, so long as no Event of Default, Rapid Amortization Event, or Cash Flow Sweeping
Event has occurred and is continuing, the positive amount, if any, which the Manager has elected to withdraw from the Concentration Account
or the Collection Account, equal to or less than the following: (i) the amounts on deposit in the Concentration Account and the Collection
Account less (ii) the aggregate amounts necessary, in the reasonable judgment of the Manager, to satisfy clauses (i) through (xxv) of
the Priority of Payments on the next applicable Monthly Allocation Date. For the avoidance of doubt, Excess Amounts shall not be permitted
with respect to the payment of any dividends or any other distribution, whether in cash, property, securities or otherwise.
“Exchange
Act” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.
“Exchange
Notes” has the meaning specified in the Series Supplement.
“Exchangeable
Combination” has the meaning specified in the Series Supplement.
“Exchangeable
Notes” has the meaning specified in the Series Supplement.
“Excluded
Amounts” means (i) Advertising Fees, (ii) fees and expenses paid by or on behalf of any Guarantor in connection with registering,
maintaining and enforcing the Securitization IP and paying third party licensing and subscription fees, or any other fees, expenses or
costs in connection with indemnification obligations and other obligations under any other license, (iii) account expenses and fees paid
to the banks at which the Management Accounts are held, (iv) insurance and condemnation proceeds payable by the Securitization Entities
to Franchisees, (v) withholding, sales and other taxes (if any) included in Collections that are due and payable to a Governmental Authority
or other unaffiliated third party, (vi) amounts paid by Guarantors for corporate services provided by unaffiliated third parties to the
Manager, including, without limitation, repairs and maintenance, gift card administration, asset development services and employee training,
(vii) proceeds of directors’ and officers’ insurance, (viii) any amounts that cannot be transferred to the Concentration
Account or the Collection Account due to applicable law, (ix) [reserved], (x) equity proceeds, (xi) insurance and condemnation proceeds
payable by the Securitization Entities to third parties or by Franchisees to the Manager or the Securitization Entities, (xii) rebates,
credits and any other amounts paid by or on behalf of the Manager to any Franchisee in connection with any Rebate Agreement or agreements
related thereto, (xiii) Distributor Costs of Goods Sold, Distribution Operating Expenses, Distributor Franchisee Rebates and Distribution
Center Expenses, (xiv) amounts paid by Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie, LLC and Twin Restaurant Burleson, LLC representing contractual
obligations to pay up to 3% of net taxable income of Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie, LLC and Twin Restaurant Burleson, LLC, respectively,
to third party investors in the stores pursuant to the Profits Interest Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date, between Twin Restaurant
Grand Prairie, LLC and FAT Brands Development 5, LLC, and the Profits Interest Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date, between Twin
Restaurant Burleson, LLC and FAT Brands Development 3, LLC, respectively, and (xv) any other amounts deposited into the Concentration
Account or otherwise included in Collections that are not required to be deposited into the Collection Account. Excluded Amounts are
not transferred into the Collection Account, will not constitute Collateral regardless of whether such amounts are deposited into Management
Accounts, and therefore not available to pay interest on and principal of the Series of Notes.
“Excluded
IP” means (a) any Intellectual Property arising under the laws of any jurisdiction other than the United States, any state
thereof or the District of Columbia, (b) any trademarks owned and used by a Non-Securitization Entity principally for its own corporate
purposes that are not otherwise included in Securitization IP and (c) any commercially available Software licensed to or on behalf of
any Non-Securitization Entity.
“FAT
Brands” means FAT Brands Inc., a Delaware corporation, and its successors and assigns.
“FATCA”
means Sections 1471 through 1474 of the Code, any current or future regulations or official interpretations thereunder or official interpretations
thereof and any agreements entered into pursuant to Section 1471(b)(1) of the Code, any published intergovernmental agreement entered
into in connection with the implementation of such sections of the Code and any fiscal or regulatory legislation, rules or official practices
adopted pursuant to such published intergovernmental agreement.
“FDIC”
means the U.S. Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.
“Financial
Assets” has the meaning set forth in Section 5.7(b) of this Base Indenture.
“Financing
Obligation” means the amount of minimum lease payments for sale-leaseback transactions accounted for as financings.
“Fitch”
means Fitch Ratings Inc., or any successor thereto.
“Franchise
Agreement” means a franchise agreement whereby a Franchisee agrees to operate a Branded Restaurant.
“Franchise
Documents” means all Franchise Agreements, Development Agreements and agreements related thereto, together with any modifications,
amendments, extensions or replacements of the foregoing.
“Franchise
Entities” means (i) Twin Restaurant Franchise, LLC, (ii) Twin Restaurant International Franchise, LLC and (iii) each Additional
Guarantor designated as a “Franchise Entity”.
“Franchised
Restaurant Leases” means (a) leases from landlords unaffiliated with the Securitization Entities in respect of which a Securitization
Entity is the prime lessee and a Franchisee or other Person is the sub-lessee executed or acquired by such Securitization Entity and
(b) leases or subleases in respect of which a Securitization Entity is the lessor or sublessor and a Franchisee or other Person is the
lessee or sublessee.
“Franchised
Restaurants” means a Branded Restaurant owned and operated by a Franchisee.
“Franchisee”
means any Person that is a franchisee under a Franchise Agreement.
“Franchisee
Lease Payments” means all lease payments, taxes and any other amounts payable by Franchisees to a Guarantor in respect of Real
Estate Assets and New Real Estate Assets.
“Franchisee
Note” means any franchisee note entered into by a Franchise Entity or any franchisee note or other franchisee financing agreement
entered into in order to finance the payment of franchisee fees or other amounts owing by a Franchisee.
“Franchisee
Note Payments” means all amounts payable to a Guarantor by a Franchisee pursuant to a Franchisee Note.
“Franchisee
Payments” means, all amounts payable to a Guarantor by Franchisees pursuant to the Franchise Documents other than Excluded
Amounts.
“GAAP”
means the generally accepted accounting principles in the United States promulgated or adopted by the Financial Accounting Standards
Board and its predecessors and successors in effect from time to time.
“Government
Securities” means readily marketable obligations issued or directly and fully guaranteed or insured by the United States of
America or any agency or instrumentality thereof and as to which obligations the full faith and credit of the United States of America
is pledged in support thereof.
“Governmental
Authority” means the government of the United States of America or any other nation or any political subdivision thereof, whether
state or local, and any agency, authority, instrumentality, regulatory body, court, central bank or other entity exercising executive,
legislative, judicial, taxing, regulatory or administrative powers or functions of or pertaining to government.
“Gross
Sales” means, with respect to a restaurant, the total amount of revenue received from the sale of all food, products, merchandise
and performance of all services (except Manager-approved promotional items) and all other income of every kind and nature (including
gift certificates when redeemed but not when purchased), whether for cash or credit and regardless of collection in the case of credit;
provided, however, that Gross Sales shall not include (i) refunds and allowances; (ii) any sales taxes or other taxes,
in each case collected from customers for transmittal to the appropriate taxing authority or (iii) revenues that are not subject to royalties
in accordance with the related Franchise Agreement, Company Restaurant License or other applicable agreement.
“Guarantee”
means, as to any Person, any (a) obligation, contingent or otherwise, of such Person guaranteeing or having the economic effect of guaranteeing
any Indebtedness or other obligation payable or performable by another Person (the “Primary Obligor”) in any manner,
whether directly or indirectly, and including any obligation of such Person, direct or indirect, (i) to purchase or pay (or advance or
supply funds for the purchase or payment of) such Indebtedness or other obligation, (ii) to purchase or lease property, securities or
services for the purpose of assuring the obligee in respect of such Indebtedness or other obligation of the payment or performance of
such Indebtedness or other obligation, (iii) to maintain working capital, equity capital or any other financial statement condition or
liquidity or level of income or cash flow of the Primary Obligor so as to enable the Primary Obligor to pay such Indebtedness or other
obligation, or (iv) entered into for the purpose of assuring in any other manner the obligee in respect of such Indebtedness or other
obligation of the payment or performance thereof or to protect such obligee against loss in respect thereof (in whole or in part), or
(b) Lien on any assets of such Person securing any Indebtedness or other obligation of any other Person, whether or not such Indebtedness
or other obligation is assumed by such Person (or any right, contingent or otherwise, of any holder of such Indebtedness to obtain any
such Lien). The amount of any Guarantee shall be deemed to be (i) with respect to a Guarantee pursuant to clause (a) above, an amount
equal to the stated or determinable amount of the related primary obligation, or portion thereof, in respect of which such Guarantee
is made or, if not stated or determinable, the maximum reasonably anticipated liability in respect thereof as determined by the guaranteeing
Person in good faith or (ii) with respect to a Guarantee pursuant to clause (b) above, the fair market value of the assets subject to
(or that could be subject to) the related Lien. The term “Guarantee” as a verb has a corresponding meaning.
“Guarantee
and Collateral Agreement” means the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date, by and among the Guarantors
and the Trustee, as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.
“Guarantor
Assets” means:
|
(i) |
the
Franchisee Notes and New Franchisee Notes; |
|
|
|
|
(ii) |
the
Equipment Leases and New Equipment Leases, |
|
(iii) |
the
Franchise Agreements and New Franchise Agreements; |
|
|
|
|
(iv) |
the
Development Agreements and New Development Agreements; |
|
|
|
|
(v) |
the
Product Sourcing Assets and New Product Sourcing Assets; |
|
|
|
|
(vi) |
Real
Estate Assets and New Real Estate Assets; |
|
|
|
|
(vii) |
Company
Restaurants and New Company Restaurants; |
|
|
|
|
(viii) |
Company
Restaurant Leases and New Company Restaurant Leases; |
|
|
|
|
(ix) |
all
guarantees of such obligations and the rights evidenced by or reflected in the applicable agreements, in each case together with
all payments, proceeds and accrued and future rights to payment thereon; and |
|
|
|
|
(x) |
any
and all other property of every nature, now or hereafter transferred, mortgaged, pledged, or assigned as security for payment or
performance of any obligation of the Franchisees or other Persons, as applicable, to such Guarantor under the Guarantee and Collateral
Agreement. |
“Guarantor
Collections” means, with respect to each Monthly Collection Period, all amounts received by or for the account of (or in the
case of ACH transactions, amounts remitted via ACH to or for the account of but net of any Reversed ACH Remittance) the Securitization
Entities during such Monthly Collection Period, including (without duplication):
(i)
Franchisee Payments;
(ii)
all amounts received in connection with the Product Sourcing Assets;
(iii)
Franchisee Lease Payments;
(iv)
Franchisee Note Payments;
(v)
Equipment Lease Payments;
(vi)
all net proceeds received upon the disposition of the Collateral including any net proceeds from the sale of any Prospective Company
Restaurant Property;
(vii)
all Monthly Fiscal Period Estimated Company Restaurant Profits Amounts and, without duplication and Monthly Fiscal Period Company Restaurant
Profits True-up Amounts; and
(viii)
any other payments or proceeds or other revenue of the Guarantors other than Excluded Amounts.
“Guarantor
Product Sourcing Payments” means all amounts payable by any Guarantor to a manufacturer of Products under any Product Sourcing
Agreement.
“Guarantors”
means the following entities and any Additional Guarantor:
|
● |
TP
Franchise Austin, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
TP
Franchise Round Rock, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
TP
Franchise Venture I, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
TP
Texas Beverages, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
TPJV2,
LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Peaks Buyer, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Amarillo, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Amarillo Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Amarillo Management, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Beverage - Texas, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Beverage Holding, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Brandon, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Broomfield, LLC, a Colorado limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Burleson, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Burleson Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Burleson Management, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Centennial, LLC, a Colorado limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Denver, LLC, a Colorado limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Denver, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Development, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant El Paso, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant EL Paso Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant FL Payroll, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Franchise, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Frisco, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Grand Prairie, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Grand Prairie Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Grand Prairie Management, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Holding, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant International Franchise, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Investment Company, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Investment Company II, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant IP, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant JV Management, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Lakeland, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Lewisville, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Little Rock, LLC, an Arkansas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Live Oak, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Live Oak Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Live Oak Management, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Live Oak RE, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant LV -2 LLC, a Nevada limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant McKinney, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant McKinney Beverage Holding, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant McKinney RE, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Midland, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Midland Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant N Irving, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant N Irving Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Northlake, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Oakbrook, LLC, an Illinois limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Odessa, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Odessa Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Park North, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Park North Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Park North Management, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Plano, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant RE, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant S Fort Worth, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant S Fort Worth Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant San Angelo, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant San Angelo Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant San Angelo Management, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant San Antonio, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant San Antonio Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant San Marcos, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant San Marcos Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant San Marcos Management, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Sarasota, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Sarasota RE, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Sunland Park, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Sunland Park Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Terrell, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Terrell Beverage Holding, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Terrell RE, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Viva Las Vegas, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Warrenville, LLC, an Illinois limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Western Center, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Western Center Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Westover, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant Westover Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company |
|
● |
Twin
Restaurant JV Holding, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Barbeque
Integrated, Inc., a Delaware corporation |
|
● |
Smokey
Bones (Florida), LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
GMR
of Pennsylvania-SB Properties, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company |
|
● |
Integrated
Card Solutions, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company that will be converted to a Virginia limited liability company following
the Closing Date. |
“Hot
Back-Up Management Duties” has the meaning set forth in the Back-Up Management Agreement.
“Improvements”
means any additions, modifications, developments, variations, refinements, enhancements or improvements, including without limitation
derivative works as defined by applicable Requirements of Law.
“Indebtedness”
means, as to any Person as of any date, without duplication, (a) all obligations of such Person for borrowed money and all obligations
of such Person evidenced by bonds, debentures, notes, loan agreements or other similar instruments, (b) all Capitalized Lease Obligations
of such Person, (c) all Financing Obligations (current and long term) of such Person and (d) the maximum amount of all direct or contingent
obligations of such Person arising under letters of credit, in the case of the foregoing clauses (a), (b) and (c),
to the extent such item would be classified as a liability on a consolidated balance sheet of such Person as of such date. Notwithstanding
anything in this Base Indenture to the contrary, Indebtedness shall not include, and shall be calculated without giving effect to, (y)
the effects of Financial Accounting Standards Board Accounting Standards Codification 825 and related interpretations to the extent such
effects would otherwise increase or decrease an amount of Indebtedness for any purpose under this Base Indenture as a result of accounting
for any embedded derivatives created by the terms of such Indebtedness and any such amounts that would have constituted Indebtedness
under this Base Indenture but for the application of this sentence shall not be deemed an incurrence of Indebtedness under this Base
Indenture and (z) interest, fees, make-whole amounts, premiums, charges or expenses, if any, relating to the principal amount of Indebtedness.
“Indemnification
Amount” means, with respect to any Guarantor Asset or New Real Estate Asset, an amount equal to the Allocated Note Amount for
such asset.
“Indenture”
means the Base Indenture, together with all Series Supplements, as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time by Supplements
thereto in accordance with its terms.
“Indenture
Collateral” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.1 of the Base Indenture.
“Indenture
Documents” means, with respect to any Series of Notes, collectively, the Base Indenture, the Series Supplement, the Notes of
such Series, the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, the Limited Guaranty, the related Account Control Agreements and any other agreements
relating to the issuance or the purchase of the Notes of such Series or the pledge of Collateral under any of the foregoing.
“Indenture
Trust Accounts” means, the Collection Account, the Collection Account Administrative Accounts, the Distribution Account, the
Reserve Account, the Series Distribution Accounts and such other accounts as the Trustee may establish from time to time pursuant to
instruction from the Issuer or Control Party, as applicable and as contemplated hereby, to establish additional accounts pursuant to
the Indenture.
“Independent”
means, as to any Person, any other Person (including, in the case of an accountant, or lawyer, a firm of accountants or lawyers and any
member thereof or an investment bank and any member thereof) who (i) does not have and is not committed to acquire any material direct
or any material indirect financial interest in such Person or in any Affiliate of such Person and (ii) is not connected with such Person
or an Affiliate of such Person as an officer, employee, promoter, underwriter, voting trustee, partner, director or Person performing
similar functions. “Independent” when used with respect to any accountant may include an accountant who audits the books
of such Person if, in addition to satisfying the criteria set forth above, the accountant is independent with respect to such Person
within the meaning of Rule 101 of the Code of Ethics of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants. Whenever any Independent
Person’s opinion or certificate is to be furnished to the Trustee, such opinion or certificate shall state that the signer has
read this definition and that the signer is Independent within the meaning hereof.
“Independent
Auditors” means the firm of Independent accountants appointed pursuant to the Management Agreement or any successor Independent
accountant.
“Independent
Director” means, with respect to any corporation, an individual who has prior experience as an independent director, independent
manager or independent member with at least three years of employment experience and who is provided by Corporation Service Company,
CT Corporation, Lord Securities Corporation, National Registered Agents, Inc., Stewart Management Company, Wilmington Trust, National
Association, Wilmington Trust SP Services, Inc., Citadel SPV LLC, or, if none of those companies is then providing professional independent
managers, another nationally-recognized company reasonably approved by the Control Party, in each case that is not an Affiliate of the
corporation and that provides professional independent managers and other corporate services in the ordinary course of its business,
and which individual is duly appointed as an Independent Director and is not, and has never been, and will not while serving as Independent
Director be, any of the following:
(i)
a member (other than a special member), partner, equityholder, manager, director, officer or employee of the corporation (other than
any Securitization Entity), the shareholder thereof, or any of their respective equityholders or Affiliates (other than as an Independent
Director of the corporation or an Affiliate of the corporation that is not in the direct chain of ownership of the corporation and that
is required by a creditor to be a single purpose bankruptcy remote entity, provided that such Independent Director is employed by a corporation
that routinely provides professional independent directors in the ordinary course of its business);
(ii)
a creditor, supplier or service provider (including a provider of professional services) to the corporation, or any of its equityholders
or Affiliates (other than a nationally-recognized company that routinely provides professional independent directors and other corporate
services to the corporation or any of its equityholders or Affiliates in the ordinary course of its business);
(iii)
a family member of any such member, partner, equityholder, manager, director, officer, employee, creditor, supplier or service provider;
or
(iv)
a Person that controls (whether directly, indirectly or otherwise) any of (i), (ii) or (iii) above.
A
natural person who otherwise satisfies the foregoing definition and satisfies subparagraph (i) by reason of being the Independent Director
(or independent director or manager) of a “special purpose entity” which is an Affiliate of the corporation shall be qualified
to serve as an Independent Director of the corporation, provided that the fees that such individual earns from serving as Independent
Director (or independent director or manager of any Affiliate of the corporation) in any given year constitute in the aggregate less
than five percent (5%) of such individual’s annual income for that year.
“Independent
Manager” means, with respect to any limited liability company, an individual who has prior experience as an independent director,
independent manager or independent member with at least three years of employment experience and who is provided by Corporation Service
Company, CT Corporation, Lord Securities Corporation, National Registered Agents, Inc., Stewart Management Company, Wilmington Trust,
National Association, Wilmington Trust SP Services, Inc., Citadel SPV LLC, or, if none of those companies is then providing professional
independent managers, another nationally-recognized company reasonably approved by the Control Party, in each case that is not an Affiliate
of the company and that provides professional independent managers and other corporate services in the ordinary course of its business,
and which individual is duly appointed as an Independent Manager and is not, and has never been, and will not while serving as Independent
Manager be, any of the following:
(i)
a member (other than a special member), partner, equityholder, manager, director, officer or employee of the company, the member thereof,
or any of their respective equityholders or Affiliates (other than as an Independent Manager of the company or an Affiliate of the company
(other than any Securitization Entity) that is not in the direct chain of ownership of the company and that is required by a creditor
to be a single purpose bankruptcy remote entity, provided that such Independent Manager is employed by a company that routinely provides
professional independent managers in the ordinary course of its business);
(ii)
a creditor, supplier or service provider (including provider of professional services) to the company, or any of its equityholders or
Affiliates (other than a nationally-recognized company that routinely provides professional independent managers and other corporate
services to the company or any of its equityholders or Affiliates in the ordinary course of its business);
(iii)
a family member of any such member, partner, equityholder, manager, director, officer, employee, creditor, supplier or service provider;
or
(iv)
a Person that controls (whether directly, indirectly or otherwise) any of (i), (ii) or (iii) above.
A
natural person who otherwise satisfies the foregoing definition and satisfies subparagraph (i) by reason of being the Independent Manager
(or independent manager) of a “special purpose entity” which is an Affiliate of the company shall be qualified to serve as
an Independent Manager of the company, provided that the fees that such individual earns from serving as Independent Manager (or independent
manager) of any Affiliate of the company in any given year constitute in the aggregate less than five percent (5%) of such individual’s
annual income for that year.
“Ineligible
Account” has the meaning set forth in Section 5.16 of the Base Indenture.
“Initial
Principal Amount” means, with respect to any Series or Class (or Subclass) of Notes, the aggregate initial principal amount
of such Series or Class (or Subclass) of Notes specified in the Series Supplement.
“Insolvency”
means liquidation, insolvency, bankruptcy, rehabilitation, composition, reorganization or conservation, and when used as an adjective
“Insolvent.”
“Insolvency
Law” means any applicable federal, state or foreign law relating to liquidation, insolvency, bankruptcy, rehabilitation, composition,
reorganization, conservation or other similar law now or hereafter in effect.
“Insurance/Condemnation
Proceeds” means an amount equal to: (i) any cash payments or proceeds received by the Securitization Entities (a) by reason
of theft, physical destruction or damage or any other similar event with respect to any properties or assets of the Securitization Entities
under any policy of insurance (other than liability insurance) in respect of a covered loss thereunder or (b) as a result of any non-temporary
condemnation, taking, seizing or similar event with respect to any properties or assets of the Securitization Entities by any Person
pursuant to the power of eminent domain, condemnation or otherwise, or pursuant to a sale of any such assets to a purchaser with such
power under threat of such a taking minus (ii)(a) any actual and reasonable documented costs incurred by the Securitization Entities
in connection with the adjustment or settlement of any claims of the Securitization Entities in respect thereof and (b) any bona fide
direct costs incurred in connection with any disposition of such assets as referred to in clause (i)(b) of this definition, including
income taxes reasonably estimated to be actually payable by the Securitization Entities’ consolidated group as a result of any
gain recognized in connection therewith. For the avoidance of doubt, “Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds” shall not include
any proceeds of policies of insurance not described above, such as business interruption insurance, food safety insurance coverage and
other insurance procured in the ordinary course of business, which shall be treated as Collections.
“Intellectual
Property” or “IP” means all rights in intellectual property of any type throughout the world, including:
(i) Trademarks; (ii) Patents; (iii) rights in computer programs, including in both source code and object code therefor, together with
related documentation and explanatory materials and databases, including any Copyrights, Patents and trade secrets thereon or therein
(“Software”); (iv) copyrights (whether registered or unregistered) in unpublished and published works (“Copyrights”);
(v) trade secrets and other confidential or proprietary information, including with respect to recipes, unpatented inventions, operating
procedures, know how, procedures and formulas for preparing food and beverage products, specifications for certain food and beverage
products, inventory methods, customer service methods and financial control methods, and training techniques (“Trade Secrets”);
(vi) all Improvements of or to any of the foregoing; (vii) all registrations, applications for registration or issuances, recordings,
renewals and extensions relating to any of the foregoing; and (viii) for the avoidance of doubt, the sole and exclusive rights to prosecute
and maintain any of the foregoing, to enforce any past, present or future infringement, misappropriation or other violation of any of
the foregoing, and to defend any pending or future challenges to any of the foregoing.
“Interest
Accrual Period” means, with respect to any Class of Notes of any Series of Notes, a period commencing on and including the
25th day of the calendar month in which the immediately preceding Quarterly Payment Date occurred to but excluding the 25th day of the
calendar month which includes the then-current Quarterly Payment Date; provided, however, that the initial Interest Accrual
Period for any Series will commence on and include the Series Closing Date and end on the date specified in the Series Supplement; provided
further that the Interest Accrual Period, with respect to each Series of Notes Outstanding, immediately preceding the Quarterly Payment
Date on which the last payment on the Notes of such Series is to be made will end on such Quarterly Payment Date; provided further
that, in the case of an Additional Payment Date, interest accruing on the Notes during an Interest Accrual Period shall accrue (x)
to but excluding such Additional Payment Date on the outstanding principal amount of such Notes as of the end of the prior Quarterly
Payment Date (after giving effect to all payments made on such prior Quarterly Payment Date) and (y) on and after such Additional Payment
Date on the outstanding principal amount of such Notes as of the Additional Payment Date (after giving effect to all payments made on
such Additional Payment Date).
“Interest-Only
DSCR” means the P&I DSCR calculated as of any Quarterly Calculation Date without giving effect to clause (C) of
the definition of “Debt Service”.
“Interim
Successor Manager” means, upon the resignation or termination of the Manager pursuant to the terms of the Management Agreement
and prior to the appointment of any successor to the Manager by the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative),
subject to the terms of the Back-Up Management Agreement, the Back-Up Manager.
“Investment
Income” means the investment income earned on a specified account during a specified period, in each case net of all losses
and expenses allocable thereto.
“Investor
Request Certification” has the meaning specified in Section 4.4 of this Base Indenture.
“Investments”
means, with respect to any Person(s), all investments by such Person(s) in other Persons in the form of loans (including guarantees),
advances or capital contributions (excluding accounts receivable, trade credit and advances to customers and commission, travel, moving
and other similar advances to officers, directors, employees and consultants of such Person(s) (including Affiliates) made in the ordinary
course of business) and purchases or other acquisitions for consideration of Indebtedness, Equity Interests or other securities issued
by any other Person.
“IP
License Agreements” means any license to or for the use of intellectual property to which a Guarantor is a party.
“Level
I QEO Quarterly Payment Date” has the meaning specified in the Series Supplement.
“Level
II QEO Quarterly Payment Date” has the meaning specified in the Series Supplement.
“Level
I Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event” has the meaning specified in the Series Supplement.
“Level
II Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event” has the meaning specified in the Series Supplement.
“Legacy
Account” means, on or after the date that any Class or Series of Notes issued pursuant to the Base Indenture is no longer Outstanding,
any account maintained by the Trustee to which funds have been allocated in accordance with the Priority of Payments for the payment
of interest, fees or other amounts in respect of such Class or Series of Notes.
“Licensees”
means, collectively, the Franchisees and the Company Restaurant Guarantors.
“Lien”
means, when used with respect to any Person, any interest in any real or personal property, asset or other right held, owned or being
purchased or acquired by such Person which secures payment or performance of any obligation, and will include any mortgage, lien, pledge,
encumbrance, charge, retained security title of a conditional vendor or lessor, or other security interest of any kind, whether arising
under a security agreement, mortgage, lease, deed of trust, chattel mortgage, assignment for security purposes, pledge, retention or
security title, financing or similar statement, or arising as a matter of law, judicial process or otherwise, but excluding any of the
foregoing with respect to leases characterized as operating leases in accordance with GAAP as in effect on December 1, 2018 (disregarding
any future phase-in of changes to GAAP that have been approved as of December 1, 2018).
“Limited
Guaranty” means the Limited Guaranty, dated as of the Closing Date, made by Twin Hospitality Group Inc. (in such capacity,
the “Limited Guarantor”) in favor of the Trustee, on behalf of the Secured Parties, as amended, supplemented or otherwise
modified from time to time.
“Majority
of Controlling Class” means Noteholders holding in excess of 50% of the sum of the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Controlling
Class; provided, that the Exchangeable Notes will be treated as the corresponding Exchange Notes in the Outstanding Principal Amount
of such Exchange Notes allocable to such Exchangeable Notes.
“Majority
of Senior Noteholders” means Senior Noteholders holding in excess of 50% of the sum of the Outstanding Principal Amount of
each Series of Senior Notes (excluding any Senior Notes or beneficial interests in Senior Notes held by any Securitization Entity or
any Affiliate of any Securitization Entity); provided, that the Exchangeable Notes will be treated as the corresponding Senior Notes
in the Outstanding Principal Amount of such Senior Notes allocable to such Exchangeable Notes.
“Majority
of Senior Subordinated Noteholders” means Senior Subordinated Noteholders holding in excess of 50% of the sum of the Outstanding
Principal Amount of each Series of Senior Subordinated Notes (excluding any Senior Subordinated Notes or beneficial interests in Senior
Subordinated Notes held by the Issuer or any Affiliate thereof); provided, that the Exchangeable Notes will be treated as the corresponding
Senior Subordinated Notes in the Outstanding Principal Amount of such Senior Subordinated Notes allocable to such Exchangeable Notes.
“Majority
of Subordinated Noteholders” means Subordinated Noteholders holding in excess of 50% of the sum of the Outstanding Principal
Amount of each Series of Subordinated Notes (excluding any Subordinated Notes or beneficial interests in Subordinated Notes held by the
Issuer or any Affiliate thereof); provided, that the Exchangeable Notes will be treated as the corresponding Subordinated Notes in the
Outstanding Principal Amount of such Subordinated Notes allocable to such Exchangeable Notes.
“Majority
of Super Senior Noteholders” means Super Senior Noteholders holding in excess of 50% of the sum of the Outstanding Principal
Amount of each Series of Super Senior Notes (excluding any Super Senior Notes or beneficial interests in Super Senior Notes held by any
Securitization Entity or any Affiliate of any Securitization Entity); provided, that the Exchangeable Notes will be treated as the corresponding
Super Senior Notes in the Outstanding Principal Amount of such Super Senior Notes allocable to such Exchangeable Notes.
“Management
Accounts” means, collectively, the Concentration Account and any Additional Management Account as may be established by the
Manager from time to time pursuant to the Management Agreement that the Manager designates as a “Management Account” for
purposes of the Management Agreement; provided each such other account is established with the Trustee or otherwise controlled
by the Trustee under the New York UCC, or subject to an Account Control Agreement.
“Management
Agreement” means the Management Agreement, dated November 21, 2024, by and among the Manager, the Issuer, the other Securitization
Entities party thereto and the Trustee, as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.
“Manager”
means Twin Hospitality Group Inc., as the Manager, under the Management Agreement, and any successor thereto.
“Manager
Advances” has the meaning set forth in the Management Agreement.
“Manager
Termination Event” means the occurrence of an event specified in Section 6.1 of the Management Agreement.
“Managing
Standard” has the meaning set forth in the Management Agreement.
“Material
Adverse Effect” means:
(a)
with respect to the Manager, a material adverse effect on (i) its results of operations, business, properties or financial condition,
taken as a whole, (ii) its ability to conduct its business or to perform in any material respect its obligations under the Management
Agreement or any other Transaction Document, (iii) the Collateral, taken as a whole, or (iv) the ability of the Securitization Entities
to perform in any material respect their obligations under the Transaction Documents;
(b)
with respect to the Collateral, a material adverse effect with respect to the Collateral taken as a whole, the enforceability of the
terms thereof, the likelihood of the payment of the amounts required with respect thereto in accordance with the terms thereof, the value
thereof, the ownership thereof by the Securitization Entities (as applicable) or the Lien of the Trustee thereon;
(c)
with respect to any Securitization Entity, a materially adverse effect on the results of operations, business, properties or financial
condition of each such Securitization Entity, taken as a whole, or the ability of each such Securitization Entity, taken as a whole,
to conduct its business or to perform in any material respect its obligations under any of the Transaction Documents; or
(d)
with respect to any Person or matter, a material impairment to the rights of or benefits available to, taken as a whole, the Securitization
Entities, the Trustee, or the Noteholders under any Transaction Document or the enforceability of any material provision of any Transaction
Document; provided, that where “Material Adverse Effect” is used in any Transaction Document without specific reference,
such term will have the meaning specified in clauses (a) through (d), as the context may require.
“Material
Contract” means all vendor, supplier, distribution and other third-party agreements relating to the Collateral contributed
to or entered into by a Company Restaurant Guarantor or the Manager on its behalf.
“Materials
of Environmental Concern” means any gasoline or petroleum (including crude oil or any fraction thereof) or petroleum products
(virgin or unused), polychlorinated biphenyls, urea-formaldehyde insulation, asbestos, pollutants, contaminants, radioactivity and any
other materials or substances of any kind, whether or not any such material or substance is defined as hazardous or toxic under any Environmental
Law, that is regulated pursuant to or could reasonably be expected to give rise to liability under any Environmental Law.
“McIlhenny
Agreement” means the unwritten understanding with McIlhenny Co. to provide a rebate of two dollars per case of Tabasco sold.
“Monthly
Allocation Date” means each of the dates set forth in the schedule of Monthly Manager’s Certificates delivery dates and
Monthly Allocation Dates in Annex B of the Series Supplement.
“Monthly
Collection Period” means each monthly period commencing at 12:00 a.m. (Pacific time) on the first day of each Monthly Fiscal
Period and ending immediately prior to 12:00 a.m. (Pacific time) on the last day of such Monthly Fiscal Period.
“Monthly
Fiscal Period” means the following monthly fiscal periods of the Securitization Entities: (a) eight 4-week fiscal periods and
four 5-week fiscal periods of the Securitization Entities in connection with their 52-week fiscal years and (b) eight 4-week fiscal periods,
three 5-week fiscal periods and one 6-week fiscal period of the Securitization Entities in connection with their 53-week fiscal years,
whereby the 6-week period is the last fiscal period in such fiscal year.
“Monthly
Fiscal Period Company Restaurant Accrual Profits Amount” means, with respect to each Monthly Fiscal Period of the Securitization
Entities, the amount (not less than zero) equal to (a) all revenue accrued in respect of all Company Restaurants; minus (b) all Restaurant
Operating Expenses accrued over such period in connection with the operation of the Company Restaurants over such period.
“Monthly
Fiscal Period Company Restaurant Cash Profits Amount” means, with respect to each Monthly Fiscal Period of the Securitization
Entities, the amount (not less than zero) equal to (a) Company Restaurant Collections over such period; minus (b) all Restaurant Operating
Expenses paid in cash out of funds on deposit in the Company Restaurant Accounts in connection with the operation of the Company Restaurants
over such period.
“Monthly
Fiscal Period Company Restaurant Profits True-up Amount” means, with respect to each Monthly Fiscal Period of the Securitization
Entities, the sum of (a) the amount (whether positive or negative) equal to (i) the Monthly Fiscal Period Company Restaurant Accrual
Profits Amount for such Monthly Fiscal Period minus (ii) the Monthly Fiscal Period Estimated Company Restaurant Profits Amount for such
Monthly Fiscal Period plus (b) the unpaid amount of all Monthly Fiscal Period Company Restaurant Profits True- up Amounts for all prior
Monthly Fiscal Periods.
“Monthly
Fiscal Period Estimated Company Restaurant Profits Amount” means, with respect to each Monthly Fiscal Period of the Securitization
Entities, the lesser of (or, at the option of the Issuer, the greater of) (x) an estimate of the Monthly Fiscal Period Company Restaurant
Accrual Profits Amount for such period and (y) an estimate of the Monthly Fiscal Period Company Restaurant Cash Profits Amount for such
period, in each case, as set forth in the relevant Monthly Manager’s Certificate.
“Monthly
Management Fee” has the meaning set forth in the Management Agreement.
“Monthly
Manager’s Certificate” has the meaning specified in Section 4.1(a) of the Base Indenture.
“Moody’s”
means Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. or any successor thereto.
“Mortgages”
means the mortgages or deeds of trust, in form reasonably acceptable to the Issuer, the Control Party and the Trustee, required, pursuant
to Section 8.38 of the Base Indenture, to be prepared, executed and delivered by the applicable Guarantor to the Control Party
(with a copy to the Trustee) (for the benefit of the Secured Parties) to hold in escrow with respect to each New Owned Real Property.
“Mortgage
Preparation Event” means the occurrence following any Rapid Amortization Event (for which the Trustee receives notice) or following
any date of measurement upon which a Cash Flow Sweeping Event has occurred and is continuing.
“Mortgage
Recordation Event” means, in the event that any Rapid Amortization Event occurs (or is continuing) on or following the 120th
day following the occurrence of a Mortgage Preparation Event, the Control Party’s delivery of the Mortgages to the applicable
recording office for recordation within five (5) Business Days of receiving direction of the Controlling Class Representative (unless
such recordation requirement is waived by the Controlling Class Representative).
“Mortgage
Recordation Fees” means any fees, taxes or other amounts required to be paid to any applicable Governmental Authority, or any
expenses incurred by the Trustee or the Control Party, as applicable, in connection with the recording of any Mortgages as required by
the Base Indenture.
“Multiemployer
Plan” means a “multiemployer plan” as defined in Section 4001(a)(3) of ERISA that is subject to Title IV of ERISA
and contributed to for any employees of the Manager.
“Net
Cash Flow” means, with respect to any Quarterly Payment Date and the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period, the
amount (not less than zero) equal to:
(a)
the Retained Collections with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period; minus
(b)
the amount (without duplication) equal to the sum of payments pursuant to priorities (i), (ii), (iii), (iv)
and (v) of the Priority of Payments.
“New
Company Restaurant Asset” means all Company Restaurant Assets acquired by a Securitization Entity following the Closing Date.
“New
Company Restaurant Leases” means all Company Restaurant Leases entered into by a Securitization Entity following the Series
2024-1 Closing Date.
“New
Company Restaurants” means all Company Restaurants acquired by a Securitization Entity following the Closing Date.
“New
Development Agreements” means all Development Agreements and related guaranty agreements entered into by a Securitization Entity
following the Closing Date.
“New
Equipment Leases” means all Equipment Leases and related guaranty agreements entered into by a Securitization Entity following
the Closing Date.
“New
Franchise Agreements” means all Franchise Agreements and related guaranty agreements entered into by a Securitization Entity
following the Closing Date, in its capacity as franchisor for Branded Restaurants.
“New
Franchised Restaurant Leases” means all Franchised Restaurant Leases and related documents acquired by a Securitization Entity
following the Closing Date.
“New
Franchisee Notes” means all Franchisee Notes and related guaranty and collateral agreements entered into by a Securitization
Entity following the Closing Date.
“New
Owned Real Property” means all Owned Real Property and related agreements acquired by a Securitization Entity following the
Closing Date.
“New
Product Sourcing Agreement” means all Product Sourcing Agreements entered into by a Securitization Entity following the Closing
Date.
“New
Product Sourcing Assets” means all Product Sourcing Assets and related agreements entered into by a Securitization Entity following
the Closing Date.
“New
Real Estate Asset” means collectively, the New Owned Real Property, the New Franchised Restaurant Leases and the New Company
Restaurant Leases.
“New
York UCC” has the meaning set forth in Section 5.7(b) of the Base Indenture.
“Non-Securitization
Entity” means any Twin Hospitality Affiliate that is not a Securitization Entity.
“Note
Owner” means, with respect to a Note, the Person who is the beneficial owner of such Book-Entry Note, as reflected on the books
of the Clearing Agency that holds the Book-Entry Note, or on the books of a Person holding an account with such Clearing Agency (directly
or as an indirect participant, in accordance with the rules of such Clearing Agency).
“Note
Rate” means, with respect to any Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes, the annual rate at which interest (other than
contingent or additional interest) accrues on the Notes of such Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes (or the formula on the basis
of which such rate will be determined) as stated in the Series Supplement.
“Note
Register” means the register maintained pursuant to Section 2.5(a) of the Base Indenture, providing for the registration
of the Notes and transfers and exchanges thereof, subject to such reasonable regulations as the Issuer may prescribe.
“Note
Registrar” has the meaning specified in Section 2.5(a) of this Base Indenture.
“Noteholder”
or “Holder” means the Person in whose name a Note is registered in the Note Register.
“Noteholder
Certificate” has the meaning specified in Section 11.5 of the Base Indenture.
“Notes”
has the meaning specified in the recitals to the Base Indenture.
“Notes
Discharge Date” means, with respect to any Class or Series of Notes, the first date on which such Class or Series of Notes
is no longer Outstanding.
“Obligations”
means (a) all principal, interest and premium, if any, at any time and from time to time, owing by the Issuer on the Notes or owing by
the Guarantors pursuant to the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement or the Limited Guarantor pursuant to the Limited Guaranty, (b) the
payment and performance of all other obligations, covenants and liabilities of the Issuer or the Guarantors arising under the Indenture,
the Back-Up Management Agreement, the Notes, any other Indenture Document, the Control Party Agreement or of the Guarantors under the
Guarantee and Collateral Agreement or the Limited Guarantor under the Limited Guaranty, (c) the obligation of the Issuer to pay to the
Trustee all fees, expenses and indemnification amounts payable to the Trustee under the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents
to which it is a party and all Mortgage Recordation Fees when due and payable as provided in the Indenture, (d) the obligation of the
Issuer to pay to the Control Party and the Controlling Class Representative all fees, expenses and indemnification amounts payable to
the Control Party and the Controlling Class Representative under the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents to which it is a party
and (e) the obligation of the Issuer to pay to the Back-Up Manager all fees, expenses and indemnification amounts payable to the Back-Up
Manager under the Indenture, the Back-Up Management Agreement and the other Transaction Documents.
“Officer’s
Certificate” means a certificate signed by an Authorized Officer of the party delivering such certificate.
“Opinion
of Counsel” means a written opinion from legal counsel who is reasonably acceptable to the addressees. Unless otherwise specified,
the counsel may be an employee of, or in-house counsel to, the Securitization Entities, Twin Hospitality, the Manager or the Back-Up
Manager, as the case may be.
“Optional
Scheduled Principal Payment” means, each principal payment with respect to any Series of Notes, or Class, Subclass or Tranche
thereof identified as an “Optional Scheduled Principal Payment” in the Series Supplement.
“Outstanding”
means, with respect to the Notes, as of any time, all of the Notes of any one or more Series, as the case may be, theretofore authenticated
and delivered under the Indenture except:
(i)
Notes theretofore canceled by the Note Registrar or delivered to the Note Registrar for cancellation, including any such Notes delivered
to the Note Registrar by a Twin Hospitality TP Entity or an Affiliate;
(ii)
Notes, or portions thereof, for whose payment or redemption funds in the necessary amount have been theretofore irrevocably deposited
with the Trustee in trust for the Noteholders of such Notes pursuant to the Indenture; provided that, if such Notes or portions thereof
are to be redeemed, notice of such redemption has been duly given pursuant to the Indenture;
(iii)
Notes in exchange for, or in lieu of which other Notes have been authenticated and delivered pursuant to the Indenture, unless proof
reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee is presented that any such Notes are held by a holder in due course or Protected Purchaser;
(iv)
Notes that have been defeased in accordance with the Indenture; and
(v)
Notes alleged to have been mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen for which replacement Notes have been issued as provided in the Indenture;
provided
that, (A) in determining whether the Noteholders of the requisite Outstanding Principal Amount have given any request, demand, authorization,
direction, notice, consent, waiver or vote under the Indenture: (x) Notes owned by the Securitization Entities or any other obligor upon
the Notes or any Affiliate of any of them shall be disregarded and deemed not to be Outstanding, (y) Notes held in any accounts with
respect to which the Manager or any Affiliate thereof exercises discretionary voting authority shall be disregarded and deemed not to
be Outstanding and (z) the portion of the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Exchangeable Notes allocable to any Class of Exchange Notes
shall be included in the principal amount of such Class of Exchange Notes; provided, further, that in determining whether the Trustee
shall be protected in relying upon any such request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or vote, only Notes as
described under clause (x), (y) or (z) above that a Trust Officer actually knows to be so owned shall be so disregarded; and (B) Notes
owned in the manner indicated in clause (x) or (y) above that have been pledged in good faith may be regarded as Outstanding if the pledgee
establishes to the satisfaction of the Trustee the pledgee’s right so to act with respect to such Notes and that the pledgee is
not a Securitization Entity or any other obligor or the Manager, an Affiliate thereof, or an account for which the Manager or an Affiliate
of the Manager exercises discretionary voting authority.
“Outstanding
Principal Amount” means, with respect to (i) any Class of Exchange Notes, at any time, the aggregate principal amount Outstanding
of such Class of Exchange Notes at such time and (ii) any Class of Exchangeable Notes, at any time, the sum of the aggregate principal
amount Outstanding of each constituent Class of Exchange Notes (whether or not represented by such Exchangeable Notes). Any reduction
in the Outstanding Principal Amount of a Class of Exchange Notes will reduce the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Class of the Exchangeable
Notes in each corresponding Exchangeable Combination dollar-for-dollar regardless of whether any exchange has occurred so that the aggregate
Outstanding Principal Amount of the Classes of Exchange Notes will at all times reflect the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Class
of Exchangeable Notes in each corresponding Exchangeable Combination.
“Owned
Real Property” means the real property (including the land, buildings and fixtures) owned in fee (as of the Closing Date) by
a Securitization Entity.
“P&I
DSCR” means an amount calculated as of any Quarterly Calculation Date by dividing (x) the Net Cash Flow over the four (4) immediately
preceding Quarterly Collection Periods most recently ended by (y) an amount equal to the Debt Service times four (4); provided that,
for purposes of calculating the P&I DSCR as of the first four (4) Quarterly Calculation Dates:
(a)
“Net Cash Flow” for the Quarterly Collection Period ended December 31, 2023 shall be deemed to be $23,675,945.35, “Net
Cash Flow” for the Quarterly Collection Period ended March 31, 2024 shall be deemed to be $16,854,109.70, “Net Cash Flow”
for the Quarterly Collection Period ended June 30, 2024 shall be deemed to be $16,000,196.53, “Net Cash Flow” for the Quarterly
Collection Period ended September 29, 2024 shall be deemed to be $14,005,628.88 and “Net Cash Flow” from September 30, 2024
through the Closing Date shall be deemed to be $9,429,367.81; provided that, for the avoidance of doubt, the foregoing Net Cash Flow
amounts shall be subject to pro forma adjustments in accordance with the Indenture with respect to any pro forma events occurring after
the date of the Base Indenture; and
(b)
the Debt Service due during such period for purposes of clause (ii) shall be deemed to equal the Debt Service for the most recently
ended Quarterly Collection Period times four (and for the first Quarterly Collection Period, the Debt Service measured for such Quarterly
Collection Period shall be adjusted as set forth in the definition of such term to account for the irregular number of days in such Quarterly
Collection Period).
“Pass-Through
Amount” means amounts in respect of sales Taxes and other comparable Taxes, payroll Taxes, wage garnishments and other amounts
received by Company Restaurants that are due and payable to a Governmental Authority or other unaffiliated third party.
“Patents”
means United States and non-U.S. patents, (including, during the term of the patent, the inventions claimed thereunder), patent disclosures,
industrial designs, inventions (whether or not patentable or reduced to practice), invention disclosures, and applications, divisions,
continuations, continuations-in-part, provisionals, reexaminations and reissues for any of the foregoing.
“Paying
Agent” has the meaning specified in Section 2.5(a) of the Base Indenture.
“PBGC”
means the Pension Benefit Guarantee Corporation or any entity succeeding to all or any of its functions under ERISA.
“Pension
Plan” means any “employee pension benefit plan,” as such term is defined in Section 3(2) of ERISA (other than a
Multiemployer Plan), which is subject to Title IV of ERISA and to which any company in the same Controlled Group as the Manager has liability,
including any liability by reason of having been a substantial employer within the meaning of Section 4063 of ERISA for any time within
the preceding five (5) years or by reason of being deemed to be a contributing sponsor under Section 4069 of ERISA.
“Permitted
Asset Dispositions” has the meaning set forth in Section 8.16 of the Base Indenture.
“Permitted
Liens” means (a) Liens for (i) Taxes, assessments or other governmental charges not delinquent by more than 30 days or (ii)
Taxes, assessments or other charges being contested in good faith and by appropriate action and with respect to which adequate reserves
have been established, and are being maintained, in accordance with GAAP, (b) all Liens created or permitted under the Transaction Documents
in favor of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, (c) restrictions under federal, state or foreign securities laws on the
transfer of securities, (d) any Liens arising under law or pursuant to documentation governing permitted accounts in connection with
the Securitization Entities’ cash management system, (e) Liens arising from (i) judgment, decrees or attachments in circumstances
not constituting an Event of Default or (ii) notices of lis pendens and associated rights related to litigation being contested
in good faith by appropriate action and with respect to which adequate reserves have been established, and are being maintained, in accordance
with GAAP, (f) Liens arising in connection with any Capitalized Lease Obligations, sale-leaseback transaction or in connection with any
Indebtedness, in each case that is permitted under the Indenture, (g) Liens imposed by law, constituting landlord’s, carriers’,
warehousemen’s, mechanics’, materialmen’s, workmen’s, repairmen’s, supplier’s, construction or other
like Liens, securing obligations that are not overdue by more than 30 days or that are being contested in good faith by appropriate action
and with respect to which adequate reserves have been established, and are being maintained, in accordance with GAAP, (h) pledges and
deposits and other Liens securing liability for reimbursement or indemnification obligations of (including obligations in respect of
letters of credit or bank guarantees for the benefit of) insurance carriers providing property, casualty or liability insurance to any
Securitization Entity in the ordinary course of its business, (i) pledges and deposits and other Liens to secure the performance of bids,
trade contracts (other than for Indebtedness), leases (other than Capitalized Lease Obligations), statutory obligations, surety and appeal
bonds, performance and return of money bonds, bids, leases, government contracts, agreements with utilities, and other obligations of
a like nature (including letters of credit in lieu of any such bonds or to support the issuance thereof), in each case to the extent
such deposits and other Liens are incurred in the ordinary course of business, including those incurred to secure health, safety and
environmental obligations in the ordinary course of business, (j) Liens arising by operation of law in the United States under Article
2 of the UCC in favor of a reclaiming seller of goods or buyer of goods, (k) any interest or title of a ground lessor or any other lessor,
sublessor or licensor under any ground leases or any other leases, subleases or licenses entered into by any Securitization Entity in
the ordinary course of business, and all Liens suffered or created by any such ground lessor or any other lessor, sublessor or licensor
(or any predecessor in interest) with respect to any such interest or title in the real property which is subject thereof, (l) Liens
that are contractual rights of set-off (i) relating to the establishment of depository relations with banks and other financial institutions
not given in connection with the issuance of Indebtedness, (ii) relating to pooled deposits, sweep accounts, reserve accounts or similar
accounts of any Securitization Entity to permit satisfaction of overdraft or similar obligations incurred in the ordinary course of business
of any Securitization Entity, including with respect to credit card charge-backs and similar obligations, or (iii) relating to purchase
orders and other agreements entered into with customers, suppliers or service providers of any Securitization Entity in the ordinary
course of business, (m) leases or subleases, and licenses or sublicenses (including with respect to any real property, fixtures, furnishings,
equipment, vehicles or other personal property, or intellectual property) and covenants not to sue of or under intellectual property
or software or other technology, granted to others in the ordinary course of business or otherwise not interfering in any material respect
with the business of any Securitization Entity, (n) Liens arising from precautionary UCC financing statements (or other similar filings
in other applicable jurisdictions) regarding operating leases or other obligations incurred in the ordinary course of business and not
constituting Indebtedness, (o) Liens securing insurance premiums financing arrangements; provided that such Liens are limited to the
applicable unearned insurance premiums, (p) Liens arising out of conditional sale, title retention, hire purchase, consignment or similar
arrangements for the sale or purchase of goods by any Securitization Entity in the ordinary course of business, (q) Liens relating to
any financing in respect of a Prospective Company Restaurant Property or Company Restaurant Build-Out in an amount equal to $5,000,000
or less per property or $25,000,000 or less in aggregate for all properties, (r) Liens relating to any financing in respect of a Prospective
Company Restaurant Property or Company Restaurant Build-Out in an amount equal to more than $5,000,000 per property or more than $25,000,000
in aggregate for all properties, which, in each case, has been approved by the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class
Representative), and (s) Liens that attach to or otherwise encumber any Collateral or other assets in an aggregate outstanding amount
not exceeding $1,000,000 at any time.
“Permitted
Uses” means, with respect to the use of funds in the Permitted Uses Account, the following purposes: (i) payment or reimbursement
of the costs and expenses associated with the conversion of the Branded Restaurant in Lakeland, Florida to a Twin Peaks Restaurant, (ii)
cost or reimbursement of costs associated with building the Terrel corporate store, (iii) cost or reimbursement of costs associated with
building the McKinney corporate store, (iv) payment or reimbursement of the costs and expenses associated with the conversion of the
Branded Restaurant in Brandon, Florida to a Twin Peaks Restaurant, (v) payment or reimbursement of the costs and expenses associated
with the conversion of the Branded Restaurant in Tampa, Florida to a Twin Peaks Restaurant, (vi) payment or reimbursement of the costs
and expenses associated with the conversion of the Branded Restaurant in Kissimmee, Florida to a Twin Peaks Restaurant, and/or (vii)
cost, up to $1,000,000 per Franchised Restaurant, associated with opening a Franchised Restaurant, which shall be released after such
Franchised Restaurant has been contributed into the Securitization Transaction.
“Permitted
Uses Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o the
Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I LLC Permitted Uses Account”, maintained by the Trustee pursuant to Section 5.3(a) of
the Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.3(a) of the Base Indenture.
“Person”
means an individual, corporation (including a business trust), partnership, limited liability partnership, limited liability company,
joint venture, association, joint stock company, trust (including any beneficiary thereof), other entity, unincorporated association
or government or any agency or political subdivision thereof.
“Plan”
means (i) an “employee benefit plan” (as defined in Section 3(3) of ERISA) that is subject to Title I of ERISA, (ii) a “plan”
(as defined in Section 4975(e)(1) of the Code) that is subject to Section 4975 of the Code and (iii) an entity whose underlying assets
include the assets of an employee benefit plan or plan.
“Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest” means any Super Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest,
Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest, Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest and/or Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest.
“Potential
Manager Termination Event” means any occurrence or event which, with the giving of notice, the passage of time or both, would
constitute a Manager Termination Event.
“Potential
Rapid Amortization Event” means any occurrence or event which, with the giving of notice, the passage of time or both, would
constitute a Rapid Amortization Event.
“Prime
Rate” means the rate of interest publicly announced from time to time by a commercial bank mutually agreed upon by the Manager
and the Control Party as its reference rate, base rate or prime rate.
“Principal
Payment Account” means each of the Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account, the Senior Notes Principal Payment Account,
the Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account, and the Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account.
“Principal
Terms” has the meaning specified in Section 2.3 of the Base Indenture.
“Priority
of Payments” means the allocation and payment obligations described in Section 5.10 of the Base Indenture as supplemented
by the allocation and payment obligations with respect to each Series of Notes described in each Series Supplement.
“Proceeding”
means any suit in equity, action at law or other judicial or administrative proceeding.
“Proceeds”
has the meaning specified in Section 9-102(a)(64) of the applicable UCC.
“Product
Sourcing Advance” has the meaning specified in the Management Agreement.
“Product
Sourcing Agreements” means all agreements for (a) the manufacture and production of Products and (b) the sale of Products to
Distributors including the Distribution Agreement for the manufacture and supply of products for re-sale to certain Franchisees, Company
Restaurants or any other Persons.
“Product
Sourcing Assets” means, with respect to each Guarantor, (i) the Product Sourcing Agreements and all Product Sourcing Payments
thereon; (ii) the New Product Sourcing Agreements and all Product Sourcing Payments thereon; (iii) all rights to enter into New Product
Sourcing Agreements and (iv) any and all other property of every nature, now or hereafter transferred, mortgaged, pledged, or assigned
as security for payment or performance of any obligation of any Person to such Guarantor under the Product Sourcing Agreements and all
guarantees of such obligations and the rights evidenced by or reflected in the Product Sourcing Agreements, in each case together with
all payments, proceeds and accrued and future rights to payment thereon.
“Product
Sourcing Payments” means all amounts payable to a Guarantor by Distributors with respect to purchases of Products.
“Products”
means any good sold by any Distributor to a Licensee or any other Person pursuant to current practices, the Product Sourcing Agreement
or otherwise.
“Prospective
Company Restaurant Properties” mean (i) any real property acquired by a Securitization Entity before, on or after the Closing
Date with which the Manager intends to enter into or did enter into a sale-lease back transaction with the purpose of opening a Company
Restaurant, (ii) any real property currently or previously leased by a Securitization Entity which the Manager intends to improve or
has improved to become a Company Restaurant and (iii) any existing Company Restaurants which the Manager intends to or did improve for
purposes of a conversion to another Brand.
“Protected
Purchaser” has the meaning specified in Section 8-303 of the UCC.
“pro
forma event” has the meaning set forth in Section 14.18 of the Base Indenture.
“PTO”
means the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office and any successor U.S. Federal office.
“Qualified
Equity Offering” means a public or private offering or issuance by Twin Hospitality Group Inc. of its common equity securities
(including securities convertible into or exchangeable for its common equity securities) for cash, excluding (i) any offer, grant or
issuance of securities pursuant to a stock option or equity incentive plan approved by the Board of Directors of Twin Hospitality Group
Inc. for the benefit of its officers, directors or employees, (ii) any issuance of securities as consideration for the consummation of
any merger or acquisition, partnership, joint venture or strategic alliance for primarily non-capital raising purposes, and (iii) the
issuance of equity securities upon exercise or conversion of any options, warrants or convertible securities from time to time outstanding.
“Qualified
Equity Offering Additional Interest” means any Super Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest,
Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest and/or Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering
Additional Interest.
“Qualified
Equity Offering Proceeds” means amounts received from the net proceeds received by Twin Hospitality Group Inc. pursuant to
a Qualified Equity Offering.
“Qualified
Institution” means a depository institution organized under the laws of the United States of America or any state thereof or
incorporated under the laws of a foreign jurisdiction with a branch or agency located in the United States of America or any state thereof
and subject to supervision and examination by federal or state banking authorities that at all times has the Required Rating and, in
the case of any such institution organized under the laws of the United States of America, whose deposits are insured by the FDIC.
“Quarterly
Calculation Date” means the date four (4) Business Days prior to each Quarterly Payment Date. Any reference to a Quarterly
Calculation Date relating to a Quarterly Payment Date means the Quarterly Calculation Date occurring in the same calendar month as the
Quarterly Payment Date and any reference to a Quarterly Calculation Date relating to a Quarterly Collection Period means the Quarterly
Collection Period most recently ended on or prior to the related Quarterly Payment Date.
“Quarterly
Collection Period” means each period commencing on and including the first day of a Quarterly Fiscal Period and ending on but
excluding the first day of the immediately following Quarterly Fiscal Period, except that the first Quarterly Collection Period will
commence on and include the Closing Date, and end on December 25, 2024.
“Quarterly
Compliance Certificate” has the meaning specified in Section 4.1(d) of the Base Indenture.
“Quarterly
Fiscal Period” means the following quarterly fiscal periods of the Twin Hospitality TP Entities: (a) four 13-week quarters
of the Twin Hospitality TP Entities in connection with their 52-week fiscal years and (b) three 13-week quarters and one 14 week quarter
of the Twin Hospitality TP Entities in connection with their 53-week fiscal years. The last day of the fourth Quarterly Fiscal Period
of each fiscal year of the Twin Hospitality TP Entities is the Sunday nearest to December 31, but in no event later than December 31.
References to “weeks” mean the Twin Hospitality TP Entities’ fiscal weeks, which commence on each Monday of a calendar
week and end immediately prior to the Monday of the following calendar week.
“Quarterly
Noteholders’ Report” means, with respect to any Series of Notes, a statement substantially in the form of an Exhibit
to the Series Supplement, including the Manager’s statement specified in such exhibit.
“Quarterly
Payment Date” means, unless otherwise specified in any Series Supplement for the related Series of Notes, the 25th
day of each of the following calendar months: January, April, July and October, or if such date is not a Business Day, the next succeeding
Business Day, commencing on January 27, 2025. Any reference to a Quarterly Collection Period relating to a Quarterly Payment Date means
the Quarterly Collection Period most recently ended prior to such Quarterly Payment Date, and any reference to an Interest Accrual Period
relating to a Quarterly Payment Date means the Interest Accrual Period most recently ended prior to such Quarterly Payment Date.
“Rapid
Amortization Event” has the meaning specified in Section 9.1 of the Base Indenture.
“Rapid
Amortization Period” means the period commencing on the date on which a Rapid Amortization Event occurs and ending on the earlier
to occur of the waiver of the occurrence of such Rapid Amortization Event in accordance with Section 9.7 of the Base Indenture
and the date on which there are no Notes Outstanding.
“Real
Estate Assets” means the Owned Real Property, the Franchised Restaurant Leases and the Company Restaurant Leases.
“Rebate
Agreements” means collectively, the (i) Beverage Marketing Agreement, dated December 16, 2013, as amended July 1, 2023, between
The Coca-Cola Company, acting by and through its Coca-Cola North America Group and Twin Restaurant, LLC, (ii) the Fountain Support Agreement,
dated June 28, 2021, between Dr Pepper/Seven Up, Inc., a Dr Pepper Snapple Group company and Twin Restaurants, LLC, (iii) the Product
and Services Supply Agreement, dated August 1, 2021, between Ecolab, Inc. and Twin Restaurant, LLC, (iv) the Agreement for Designation
as Approved Distributor, dated August 29, 2023, between Twin Restaurant Holding, LLC and Twin Restaurant Holding, LLC and Sysco Corporation,
and (v) the McIlhenny Agreement.
“Record
Date” means, with respect to any Quarterly Payment Date, Optional Prepayment Date or Additional Payment Date, the close of
business on the 20th day of the calendar month in which such Quarterly Payment Date falls, or Optional Prepayment Date or Additional
Payment Date occurs.
“Release
Request” means, with respect to any request from the Manager for a release of funds from the Permitted Uses Account, a written
request substantially in the form of Exhibit C hereto.
“Reportable
Event” means a “reportable event,” within the meaning of Section 4043 of ERISA, with respect to a Pension Plan
as to which the PBGC has not by regulation waived the requirement of Section 4043(a) of ERISA that it be notified of such event.
“Required
Rating” means (i) a short-term certificate of deposit rating from Moody’s of “P-1” and (ii) a long-term unsecured
debt rating of not less than “Baa1” by Moody’s.
“Required
Reserve Amount” means, with respect to any Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes, the amount specified as the Required
Reserve Amount for such Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes in the Series Supplement.
“Requirements
of Law” means, with respect to any Person or any of its property, the certificate of incorporation or articles of association
and by-laws, limited liability company agreement, partnership agreement or other organizational or governing documents of such Person
or any of its property, and any law, treaty, rule or regulation, or determination of any arbitrator or Governmental Authority, in each
case applicable to, or binding upon, such Person or any of its property or to which such Person or any of its property is subject, whether
federal, state, local or foreign (including usury laws, the Federal Truth in Lending Act, state franchise laws and retail installment
sales acts).
“Reserve
Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o the Secured
Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Reserve Account”, maintained by the Trustee pursuant to Section 5.2(a) of the Base Indenture
or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.2(a) of the Base Indenture.
“Reserve
Account Deficit Amount” means as of any date of determination, the excess, if any, of the Required Reserve Amount over the
amount on deposit in the Reserve Account.
“Reserve
Account Withdrawal Amount” means, with respect to any Monthly Allocation Date, the lesser of (x) any shortfall in the amount
of Retained Collections available to pay the amounts pursuant to priorities (i) through (xi) of the Priority of Payments (taking into
account application of Retained Collections pursuant to the Priority of Payments and ignoring any provision which otherwise limits the
amounts described in such priorities to the amount of funds available) and (y) the amount on deposit in the Reserve Account on such Monthly
Allocation Date prior to application of amounts on deposit therein.
“Residual
Amount” means for any Monthly Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly Collection Period the amount, if any, by which
the amount allocated to the Collection Account on such Monthly Allocation Date exceeds the sum of the amounts to be paid and/or allocated
on such Monthly Allocation Date pursuant to priorities (i) through (xxv) of the Priority of Payments; provided, if, as
of any date of determination, the P&I DSCR calculation is maintained or improved as a result of an equity contribution to the Issuer,
the Residual Amount shall be reduced to the Residual Amount that would have been paid absent such equity contribution; provided further,
the amount of such reduction shall be deposited into the Reserve Account and released to the Collection Account only upon the P&I
DSCR calculation being satisfied without giving any effect to any equity contributions by the Manager.
“Restaurant
Operating Expenses” means (a) operating expenses that are incurred by or allocated, in accordance with the Managing Standard,
to Company Restaurants in the ordinary course of business relating to the operation of the Company Restaurants, such as the cost of goods
sold, labor (including wages, workers’ compensation-related expenses and other labor-related expenses for employees in respect
of Company Restaurants), repair and maintenance expenses, insurance (including self-insurance), (b) local advertising expenses and Advertising
Fees allocable to the Company Restaurants, (c) lease payments to third party landlords with respect to the Company Restaurants, (d) Pass-Through
Amounts with respect to the Company Restaurants, (e) debt service and other amounts required to be paid in respect of Prospective Company
Restaurant Properties and (f) amounts required to be paid with respect to the Company Restaurants in connection with the Company Restaurant
Royalty Payments, if any.
“Retained
Collections” means, with respect to any specified period of time, the amount equal to (i) Collections received over such period
minus without duplication (ii) the Excluded Amounts, Excess Amounts and Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds over such period and amounts
withdrawn from the Concentration Account pursuant to Section 5.9(b)(i)-(iii) herein. For the purposes of calculating the P&I DSCR,
Retained Collections will include any waived Management Fees and will be deemed to exclude any equity contributions, amounts released
from the Reserve Account, proceeds of equity sales, Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds, Asset Disposition Proceeds, Indemnification Amounts,
Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds and any other non-recurring payments or proceeds with respect to the Collateral or received from the
Guarantors.
“Reversed
ACH Remittance” means, with respect to any Monthly Collection Period, an ACH remittance, check, wire transfer, credit, payment
order or other deposit relating to any Monthly Collection Period that is reversed, returned, adjusted or subject to chargeback, or any
item subject to a claim for breach of transfer or presentment warranty under the Uniform Commercial Code, clearing house operating rules
or the National Automated Clearing House Association, during such Monthly Collection Period.
“S&P”
means S&P Global Ratings, or any successor thereto.
“Sale
and Contribution Agreement (Issuer)” means the Sale and Contribution Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date, between FAT Brands
and Twin Hospitality, pertaining to the Issuer.
“Scheduled
Principal Payments” means, with respect to any Series, Class of any Series of Notes, or Subclass or Tranche thereof, any payments
scheduled to be made pursuant to the Series Supplement that reduce the amount of principal Outstanding with respect to such Series, Class,
Subclass or Tranche on a periodic basis that are identified as “Scheduled Principal Payments” in the Series Supplement.
“Scheduled
Principal Payments Deficiency Event” means, with respect to any Quarterly Collection Period, as of the last Monthly Allocation
Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period, the occurrence of the following event: the amount of funds on deposit in the Super
Senior Notes Principal Payment Account after the last Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period is less
than the Super Senior Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments for the next succeeding Quarterly Payment Date.
“Scheduled
Principal Payments Deficiency Notice” has the meaning specified in Section 4.1(e) of the Base Indenture.
“SEC”
means the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.
“Secured
Parties” means the (i) Trustee, (ii) the Noteholders, (iii) the Control Party, (iv) the Manager and (v) the Back-Up Manager,
together with their respective successors and assigns.
“Securities
Intermediary” has the meaning set forth in Section 5.7(a) of the Base Indenture.
“Securitization
Entities” means, collectively, the Issuer and the Guarantors. For the avoidance of doubt, Twin Hospitality does not and shall
not at any time constitute a “Securitization Entity”.
“Securitization
IP” means all Intellectual Property (including After-Acquired Securitization IP but excluding the Excluded IP) created, developed,
authored, acquired or owned by or on behalf of or licensed to or on behalf of Twin Hospitality or its direct or indirect Subsidiaries
reading on or embodied in (i) any of the Brands, (ii) products or services sold or distributed under any of the Brands, (iii) the Branded
Restaurants, and (iv) the Twin Hospitality TP Systems.
“Securitization
Operating Expense Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee
f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I LLC Securitization Operating Expense Account” maintained by the Trustee for the benefit
of the Secured Parties pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section
5.5 of the Base Indenture.
“Securitization
Operating Expenses” means all expenses incurred by the Securitization Entities and payable to third parties in connection with
the maintenance and operation of the Securitization Entities and the transactions contemplated by the Transaction Documents to which
it is a party (other than those paid for from the Concentration Account as described in the Indenture or otherwise payable under any
other step in the Priority of Payments or Company Restaurant Account), including, without limitation, (i) accrued and unpaid taxes (other
than federal, state and local income taxes), filing fees and registration fees payable by the Securitization Entities to any federal,
state or local governmental authority; (ii) fees and expenses payable to (A) the Back-Up Manager as Back-Up Manager Fees, (B) independent
certified public accountants (including, for the avoidance of doubt, any incremental auditor costs) or external legal counsel and (C)
any stock exchange on which the Notes may be listed; (iii) the indemnification obligations of the Securitization Entities under the Transaction
Documents to which it is a party (including any interest thereon at a rate equal to the Prime Rate plus 3.0% per annum, if applicable);
and (iv) independent director and manager fees.
“Securitization
Transactions” means the transactions contemplated by the Transaction Documents including, without limitation, the contribution
to the applicable Securitization Entities of the Contributed Assets and the proceeds thereof on the Series Closing Dates and the issuance
and sale of each Series of Notes on the related Series Closing Date in the manner provided in the applicable Transaction Documents.
“Senior
Leverage Ratio” means, as of any date of determination, the ratio of (a)(i) the aggregate principal amount of each Series of
Super Senior Notes and Senior Notes Outstanding as of the end of the most recently ended Quarterly Fiscal Period less (ii) the sum of
(x) the cash and cash equivalents of the Securitization Entities credited to the Reserve Account as of the end of the most recently ended
Quarterly Fiscal Period and (y) the cash and cash equivalents of the Securitization Entities maintained in the Management Accounts as
of the end of the most recently ended Quarterly Fiscal Period that, pursuant to a Monthly Manager’s Certificate delivered on or
prior to such date, will constitute the Residual Amount on the next succeeding Monthly Allocation Date to (b) Net Cash Flow for the preceding
four Quarterly Collection Periods most recently ended as of such date and for which financial statements are required to be delivered.
The Senior Leverage Ratio shall be calculated in accordance with Section 14.18(a) of the Base Indenture.
“Senior
Noteholder” means any Holder of Senior Notes of any Series.
“Senior
Notes” or “Class A-2-II Notes” means any Series or Class of any Series of Notes issued that are designated
as “Class A-2-II” and identified as “Senior Notes” in the Series Supplement.
“Senior
Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to a Quarterly Collection Period,
an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one-third of the Senior Notes Aggregate Quarterly Interest for the Interest Accrual
Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount
for such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) Senior Notes Aggregate Quarterly Interest for the Interest
Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period exceeds (ii) the aggregate amount previously allocated to the
Senior Notes Interest Payment Account with respect to the Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount on each preceding Monthly Allocation
Date (or prefunded on the Closing Date) with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period.
“Senior
Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation Date
with respect to a Quarterly Collection Period an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one-third of the Senior Notes Aggregate
Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly
Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount for
such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) Senior Notes Aggregate Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date
Additional Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period exceeds (ii) the aggregate
amount previously allocated to the Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account with respect to Senior Notes
Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest on each preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to the Quarterly
Collection Period.
“Senior
Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation Date with
respect to an applicable Quarterly Collection Period, an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one-third of the Senior Notes
Aggregate Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly
Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount for such
Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) Senior Notes Aggregate Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional
Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period exceeds (ii) the aggregate amount
previously allocated to the Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account with respect to Senior Notes Quarterly
Qualified Equity Offering Date Additional Interest on each preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to the applicable Quarterly
Collection Period.
“Senior
Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly Collection
Period an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one third of the Senior Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments for the
Quarterly Payment Date in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal
Payments Amount for such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) the Senior Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal
Payments for the Quarterly Payment Date in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period exceeds (ii) the aggregate amount previously
allocated to the Senior Notes Principal Payment Account with respect to Senior Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments on each preceding
Monthly Allocation Date (or prefunded on the Closing Date) with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period.
“Senior
Notes Aggregate Quarterly Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with respect to all Senior Notes Outstanding, the
aggregate Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount due and payable on all such Senior Notes with respect to such Interest Accrual Period.
“Senior
Notes Aggregate Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with
respect to all Senior Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest
accrued on all such Senior Notes with respect to such Interest Accrual Period.
“Senior
Notes Aggregate Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with respect
to all Senior Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest accrued
on all such Senior Notes with respect to such Interest Accrual Period.
“Senior
Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments” means, for any Quarterly Payment Date, with respect to all Senior Notes Outstanding,
the aggregate amount of Senior Notes Scheduled Principal Payments Amounts due and payable on all such Senior Notes on such Quarterly
Payment Date.
“Senior
Notes Interest Payment Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as
trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Senior Notes Interest Payment Account”, maintained by the Trustee pursuant
to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base
Indenture.
“Senior
Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account
entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest Account, maintained by the Trustee pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture or any successor securities
account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture.
“Senior
Notes Principal Payment Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as
trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Senior Notes Principal Payment Account”, maintained by the Trustee pursuant
to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base
Indenture.
“Senior
Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled
“UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional
Interest Account” maintained by the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties pursuant to Section 5.5 of this Base Indenture
or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of this Base Indenture.
“Senior
Notes Quarterly Interest Amount” means with respect to each Quarterly Payment Date, the aggregate amount of interest due and
payable, with respect to the related Interest Accrual Period, on the Senior Notes that is identified as a “Senior Notes Quarterly
Interest Amount” in the Series Supplement (other than any Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest or Qualified Equity
Offering Additional Interest); provided, that if, on any Quarterly Payment Date or other date of determination, the actual amount
of any such interest cannot be ascertained, an estimate of such interest will be used to calculate the Senior Notes Quarterly Interest
Amount for such Quarterly Payment Date or other date of determination in accordance with the terms and provisions of the Series Supplement;
provided, further, that any amount identified as “Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” or “Qualified
Equity Offering Additional Interest” in any Series Supplement shall under no circumstances be deemed to constitute part of the
“Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount.”
“Senior
Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with respect to
any Class of Senior Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of interest accrued with respect to such Interest Accrual Period on each
such Class of Senior Notes that is identified as “Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest”
in the Series Supplement; provided that if, on any Monthly Allocation Date or other date of determination, the actual amount of any such
interest cannot be ascertained, an estimate of such interest will be used to calculate the Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest for such Monthly Allocation Date or other date of determination in accordance with the terms and provisions
of the Series Supplement; provided further that any amount identified as “Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount” in any
Series Supplement will under no circumstances be deemed to constitute “Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional
Interest.”
“Senior
Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with respect to any
Class of Senior Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of interest accrued with respect to such Interest Accrual Period on each such
Class of Senior Notes that is identified as “Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest” in the
applicable Series Supplement; provided that if, on any Monthly Allocation Date or other date of determination, the actual amount of any
such interest cannot be ascertained, an estimate of such interest will be used to calculate the Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity
Offering Additional Interest for such Monthly Allocation Date or other date of determination in accordance with the terms and provisions
of the applicable Series Supplement; provided further that any amount identified as “Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount”
in any Series Supplement will under no circumstances be deemed to constitute “Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering
Additional Interest.”
“Senior
Notes Scheduled Principal Payments Amounts” means, with respect to any Class of Senior Notes Outstanding, any Scheduled Principal
Payments with respect to such Class of Senior Notes.
“Senior
Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount” means, with respect to any Senior Notes Outstanding as calculated in connection
with any Quarterly Payment Date (1) the amount, if any, by which (a) the Senior Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments for such
Class of Notes exceeds (b) the sum of (i) the amount of funds on deposit with respect to such Class of Notes in the Senior Notes Principal
Payment Account plus (ii) any other funds on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts that are available to pay the Senior Notes Aggregate
Scheduled Principal Payments for such Class of Notes on such Quarterly Payment Date in accordance with the Indenture, plus (2) any Senior
Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments due but unpaid from any previous Quarterly Payment Dates.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes” means any issuance of Notes under the Indenture by the Issuer that are part of a Class with an alphanumerical
designation that contains any letter from “B” through “L” of the alphabet.
“Senior
Subordinated Noteholders” means, collectively, all holders of Senior Subordinated Notes.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to a Quarterly Collection
Period, an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one-third of the Senior Subordinated Notes Aggregate Quarterly Interest for
the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Senior Subordinated Notes
Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount for such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) Senior Subordinated Notes
Aggregate Quarterly Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period exceeds (ii) the
aggregate amount previously allocated to the Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account with respect to the Senior Subordinated
Notes Quarterly Interest Amount on each preceding Monthly Allocation Date (or prefunded on the Closing Date) with respect to such Quarterly
Collection Period.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation
Date with respect to a Quarterly Collection Period an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one-third of the Senior Subordinated
Notes Aggregate Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding
Quarterly Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional
Interest Amount for such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) Senior Subordinated Notes Aggregate Quarterly
Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection
Period exceeds (ii) the aggregate amount previously allocated to the Senior Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional
Interest Account with respect to Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest on each preceding
Monthly Allocation Date with respect to the Quarterly Collection Period.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation
Date with respect to an applicable Quarterly Collection Period an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one-third of the Senior
Subordinated Notes Aggregate Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next
succeeding Quarterly Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional
Interest Amount for such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) Senior Subordinated Notes Aggregate Quarterly
Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period
exceeds (ii) the aggregate amount previously allocated to the Senior Subordinated Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest
Account with respect to Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest on each preceding Monthly Allocation
Date with respect to the applicable Quarterly Collection Period.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to any
Quarterly Collection Period an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one third of the Senior Subordinated Notes Aggregate
Scheduled Principal Payments for the Quarterly Payment Date in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover
Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount for such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by
which (i) the Senior Subordinated Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments for the Quarterly Payment Date in the next succeeding
Quarterly Collection Period exceeds (ii) the aggregate amount previously allocated to the Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment
Account with respect to Senior Subordinated Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments on each preceding Monthly Allocation Date (or
prefunded on the Closing Date) with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Aggregate Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual
Period, with respect to all Senior Subordinated Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest accrued on all such Senior Subordinated Notes with respect to such Interest Accrual Period.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Aggregate Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period,
with respect to all Senior Subordinated Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity
Offering Additional Interest accrued on all such Senior Subordinated Notes with respect to such Interest Accrual Period.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank,
N.A., as trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account”, maintained
by the Trustee pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section
5.5 of the Base Indenture.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Interest Shortfall Amount” has the meaning set forth in Section 5.11(b)(iii)(B) of the Base Indenture.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing
trust account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Senior Subordinated Notes
Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account, maintained by the Trustee pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture
or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB
Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account”,
maintained by the Trustee pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant
to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust
account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Senior Subordinated Notes Qualified
Equity Offering Additional Interest Account” maintained by the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties pursuant to Section
5.5 of this Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of this Base Indenture.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount” means, with respect to each Quarterly Payment Date, the aggregate amount of interest
due and payable, with respect to the related Interest Accrual Period, on any Class of Senior Subordinated Notes Outstanding that is identified
as “Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount” in the applicable Series Supplement (other than any Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest or Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest); provided, that if, on any Quarterly Payment
Date or other date of determination, the actual amount of any such interest cannot be ascertained, an estimate of such interest will
be used to calculate the Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount for such Quarterly Payment Date or other date of determination
in accordance with the terms and provisions of the applicable Series Supplement; provided, further, that any amount identified as “Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest” or “Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest” in any Series Supplement shall
under no circumstances be deemed to constitute part of the “Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount.”
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with
respect to any Class of Senior Subordinated Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of interest accrued with respect to such Interest
Accrual Period on each such Class of Senior Subordinated Notes that is identified as “Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest” in the applicable Series Supplement; provided that if, on any Monthly Allocation Date or other
date of determination, the actual amount of any such interest cannot be ascertained, an estimate of such interest will be used to calculate
the Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest for such Monthly Allocation Date or other
date of determination in accordance with the terms and provisions of the applicable Series Supplement; provided further that any
amount identified as “Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount” in any Series Supplement will under no circumstances
be deemed to constitute “Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest.”
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with respect
to any Class of Senior Subordinated Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of interest accrued with respect to such Interest Accrual
Period on each such Class of Senior Subordinated Notes that is identified as “Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity
Offering Additional Interest” in the applicable Series Supplement; provided that if, on any Monthly Allocation Date or other date
of determination, the actual amount of any such interest cannot be ascertained, an estimate of such interest will be used to calculate
the Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest for such Monthly Allocation Date or other date
of determination in accordance with the terms and provisions of the applicable Series Supplement; provided further that any amount identified
as “Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount” in any Series Supplement will under no circumstances be deemed to
constitute “Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest.”
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts” means, with respect to any Class of Senior Subordinated Notes Outstanding,
any Scheduled Principal Payments with respect to such Class of Senior Subordinated Notes.
“Senior
Subordinated Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount” has the meaning specified in the Series Supplement, with
respect to any Series of Senior Subordinated Notes.
“Series
2024-1 Notes” has the meaning set forth in the Series Supplement.
“Series
Account” means any account or accounts established pursuant to a Series Supplement for the benefit of a Series of Notes (or
any Class thereof).
“Series
Anticipated Repayment Date” means, with respect to each Series of Notes, or Class or Tranche thereof, the anticipated repayment
date provided for in the Series Supplement for such Series of Notes, or Class or Tranche thereof.
“Series
Closing Date” means, with respect to any Series, Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes, the date of issuance of such Series,
Class, Subclass or Tranche of Notes, as specified in the Series Supplement.
“Series
Defeasance Date” has the meaning set forth in Section 12.1(c) of the Base Indenture.
“Series
Distribution Account” means, with respect to any Series of Notes or any Class of any Series of Notes, an account established
to receive distributions to be paid to the Noteholders of such Class or such Series of Notes pursuant to the Series Supplement, if any.
“Series
Legal Final Maturity Date” means, with respect to any Series, the “Series Legal Final Maturity Date” set forth
in the Series Supplement.
“Series
Obligations” means, with respect to a Series of Notes, (a) all principal, interest, premiums and make-whole payments, at any
time and from time to time, owing by the Issuer on such Series of Notes or owing by the Guarantors pursuant to the Guarantee and Collateral
Agreement on such Series of Notes and (b) the payment and performance of all other obligations, covenants and liabilities of the Issuer
or the Guarantors arising under the Indenture, the Back-Up Management Agreement, the Notes or any other Indenture Document, in each case,
solely with respect to such Series of Notes.
“Series
of Notes” or “Series” means each series of Notes issued and authenticated pursuant to the Base Indenture
and the Series Supplement.
“Series
Supplement” means a supplement to the Base Indenture complying (to the extent applicable) with the terms of Section 2.3
and Article XIII of the Base Indenture regarding the issuance of a new Series of Notes.
“Services”
has the meaning set forth in the Management Agreement.
“Side
Letter” means the Side Letter Agreement, dated November 21, 2024, by and among the Issuer, the Manager, FAT Brands and each
Noteholder, as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, pursuant to which the Issuer, the Manager and/or FAT Brands
will agree to take or refrain from taking certain actions for the benefit of the Noteholders.
“Similar
Law” means any federal, state, local or non-U.S. laws or regulations that are substantially similar to Section 406 of ERISA
and/or Section 4975 of the Code.
“Software”
has the meaning set forth in the definition of “Intellectual Property.”
“Specified
Bankruptcy Opinion Provisions” means the provisions contained in the legal opinion(s) delivered in connection with the issuance
of each Series of Notes relating to the non-substantive consolidation of the Securitization Entities with Twin Hospitality.
“Specified
Payment Amendment Provisions” has the meaning set forth in Section 13.2(a)(iii).
“Subclass”
means, with respect to any Class of any Series of Notes, any one of the subclasses of Notes of such Class as specified in the Series
Supplement.
“Subordinated
Notes” means any issuance of Notes under the Indenture by the Issuer that are part of a Class with an alphanumerical designation
that contains any letter from “M” through “Z” of the alphabet.
“Subordinated
Noteholders” means, collectively, the holders of any Subordinated Notes.
“Subordinated
Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to a Quarterly Collection Period,
an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one-third of the Subordinated Notes Aggregate Quarterly Interest for the Interest
Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly
Interest Amount for such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) Subordinated Notes Aggregate Quarterly Interest
for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period exceeds (ii) the aggregate amount previously
allocated to the Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account with respect to the Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount on each
preceding Monthly Allocation Date (or prefunded on the Closing Date) with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period.
“Subordinated
Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation Date
with respect to a Quarterly Collection Period an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one-third of the Subordinated Notes
Aggregate Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding
Quarterly Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest
Amount for such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) Subordinated Notes Aggregate Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period exceeds
(ii) the aggregate amount previously allocated to the Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account
with respect to Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest on each preceding Monthly Allocation
Date with respect to the Quarterly Collection Period.
“Subordinated
Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly Collection
Period and any Subordinated Notes, the amount defined in the Series Supplement.
“Subordinated
Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly Collection
Period an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one third of the Subordinated Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments
for the Quarterly Payment Date in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled
Principal Payments Amount for such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) the Subordinated Notes Aggregate
Scheduled Principal Payments for the Quarterly Payment Date in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period exceeds (ii) the aggregate
amount previously allocated to the Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account with respect to the Subordinated Notes Aggregate Scheduled
Principal Payments on each preceding Monthly Allocation Date (or prefunded on the Closing Date) with respect to such Quarterly Collection
Period.
“Subordinated
Notes Aggregate Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with
respect to all Subordinated Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional
Interest accrued on all such Subordinated Notes with respect to such Interest Accrual Period.
“Subordinated
Notes Interest Payment Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as
trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account”, maintained by the Trustee
pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of
the Base Indenture.
“Subordinated
Notes Interest Shortfall Amount” has the meaning set forth in Section 5.11(b)(vii)(B) of the Base Indenture.
“Subordinated
Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account
entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest Account, maintained by the Trustee pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture or any successor securities
account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture.
“Subordinated
Notes Principal Payment Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as
trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account”, maintained by the Trustee
pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of
the Base Indenture.
“Subordinated
Notes Quarterly Interest Amount” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with respect to any Class of Subordinated Notes Outstanding,
the aggregate amount of interest due and payable, with respect to such Interest Accrual Period, on such Class of Subordinated Notes that
is identified as a “Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount” in the applicable Series Supplement (other than any Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest); provided that if, on any Monthly Allocation Date or other date of determination, the actual amount
of any such interest, fees or expenses cannot be ascertained, an estimate of such interest, fees or expenses will be used to calculate
the Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount for such Monthly Allocation Date or other date of determination in accordance with the
terms and provisions of the applicable Series Supplement; provided, further, that any amount identified as “Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest” in any Series Supplement shall under no circumstances be deemed to constitute part of the “Subordinated
Notes Quarterly Interest Amount.”
“Subordinated
Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with respect to
any Class of Subordinated Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of interest accrued with respect to such Interest Accrual Period on
each such Class of Subordinated Notes that is identified as “Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional
Interest” in the applicable Series Supplement; provided that if, on any Monthly Allocation Date or other date of determination,
the actual amount of any such interest cannot be ascertained, an estimate of such interest will be used to calculate the Subordinated
Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest for such Monthly Allocation Date or other date of determination in
accordance with the terms and provisions of the applicable Series Supplement; provided further that any amount identified as “Subordinated
Notes Quarterly Interest Amount” in any Series Supplement will under no circumstances be deemed to constitute “Subordinated
Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest.”
“Subordinated
Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts” means, with respect to any Class of Subordinated Notes Outstanding, any Scheduled
Principal Payments with respect to such Class of Subordinated Notes.
“Subordinated
Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount” has the meaning specified in the Series Supplement, with respect to any
Series of Subordinated Notes.
“Subsidiary”
means, with respect to any Person (herein referred to as the “parent”), any corporation, partnership, limited liability
company, association or other business entity (a) of which securities or other ownership interests representing more than 50% of the
equity or more than 50% of the ordinary voting power or more than 50% of the general partnership interests are, at the time any determination
is being made, owned, controlled or held by the parent or (b) that is, at the time any determination is being made, otherwise controlled,
by the parent or one or more subsidiaries of the parent or by the parent and one or more subsidiaries of the parent.
“Successor
Manager” means any successor to the Manager appointed by the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class
Representative) upon the resignation, termination, replacement or removal of the Manager pursuant to the terms of the Management Agreement.
“Successor
Manager Transition Expenses” means all costs and expenses incurred by a Successor Manager or the Interim Successor Manager
in connection with the resignation, termination, removal or replacement of the Manager under the Management Agreement.
“Successor
Control Party Transition Expenses” means all costs and expenses incurred by a successor Control Party in connection with the
termination, removal and replacement of the Control Party under the Control Party Agreement.
“Super
Senior Noteholder” means any Holder of Super Senior Notes of any Series.
“Super
Senior Notes” or “Class A-2-I Notes” means any Series or Class of any Series of Notes issued that are designated
as “Class A-2-I” and identified as “Super Senior Notes” in the Series Supplement.
“Super
Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to a Quarterly Collection
Period, an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one-third of the Super Senior Notes Aggregate Quarterly Interest for the
Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Super Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly
Interest Amount for such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) Super Senior Notes Aggregate Quarterly Interest
for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period exceeds (ii) the aggregate amount previously
allocated to the Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account with respect to the Super Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount on each
preceding Monthly Allocation Date (or prefunded on the Closing Date) with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period.
“Super
Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation
Date with respect to a Quarterly Collection Period an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one-third of the Super Senior
Notes Aggregate Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding
Quarterly Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Super Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest
Amount for such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) Super Senior Notes Aggregate Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period exceeds
(ii) the aggregate amount previously allocated to the Super Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account
with respect to Super Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest on each preceding Monthly Allocation
Date with respect to the Quarterly Collection Period.
“Super
Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation Date
with respect to an applicable Quarterly Collection Period, an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one-third of the Super
Senior Notes Aggregate Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding
Quarterly Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Super Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest
Amount for such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) Super Senior Notes Aggregate Quarterly Qualified Equity
Offering Additional Interest for the Interest Accrual Period ending in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period exceeds (ii) the
aggregate amount previously allocated to the Super Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account with respect to
Super Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Date Additional Interest on each preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect
to the applicable Quarterly Collection Period.
“Super
Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount” means, for each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly
Collection Period an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the sum of (i) one third of the Super Senior Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal
Payments for the Quarterly Payment Date in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period and (ii) the Carryover Super Senior Notes
Accrued Scheduled Principal Payments Amount for such Monthly Allocation Date and (b) the amount, if any, by which (i) the Super Senior
Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments for the Quarterly Payment Date in the next succeeding Quarterly Collection Period exceeds
(ii) the aggregate amount previously allocated to the Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account with respect to Super Senior Notes
Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments on each preceding Monthly Allocation Date (or prefunded on the Closing Date) with respect to such
Quarterly Collection Period.
“Super
Senior Notes Aggregate Quarterly Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with respect to all Super Senior Notes Outstanding,
the aggregate Super Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount due and payable on all such Super Senior Notes with respect to such Interest
Accrual Period.
“Super
Senior Notes Aggregate Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period,
with respect to all Super Senior Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of Super Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date
Additional Interest accrued on all such Super Senior Notes with respect to such Interest Accrual Period.
“Super
Senior Notes Aggregate Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with
respect to all Super Senior Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of Super Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional
Interest accrued on all such Super Senior Notes with respect to such Interest Accrual Period.
“Super
Senior Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments” means, for any Quarterly Payment Date, with respect to all Super Senior
Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of Super Senior Notes Scheduled Principal Payments Amounts due and payable on all such Super
Senior Notes on such Quarterly Payment Date.
“Super
Senior Notes Interest Payment Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A.,
as trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account”, maintained by the Trustee
pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of
the Base Indenture.
“Super
Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust
account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Super Senior Notes Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest Account, maintained by the Trustee pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture or any successor
securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture.
“Super
Senior Notes Principal Payment Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank,
N.A., as trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account”, maintained by
the Trustee pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section
5.5 of the Base Indenture.
“Super
Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account
entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Super Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering
Additional Interest Account” maintained by the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties pursuant to Section 5.5 of this Base
Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of this Base Indenture.
“Super
Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount” means with respect to each Quarterly Payment Date, the aggregate amount of interest
due and payable, with respect to the related Interest Accrual Period, on the Super Senior Notes that is identified as a “Super
Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount” in the Series Supplement (other than any Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest
or Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest); provided, that if, on any Quarterly Payment Date or other date of determination,
the actual amount of any such interest cannot be ascertained, an estimate of such interest will be used to calculate the Super Senior
Notes Quarterly Interest Amount for such Quarterly Payment Date or other date of determination in accordance with the terms and provisions
of the Series Supplement; provided, further, that any amount identified as “Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest”
or “Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest” in any Series Supplement shall under no circumstances be deemed to constitute
part of the “Super Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount.”
“Super
Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with respect
to any Class of Super Senior Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of interest accrued with respect to such Interest Accrual Period
on each such Class of Super Senior Notes that is identified as “Super Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional
Interest” in the Series Supplement; provided that if, on any Monthly Allocation Date or other date of determination, the actual
amount of any such interest cannot be ascertained, an estimate of such interest will be used to calculate the Super Senior Notes Quarterly
Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest for such Monthly Allocation Date or other date of determination in accordance with
the terms and provisions of the Series Supplement; provided further that any amount identified as “Super Senior Notes Quarterly
Interest Amount” in any Series Supplement will under no circumstances be deemed to constitute “Super Senior Notes Quarterly
Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest.”
“Super
Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest” means, for any Interest Accrual Period, with respect
to any Class of Super Senior Notes Outstanding, the aggregate amount of interest accrued with respect to such Interest Accrual Period
on each such Class of Super Senior Notes that is identified as “Super Senior Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional
Interest” in the applicable Series Supplement; provided that if, on any Monthly Allocation Date or other date of determination,
the actual amount of any such interest cannot be ascertained, an estimate of such interest will be used to calculate the Super Senior
Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest for such Monthly Allocation Date or other date of determination in accordance
with the terms and provisions of the applicable Series Supplement; provided further that any amount identified as “Super Senior
Notes Quarterly Interest Amount” in any Series Supplement will under no circumstances be deemed to constitute “Super Senior
Notes Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest.”
“Super
Senior Notes Scheduled Principal Payments Amounts” means, with respect to any Class of Super Senior Notes Outstanding, any
Scheduled Principal Payments with respect to such Class of Super Senior Notes.
“Super
Senior Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount” means, with respect to any Super Senior Notes Outstanding as calculated
in connection with any Quarterly Payment Date (1) the amount, if any, by which (a) the Super Senior Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal
Payments for such Class of Notes exceeds (b) the sum of (i) the amount of funds on deposit with respect to such Class of Notes in the
Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account plus (ii) any other funds on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts that are available
to pay the Super Senior Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments for such Class of Notes on such Quarterly Payment Date in accordance
with the Indenture, plus (2) any Super Senior Notes Aggregate Scheduled Principal Payments due but unpaid from any previous Quarterly
Payment Dates.
“Supplement”
means a Series Supplement or such other supplement to the Base Indenture or to any Series Supplement complying with the terms of Article
XIII hereof and, if a supplement to a Series Supplement, the applicable terms of such Series Supplement.
“Supplemental
Management Fee” means for each Monthly Allocation Date with respect to any Quarterly Collection Period the amount, approved
in writing by the Control Party acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative, by which, with respect to any Quarterly
Collection Period, (i) the expenses incurred or other amounts charged by the Manager since the beginning of such Quarterly Collection
Period in connection with the performance of the Manager’s obligations under the Management Agreement and the amount of any current
or projected Tax Payment Deficiency, if applicable, exceed (ii) the Monthly Management Fees received and to be received by the
Manager on such Monthly Allocation Date and each preceding Monthly Allocation Date with respect to such Quarterly Collection Period.
“Swap
Contract” means (a) any and all rate swap transactions, basis swaps, credit derivative transactions, forward rate transactions,
commodity swaps, commodity options, forward commodity contracts, equity or equity index swaps or options, bond or bond price or bond
index swaps or options or forward bond or forward bond price or forward bond index transactions, interest rate options, forward foreign
exchange transactions, cap transactions, cross-currency rate swap transactions, currency options, spot contracts, or any other similar
transactions or any combination of any of the foregoing (including any options to enter into any of the foregoing), whether or not any
such transaction is governed by or subject to any master agreement, and (b) any and all transactions of any kind, and the related confirmations,
which are subject to the terms and conditions of, or governed by, any form of master agreement published by the International Swaps and
Derivatives Association, Inc., any International Foreign Exchange Master Agreement, or any other master agreement (any such master agreement,
together with any related schedules, a “Master Agreement”), including any such obligations or liabilities under any
Master Agreement.
“Tax”
means (i) any federal, state, local or foreign income, gross receipts, license, payroll, employment, excise, severance, stamp, occupation,
premium, environmental, customs duties, capital stock, profits, documentary, property, franchise, withholding, social security (or similar),
unemployment, disability, real property, personal property, sales, use, transfer, registration, value added, alternative or add-on minimum,
or other tax of any kind whatsoever, including any interest, penalty, fine, assessment or addition thereto and (ii) any transferee liability
in respect of any items described in clause (i) above.
“Tax
Information” means information and/or properly completed and signed tax certifications sufficient to eliminate the imposition
of or to determine the amount of any withholding of tax, including backup withholding and withholding required pursuant to FATCA.
“Tax
Lien Reserve Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o
the Secured Parties, Twin Hospitality I, LLC Tax Lien Reserve Account”, maintained by the Trustee pursuant to Section 5.5
of the Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture.
“Tax
Lien Reserve Amount” means any funds contributed by Twin Hospitality or a Subsidiary thereof to satisfy Liens filed by the
IRS pursuant to Section 6323 of the Code against any Securitization Entity.
“Tax
Opinion” means an opinion of tax counsel of nationally recognized standing in the United States experienced in such matters
to be delivered in connection with the issuance of the Notes to the effect that, for United States federal income tax purposes, (a) the
Class A-2-I Notes and the Class A-2-II Notes will, and the Class B-2 Notes should be characterized as indebtedness as of the date of
issuance, to the extent treated as beneficially owned by a person other than the Manager or an Affiliate of the Manager and (b) except
with respect to any Additional Guarantor (including Additional Guarantors organized with the consent of the Control Party (acting at
the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) pursuant to Section 8.34(b) of the Base Indenture) in existence as of the
date of delivery of such opinion that will be treated as a corporation for United States federal income tax purposes, the Issuer organized
in the United States, each other Securitization Entity organized in the United States in existence as of the date of the delivery of
such opinion, and each other direct or indirect Subsidiary of the Issuer organized in the United States in existence as of the date of
delivery of such opinion will not as of the date of issuance be classified as a corporation or as an association or a publicly traded
partnership taxable as a corporation.
“Tax
Payment Deficiency” means any Tax liability of Twin Hospitality (or, if Twin Hospitality is not the taxable parent entity of
any Securitization Entity, such other taxable parent entity) (including Taxes imposed under Treasury Regulation Section 1.1502-6 (or
any similar provision of state, local or foreign law)) attributable to the operations of the Securitization Entities or their direct
or indirect Subsidiaries that the Manager determines cannot be satisfied by Twin Hospitality (or such other taxable parent entity) from
its available funds.
“Title
Policy” means an ALTA mortgagee title insurance policy issued by a title insurance company reasonably acceptable to the Control
Party (it being understood that Old Republic Title Insurance Company shall be deemed acceptable to the Control Party) in an insured amount
reasonably acceptable to Control Party, not to exceed 110% of the estimated value of the property, insuring the related Mortgage as a
first priority mortgage lien, free and clear of all defects and encumbrances except Permitted Liens, and otherwise in form and substance
reasonably satisfactory to the Control Party, and shall include such endorsements as are (i) reasonably requested by the Control Party
and (ii) available at commercially reasonable rates.
“Trade
Secrets” has the meaning set forth in the definition of “Intellectual Property”.
“Trademarks”
means all United States, state and non-U.S. trademarks, service marks, trade names, trade dress, designs, logos, slogans and other indicia
of source or origin, whether registered or unregistered, registrations and pending applications to register the foregoing, internet domain
names, and all goodwill of any business connected with the use thereof or symbolized thereby.
“Tranche”
means with respect to any Class or Subclass of any Series of Notes, any one of the tranches of Notes of such Class or Subclass as specified
in the Series Supplement.
“Transaction
Documents” means the Indenture Documents, the Notes, each control agreement relating to an account, the Guarantee and Collateral
Agreement, each Account Control Agreement, the Management Agreement, the Control Party Agreement, the Back-Up Management Agreement, the
Contribution Agreement (TP Buyer), the Contribution Agreement (SB Equity), the Sale and Contribution Agreement (Issuer), the Side Letter,
the Warrants, the Contingent Value Rights Agreement, the Limited Guaranty, the IP License Agreements, any note purchase agreement pursuant
to which Notes are purchased, any Enhancement Agreement, Charter Documents, the organizational documents of the Securitization Entities
and any additional document identified as a “Transaction Document” in the Series Supplement for any Series of Notes Outstanding
and any other material agreements entered into, or certificates delivered, pursuant to the foregoing documents.
“Transaction
Expenses” means all expenses and fees incurred in connection with the consummation of the transactions contemplated by the
Indenture and application of the proceeds of the Notes, including, without limitation, professional, financing and accounting fees, costs
and expenses, transfer taxes and any premiums, fees, discounts, expenses and losses (and any amortization thereof) payable in connection
with a tender offer for and redemption or prepayment of Indebtedness (including amortization or write offs of debt issuance or deferred
financing costs, premiums and prepayment penalties).
“Transition
Plan” means a comprehensive plan created by the Back-Up Manager with the assistance and oversight of the Control Party to prepare
for a transition to a Successor Manager, other than the Back-Up Manager, if the Manager is terminated following the occurrence of a Manager
Termination Event.
“Trust
Officer” means any officer within the corporate trust department of the Trustee, including any Senior Vice President, Vice
President, Assistant Vice President or Assistant Treasurer of the Corporate Trust Office or any officer customarily performing functions
similar to those performed by the person who at the time will be such officers, in each case having direct responsibility for the administration
of this Indenture, and also, with respect to a particular matter, any officer to whom any corporate trust matter is referred because
of his or her knowledge of and familiarity with a particular subject.
“Trustee”
means the party named as such in the Indenture acting in its capacity as trustee until a successor replaces it in accordance with the
applicable provisions of the Indenture and thereafter means the successor serving thereunder. On the Closing Date, the Trustee shall
be UMB Bank, N.A., a national banking association.
“Trustee
Accounts” has the meaning set forth in Section 5.7(a) of the Base Indenture.
“Twin
Hospitality” means Twin Hospitality Group Inc., a Delaware corporation, and its successors and assigns.
“Twin
Hospitality Securitization Entities” means Twin Hospitality and each of its direct and indirect Subsidiaries (excluding any
such Subsidiaries that are issuers or direct or indirect subsidiaries of such issuers in connection with any asset-backed securitization
or financing).
“Twin
Hospitality TP Entities” means Twin Hospitality and each of its direct and indirect Subsidiaries, now existing or hereafter
created, other than the Twin Hospitality Securitization Entities.
“Twin
Hospitality TP Systems” means the system of Branded restaurants operating under the Brands.
“Twin
Hospitality TP Systemwide Sales” means, with respect to any Quarterly Calculation Date, aggregate Gross Sales (which will be
permitted to include a good faith estimate (in accordance with the Managing Standard) of estimated Gross Sales of up to 10% of the total
to the extent actual Gross Sales are not available as of such Quarterly Calculation Date) for all Branded Restaurants for the four (4)
Quarterly Fiscal Periods ended immediately prior to such Quarterly Calculation Date.
“U.S.
Dollars” or “$” refers to lawful money of the United States of America.
“UCC”
means the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in the specified jurisdiction or any applicable jurisdiction, as the
case may be.
“UETA”
has the meaning set forth in Section 14.11 of this Base Indenture.
“United
States” or “U.S.” means the United States of America, its fifty states and the District of Columbia.
“Warm
Back-Up Management Duties” has the meaning set forth in the Back-Up Management Agreement.
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
A
Form
of Monthly Manager’s Certificate
(Attached.)
TWIN HOSPITALITY GROUP INC.
MONTHLY MANAGER’S CERTIFICATE
Monthly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Monthly
Allocation Date: |
______________,
20____ |
|
|
Quarterly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Next
Quarterly Payment Date: |
______________,
20____ |
Collections and Retained Collections during Monthly Collection Period: | |
| | |
Collections | |
| | |
Distributions from Guarantors | |
$ | | |
Proceeds from disposition of Collateral required to be deposited | |
$ | | |
Investment Income earned from funds on deposit in the following accounts, if applicable: | |
| | |
Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Notes Interest Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Notes Principal Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Securitization Operating Expenses Account | |
$ | | |
Reserve Account | |
$ | | |
Super Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Super Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Subordinated Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Tax Lien Reserve Account | |
$ | | |
Concentration Account | |
$ | | |
Other accounts subject to an Account Control Agreement | |
$ | | |
Equity Contributions made to Issuer | |
$ | | |
Excluded Amounts | |
$ | | |
Amounts released from Reserve Account | |
$ | | |
Any Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds, Asset Disposition Proceeds or Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds required to be deposited | |
$ | | |
Other payments or proceeds received with respect to the Collateral | |
$ | | |
Other amounts | |
$ | | |
Total Collections during Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Excluded Amounts | |
| | |
Advertising Fees | |
$ | | |
Fees and expenses paid by or on behalf of any Guarantor in connection with Securitization IP | |
$ | | |
Account expenses and fees paid to banks pursuant to Management Accounts | |
$ | | |
Insurance and condemnation proceeds payable to Franchisees | |
$ | | |
Withholding, sales, or other taxes | |
$ | | |
Amounts paid by Guarantors for corporate services provided by the Manager | |
$ | | |
Proceeds of directors’ and officers’ insurance | |
$ | | |
Transfers to Concentration Account or Collection Account not permitted by law | |
$ | | |
Proceeds of any offer and sale of Notes except if refinancing existing Notes | |
$ | | |
Equity proceeds | |
$ | | |
Insurance and condemnation proceeds payable to third-parties, the Manager or the Securitization Entities | |
$ | | |
Rebates, credits and any other amounts paid by or on behalf of the Manager to any Guarantor in connection with any Rebate Agreement or agreements related thereto | |
$ | | |
Distributor Costs of Goods Sold, Distribution Operating Expenses, Distributor Franchisee Rebates and Distribution Center Expenses | |
$ | | |
Other Amounts | |
$ | | |
Total Excluded Amounts during Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Total Collections during Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Less: Total Excluded Amounts during Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Total Retained Collections during Monthly Collection Period (To be deposited to the Collection Account) | |
$ | | |
TWIN HOSPITALITY GROUP INC.
MONTHLY MANAGER’S CERTIFICATE
Monthly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Monthly
Allocation Date: |
______________,
20____ |
|
|
Quarterly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Next
Quarterly Payment Date: |
______________,
20____ |
Fees, Expenses and Annual Cap Accruals: | |
| | |
| |
| | |
Fees and Expenses payable on Monthly Allocation Date: | |
| | |
| |
| | |
Trustee fees, expenses, and indemnities | |
$ | | |
Control Party fees, expenses, and indemnities | |
$ | | |
Control Party expenses and indemnities incurred without direction from Controlling Class Representative | |
$ | | |
Manager Advances | |
$ | | |
Successor Manager Transition Expenses | |
$ | | |
Monthly Management Fee | |
$ | | |
Securitization Operating Expenses | |
| | |
Accrued and unpaid taxes, filings fees, and registration fees | |
$ | | |
Fees and expenses to the Back-Up Manager | |
$ | | |
Fees and expenses to independent accountants, auditors and external legal counsel | |
$ | | |
Stock exchange fees related to exchanges where Notes may be listed | |
$ | | |
Indemnification obligations of the Securitization Entities | |
$ | | |
Independent Director and Independent Manager Fees | |
$ | | |
Other Securitization Operating Expenses | |
$ | | |
Total Fees and Expenses payable on Monthly Allocation Date: | |
$ | | |
TWIN HOSPITALITY GROUP INC.
MONTHLY MANAGER’S CERTIFICATE
Monthly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Monthly
Allocation Date: |
______________,
20____ |
|
|
Quarterly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Next
Quarterly Payment Date: |
______________,
20____ |
Accruals towards Annual Caps on Fees and Expenses: | |
| | |
| |
| | |
Trustee and Control Party Fees, Expenses, and Indemnities | |
| | |
Cumulative Annual Balance as of Prior Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Additions during current Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Cumulative Annual Balance as of end of Current Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Annual Calendar Year Cap | |
$ | 250,000 | |
| |
| | |
Control Party Expenses and Indemnities incurred without direction from Controlling Class Representative | |
| | |
Cumulative Annual Balance as of Prior Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Additions during current Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Cumulative Annual Balance as of end of Current Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Annual Calendar Year Cap | |
$ | 200,000 | |
| |
| | |
Securitization Operating Expenses | |
| | |
Cumulative Annual Balance as of Prior Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Additions during current Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Cumulative Annual Balance as of end of Current Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Annual Rolling Cap Beginning on Closing Date | |
$ | | |
Monthly Allocation of Funds:
Deposits to the Collection Account of Investment Income from Eligible Investments of funds in the following accounts:
Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Notes Interest Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Notes Principal Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account | |
$ | | |
Super Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Subordinated Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Super Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Senior Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Securitization Operating Expense Account | |
$ | | |
Reserve Account | |
$ | | |
Tax Lien Reserve Account | |
$ | | |
Other accounts subject to an Account Control Agreement | |
$ | | |
Total Investment Income on deposit to be transferred by Trustee to the Collection Account | |
$ | | |
TWIN HOSPITALITY GROUP INC.
MONTHLY MANAGER’S CERTIFICATE
Monthly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Monthly
Allocation Date: |
______________,
20____ |
|
|
Quarterly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Next
Quarterly Payment Date: |
______________,
20____ |
Triggers: |
|
|
|
Cash
Sweeping Period |
Yes
/ No |
|
|
Cash
Flow Sweeping Percentage, if applicable |
[ ]% |
|
|
Rapid
Amortization Period |
Yes
/ No |
|
|
Manager
Termination Event |
Yes
/ No |
|
|
Event
of Default |
Yes
/ No |
|
|
Level
I Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event |
Yes
/ No |
|
|
Level
II Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event |
Yes
/ No |
Monthly
Priority of Payment Allocation: |
|
|
|
|
|
Retained
Collections plus Reserve Account Withdrawal Amount, less |
|
$ |
First,
● |
Reimbursement of Trustee fees, expenses, Mortgage Recordation Fees and indemnities to Trustee; | |
$ | | |
● |
Reimbursement of Control Party fees, expenses, and indemnities to Control Party; | |
$ | | |
● |
Reimbursement of Control Party expenses and indemnities incurred without direction from Controlling Class Representative to Control Party; | |
$ | | |
Second,
● |
Reimbursement of Manager Advances to Manager; | |
$ | | |
Third,
● |
Payment of Successor Manager Transition Expenses, if any, to Successor Manager; | |
$ | | |
TWIN HOSPITALITY GROUP INC.
MONTHLY MANAGER’S CERTIFICATE
Monthly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Monthly
Allocation Date: |
______________,
20____ |
|
|
Quarterly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Next
Quarterly Payment Date: |
______________,
20____ |
Fourth,
● |
Payment of Monthly Management Fee to Manager; | |
$ | | |
Fifth,
● |
pro rata, (A) Deposit of Capped Securitization Operating Expenses to Securitization Operating Expense Account, (B) reimbursement of Controlling Class Representative fees, expenses, and indemnities to Controlling Class Representative; and (C) after a Mortgage Recordation Event, all Mortgage Recordation Fees due and owing to the Control Party | |
$ | | |
Sixth,
● |
pro rata, (A) Deposit of Super Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount to Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account; and (B) deposit of Super Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount to the Super Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Seventh,
● |
Deposit of Super Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment to Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ | | |
● |
Deposit of Super Senior Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount to Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ | | |
● |
Deposit of Indemnification Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds, Asset Disposition Proceeds or any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds to Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ | | |
● |
In the case of any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds, deposit of amount necessary to reduce the Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class of Super Senior Notes to zero to Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ | | |
Eighth,
● |
pro rata, (A) Deposit of Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount to Senior Notes Interest Payment Account; and (B) deposit of Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount to the Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
Ninth,
● |
Deposit of Senior Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment to Senior Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ | | |
● |
Deposit of Senior Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount to Senior Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ | | |
● |
Deposit of Indemnification Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds, Asset Disposition Proceeds or any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds to Senior Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ | | |
● |
In the case of any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds, deposit of amount necessary to reduce the Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class of Senior Notes to zero to Senior Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
| | |
TWIN HOSPITALITY GROUP INC.
MONTHLY MANAGER’S CERTIFICATE
Monthly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Monthly
Allocation Date: |
______________,
20____ |
|
|
Quarterly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Next
Quarterly Payment Date: |
______________,
20____ |
Tenth,
● |
Deposit of Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest
Amount to Senior Subordinated Interest Payment Account | |
$ |
Eleventh,
● |
Deposit of Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal
Payment Amount to Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ |
● |
Deposit of Senior Subordinated Notes Scheduled Principal Payment
Deficiency Amount to Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ |
● |
Deposit of Indemnification Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation
Proceeds, Asset Disposition Proceeds or any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds to Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ |
● |
In the case of any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds, deposit
of amount necessary to reduce the Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class of Senior Subordinated Notes to zero to Senior Subordinated
Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
|
Twelfth,
● |
Deposit of Reserve Account Deficient Amount to Reserve Account; | |
$ |
Thirteenth,
● |
If a Cash Flow Sweeping Period is continuing, deposit the lesser
of (a) the product of the Cash Flow Sweeping percentage and the funds available in the Collection Account after application of priorities
(i) - (xii) or (b) the aggregate Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class of Super Senior Notes to Super Senior Notes Principal
Payment Account; | |
$ |
Fourteenth,
● |
If a Cash Flow Sweeping Period is continuing, deposit the lesser
of (a) the product of the Cash Flow Sweeping percentage and the funds available in the Collection Account after application of priorities
(i) - (xii) subtracted by the amounts paid in priority (xiii), if any, or (b) the aggregate Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class
of Senior Notes to Senior Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ |
Fifteenth,
● |
If a Cash Flow Sweeping Period is continuing, deposit the lesser
of (a) the product of the Cash Flow Sweeping percentage and the funds available in the Collection Account after application of priorities
(i) - (xii) subtracted by the amounts paid in priorities (xiii) and (xiv), if any, or (b) the aggregate Outstanding Principal Amount
of the Senior Subordinated Notes to Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ |
Sixteenth,
● |
If a Rapid Amortization Period is continuing, deposit 100%
of amounts remaining in Collection Account 1st to each Class of Super Senior Notes to Super Senior Notes Principal Payment
Account; | |
|
● |
2nd to each Class of Senior Notes to Senior Notes
Payment Account; and | |
|
● |
3rd to each Class of Senior Subordinated Notes to
Senior Subordinated Notes Payment Account; | |
$ |
TWIN HOSPITALITY GROUP INC.
MONTHLY MANAGER’S CERTIFICATE
Monthly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Monthly
Allocation Date: |
______________,
20____ |
|
|
Quarterly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Next
Quarterly Payment Date: |
______________,
20____ |
Seventeenth,
● |
Deposit of Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Interest Amount
to Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account; | |
$ |
Eighteenth,
● |
Deposit of Subordinated Notes Accrued Scheduled Principal Payment
Amount to Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ |
● |
Deposit of Subordinated Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency
Amount to Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ |
● |
Deposit of Indemnification Amounts, Insurance/Condemnation
Proceeds, Asset Disposition Proceed or any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds to Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ |
● |
In the case of any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds, deposit
of amount necessary to reduce the Outstanding Principal Amount of each Class of Subordinated Notes to zero to Subordinated Notes Principal
Payment Account; | |
|
Nineteenth,
● |
to pay the Supplemental Management Fee to the Manager; | |
$ |
Twentieth,
● |
If a Rapid Amortization Period is continuing, deposit 100%
of amounts remaining in Collection Account to each Class of Subordinated Notes to Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account; | |
$ |
Twenty-first,
● |
Payment of pro rata, any Trustee expenses due not previously paid in priority (i) to Trustee; and | |
$ |
|
| |
|
|
○ |
any Control Party Expenses due not previously paid in priority
(i) to Control Party; and | |
$ |
|
○ |
Deposit of any Securitization Operating Expenses accrued
but unpaid in priority (v) to Securitization Operating Expense Account; | |
$ |
Twenty-second, | |
|
| |
|
● |
Allocate to the Super Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account any Super Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly
Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount for any Class of Super Senior Notes for such Monthly Allocation Date; | |
|
Twenty-third, | |
|
| |
|
● |
Allocate to the Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account any Senior Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount for any Class of Senior Notes for such Monthly Allocation Date; | |
|
TWIN HOSPITALITY GROUP INC.
MONTHLY MANAGER’S CERTIFICATE
Monthly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Monthly
Allocation Date: |
______________,
20____ |
|
|
Quarterly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Next
Quarterly Payment Date: |
______________,
20____ |
Twenty-fourth, | |
| |
| |
| |
● |
Pro rata, allocate to the Senior Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account any Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount for any Class of Senior Subordinated Notes for such Monthly Allocation Date; | |
| | |
|
| |
| | |
● |
Pro rata, allocate to the Senior Subordinated Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account any Senior Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Amount for any Class of Senior Subordinated Notes for such Monthly Allocation Date | |
| | |
Twenty-fifth,
● |
Allocate to the Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account any Subordinated Notes Accrued Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Amount for any Class of Subordinated Notes for such Monthly Allocation Date; and | |
$ | | |
Twenty-sixth,
|
| |
| | |
● |
Payment of 100% of Residual Amount at the direction of Issuer. | |
$ | | |
|
| |
| | |
In the event that any Exchange Notes have been exchanged for
the related Class of Exchangeable Notes in an Exchangeable Combination, such Class of Exchangeable Notes received in such an exchange
shall be entitled to a proportionate share of the interest and principal payments, as applicable, otherwise allocable to the Exchange
Notes that were exchanged for the Exchangeable Notes, in accordance with the payment priorities set forth above. | |
| | |
Payments
from the Collection Account to the following parties: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Trustee |
|
$ |
|
Control
Party |
|
$ |
|
Manager |
|
$ |
|
Successor
Manager, if any |
|
$ |
|
Other |
|
$ |
|
Total
payments to be made by Trustee from the Collection Account |
|
$ |
|
TWIN HOSPITALITY GROUP INC.
MONTHLY MANAGER’S CERTIFICATE
Monthly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Monthly
Allocation Date: |
______________,
20____ |
|
|
Quarterly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Next
Quarterly Payment Date: |
______________,
20____ |
Deposits from the Collection Account to the following accounts and allocations: | |
| |
| |
| |
Accrual of interest related to Series 20__-_ Class A-2-I Notes | |
| |
Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Accrual of interest related to Series 20__-_ Class A-2-II Notes | |
| | |
Senior Notes Interest Payment Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Accrual of interest related to Series 20__-_ Class B-2 Notes | |
$ | | |
Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Accrual of interest related to Series 20__-_ Class M-2 Notes | |
$ | | |
Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Principal payments to Series 20__-_ Class A-2-I Notes | |
| | |
Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Principal payments to Series 20__-_ Class A-2-II Notes | |
| | |
Senior Notes Principal Payment Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Principal payments to Series 20__-_ Class B-2 Notes | |
$ | | |
Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Principal payments to Series 20__-_ Class M-2 Notes | |
$ | | |
Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Additional interest payments to Series 20__-_ Class A-2-I Notes | |
$ | | |
Super Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Additional interest payments to Series 20__-_ Class A-2-II Notes | |
$ | | |
Senior Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Additional interest payments to Series 20__-_ Class B-2 Notes | |
$ | | |
Senior Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Additional interest payments to Series 20__-_ Class M-2 Notes | |
$ | | |
Subordinated Notes Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Additional interest payments to Series 20__-_ Class A-2-I Notes | |
$ | | |
Super Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Additional interest payments to Series 20__-_ Class A-2-II Notes | |
$ | | |
Senior Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Additional interest payments to Series 20__-_ Class B-2 Notes | |
$ | | |
Senior Subordinated Notes Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Account | |
$ | | |
| |
| | |
Securitization Operating Expense Account | |
$ | | |
TWIN HOSPITALITY GROUP INC.
MONTHLY MANAGER’S CERTIFICATE
Monthly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Monthly
Allocation Date: |
______________,
20____ |
|
|
Quarterly
Collection Period: |
______________,
20____ TO ______________, 20____ |
Next
Quarterly Payment Date: |
______________,
20____ |
Payments from the Securitization Operating Expense Account to the following parties: | |
| |
Back-up Manager | |
$ | | |
Independent accountants, auditors and external legal counsel | |
$ | | |
Independent Director and Independent Manager | |
$ | | |
Other | |
$ | | |
Total payments to be made by Trustee from the Securitization Operating Expense Account | |
$ | | |
Reserve Account Amounts: | |
| |
| |
| |
Available
Required Reserve Amount as of Prior Monthly Allocation Date | |
$ | | |
Deposits into Reserve Account during Monthly Collection Period | |
$ | | |
Less releases from Required Reserve Amount | |
$ | | |
Available Required Reserve Amount as of Current Monthly Allocation Date | |
$ | | |
IN
WITNESS HEREOF, the undersigned has duly executed and delivered this Monthly Manager’s Certificate
this
_______________________________________
Twin
Hospitality Group Inc. as Manager on behalf of Issuer, Twin Hospitality I, LLC, and certain subsidiaries thereto,
by:
_______________________________________
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
B
Form
of Investor Request Certification
UMB
Bank, N.A.
100 William Street, Suite 1850
New
York, NY 10038
Attention:
Michele Voon
Email:
xxxxxxxxxxx
Pursuant
to Section 4.4 of the Base Indenture, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality I, LLC, as Issuer, and UMB
Bank, N.A., as Trustee and Securities Intermediary (as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, the “Base
Indenture”), the undersigned hereby certifies and agrees to the following conditions. Capitalized terms used herein but not
otherwise defined herein shall have the respective meanings ascribed thereto in Annex A to the Base Indenture.
1.
The undersigned is a [Noteholder][Note Owner][prospective purchaser] of Series [ ] [ ]% Fixed Rate [Super] [Senior] [Subordinate] Secured
Notes, Class _-_. In the case that the undersigned is a Note Owner, the undersigned is a beneficial owner of Notes. In the case that
the undersigned is a prospective purchaser, the undersigned has been designated by a Noteholder or Note Owner as a prospective transferee
of Notes.
2.
The undersigned is requesting all information and copies of all documents that the Trustee is required to deliver to such Noteholder,
Note Owner or prospective purchaser, as the case may be, pursuant to Section 4.4 of the Base Indenture. In the case that the undersigned
is a Noteholder, Note Owner or a prospective purchaser, pursuant to Section 4.4 of the Base Indenture, the undersigned is also
requesting access for the undersigned to the password-protected area of the Trustee’s website at www.debtx.com (or such other address
as the Trustee may specify from time to time) relating to the Notes.
3.
The undersigned is requesting such information solely for use in evaluating the undersigned’s investment, or possible investment
in the case of a prospective purchaser, in the Notes.
4.
The undersigned is not a Competitor.
5.
The undersigned understands that [the documents it has requested][and][the Trustee’s website] contains confidential information.
6.
In consideration of the Trustee’s disclosure to the undersigned, the undersigned will keep the information strictly confidential,
and such information will not be disclosed by the undersigned or by its officers, directors, partners, employees, agents or representatives
in any manner whatsoever, without the prior written consent of the Manager or used for any purpose other than evaluating the undersigned’s
investment or possible investment in the Notes; provided, however, that the undersigned shall be permitted to disclose such information:
(A) to (1) those personnel employed by it who need to know such information which have agreed to keep such information confidential and
to treat the information as confidential information, (2) its attorneys and outside auditors which have agreed to keep such information
confidential and to treat the information as confidential information, or (3) a regulatory or self-regulatory authority pursuant to applicable
law or regulation or (B) by judicial process; provided, that it may disclose to any and all persons, without limitation of any kind,
the tax treatment and tax structure of the transactions and any related tax strategies to the extent necessary to prevent the transaction
from being described as a “confidential transaction” under U.S. Treasury Regulations Section 1.6011-4(b)(3).
7.
The undersigned will not use or disclose the information in any manner which could result in a violation of any provision of the 1933
Act or the Exchange Act or would require registration of any non-registered security pursuant to the 1933 Act.
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has caused its name to be signed hereto by its duly authorized officer.
Name
of [Noteholder][Note Owner][prospective purchaser]
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
C
RELEASE
REQUEST
Reference
is made to the Base Indenture, dated as of November 21, 2024 (as it may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time
in accordance with the terms thereof, the “Base Indenture”), between Twin Hospitality I, LLC (f/k/a Fat Brands Twin
Peaks I, LLC), a Delaware limited liability company, (the “Issuer”), and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee (in such capacity,
the “Trustee”), and as securities intermediary. Capitalized terms used but not otherwise defined herein shall have
the meanings set forth in the Base Indenture.
Pursuant
to Section 5.3(c) of the Base Indenture, the Manager, on behalf of the Issuer, desires that the Trustee release funds in the Permitted
Uses Account to the Manager solely for further application to Permitted Uses in accordance with the applicable terms and conditions of
the Base Indenture on [mm/dd/yy] (the “Release Date”):
1. |
Amount
Requested: |
$ |
[___,___,___] |
The
Manager hereby certifies that:
(i)
as of the Release Date, each Transaction Documents is in full force and effect and no provision thereof has been amended, restated, supplemented,
modified or waived in any material respect without the consent of the parties thereto;
(ii)
as of the Release Date, the representations and warranties made by the Issuer and the Manager contained in the Transaction Documents
to which they are a party are true and correct in all material respects on and as of such Release Date to the same extent as though made
on and as of such date, except to the extent such representations and warranties specifically relate to an earlier date, in which case
such representations and warranties are true and correct in all material respects on and as of such earlier date; and
(iii)
as of the Release Date, after giving effect to the requested release of funds from the Permitted Uses Account on the Release Date, no
event has occurred and is continuing or would result from the consummation of the borrowing contemplated hereby that would constitute
an Event of Default.
Date:
[mm/dd/yy] |
TWIN
HOSPITALITY I, LLC |
|
as
Issuer |
|
|
|
By: |
|
|
Name: |
|
|
Title: |
|
|
|
|
|
TWIN
HOSPITALITY GROUP INC. |
|
as
Manager |
|
|
|
By: |
|
|
Name: |
|
|
Title:
|
|
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
D
[Reserved]
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
E
[Reserved]
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
EXHIBIT
A
[Reserved]
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
F
[Reserved]
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
G
Form
of Noteholder Certification
Sent
to:
Re:
Request to Communicate with Noteholders
Reference
is made to Section 11.5(b) of the Base Indenture, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality I, LLC, as Issuer,
and UMB Bank, N.A., as Trustee and Securities Intermediary (as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, the “Base
Indenture”). Capitalized terms used herein but not otherwise defined herein shall have the respective meanings ascribed thereto
in Annex A to the Base Indenture.
The
undersigned hereby certify that they are Noteholders who collectively hold beneficial interests of not less than $_______________ in
aggregate principal amount of Notes.
The
undersigned wish to communicate with other Noteholders with respect to their rights under the Indenture or under the Notes and hereby
request that the Trustee deliver the enclosed notice or communication to all other Noteholders.
The
undersigned agree to indemnify the Trustee for its costs and expenses in connection with the delivery of the enclosed notice or communication.
|
Dated:
_______________________________________ |
|
Signed:
______________________________________ |
|
Printed
Name: _________________________________ |
|
Dated:
_______________________________________ |
|
Signed:
_______________________________________ |
|
Printed
Name: __________________________________ |
Enclosure(s):
[ ]
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
H
Form
of Transferee Certification
Sent to: |
UMB Bank, N.A., as Trustee |
Twin
Hospitality I, LLC, as Issuer
Re: |
Transfer of [Insert Series
and Class] Notes of Twin Hospitality I, LLC |
Reference
is made to Section 2.8(g) of the Base Indenture, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality I, LLC, as Issuer,
and UMB Bank, N.A., as Trustee and Securities Intermediary (as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, the “Base
Indenture”). Capitalized terms used herein but not otherwise defined herein shall have the respective meanings ascribed thereto
in Annex A to the Base Indenture.
In
connection with the transfer of [Insert Series and Class] Notes, the undersigned hereby certifies as follows:
(1)
It is not a member of an “expanded group” (within the meaning of Section 385 of the Code and the regulations thereunder)
that includes a domestic corporation (as determined for U.S. federal income tax purposes) if such domestic corporation, directly or indirectly
(through one or more entities that are treated for U.S. federal income tax purposes as partnerships, disregarded entities, or grantor
trusts) owns membership interests of the Issuer; provided that it may acquire Notes in violation of this restriction if it provides the
Issuer (a copy of which the Issuer shall provide to the Trustee) with an opinion of nationally recognized tax counsel experienced in
such matters reasonably acceptable to the Issuer to the effect that the acquisition or transfer of such Notes will not cause such Notes
to be treated as equity pursuant to Section 385 of the Code and the regulations thereunder.
(2)
If it is classified for U.S. federal income tax purposes as a partnership, subchapter S corporation or grantor trust then (A) none of
the direct or indirect beneficial owners of any interest in such person have or ever will have more than 50% of the value of its interest
in such person attributable to the aggregate interest of such person in the combined value of the Notes (and/or any equity interests
in the Issuer for U.S. federal income tax purposes), and (B) it is not and will not be a principal purpose of the arrangement involving
the investment of such person in any Note and/or equity interests of the Issuer to permit the Issuer to satisfy the “private placement”
safe harbor of Treasury Regulation Section 1.7704-1(h).
(3)
It will not directly or indirectly sell, encumber, assign, participate, pledge, hypothecate, rehypothecate, exchange or otherwise dispose
of, suffer the creation of a lien on, or transfer or convey (each, a “Transfer”) the Notes (or any interest therein
described in Treasury Regulation Section 1.7704-1(a)(2)(i)(B)) in any manner or cause the Notes (or any interest therein) to be marketed,
in each case, (i) on or through an “established securities market” or a “secondary market (or the substantial equivalent
thereof)” within the meaning of Section 7704(b) of the Code and Treasury Regulation Sections 1.7704-1(b) and 1.7704-1(c), including,
without limitation, an interdealer quotation system that regularly disseminates firm buy or sell quotations, or (ii) if such Transfer
would cause the combined number of holders of the Notes and any other equity interests in the Issuer for U.S. federal income tax purposes
to be held by more than 100 persons in accordance with Treasury Regulation Section 1.7704-1(h).
(4)
It will not enter into any financial instrument the payments on which are, or the value of which is, determined in whole or in part by
reference to the Notes or the Issuer (including the amount of distributions on the Notes or any equity interests in the Issuer for U.S.
federal income tax purposes, the value of the Issuer’s assets, or the result of the Issuer’s operations), or any contract
that otherwise is described in Treasury Regulation Section 1.7704-1(a)(2)(i)(B).
(5)
Its beneficial interest in the Note is not and will not be in an amount that is less than the applicable Minimum Denomination, and it
does not and will not hold any beneficial interest in the Note on behalf of any person whose beneficial interest in the Note is in an
amount that is less than the applicable Minimum Denomination. It will not acquire or Transfer any beneficial interest in the Note or
enter into any financial instrument or contract the value of which is determined by reference in whole or in part to any Note, in each
case, if the effect of doing so would be that the beneficial interest of any person in a Note would be in an amount that is less than
the applicable Minimum Denomination. For this purpose, the “Minimum Denomination” is $100,000 for the Class A-2-I Notes and
the Class A-2-II Notes, $1,500,000 for the Class B-2 Notes (provided up to one Holder purchasing Class B-2 Notes on the Series Closing
Date will be permitted to hold such Class B-2 Notes in a minimum denomination of $1,000,000), $2,000,000 for the Class M-2 Notes, $1,500,000
for the Class A2IIB2 Notes and $2,000,000 for the Class A2IIB2M2 Notes.
(6)
It will not take any action that could cause, and will not omit to take any action, which omission would cause, the Issuer to become
taxable as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
The
undersigned agrees to indemnify the Trustee for its costs and expenses in connection with the delivery of the enclosed notice or communication.
|
Dated:
________________________________________ |
|
|
|
Signed:
_______________________________________ |
|
|
|
Printed
Name: ___________________________________ |
|
|
|
Dated:
_________________________________________ |
|
|
|
Signed:
________________________________________ |
|
|
|
Printed
Name: ___________________________________ |
*If
transferee is unable to provide any of the representations set forth in paragraphs (2) through (4) above, the transfer may still be registered
if transferee provides to the Issuer written advice of Katten Muchin Rosenman LLP or an opinion of other nationally recognized U.S. tax
counsel experienced in such matters, to the effect that the acquisition or transfer of Notes will not cause the Issuer to be treated
as a publicly traded partnership taxable as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
I-1
FORM
OF NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN TRADEMARKS
This
NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN TRADEMARKS (the “Notice”) is made and entered into as of [_______________],
by and between [FRANCHISE ENTITY], a _________ located at _______________ (“Grantor”), in favor of UMB BANK, N.A.,
a national banking association (“UMB”), as trustee located at _______________ (“Trustee”).
WHEREAS,
Grantor is the owner of the United States trademarks and service marks set forth in Schedule 1 attached hereto, including the
associated registrations and applications for registration set forth in Schedule 1 attached hereto (collectively, the “Trademarks”)
and the goodwill connected with the use of or symbolized by such Trademarks; and
WHEREAS,
pursuant to the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among the Grantor and certain other “Guarantors”
from time to time a party thereto, each as a Guarantor, and the Trustee (the “Guarantee and Collateral Agreement”),
to secure the Obligations, Grantor has granted to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest in Grantor’s
right, title and interest in, to and under certain intellectual property of Grantor, including the Trademarks and the goodwill connected
with the use of or symbolized by the Trademarks, and the right to bring an action at law or in equity for any infringement, misappropriation,
dilution or other violation thereof, and to collect all damages, settlements and proceeds derived from or related thereto, and, to the
extent not otherwise included, all payments, proceeds, supporting obligations and accrued and future rights to payment with respect to
the foregoing (collectively the “Trademark Collateral”); and
WHEREAS,
pursuant to Section 4.6 of the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, Grantor agreed to execute and deliver to the Trustee this Notice for
purposes of filing the same with the PTO to confirm, evidence and perfect the security interest in the Trademark Collateral granted under
the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement;
NOW,
THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, and subject to all applicable
terms and conditions of the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, which are incorporated by reference as if fully set
forth herein, to secure the Obligations, Grantor hereby grants to the Trustee, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest
in Grantor’s right, title and interest in, to and under the Trademark Collateral, to the extent now owned or at any time hereafter
acquired by Grantor; provided that the grant of security interest hereunder shall not include any application for registration of a Trademark
that would be invalidated, canceled, voided or abandoned due to the grant and/or enforcement of such security interest, including intent-to-use
applications filed with the PTO pursuant to 15 U.S.C. Section 1051(b) prior to the filing of a statement of use or amendment to allege
use pursuant to 15 U.S.C. Section 1051(c) or (d), provided that at such time that the grant and/or enforcement of the security interest
will not cause such Trademark to be invalidated, cancelled, voided or abandoned such Trademark application will not be excluded from
this Notice.
Capitalized
terms used in this Notice (including the preamble and the recitals hereto), and not defined in this Notice, shall have the meanings assigned
to such terms in Annex A attached to the Base Indenture, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality I, LLC, a Delaware
limited liability company, (the “Issuer”), and UMB Bank, N.A., as Trustee and Securities Intermediary (the “Indenture”).
1.
The parties intend that this Notice is for recordation purposes. The terms of this Notice shall not modify the applicable terms and conditions
of the Indenture or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, which govern the Trustee’s interest in the Trademark Collateral and
which shall control in the event of any conflict. Grantor hereby acknowledges the sufficiency and completeness of this Notice to create
a security interest in the Trademark Collateral in favor of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, and Grantor hereby requests
the PTO to file and record this Notice together with the annexed Schedule 1.
2.
Grantor and Trustee hereby acknowledge and agree that the grant of security interest in, to and under the Trademark Collateral made hereby
may be terminated only in accordance with the terms of the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and shall terminate automatically
upon the termination of the Indenture or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement.
3.
THIS NOTICE SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED AND INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK WITHOUT REGARD
TO CONFLICTS OF LAW PRINCIPLES (OTHER THAN LIMITATION SECTIONS 5-1401 AND 5-1402 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATIONS LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK).
4.
This Notice may be executed by the parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to be an original
and all of which when taken together shall constitute one and the same agreement.
[Remainder
of this page intentionally left blank]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has caused this NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN TRADEMARKS to be duly executed by its duly authorized
officer as of the date and year first written above.
|
[FRANCHISE
ENTITY] |
|
|
|
|
By:
|
|
|
Name:
|
|
|
Title:
|
|
Notice
of Grant of Security Interest in Trademarks
Schedule
1
Trademarks
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
I-2
FORM
OF NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN PATENTS
This
NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN PATENTS (the “Notice”) is made and entered into as of [_______________], by
and between [FRANCHISE ENTITY], a _________ located at _______________ (“Grantor”), in favor of UMB BANK, N.A., a
national banking association (“UMB”), as trustee located at _______________ (“Trustee”).
WHEREAS,
Grantor is the owner of the United States patents and patent applications set forth in Schedule 1 attached hereto (collectively,
the “Patents”); and
WHEREAS,
pursuant to the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among the Grantor and certain other “Guarantors”
from time to time a party thereto, each as a Guarantor, and the Trustee (“Guarantee and Collateral Agreement”),
to secure the Obligations, Grantor has granted to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest in Grantor’s
right, title and interest in, to and under certain intellectual property of Grantor, including the Patents and the right to bring an
action at law or in equity for any infringement, misappropriation or other violation thereof, and to collect all damages, settlements
and proceeds derived from or related thereto, and, to the extent not otherwise included, all payments, proceeds, supporting obligations
and accrued and future rights to payment with respect to the foregoing (collectively, the “Patent Collateral”); and
WHEREAS,
pursuant to Section 4.6 of the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, Grantor agreed to execute and deliver to the Trustee this Notice for
purposes of filing the same with the PTO to confirm, evidence and perfect the security interest in the Patent Collateral granted under
the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement;
NOW,
THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, and subject to all applicable
terms and conditions of the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, which are incorporated by reference as if fully set
forth herein, to secure the Obligations, Grantor hereby grants to the Trustee, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest
in Grantor’s right, title and interest in, to and under the Patent Collateral, to the extent now owned or at any time hereafter
acquired by Grantor.
Capitalized
terms used in this Notice (including the preamble and the recitals hereto), and not defined in this Notice, shall have the meanings assigned
to such terms in Annex A attached to the Base Indenture, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality I, LLC, a Delaware
limited liability company, (the “Issuer”), and UMB Bank, N.A., as Trustee and Securities Intermediary (the “Indenture”).
1.
The parties intend that this Notice is for recordation purposes. The terms of this Notice shall not modify the applicable terms and conditions
of the Indenture or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, which govern the Trustee’s interest in the Patent Collateral and which
shall control in the event of any conflict. Grantor hereby acknowledges the sufficiency and completeness of this Notice to create a security
interest in the Patent Collateral in favor of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, and Grantor hereby requests the PTO
to file this Notice together with the annexed Schedule 1.
2.
Grantor and Trustee hereby acknowledge and agree that the grant of security interest in, to and under the Patent Collateral made hereby
may be terminated only in accordance with the terms of the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and shall terminate automatically
upon the termination of the Indenture or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement.
3.
THIS NOTICE SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED AND INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK WITHOUT REGARD
TO CONFLICTS OF LAW PRINCIPLES (OTHER THAN SECTIONS 5-1401 AND 5-1402 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATIONS LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK).
4.
This Notice may be executed by the parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to be an original
and all of which when taken together shall constitute one and the same agreement.
[Remainder
of this page intentionally left blank]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has caused this NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN PATENTS to be duly executed by its duly authorized
officer as of the date and year first written above.
|
[FRANCHISE
ENTITY] |
|
|
|
|
By:
|
|
|
Name:
|
|
|
Title:
|
|
Notice
of Grant of Security Interest in Patents
Schedule
1
Patents and Patent Applications
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
I-3
FORM
OF NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN COPYRIGHTS
This
NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN COPYRIGHTS (the “Notice”) is made and entered into as of [_______________],
by and between [FRANCHISE ENTITY], a _________ located at _______________ (“Grantor”), in favor of UMB BANK, N.A.,
a national banking association (“UMB”), as trustee located at _______________ (“Trustee”).
WHEREAS,
Grantor is the owner of the United States copyright registrations set forth in Schedule 1 attached hereto (collectively, the “Copyrights”);
and
WHEREAS,
pursuant to the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among the Grantor and certain other “Guarantors”
from time to time a party thereto, each as a Guarantor, and the Trustee (the “Guarantee and Collateral Agreement”),
to secure the Obligations, Grantor has granted to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest in Grantor’s
right, title and interest in, to and under certain intellectual property of Grantor, including the Copyrights and the right to bring
an action at law or in equity for any infringement, misappropriation or other violation thereof, and to collect all damages, settlements
and proceeds derived from or related thereto, and, to the extent not otherwise included, all payments, proceeds, supporting obligations,
and accrued and future rights to payment with respect to the foregoing (collectively, the “Copyright Collateral”);
and
WHEREAS,
pursuant to Section 4.6 of the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, Grantor agreed to execute and deliver to the Trustee this Notice for
purposes of filing the same with the United States Copyright Office to confirm, evidence and perfect the security interest in the Copyright
Collateral granted under the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement;
NOW,
THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, and subject to all applicable
terms and conditions of the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, which are incorporated by reference as if fully set
forth herein, to secure the Obligations, Grantor hereby grants to the Trustee, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest
in Grantor’s right, title and interest in, to and under the Copyright Collateral, to the extent now owned or at any time hereafter
acquired by Grantor.
Capitalized
terms used in this Notice (including the preamble and the recitals hereto), and not defined in this Notice, shall have the meanings assigned
to such terms in Annex A attached to the Base Indenture, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality I, LLC, a Delaware
limited liability company, (the “Issuer”), and UMB Bank, N.A., as Trustee and Securities Intermediary (the “Indenture”).
1.
The parties intend that this Notice is for recordation purposes. The terms of this Notice shall not modify the applicable terms and conditions
of the Indenture or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, which govern the Trustee’s interest in the Copyright Collateral and
which shall control in the event of any conflict. Grantor hereby acknowledges the sufficiency and completeness of this Notice to create
a security interest in the Copyright Collateral in favor of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, and Grantor hereby requests
the Copyright Office to file and record this Notice together with the annexed Schedule 1.
2.
Grantor and Trustee hereby acknowledge and agree that the grant of security interest in, to and under the Copyright Collateral made hereby
may be terminated only in accordance with the terms of the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and shall terminate automatically
upon the termination of the Indenture or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement.
3.
THIS NOTICE SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED AND INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK WITHOUT REGARD
TO CONFLICTS OF LAW PRINCIPLES (OTHER THAN LIMITATION SECTIONS 5-1401 AND 5-1402 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATIONS LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK).
4.
This Notice may be executed by the parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to be an original
and all of which when taken together shall constitute one and the same agreement.
[Remainder
of this page intentionally left blank]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has caused this NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN COPYRIGHTS to be duly executed by its duly authorized
officer as of the date and year first written above.
|
[FRANCHISE
ENTITY] |
|
|
|
|
By:
|
|
|
Name:
|
|
|
Title:
|
|
Notice
of Grant of Security Interest in Copyrights
Schedule
1
Copyrights
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
J-1
FORM
OF SUPPLEMENTAL NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN TRADEMARKS
This
SUPPLEMENTAL NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN TRADEMARKS (the “Notice”) is made and entered into as of [_______________],
by and between [FRANCHISE ENTITY], a _________ located at _______________ (“Grantor”), in favor of UMB BANK, N.A.,
a national banking association (“UMB”), as trustee located at _______________ (“Trustee”).
WHEREAS,
Grantor is the owner of the United States trademarks and service marks set forth in Schedule 1 attached hereto, including the
associated registrations and applications for registration set forth in Schedule 1 attached hereto (collectively, the “Trademarks”)
and goodwill connected with the use of or symbolized by such Trademarks; and
WHEREAS,
pursuant to the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among the Grantor and certain other “Guarantors”
from time to time a party thereto, each as a Guarantor, and the Trustee (the “Guarantee and Collateral Agreement”),
to secure the Obligations, Grantor has granted to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest in Grantor’s
right, title and interest in, to and under certain intellectual property of Grantor, including the Trademarks and the goodwill connected
with the use of or symbolized by the Trademarks and the right to bring an action at law or in equity for any infringement, misappropriation
or other violation thereof, and to collect all damages, settlements and proceeds derived from or related thereto, and, to the extent
not otherwise included, all payments, proceeds, supporting obligations, and accrued and future rights to payment with respect to the
foregoing (collectively the “Trademark Collateral”); and
WHEREAS,
pursuant to Section 8.25(e) of the Base Indenture, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality I, LLC, a Delaware
limited liability company, (the “Issuer”), and UMB Bank, N.A., as Trustee and Securities Intermediary (the “Indenture”),
and Section 3.5 of the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, Grantor agreed to execute and deliver to the Trustee this Notice for
purposes of filing the same with the PTO to confirm, evidence and perfect the security interest in the Trademark Collateral granted under
the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement;
NOW,
THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, and subject to all applicable
terms and conditions of the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, which are incorporated by reference as if fully set
forth herein, to secure the Obligations Grantor hereby grants to the Trustee, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest
in Grantor’s right, title and interest in the Trademark Collateral, to the extent now owned or at any time hereafter acquired by
Grantor; provided that the grant of security interest hereunder shall not include any application for registration of a Trademark that
would be invalidated, canceled, voided or abandoned due to the grant and/or enforcement of such security interest, including, intent-to-use
applications filed with the PTO pursuant to 15 U.S.C. Section 1051 (b) prior to the filing of a statement of use or amendment to allege
use pursuant to 15 U.S.C. Section 1051 (c) or (d), provided that, at such time as the grant and/or enforcement of the security interest
will not cause such Trademark to be invalidated, cancelled, voided or abandoned such Trademark will not be excluded from this Notice.
Capitalized
terms used in this Notice (including the preamble and the recitals hereto), and not defined in this Notice, shall have the meanings assigned
to such terms in Annex A attached to the Indenture (as defined above).
1.
The parties intend that the Trademark Collateral subject to this Notice is to be considered as After-Acquired Securitization IP under
the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and that this Notice is for recordation purposes. The terms of this Notice shall
not modify the applicable terms and conditions of the Indenture or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, which govern the Trustee’s
interest in the Trademark Collateral and which shall control in the event of any conflict. Grantor hereby acknowledges the sufficiency
and completeness of this Notice to create a security interest in the Trademark Collateral in favor of the Trustee for the benefit of
the Secured Parties, and Grantor hereby requests the PTO to file and record this Notice together with the annexed Schedule 1.
2.
Grantor and the Trustee hereby acknowledge and agree that the grant of security interest in, to and under the Trademark Collateral made
hereby may be terminated only in accordance with the terms of the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and shall terminate
automatically upon the termination of the Indenture or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement.
3.
THIS NOTICE SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED AND INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK WITHOUT REGARD
TO CONFLICTS OF LAW PRINCIPLES (OTHER THAN SECTIONS 5-1401 AND 5-1402 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATIONS LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK).
4.
This Notice may be executed by the parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to be an original
and all of which when taken together shall constitute one and the same agreement.
[Remainder
of this page intentionally left blank]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has caused this SUPPLEMENTAL NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN TRADEMARKS to be duly executed
by its duly authorized officer as of the date and year first written above.
|
[FRANCHISE
ENTITY] |
|
|
|
|
By:
|
|
|
Name:
|
|
|
Title:
|
|
Supplemental
Notice of Grant of Security Interest in Trademarks
Schedule
1
Trademarks
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
J-2
FORM
OF SUPPLEMENTAL NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN PATENTS
This
SUPPLEMENTAL NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN PATENTS (the “Notice”) is made and entered into as of [_______________],
by and between [FRANCHISE ENTITY], a _________ located at _______________ (“Grantor”), in favor of UMB BANK, N.A.,
a national banking association (“UMB”), as trustee located at _______________ (“Trustee”).
WHEREAS,
Grantor is the owner of the United States patents and patent applications set forth in Schedule 1 attached hereto (collectively, the
“Patents”); and
WHEREAS,
pursuant to the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among Grantor and certain other “Guarantors”
from time to time a party thereto, each as a Guarantor, and the Trustee (the “Guarantee and Collateral Agreement”),
to secure the Obligations, Grantor has granted to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest in Grantor’s
right, title and interest in, to and under certain intellectual property of Grantor, including the Patents and the right to bring an
action at law or in equity for any infringement, misappropriation or other violation thereof, and to collect all damages, settlements
and proceeds derived from or related thereto, and, to the extent not otherwise included, all payments, proceeds, supporting obligations
and accrued and future rights to payment with respect to the foregoing (collectively, the “Patent Collateral”); and
WHEREAS,
pursuant to Section 8.25(e) of the Base Indenture, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality I, LLC, a Delaware
limited liability company, (the “Issuer”), and UMB Bank, N.A., as Trustee and Securities Intermediary (the “Indenture”),
and Section 3.5 of the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, Grantor agreed to execute and deliver to the Trustee this Notice for
purposes of recording the same with the PTO to confirm, evidence and perfect the security interest in the Patent Collateral granted under
the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement;
NOW,
THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, and subject to all applicable
terms and conditions of the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, which are incorporated by reference as if fully set
forth herein, to secure the Obligations Grantor hereby grants to the Trustee, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest
in Grantor’s right, title and interest under the Patent Collateral, to the extent now owned or at any time hereafter acquired by
Grantor.
Capitalized
terms used in this Notice (including the preamble and the recitals hereto), and not defined in this Notice shall have the meanings assigned
to such terms in Annex A attached to the Indenture (as defined above).
1.
The parties intend that the Patent Collateral subject to this Notice is to be considered as After-Acquired Securitization IP under the
Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and that this Notice is for recordation purposes. The terms of this Notice shall
not modify the applicable terms and conditions of the Indenture or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, which govern the Trustee’s
interest in the Patent Collateral and which shall control in the event of any conflict. Grantor hereby acknowledges the sufficiency and
completeness of this Notice to create a security interest in the Patent Collateral in favor of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured
Parties, and Grantor hereby requests the PTO to file and record this Notice together with the annexed Schedule 1.
2.
Grantor and the Trustee hereby acknowledge and agree that the grant of security interest in, to and under the Patent Collateral made
hereby may be terminated only in accordance with the terms of the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and shall terminate
automatically upon the termination of the Indenture or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement.
3.
THIS NOTICE SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED AND INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK WITHOUT REGARD
TO CONFLICTS OF LAW PRINCIPLES (OTHER THAN SECTIONS 5-1401 AND 5-1402 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATIONS LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK).
4.
This Notice may be executed by the parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to be an original
and all of which when taken together shall constitute one and the same agreement.
[Remainder
of this page intentionally left blank]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has caused this SUPPLEMENTAL NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN PATENTS to be duly executed by
its duly authorized officer as of the date and year first written above.
|
[FRANCHISE
ENTITY] |
|
|
|
|
By:
|
|
|
Name:
|
|
|
Title:
|
|
Supplemental
Notice of Grant of Security Interest in Patents
Schedule
1
Patents
and Patent Applications
Exhibits
and Schedules to Base Indenture
Exhibit
J-3
FORM
OF SUPPLEMENTAL NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN COPYRIGHTS
This
SUPPLEMENTAL NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN COPYRIGHTS (the “Notice”) is made and entered into as of [_______________],
by and between [FRANCHISE ENTITY], a _________ located at _______________ (“Grantor”), in favor of UMB BANK, N.A.,
a national banking association (“UMB”), as trustee located at _______________ (“Trustee”).
WHEREAS,
Grantor is the owner of the United States copyrights (including the associated registrations and applications for registration) set forth
in Schedule 1 attached hereto (collectively, the “Copyrights”); and
WHEREAS,
pursuant to the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among the Grantor and certain other “Guarantors”
from time to time a party thereto, each as a Guarantor, and the Trustee (the “Guarantee and Collateral Agreement”),
to secure the Obligations, Grantor has granted to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest in Grantor’s
right, title and interest in, to and under certain intellectual property of Grantor, including the Copyrights and the right to bring
an action at law or in equity for any infringement, misappropriation or other violation thereof, and to collect all damages, settlements
and proceeds derived from or related thereto, and, to the extent not otherwise included, all payments, proceeds, supporting obligations,
and accrued and future rights to payment with respect to the foregoing (collectively, the “Copyright Collateral”);
and
WHEREAS,
pursuant to Section 8.25(e) of the Base Indenture, dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among Twin Hospitality I, LLC, a Delaware
limited liability company, (the “Issuer”), and UMB Bank, N.A., as Trustee and Securities Intermediary (the “Indenture”),
and Section 3.5 of the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, Grantor agreed to execute and deliver to the Trustee this Notice for
purposes of filing the same with the United States Copyright Office (the “Copyright Office”) to confirm, evidence
and perfect the security interest in the Copyright Collateral granted under the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement;
NOW,
THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, and subject to all applicable
terms and conditions of the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, which are incorporated by reference as if fully set
forth herein, to secure the Obligations, Grantor hereby grants to the Trustee, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest
in Grantor’s right, title and interest under the Copyright Collateral, to the extent now owned or at any time hereafter acquired
by Grantor.
Capitalized
terms used in this Notice (including the preamble and the recitals hereto), and not defined in this Notice, shall have the meanings assigned
to such terms in Annex A attached to the Indenture (as defined above).
1.
The parties intend that the Copyright Collateral subject to this Notice is to be considered as After-Acquired Securitization IP under
the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and that this Notice is for recordation purposes. The terms of this Notice shall
not modify the applicable terms and conditions of the Indenture or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, which govern the Trustee’s
interest in the Copyright Collateral and which shall control in the event of any conflict. Grantor hereby acknowledges the sufficiency
and completeness of this Notice to create a security interest in the Copyright Collateral in favor of the Trustee for the benefit of
the Secured Parties, and Grantor hereby requests the Copyright Office to file and record this Notice together with the annexed Schedule
1.
3.
Grantor and the Trustee hereby acknowledge and agree that the grant of security interest in, to and under the Copyright Collateral made
hereby may be terminated only in accordance with the terms of the Indenture and the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement and shall terminate
automatically upon the termination of the Indenture or the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement.
2.
THIS NOTICE SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK WITHOUT REGARD TO CONFLICTS OF
LAW PRINCIPLES (OTHER THAN SECTIONS 5-1401 AND 5-1402 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATIONS LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK).
3.
This Notice may be executed by the parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to be an original
and all of which when taken together shall constitute one and the same agreement.
[Remainder
of this page intentionally left blank]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has caused this SUPPLEMENTAL NOTICE OF GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST IN COPYRIGHTS to be duly executed
by its duly authorized officer as of the date and year first written above.
|
[FRANCHISE
ENTITY] |
|
|
|
|
By:
|
|
|
Name:
|
|
|
Title:
|
|
Supplemental
Notice of Grant of Security Interest in Copyrights
Schedule
1
Copyrights
Exhibit
4.2
TWIN
HOSPITALITY I, LLC,
as
Issuer
and
UMB
BANK, N.A.,
as
Trustee
SERIES
2024-1 SUPPLEMENT
Dated
as of November 21, 2024
to
BASE
INDENTURE
Dated
as of November 21, 2024
$12,124,000.00
Series 2024-1 9.00% Fixed Rate Super Senior Secured Notes, Class A-2-I
$269,257,000.00
Series 2024-1 9.00% Fixed Rate Senior Secured Notes, Class A-2-II
$57,619,000.00
Series 2024-1 10.00% Fixed Rate Senior Subordinated Secured Notes, Class B-2
$77,711,000.00
Series 2024-1 11.00% Fixed Rate Subordinated Secured Notes, Class M-2
$326,876,000.00
Series 2024-1 Fixed Rate Exchangeable Secured Notes, Class A2IIB2
$404,587,000.00
Series 2024-1 Fixed Rate Exchangeable Secured Notes, Class A2IIB2M2
TABLE
OF CONTENTS
|
|
|
|
Page |
|
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE I DEFINITIONS;
RULES OF CONSTRUCTION |
|
2 |
|
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE II AUTHORIZATION
AND DETAILS |
|
2 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Section
2.1 |
Authorization
of the Series 2024-1 Notes |
|
2 |
|
Section
2.2 |
Details
of the Series 2024-1 Notes |
|
2 |
|
Section
2.3 |
Denominations |
|
2 |
|
Section
2.4 |
Monthly
Allocation Dates |
|
3 |
|
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE III
SERIES 2024-1 ALLOCATIONS; PAYMENTS |
|
3 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Section
3.1 |
Allocations
of Net Proceeds with Respect to the Series 2024-1 Notes |
|
3 |
|
Section
3.2 |
Reserved. |
|
3 |
|
Section
3.3 |
Certain
Distributions to Series 2024-1 Noteholders |
|
3 |
|
Section
3.4 |
Series
2024-1 Interest. |
|
4 |
|
Section
3.5 |
Payment
of Principal. |
|
7 |
|
Section
3.6 |
Manager |
|
15 |
|
Section
3.7 |
Other
Agreements |
|
15 |
|
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE IV FORM
OF SERIES 2024-1 NOTES |
|
16 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Section
4.1 |
Issuance
of Series 2024-1 Global Notes. |
|
16 |
|
Section
4.2 |
Transfer
Restrictions of Series 2024-1 Global Notes. |
|
17 |
|
Section
4.3 |
Exchange
Procedures |
|
24 |
|
Section
4.4 |
Note
Owner Representations and Warranties |
|
26 |
|
Section
4.5 |
Limitation
on Liability |
|
28 |
|
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE V GENERAL |
|
28 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Section
5.1 |
Information |
|
28 |
|
Section
5.2 |
Exhibits |
|
29 |
|
Section
5.3 |
Ratification
of Base Indenture |
|
29 |
|
Section
5.4 |
[Reserved] |
|
29 |
|
Section
5.5 |
Counterparts |
|
29 |
|
Section
5.6 |
Governing
Law |
|
29 |
|
Section
5.7 |
Amendments |
|
29 |
|
Section
5.8 |
Termination
of Series Supplement; Defeasance. |
|
29 |
|
Section
5.9 |
Limited
Recourse |
|
29 |
|
Section
5.10 |
Entire
Agreement |
|
29 |
|
Section
5.11 |
Control
Party Protections |
|
29 |
ANNEXES |
|
|
|
|
|
Annex
A |
|
Series
2024-1 Supplemental Definitions List |
Annex
B |
|
Schedule
of Relevant Dates |
|
|
|
EXHIBITS |
|
|
|
|
|
Exhibit
A-1 |
|
Form
of Rule 144A Global Note |
Exhibit
A-2 |
|
Form
of Temporary Regulation S Global Note |
Exhibit
A-3 |
|
Form
of Permanent Regulation S Global Note |
Exhibit
B-1 |
|
Transfer
Certificate (Rule 144A Global Note to Temporary Regulation S Global Note) |
Exhibit
B-2 |
|
Transfer
Certificate (Rule 144A Global Note to Permanent Regulation S Global Note) |
Exhibit
B-3 |
|
Transfer
Certificate (Regulation S Global Note to Rule 144A Global Note) |
Exhibit
C |
|
Form
of Quarterly Noteholders’ Report |
Exhibit
D |
|
Exchangeable
Combinations |
Exhibit
E |
|
Form
of Exchange Letter |
SERIES
2024-1 SUPPLEMENT, dated as of November 21, 2024 (this “Series 2024-1 Supplement”), by and between Twin Hospitality
I, LLC (f/k/a Fat Brands Twin Peaks I, LLC) (the “Issuer”), and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee (in such capacity, the
“Trustee”), to the Base Indenture, dated as of November 21, 2024 (as the same may be amended, amended and restated,
modified or supplemented from time to time, exclusive of Series Supplements, the “Base Indenture”), by and among the
Issuer and UMB Bank, N.A., as Trustee and as Securities Intermediary.
PRELIMINARY
STATEMENT
WHEREAS,
Sections 2.2 and 13.1 of the Base Indenture provide, among other things, that the Issuer and the Trustee may at any time
and from time to time enter into a Series Supplement to the Base Indenture for the purpose of authorizing the issuance of one or more
Series of Notes (as defined in Annex A of the Base Indenture) upon satisfaction of the conditions set forth therein; and
WHEREAS,
all such conditions have been met or waived by the Control Party (as directed by the Controlling Class Representative) for the issuance
of the Series of Notes authorized hereunder.
NOW,
THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree as follows:
DESIGNATION
There
is hereby created a Series of Notes to be issued pursuant to the Base Indenture and this Series 2024-1 Supplement, and such Series of
Notes shall be designated as the Series 2024-1 Notes. On the Series 2024-1 Closing Date, the issuer shall issue three (3) Classes of
Exchange Notes of such Series and two (2) Classes of Exchangeable Notes of such Series as follows: (a) Series 2024-1 9.00% Fixed Rate
Super Senior Secured Notes, Class A-2-I (as referred to herein, such Class or Notes thereof, as the context requires, the “Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes”), (b) Series 2024-1 9.00% Fixed Rate Senior Secured Notes, Class A-2-II (as referred to herein, such
Class or Notes thereof, as the context requires, the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes”), (c) Series 2024-1 10.00%
Fixed Rate Senior Subordinated Secured Notes, Class B-2 (as referred to herein, such Class or Notes thereof, as the context requires,
the “Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes”), (d) Series 2024-1 11.00% Fixed Rate Subordinated Secured Notes, Class M-2 (as
referred to herein, such Class or Notes thereof, as the context requires, the “Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes” and
together with the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes, Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes and Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes, the “Exchange
Notes”), (e) Series 2024-1 Fixed Rate Exchangeable Secured Notes, Class A2IIB2 (the “Series 2024-1 Class A2IIB2 Notes”
or “Class A2IIB2 Notes”), and (f) Series 2024-1 Fixed Rate Exchangeable Secured Notes, Class A2IIB2M2 (the “Series
2024-1 Class A2IIB2M2 Notes” or “Class A2IIB2M2 Notes” and together with the Series 2024-1 Class A2IIB2
Notes, the “Exchangeable Notes” and the Exchange Notes together with the Exchangeable Notes, the “Series
2024-1 Notes” or “Notes”).
ARTICLE
I
DEFINITIONS;
RULES OF CONSTRUCTION
All
capitalized terms used herein (including in the preamble and the recitals hereto) and not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings
assigned to such terms in the Series 2024-1 Supplemental Definitions List attached hereto as Annex A (the “Series 2024-1
Supplemental Definitions List”) as such Series 2024-1 Supplemental Definitions List may be amended, supplemented or otherwise
modified from time to time in accordance with the terms hereof. All capitalized terms not otherwise defined herein or therein, and the
term “written” or “in writing”, shall have the meanings assigned thereto in the Base Indenture or the Base Indenture
Definitions List attached to the Base Indenture as Annex A thereto, as such Base Indenture or Base Indenture Definitions List
may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time in accordance with the terms of the Base Indenture. Unless otherwise
specified herein, all Article, Exhibit, Section or Subsection references herein shall refer to Articles, Exhibits, Sections or Subsections
of this Series 2024-1 Supplement. Unless otherwise stated herein, as the context otherwise requires or if such term is otherwise defined
in the Base Indenture, each capitalized term used or defined herein shall relate only to the Series 2024-1 Notes and not to any other
Series of Notes issued by the Issuer. The rules of construction set forth in Section 1.4 of the Base Indenture shall apply for
all purposes under this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
ARTICLE
II
AUTHORIZATION
AND DETAILS
Section
2.1 Authorization of the Series 2024-1 Notes. The following Series 2024-1 Notes are hereby authorized to be issued in the form
of typewritten Notes representing Book-Entry Notes: (i) the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes in the aggregate principal amount of $12,124,000.00,
(ii) the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes in the aggregate principal amount of $269,257,000.00, (iii) the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes
in the aggregate principal amount of $57,619,000.00, (iv) the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes in the aggregate principal amount of $77,711,000.00,
(v) the Series 2024-1 Class A2IIB2 Notes in the aggregate principal amount of $326,876,000.00 and (vi) the Series 2024-1 Class A2IIB2M2
Notes in the aggregate principal amount of $404,587,000.00. The Series 2024-1 Notes will be the only Series of Notes to be issued by
the Issuer pursuant to this Series 2024-1 Supplement or the Base Indenture.
Section
2.2 Details of the Series 2024-1 Notes. The Series 2024-1 Series Notes shall be subject to the terms of the Base Indenture applicable
to the Notes as described therein, as modified herein, and shall bear interest as set forth in Section 3.4 of this Series 2024-1
Supplement.
Section
2.3 Denominations. The Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes shall be issued in minimum denominations of $100,000.00, the Series 2024-1
Class A-2-II Notes shall be issued in minimum denominations of $100,000.00, the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes shall be issued in minimum
denominations of $1,500,000.00 (provided up to one Holder purchasing Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes on the Series 2024-1 Closing Date
will be permitted to hold such Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes in a minimum denomination of $1,000,000), the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes
shall be issued in minimum denominations of $2,000,000.00, the Series 2024-1 Class A2IIB2 Notes shall be issued in minimum denominations
of $1,500,000.00, the Series 2024-1 Class A2IIB2M2 Notes shall be issued in minimum denominations of $2,000,000.00 and, in each case,
integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof.
Section
2.4 Monthly Allocation Dates. For the avoidance of doubt, the Monthly Allocation Dates and the date of delivery of the Monthly
Manager’s Certificate through the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Legal Final Maturity Date, the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Legal Final
Maturity Date, the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Legal Final Maturity Date and the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Legal Final Maturity Date are as
set forth in Annex B of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
ARTICLE
III
SERIES
2024-1 ALLOCATIONS; PAYMENTS
With
respect to the Series 2024-1 Notes only, the following shall apply:
Section
3.1 Allocations of Net Proceeds with Respect to the Series 2024-1 Notes. The Series 2024-1 Notes will be the only Series of Notes
to be issued by the Issuer pursuant to this Series 2024-1 Supplement or the Base Indenture. On the Series 2024-1 Closing Date, the Issuer
will issue the Series 2024-1 Notes pursuant to the Base Indenture and this Series 2024-1 Supplement and will make a distribution of the
net proceeds of the issuance and sale of the Series 2024-1 Notes to the Manager, which intends to apply such net proceeds to, among other
things, to (i) fund the Reserve Account in an amount equal to $7,771,548, (ii) pay fees and expenses related to the offering of the Series
2024-1 Notes, (iii) satisfy and discharge the obligations of the Issuer under the Previous Indenture, and (iv) fund the Permitted Uses
Account in an amount equal to all net proceeds remaining after giving effect to clauses (i) through (iii).
Section
3.2 Reserved.
Section
3.3 Certain Distributions to Series 2024-1 Noteholders. On each Quarterly Payment Date, based solely upon the most recent Quarterly
Noteholders’ Report in the form attached hereto as Exhibit C and as required under Section 4.1(c) of the Base Indenture,
the Trustee shall, in accordance with Section 6.1 of the Base Indenture, remit (i) to the Series 2024-1 Super Senior Noteholders
the amounts withdrawn from the Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account, Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account or otherwise,
as applicable, pursuant to Section 5.11 of the Base Indenture or otherwise, for the payment of interest and fees and, to the extent
applicable, principal or other amounts in respect of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes on such Quarterly Payment Date, (ii) to the
Series 2024-1 Senior Noteholders the amounts withdrawn from the Senior Notes Interest Payment Account, Senior Notes Principal Payment
Account or otherwise, as applicable, pursuant to Section 5.11 of the Base Indenture or otherwise, for the payment of interest
and fees and, to the extent applicable, principal or other amounts in respect of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes on such Quarterly
Payment Date, (iii) to the Series 2024-1 Senior Subordinated Noteholders, the amounts withdrawn from the Senior Subordinated Notes Interest
Payment Account, Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account or otherwise, as applicable, pursuant to Section 5.11 of
the Base Indenture or otherwise, for the payment of interest and, to the extent applicable, principal or other amounts in respect of
the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes on such Quarterly Payment Date and (iv) to the Series 2024-1 Subordinated Noteholders, the amounts
withdrawn from the Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account, Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account or otherwise, as applicable,
pursuant to Section 5.11 of the Base Indenture or otherwise, for the payment of interest and, to the extent applicable, principal or
other amounts in respect of the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes on such Quarterly Payment Date.
Section
3.4 Series 2024-1 Interest.
(a)
Series 2024-1 Class A-2 Notes Interest
(i)
Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes Interest. From the Series 2024-1 Closing Date until the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes has been paid in full, the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes will accrue interest
for each Interest Accrual Period (after giving effect to all payments of principal made to the Noteholders as of the first day of such
Interest Accrual Period, and also giving effect to prepayments, repurchases and cancellations of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes during
such Interest Accrual Period) at the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Note Rate. Such accrued interest will be due and payable in arrears on
each Quarterly Payment Date, from amounts that are made available for payment thereof (i) on any related Monthly Allocation Date in accordance
with the Priority of Payments and (ii) on such Quarterly Payment Date in accordance with Section 5.11 of the Base Indenture, commencing
on the Initial Quarterly Payment Date; provided that in any event all accrued but unpaid interest shall be due and payable in
full on the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Legal Final Maturity Date or on any other day on which all of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Outstanding
Principal Amount is required to be paid in full. To the extent any interest accruing at the applicable Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Note
Rate is not paid when due, such unpaid interest will accrue interest at the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Note Rate. All computations of
interest at the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Note Rate shall be made on a 30/360 Day Basis.
(ii)
Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes Interest. From the Series 2024-1 Closing Date until the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes has been paid in full, the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes will accrue
interest for each Interest Accrual Period (after giving effect to all payments of principal made to the Noteholders as of the first day
of such Interest Accrual Period, and also giving effect to prepayments, repurchases and cancellations of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes
during such Interest Accrual Period) at the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Note Rate. Such accrued interest will be due and payable in arrears
on each Quarterly Payment Date, from amounts that are made available for payment thereof (i) on any related Monthly Allocation Date in
accordance with the Priority of Payments and (ii) on such Quarterly Payment Date in accordance with Section 5.11 of the Base Indenture,
commencing on the Initial Quarterly Payment Date; provided that in any event all accrued but unpaid interest shall be due and
payable in full on the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Legal Final Maturity Date or on any other day on which all of the Series 2024-1 Class
A-2-II Outstanding Principal Amount is required to be paid in full. To the extent any interest accruing at the applicable Series 2024-1
Class A-2-II Note Rate is not paid when due, such unpaid interest will accrue interest at the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Note Rate. All
computations of interest at the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Note Rate shall be made on a 30/360 Day Basis.
(b)
Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes Interest. From the Series 2024-1 Closing Date until the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Notes has been paid in full, the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes will accrue interest
for each Interest Accrual Period (after giving effect to all payments of principal made to the Noteholders as of the first day of such
Interest Accrual Period, and also giving effect to prepayments, repurchases and cancellations of Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes during
such Interest Accrual Period) at the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Note Rate. Such accrued interest will be due and payable in arrears on each
Quarterly Payment Date, from amounts that are made available for payment thereof (i) on any related Monthly Allocation Date in accordance
with the Priority of Payments and (ii) on such Quarterly Payment Date in accordance with Section 5.11 of the Base Indenture, commencing
on the Initial Quarterly Payment Date; provided that in any event all accrued but unpaid interest shall be due and payable in
full on the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Legal Final Maturity Date or on any other day on which all of the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Outstanding
Principal Amount is required to be paid in full. To the extent any interest accruing at the applicable Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Note Rate
is not paid when due, such unpaid interest will accrue interest at the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Note Rate. All computations of interest
at the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Note Rate shall be made on a 30/360 Day Basis.
(c)
Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes Interest. From the Series 2024-1 Closing Date until the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Notes has been paid in full, the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes will accrue interest
for each Interest Accrual Period (after giving effect to all payments of principal made to the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Noteholders as
of the first day of such Interest Accrual Period, and also giving effect to prepayments, repurchases and cancellations of Series 2024-1
Class M-2 Notes during such Interest Accrual Period) at the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Note Rate. Such accrued interest will be due and
payable in arrears on each Quarterly Payment Date, from amounts that are made available for payment thereof: (i) on any related Monthly
Allocation Date in accordance with the Priority of Payments and (ii) on such Quarterly Payment Date in accordance with Section 5.11
of the Base Indenture, commencing on the Initial Quarterly Payment Date; provided that in any event, all accrued but unpaid
interest shall be due and payable in full on the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Legal Final Maturity Date or on any other day on which all of
the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Outstanding Principal Amount is required to be paid in full. To the extent any interest accruing at the applicable
Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Note Rate is not paid when due, such unpaid interest will accrue interest at the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Note
Rate. All computations of interest at the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Note Rate shall be made on a 30/360 Day Basis.
(d)
Series 2024-1 Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest.
(i)
Series 2024-1 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest. From and after the Series 2024-1 Anticipated Repayment
Date, if the Series 2024-1 Final Payment of the Class A-2-I Notes, the Class A-2-II Notes, the Class B-2 Notes and/or the Class M-2 Notes
has not been made, then additional interest will accrue on the (i) Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Outstanding Principal Amount at a per annum
rate (the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Rate”) equal to
5.0% (such additional interest, the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest”)
(ii) Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Outstanding Principal Amount at a per annum rate (the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Quarterly
Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Rate”) equal to 5.0% (such additional interest, the “Series 2024-1
Class A-2-II Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest”), (iii) Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Outstanding Principal
Amount at a per annum rate (the “Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Rate”)
equal to 5.0% (such additional interest, the “Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest”)
and (iv) Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Outstanding Principal Amount at a per annum rate (the “Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest Rate”) equal to 5.0% (such additional interest, the “Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Quarterly
Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest”, and collectively, with the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest, the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest and
the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest, the “Series 2024-1 Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest”), respectively. All computations of Series 2024-1 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest shall be made on a 30/360 Day Basis and will be due and payable on any Quarterly Payment Date to the extent
allocated in accordance with the Priority of Payments
(ii)
Payment of Series 2024-1 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest. Any Series 2024-1 Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest will be due and payable on each applicable Quarterly Payment Date from amounts that are made available
for payment thereof (A) on any related Monthly Allocation Date in accordance with the Priority of Payments and (B) on such Quarterly
Payment Date in accordance with the Priority of Payments and Section 5.11 of the Base Indenture, in the amount so made available.
The failure to pay any Series 2024-1 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest in excess of available amounts in
accordance with the foregoing (other than on the Series 2024-1 Legal Final Maturity Date) will not be an Event of Default and interest
will not accrue on any unpaid portion thereof; provided that in any event all accrued but unpaid Series 2024-1 Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest shall be due and payable in full on the Series 2024-1 Legal Final Maturity Date, on any Series 2024-1
Prepayment Date with respect to a prepayment in full of the related Class of the Series 2024-1 Notes or otherwise as part of any Series
2024-1 Final Payment.
(e)
Series 2024-1 Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest.
(i)
If, as of any Level I QEO Quarterly Payment Date, $25,000,000 of aggregate Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds are not used to prepay
the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes on or prior to such Level I QEO Quarterly Payment Date (a “Level I Qualified Equity
Offering Trigger Event”), then additional interest will accrue until such Level I Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event is
cured, including retroactively for the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period most recently ended on the (i) Series 2024-1
Class A-2-I Outstanding Principal Amount at a per annum rate (the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering
Additional Interest Rate”) equal to 3.0% (such additional interest, the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Quarterly Qualified
Equity Offering Additional Interest”), (ii) Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Outstanding Principal Amount at a per annum rate (the
“Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Rate”) equal to 3.0% (such additional
interest, the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest”) and (iii) Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Outstanding Principal Amount at a per annum rate (the “Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering
Additional Interest Rate”) equal to 2.0% (such additional interest, the “Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Qualified
Equity Offering Additional Interest”, and together, with the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering
Additional Interest and the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest, the “Series
2024-1 Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest”). All such computations of Series 2024-1 Quarterly Qualified
Equity Offering Additional Interest shall be made on a 30/360 Day Basis;
(ii)
If, as of any Level II QEO Quarterly Payment Date, $75,000,000, inclusive of any amounts prepaid in accordance with the foregoing paragraph,
of aggregate Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds are not used to prepay the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes on or prior to such
Level II QEO Quarterly Payment Date (a “Level II Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event” and, together with the Level
I Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event, a “Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event”), then the Series 2024-1 Class
A-2-I Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest, the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional
Interest and the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest will accrue until such Level II Qualified
Equity Offering Trigger Event is cured, including retroactively for the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period most recently
ended. All such computations of Series 2024-1 Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest shall be made on a 30/360 Day Basis.
(iii)
Any Series 2024-1 Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest will be due and payable on each applicable Quarterly Payment
Date from amounts that are made available for payment thereof (i) on any related Monthly Allocation Date in accordance with the Priority
of Payments and (ii) on such Quarterly Payment Date in accordance with the Priority of Payments and Section 5.11 of the Base Indenture
(Quarterly Payment Date Applications), in the amount so made available. The failure to pay any Series 2024-1 Quarterly Qualified Equity
Offering Additional Interest in excess of available amounts in accordance with the foregoing (other than on the Series 2024-1 Legal Final
Maturity Date) will not be an Event of Default and interest will not accrue on any unpaid portion thereof; provided that in any
event all accrued but unpaid Series 2024-1 Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest shall be due and payable in full on
the Series 2024-1 Legal Final Maturity Date, on any Series 2024-1 Prepayment Date with respect to a prepayment in full of the related
Class of the Series 2024-1 Notes or otherwise as part of any Series 2024-1 Final Payment.
(f)
Initial Interest Accrual Period. The initial Interest Accrual Period for the Series 2024-1 Notes shall commence on (and include)
the Series 2024-1 Closing Date and end on (but exclude) January 25, 2025.
(g)
Exchangeable Notes Interest. Each Class of Exchangeable Notes will bear interest at a rate equal to the weighted average of the
interest rate on the Classes of the corresponding Exchange Notes based on the outstanding principal amount of such Classes of Exchange
Notes for the related Interest Accrual Period.
Section
3.5 Payment of Principal.
(a)
Payment of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Note Principal.
(i)
Principal Payment at Legal Maturity. The Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Outstanding Principal Amount shall be due and payable in full
on the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Legal Final Maturity Date. The Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Outstanding Principal Amount is not prepayable,
in whole or in part, except as set forth in the Base Indenture and this Section 3.5.
(ii)
Series 2024-1 Anticipated Repayment Date. The Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Final Payment Date is anticipated to occur on the Quarterly
Payment Date occurring in October 2027 (such date, the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Anticipated Repayment Date”).
(iii)
Payment of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts. Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes Scheduled Principal
Payment Amounts will be due and payable on each applicable Quarterly Payment Date in accordance with Section 5.11 of the Base
Indenture.
(b)
Payment of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Note Principal.
(i)
Principal Payment at Legal Maturity. The Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Outstanding Principal Amount shall be due and payable in full
on the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Legal Final Maturity Date. The Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Outstanding Principal Amount is not prepayable,
in whole or in part, except as set forth in the Base Indenture and this Section 3.5.
(ii)
Series 2024-1 Anticipated Repayment Date. The Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Final Payment Date is anticipated to occur on the Quarterly
Payment Date occurring in October 2027 (such date, the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Anticipated Repayment Date”).
(iii)
Payment of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts. Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes Scheduled Principal
Payment Amounts will be due and payable on each applicable Quarterly Payment Date in accordance with Section 5.11 of the Base
Indenture.
(c)
Payment of Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Note Principal.
(i)
Principal Payment at Legal Maturity. The Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Outstanding Principal Amount shall be due and payable in full
on the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Legal Final Maturity Date. The Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Outstanding Principal Amount is not prepayable,
in whole or in part, except as set forth in the Base Indenture and this Section 3.5.
(ii)
Series 2024-1 Anticipated Repayment Date. The Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Final Payment Date is anticipated to occur on the Quarterly
Payment Date occurring in October 2027 (such date, the “Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Anticipated Repayment Date”).
(iii)
Payment of Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts. Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes Scheduled Principal
Payment Amounts will be due and payable on each applicable Quarterly Payment Date in accordance with Section 5.11 of the Base
Indenture.
(d)
Payment of Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Note Principal.
(i)
Principal Payment at Legal Maturity. The Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Outstanding Principal Amount shall be due and payable in full
on the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Legal Final Maturity Date. The Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Outstanding Principal Amount is not prepayable,
in whole or in part, except as set forth in the Base Indenture and this Section 3.5.
(ii)
Series 2024-1 Anticipated Repayment Date. The Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Final Payment Date is anticipated to occur on the Quarterly
Payment Date occurring in October 2027 (such date, the “Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Anticipated Repayment Date”).
(iii)
Payment of Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts. Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes Scheduled Principal
Payment Amounts will be due and payable on each applicable Quarterly Payment Date in accordance with Section 5.11 of the Base
Indenture.
(e)
Rapid Amortization of Series 2024-1 Notes. During any Rapid Amortization Period, principal payments shall be due and payable on
each Quarterly Payment Date on the applicable Classes of Series 2024-1 Notes as and when amounts are made available for payment thereof
(i) on any related Monthly Allocation Date, in accordance with the Priority of Payments and (ii) on such Quarterly Payment Date in accordance
with Section 5.11 of the Base Indenture. Such payments shall be ratably allocated among the Series 2024-1 Noteholders within each
applicable Class based on their respective portion of the Series 2024-1 Outstanding Principal Amount of such Class.
(f)
Optional Prepayment.
(i)
Optional Prepayment of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes. Subject to Section 5.12(b) of the Base Indenture and Section
3.5(i), the Issuer shall have the option to prepay (including with the proceeds of equity contributions, refinancings and public
or private sales of equity in the Issuer including any Qualified Equity Offering) the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Series 2024-1
Class A-2-I Notes in whole or in part (each such prepayment, a “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Prepayment”) on any Quarterly
Payment Date that is specified as the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Prepayment Date in the applicable Prepayment Notice (each, a “Class
A-2-I Optional Prepayment Date”); provided that no such optional prepayment of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes may
be made unless the below conditions shall be satisfied:
(A)
subject to Section 5.12(b) of the Base Indenture, in the case of a prepayment of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes in part:
a.
the amounts on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts, the Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account, the Super Senior Notes Principal
Payment Account or other available amounts, in each case allocable to Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes, are sufficient to pay the amount
of such prepayment as of Quarterly Payment Date, and
b.
the amounts on deposit in, or allocable to the Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account and the Super Senior Notes Principal Payment
Account and other available amounts to be distributed on the Quarterly Payment Date which coincides with such Class A-2-I Optional Prepayment
Date are sufficient to pay the Super Senior Prepayment Condition Amounts on such Quarterly Payment Date; and
(B)
subject to Section 5.12(b) of the Base Indenture, in the case of an optional prepayment of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes
in whole:
a.
the amounts on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts, the Super Senior Notes Interest Payment Account, the Super Senior Notes Principal
Payment Account or other available amounts, in each case allocable to Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes, are sufficient to pay all outstanding
monetary Obligations (including unreimbursed Manager Advances) in respect of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes set forth in the Priority
of Payments after giving effect to the applicable allocations set forth therein on such Class A-2-I Optional Prepayment Date, including
unpaid interest accrued in respect of the period prior to such Class A-2-I Optional Prepayment Date and the Super Senior Prepayment Condition
Amounts on such Quarterly Payment Date, and
b.
the amounts on deposit in the Collection Account, the Indenture Trust Accounts or otherwise available are reasonably expected by the
Manager to be sufficient to pay the Super Senior Prepayment Condition Amounts, other than with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I
Notes, on such Class A-2-I Optional Prepayment Date, if such date is a Quarterly Payment Date, or, in each case, any shortfalls in such
amounts (in a. or b. above) have been deposited to the applicable accounts.
(ii)
Optional Prepayment of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes. Subject to Section 5.12(b) of the Base Indenture and Section
3.5(i), the Issuer shall have the option to prepay (including with the proceeds of equity contributions, refinancings and public
or private sales of equity in the Issuer including any Qualified Equity Offering) the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Series 2024-1
Class A-2-II Notes in whole or in part (each such prepayment, a “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Prepayment”) on any Quarterly
Payment Date that is specified as the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Prepayment Date in the applicable Prepayment Notice (each, a “Class
A-2-II Optional Prepayment Date”); provided that no such optional prepayment of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes
may be made unless (a) the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes are a Defeased Class or (b) the Issuer simultaneously makes an optional prepayment
of a principal amount of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes in accordance with Section 3.5(f)(i) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement
at least equal to the lesser of (x) the outstanding principal amount of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes and (y) principal amount
of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes that the Issuer has elected to prepay, provided that following a Series Anticipated Repayment
Date for any Series of Notes that remains Outstanding, all optional prepayments must be applied first, to Super Senior Notes and second,
to Senior Notes; and provided further that the following conditions shall be satisfied:
(A)
subject to Section 5.12(b) of the Base Indenture, in the case of a prepayment of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes in part:
a.
the amounts on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts, the Senior Notes Interest Payment Account, the Senior Notes Principal Payment
Account or other available amounts, in each case allocable to Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes, are sufficient to pay the amount of such
prepayment as of Quarterly Payment Date, and
b.
the amounts on deposit in, or allocable to the Senior Notes Interest Payment Account and the Senior Notes Principal Payment Account and
other available amounts to be distributed on the Quarterly Payment Date which coincides with such Class A-2-II Optional Prepayment Date
are sufficient to pay the Senior Prepayment Condition Amounts on such Quarterly Payment Date; and
(B)
subject to Section 5.12(b) of the Base Indenture, in the case of an optional prepayment of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes
in whole:
a.
the amounts on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts, the Senior Notes Interest Payment Account, the Senior Notes Principal Payment
Account or other available amounts, in each case allocable to Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes, are sufficient to pay all outstanding
monetary Obligations (including unreimbursed Manager Advances) in respect of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes set forth in the Priority
of Payments after giving effect to the applicable allocations set forth therein on such Class A-2-II Optional Prepayment Date, including
unpaid interest accrued in respect of the period prior to such Class A-2-II Optional Prepayment Date and the Senior Prepayment Condition
Amounts on such Quarterly Payment Date, and
b.
the amounts on deposit in the Collection Account, the Indenture Trust Accounts or otherwise available are reasonably expected by the
Manager to be sufficient to pay the Senior Prepayment Condition Amounts, other than with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes,
on such Class A-2-II Optional Prepayment Date, if such date is a Quarterly Payment Date, or, in each case, any shortfalls in such amounts
(in a. or b. above) have been deposited to the applicable accounts.
(iii)
Optional Prepayment of Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes. Subject to Section 5.12(b) of the Base Indenture and Section 3.5(i),
the Issuer shall have the option to prepay (including with the proceeds of equity contributions, refinancings and public or private sales
of equity in the Issuer including any Qualified Equity Offering) the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes
in whole or in part (each such prepayment a “Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Prepayment”) on any Quarterly Payment Date that
is specified as the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Prepayment Date in the applicable Prepayment Notice (each, a “Class B-2 Optional
Prepayment Date”); provided that no such optional prepayment of the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes may be made unless
(a) the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes and the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes are each a Defeased Class or (b) the Issuer simultaneously
makes an optional prepayment of a principal amount of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes and the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes in accordance
with Section 3.5(f)(i) and Section 3.5(f)(ii) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement at least equal to the lesser of: (A) with
respect to the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes, (x) the outstanding principal amount of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes and (y) principal
amount of Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes that the Issuer has elected to prepay; and (B) with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II
Notes, (x) the outstanding principal amount of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes and (y) principal amount of Series 2024-1 Class B-2
Notes that the Issuer has elected to prepay, provided that following a Series Anticipated Repayment Date for any Series of Notes
that remains Outstanding, all optional prepayments must be applied first, to Super Senior Notes, second, to Senior Notes and third, to
Senior Subordinated Notes; and provided further that the following conditions shall be satisfied:
(A)
subject to Section 5.12(b) of the Base Indenture, in the case of a prepayment of the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes in part:
a.
the amounts on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts, the Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account, the Senior Subordinated
Notes Principal Payment Account or other available amounts, in each case allocable to Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes, are sufficient to
pay the amount of such prepayment as of Quarterly Payment Date, and
b.
the amounts on deposit in, or allocable to, the Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account and the Senior Subordinated Notes
Principal Payment Account and other available amounts to be distributed on the Quarterly Payment Date which coincides with such Class
B-2 Optional Prepayment Date are sufficient to pay the Prepayment Condition Amounts on such Quarterly Payment Date; and
(B)
subject to Section 5.12(b) of the Base Indenture, in the case of an optional prepayment of the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes in
whole:
a.
the amounts on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts, the Senior Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account, the Senior Subordinated
Notes Principal Payment Account or other available amounts, in each case allocable to Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes, are sufficient to
pay all outstanding monetary Obligations (including unreimbursed Manager Advances) in respect of the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes set
forth in the Priority of Payments after giving effect to the applicable allocations set forth therein on such Class B-2 Optional Prepayment
Date, including unpaid interest accrued in respect of the period prior to such Class B-2 Optional Prepayment Date; and
b.
the amounts on deposit in the Collection Account, the Indenture Trust Accounts or otherwise available are reasonably expected by the
Manager to be sufficient to pay the Prepayment Condition Amounts, other than with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes, on such
Class B-2 Optional Prepayment Date, if such date is a Quarterly Payment Date, or, in each case, any shortfalls in such amounts (in a.
or b. above) have been deposited to the applicable accounts.
(iv)
Optional Prepayment of Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes. Subject to Section 5.12(b) of the Base Indenture and Section 3.5(i),
the Issuer shall have the option to prepay (including with the proceeds of equity contributions, refinancings and public or private sales
of equity in the Issuer including any Qualified Equity Offering) the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes
in whole or in part (each such prepayment a “Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Prepayment”) on any Quarterly Payment Date that
is specified as the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Prepayment Date in the applicable Prepayment Notice (each, a “Class M-2 Optional
Prepayment Date”); provided that no such optional prepayment of the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes may be made unless
(a) the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes, the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes and the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes are each a Defeased
Class or (b) the Issuer simultaneously makes an optional prepayment of a principal amount of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes, Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes and Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes in accordance with Section 3.5(f)(i), Section 3.5(f)(ii) and
Section 3.5(f)(iii) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement at least equal to the lesser of: (A) with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class
A-2-I Notes, (x) the outstanding principal amount of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes and (y) principal amount of Series 2024-1 Class
B-2 Notes that the Issuer has elected to prepay; (B) with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes, (x) the outstanding principal
amount of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes and (y) principal amount of Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes that the Issuer has elected
to prepay; and (C) with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes, (x) the outstanding principal amount of the Series 2024-1 Class
B-2 Notes and (y) principal amount of Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes that the Issuer has elected to prepay, provided further that following
a Series Anticipated Repayment Date for any Series of Notes that remains Outstanding, all optional prepayments must be applied first,
to Super Senior Notes, second, to Senior Notes, third, to Senior Subordinated Notes and fourth, to Subordinated Notes, and provided further
that the following conditions shall be satisfied:
(A)
subject to Section 5.12(b) of the Base Indenture, in the case of a prepayment of the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes in part:
a.
the amounts on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts, the Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account, the Subordinated Notes Principal
Payment Account or other available amounts, in each case allocable to Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes, are sufficient to pay the amount
of such prepayment as of Quarterly Payment Date, and
b.
the amounts on deposit in, or allocable to, the Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account and the Subordinated Notes Principal Payment
Account and other available amounts to be distributed on the Quarterly Payment Date which coincides with such Class M-2 Optional Prepayment
Date are sufficient to pay the Prepayment Condition Amounts on such Quarterly Payment Date; and
(B)
subject to Section 5.12(b) of the Base Indenture, in the case of an optional prepayment of the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes in
whole:
a.
the amounts on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts, the Subordinated Notes Interest Payment Account, the Subordinated Notes Principal
Payment Account or other available amounts, in each case allocable to Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes, are sufficient to pay all outstanding
monetary Obligations (including unreimbursed Manager Advances) in respect of the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes set forth in the Priority
of Payments after giving effect to the applicable allocations set forth therein on such Class M-2 Optional Prepayment Date, including
unpaid interest accrued in respect of the period prior to such Class M-2 Optional Prepayment Date; and
b.
the amounts on deposit in the Collection Account, the Indenture Trust Accounts or otherwise available are reasonably expected by the
Manager to be sufficient to pay the Prepayment Condition Amounts, other than with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes, on such
Class M-2 Optional Prepayment Date, if such date is a Quarterly Payment Date, or, in each case, any shortfalls in such amounts (in a.
or b. above) have been deposited to the applicable accounts.
(g)
Notices of Prepayments.
(i)
The Issuer shall give prior written notice (each, a “Prepayment Notice”) at least fifteen (15) Business Days but not
more than twenty (20) Business Days prior to any Series 2024-1 Prepayment with respect to any Class pursuant to Section 3.5(f)
to each Series 2024-1 Noteholder affected by such Series 2024-1 Prepayment, the Trustee and the Control Party; provided that at
the request of the Issuer, such notice to the affected Series 2024-1 Noteholders shall be given by the Trustee in the name and at the
expense of the Issuer.
(ii)
With respect to each such Series 2024-1 Prepayment, the related Prepayment Notice shall, in each case, specify (A) the Series 2024-1
Prepayment Date on which such prepayment will be made, which in all cases shall be a Business Day, and (B) the Series 2024-1 Prepayment
Amount.
(iii)
Any such optional prepayment and Prepayment Notice may, in the Issuer’s discretion, be subject to the satisfaction of one or more
conditions precedent, including but not limited to the occurrence of a Change of Control. The Issuer shall have the option to provide
in any Prepayment Notice that the payment of the amounts set forth in Section 3.5(f) and the performance of the Issuer’s
obligations with respect to such optional prepayment may be performed by another Person.
(iv)
The Issuer shall have the option, by written notice to the Trustee, the Control Party and the affected Noteholders, to revoke, or amend
the Series 2024-1 Prepayment Date set forth in, any Prepayment Notice relating to an optional prepayment at any time up to the fifth
Business Day before the Series 2024-1 Prepayment Date set forth in such Prepayment Notice; provided that at the request of the
Issuer, such notice to the affected Series 2024-1 Noteholders shall be given by the Trustee in the name and at the expense of the Issuer.
(h)
Series 2024-1 Prepayments. Subject to Section 3.5(g), on each Series 2024-1 Prepayment Date with respect to any Series
2024-1 Prepayment, the Series 2024-1 Prepayment Amount shall be due and payable.
(i)
Distributions of Optional Prepayments
(i)
Distributions of Optional Prepayments of Series 2024-1 Notes.
(A)
No later than five (5) Business Days prior to the Series 2024-1 Prepayment Date for each Series 2024-1 Prepayment to be made pursuant
to Section 3.5(h), the Issuer shall provide the Trustee with a written report instructing the Trustee to deposit the amounts set
forth in such report, which shall include such amounts set forth in Section 3.5(f)(i)(B)a, Section 3.5(f)(ii)(B)a and Section
3.5(f)(iii)(B)a, as applicable, and in each case due and payable to the applicable Noteholders on such Series 2024-1 Prepayment Date.
Such written report may be consolidated with additional payment instructions as necessary to effect other distributions occurring on,
or substantially concurrently with, such Series 2024-1 Prepayment Date.
(B)
On the Series 2024-1 Prepayment Date for each Series 2024-1 Prepayment to be made pursuant to Section 3.5(f), the Trustee shall,
in accordance with Section 6.1 of the Base Indenture (except that, notwithstanding anything to the contrary therein, references
to the distributions being made on a Quarterly Payment Date shall be deemed to be references to distributions made on such Series 2024-1
Prepayment Date and references to the Record Date shall be deemed to be references to the Prepayment Record Date), distribute to the
Noteholders of record of the applicable Class on the preceding Prepayment Record Date on a pro rata basis, based on their respective
portion of the Outstanding Principal Amount of the applicable Class of Notes the amount specified in the written report delivered in
accordance with Section 3.5(i)(i)(A) in order to pay (without duplication) (A) the applicable portion of such Outstanding Principal
Amount, and (B) in the case of an optional prepayment in whole, the outstanding monetary Obligations described in Section 3.5(f)(i)(B)a,
Section 3.5(f)(ii)(B)a and Section 3.5(f)(iii)(B)a, as applicable, in each case due and payable on such Series 2024-1 Prepayment
Date.
(j)
Series 2024-1 Notices of Final Payment. The Issuer shall notify the Trustee and the Manager of the Series 2024-1 Final Payment
Date of a Class of Notes on or before the Prepayment Record Date preceding such Series 2024-1 Prepayment Date; provided, however,
that with respect to any Series 2024-1 Final Payment that is made in connection with any mandatory or optional prepayment in full, the
Issuer shall not be obligated to provide any additional notice to the Trustee of such Series 2024-1 Final Payment beyond the notice required
to be given in connection with such prepayment pursuant to Section 3.5(g). The Trustee shall provide any written notice required
under this Section 3.5(j) to each Person in whose name such Series 2024-1 Notes are registered at the close of business on such
Prepayment Record Date of the Series 2024-1 Prepayment Date that will be the Series 2024-1 Final Payment Date for such Class of Notes.
Such written notice to be sent to the Series 2024-1 Noteholders shall be made at the expense of the Issuer and shall be mailed by the
Trustee within five (5) Business Days of receipt of notice from the Issuer indicating that the Series 2024-1 Final Payment will be made
and shall specify that such Series 2024-1 Final Payment will be payable only upon presentation and surrender of the related Series 2024-1
Notes, which such surrender shall also constitute a general release by the applicable Noteholder from any claims against the Issuer,
the Manager, the Trustee and their affiliates, and shall specify the place where the related Series 2024-1 Notes may be presented and
surrendered for such Series 2024-1 Final Payment.
Section
3.6 Manager. Pursuant to the Management Agreement, the Manager has agreed to provide certain reports, notices, instructions and
other services on behalf of the Issuer. The Series 2024-1 Noteholders by their acceptance of the Series 2024-1 Notes consent to the provision
of such reports and notices to the Trustee by the Manager in lieu of the Issuer.
Section
3.7 Other Agreements. In accordance with Section 8.22 of the Base Indenture, for the avoidance of doubt, the Securitization
Entities shall be permitted to enter into or be a party to certain letters of credit relating to self-insurance in respect of Company
Restaurants and any other Company Restaurant Expenses.
ARTICLE
IV
FORM
OF SERIES 2024-1 NOTES
Section
4.1 Issuance of Series 2024-1 Global Notes.
(a)
The Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes may be offered and sold in the applicable Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Initial Principal Amount on the
Series 2024-1 Closing Date by the Issuer. The Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes may be offered and sold in the applicable Series 2024-1
Class A-2-II Initial Principal Amount on the Series 2024-1 Closing Date by the Issuer. The Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes may be offered
and sold in the applicable Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Initial Principal Amount on the Series 2024-1 Closing Date by the Issuer. The Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Notes may be offered and sold in the applicable Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Initial Principal Amount on the Series 2024-1
Closing Date by the Issuer. The Series 2024-1 Class A2IIB2 Notes and the Series 2024-1 Class A2IIB2M2 Notes may be offered and sold in
the applicable principal amounts provided in Exhibit D; provided, that for any such Exchangeable Notes offered and sold
on the Series 2024-1 Closing Date, Exchange Notes with an aggregate principal amount equal to the principal amount of such Exchangeable
Notes issued on the Series 2024-1 Closing Date will be deemed to have been exchanged for such Exchangeable Notes on the Series 2024-1
Closing Date in the relevant Exchangeable Combination. The Series 2024-1 Notes will be “restricted securities” issued pursuant
to the provisions of Rule 506 (b) of Regulation D under Section 4(a)(2) of the 1933 Act sold only to QIBs purchasing for their own account
or the account of one or more Persons, each of which is a QIB. The Series 2024-1 Notes will be resold only to the Issuer or its Affiliates
or (A) in the United States, to Persons who are not Competitors and who are QIBs purchasing for their own account or the account of one
or more other Persons, each of which is a QIB, in reliance on Rule 144A and (B) outside the United States, to Persons who are not Competitors
and who are not a U.S. person (as defined in Regulation S) (a “U.S. Person”) in reliance on Regulation S, purchasing
for their own account or the account of one or more other Persons, each of which is a non-U.S. Person. The Series 2024-1 Notes may thereafter
be transferred in reliance on Rule 144A and/or Regulation S and in accordance with the procedure described herein. The Series 2024-1
Notes will be Book-Entry Notes and DTC will be the Depository for such Series 2024-1 Notes. The Applicable Procedures shall be applicable
to transfers of beneficial interests in the Series 2024-1 Notes.
(b)
Global Notes.
(i)
Rule 144A Global Notes. The Series 2024-1 Notes offered and sold in their initial distribution in reliance upon Rule 144A will
be issued in the form of one or more global notes in fully registered form, without coupons, substantially in the form set forth in Exhibit
A-1 hereto, registered in the name of Cede & Co. (“Cede”), as nominee of DTC, and deposited with the Trustee,
as custodian for DTC (collectively, for purposes of this Section 4.1 and Section 4.2, the “Rule 144A Global Notes”).
The aggregate initial principal amount of the Rule 144A Global Notes of each Class may from time to time be increased or decreased by
adjustments made on the records of the Trustee, as custodian for DTC, in connection with a corresponding decrease or increase in the
aggregate initial principal amount of the corresponding Class of Temporary Regulation S Global Notes or Permanent Regulation S Global
Notes, as hereinafter provided.
(ii)
Regulation S Global Notes. Any Series 2024-1 Notes offered and sold on the Series 2024-1 Closing Date in reliance upon Regulation
S will be issued in the form of one or more global notes in fully registered form, without coupons, substantially in the form set forth
in Exhibit A-2 hereto, registered in the name of Cede, as nominee of DTC, and deposited with the Trustee, as custodian for DTC,
for credit to the respective accounts at DTC of the designated agents holding on behalf of Euroclear or Clearstream. Until such time
as the Restricted Period shall have terminated with respect to any Series 2024-1 Note, such Series 2024-1 Notes shall be referred to
herein collectively, for purposes of this Section 4.1 and Section 4.2, as the “Temporary Regulation S Global Notes.”
After such time as the Restricted Period shall have terminated, the Temporary Regulation S Global Notes shall be exchangeable, in whole
or in part, for interests in one or more permanent global notes in registered form without interest coupons, substantially in the form
set forth in Exhibit A-3 hereto, as hereinafter provided (collectively, for purposes of this Section 4.1 and Section
4.2, the “Permanent Regulation S Global Notes”). The aggregate principal amount of the Temporary Regulation S
Global Notes or the Permanent Regulation S Global Notes may from time to time be increased or decreased by adjustments made on the records
of the Trustee, as custodian for DTC, in connection with a corresponding decrease or increase of aggregate principal amount of the corresponding
Rule 144A Global Notes, as hereinafter provided.
(c)
Definitive Notes. The Series 2024-1 Global Notes of each Class shall be exchangeable in their entirety for one or more definitive
notes in registered form, without interest coupons (collectively, for purposes of this Section 4.1 and Section 4.2, the
“Definitive Notes”) pursuant to Section 2.13 of the Base Indenture and this Section 4.1(c) in accordance
with their terms and, upon complete exchange thereof, such Series 2024-1 Global Notes shall be surrendered for cancellation at the applicable
Corporate Trust Office.
Section
4.2 Transfer Restrictions of Series 2024-1 Global Notes.
(a)
A Series 2024-1 Global Note may not be transferred, in whole or in part, to any Person other than DTC or a nominee thereof, or to a successor
Depository or to a nominee of a successor Depository, and no such transfer to any such other Person may be registered; provided,
however, that this Section 4.2(a) shall not prohibit any transfer of any Series 2024-1 Note that is issued in exchange
for a Series 2024-1 Global Note in accordance with Section 2.8 of the Base Indenture and shall not prohibit any transfer of a
beneficial interest in a Series 2024-1 Global Note effected in accordance with the other provisions of this Section 4.2.
(b)
The transfer by a Series 2024-1 Note Owner holding a beneficial interest in a Series 2024-1 Note of any Class in the form of a Rule 144A
Global Note to a Person who wishes to take delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in the Rule 144A Global Note of such
Class shall be made upon the deemed representation of the transferee that it is purchasing for its own account or an account with respect
to which it exercises sole investment discretion and that it and any such account is a QIB and not a Competitor, and is aware that the
sale to it is being made in reliance on Rule 144A and acknowledges that it has received such information regarding the Issuer as such
transferee has requested pursuant to Rule 144A or has determined not to request such information and that it is aware that the transferor
is relying upon its foregoing representations in order to claim the exemption from registration provided by Rule 144A.
(c)
If a Series 2024-1 Note Owner holding a beneficial interest in a Series 2024-1 Note of such Class in the form of a Rule 144A Global Note
wishes at any time to exchange its interest in such Rule 144A Global Note for an interest in the Temporary Regulation S Global Note of
such Class, or to transfer such interest to a Person who wishes to take delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in the
Temporary Regulation S Global Note of such Class, such exchange or transfer may be effected, subject to the Applicable Procedures, only
in accordance with the provisions of this Section 4.2(c). Upon receipt by the Note Registrar, at the applicable Corporate Trust
Office, of (i) written instructions given in accordance with the Applicable Procedures from a Clearing Agency Participant directing the
Note Registrar to credit or cause to be credited to a specified Clearing Agency Participant’s account a beneficial interest in
the Temporary Regulation S Global Note, in a principal amount equal to that of the beneficial interest in such Rule 144A Global Note
to be so exchanged or transferred, (ii) a written order given in accordance with the Applicable Procedures containing information regarding
the account of the Clearing Agency Participant (and the Euroclear or Clearstream account, as the case may be) to be credited with, and
the account of the Clearing Agency Participant to be debited for, such beneficial interest and (iii) a certificate in substantially the
form set forth in Exhibit B-1 hereto given by the Series 2024-1 Note Owner holding such beneficial interest in such Rule 144A
Global Note, the Note Registrar shall instruct the Trustee, as custodian of DTC, to reduce the principal amount of the Rule 144A Global
Note, and to increase the principal amount of the Temporary Regulation S Global Note, by the principal amount of the beneficial interest
in such Rule 144A Global Note to be so exchanged or transferred, and to credit or cause to be credited to the account of the Person specified
in such instructions (which shall be the Clearing Agency Participant for Euroclear or Clearstream or both, as the case may be) a beneficial
interest in the Temporary Regulation S Global Note having a principal amount equal to the amount by which the principal amount of such
Rule 144A Global Note was reduced upon such exchange or transfer.
(d)
If a Series 2024-1 Note Owner holding a beneficial interest in a Rule 144A Global Note of any Class wishes at any time to exchange its
interest in such Rule 144A Global Note for an interest in the Permanent Regulation S Global Note of such Class, or to transfer such interest
to a Person who wishes to take delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in the Permanent Regulation S Global Note of such
Class, such exchange or transfer may be effected, subject to the Applicable Procedures, only in accordance with the provisions of this
Section 4.2(d). Upon receipt by the Note Registrar, at the applicable Corporate Trust Office, of (i) written instructions given
in accordance with the Applicable Procedures from a Clearing Agency Participant directing the Note Registrar to credit or cause to be
credited to a specified Clearing Agency Participant’s account a beneficial interest in the Permanent Regulation S Global Note in
a principal amount equal to that of the beneficial interest in such Rule 144A Global Note to be so exchanged or transferred, (ii) a written
order given in accordance with the Applicable Procedures containing information regarding the account of the Clearing Agency Participant
(and the Euroclear or Clearstream account, as the case may be) to be credited with, and the account of the Clearing Agency Participant
to be debited for, such beneficial interest and (iii) a certificate in substantially the form of Exhibit B-2 hereto given by the
Series 2024-1 Note Owner holding such beneficial interest in such Rule 144A Global Note, the Note Registrar shall instruct the Trustee,
as custodian of DTC, to reduce the principal amount of such Rule 144A Global Note, and to increase the principal amount of the Permanent
Regulation S Global Note, by the principal amount of the beneficial interest in such Rule 144A Global Note to be so exchanged or transferred,
and to credit or cause to be credited to the account of the Person specified in such instructions (which shall be the Clearing Agency
Participant for Euroclear or Clearstream or both, as the case may be) a beneficial interest in the Permanent Regulation S Global Note
having a principal amount equal to the amount by which the principal amount of such Rule 144A Global Note was reduced upon such exchange
or transfer.
(e)
If a Series 2024-1 Note Owner holding a beneficial interest in a Temporary Regulation S Global Note or a Permanent Regulation S Global
Note wishes at any time to exchange its interest in such Temporary Regulation S Global Note or such Permanent Regulation S Global Note
for an interest in the Rule 144A Global Note, or to transfer such interest to a Person who wishes to take delivery thereof in the form
of a beneficial interest in the Rule 144A Global Note, such exchange or transfer may be effected, subject to the Applicable Procedures,
only in accordance with the provisions of this Section 4.2(e). Upon receipt by the Note Registrar, at the applicable Corporate
Trust Office, of (i) written instructions given in accordance with the Applicable Procedures from a Clearing Agency Participant directing
the Note Registrar to credit or cause to be credited to a specified Clearing Agency Participant’s account a beneficial interest
in the Rule 144A Global Note of the applicable Class in a principal amount equal to that of the beneficial interest in such Temporary
Regulation S Global Note or such Permanent Regulation S Global Note, as the case may be, to be so exchanged or transferred, (ii) a written
order given in accordance with the Applicable Procedures containing information regarding the account of the Clearing Agency Participant
(and the Euroclear or Clearstream account, as the case may be) to be credited with, and the account of the Clearing Agency Participant
to be debited for, such beneficial interest and (iii) with respect to a transfer of a beneficial interest in such Temporary Regulation
S Global Note (but not such Permanent Regulation S Global Note), a certificate in substantially the form set forth in Exhibit B-3
hereto given by such Series 2024-1 Note Owner holding such beneficial interest in such Temporary Regulation S Global Note, the Note
Registrar shall instruct the Trustee, as custodian of DTC, to reduce the principal amount of such Temporary Regulation S Global Note
or such Permanent Regulation S Global Note, as the case may be, and to increase the principal amount of such Rule 144A Global Note, by
the principal amount of the beneficial interest in such Temporary Regulation S Global Note or such Permanent Regulation S Global Note
to be so exchanged or transferred, and to credit or cause to be credited to the account of the Person specified in such instructions
(which shall be the Clearing Agency Participant for DTC) a beneficial interest in such Rule 144A Global Note having a principal amount
equal to the amount by which the principal amount of such Temporary Regulation S Global Note or such Permanent Regulation S Global Note,
as the case may be, was reduced upon such exchange or transfer.
(f)
In the event that a Series 2024-1 Global Note of any Class or any portion thereof is exchanged for a Series 2024-1 Note of such Class
other than Series 2024-1 Global Notes, such other Series 2024-1 Notes may in turn be exchanged (upon transfer or otherwise) for Series
2024-1 Notes of such Class that are not Series 2024-1 Global Notes or for a beneficial interest in a Series 2024-1 Global Note of such
Class (if any is then outstanding) only in accordance with such procedures as may be adopted from time to time by the Issuer and the
Note Registrar, which shall be substantially consistent with the provisions of Section 4.2(a) through Section 4.2(e) and
Section 4.2(g) (including the certification requirement intended to ensure that transfers and exchanges of beneficial interests
in a Series 2024-1 Global Note comply with Rule 144A or Regulation S under the 1933 Act, as the case may be) and any Applicable Procedures.
(g)
Until the termination of the Restricted Period with respect to any Series 2024-1 Note, interests in the Temporary Regulation S Global
Notes representing such Series 2024-1 Note may be held only through Clearing Agency Participants acting for and on behalf of Euroclear
and Clearstream; provided that this Section 4.2(g) shall not prohibit any transfer in accordance with Section 4.2(d).
After the expiration of the applicable Restricted Period, interests in the Permanent Regulation S Global Notes may be transferred without
requiring any certifications other than those set forth in this Section 4.2.
(h)
The Series 2024-1 Notes Rule 144A Global Notes, the Series 2024-1 Notes Temporary Regulation S Global Notes and the Series 2024-1 Notes
Permanent Regulation S Global Notes shall bear the following legend:
THE
ISSUANCE AND SALE OF THIS [RULE 144A] [TEMPORARY REGULATION S] [PERMANENT REGULATION S] SERIES 2024-1 CLASS [A-2-I][A-2-II][B-2][M-2]
[A2IIB2] [A2IIB2M2] NOTE HAVE NOT BEEN AND WILL NOT BE REGISTERED UNDER THE UNITED STATES SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “1933
ACT”), OR WITH ANY SECURITIES REGULATORY AUTHORITY OF ANY STATE OR OTHER RELEVANT JURISDICTION, AND TWIN HOSPITALITY I, LLC
(THE “ISSUER”) HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE INVESTMENT COMPANY ACT OF 1940, AS AMENDED (THE “1940 ACT”).
THIS NOTE OR ANY INTEREST HEREIN MAY BE OFFERED, SOLD, PLEDGED OR OTHERWISE TRANSFERRED ONLY (A) TO THE ISSUER OR AN AFFILIATE THEREOF,
(B) IN THE UNITED STATES, TO A PERSON WHO IS NOT A COMPETITOR AND IS A “QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER” AS DEFINED IN RULE
144A UNDER THE 1933 ACT (“RULE 144A”), ACTING FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT OR ONE OR MORE ACCOUNTS WITH RESPECT TO WHICH SUCH
PERSON EXERCISES SOLE INVESTMENT DISCRETION OR (C) OUTSIDE THE UNITED STATES, TO A PERSON WHO IS NOT A COMPETITOR AND IS NOT A “U.S.
PERSON” AS DEFINED IN REGULATION S UNDER THE 1933 ACT (“REGULATION S”), ACTING FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT OR ONE OR
MORE ACCOUNTS WITH RESPECT TO WHICH SUCH PERSON EXERCISES SOLE INVESTMENT DISCRETION, NONE OF WHICH ARE A U.S. PERSON, IN OFFSHORE TRANSACTIONS
IN RELIANCE ON REGULATION S, AND, IN EACH CASE, IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE CERTIFICATIONS AND OTHER REQUIREMENTS SPECIFIED IN THE INDENTURE
REFERRED TO HEREIN AND ANY APPLICABLE SECURITIES LAWS OF ANY STATE OR THE UNITED STATES AND ANY OTHER RELEVANT JURISDICTION.
BY
ITS ACQUISITION OR ACCEPTANCE HEREOF, THE HOLDER (IF NOT THE ISSUER OR AN AFFILIATE OF THE ISSUER) REPRESENTS THAT (A) IT IS NOT A COMPETITOR
AND IS (X) A “QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER” AS DEFINED IN RULE 144A OR (Y) NOT A U.S. PERSON AND IS ACQUIRING THIS NOTE
IN AN OFFSHORE TRANSACTION, AS APPLICABLE, (B) IT IS NOT A COMPETITOR AND IS ACTING FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OF ANOTHER
PERSON WHICH IS EITHER (X) A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER OR (Y) NOT A U.S. PERSON, AND IN EACH CASE WITH RESPECT TO WHICH IT EXERCISES
SOLE INVESTMENT DISCRETION, (C) IT AND EACH ACCOUNT FOR WHICH IT IS PURCHASING WILL HOLD AND TRANSFER AT LEAST THE MINIMUM DENOMINATION
OF NOTES, (D) IT UNDERSTANDS THAT THE ISSUER MAY RECEIVE A LIST OF PARTICIPANTS HOLDING POSITIONS IN ITS NOTES FROM ONE OR MORE BOOK-ENTRY
DEPOSITORIES AND (E) IT WILL PROVIDE NOTICE OF THE TRANSFER RESTRICTIONS TO ANY SUBSEQUENT TRANSFEREES.
EACH
PERSON (IF NOT THE ISSUER OR AN AFFILIATE OF THE ISSUER) TAKING DELIVERY OF THIS NOTE OR AN INTEREST IN THIS NOTE WILL BE DEEMED TO HAVE
MADE THE APPLICABLE REPRESENTATIONS AND AGREEMENTS REFERRED TO IN THE INDENTURE. EACH PERSON TAKING DELIVERY OF THIS NOTE OR AN INTEREST
IN THIS NOTE IN THE FORM OF AN INTEREST IN A [TEMPORARY REGULATION S GLOBAL NOTE] [RULE 144A GLOBAL NOTE] OR [PERMANENT REGULATION S
GLOBAL NOTE] WILL BE REQUIRED TO DELIVER A TRANSFER CERTIFICATE IN THE FORM REQUIRED BY THE INDENTURE AND WILL BE REQUIRED TO MAKE THE
APPLICABLE REPRESENTATIONS AND AGREEMENTS REFERRED TO IN THE INDENTURE.
ANY
TRANSFER OF THIS NOTE IN VIOLATION OF THE FOREGOING WILL BE OF NO FORCE AND EFFECT AND WILL BE VOID AB INITIO AND WILL NOT OPERATE TO
TRANSFER ANY RIGHTS TO ANY PERSON CAUSING SUCH VIOLATION, NOTWITHSTANDING ANY INSTRUCTIONS TO THE CONTRARY TO THE ISSUER, THE TRUSTEE
OR ANY INTERMEDIARY; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, THAT THE PRECEDING PORTION OF THIS SENTENCE SHALL NOT OPERATE TO INVALIDATE ANY OTHERWISE BONA
FIDE TRANSFER TO AN ELIGIBLE TRANSFEREE WHERE A PREVIOUS ERRONEOUSLY REGISTERED TRANSFEROR IN THE CHAIN OF TITLE OF SUCH TRANSFEREE WOULD
HAVE BEEN INELIGIBLE SOLELY ON ACCOUNT OF BEING A COMPETITOR.
IF
THIS NOTE WAS ACQUIRED IN THE UNITED STATES, AND THE HOLDER IS DETERMINED TO BE A COMPETITOR OR NOT TO HAVE BEEN A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL
BUYER AT THE TIME OF ACQUISITION OF THIS NOTE, THE ISSUER HAS THE RIGHT TO REQUIRE SUCH HOLDER TO SELL THIS NOTE TO A PURCHASER WHO IS
NOT A COMPETITOR AND IS A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER. THE ISSUER ALSO HAS THE RIGHT TO REFUSE TO HONOR A TRANSFER TO A PERSON WHO
IS NOT A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER OR WHO IS A COMPETITOR.
IF
THIS NOTE WAS ACQUIRED OUTSIDE THE UNITED STATES, AND THE HOLDER IS DETERMINED TO BE A COMPETITOR OR TO HAVE BEEN A “U.S. PERSON”
AT THE TIME OF ACQUISITION OF THIS NOTE, THE ISSUER HAS THE RIGHT TO REQUIRE SUCH HOLDER TO SELL THIS NOTE TO A PURCHASER WHO IS NOT
A COMPETITOR AND IS NOT A “U.S. PERSON.” THE ISSUER ALSO HAS THE RIGHT TO REFUSE TO HONOR A TRANSFER TO A PERSON WHO IS A
“U.S. PERSON” OR WHO IS A COMPETITOR.
BY
ACCEPTING THIS NOTE, EACH HOLDER COVENANTS THAT IT WILL NOT AT ANY TIME PRIOR TO THE DATE WHICH IS ONE (1) YEAR AND ONE (1) DAY AFTER
THE PAYMENT IN FULL OF THE LATEST MATURING NOTE, INSTITUTE AGAINST, OR JOIN WITH ANY OTHER PERSON IN INSTITUTING AGAINST, ANY SECURITIZATION
ENTITY ANY BANKRUPTCY, REORGANIZATION, ARRANGEMENT, INSOLVENCY OR LIQUIDATION PROCEEDINGS, OR OTHER PROCEEDINGS, UNDER ANY FEDERAL OR
STATE BANKRUPTCY OR SIMILAR LAW.
THIS
NOTE IS A GLOBAL NOTE WITHIN THE MEANING OF THE INDENTURE HEREINAFTER REFERRED TO AND IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF THE DEPOSITORY TRUST
COMPANY (“DTC”), A NEW YORK CORPORATION, 55 WATER STREET, NEW YORK, NEW YORK 10041, OR A NOMINEE THEREOF. THIS NOTE
MAY NOT BE EXCHANGED IN WHOLE OR IN PART FOR A SECURITY REGISTERED, AND NO TRANSFER OF THIS NOTE IN WHOLE OR IN PART MAY BE REGISTERED,
IN THE NAME OF ANY PERSON OTHER THAN DTC OR A NOMINEE THEREOF, EXCEPT IN THE LIMITED CIRCUMSTANCES DESCRIBED IN THE INDENTURE. UNLESS
THIS NOTE IS PRESENTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC TO THE ISSUER OR THE NOTE REGISTRAR, AND ANY NOTE ISSUED IS REGISTERED
IN THE NAME OF CEDE & CO. OR IN SUCH OTHER NAME AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC, AND ANY PAYMENT IS MADE TO
CEDE & CO. OR TO SUCH OTHER ENTITY AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC, ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF
FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY PERSON IS WRONGFUL BECAUSE THE REGISTERED OWNER, CEDE & CO., HAS AN INTEREST HEREIN.
[THIS
[RULE 144A][TEMPORARY REGULATION S] [PERMANENT REGULATION S] GLOBAL SERIES 2024-1 CLASS [A-2-I][A-2-II][B-2][M-2] [A2IIB2] [A2IIB2M2]
NOTE WAS ISSUED WITH “ORIGINAL ISSUE DISCOUNT” AS DEFINED IN SECTION 1273 OF THE INTERNAL REVENUE CODE OF 1986, AS AMENDED.
YOU MAY OBTAIN INFORMATION REGARDING THE AMOUNT OF ORIGINAL ISSUE DISCOUNT, THE ISSUE PRICE, THE ISSUE DATE AND THE YIELD TO MATURITY
BY CONTACTING THE MANAGER AT TWIN HOSPITALITY GROUP INC., 5151 BELT LINE ROAD, SUITE 1200, DALLAS, TEXAS 75254, ATTENTION: ROB ROSEN
AND KEN KUICK.]
THE
PRINCIPAL OF THIS NOTE IS PAYABLE AS SET FORTH HEREIN. ACCORDINGLY, THE OUTSTANDING PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF THIS NOTE AT ANY TIME MAY BE
LESS THAN THE AMOUNT SHOWN ON THE FACE HEREOF. ANY PERSON ACQUIRING THIS NOTE MAY ASCERTAIN ITS CURRENT PRINCIPAL AMOUNT BY INQUIRY OF
THE TRUSTEE.
[EXCHANGE
NOTES ONLY] THIS NOTE IS AN EXCHANGE NOTE AND, SUBJECT TO THE TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF THE INDENTURE, MAY BE EXCHANGED FOR ONE OR MORE
EXCHANGEABLE NOTES IN AN EXCHANGEABLE COMBINATION DESCRIBED THEREIN.
[EXCHANGEABLE
NOTES ONLY] THIS NOTE IS AN EXCHANGEABLE NOTE AND, SUBJECT TO THE TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF THE INDENTURE, MAY BE EXCHANGED FOR ONE OR
MORE EXCHANGE NOTES IN AN EXCHANGEABLE COMBINATION DESCRIBED THEREIN.
(i)
The Series 2024-1 Temporary Regulation S Global Notes shall also bear the following legend:
UNTIL
FORTY (40) DAYS AFTER THE ORIGINAL ISSUE DATE OF THE NOTES (THE “RESTRICTED PERIOD”) IN CONNECTION WITH THE OFFERING
OF THE NOTES IN THE UNITED STATES FROM OUTSIDE OF THE UNITED STATES, THE SALE, PLEDGE OR TRANSFER OF THIS NOTE IS SUBJECT TO CERTAIN
CONDITIONS AND RESTRICTIONS. THE HOLDER HEREOF, BY PURCHASING OR OTHERWISE ACQUIRING THIS NOTE, ACKNOWLEDGES THAT SUCH HOLDER IS EITHER
NOT A “U.S. PERSON” OR THE ISSUER OR AN AFFILIATE OF THE ISSUER, AND THAT THIS NOTE HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE 1933
ACT, AND AGREES FOR THE BENEFIT OF THE ISSUER THAT THIS NOTE MAY BE TRANSFERRED, RESOLD, PLEDGED OR OTHERWISE TRANSFERRED ONLY TO A HOLDER
THAT IS NOT A “U.S. PERSON” OR TO THE ISSUER OR AN AFFILIATE OF THE ISSUER AND IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE 1933 ACT AND OTHER
APPLICABLE LAWS OF THE STATES, TERRITORIES AND POSSESSIONS OF THE UNITED STATES GOVERNING THE OFFER AND SALE OF SECURITIES, AND PRIOR
TO THE EXPIRATION OF THE RESTRICTED PERIOD, ONLY (I) IN AN OFFSHORE TRANSACTION IN ACCORDANCE WITH REGULATION S UNDER THE 1933 ACT OR
(II) PURSUANT TO AND IN ACCORDANCE WITH RULE 144A UNDER THE 1933 ACT.
(j)
The required legends set forth above shall not be removed from the applicable Series 2024-1 Notes except as provided herein. The legend
required for a Series 2024-1 Rule 144A Global Note may be removed from such Series 2024-1 Notes Rule 144A Global Note if there is delivered
to the Issuer and the Note Registrar such satisfactory evidence, which may include an Opinion of Counsel, as may be reasonably required
by the Issuer that neither such legend nor the restrictions on transfer set forth therein are required to ensure that transfers of such
Series 2024-1 Notes Rule 144A Global Note will not violate the registration requirements of the 1933 Act. Upon provision of such satisfactory
evidence, the Trustee at the direction of the Issuer (or the Manager, on its behalf), shall authenticate and deliver in exchange for
such Series 2024-1 Rule 144A Global Note a Series 2024-1 Note or Series 2024-1 Notes of the applicable Class having an equal aggregate
principal amount that does not bear such legend. If such a legend required for a Series 2024-1 Rule 144A Global Note has been removed
from a Series 2024-1 Note as provided above, no other Series 2024-1 Note issued in exchange for all or any part of such Series 2024-1
Note shall bear such legend, unless the Issuer has reasonable cause to believe that such other Series 2024-1 Note is a “restricted
security” within the meaning of Rule 144 under the 1933 Act and instructs the Trustee to cause a legend to appear thereon.
Section
4.3 Exchange Procedures.
(a)
General Procedures. Pursuant to the procedures and subject to the fees set forth herein, the Exchange Notes and/or the Exchangeable
Notes may be exchanged in accordance with the Exchangeable Combinations shown on Exhibit D, in whole or in part, at any time on
or after their applicable date of issuance. Exhibit D describes the characteristics of the Exchangeable Notes and the available
Exchangeable Combinations of Exchange Notes and Exchangeable Notes. Exchanges of Exchange Notes and Exchangeable Notes may occur repeatedly
pursuant to the procedures set forth herein.
(b)
Exchange of Notes.
(i)
Upon the presentation and surrender to the Trustee by any Noteholder or Note Owner of its Exchange Notes or Exchangeable Notes, as applicable,
in the appropriate Exchangeable Combination as set forth on Exhibit D, the Exchange Notes and the Exchangeable Notes, as applicable,
shall be exchangeable on the books and records of the Trustee and DTC for the Exchangeable Notes or Exchange Notes, as applicable, in
accordance with the terms and conditions set forth in, and otherwise in accordance with the procedures specified in, this Article
IV, on or after the Series 2024-1 Closing Date.
(ii)
The Exchange Notes and/or Exchangeable Notes may be exchanged only in the applicable Exchangeable Combination and only in the same proportions
as the then-current aggregate Outstanding Amounts of the Classes of Notes being exchanged. For the avoidance of doubt, in connection
with exchanging an Exchange Note for an Exchangeable Note, such Noteholder must present and surrender to the Trustee all Exchange Notes
in a specific Exchangeable Combination in order to receive the applicable Exchangeable Note.
(iii)
For any Exchangeable Notes issued on the Series 2024-1 Closing Date, Exchange Notes with an aggregate principal amount equal to the principal
amount of such Exchangeable Notes issued on the Series 2024-1 Closing Date will be deemed to have been exchanged for such Exchangeable
Notes on the Series 2024-1 Closing Date in the relevant Exchangeable Combination.
(iv)
There shall be no limitation on the number of exchanges authorized pursuant to this Indenture.
(c)
Procedures for Exchange.
(i)
In order to effect an exchange of Exchange Notes and/or Exchangeable Notes (except with respect to the exchange of any Exchangeable Combination
of Exchange Notes for the corresponding Exchangeable Notes on the Series 2024-1 Closing Date), the Noteholder or the Note Owner, as applicable,
shall deliver a notice in the form set forth in Exhibit E attached hereto (an “Exchange Letter”) to the Trustee,
by e-mail at xxxxxxxxxxx, no later than three (3) Business Days before the proposed date on which the Noteholder or the Note Owner, as
applicable, proposes to make the exchange (the “Exchange Date”). The Exchange Date may occur on any Business Day other
than a day that is within five (5) Business Days prior to any Quarterly Payment Date. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary,
other than exchanges that take place on the Series 2024-1 Closing Date in connection with the initial issuance of the Notes, no exchanges
of Exchange Notes and/or Exchangeable Notes may occur until after the fifth (5th) Business Day following the Series 2024-1
Closing Date in accordance with the requirements set forth herein. The Exchange Letter delivered by the Noteholder or the Note Owner,
as applicable, pursuant to this Section 4.3(c)(i) must be signed by two officers authorized to execute on behalf of such Noteholder
or Note Owner, as applicable (which the Trustee shall be entitled to conclusively rely on without investigation).
(ii)
Notwithstanding any other provision herein set forth, unless waived by the Trustee in its sole discretion, a fee shall be payable by
the exchanging Noteholder or Note Owner, as applicable, to the Trustee in connection with each exchange equal to $2,500 (the “Exchange
Fee”). Such fee must be received by the Trustee prior to the Exchange Date or such exchange shall not be effected. In addition,
any Noteholder or Note Owner, as applicable, wishing to effect an exchange must pay any other expenses related to such exchange, including
any fees charged by DTC.
(iii)
After receiving the Exchange Letter, the Trustee will e-mail the Noteholder or the Note Owner, as applicable, with wire payment instructions
relating to the Exchange Fee. The Trustee and the Noteholder or the Note Owner, as applicable, will utilize the “Deposit Withdrawal
System” at DTC to exchange the corresponding Exchange Notes and Exchangeable Notes. The certification shall become irrevocable
on the second (2nd) Business Day prior to the proposed Exchange Date.
(iv)
For the avoidance of doubt, the Trustee (in each of its respective capacities, including, but not limited to, its capacities as Note
Registrar and Paying Agent) shall be entitled to conclusively rely on, and shall be fully protected in relying and acting on, the certifications
and/or notifications set forth herein.
(d)
Payments.
(i)
The Paying Agent will make the first payment on an Exchange Note or Exchangeable Note received in an exchange transaction on the Quarterly
Payment Date following the date of exchange to the Noteholder of record as of the related Record Date.
(ii)
In the event that Exchange Notes have been exchanged for the corresponding Exchangeable Notes in one of the Exchangeable Combinations
listed on Exhibit D hereto (it being understood that for all purposes of this Indenture, Exchangeable Notes issued on the Series
2024-1 Closing Date shall be deemed to have been issued in exchange for the corresponding Exchange Notes), the Exchangeable Notes received
in such an exchange will be entitled to a proportionate share of the interest, principal and other payments otherwise allocable to the
Classes of Exchange Notes so exchanged.
(iii)
Outstanding Amounts of each Class of Exchange Notes represented by Exchangeable Notes, and the rights and obligations of the Noteholders
of such Classes of Exchange Notes (including, without limitation, with respect to any payments to such Classes of Exchange Notes or notices
or consents to be given by such holders), will include the rights and obligations of the holders of the Exchangeable Notes to the extent
of the Outstanding Amounts of any such Classes of Exchange Notes (in all cases, without duplication).
(iv)
The Noteholders of the Exchangeable Notes shall be entitled to participate in any consent of, or any direction or objection by, the Noteholders
of the corresponding Classes of Exchange Notes to the extent of the Outstanding Amount of any such Classes of Exchange Notes represented
by the corresponding Exchangeable Notes.
(v)
All references in this Indenture to payments of, or amounts owing in respect of, principal of or interest on the Notes shall include
the respective portions of principal of or interest on any Class A-2-I Notes, Class A-2-II Notes, Class B-2 Notes and Class M-2 Notes
represented by Exchangeable Notes.
Section
4.4 Note Owner Representations and Warranties. Each Person who becomes a Note Owner of a beneficial interest in a Series 2024-1
Note pursuant to the Offering Memorandum will be deemed to represent, warrant and agree on the date such Person acquires any interest
in any such Series 2024-1 Note as follows:
(a)
With respect to any sale of Series 2024-1 Notes pursuant to Rule 144A, it is a QIB pursuant to Rule 144A, and is aware that any sale
of Series 2024-1 Notes to it will be made in reliance on Rule 144A. Its acquisition of Series 2024-1 Notes in any such sale will be for
its own account or for the account of another QIB.
(b)
With respect to any sale of Series 2024-1 Notes pursuant to Regulation S, at the time the buy order for such Series 2024-1 Notes was
originated, it was outside the United States and the offer was made to a Person who is not a U.S. Person, and was not purchasing for
the account or benefit of a U.S. Person.
(c)
It will, and each account for which it is purchasing will, (i) hold and transfer at least the minimum denomination of Series 2024-1 Notes
set forth in Section 2.3 of this Series 2024-1 Supplement and (ii) the Exchangeable Notes are issued and may only be held in permitted
denominations of the corresponding Classes of Exchange Notes.
(d)
It understands that the Issuer, the Controlling Class Representative and the Manager may receive a list of participants holding positions
in the Series 2024-1 Notes from one or more book-entry depositories.
(e)
It understands that the Manager, the Controlling Class Representative and the Issuer may receive (i) a list of Note Owners that have
requested access to the Trustee’s password-protected website or that have voluntarily registered as a Note Owner with the Trustee
and (ii) copies of Noteholder confirmations of representations and warranties executed to obtain access to the Trustee’s password-protected
website.
(f)
It will provide to each person to whom it transfers Series 2024-1 Notes notices of any restrictions on transfer of such Series 2024-1
Notes.
(g)
It understands that (i) the Series 2024-1 Notes are being offered in a transaction not involving any public offering in the United States
within the meaning of the 1933 Act, (ii) the Series 2024-1 Notes have not been registered under the 1933 Act, (iii) the Series 2024-1
Notes may be offered, resold, pledged or otherwise transferred only to (a) in the United States, Persons who are not Competitors and
who are QIBs, purchasing for their own account or the account of one or more other Persons, each of which is a QIB, (b) outside the United
States, Persons who are not Competitors and who are not “U.S. Persons” in offshore transactions in reliance on Regulation
S under the 1933 Act, purchasing for their own account or the account of one or more other Persons, each of which is a non-U.S. Person,
or (c) the Issuer or an Affiliate of the Issuer, in each case, in accordance with any applicable securities laws of any state of the
United States and any other relevant jurisdiction, and (iv) it will, and each subsequent holder of a Series 2024-1 Note is required to,
notify any subsequent purchaser of a Series 2024-1 Note of the resale restrictions set forth in clause (iii) above.
(h)
It understands that the certificates evidencing the Rule 144A Global Notes will bear legends substantially similar to those set forth
in Section 4.2(h).
(i)
It understands that the certificates evidencing the Temporary Regulation S Global Notes will bear legends substantially similar to those
set forth in Sections 4.2(h) and Section 4.2(i), as applicable.
(j)
It understands that the certificates evidencing the Permanent Regulation S Global Notes will bear legends substantially similar to those
set forth in Section 4.2(h).
(k)
Either (i) it is not, and it is not acquiring or holding the Series 2024-1 Notes (or any interest therein) for or on behalf of, or with
the assets of, a Plan or a governmental, church or non-U.S. plan that is subject to any Similar Law, or (ii) for the Series 2024-1 Class
A-2-I Notes and the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes only, its acquisition, holding and disposition of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I
Notes (or any interest therein) or the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes (or any interest therein), as applicable, will not constitute
or result in a non-exempt prohibited transaction under Section 406 of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code or a violation of any Similar
Law, as applicable.
(l)
It understands that any subsequent transfer of the Series 2024-1 Notes or any interest therein is subject to certain restrictions and
conditions set forth in the Indenture and it agrees to be bound by, and not to resell, pledge or otherwise transfer the Series 2024-1
Notes or any interest therein except in compliance with, such restrictions and conditions and the 1933 Act.
(m)
It is not a Competitor.
(n)
It will strictly comply with this Series 2024-1 Supplement and the Base Indenture as to treatment of Noteholders of Exchangeable Notes
as directly owning the separate Classes of Exchange Notes corresponding to such Exchangeable Notes, in each case for purposes of U.S.
federal, state and local income or franchise taxes and any other tax imposed on or measured by income, as provided in this Series 2024-1
Supplement and the Base Indenture.
Section
4.5 Limitation on Liability. None of the Issuer, the Manager, the Trustee or any Paying Agent or any of their respective Affiliates
shall have any responsibility or liability with respect to (i) any aspects of the records maintained by DTC or its nominee or any of
the Agent Members relating to or for payments made thereby on account of beneficial interests in a Rule l44A Global Note or a Regulation
S Global Note or (ii) any records maintained by the Noteholder with respect to the beneficial holders thereof or payments made thereby
on account of beneficial interests held therein. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein or in the Base Indenture,
the Trustee (including in its capacity as Note Registrar and Paying Agent) shall have no responsibility or liability with respect to
(i) transfers of beneficial interests within a Rule 144A Global Note or a Regulation S Global Note or (ii) monitoring or inquiring into
or verifying compliance by a Noteholder or Note Owner with the representations, covenants or restrictions set forth in this Series 2024-1
Supplement, the Base Indenture or the Notes.
ARTICLE
V
GENERAL
Section
5.1 Information. On or before the third (3rd) Business Day prior to each Quarterly Payment Date, the Issuer shall furnish,
or cause to be furnished, a Quarterly Noteholders’ Report with respect to the Series 2024-1 Notes to the Trustee and the Back-Up
Manager, substantially in the form of Exhibit C hereto, setting forth, inter alia, the following information with respect
to such Quarterly Payment Date and all other information required pursuant to Section 5.11 of the Base Indenture:
(i)
the total amount available to be distributed to Series 2024-1 Noteholders on such Quarterly Payment Date;
(ii)
the amount of such distribution allocable to the payment of interest on each Class of the Series 2024-1 Notes;
(iii)
the amount of such distribution allocable to the payment of principal of each Class of the Series 2024-1 Notes;
(iv)
[Reserved];
(v)
whether, to the Actual Knowledge of the Issuer, any Potential Rapid Amortization Event, Rapid Amortization Event, Default, Event of Default,
Potential Manager Termination Event or Manager Termination Event has occurred and is continuing as of the related Quarterly Calculation
Date or any Cash Flow Sweeping Period is in effect, as of such Quarterly Calculation Date;
(vi)
the P&I DSCR for such Quarterly Payment Date and the three Quarterly Payment Dates immediately preceding such Quarterly Payment Date;
(vii)
the amount of Twin Hospitality TP Systemwide Sales as of the related Quarterly Calculation Date; and
(viii)
the amount on deposit in the Reserve Account as of the close of business on the last Business Day of the preceding Quarterly Collection
Period.
Any
Series 2024-1 Noteholder may obtain copies of each Quarterly Noteholders’ Report in accordance with the procedures set forth in
Section 4.4 of the Base Indenture.
Section
5.2 Exhibits. The annexes, exhibits and schedules attached hereto and listed on the table of contents hereto supplement the annexes,
exhibits and schedules included in the Base Indenture.
Section
5.3 Ratification of Base Indenture. As supplemented by this Series 2024-1 Supplement, the Base Indenture is in all respects ratified
and confirmed and the Base Indenture as so supplemented by this Series 2024-1 Supplement shall be read, taken and construed as one and
the same instrument.
Section
5.4 [Reserved].
Section
5.5 Counterparts. This Series 2024-1 Supplement may be executed in any number of counterparts, each of which so executed shall
be deemed to be an original, but all of such counterparts shall together constitute but one and the same instrument.
Section
5.6 Governing Law. THIS SERIES 2024-1 SUPPLEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED AND INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS
OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK WITHOUT REGARD TO CONFLICTS OF LAW PRINCIPLES (OTHER THAN SECTIONS 5-1401 AND 5-1402 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATIONS
LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK).
Section
5.7 Amendments. This Series 2024-1 Supplement may not be modified or amended except in accordance with the terms of the Base Indenture.
Section
5.8 Termination of Series Supplement; Defeasance.
(a)
This Series 2024-1 Supplement shall cease to be of further effect when (i) all Outstanding Series 2024-1 Notes theretofore authenticated
and issued have been delivered (other than destroyed, lost, or stolen Series 2024-1 Notes that have been replaced or paid) to the Trustee
for cancellation and (ii) the Issuer has paid all sums payable hereunder; provided that any provisions of this Series 2024-1 Supplement
required for the Series 2024-1 Final Payment to be made shall survive until the Series 2024-1 Final Payment is paid to the Series 2024-1
Noteholders. In accordance with Section 6.1(a) of the Base Indenture, the final principal payment due on each Series 2024-1 Note
shall only be paid upon due presentment and surrender of such Note for cancellation in accordance with the provisions of such Note at
the applicable Corporate Trust Office, which such surrender shall also constitute a general release by the applicable Noteholder from
any claims against the Issuer, the Manager, the Trustee and their affiliates.
(b)
In addition to (and notwithstanding) the terms of Section 12.1 of the Base Indenture, upon the payment in full (whether optional
or mandatory) or a redemption in full of a particular Class of Series 2024-1 Notes (the “Defeased Class”) as provided
hereunder, the Obligations of the Issuer and the Guarantors under the Transaction Documents in respect of such Defeased Class shall be
terminated.
Section
5.9 Limited Recourse. The obligations of the Issuer under this Series 2024-1 Supplement are solely the limited liability company
obligations of the Issuer, and the Issuer shall be liable for claims hereunder only to the extent that funds or assets are available
to pay such claims pursuant to this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
Section
5.10 Entire Agreement. This Series 2024-1 Supplement, together with the exhibits and schedules hereto and the other Indenture
Documents, contains a final and complete integration of all prior expressions by the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter
hereof and shall constitute the entire agreement among the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter hereof, superseding all
previous oral statements and other writings with respect thereto.
Section
5.11 Control Party Protections. In taking or refraining from taking any action hereunder, the Control Party shall be entitled
to the rights, protections, benefits, immunities and indemnities afforded to the Control Party under this Series 2024-1 Supplement and
the other Transaction Documents mutatis mutandis.
[Signature
Pages Follow]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, each of the Issuer and the Trustee have caused this Series 2024-1 Supplement to be duly executed by its respective duly
authorized officer as of the day and year first written above.
|
TWIN
HOSPITALITY I, LLC
(f/k/a FAT BRANDS
TWIN PEAKS I, LLC),
as Issuer
|
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Robert G. Rosen |
|
Name: |
Robert
G. Rosen |
|
Title: |
Chief
Executive Officer |
Signature
Page to Series 2024-1 Supplement to the Base Indenture
TWIN
HOSPITALITY I, LLC
|
UMB
BANK, N.A., in its capacity as Trustee |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Michele Voon |
|
Name:
|
Michele
Voon |
|
Title:
|
Senior
Vice President |
Signature
Page to Series 2024-1 Supplement to the Base Indenture
TWIN
HOSPITALITY I, LLC
CONSENT
OF CONTROL PARTY:
The
undersigned, as Control Party, hereby consents to the execution and delivery of this Series 2024-1 Supplement by the parties hereto,
and as Control Party hereby directs the Trustee to execute and deliver this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
CITADEL
SPV LLC, in its capacity as Control Party
By: |
/s/
Orlando Figueroa |
|
Name:
|
Orlando
Figueroa |
|
Title:
|
President |
|
Signature
Page to Series 2024-1 Supplement to the Base Indenture
TWIN
HOSPITALITY I, LLC
ANNEX
A
SERIES
2024-1
SUPPLEMENTAL
DEFINITIONS LIST
“30/360
Day Basis” means the accrual of interest calculated on the basis of a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months.
“Agent
Members” means members of, or participants in, DTC.
“Change
in Law” means (a) any law, rule or regulation or any change therein or in the interpretation or application thereof (whether
or not having the force of law), in each case, adopted, issued or occurring after the Series 2024-1 Closing Date or (b) any request,
guideline or directive (whether or not having the force of law) from any government or political subdivision or agency, authority, bureau,
central bank, commission, department or instrumentality thereof, or any court, tribunal, grand jury or arbitrator, or any accounting
board or authority (whether or not a Governmental Authority) which is responsible for the establishment or interpretation of national
or international accounting principles, in each case, whether foreign or domestic (each, an “Official Body”) charged
with the administration, interpretation or application thereof, or the compliance with any request or directive of any Official Body
(whether or not having the force of law) made, issued or occurring after the Series 2024-1 Closing Date.
“Change
of Control” has the meaning ascribed to such term in the Management Agreement.
“Clearstream”
means Clearstream Luxembourg.
“Defeased
Class” has the meaning set forth in Section 5.8(b) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Definitive
Notes” has the meaning set forth in Section 4.1(c) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“DTC”
means The Depository Trust Company, and any successor thereto, as the initial Clearing Agency.
“Euroclear”
means Euroclear Bank, S.A./N.A., or any successor thereto, as operator of Euroclear System.
“Exchange
Date” has the meaning set forth in Section 4.3(c)(i) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Exchange
Fee” has the meaning set forth in Section 4.3(c)(ii) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Exchange
Letter” has the meaning set forth in Section 4.3(c)(i) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Exchange
Notes” means, collectively, each of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes, the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes, the Series 2024-1
Class B-2 Notes and the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes.
“Exchangeable
Combination” means each permissible exchange combination described in Exhibit D hereto.
“Exchangeable
Notes” means the Series 2024-1 Class A2IIB2 Notes and the Series 2024-1 Class A2IIB2M2 Notes.
“Initial
Purchaser” means Jefferies LLC.
“Initial
Quarterly Payment Date” means January 27, 2025.
“Level
I QEO Quarterly Payment Date” means the Quarterly Payment Date occurring in April 2025, July 2025 and October 2025.
“Level
II QEO Quarterly Payment Date” means the Quarterly Payment Date occurring in January 2026 and each Quarterly Payment Date thereafter.
“Level
I Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event” means, as of any Level I QEO Quarterly Payment Date, the failure to use $25,000,000
in aggregate Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds to prepay the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes on or prior to such Level I QEO
Quarterly Payment Date.
“Level
II Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event” means, as of any Level II QEO Quarterly Payment Date, the failure to use $75,000,000
in aggregate Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds to prepay the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes on or prior to such Level II
QEO Quarterly Payment Date.
“Monthly
Allocation Date” means each of the dates set forth in the schedule of Monthly Manager’s Certificates delivery dates and
Monthly Allocation Dates in the Series Supplement.
“Offering
Memorandum” means the Offering Memorandum for the offering of the Series 2024-1 Notes, dated November 15, 2024, prepared by
the Issuer.
“Official
Body” has the meaning set forth in the definition of “Change in Law.”
“Outstanding
Principal Amount” means, with respect to (i) any Class of Exchange Notes, at any time, the aggregate principal amount Outstanding
of such Class of Exchange Notes at such time and (ii) any Class of Exchangeable Notes, at any time, the sum of the aggregate principal
amount Outstanding of each constituent Class of Exchange Notes (whether or not represented by such Exchangeable Notes). Any reduction
in the Outstanding Principal Amount of a Class of Exchange Notes will reduce the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Class of the Exchangeable
Notes in each corresponding Exchangeable Combination dollar-for-dollar regardless of whether any exchange has occurred so that the aggregate
Outstanding Principal Amount of the Classes of Exchange Notes will at all times reflect the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Class
of Exchangeable Notes in each corresponding Exchangeable Combination.
“Permanent
Regulation S Global Notes” has the meaning set forth in Section 4.1(b) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Prepayment
Condition Amounts” means (i) the Super Senior Prepayment Condition Amounts, the Senior Prepayment Condition Amounts and the
Senior Subordinated Prepayment Condition Amounts and (ii) as of any Quarterly Payment Date, the aggregate amount due and payable to all
of the Noteholders as of such Quarterly Payment Date.
“Prepayment
Notice” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.5(g) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Prepayment
Record Date” means, with respect to the date of any Series 2024-1 Prepayment, the last day of the calendar month immediately
preceding the date of such Series 2024-1 Prepayment unless such last day is less than ten (10) Business Days prior to the date of such
Series 2024-1 Prepayment, in which case the “Prepayment Record Date” will be the date that is ten (10) Business Days prior
to the date of such Series 2024-1 Prepayment.
“Qualified
Equity Offering Trigger Event” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.4(e)(ii) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Qualified
Institutional Buyer” or “QIB” means a Person who is a “qualified institutional buyer” as defined
in Rule 144A.
“Regulation
S” means Regulation S promulgated under the 1933 Act.
“Regulation
S Global Notes” means, collectively, the Temporary Regulation S Global Notes and the Permanent Regulation S Global Notes.
“Required
Reserve Amount” means, as of each Quarterly Calculation Date, the quotient of: (A) the sum of (i)(a) the Series 2024-1 Class
A-2-I Outstanding Principal Amount (after giving effect to all principal payments made on the related Quarterly Payment Date), times
(b) the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Note Rate (after giving effect to all principal payments made on the related Quarterly Payment
Date), plus (ii)(a) the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Outstanding Principal Amount (after giving effect to all principal payments
made on the related Quarterly Payment Date), times (b) the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Note Rate, plus (iii)(a) the Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Outstanding Principal Amount (after giving effect to all principal payments made on the related Quarterly Payment Date),
times (b) the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Note Rate, divided by (B) 4.
“Restricted
Period” means, with respect to any Series 2024-1 Notes sold pursuant to Regulation S, the period commencing on the Series 2024-1
Closing Date and ending on the 40th day after the Series 2024-1 Closing Date.
“Rule
144A” means Rule 144A promulgated under the 1933 Act.
“Rule
144A Global Notes” has the meaning set forth in Section 4.1(b) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Senior
Prepayment Condition Amounts” means, as of any Quarterly Payment Date, the aggregate amount due and payable to all of the Super
Senior Noteholders and Senior Noteholders as of such Quarterly Payment Date.
“Senior
Subordinated Prepayment Condition Amounts” means, as of any Quarterly Payment Date, the aggregate amount due and payable to
all of the Super Senior Noteholders, Senior Noteholders and Senior Subordinated Noteholders as of such Quarterly Payment Date.
“Series
2024-1 Anticipated Repayment Date” means the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Anticipated Repayment Date, the Series 2024-1 Class
A-2-II Anticipated Repayment Date, Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Anticipated Repayment Date and Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Anticipated Repayment
Date. For purposes of the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Anticipated Repayment Date” shall be deemed to be a “Series
Anticipated Repayment Date”.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Anticipated Repayment Date” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.5(a)(ii) of this Series 2024-1
Supplement. For purposes of the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Anticipated Repayment Date” shall be deemed
to be a “Series Anticipated Repayment Date”.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Initial Principal Amount” means, the aggregate initial outstanding principal amount of the Class A-2-I Notes
as of the 2024-1 Closing Date, which is $12,124,000.00.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Legal Final Maturity Date” means the Quarterly Payment Date occurring on October 26, 2054. For purposes
of the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Legal Final Maturity Date” shall be deemed to be a “Series Legal
Final Maturity Date.”
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Note Rate” means, (i) prior to the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Anticipated Repayment Date, 9.00% per annum,
compounded quarterly and (ii) on and after the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Anticipated Repayment Date, 14.00% per annum, compounded quarterly.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Noteholder” means the Person in whose name a Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Note is registered in the Note Register.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes” has the meaning specified in the “Designation” of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amount” means, (i) on each Quarterly Payment Date prior to the Quarterly
Payment Date occurring in April 2025, an amount equal to zero percent (0.00%) of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Initial Principal Amount
and (ii) on each Quarterly Payment Date on and following the Quarterly Payment Date occurring in April 2025, an amount equal to two point
seventy-five percent (2.75%) of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Initial Principal Amount. For purposes of the Base Indenture, the “Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts” shall be deemed to be “Scheduled Principal Payments.”
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount” means, with respect to any Quarterly Payment Date,
if on any Quarterly Calculation Date, (a) the sum of (i) the amount of funds on deposit in the Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account
with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes and (ii) any other funds on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts that are available
to pay the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes Scheduled Principal Payments with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes on such Quarterly
Payment Date is less than (b) the sum of (i) the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amount due and payable,
if any, on such Quarterly Payment Date plus any Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts due but unpaid
from any previous Quarterly Payment Dates and (ii) the amount of funds on deposit in the Super Senior Notes Principal Payment Account
with respect to such amounts set forth in clause (b)(i) and allocated to the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes, the amount of such
deficiency.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Outstanding Principal Amount” means, on any date, an amount equal to (a) the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Initial
Principal Amount, minus (b) the aggregate amount of principal payments (whether pursuant to the payment of Series 2024-1 Class
A-2-I Notes Scheduled Principal Payments Amounts, a prepayment, a purchase and cancellation, a redemption or otherwise) made to Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Noteholders on or prior to such date. For purposes of the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Outstanding
Principal Amount” shall be deemed to be an “Outstanding Principal Amount.”
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Prepayment” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.5(f)(i) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Quarterly Interest Amount” means, for each Interest Accrual Period, an amount equal to the accrued interest
at the applicable Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Note Rate on the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Outstanding Principal Amount (as of the first
day of such Interest Accrual Period after giving effect to all payments of principal (if any) made to such Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I
Noteholders as of such day and also giving effect to prepayments, repurchases and cancellations of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes during
such Interest Accrual Period). For purposes of the Base Indenture, “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Quarterly Interest Amount”
shall be deemed to be a “Super Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount.”
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.4(d)(i)
of this Series 2024-1 Supplement. For purposes of the Base Indenture, Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest shall be deemed to be “Super Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest.”
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Rate” has the meaning set forth in Section
3.4(d)(i) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.4(e)(i)
of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-I Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Rate” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.4(e)(i)
of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Anticipated Repayment Date” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.5(b)(ii) of this Series 2024-1
Supplement. For purposes of the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Anticipated Repayment Date” shall be deemed
to be a “Series Anticipated Repayment Date”.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Initial Principal Amount” means, the aggregate initial outstanding principal amount of the Class A-2-II
Notes as of the 2024-1 Closing Date, which is $269,257,000.00.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Legal Final Maturity Date” means the Quarterly Payment Date occurring on October 26, 2054. For purposes
of the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Legal Final Maturity Date” shall be deemed to be a “Series Legal
Final Maturity Date.”
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Note Rate” means, (i) prior to the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Anticipated Repayment Date, 9.00% per annum,
compounded quarterly and (ii) on and after the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Anticipated Repayment Date, 14.00% per annum, compounded quarterly.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Noteholder” means the Person in whose name a Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Note is registered in the Note
Register.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes” has the meaning specified in the “Designation” of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amount” means, (i) on each Quarterly Payment Date prior to the Quarterly
Payment Date occurring in April 2025, an amount equal to zero percent (0.00%) of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Initial Principal Amount
and (ii) on each Quarterly Payment Date on and following the Quarterly Payment Date occurring in April 2025, an amount equal to two point
seventy-five percent (2.75%) of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Initial Principal Amount. For purposes of the Base Indenture, the “Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts” shall be deemed to be “Scheduled Principal Payments.”
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount” means, with respect to any Quarterly Payment Date,
if on any Quarterly Calculation Date, (a) the sum of (i) the amount of funds on deposit in the Senior Notes Principal Payment Account
with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes and (ii) any other funds on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts that are available
to pay the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes Scheduled Principal Payments with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes on such
Quarterly Payment Date is less than (b) the sum of (i) the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amount due and
payable, if any, on such Quarterly Payment Date plus any Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts
due but unpaid from any previous Quarterly Payment Dates and (ii) the amount of funds on deposit in the Senior Notes Principal Payment
Account with respect to such amounts set forth in clause (b)(i) and allocated to the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes, the amount
of such deficiency.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Outstanding Principal Amount” means, on any date, an amount equal to (a) the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II
Initial Principal Amount, minus (b) the aggregate amount of principal payments (whether pursuant to the payment of Series 2024-1
Class A-2-II Notes Scheduled Principal Payments Amounts, a prepayment, a purchase and cancellation, a redemption or otherwise) made to
Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Noteholders on or prior to such date. For purposes of the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II
Outstanding Principal Amount” shall be deemed to be an “Outstanding Principal Amount.”
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Prepayment” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.5(f)(ii) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Quarterly Interest Amount” means, for each Interest Accrual Period, an amount equal to the accrued interest
at the applicable Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Note Rate on the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Outstanding Principal Amount (as of the first
day of such Interest Accrual Period after giving effect to all payments of principal (if any) made to such Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II
Noteholders as of such day and also giving effect to prepayments, repurchases and cancellations of Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes during
such Interest Accrual Period). For purposes of the Base Indenture, “Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Quarterly Interest Amount”
shall be deemed to be a “Senior Notes Quarterly Interest Amount.”
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” has the meaning set forth in Section
3.4(d)(i) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement. For purposes of the Base Indenture, Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Quarterly Post-Anticipated
Repayment Date Additional Interest shall be deemed to be “Senior Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest.”
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Rate” has the meaning set forth in Section
3.4(d)(i) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.4(e)(i)
of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class A-2-II Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Rate” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.4(e)(i)
of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Anticipated Repayment Date” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.5(c)(ii) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
For purposes of the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Anticipated Repayment Date” shall be deemed to be a “Series
Anticipated Repayment Date”.
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Initial Principal Amount” means, the aggregate initial outstanding principal amount of the Class B-2 Notes
as of the 2024-1 Closing Date, which is $57,619,000.00.
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Legal Final Maturity Date” means the Quarterly Payment Date occurring on October 26, 2054. For purposes of
the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Legal Final Maturity Date” shall be deemed to be a “Series Legal Final
Maturity Date.”
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Note Rate” means, (i) prior to the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Anticipated Repayment Date, 10.00% per annum, compounded
quarterly and (ii) on and after the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Anticipated Repayment Date, 15.00% per annum, compounded quarterly.
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Noteholder” means the Person in whose name a Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Note is registered in the Note Register.
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Notes” has the meaning specified in the “Designation” of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amount” means, (i) on each Quarterly Payment Date prior to the Quarterly
Payment Date occurring in April 2025, an amount equal to zero percent (0.00%) of the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Initial Principal Amount
and (ii) on each Quarterly Payment Date on and following the Quarterly Payment Date occurring in April 2025, an amount equal to two percent
(2.00%) of the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Initial Principal Amount. For purposes of the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Class B-2
Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts” shall be deemed to be “Scheduled Principal Payments.”
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount” means, with respect to any Quarterly Payment Date, if
on any Quarterly Calculation Date, (a) the sum of (i) the amount of funds on deposit in the Senior Subordinated Notes Principal Payment
Account with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes and (ii) any other funds on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts that are
available to pay the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payments with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes on
such Quarterly Payment Date is less than (b) the sum of (i) the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amount due
and payable, if any, on such Quarterly Payment Date plus any Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts
due but unpaid from any previous Quarterly Payment Dates and (ii) the amount of funds on deposit in the Senior Subordinated Notes Principal
Payment Account with respect to such amounts set forth in clause (b)(i) and allocated to the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes, the
amount of such deficiency.
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Outstanding Principal Amount” means, on any date, an amount equal to (a) the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Initial
Principal Amount, minus (b) the aggregate amount of principal payments (whether pursuant to the payment of Series 2024-1 Class
B-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payments Amounts, a prepayment, a purchase and cancellation, a redemption or otherwise) made to Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Noteholders on or prior to such date. For purposes of the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Outstanding
Principal Amount” shall be deemed to be an “Outstanding Principal Amount.”
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Prepayment” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.5(f)(iii) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Interest Amount” means, for each Interest Accrual Period, an amount equal to the accrued interest
at the applicable Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Note Rate on the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Outstanding Principal Amount (as of the first day
of such Interest Accrual Period after giving effect to all payments of principal (if any) made to such Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Noteholders
as of such day and also giving effect to prepayments, repurchases and cancellations of Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes during such Interest
Accrual Period). For purposes of the Base Indenture, “Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Interest Amount” shall be deemed
to be a “Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount.”
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.4(d)(i)
of this Series 2024-1 Supplement. For purposes of the Base Indenture, Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest shall be deemed to be “Senior Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional
Interest.”
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Rate” has the meaning set forth in Section
3.4(d)(i) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.4(e)(i) of
this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest Rate” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.4(e)(i)
of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Anticipated Repayment Date” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.5(d)(ii) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
For purposes of the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Anticipated Repayment Date” shall be deemed to be a “Series
Anticipated Repayment Date”.
“Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Initial Principal Amount” means, the aggregate initial outstanding principal amount of the Class M-2 Notes
as of the 2024-1 Closing Date, which is $77,711,000.00.
“Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Legal Final Maturity Date” means the Quarterly Payment Date occurring on October 26, 2054. For purposes of
the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Legal Final Maturity Date” shall be deemed to be a “Series Legal Final
Maturity Date.”
“Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Note Rate” means, (i) prior to the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Anticipated Repayment Date, 11.00% per annum, compounded
quarterly and (ii) on and after the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Anticipated Repayment Date, 16.00% per annum, compounded quarterly.
“Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Noteholder” means the Person in whose name a Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Note is registered in the Note Register.
“Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Notes” has the meaning specified in the “Designation” of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amount” means, (i) on each Quarterly Payment Date prior to the Quarterly
Payment Date occurring in April 2025, an amount equal to zero percent (0.00%) of the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Initial Principal Amount
and (ii) on each Quarterly Payment Date on and following the Quarterly Payment Date occurring in April 2025, an amount equal to zero
percent (0.00%) of the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Initial Principal Amount. For purposes of the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1
Class M-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts” shall be deemed to be “Scheduled Principal Payments.”
“Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Deficiency Amount” means, with respect to any Quarterly Payment Date, if
on any Quarterly Calculation Date, (a) the sum of (i) the amount of funds on deposit in the Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account
with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes and (ii) any other funds on deposit in the Indenture Trust Accounts that are available
to pay the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payments with respect to the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes on such Quarterly
Payment Date is less than (b) the sum of (i) the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amount due and payable, if
any, on such Quarterly Payment Date plus any Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payment Amounts due but unpaid
from any previous Quarterly Payment Dates and (ii) the amount of funds on deposit in the Subordinated Notes Principal Payment Account
with respect to such amounts set forth in clause (b)(i) and allocated to the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes, the amount of such
deficiency.
“Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Outstanding Principal Amount” means, on any date, an amount equal to (a) the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Initial
Principal Amount, minus (b) the aggregate amount of principal payments (whether pursuant to the payment of Series 2024-1 Class
M-2 Notes Scheduled Principal Payments Amounts, a prepayment, a purchase and cancellation, a redemption or otherwise) made to the Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Noteholders on or prior to such date. For purposes of the Base Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Outstanding
Principal Amount” shall be deemed to be an “Outstanding Principal Amount.”
“Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Prepayment” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.5(f)(iv) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Quarterly Interest Amount” means, for each Interest Accrual Period, an amount equal to the accrued interest
at the applicable Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Note Rate on the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Outstanding Principal Amount (as of the first day
of such Interest Accrual Period after giving effect to all payments of principal (if any) made to such Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Noteholders
as of such day and also giving effect to prepayments, repurchases and cancellations of Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes during such Interest
Accrual Period). For purposes of the Base Indenture, “Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Quarterly Interest Amount” shall be deemed
to be a “Subordinated Notes Quarterly Interest Amount.”
“Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.4(d)(i)
of this Series 2024-1 Supplement. For purposes of the Base Indenture, Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment
Date Additional Interest shall be deemed to be “Subordinated Notes Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest.”
“Series
2024-1 Class M-2 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest Rate” has the meaning set forth in Section
3.4(d)(i) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Closing Date” means November 21, 2024.
“Series
2024-1 Final Payment” means as to any Class of Notes, the payment of all accrued and unpaid interest on and principal of all
Outstanding Series 2024-1 Notes of such Class.
“Series
2024-1 Final Payment Date” means as to any Class of Notes, the date on which the Series 2024-1 Final Payment with respect to
such Class is made.
“Series
2024-1 Global Notes” means, collectively, the Regulation S Global Notes and the Rule 144A Global Notes.
“Series
2024-1 Ineligible Account” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.10 of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Legal Final Maturity Date” means the Quarterly Payment Date occurring on October 26, 2054. For purposes of the Base
Indenture, the “Series 2024-1 Legal Final Maturity Date” shall be deemed to be a “Series Legal Final Maturity Date.”
“Series
2024-1 Noteholders” means, collectively, the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Noteholders, the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Noteholders,
the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Noteholders and the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Noteholders.
“Series
2024-1 Note Owner” means, with respect to a Series 2024-1 Note that is a Book-Entry Note, the Person who is the beneficial
owner of such Book-Entry Note, as reflected on the books of the Clearing Agency that holds such Book-Entry Note, or on the books of a
Person maintaining an account with such Clearing Agency (directly or as an indirect participant, in accordance with the rules of such
Clearing Agency).
“Series
2024-1 Notes” means, collectively, the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes, the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes, the Series 2024-1
Class B-2 Notes and the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes.
“Series
2024-1 Outstanding Principal Amount” means, with respect to any date, the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Outstanding Principal Amount,
the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Outstanding Principal Amount, the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Outstanding Principal Amount or the Series 2024-1
Class M-2 Outstanding Principal Amount, as applicable.
“Series
2024-1 Prepayment” means a Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Prepayment, a Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Prepayment, a Series 2024-1 Class
B-2 Prepayment or a Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Prepayment, as applicable.
“Series
2024-1 Prepayment Amount” means the aggregate principal amount of the applicable Class of Notes to be prepaid on any Series
2024-1 Prepayment Date, together with all accrued and unpaid interest thereon to such date.
“Series
2024-1 Prepayment Date” means the date on which any prepayment on the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes, the Series 2024-1 Class
A-2-II Notes, the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes or the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes is made pursuant to Section 3.5(f) of this
Series 2024-1 Supplement, which shall be, with respect to any Series 2024-1 Prepayment Amount pursuant to Section 3.5(f), the
Quarterly Payment Date specified as such in the applicable Prepayment Notice.
“Series
2024-1 Quarterly Post-Anticipated Repayment Date Additional Interest” means interest accruing on the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I
Notes, the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes, the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes and/or the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes from and after
the Anticipated Repayment Date if the Series 2024-1 Final Payment of the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes, the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II
Notes, the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes and/or the Series 2024-1 Class M-2 Notes, respectively, has not been made.
“Series
2024-1 Quarterly Qualified Equity Offering Additional Interest” means interest on the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes, the
Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes and the Series 2024-1 Class B-2 Notes (i) if, as of any Level I QEO Quarterly Payment Date, $25,000,000
of aggregate Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds are not used to prepay the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes on or prior to such
Level I QEO Quarterly Payment Date, accruing until such Level I Qualified Equity Offering Trigger Event is cured, including for the immediately
preceding Quarterly Collection Period most recently ended or (ii) if, as of any Level II QEO Quarterly Payment Date, $75,000,000, inclusive
of any amounts prepaid in accordance with the foregoing clause (i), of aggregate Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds are not used to prepay
the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes on or prior to such Level I QEO Quarterly Payment Date, accruing until such Level II Qualified
Equity Offering Trigger Event is cured, including for the immediately preceding Quarterly Collection Period most recently ended.
“Series
2024-1 Securities Intermediary” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.8(a) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“Series
2024-1 Senior Notes” means the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-II Notes.
“Series
2024-1 Super Senior Notes” means the Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes.
“Series
2024-1 Supplement” means this Series 2024-1 Supplement, dated as of the Series 2024-1 Closing Date by and among the Issuer
and Trustee, as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.
“Super
Senior Prepayment Condition Amounts” means, as of any Quarterly Payment Date, the aggregate amount due and payable to all of
the Super Senior Noteholders as of such Quarterly Payment Date.
“Temporary
Regulation S Global Notes” has the meaning set forth in Section 4.1(b) of this Series 2024-1 Supplement.
“U.S.
Government Securities Business Day” means any day except for a Saturday, a Sunday or a day on which the Securities Industry
and Financial Markets Association recommends that the fixed income departments of its members be closed for the entire day for purposes
of trading in U.S. government securities.
“U.S.
Person” has the meaning set forth in Regulation S under the Securities Act.
ANNEX
B
Fiscal
QE Date |
|
Prior
Three Monthly Collection Period End Dates |
|
Record
Date |
|
Quarterly
Calculation Date |
|
Quarterly
Noteholders’ Report Date |
|
Quarterly
Payment Date |
Last
Sunday of Each 13 |
|
All
included in each respective quarterly collection period |
|
20th
Calendar Day of Month in which Quarterly Payment |
|
4
Business Days Prior to Quarterly |
|
3
Business Days Prior to Quarterly |
|
25th
Calendar Day of the following Months (April, July October January)
(if
not Business Day, following |
Week
Quarter |
|
Month
1 |
|
Month
2 |
|
Month
3 |
|
Date
Falls |
|
Payment
Date |
|
Payment
Date |
|
Business
Day) |
Sunday,
December 29, 2024 |
|
Sunday,
October 27, 2024 |
|
Sunday,
November 24, 2024 |
|
Sunday,
December 29, 2024 |
|
Monday,
January 20, 2025 |
|
Tuesday,
January 21, 2025 |
|
Wednesday,
January 22, 2025 |
|
Monday,
January 27, 2025 |
Sunday,
March 30, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
January 26, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
February 23, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
March 30, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
April 20, 2025 |
|
Monday,
April 21, 2025 |
|
Tuesday,
April 22, 2025 |
|
Friday,
April 25, 2025 |
Sunday,
June 29, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
April 27, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
May 25, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
June 29, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
July 20, 2025 |
|
Monday,
July 21, 2025 |
|
Tuesday,
July 22, 2025 |
|
Friday,
July 25, 2025 |
Sunday,
September 28, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
July 27, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
August 24, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
September 28, 2025 |
|
Monday,
October 20, 2025 |
|
Tuesday,
October 21, 2025 |
|
Wednesday,
October 22, 2025 |
|
Monday,
October 27, 2025 |
Sunday,
December 28, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
October 26, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
November 23, 2025 |
|
Sunday,
December 28, 2025 |
|
Tuesday,
January 20, 2026 |
|
Tuesday,
January 20, 2026 |
|
Wednesday,
January 21, 2026 |
|
Monday,
January 26, 2026 |
Sunday,
March 29, 2026 |
|
Sunday,
January 25, 2026 |
|
Sunday,
February 22, 2026 |
|
Sunday,
March 29, 2026 |
|
Monday,
April 20, 2026 |
|
Tuesday,
April 21, 2026 |
|
Wednesday,
April 22, 2026 |
|
Monday,
April 27, 2026 |
Sunday,
June 28, 2026 |
|
Sunday,
April 26, 2026 |
|
Sunday,
May 24, 2026 |
|
Sunday,
June 28, 2026 |
|
Monday,
July 20, 2026 |
|
Tuesday,
July 21, 2026 |
|
Wednesday,
July 22, 2026 |
|
Monday,
July 27, 2026 |
Monthly
Manager Certificate Date |
|
Monthly
Allocation Date |
5
Business Days Prior to Monthly Allocation Date |
|
2nd
Friday Following Fiscal Month End (if not Business Day, following Business Day) |
Friday,
November 29, 2024 |
|
Friday,
December 6, 2024 |
Friday,
January 3, 2025 |
|
Friday,
January 10, 2025 |
Friday,
January 31, 2025 |
|
Friday,
February 7, 2025 |
Friday,
February 28, 2025 |
|
Friday,
March 7, 2025 |
Friday,
April 4, 2025 |
|
Friday,
April 11, 2025 |
Friday,
May 2, 2025 |
|
Friday,
May 9, 2025 |
Friday,
May 30, 2025 |
|
Friday,
June 6, 2025 |
Thursday,
July 3, 2025 |
|
Friday,
July 11, 2025 |
Friday,
August 1, 2025 |
|
Friday,
August 8, 2025 |
Friday,
August 29, 2025 |
|
Friday,
September 5, 2025 |
Friday,
October 3, 2025 |
|
Friday,
October 10, 2025 |
Friday,
October 31, 2025 |
|
Friday,
November 7, 2025 |
Friday,
November 28, 2025 |
|
Friday,
December 5, 2025 |
Friday,
January 2, 2026 |
|
Friday,
January 9, 2026 |
Friday,
January 30, 2026 |
|
Friday,
February 6, 2026 |
Friday,
February 27, 2026 |
|
Friday,
March 6, 2026 |
Friday,
April 3, 2026 |
|
Friday,
April 10, 2026 |
Friday,
May 1, 2026 |
|
Friday,
May 8, 2026 |
Friday,
May 29, 2026 |
|
Friday,
June 5, 2026 |
Thursday
July 2, 2026 |
|
Friday
July 10, 2026 |
Exhibits
to Series 2024-1 Supplement
Exhibit
A-1
Form
of Rule 144A Global Note
(Attached.)
Exhibits
to Series 2024-1 Supplement
Exhibit
A-2
Form
of Temporary Regulation S Global Note
(Attached.)
Exhibits
to Series 2024-1 Supplement
Exhibit
A-3
Form
of Permanent Regulation S Global Note
(Attached.)
Exhibits
to Series 2024-1 Supplement
Exhibit
B-1
Form
of Transfer Certificate
(Rule
144A Global Note to Temporary Regulation S Global Note)
(Attached.)
Exhibits
to Series 2024-1 Supplement
Exhibit
B-2
Form
of Transfer Certificate
(Rule
144A Global Note to Permanent Regulation S Global Note)
(Attached.)
Exhibits
to Series 2024-1 Supplement
Exhibit
B-3
Form
of Transfer Certificate
(Regulation
S Global Note to Rule 144A Global Note)
(Attached.)
Exhibits
to Series 2024-1 Supplement
Exhibit
C
Form
of Quarterly Noteholders’ Report
(Attached.)
Exhibits
to Series 2024-1 Supplement
Exhibit
D
Exchangeable
Combinations
(Attached.)
Exhibits
to Series 2024-1 Supplement
Exhibit
E
Form
of Exchange Letter
(Attached.)
Exhibit
4.3
OMNIBUS
AMENDMENT
November
21, 2024
This
OMNIBUS AMENDMENT, dated as of the date specified above (this “Amendment”), is by and among FB Resid Holdings I, LLC,
a Delaware limited liability company, (the “Issuer”), FAT Brands Royalty I, LLC, FAT Brands GFG Royalty I, LLC, FAT
Brands Twin Peaks I, LLC, FAT Brands Fazoli’s Native I, LLC, and FAT Brands Inc. (each as an “Obligor”), each
Noteholder party hereto, and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee (the “Trustee”), to (i) the Base Indenture, dated as of July
10, 2023 (as supplemented by that certain Series 2023-1 Supplement, dated as of July 10, 2023, and that certain Series 20234-1 Supplement,
dated as of the date hereof, each between the Issuer and the Trustee, and as further amended, restated, modified or otherwise supplemented
from time to time, the “Indenture”), by and among the Issuer and the Trustee and (ii) the Irrevocable Payment Direction
Letter, dated July 10, 2023 as amended, restated, modified or otherwise supplemented from time to time, the “Direction Letter”),
from FAT Brands Royalty I, LLC, FAT Brands GFG Royalty I, LLC, FAT Brands Twin Peaks I, LLC and FAT Brands Fazoli’s Native I, LLC,
as issuers, and FAT Brands Inc., as manager, to UMB Bank, N.A. and acknowledged by UMB Bank, N.A. and the Issuer. Whenever used in this
Amendment and unless the context requires a different meaning, capitalized terms used herein and not otherwise expressly defined herein
shall have the meanings assigned to such terms in the Indenture.
R
E C I T A L S
WHEREAS,
the parties hereto desire to amend the Indenture in certain respects pursuant to and in accordance with Section 13.2 of the Indenture
and to amend the Direction Letter in accordance with its terms;
NOW,
THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt, adequacy and sufficiency
of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto agree as follows:
1.
Amendments to Indenture.
i.
Section 4.1(b) of the Indenture is hereby amended by replacing such Section in its entirety with the following:
“(b)
Concurrently with the delivery thereof under each Existing Securitization, the Manager shall deliver a copy of each Monthly Manager’s
Certificate (as defined in each Existing Securitization) to the Trustee and the Controlling Class Representative.”
ii.
Section 5.5(a) of the Indenture is hereby amended by inserting the following new clause (vi) in appropriate order at the end of such
Section 5.5(a):
“(vi)
the Excess Amounts Account for the deposit of Excess Amounts.”
iii.
Section 5.7(c) of the Indenture is hereby amended by inserting the following new language at the end thereof:
iv.
“From and after the Refinancing Date, each of the Existing Issuers and the Existing Managers further agree and direct the Trustee
pursuant to this Agreement and the Direction Letter to make payment of all Excess Amounts to the Excess Amounts Account if (i) the Trustee
has received prior written notice of the occurrence and continuation of an Event of Default or (ii) to the extent that the Controlling
Class Representative (acting reasonably and in good faith, based on information provided by the Manager) has provided prior written notice
to the Trustee that certain Excess Amounts are required to satisfy clauses (i) through (vi) of the Priority of Payments on the next applicable
Monthly Allocation Date. For the avoidance of doubt, amounts deposited into the Excess Amounts Account pursuant to the Direction Letter
prior to any Monthly Allocation Date will be included in Retained Collections and deposited in the Collection Account for application
in accordance with Section 5.10 on such Monthly Allocation Date.”
v.
Section 5.9(c)(ii) of the Indenture is hereby amended by replacing such provision with [Reserved].
vi.
Section 5.11 of the Indenture is hereby amended by inserting the following new Section 5.11(c) at the end thereof:
“(c)
Notwithstanding the foregoing to the contrary, with respect to (i) any Mandatory Prepayment Amount and/or (ii) from and after the occurrence
of any Event of Default, (i) payments of interest and principal with respect to the Class A-1 Notes and the Class A-2 Notes shall be
made in accordance with the Applicable Class A Payment Priority and (ii) no amounts (whether of principal, interest or otherwise) shall
be payable on or with respect to the Class A-1B Notes or the Class A-2B Notes unless and until amounts then due and owing to the Class
A-1A Notes and the Class A-2A Notes have been paid in full in cash.”
vii.
Section 8.31 of the Indenture is hereby amended by replacing such Section 8.31 in its entirety with the following:
“Section
8.31 Specified Additional Issuances, etc.
Without
the prior written consent of the Controlling Class Representative, in its sole discretion, the Manager and Issuer shall not permit (i)
any Equity Interests of any Existing Issuer to be sold, transferred or disposed, other than the transactions contemplated by the Twin
Peaks Listing Event or (ii) any Specified Additional Issuance.”
viii.
Section 9.2 of the Indenture is hereby amended by inserting the following new clause (n) in appropriate order, immediately after clause
(m):
“(n)
the Issuer or an Affiliate of the Issuer shall fail, on or prior to July 31, 2026, to have prepaid or purchased Class A-1A Notes and
Class A-2A Notes held by the Controlling Class Representative and its Approved Funds in an aggregate principal amount equal to or greater
than $20,000,000;”
ix.
Annex A to the Indenture is hereby amended by deleting the definition of “Mandatory Contribution Amounts”.
x.
Annex A to the Indenture is hereby amended by replacing the definitions of “Existing Issuer”, “Existing Securitization”,
“Collateral”, “Collateral Transaction Documents”, “Mandatory Amounts” “Specified Additional
Issuance”, “TP Indenture” and “TP Issuer” with the following:
“Existing
Issuer” means each of the following entities as a securitization issuer: (i) FAT Brands Royalty I, LLC, (ii) FAT Brands GFG
Royalty I, LLC, (iii) until the occurrence of the Twin Peaks Listing Event, Twin Hospitality I, LLC and (iv) FAT Brands Fazoli’s
Native I, LLC.
“Existing
Securitization” means the securitization transactions involved each of the following entities as a securitization issuer: (i)
FAT Brands Royalty I, LLC, (ii) FAT Brands GFG Royalty I, LLC, (iii) until the occurrence of the Twin Peaks Listing Event, Twin Hospitality
I, LLC and (iv) FAT Brands Fazoli’s Native I, LLC.
“Collateral”
has the meaning set forth in Section 3.1 of the Base Indenture and, solely with respect to any Notes held by the Controlling Class Representative
and its Approved Funds, “Collateral” shall include the “Pledged Shares” and the “Securities Collateral”
(each as defined in the Pledge Agreement).
“Collateral
Transaction Documents” means the Contribution Agreement, the Account Control Agreements, the Management Agreement, the Back-Up
Management Agreement and the Pledge Agreement.
“Mandatory
Amounts” means the Mandatory Prepayment Amount.
“Specified
Additional Issuance” means any (i) additional issuance of any series of notes under any Existing Securitization following the
First Amendment Date and (ii) any refinancing of any series of notes under any Existing Securitization following the First Amendment
Date.
“TP
Indenture” means the Base Indenture, dated as of the First Amendment Date, by and between Twin Hospitality I, LLC and UMB Bank,
N.A., as trustee and securities intermediary.
“TP
Issuer” means Twin Hospitality I, LLC.
xi.
Annex A to the Indenture is hereby further amended by inserting the following new definitions in appropriate alphabetical order:
“Acceptable
Exchange” means any of the following markets or exchanges on which the Pledged Shares are listed or quoted for trading on the
date in question: (i) the Nasdaq Capital Market, the Nasdaq Global Market, the Nasdaq Global Select Market, the New York Stock exchange,
or the NYSE American or (ii) if acceptable to the Controlling Class Representative, any other “national securities exchange”
designated as such from time to time by the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.
“Applicable
Class A Payment Priority” means (i) Class A-1A Notes will be (A) senior in right of payment of interest to other Class A-1
Notes (including, without limitation, Class A-1B Notes) and (B) senior in right of payment of principal to other Class A-1 Notes (including,
without limitation, the Class A-1B Notes) and (ii) Class A-2A Notes will be (A) senior in right of payment of interest to other Class
A-2 Notes (including, without limitation, Class A-2B Notes) and (B) senior in right of payment of principal to other Class A-1 Notes
(including, without limitation, the Class A-2B Notes).
“Approved
Fund” means any Person (other than a natural person) that is engaged or advises funds or other investment vehicles that are
engaged in making, purchasing, holding or investing in commercial loans, bonds and similar extensions of credit or securities in the
ordinary course of business and that is administered, advised or managed by (a) the Controlling Class Representative, (b) an Affiliate
of the Controlling Class Representative or (c) an entity or an Affiliate of an entity that administers, advises or manages the Controlling
Class Representative.
“Class
A-1A Notes” means all Class A-1 Notes held by Noteholders other than the Issuer or its Affiliates.
“Class
A-1B Notes” means all Class A-1 Notes held by the Issuer or its Affiliates or their respective successors and assigns.
“Class
A-2A Notes” means all Class A-2 Notes held by Noteholders other than the Issuer or its Affiliates.
“Class
A-2B Notes” means all Class A-2 Notes held by the Issuer or its Affiliates or their respective successors and assigns.
“Existing
Managers” means each of the following entities in their capacity as managers under the Existing Securitizations: (i) FAT Brands
Inc. and (ii) until the occurrence of the Twin Peaks Listing Event, Twin Hospitality Group Inc.
“Excess
Amounts” means all “Excess Amounts” as set forth in each Existing Securitization.
“Excess
Amounts Account” means the segregated, non-interest bearing trust account entitled “UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee f/b/o
the Secured Parties, FB Resid Holdings I, LLC Excess Amounts Account”, maintained by the Trustee pursuant to Section 5.5
of the Base Indenture or any successor securities account maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 of the Base Indenture.
“First
Amendment Date” means November 21, 2024.
“Pledge
Agreement” means that certain Pledge Agreement, to be dated on or about the Refinancing Date, among FAT Brands Inc., as Pledgor
and UMB Bank, N.A., solely in its capacity as Trustee and Securities Intermediary.
“Pledged
Shares” means the shares of Class A Common Stock, par value $0.0001 per share, of Twin Hospitality Group Inc. (or its successor)
that are owned by FAT Brands and not distributed to its shareholders at the time of the Twin Peaks Listing Event.
“Refinancing
Date” means the date on which the Twin Peaks Refinancing is consummated.
“Twin
Peaks Listing Event” mean the date on which (i) the dividend or distribution of approximately 5% of the Class A Common Stock
of Twin Hospitality Group Inc. to the shareholders of FAT Brands, (ii) commencing of trading of the Class A Common Stock of Twin Hospitality
Group Inc. on an Acceptable Exchange, (iii) all filings related with respect to the foregoing required pursuant to the rules and regulations
of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission are effective, (iv) the deposit of the Pledged Shares into the account specified in the
Pledge Agreement and (v) the Pledge Agreement is in full force and effect.
“Twin
Peaks Refinancing” means the payment in full in cash of all outstanding Notes (including all principal of and interest thereon)
issued under that certain Base Indenture, dated as of October 1, 2021, by and between FAT Brands Twin Peaks I, LLC and UMB Bank, N.A.,
as trustee and securities intermediary.
2.
Amendments to Direction Letter.
i.
The first paragraph of the Direction Letter is hereby amended and restated in its entirety to read as follows:
“Reference
is hereby made to the Base Indentures set forth on Exhibit A hereto. Capitalized terms used herein but not otherwise defined herein
shall have the respective meanings ascribed thereto in the applicable Base Indenture. For purposes of this instruction letter, (a) “Managers”
shall mean (i) FAT Brands Inc. (“FAT Brands”) and, (ii) until the occurrence of the Twin Peaks Listing Event, Twin Hospitality
Group Inc. (“Twin Hospitality”), and (b) “Issuers” shall mean (i) FAT Brands Royalty I, LLC, (ii) FAT Brands
GFG Royalty I, LLC, (iii) until the occurrence of the Twin Peaks Listing Event, Twin Hospitality I, LLC (the “TP Issuer”),
and (iv) FAT Brands Fazoli’s Native I, LLC. Pursuant to Section 5.10 of each Base Indenture, UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee under each
Base Indenture (the “Trustee”), shall make payment of the applicable Residual Amount at the direction of the applicable
Issuer. Each Issuer hereby directs the Trustee to make payments in respect of the applicable Residual Amount from and after July 10,
2023 payable to FAT Brands and shall remit all such funds on behalf of FAT Brands, by immediately sending such amounts by wire or ACH
transfer, to the following bank account (the “FBRH 2023-1 Collection Account”):
Bank
Name: UMB Bank NA
Bank
Address: 1010 Grand Blvd, Kansas City, MO 64106
Bank
ABA#: xxxxxxxx
SWIFT
Code: xxxxxxxx
Account
Name: xxxxxxxx
Account
Number: xxxxxxxx
Reference:
xxxxxxxx
From
and after the Refinancing Date, the Issuers and the Managers further agree and direct the Trustee to make payment of all Excess Amounts
to the following bank account (the “FBRH 2023-1 Excess Amounts Account”) if (i) the Trustee has received prior written
notice of the occurrence and continuation of an Event of Default or (ii) to the extent that the Controlling Class Representative (acting
reasonably and in good faith, based on information provided FAT Brands in its capacity as Manager for the Resid Indenture (defined below))
has provided prior written notice to the Trustee that certain Excess Amounts are required to satisfy clauses (i) through (xiii) of the
Priority of Payments on the next applicable Monthly Allocation Date:
Bank
Name: UMB Bank NA
Bank
Address: 1010 Grand Blvd, Kansas City, MO 64106
Bank
ABA#: xxxxxxxx
SWIFT
Code: xxxxxxxx
Account
Name: xxxxxxxx
Account
Number: xxxxxxxx
Reference:
xxxxxxxx
Except
as otherwise provided herein with respect to the payment of Residual Amounts, each Issuer agrees that it shall not declare or pay any
distributions on any of its limited liability company interests.
ii.
Effective as of the Refinancing Date, Section 3 of Exhibit A of the Direction Letter is replaced in its entirety with the following:
“Base Indenture, dated as of November 21, 2024 (the “TP Base Indenture”), by and between Twin Hospitality I,
LLC (the “TP Issuer”) and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee and securities intermediary.”
iii.
Effective as of the Refinancing Date, references to FAT Brands Inc. as the Manager for the TP Indenture shall be replaced with Twin Hospitality
Group Inc. and Twin Hospitality Group Inc. shall become a party to the Direction Letter.
3.
Covenants of FAT Brands Inc.
i.
FAT Brands Inc. (“FAT”) agrees that it shall not sell or otherwise dispose of, and shall not permit its Subsidiaries
to sell or dispose of, any of FAT’s Equity Interests of Twin Hospitality Group Inc. (or any successor) (“Twin Hospitality”)
until Twin Hospitality has used $75,000,000 of aggregate Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds or other proceeds to prepay the Outstanding
Principal Amount of TP Issuer’s Series 2024-1 Notes.
ii.
FAT shall not, and shall not permit its Subsidiaries to, declare or pay any dividend or distribution in the form of Equity Interests
in Twin Hospitality (or any security convertible into such Equity Interests) (A) on any date prior to the third anniversary of the First
Amendment Date or (B) if any Potential Rapid Amortization Event, Rapid Amortization Event, Default or Event of Default has occurred and
is continuing with respect to any Notes outstanding under any Base Indenture (as set forth on Schedule A to the Direction Letter) or
would result therefrom under any Base Indenture (as set forth on Schedule A to the Direction Letter); provided, that this sentence shall
not prevent the distribution described in clause (i) of the definition of Twin Peaks Listing Event.
4.
Effectiveness. The amendments described in Sections 1 and 2 of this Amendment and the undertakings described in Section
3 will become effective when all of the following conditions have been satisfied:
|
a) |
counterparts
of this Amendment have been duly executed and delivered by the parties; |
|
|
|
|
b) |
the
Issuer and Noteholders shall have directed the Trustee to execute this Amendment; |
|
|
|
|
c) |
All
Noteholders under the Indenture have been made aware of and agree on the terms of the release of the portion of the Collateral (as
such term is defined under the FBRH Indenture) relating to the “Residual Amounts”, “Excess Amounts” and “Monthly
Management Fees” payable to FAT under the securitization transaction involving FAT Brands Twin Peaks I, LLC on or about the date
hereof. |
|
|
|
|
d) |
the
Issuer has delivered an Officer’s Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel to the Trustee, in each case stating that the execution
of this Amendment is authorized or permitted by the Indenture and that all conditions precedent provided for in the Indenture relating
to the Amendment have been complied with. |
5.
Reference to and Effect Upon the Transaction Documents. Except as specifically amended hereby, all terms, conditions, covenants,
representations and warranties contained in the Transaction Documents, and all rights of the parties thereto and all of the obligations
under the Transaction Documents, shall remain in full force and effect. All references to the Indenture in any other document or instrument
means the Indenture as amended by this Amendment. This is an amendment, not a novation, of the Indenture.
6.
GOVERNING LAW. THIS AMENDMENT WILL BE CONSTRUED AND INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH AND GOVERNED BY THE LAWS OF THE STATE
OF NEW YORK, INCLUDING SECTION 5-1401 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATIONS LAW, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS AND THE OBLIGATIONS,
RIGHTS, AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.
7.
Counterparts. This Amendment may be executed in one or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed an original but
all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument. Signatures of the parties hereto transmitted by facsimile or by electronic
media or similar means shall be deemed to be their original signature for all purposes.
8.
Severability. The invalidity, illegality, or unenforceability of any provision in or obligation under this Amendment in
any jurisdiction shall not affect or impair the validity, legality, or enforceability of the remaining provisions or obligations under
this Amendment or of such provision or obligation in any other jurisdiction. If feasible, any such offending provision shall be deemed
modified to be within the limits of enforceability or validity; provided that if the offending provision cannot be so modified,
it shall be stricken and all other provisions of this Amendment in all other respects shall remain valid and enforceable.
9.
Further Assurances. The parties hereto shall do and perform, or cause to be done and performed, all such further acts and
things, and shall execute and deliver all such other agreements, certificates, instruments and documents, as any other party may reasonably
request in order to carry out the intent and accomplish the purposes of this Amendment and the consummation of the transactions contemplated
hereby.
10.
Headings. The headings of this Amendment are for convenience of reference and shall not form part of, or affect the interpretation
of, this Amendment.
11.
Limitation of Liability of Trustee. This Amendment is executed by Wilmington Trust, National Association, not in its individual
capacity, but solely in its capacity as Trustee, and as such Wilmington Trust, National Association shall incur no personal liability
in connection herewith.
[Remainder
of Page Intentionally Left Blank; Signature Pages Follows]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Amendment to be duly executed and effective as of the date first written above.
|
FB
RESID HOLDINGS I, LLC, as Issuer |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Robert G. Rosen |
|
Name: |
Robert
G. Rosen |
|
Title: |
President
and Chief Executive Officer |
|
|
|
|
FAT
BRANDS ROYALTY I, LLC, as an Obligor |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Robert G. Rosen |
|
Name: |
Robert
G. Rosen |
|
Title: |
President
and Chief Executive Officer |
|
|
|
|
FAT
BRANDS GFG ROYALTY I, LLC, as an Obligor |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Kenneth J. Kuick |
|
Name: |
Kenneth
J. Kuick |
|
Title: |
Treasurer
and Chief Financial Officer |
|
|
|
|
FAT
BRANDS TWIN PEAKS I, LLC, as an Obligor |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Kenneth J. Kuick |
|
Name: |
Kenneth
J. Kuick |
|
Title: |
Treasurer
and Chief Financial Officer |
Signature
Page to Omnibus Amendment
|
FAT
BRANDS FAZOLI’S NATIVE I, LLC, as an Obligor |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Robert G. Rosen |
|
Name: |
Robert
G. Rosen |
|
Title: |
President
and Chief Executive Officer |
|
|
|
|
FAT
BRANDS Inc., as an Obligor |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Robert G. Rosen |
|
Name: |
Robert
G. Rosen |
|
Title: |
Co-Chief
Executive Officer |
Signature
Page to Omnibus Amendment
|
3|5|2
CAPITAL ABS MASTER FUND LP, as Noteholder |
|
|
|
|
By: |
3|5|2
Capital GP LLC, its general partner |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Matt Smith |
|
Name: |
Matt
Smith |
|
Title: |
Chief
Operating Officer |
|
|
|
|
TW
EQUITY INVESTORS, L.P., as Noteholder |
|
|
|
|
By: |
Jasper
Ridge Genpar Holdings, LLC, its general partner |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Raymond Durham |
|
Name: |
Raymond
Durham |
|
Title: |
Vice
President |
Signature
Page to Omnibus Amendment
|
FAT
BRANDS INC., as Noteholder |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Robert G. Rosen |
|
Name: |
Robert
G. Rosen |
|
Title: |
Co-Chief
Executive Officer |
Signature
Page to Omnibus Amendment
UMB
BANK, N.A., as Trustee and not in its individual capacity |
|
|
|
By:
|
/s/
Michele Voon |
|
Name: |
Michele
Voon |
|
Title: |
Senior
Vice President |
|
Signature
Page to Omnibus Amendment
Acknowledged
and agreed with respect to Section 3: |
|
|
|
|
FAT
BRANDS INC. |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Robert G. Rosen |
|
Name: |
Robert
G. Rosen |
|
Title: |
Co-Chief
Executive Officer |
|
Signature
Page to Omnibus Amendment
Exhibit
10.1
GUARANTEE
AND COLLATERAL AGREEMENT
made
by
THE
GUARANTORS PARTY HERETO,
each
as a Guarantor
in
favor of
UMB
BANK, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
as Trustee
Dated
as of November 21, 2024
TABLE
OF CONTENTS
|
Page |
SECTION
1 DEFINED TERMS; RULES OF CONSTRUCTION |
1 |
1.1 |
Definitions; Rules of Construction. |
1 |
SECTION
2 GUARANTEE |
2 |
2.1 |
Guarantee. |
2 |
2.2 |
No Subrogation |
3 |
2.3 |
Amendments, etc. with respect to the Issuer Obligations |
3 |
2.4 |
Guarantee Absolute and Unconditional |
4 |
2.5 |
Reinstatement |
4 |
2.6 |
Payments |
4 |
2.7 |
Information |
5 |
SECTION
3 SECURITY |
5 |
3.1 |
Grant of Security Interest. |
5 |
3.2 |
Certain Rights and Obligations of the Guarantors Unaffected. |
7 |
3.3 |
Performance of Collateral Documents |
8 |
3.4 |
Stamp, Other Similar Taxes and Filing Fees |
8 |
3.5 |
Authorization to File Financing Statements; Other Filing and
Recording Documents. |
9 |
SECTION
4 REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES |
9 |
4.1 |
Existence and Power |
9 |
4.2 |
Company and Governmental Authorization |
10 |
4.3 |
No Consent |
10 |
4.4 |
Binding Effect |
10 |
4.5 |
Subsidiaries |
10 |
4.6 |
Security Interests. |
10 |
4.7 |
Other Representations |
11 |
SECTION
5 COVENANTS |
12 |
5.1 |
[Reserved]. |
12 |
5.2 |
Defaults or Events of Default; Covenants in Base Indenture
and Other Transaction Documents |
12 |
5.3 |
Further Assurances. |
12 |
5.4 |
Legal Name, Location Under Section 9-301 or 9-307 |
13 |
5.5 |
Management Accounts |
13 |
SECTION
6 REMEDIAL PROVISIONS |
13 |
6.1 |
Rights of the Control Party and Trustee upon Event of Default. |
13 |
6.2 |
Waiver of Appraisal, Valuation, Stay and Right to Marshaling |
16 |
6.3 |
Limited Recourse |
16 |
6.4 |
Optional Preservation of the Collateral |
17 |
6.5 |
Control by the Control Party |
17 |
6.6 |
The Trustee May File Proofs of Claim |
17 |
6.7 |
Undertaking for Costs |
18 |
6.8 |
Restoration of Rights and Remedies |
18 |
6.9 |
Rights and Remedies Cumulative |
18 |
6.10 |
Delay or Omission Not Waiver |
18 |
6.11 |
Waiver of Stay or Extension Laws |
19 |
SECTION
7 THE TRUSTEE’S AUTHORITY |
19 |
SECTION
8 MISCELLANEOUS |
19 |
8.1 |
Amendments |
19 |
8.2 |
Notices. |
19 |
8.3 |
Governing Law |
20 |
8.4 |
Successors |
20 |
8.5 |
Severability |
21 |
8.6 |
Counterpart Originals |
21 |
8.7 |
Table of Contents, Headings, etc |
21 |
8.8 |
Recording of Agreement |
21 |
8.9 |
Waiver of Jury Trial |
21 |
8.10 |
Submission to Jurisdiction; Waivers |
21 |
8.11 |
Additional Guarantor |
22 |
8.12 |
Currency Indemnity |
22 |
8.13 |
Acknowledgment of Receipt; Waiver |
23 |
8.14 |
Termination; Partial Release. |
23 |
8.15 |
Third Party Beneficiary |
23 |
8.16 |
Entire Agreement |
23 |
SCHEDULES
Schedule
4.5 – Guarantor Ownership Relationships
EXHIBITS
Exhibit
A – Form of Assumption Agreement
GUARANTEE
AND COLLATERAL AGREEMENT
GUARANTEE
AND COLLATERAL AGREEMENT (as the same may be amended, amended and restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, this
“Agreement”), dated as of November 21, 2024, is made by the undersigned guarantors (collectively, the “Guarantors”)
in favor of UMB Bank, National Association, a national banking association, as trustee under the Indenture referred to below (in such
capacity, together with its successors, the “Trustee”) for the benefit of the Secured Parties.
W
I T N E S S E T H:
WHEREAS,
Twin Hospitality I, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “Issuer”) and the Trustee have entered into that
certain Base Indenture, dated November 21, 2024 (as the same may be amended, amended and restated, supplemented or otherwise modified
from time to time, exclusive of any Series Supplements, the “Base Indenture” and, together with all Series Supplements,
the “Indenture”), providing for the issuance from time to time of one or more Series of Notes thereunder; and
WHEREAS,
in connection with the Indenture, the parties hereto have agreed to enter into this Agreement.
NOW,
THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and for other good and valuable consideration the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby
acknowledged, each Guarantor hereby agrees with the Trustee, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, as follows:
SECTION
1
DEFINED TERMS; RULES OF CONSTRUCTION
1.1
Definitions; Rules of Construction.
(a)
Unless otherwise defined herein, terms defined in the Base Indenture Definitions List attached to the Base Indenture as Annex A thereto
and used herein shall have the meanings given to them in such Base Indenture Definitions List.
(b)
Any terms used in this Agreement (including, without limitation, for purposes of Section 3) that are defined in the UCC and pertain to
Collateral shall be construed and defined as set forth in the UCC, unless otherwise defined herein.
(c)
The following terms shall have the following meanings for purposes of this Agreement:
“Collateral”
has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 3.1(a).
“Issuer
Obligations” means all Obligations owed by the Issuer to the Secured Parties under the Indenture and the other Transaction
Documents.
“Other
Currency” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 8.12.
“Termination
Date” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 2.1(d).
(d)
The rules of construction set forth in Section 1.4 of the Base Indenture shall apply for all purposes under this Agreement.
SECTION
2
GUARANTEE
2.1
Guarantee.
(a)
Each of the Guarantors hereby, jointly and severally, unconditionally and irrevocably, guarantees to the Trustee, for the benefit of
the Secured Parties, the prompt and complete payment and performance by the Issuer when due (whether at the stated maturity, by acceleration
or otherwise, but after giving effect to all applicable grace or cure periods) of the Issuer Obligations. In furtherance of the foregoing
and not in limitation of any other right that the Trustee or any other Secured Party has at law or in equity against any Guarantor by
virtue hereof, upon the failure of the Issuer to pay any Issuer Obligation when and as the same shall become due, but after giving effect
to all applicable grace or cure periods, whether at maturity, by acceleration, after notice of prepayment or otherwise, each Guarantor
hereby jointly and severally promises to and shall forthwith pay, or cause to be paid, to the Trustee for distribution to the applicable
Secured Parties in accordance with the Indenture, in cash, the amount of such unpaid Issuer Obligations. This is a guarantee of payment
and not merely of collection.
(b)
Anything herein or in any other Transaction Document to the contrary notwithstanding, the maximum liability of each Guarantor hereunder
and under the other Transaction Documents shall in no event exceed the amount which can be guaranteed by such Guarantor under applicable
federal and state laws relating to the insolvency of debtors.
(c)
Each Guarantor agrees that the Issuer Obligations may at any time and from time to time exceed the amount of the liability of such Guarantor
hereunder without impairing the guarantee contained in this Section 2 or affecting the rights and remedies of the Trustee or any
other Secured Party hereunder.
(d)
The guarantee contained in this Section 2 shall remain in full force and effect until the date (the “Termination Date”)
on which this Agreement ceases to be of further effect in accordance with Article XII of the Base Indenture, notwithstanding that
from time to time prior thereto the Issuer may be free from any Issuer Obligations.
(e)
No payment made by the Issuer, any of the Guarantors, any other guarantor or any other Person or received or collected by the Trustee
or any other Secured Party from the Issuer, any of the Guarantors, any other guarantor or any other Person by virtue of any action or
proceeding or any set-off or appropriation or application at any time or from time to time in reduction of or in payment of the Issuer
Obligations shall be deemed to modify, reduce, release or otherwise affect the liability of any Guarantor which shall, notwithstanding
any such payment (other than any payment made by such Guarantor in respect of the Issuer Obligations or any payment received or collected
from such Guarantor in respect of the Issuer Obligations), remain liable hereunder for the Issuer Obligations up to the maximum liability
of such Guarantor hereunder until the Termination Date.
2.2
No Subrogation. Notwithstanding any payment made by any Guarantor hereunder or any set-off or application of funds of any Guarantor
by the Trustee or any other Secured Party, no Guarantor shall be entitled to be subrogated to any of the rights of the Trustee or any
other Secured Party against the Issuer or any other Guarantor or any collateral security or guarantee or right of offset held by the
Trustee or any other Secured Party for the payment of the Issuer Obligations, nor shall any Guarantor seek or be entitled to seek any
contribution or reimbursement from the Issuer or any other Guarantor in respect of payments made by such Guarantor hereunder, until the
Termination Date. If any amount shall be paid to any Guarantor on account of such subrogation, contribution or reimbursement rights at
any time when all of the Issuer Obligations shall not have been paid in full, such amount shall be held by such Guarantor in trust for
the Trustee and the other Secured Parties, segregated from other funds of such Guarantor, and shall, forthwith upon receipt by such Guarantor,
be turned over to the Trustee in the exact form received by such Guarantor (duly endorsed by such Guarantor to the Trustee, if required),
to be applied against the Issuer Obligations, whether matured or unmatured, in such order as the Trustee may determine in accordance
with the Indenture.
2.3
Amendments, etc. with respect to the Issuer Obligations. Each Guarantor shall remain obligated hereunder notwithstanding that,
without any reservation of rights against any Guarantor and without notice to or further assent by any Guarantor, any demand for payment
of any of the Issuer Obligations made by the Trustee or any other Secured Party may be rescinded by the Trustee or such other Secured
Party and any of the Issuer Obligations continued, and the Issuer Obligations, or the liability of any other Person upon or for any part
thereof, or any collateral security or guarantee therefor or right of offset with respect thereto, may, from time to time, in whole or
in part, be renewed, extended, amended, modified, accelerated, compromised, waived, surrendered or released by the Trustee or any other
Secured Party, and the Base Indenture and any other documents executed and delivered in connection therewith may be amended, modified,
supplemented or terminated, in whole or in part, from time to time, and any collateral security, guarantee or right of offset at any
time held by the Trustee or any other Secured Party for the payment of the Issuer Obligations may be sold, exchanged, waived, surrendered
or released (it being understood that this Section 2.3 is not intended to affect any rights or obligations set forth in any other
Transaction Document).
2.4
Guarantee Absolute and Unconditional. Each Guarantor waives any and all notice of the creation, renewal, extension or accrual
of any of the Issuer Obligations and notice of or proof of reliance by the Trustee or any other Secured Party upon the guarantee contained
in this Section 2 or acceptance of the guarantee contained in this Section 2; the Issuer Obligations, and any of them,
shall conclusively be deemed to have been created, contracted or incurred, or renewed, extended, amended or waived, in reliance upon
the guarantee contained in this Section 2 and the grant of the security interests pursuant to Section 3; and all dealings
between the Issuer and any of the Guarantors, on the one hand, and the Trustee and the other Secured Parties, on the other hand, likewise
shall be conclusively presumed to have occurred or been consummated in reliance upon the guarantee contained in this Section 2
and the grant of the security interests pursuant to Section 3. Each Guarantor waives diligence, presentment, protest, demand for
payment and notice of default or nonpayment to or upon the Issuer or any of the Guarantors with respect to the Issuer Obligations. Each
Guarantor understands and agrees that the guarantee contained in this Section 2 and the grant of the security interests pursuant
to Section 3 shall be construed as a continuing, absolute and unconditional guarantee of payment without regard to (a) the validity
or enforceability of the Indenture or any other Transaction Document, any of the Issuer Obligations or any other collateral security
therefor or guarantee or right of offset with respect thereto at any time or from time to time held by the Trustee or any other Secured
Party, (b) any defense, set-off or counterclaim (other than a defense of full payment or performance) which may at any time be available
to or be asserted by the Issuer or any other Person against the Trustee or any other Secured Party, or (c) any other circumstance whatsoever
(with or without notice to or knowledge of the Issuer or such Guarantor) which constitutes, or might be construed to constitute, an equitable
or legal discharge of the Issuer for the Issuer Obligations, or of such Guarantor under the guarantee contained in this Section 2
and the grant of the security interests pursuant to Section 3, in bankruptcy or in any other instance. When making any demand
hereunder or otherwise pursuing its rights and remedies hereunder against any Guarantor, the Trustee or any other Secured Party may,
but shall be under no obligation to, make a similar demand on or otherwise pursue such rights and remedies as it may have against the
Issuer, any other Guarantor or any other Person or against any collateral security or guarantee for the Issuer Obligations or any right
of offset with respect thereto, and any failure by the Trustee or any other Secured Party to make any such demand, to pursue such other
rights or remedies or to collect any payments from the Issuer, any other Guarantor or any other Person or to realize upon any such collateral
security or guarantee or to exercise any such right of offset, or any release of the Issuer, any other Guarantor or any other Person
or any such collateral security, guarantee or right of offset, shall not relieve any Guarantor of any obligation or liability hereunder,
and shall not impair or affect the rights and remedies, whether express, implied or available as a matter of law, of the Trustee or any
other Secured Party against any Guarantor. Neither the Trustee nor any other Secured Party shall have any obligation to protect, secure,
perfect or insure any Lien at any time held by it as security for the Issuer Obligations or for the guarantee contained in this Section
2 or any property subject thereto. For the purposes hereof “demand” shall include the commencement and continuance of
any legal proceedings.
2.5
Reinstatement. The guarantee contained in this Section 2 shall continue to be effective, or be reinstated, as the case
may be, if at any time payment, or any part thereof, of any of the Issuer Obligations is rescinded or must otherwise be restored or returned
by the Trustee or any other Secured Party upon the insolvency, bankruptcy, dissolution, liquidation or reorganization of the Issuer or
any Guarantor, or upon or as a result of the appointment of a receiver, intervenor or conservator of, or trustee or similar officer for,
the Issuer or any Guarantor or any substantial part of their respective property, or otherwise, all as though such payments had not been
made.
2.6
Payments. Each Guarantor hereby guarantees that payments hereunder shall be paid to the Trustee without set-off or deduction or
counterclaim in immediately available funds in Dollars at the office of the Trustee.
2.7
Information. Each Guarantor assumes all responsibility for being and keeping itself informed of the Issuer’s and each other
Guarantor’s financial condition and assets, and of all other circumstances bearing upon the risk of nonpayment of the Issuer Obligations
and the nature, scope and extent of the risks that such Guarantor assumes and incurs hereunder, and agrees that neither the Trustee nor
any other Secured Party shall have any duty to advise such Guarantor of information known to it or any of them regarding such circumstances
or risks.
SECTION
3
SECURITY
3.1
Grant of Security Interest.
(a)
To secure the Obligations, each Guarantor hereby pledges, assigns, conveys, delivers, transfers and sets over to the Trustee, for the
benefit of the Secured Parties, and hereby grants to the Trustee, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a security interest in such
Guarantor’s right, title and interest in, to and under all of the following property to the extent now owned or at any time hereafter
acquired by such Guarantor (collectively, the “Collateral”):
(i)
the Securitization IP and the right to bring an action at law or in equity for any infringement, misappropriation, dilution or other
violation thereof occurring prior to, on or after the Closing Date, and to collect all damages, settlements and proceeds relating thereto;
(ii)
(A) the Franchisee Notes, if any, and the Equipment Leases, if any; and (B)(i) the Franchise Agreements and all Franchisee Payments thereon;
(ii) the Development Agreements and all Franchisee Payments thereon; (iii) the New Franchise Agreements and all Franchisee Payments thereon;
(iv) the New Development Agreements and all Franchisee Payments thereon; (v) all rights to enter into New Franchise Agreements and New
Development Agreements; (vi) any and all other property of every nature, now or hereafter transferred, mortgaged, pledged, or assigned
as security for payment or performance of any obligation of the Franchisees or other Persons, as applicable, to such Guarantor under
the Franchise Agreements or the Development Agreements and all guarantees of such obligations and the rights evidenced by or reflected
in the Franchise Agreements or the Development Agreements;
(iii)
(i) the Product Sourcing Agreements and all Product Sourcing Payments thereon; (ii) the New Product Sourcing Assets and all Product Sourcing
Payments thereon; (iii) all rights to enter into New Product Sourcing Agreements; and (iv) any and all other property of every nature,
now or hereafter transferred, mortgaged, pledged, or assigned as security for payment or performance of any obligation of any Person
to such Guarantor under the Product Sourcing Agreements and all guarantees of such obligations and the rights evidenced by or reflected
in the Product Sourcing Agreements;
(iv)
any Owned Real Property and any New Owned Real Property;
(v)
the Franchisee Lease Payments received under the Franchised Restaurant Leases;
(vi)
the IP License Agreements, all related payments thereon and all rights thereunder;
(vii)
(i) the Material Contracts (in each case, to the extent contributed to or entered into by such Company Restaurant Guarantor), all related
payments thereon and all rights to enter into Material Contracts; (ii) the Company Restaurants and all Company Restaurant Assets relating
thereto; and (iii) the New Company Restaurants and all New Company Restaurant Assets relating thereto;
(viii)
each Account and all amounts or other property on deposit in or otherwise credited to such Accounts;
(ix)
the books and records (whether in physical, electronic or other form), including those books and records maintained by the Manager on
behalf of the Guarantors relating to the Guarantor Assets, the Product Sourcing Assets and the Securitization IP;
(x)
the rights, powers, remedies and authorities of the Guarantors under (i) each of the Transaction Documents (other than the Indenture
and the Notes) to which they are a party and (ii) each of the documents relating to the Guarantor Assets and Product Sourcing Assets
to which it is a party;
(xi)
any and all other property of the Guarantors now or hereafter acquired, including, without limitation, all accounts, chattel paper, commercial
tort claims, deposit accounts, documents, equipment, fixtures, general intangibles, instruments, inventory, securities, securities accounts
and other investment property and letter-of-credit rights (in each case, as defined in the New York UCC); and
(xii)
all payments, proceeds, supporting obligations and accrued and future rights to payment with respect to the foregoing;
provided,
that the Collateral shall exclude the Collateral Exclusions. The Trustee, on behalf of the Secured Parties, acknowledges that it shall
have no security interest in any Collateral Exclusions.
(b)
The foregoing grant is made in trust to secure the Obligations and to secure compliance with the provisions of this Agreement, all as
provided in this Agreement. The Trustee, on behalf of the Secured Parties, acknowledges such grant, accepts the trusts under this Agreement
in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement and agrees to perform its duties required in this Agreement. The Collateral shall
secure the Obligations equally and ratably without prejudice, priority or distinction (except, with respect to any Series of Notes, as
otherwise stated in the applicable Series Supplement or in the applicable provisions of the Base Indenture).
(c)
In addition, pursuant to and within the time periods specified in Section 8.38 of the Base Indenture, each applicable Guarantor
shall execute and deliver to the Control Party (with a copy to the Trustee), for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a Mortgage with
respect to each New Owned Real Property acquired by such Guarantor (and to the extent necessary, any Contributed Owned Real Property),
which shall be delivered to the Control Party or its agent to be held in escrow; provided and notwithstanding any other provision of
the Base Indenture, that Prospective Company Restaurant Properties will not be subject to such requirement. Upon the occurrence of a
Mortgage Recordation Event, unless such Mortgage Recordation Event is waived by the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling
Class Representative), the Control Party or its agent, at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative, will deliver the Mortgages
within five (5) Business Days to the applicable recording office for recordation in accordance with Section 8.38 of the Base Indenture.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, no Lien will be granted to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties on any New Owned Real Property
until such time as the Mortgages are required to be delivered in accordance with the Indenture.
3.2
Certain Rights and Obligations of the Guarantors Unaffected.
(a)
Notwithstanding the grant of the security interest in the Collateral hereunder to the Trustee, on behalf of the Secured Parties, the
Guarantors acknowledge that the Manager, on behalf of the Securitization Entities, including, without limitation, any Guarantors that
are Guarantors, shall, subject to the terms and conditions of the Management Agreement, nevertheless have the right, subject to the Trustee’s
right to revoke such right, in whole or in part, in the event of the occurrence of an Event of Default, (i) to give, in accordance with
the Managing Standard, all consents, requests, notices, directions, approvals, extensions or waivers, if any, which are required or permitted
to be given by any Guarantor under the Collateral Documents to which it is a party, and to enforce all rights, remedies, powers, privileges
and claims of each Guarantor under the Collateral Documents to which it is a party, (ii) to give, in accordance with the Managing Standard,
all consents, requests, notices, directions and approvals, if any, which are required or permitted to be given by any Guarantor under
any IP License Agreement to which it is a party and to enforce all rights, remedies, powers, privileges and claims of such Guarantor
thereunder and (iii) to take any other actions required or permitted to be taken by a Guarantor under the terms of the Management Agreement.
(b)
The grant of the security interest by the Guarantors in the Collateral to the Trustee on behalf of and for the benefit of the Secured
Parties hereunder shall not (i) relieve any Guarantor from the performance of any term, covenant, condition or agreement on such Guarantor’s
part to be performed or observed under or in connection with any of the Collateral Documents to which it is a party or (ii) impose any
obligation on the Trustee or any of the Secured Parties to perform or observe any such term, covenant, condition or agreement on any
Guarantor’s part to be so performed or observed or impose any liability on the Trustee or any of the other Secured Parties for
any act or omission on the part of such Guarantor or from any breach of any representation or warranty on the part of such Guarantor.
(c)
Each Guarantor hereby jointly and severally agrees to indemnify and hold harmless the Trustee and each Secured Party (including its respective
directors, officers, employees and agents) from and against any and all losses, liabilities (including liabilities for penalties), claims,
demands, actions, suits, judgments, reasonable and documented out-of-pocket costs and expenses arising out of or resulting from the security
interest granted hereby, whether arising by virtue of any act or omission on the part of such Guarantor or otherwise, including, without
limitation, the reasonable and documented out-of-pocket costs, expenses and disbursements (including reasonable attorneys’ fees
and expenses) incurred by the Trustee or any Secured Party in enforcing this Agreement or any other Transaction Document or preserving
any of its rights to, or realizing upon, any of the Collateral; provided, however, that the foregoing indemnification shall
not extend to any action by the Trustee or any other Secured Party which constitutes gross negligence, bad faith or willful misconduct
by the Trustee or any Secured Party or any other indemnified person hereunder. The indemnification provided for in this Section 3.2
shall survive the removal of, or a resignation by, such Person as Trustee as well as the termination of this Agreement. No amounts
shall be required to be paid under this Section 3.2(c) in duplication of amounts paid under Section 3.2(c) of the Base
Indenture.
3.3
Performance of Collateral Documents. Upon the occurrence of a default or breach (after giving effect to any applicable grace or
cure periods) by any Person party to (a) a Collateral Transaction Document to which a Guarantor is a party or (b) a Collateral Franchise
Business Document to which a Guarantor is a party (only if a Manager Termination Event or an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing),
promptly following a request from the Trustee to do so and at such Guarantors’ expense, each such Guarantor shall take all such
lawful action as permitted under this Agreement as the Trustee (acting at the direction of the Control Party (at the direction of the
Controlling Class Representative)) may reasonably request to compel or secure the performance and observance by such Person of its obligations
to such Guarantor, and to exercise any and all rights, remedies, powers and privileges lawfully available to such Guarantor to the extent
and in the manner directed by the Trustee (acting at the direction of the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)),
including, without limitation, the transmission of notices of default and the institution of legal or administrative actions or proceedings
to compel or secure performance by such Person of its obligations thereunder. If (i) a Guarantor shall have failed, within fifteen (15)
Business Days of receiving the direction of the Trustee, to take commercially reasonable action to accomplish such directions of the
Trustee, (ii) a Guarantor refuses to take any such action, as reasonably determined by the Control Party in good faith, or (iii) the
Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) reasonably determines that such action must be taken immediately,
in any such case the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) may, but shall not be obligated to, take,
and the Trustee shall take (if so directed by the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)), at the expense
of the Guarantors, such previously directed action and any related action permitted under this Agreement which the Control Party (at
the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) thereafter determines is appropriate (without the need under this provision or
any other provision under this Agreement to direct such Guarantor to take such action), on behalf of such Guarantor and the Secured Parties.
No amounts shall be required to be paid under this Section 3.3 in duplication of amounts paid under Section 3.3 of the
Base Indenture.
3.4
Stamp, Other Similar Taxes and Filing Fees. The Guarantors shall jointly and severally indemnify and hold harmless the Trustee
and each other Secured Party from any present or future claim for liability for any stamp, documentary or other similar tax, and any
penalties or interest and expenses with respect thereto, that may be assessed, levied or collected by any jurisdiction in connection
with this Agreement, any other Transaction Document or any Collateral. The Guarantors shall pay, and jointly and severally indemnify
and hold harmless each Secured Party against, any and all amounts in respect of all search, filing, recording and registration fees,
taxes, excise taxes and other similar imposts that may be payable or determined to be payable in respect of the execution, delivery,
performance and/or enforcement of this Agreement or any other Transaction Document. No amounts shall be required to be paid under this
Section 3.4 in duplication of amounts paid under Section 3.4 of the Base Indenture.
3.5
Authorization to File Financing Statements; Other Filing and Recording Documents.
(a)
Each Guarantor hereby irrevocably authorizes the Control Party on behalf of the Secured Parties at any time and from time to time to
file or record in any filing office in any applicable jurisdiction financing statements and other filing or recording documents or instruments
(or, with respect to the Mortgages, upon the occurrence of a Mortgage Recordation Event, unless such Mortgage Recordation Event is waived
by the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)) with respect to the Collateral, including, without limitation,
any and all Securitization IP (to the extent set forth in Sections 8.25(c) and 8.25(e) of the Base Indenture), to perfect
the security interests of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties under this Agreement. Each Guarantor authorizes the filing
of any such financing statement, document or instrument naming the Trustee as secured party and indicating that the Collateral includes
(a) “all assets” or words of similar effect or import regardless of whether any particular assets comprised in the Collateral
fall within the scope of Article 9 of the UCC, including, without limitation, any and all Securitization IP or (b) as being of
an equal or lesser scope or with greater detail. Each Guarantor agrees to furnish any information necessary to accomplish the foregoing
promptly upon the Control Party’s request. Each Guarantor also hereby ratifies and authorizes the filing by or on behalf of the
Trustee, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, of any financing statement with respect to the Collateral made prior to the date hereof.
(b)
Each Guarantor acknowledges that the Collateral may include certain rights of such Guarantor as a secured party under the Transaction
Documents. To the extent a Guarantor is a secured party under the Transaction Documents, such Guarantor hereby irrevocably appoints the
Trustee as its representative with respect to all financing statements filed to perfect or record evidence of such security interests
and authorizes the Control Party on behalf of and for the benefit of the Secured Parties to make such filings as it deems necessary to
reflect the Trustee as secured party of record with respect to such financing statements.
SECTION
4
REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES
Each
Guarantor hereby represents and warrants, for the benefit of the Trustee and the other Secured Parties, as follows as of the Closing
Date and as of each Series Closing Date thereafter:
4.1
Existence and Power. Each Guarantor (a) is duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction
of organization, (b) is duly qualified to do business as a foreign entity and in good standing under the laws of each jurisdiction where
the character of its property, the nature of its business or the performance of its obligations under the Transaction Documents make
such qualification necessary, except to the extent that the failure to so qualify would not reasonably be likely to result in a Material
Adverse Effect, and (c) has all limited liability company, corporate or other powers and all governmental licenses, authorizations, consents
and approvals required to carry on its business as now conducted and for purposes of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement
and the other Transaction Documents, except to the extent the failure to do so would not reasonably be expected to result in a Material
Adverse Effect.
4.2
Company and Governmental Authorization. The execution, delivery and performance by each Guarantor of this Agreement and the other
Transaction Documents to which it is a party (a) is within such Guarantor’s limited liability company, corporate or other powers
and has been duly authorized by all necessary limited liability company, corporate or other action, (b) requires no action by or in respect
of, or filing with, any Governmental Authority which has not been obtained (other than any actions or filings that may be undertaken
after the Closing Date pursuant to the terms of the Base Indenture or any other Transaction Document, including actions or filings with
respect to any Mortgages) and (c) does not contravene, or constitute a default under, any Requirements of Law with respect to such Guarantor
or any Contractual Obligation with respect to such Guarantor or result in the creation or imposition of any Lien on any property of any
Guarantor, except for Liens created by this Agreement or the other Transaction Documents, except in the case of clauses (b) and (c) above,
solely with respect to the Contribution Agreements, the violation of which could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse
Effect. This Agreement and each of the other Transaction Documents to which each Guarantor is a party has been executed and delivered
by a duly Authorized Officer of such Guarantor.
4.3
No Consent. Except as set forth on Schedule 7.3 to the Base Indenture, no consent, action by or in respect of, approval
or other authorization of, or registration, declaration or filing with, any Governmental Authority or other Person is required for the
valid execution and delivery by each Guarantor of this Agreement or any Transaction Document to which it is a party or for the performance
of any of the Guarantors’ obligations hereunder or thereunder other than such consents, approvals, authorizations, registrations,
declarations or filings (a) as shall have been obtained or made by such Guarantor prior to the Closing Date or as are permitted to be
obtained subsequent to the Closing Date in accordance with Section 4.6 hereof or Sections 7.13, 8.25, or 8.38
of the Base Indenture or (b) relating to the performance of any Collateral Franchise Business Document the failure of which to obtain
is not reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.
4.4
Binding Effect. This Agreement, and each other Transaction Document to which a Guarantor is a party, is a legal, valid and binding
obligation of each such Guarantor enforceable against such Guarantor in accordance with its terms (except as may be limited by bankruptcy,
insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization, moratorium and other similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally or by
general equitable principles, whether considered in a proceeding at law or in equity, or by an implied covenant of good faith and fair
dealing).
4.5
Subsidiaries. The Guarantors do not and shall not own any Subsidiaries other than Subsidiaries that are Guarantors.
4.6
Security Interests.
(a)
Each Guarantor owns and has good title to its Collateral, free and clear of all Liens other than Permitted Liens. Except in the case
of the New Real Estate Assets and Prospective Company Restaurant Properties included in the Collateral, this Agreement constitutes a
valid and continuing Lien on the Collateral in favor of the Trustee on behalf of and for the benefit of the Secured Parties, which Lien
on the Collateral has been perfected and is prior to all other Liens (other than Permitted Liens), and is enforceable as such as against
creditors of and purchasers from each Guarantor in accordance with its terms (except, in each case, as described on Schedule 7.13(a)
of the Base Indenture and subject to Sections 8.25(c), 8.25(e), and 8.38 of the Base Indenture, or as is permitted
under this Section 4.6(a)), except as such enforceability may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization,
moratorium and other similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally or by general equitable principles, whether considered
in a proceeding at law or in equity and by an implied covenant of good faith and fair dealing. Except as set forth on Schedule 7.13(a)
of the Base Indenture, the Guarantors have received all consents and approvals required by the terms of the Collateral to the pledge
of the Collateral to the Trustee hereunder and the Guarantors have filed, or shall have caused, the filing of all appropriate financing
statements in the proper filing office in the appropriate jurisdictions under applicable law in order to perfect the first-priority security
interest (subject to Permitted Liens) in the Collateral (other than the Owned Real Property, any New Owned Real Property and any Prospective
Company Restaurant Property) granted to the Trustee hereunder no later than ten (10) days after the Closing Date or such Series Closing
Date; provided, that with respect to Intellectual Property, New Real Estate Assets or Prospective Company Restaurant Property
included in the Collateral the Guarantors shall only take such action necessary to perfect such first-priority security interest consistent
with and subject to the obligations and time periods set forth in Sections 8.25(c), 8.25(e), or 8.38 of the Base
Indenture, as applicable.
(b)
Other than the security interest granted to the Trustee hereunder, pursuant to the other Transaction Documents or any other Permitted
Lien, none of the Guarantors has pledged, assigned, sold or granted a security interest in the Collateral. All action necessary (including
the filing of UCC-1 financing statements and filings with the PTO and the United States Copyright Office) to protect and evidence the
Trustee’s security interest in the Collateral in the United States has been, or shall be, duly and effectively taken consistent
with and subject to the obligations set forth in Section 4.6(a) above and Sections 8.25(c), 8.25(e) or 8.38
of the Base Indenture, except as described on Schedule 7.13(a) to the Base Indenture. No security agreement, financing statement,
equivalent security or lien instrument or continuation statement authorized by any Guarantor and listing such Guarantor as debtor covering
all or any part of the Collateral is on file or of record in any jurisdiction, except in respect of Permitted Liens or such as may have
been filed, recorded or made by such Guarantor in connection with a Contribution Agreement or in favor of the Trustee on behalf of the
Secured Parties in connection with this Agreement, and no Guarantor has authorized any such filing.
(c)
All authorizations in this Agreement for the Trustee to endorse checks, instruments and securities and to execute financing statements,
continuation statements, security agreements and other instruments with respect to the Collateral and to take such other actions with
respect to the Collateral authorized by this Agreement are powers coupled with an interest and are irrevocable.
(d)
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, the Guarantors make no representation as to the validity, effectiveness, priority or
enforceability of any grant of security interest in any real property assets under Section 3, including, in each case, the New
Real Estate Assets or the Prospective Company Restaurant Properties, or the perfection thereof, which in each case shall be governed
by the Mortgages, if applicable.
4.7
Other Representations. All representations and warranties of or about each Guarantor (if made by the Issuer) made in the Base
Indenture and in each other Transaction Document to which the Issuer or such Guarantor is a party are true and correct (i) if qualified
as to materiality, in all respects, and (ii) if not qualified as to materiality, in all material respects (unless stated to relate solely
to an earlier date, in which case such representations and warranties were true and correct in all respects or in all material respects,
as applicable, as of such earlier date) and are repeated herein as though fully set forth herein.
SECTION
5
COVENANTS
5.1
[Reserved].
5.2
Defaults or Events of Default; Covenants in Base Indenture and Other Transaction Documents. Each Guarantor shall take, or shall
refrain from taking, as the case may be, each action that is necessary to be taken or not taken, as the case may be, so that no Default
or Event of Default is caused by the failure to take such action or to refrain from taking such action by such Guarantor; provided that,
for the avoidance of doubt, such taking or refraining from taking such action shall result in an Event of Default under the Indenture
subject to the applicable cure periods set forth thereunder. All covenants of each Guarantor made in the Base Indenture and in each other
Transaction Document are repeated herein as though fully set forth herein.
5.3
Further Assurances.
(a)
Each Guarantor shall do such further acts and things, and execute and deliver to the Trustee and the Control Party such additional assignments,
agreements, powers and instruments, as are necessary or desirable to obtain or maintain the security interest of the Trustee in the Collateral
on behalf of the Secured Parties as a perfected security interest subject to no prior Liens (other than Permitted Liens), to carry into
effect the purposes of this Agreement or the other Transaction Documents or to better assure and confirm unto the Trustee, the Control
Party the Noteholders or the other Secured Parties their rights, powers and remedies hereunder including, without limitation, the filing
of any financing or continuation statements or amendments under the UCC in effect in any jurisdiction with respect to the liens and security
interests granted hereby, except as set forth on Schedule 8.11 to the Base Indenture, and in each case subject to Sections
8.25(c), 8.25(e), or 8.38 of the Base Indenture. The Guarantors intend the security interests granted pursuant to this
Agreement in favor of the Secured Parties to be prior to all other Liens (other than Permitted Liens) in respect of the Collateral, and
each Guarantor shall take all actions necessary to obtain and maintain, in favor of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties,
a first lien on and a first priority, perfected security interest in the Collateral (except with respect to Permitted Liens and except
as set forth on Schedule 8.11 of the Base Indenture or in Sections 8.25 or 8.38 of the Base Indenture). If any Guarantor
fails to perform any of its agreements or obligations under this Section 5.3(a), then the Control Party may perform such agreement
or obligation, and the expenses of the Control Party incurred in connection therewith shall be payable by the Guarantors (without duplication
amounts paid under Section 8.11 of the Base Indenture) upon the Control Party’s demand therefor. The Control Party is hereby
authorized to execute and file any financing statements, continuation statements, amendments or other instruments necessary or appropriate
to perfect or maintain the perfection of the Trustee’s security interest in the Collateral.
(b)
If any amount payable under or in connection with any of the Collateral shall be or become evidenced by any promissory note, chattel
paper or other instrument, such note, chattel paper or instrument shall be deemed to be held in trust and immediately pledged and within
two (2) Business Days physically delivered to the Trustee hereunder, and shall, subject to the rights of any Person in whose favor a
prior Lien has been perfected, be duly endorsed in a manner satisfactory to the Trustee and delivered to the Trustee promptly; provided,
that no Guarantor shall be required to deliver any Franchisee Note or Equipment Lease.
(c)
Notwithstanding the provisions set forth in clauses (a) and (b) above, the Guarantors shall not be required to perfect
any security interest in any fixtures (other than through a central filing of a UCC financing statement), any Franchisee promissory notes
or, except as provided in Section 8.38 to the Base Indenture, any New Real Estate Assets or Prospective Company Restaurant Properties.
(d)
The Guarantors, upon obtaining an interest in any commercial tort claim or claims (as such term is defined in the New York UCC), shall
comply with Section 8.11(d) of the Base Indenture.
(e)
Each Guarantor shall warrant and defend the Trustee’s right, title and interest in and to the Collateral and the income, distributions
and Proceeds thereof, for the benefit of the Trustee on behalf of the Secured Parties, against the claims and demands of all Persons
whomsoever.
5.4
Legal Name, Location Under Section 9-301 or 9-307. Each Guarantor shall comply with the terms of Section 8.19 of the Base
Indenture if it changes its location (within the meaning of Section 9-301 or 9-307 of the applicable UCC) or its legal name.
5.5
Management Accounts. To the extent that it owns any Management Account (including any lock-box related thereto), each Guarantor
shall comply with Section 5.1 of the Base Indenture with respect to each such Management Account (including any lock-box related
thereto).
SECTION
6
REMEDIAL PROVISIONS
6.1
Rights of the Control Party and Trustee upon Event of Default.
(a)
Proceedings To Collect Money. In case any Guarantor shall fail forthwith to pay any amounts due on this Guarantee upon demand,
the Trustee at the direction of the Control Party (subject to Section 11.4(e) of the Base Indenture, at the direction of the Controlling
Class Representative), in its own name and as trustee of an express trust, may institute a Proceeding for the collection of the sums
so due and unpaid, and may prosecute such Proceeding to judgment or final decree, and may enforce the same against any Guarantor and
collect in the manner provided by law out of the property of any Guarantor, wherever situated, the moneys adjudged or decreed to be payable.
(b)
Other Proceedings. If and whenever an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Trustee, at the direction of
the Control Party (subject to Section 11.4(e) of the Base Indenture, at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative),
shall take one or more of the following actions:
(i)
proceed to protect and enforce its rights and the rights of the Noteholders and the other Secured Parties, by such appropriate Proceedings
as the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) shall deem most effective to protect and enforce any
such rights, whether for the specific enforcement of any covenant or agreement in this Agreement or any other Transaction Document or
in aid of the exercise of any power granted therein, or to enforce any other proper remedy or legal or equitable right vested in the
Trustee by this Agreement or any other Transaction Document or by law, including any remedies of a secured party under Requirements of
Law;
(ii)
(A) direct the Guarantors to exercise (and each Guarantor agrees to exercise) all rights, remedies, powers, privileges and claims of
any Guarantor against any party to any Collateral Document to which such Guarantor is a party arising as a result of the occurrence of
such Event of Default or otherwise, including the right or power to take any action to compel performance or observance by any such party
of its obligations to any Guarantor, and any right of any Guarantor to take such action independent of such direction shall be suspended,
and (B) if (x) the Guarantors shall have failed, within ten (10) Business Days of receiving the direction of the Trustee (given at the
direction of the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)), to take commercially reasonable action to
accomplish such directions of the Trustee, (y) any Guarantor refuses to take such action or (z) the Control Party (at the direction of
the Controlling Class Representative) reasonably determines that such action must be taken immediately, take (or the Control Party on
behalf of the Trustee shall take) such previously directed action (and any related action as permitted under this Agreement thereafter
determined by the Trustee or the Control Party to be appropriate without the need under this provision or any other provision under this
Agreement to direct the Guarantors to take such action);
(iii)
institute Proceedings from time to time for the complete or partial foreclosure of this Agreement or, to the extent applicable, any other
Transaction Document, with respect to the Collateral; provided that the Trustee shall not be required to take title to any real
property in connection with any foreclosure or other exercise of remedies hereunder or under such Transaction Documents and title to
such property shall instead be acquired in an entity designated and (unless owned by a third party) controlled by the Control Party;
and/or
(iv)
sell all or a portion of the Collateral at one or more public or private sales called and conducted in any manner permitted by law; provided,
however, that the Trustee shall not proceed with any such sale without the prior written consent of the Control Party (at the
direction of the Controlling Class Representative) and the Trustee shall provide notice to the Guarantors and each Holder of Notes of
a proposed sale of Collateral.
(c)
Sale of Collateral. In connection with any sale of the Collateral hereunder (which may proceed separately and independently from
the exercise of remedies under the Indenture), under any Mortgage or under any judgment, order or decree in any judicial proceeding for
the foreclosure or involving the enforcement of this Agreement or any other Transaction Document:
(i)
any of the Trustee, any Noteholder, any Enhancement Provider and/or any other Secured Party may bid for and purchase the property being
sold, and upon compliance with the terms of the sale may hold, retain, possess and dispose of such property in its own absolute right
without further accountability;
(ii)
the Trustee (at the direction of the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)) may make and deliver to
the purchaser or purchasers a good and sufficient deed, bill of sale and instrument of assignment and transfer of the property sold;
(iii)
all right, title, interest, claim and demand whatsoever, either at law or in equity or otherwise, of any Guarantor of, in and to the
property so sold shall be divested; and such sale shall be a perpetual bar both at law and in equity against such Guarantor, its successors
and assigns, and against any and all Persons claiming or who may claim the property sold or any part thereof from, through or under such
Guarantor or its successors or assigns; and
(iv)
the receipt of the Trustee or of the officer thereof making such sale shall be a sufficient discharge to the purchaser or purchasers
at such sale for his or their purchase money, and such purchaser or purchasers, and his or their assigns or personal representatives,
shall not, after paying such purchase money and receiving such receipt of the Trustee or of such officer thereof, be obliged to see to
the application of such purchase money or be in any way answerable for any loss, misapplication or non-application thereof.
(d)
Application of Proceeds. Any amounts obtained by the Trustee or the Control Party on account of or as a result of the exercise
by the Trustee or the Control Party of any right hereunder shall be held by the Trustee as additional collateral for the repayment of
the Obligations, shall be deposited into the Collection Account and shall be applied as provided in the priority set forth in the Priority
of Payments; provided that unless otherwise provided in this Section 6 or Article IX of the Base Indenture, with
respect to any distribution to any Class of Notes, notwithstanding the provisions of Article V of the Base Indenture, such amounts
shall be distributed sequentially in order of alphabetical (as opposed to alphanumerical) designation and pro rata among each Class of
Notes of the same alphabetical designation based upon the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes of each such Class.
(e)
Additional Remedies. In addition to any rights and remedies now or hereafter granted hereunder or under applicable law with respect
to the Collateral, the Trustee shall have all of the rights and remedies of a secured party under the UCC as enacted in any applicable
jurisdiction.
(f)
Proceedings. The Trustee may maintain a Proceeding even if it does not possess any of the Notes or does not produce any of them
in the Proceeding, and any such Proceeding instituted by the Trustee shall be in its own name as trustee. All remedies are cumulative
to the extent permitted by law.
(g)
Power of Attorney. To the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, each Guarantor hereby grants to the Trustee an absolute
power of attorney to sign, upon the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default, any document which may be required
by the PTO, United States Copyright Office, any similar office or agency in each foreign country in which any Securitization IP is located,
or any other Governmental Authority in order to effect an absolute assignment of all right, title and interest in or to any Securitization
IP, and record the same.
6.2
Waiver of Appraisal, Valuation, Stay and Right to Marshaling. To the extent it may lawfully do so, each Guarantor for itself and
for any Person who may claim through or under it hereby:
(a)
agrees that neither it nor any such Person shall step up, plead, claim or in any manner whatsoever take advantage of any appraisal, valuation,
stay, extension or redemption laws, now or hereafter in force in any jurisdiction, which may delay, prevent or otherwise hinder (i) the
performance, enforcement or foreclosure of this Agreement, (ii) the sale of any of the Collateral or (iii) the putting of the purchaser
or purchasers thereof into possession of such property immediately after the sale thereof;
(b)
waives all benefit or advantage of any such laws;
(c)
waives and releases all rights to have the Collateral marshaled upon any foreclosure, sale or other enforcement of this Agreement; and
(d)
consents and agrees that, subject to and in accordance with the terms of the Base Indenture and this Agreement, all the Collateral may
at any such sale be sold by the Trustee as an entirety or in such portions as the Trustee may (upon direction by the Control Party (acting
at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)) determine.
6.3
Limited Recourse. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement or any other Transaction Document or otherwise, the liability
of the Guarantors to the Noteholders and any other Secured Parties under or in relation to this Agreement or any other Transaction Document
or otherwise, is limited in recourse to the Collateral. The proceeds of the Collateral having been applied in accordance with the terms
hereof, none of the Noteholders or any other Secured Parties shall be entitled to take any further steps against any Guarantor to recover
any sums due but still unpaid hereunder, under the Notes or under any of the other agreements or documents described in this Section
6.3, all claims in respect of which shall be extinguished.
6.4
Optional Preservation of the Collateral. If the maturity of the Outstanding Notes of each Series has been accelerated pursuant
to Section 9.2 of the Base Indenture following an Event of Default, and such declaration and its consequences have not been rescinded
and annulled, the Trustee, at the direction of the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), subject
to the other terms and provisions hereof and of the Base Indenture, shall elect to maintain possession of such portion, if any, of the
Collateral as the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) shall in its discretion determine.
6.5
Control by the Control Party. Notwithstanding any other provision hereof, the Control Party (subject to Section 11.4(e)
of the Base Indenture, at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) may cause the institution of and direct the time, method
and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee or exercise any trust or power conferred on the Trustee;
provided that:
(a)
such direction of time, method and place shall not be in conflict with any rule of law, the Indenture, this Agreement or any other Indenture
Document;
(b)
the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) may take any other action deemed proper by the Control Party
(at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) that is not inconsistent with such direction (as the same may be modified
by the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)); and
(c)
such direction shall be in writing;
provided,
further, that, subject to Section 10.1 of the Base Indenture, the Trustee need not take any action that it determines might
involve it in liability unless it has received an indemnity for such liability as provided in the Base Indenture. The Trustee shall take
no action referred to in this Section 6.5 unless instructed to do so by the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling
Class Representative).
6.6
The Trustee May File Proofs of Claim. The Trustee is authorized to file such proofs of claim and other papers or documents as
may be necessary or advisable in order to have the claims of the Trustee (including any claim for the reasonable compensation, expenses,
disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel), the Noteholders and any other Secured Party (as applicable) allowed
in any judicial proceedings relative to any Guarantor (or any other obligor upon the Notes), its creditors or its property, and shall
be entitled and empowered to collect, receive and distribute any money or other property payable or deliverable on any such claim and
any custodian in any such judicial proceeding is hereby authorized by each Noteholder and each other Secured Party to make such payments
to the Trustee and, in the event that the Trustee shall consent to the making of such payments directly to the Noteholders or any other
Secured Party, to pay the Trustee any amount due to it for the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee,
its agents and counsel, and any other amounts due the Trustee under Section 10.5 of the Base Indenture. To the extent that the
payment of any such compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel, and any other amounts
due the Trustee under Section 10.5 of the Base Indenture out of the estate in any such proceeding, shall be denied for any reason,
payment of the same shall be secured by a Lien on, and shall be paid out of, any and all distributions, dividends, money and other properties
which any of the Noteholders or any other Secured Party may be entitled to receive in such proceeding whether in liquidation or under
any plan of reorganization or arrangement or otherwise. Nothing herein contained shall be deemed to authorize the Trustee to authorize
or consent to or accept or adopt on behalf of any Noteholder or any other Secured Party any plan of reorganization, arrangement, adjustment
or composition affecting the Obligations or the rights of any Noteholder or any other Secured Party, or to authorize the Trustee to vote
in respect of the claim of any Noteholder or any other Secured Party in any such proceeding.
6.7
Undertaking for Costs. In any suit for the enforcement of any right or remedy under this Agreement or in any suit against the
Trustee for any action taken or omitted by it as a Trustee, a court in its discretion may require the filing by any party litigant in
the suit of any undertaking to pay the costs of the suit, and the court in its discretion may assess reasonable costs, including reasonable
attorneys’ fees, against any party litigant in the suit, having due regard to the merits and good faith of the claims or defenses
made by the party litigant. This Section 6.7 does not apply to a suit by the Trustee, a suit by a Noteholder pursuant to Section
9.9 of the Base Indenture or a suit by Noteholders of more than 10% of the Aggregate Outstanding Principal Amount of all Series of
Notes.
6.8
Restoration of Rights and Remedies. If the Trustee, any Noteholder or any other Secured Party has instituted any Proceeding to
enforce any right or remedy under this Agreement or any other Transaction Document and such Proceeding has been discontinued or abandoned
for any reason or has been determined adversely to the Trustee or to such Noteholder or other Secured Party, then and in every such case
the Trustee and the Noteholders shall, subject to any determination in such proceeding, be restored severally and respectively to their
former positions hereunder, and thereafter all rights and remedies of the Trustee, the Noteholders and the other Secured Parties shall
continue as though no such Proceeding had been instituted.
6.9
Rights and Remedies Cumulative. No right or remedy herein conferred upon or reserved to the Trustee or to the Holders of Notes
or any other Secured Party is intended to be exclusive of any other right or remedy, and every right or remedy shall, to the extent permitted
by law, be cumulative and in addition to every other right and remedy given under this Agreement or any other Transaction Document or
now or hereafter existing at law or in equity or otherwise. The assertion or employment of any right or remedy under this Agreement or
any other Transaction Document, or otherwise, shall not prevent the concurrent assertion or employment of any other appropriate right
or remedy.
6.10
Delay or Omission Not Waiver. No delay or omission of the Trustee, the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative, any
Holder of any Note or any other Secured Party to exercise any right or remedy accruing upon any Potential Rapid Amortization Event, Rapid
Amortization Event, Default or Event of Default shall impair any such right or remedy or constitute a waiver of any such Potential Rapid
Amortization Event, Rapid Amortization Event, Default or Event of Default or an acquiescence therein. Every right and remedy given by
this Section 6 or by law to the Trustee, the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative, the Holders of Notes or any
other Secured Party may be exercised from time to time to the extent not inconsistent with the Indenture or this Agreement, and as often
as may be deemed expedient, by the Trustee, the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative, the Holders of Notes or any other
Secured Party, as the case may be.
6.11
Waiver of Stay or Extension Laws. Each Guarantor covenants (to the extent that it may lawfully do so) that it shall not at any
time insist upon, or plead, or in any manner whatsoever claim or take the benefit or advantage of, any stay or extension law wherever
enacted, now or at any time hereafter in force, that may affect the covenants or the performance of this Agreement or any other Transaction
Document; and each Guarantor (to the extent that it may lawfully do so) hereby expressly waives all benefit or advantages of any such
law, and covenants that it shall not hinder, delay or impede the execution of any power herein granted to the Trustee, the Control Party
or the Controlling Class Representative, but shall suffer and permit the execution of every such power as though no such law had been
enacted.
SECTION
7
THE
TRUSTEE’S AUTHORITY
Each
Guarantor acknowledges that the rights and responsibilities of the Trustee under this Agreement with respect to any action taken by the
Trustee or the exercise or non-exercise by the Trustee of any option, voting right, request, judgment or other right or remedy provided
for herein or resulting or arising out of this Agreement shall, as between the Trustee and the other Secured Parties, be governed by
the Indenture and by such other agreements with respect thereto as may exist from time to time among them, but, as between the Trustee
and the Guarantors, the Trustee shall be conclusively presumed to be acting as agent for the Secured Parties with full and valid authority
so to act or refrain from acting, it being understood that the Trustee (at the direction of the Control Party (at the direction of the
Controlling Class Representative)) and the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) directly shall be
the only parties entitled to exercise remedies under this Agreement; and no Guarantor shall be under any obligation, or entitlement,
to make any inquiry respecting such authority. In its execution of this Agreement and performance hereunder, the Trustee shall be entitled
to all of the rights, protections, immunities and indemnities afforded to it under the Indenture.
SECTION
8
MISCELLANEOUS
8.1
Amendments. None of the terms or provisions of this Agreement may be amended, supplemented, waived or otherwise modified except
in accordance with Article XIII of the Base Indenture, provided, that the execution and delivery of any Assumption Agreement in
accordance with Section 8.11 of this Agreement shall be deemed not to constitute an amendment.
8.2
Notices.
(a)
Any notice or communication by any Guarantor or the Trustee to any other party hereto shall be in writing and delivered in person, delivered
by e-mail (provided that any e-mail notice to the Trustee shall be in the form of an attachment of a .pdf or similar file), posted on
a password protected internet website for which the recipient has granted access or mailed by first-class mail (registered or certified,
return receipt requested), facsimile or overnight air courier guaranteeing next day delivery, to such other party’s address:
If
to a Guarantor:
[INSERT
NAME OF GUARANTOR]
c/o
Twin Hospitality Group Inc.
9720
Wilshire Blvd., Suite 500
Beverly
Hills, CA 90212
Attention:
Investor Relations
Telephone:
(310) 319-1850
Email:
rrosen@fatbrands.com; kkuick@fatbrands.com
If
to the Trustee:
UMB
BANK, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION
100
William Street, Suite 1850
New
York, NY 10038
Attention:
Michele Voon
Email:
michele.voon@umb.com
Phone:
(646) 650-3840
(b)
The Guarantors or the Trustee by notice to each other party may designate additional or different addresses for subsequent notices or
communications.
(c)
Any notice (i) given in person shall be deemed delivered on the date of delivery of such notice, (ii) given by first-class mail shall
be deemed given five (5) days after the date that such notice is mailed, (iii) delivered by facsimile shall be deemed given on the date
of delivery of such notice, (iv) delivered by overnight air courier shall be deemed delivered one (1) Business Day after the date that
such notice is delivered to such overnight courier, (v) when posted on a password-protected website shall be deemed delivered after notice
of such posting has been provided to the recipient and (vi) delivered by email shall be deemed delivered on the date of delivery of such
notice.
(d)
Notwithstanding any provisions of this Agreement to the contrary, the Trustee shall have no liability based upon or arising from the
failure to receive any notice required by or relating to this Agreement or any other Transaction Document.
8.3
Governing Law. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED AND INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE
OF NEW YORK WITHOUT REGARD TO CONFLICTS OF LAW PRINCIPLES (OTHER THAN SECTIONS 5-1401 AND 5-1402 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATIONS LAW OF THE
STATE OF NEW YORK).
8.4
Successors. All agreements of each of the Guarantors in this Agreement and each other Transaction Document to which it is a party
shall bind its successors and assigns; provided, however, no Guarantor may assign its obligations or rights under this
Agreement or any other Transaction Document, except with the written consent of the Control Party. All agreements of the Trustee in the
Indenture and in this Agreement shall bind its successors as permitted by the Transaction Documents.
8.5
Severability. In case any provision in this Agreement or any other Transaction Document shall be invalid, illegal or unenforceable,
the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions shall not in any way be affected or impaired thereby.
8.6
Counterpart Originals. The parties may sign any number of copies of this Agreement. Each signed copy shall be an original, but
all of them together represent the same agreement. The exchange of copies of this Agreement and of signature pages by facsimile or electronic
transmission shall constitute effective execution and delivery of this Agreement as to the parties hereto and may be used in lieu of
the original Agreement for all purposes. Signatures of the parties hereto transmitted by facsimile or electronic transmission shall be
deemed to be their original signatures for all purposes. Facsimile, documents executed, scanned and transmitted electronically and electronic
signatures shall be deemed original signatures for purposes of this Agreement and any related document, with such facsimile, scanned
and electronic signatures having the same legal effect as original signatures. The parties agree that this Agreement, any addendum or
amendment hereto or any related document necessary may be accepted, executed or agreed to through the use of an electronic signature
in accordance with the Electronic Signatures in Global and National Commerce Act (“E-Sign Act”), Title 15, United States
Code, Sections 7001 et seq., the Uniform Electronic Transaction Act (“UETA”) and any applicable state law. Electronic signature
shall mean any electronic symbol or process attached to, or associated with, a contract or other record and adopted by a person with
the intent to sign, authenticate or accept such contract or record. Any document accepted, executed or agreed to in conformity with such
laws will be binding on all parties hereto to the same extent as if it were physically executed and each party hereby consents to the
use of any third party electronic signature capture service providers as may be reasonably chosen by a signatory hereto.
8.7
Table of Contents, Headings, etc. The Table of Contents and headings of the Sections of this Agreement have been inserted for
convenience of reference only, are not to be considered a part hereof, and shall in no way modify or restrict any of the terms or provisions
hereof.
8.8
Recording of Agreement. If this Agreement is subject to recording in any appropriate public recording offices, such recording
is to be effected by the Guarantors and at their expense accompanied by an Opinion of Counsel (which may be counsel to the Guarantors
or any other counsel reasonably acceptable to the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)) to the effect
that such recording is necessary either for the protection of the Secured Parties or for the enforcement of any right or remedy granted
to the Trustee under this Agreement.
8.9
Waiver of Jury Trial. EACH OF THE GUARANTORS AND THE TRUSTEE HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE
LAW, ANY AND ALL RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY LEGAL PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT, THE OTHER TRANSACTION DOCUMENTS
OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY AND THEREBY.
8.10
Submission to Jurisdiction; Waivers. Each of the Guarantors and the Trustee hereby irrevocably and unconditionally:
(a)
submits for itself and its property in any legal action or proceeding relating to this Agreement and the other Transaction Documents
to which it is a party, or for recognition and enforcement of any judgment in respect thereof, to the non-exclusive general jurisdiction
of the courts of the State of New York sitting in New York County, the courts of the United States for the Southern District of New York,
and appellate courts from any thereof;
(b)
consents that any such action or proceeding may be brought in such courts and waives any objection that it may now or hereafter have
to the venue of any such action or proceeding in any such court or that such action or proceeding was brought in an inconvenient court
and agrees not to plead or claim the same;
(c)
agrees that service of process in any such action or proceeding may be effected by mailing a copy thereof by registered or certified
mail (or any substantially similar form of mail), postage prepaid, to the Guarantors or the Trustee, as the case may be, at its address
set forth in Section 8.2 or at such other address of which the Trustee shall have been notified pursuant thereto;
(d)
agrees that nothing herein shall affect the right to effect service of process in any other manner permitted by law or shall limit the
right to sue in any other jurisdiction; and
(e)
waives, to the maximum extent not prohibited by law, any right it may have to claim or recover in any legal action or proceeding referred
to in this Section 8.10 any special, exemplary, punitive or consequential damages.
8.11
Additional Guarantor. Each Additional Guarantor that is designated to be an Additional Guarantor pursuant to Section 8.34
of the Base Indenture shall become a Guarantor for all purposes of this Agreement upon execution and delivery by such Additional Guarantor
of an Assumption Agreement in substantially the form of Exhibit A hereto. Upon the execution and delivery by any Additional Guarantor
of such an Assumption Agreement, the supplemental schedules attached to such Assumption Agreement shall be incorporated into and become
a part of and supplement the Schedules to this Agreement and each reference to such Schedules shall mean and be a reference to such Schedules
as supplemented pursuant to each Assumption Agreement.
8.12
Currency Indemnity. Each Guarantor shall make all payments of amounts owing by it hereunder in Dollars. If a Guarantor makes any
such payment to the Trustee or any other Secured Party in a currency (the “Other Currency”) other than Dollars (whether
voluntarily or pursuant to an order or judgment of a court or tribunal of any jurisdiction), such payment shall constitute a discharge
of the liability of such party hereunder in respect of such amount owing only to the extent of the amount of Dollars which the Trustee
or such Secured Party is able to purchase, with the amount it receives on the date of receipt. If the amount of Dollars which the Trustee
or such Secured Party is able to purchase is less than the amount of such currency originally so due in respect of such amount, such
Guarantor shall indemnify and save the Trustee or such Secured Party, as applicable, harmless from and against any loss or damage arising
as a result of such deficiency. This indemnity shall constitute an obligation separate and independent from the other obligations contained
in this Agreement, shall give rise to a separate and independent cause of action, shall survive termination hereof, shall apply irrespective
of any indulgence granted by the Trustee or such Secured Party and shall continue in full force and effect notwithstanding any judgment
or order in respect of any amount due hereunder or under any judgment or order.
8.13
Acknowledgment of Receipt; Waiver. Each Guarantor acknowledges receipt of an executed copy of this Agreement and, to the extent
permitted by applicable law, waives the right to receive a copy of any financing statement, financing change statement or verification
statement in respect of any registered financing statement or financing change statement prepared, registered or issued in connection
with this Agreement.
8.14
Termination; Partial Release.
(a)
On the Termination Date, the Collateral shall be automatically released from the Liens created hereby, and this Agreement and all obligations
(other than those expressly stated to survive such termination) of the Trustee and each Guarantor shall automatically terminate, all
without delivery of any instrument or performance of any act by any party, and all rights to the Collateral shall revert to the Guarantors.
At the request and sole expense of any Guarantor following any such termination, the Trustee shall deliver to such Guarantor any Collateral
held by the Trustee hereunder, and execute and deliver to such Guarantor such documents as such Guarantor shall reasonably request to
evidence such termination.
(b)
Any partial release of Collateral hereunder requested by the Issuer in connection with any Permitted Asset Disposition shall be governed
by Section 14.17 of the Base Indenture.
8.15
Third Party Beneficiary. Each of the Secured Parties and the Controlling Class Representative is an express third party beneficiary
of this Agreement.
8.16
Entire Agreement. This Agreement, together with the schedule hereto, the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents, contain
a final and complete integration of all prior expressions by the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter hereof and shall constitute
the entire agreement among the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter hereof, superseding all previous oral statements and
writings with respect thereto.
[Signature
pages follow]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, each of the Guarantors and the Trustee has caused this Guarantee and Collateral Agreement to be duly executed and delivered
by its duly authorized officer as of the date first above written.
GUARANTORS:
TP
FRANCHISE AUSTIN, LLC
TP
FRANCHISE ROUND ROCK, LLC
TP
FRANCHISE VENTURE I, LLC
TP
TEXAS BEVERAGES, LLC
TPJV2,
LLC
TWIN
PEAKS BUYER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT AMARILLO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT AMARILLO BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT AMARILLO MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BEVERAGE - TEXAS, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BRANDON, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BROOMFIELD, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BURLESON, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BURLESON BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BURLESON MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT CENTENNIAL, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT DENVER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT DENVER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT DEVELOPMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT EL PASO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT EL PASO BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT FL PAYROLL, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT FRANCHISE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT FRISCO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT GRAND PRAIRIE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT GRAND PRAIRIE BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT GRAND PRAIRIE MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT INTERNATIONAL FRANCHISE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT INVESTMENT COMPANY, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT INVESTMENT COMPANY II, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT IP, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT JV MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LAKELAND, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LEWISVILLE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LITTLE ROCK, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LIVE OAK, LLC
[Signature
Page to Guarantee and Collateral Agreement]
TWIN
RESTAURANT LIVE OAK BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LIVE OAK MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LIVE OAK RE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LV -2 LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MCKINNEY, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MCKINNEY BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MCKINNEY RE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MIDLAND, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MIDLAND BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT N IRVING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT N IRVING BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT NORTHLAKE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT OAKBROOK, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT ODESSA, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT ODESSA BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT PARK NORTH, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT PARK NORTH BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT PARK NORTH MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT PLANO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT RE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT S FORT WORTH, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT S FORT WORTH BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANGELO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANGELO BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANGELO MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANTONIO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANTONIO BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN MARCOS, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN MARCOS BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN MARCOS MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SARASOTA, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SARASOTA RE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SUNLAND PARK, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SUNLAND PARK BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT TERRELL, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT TERRELL BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT TERRELL RE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT VIVA LAS VEGAS, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WARRENVILLE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WESTERN CENTER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WESTERN CENTER BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WESTOVER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WESTOVER BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT JV HOLDING, LLC
BARBEQUE
INTEGRATED, INC.
SMOKEY
BONES (FLORIDA), LLC
[Signature
Page to Guarantee and Collateral Agreement]
GMR
OF PENNSYLVANIA-SB PROPERTIES, LLC
INTEGRATED CARD SOLUTIONS, LLC
|
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Joseph Hummel |
|
Name: |
Joseph
Hummel |
|
Title: |
Authorized
Person of Barbeque Integrated, Inc., Smokey Bones (Florida), LLC, GMR of Pennsylvania-SB Properties, LLC and Integrated Card Solutions,
LLC and President of all other Guarantor Entities |
|
[Signature
Page to Guarantee and Collateral Agreement]
AGREED
AND ACCEPTED |
|
|
|
UMB
BANK, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
in its capacity as Trustee |
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Michele Voon |
|
Name: |
Micele
Voon |
|
Title: |
Senior
Vice President |
|
[Signature
Page to Guarantee and Collateral Agreement]
Schedule
4.5
GUARANTOR
OWNERSHIP RELATIONSHIPS
PLEDGED ENTITY | |
OWNED BY | |
PERCENTAGE OWNERSHIP |
Twin Hospitality I, LLC | |
Twin Hospitality Group Inc. | |
100% |
TP Franchise Austin, LLC | |
TP Franchise Venture I, LLC | |
100% |
TP Franchise Round Rock, LLC | |
TP Franchise Venture I, LLC | |
100% |
TP Franchise Venture I, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Holding, LLC | |
100% |
TP Texas Beverages, LLC | |
TP Franchise Venture I, LLC | |
100% |
TPJV2, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant JV Holding, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Peaks Buyer, LLC | |
Twin Hospitality I, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Holding, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Amarillo, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Amarillo Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Amarillo Management, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Amarillo Management, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Amarillo, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Beverage - Texas, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Beverage Holding, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Brandon, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Broomfield, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Denver, LLC (TX) | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Burleson, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Burleson Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Burleson Management, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Burleson Management, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Burleson, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Centennial, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Denver, LLC (TX) | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Denver, LLC (CO) | |
Twin Restaurant Denver, LLC (TX) | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Denver, LLC (TX) | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Development, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Holding, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant El Paso, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company II, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant EL Paso Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant El Paso, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant FL Payroll, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Franchise, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Holding, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Frisco, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie Management, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie Management, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Holding, LLC | |
Twin Peaks Buyer, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant International Franchise, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Franchise, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Development, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company II, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Development, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant IP, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Holding, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant JV Management, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant JV Holding, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Lakeland, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Lewisville, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Little Rock, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company II, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Live Oak, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Live Oak Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Live Oak Management, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Live Oak Management, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Live Oak, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Live Oak RE, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant RE, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant LV -2 LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company II, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant McKinney, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant McKinney Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant McKinney, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant McKinney RE, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant RE, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Midland, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Midland Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Midland, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant N Irving, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant N Irving Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant N Irving, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Northlake, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Oakbrook, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company II, LLC | |
85.5% |
Twin Restaurant Oakbrook, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
14.5% |
Twin Restaurant Odessa, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Odessa Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Odessa, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Park North, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company II, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Park North Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Park North Management, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Park North Management, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Park North, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Plano, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant RE, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Holding, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant S Fort Worth, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company II, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant S Fort Worth Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant S Fort Worth, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant San Angelo, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant San Angelo Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant San Angelo Management, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant San Angelo Management, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant San Angelo, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant San Antonio, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant San Antonio Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant San Antonio, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant San Marcos, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant San Marcos Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant San Marcos Management, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant San Marcos Management, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant San Marcos, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Sarasota, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Sarasota RE, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant RE, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Sunland Park, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company II, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Sunland Park Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Sunland Park, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Terrell, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Terrell Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Terrell, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Terrell RE, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant RE, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Viva Las Vegas, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Development, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Warrenville, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company II, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Western Center, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Western Center Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Western Center, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Westover, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Investment Company II, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant Westover Beverage Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Westover, LLC | |
100% |
Twin Restaurant JV Holding, LLC | |
Twin Restaurant Holding, LLC | |
100% |
Barbeque Integrated, Inc. | |
Twin Hospitality I, LLC | |
100% |
Smokey Bones (Florida), LLC | |
Barbeque Integrated, Inc. | |
100% |
GMR of Pennsylvania—SB Properties, LLC | |
Barbeque Integrated, Inc. | |
100% |
Integrated Card Solutions, LLC | |
Barbeque Integrated, Inc. | |
100% |
Exhibit
A to
Guarantee
and Collateral Agreement
ASSUMPTION
AGREEMENT, dated as of ___________________, 20___ (this “Assumption Agreement”), made by ___________ a __________
(the “Additional Guarantor”), in favor of UMB BANK, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, as Trustee and securities intermediary under
the Indenture referred to below (in such capacity, together with its successors, the “Trustee”). All capitalized terms
not defined herein shall have the meaning ascribed to them in the Base Indenture Definitions List attached to the Base Indenture (as
defined below) as Annex A thereto.
W
I T N E S S E T H:
WHEREAS,
Twin Hospitality I, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “Issuer”) and the Trustee have entered into that
certain Base Indenture dated as of November 21, 2024 (the “Base Indenture” and, together with all Series Supplements,
the “Indenture”), providing for the issuance from time to time of one or more Series of Notes thereunder; and
WHEREAS,
in connection with the Base Indenture, the Guarantors and the Trustee entered into that certain Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, dated
as of November 21, 2024 (as the same may be amended, amended and restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time) (the
“Guarantee and Collateral Agreement”) in favor of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties;
WHEREAS,
the Base Indenture requires the Additional Guarantors to become a party to the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement; and
WHEREAS,
the Additional Guarantor has agreed to execute and deliver this Assumption Agreement in order to become a party to the Guarantee and
Collateral Agreement;
NOW,
THEREFORE, IT IS AGREED:
1.
Guarantee and Collateral Agreement. By executing and delivering this Assumption Agreement, the Additional Guarantor, as provided
in Section 8.11 of the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, hereby becomes a party to the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement as
a Guarantor thereunder with the same force and effect as if originally named therein as a Guarantor and, without limiting the generality
of the foregoing, hereby expressly assumes all obligations and liabilities of a Guarantor thereunder. In furtherance of the foregoing,
the Additional Guarantor, as security for the payment and performance in full of the Issuer Obligations, does (x) hereby create and grant
to the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties a security interest in all of the Additional Guarantor’s right, title and
interest in and to the Collateral of the Additional Guarantor in accordance with the terms of the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement
and subject to the exceptions set forth therein and (y) jointly and severally with the other Guarantors, unconditionally and irrevocably
hereby guarantee the prompt and complete payment and performance by the Issuer when due (whether at the stated maturity, by acceleration
or otherwise, but after giving effect to all applicable grace periods) of the Issuer Obligations. Each reference to a “Guarantor”
in the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement shall be deemed to include the Additional Guarantor. The Guarantee and Collateral Agreement
is hereby incorporated herein by reference. The information set forth in Annex 1-A hereto (A) is true and correct as of the date hereof
in all material respects and (B) is hereby added to the information set forth in Schedule 4.5 to the Guarantee and Collateral
Agreement and such Schedule shall be deemed so amended. The Additional Guarantor hereby represents and warrants that each of the representations
and warranties contained in Section 4 of the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement applicable to it is true and correct on and as
the date hereof (after giving effect to this Assumption Agreement) as if made on and as of such date. [The Additional Guarantor is designated
as [a Franchise Entity] [an IP Guarantor] [a Company Restaurant Guarantor].]
2.
Representations of Additional Guarantor. The Additional Guarantor represents and warrants to the Trustee for the benefit of the
Secured Parties that this Assumption Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by it and constitutes its legal, valid
and binding obligation, enforceable against it in accordance with its terms, subject to applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization,
moratorium or other laws affecting creditors’ rights generally and subject to general principles of equity, regardless of whether
considered in a proceeding in equity or at law.
3.
Counterparts; Binding Effect. This Assumption Agreement may be executed in counterparts (and by different parties hereto on different
counterparts), each of which shall constitute an original, but all of which taken together shall constitute a single contract. This Assumption
Agreement shall become effective when (a) the Trustee shall have received a counterpart of this Assumption Agreement that bears the signature
of the Additional Guarantor and (b) the Trustee has executed a counterpart hereof. Delivery of an executed counterpart of a signature
page of this Assumption Agreement by .pdf file in an email shall be effective as delivery of a manually executed counterpart of this
Assumption Agreement. Facsimile, documents executed, scanned and transmitted electronically and electronic signatures shall be deemed
original signatures for purposes of this Assumption Agreement and any related document, with such facsimile, scanned and electronic signatures
having the same legal effect as original signatures. The parties agree that this Assumption Agreement, any addendum or amendment hereto
or any related document necessary may be accepted, executed or agreed to through the use of an electronic signature in accordance with
the Electronic Signatures in Global and National Commerce Act (“E-Sign Act”), Title 15, United States Code, Sections 7001
et seq., the Uniform Electronic Transaction Act (“UETA”) and any applicable state law. Electronic signature shall mean any
electronic symbol or process attached to, or associated with, a contract or other record and adopted by a person with the intent to sign,
authenticate or accept such contract or record. Any document accepted, executed or agreed to in conformity with such laws will be binding
on all parties hereto to the same extent as if it were physically executed and each party hereby consents to the use of any third party
electronic signature capture service providers as may be reasonably chosen by a signatory hereto.
4.
Full Force and Effect. Except as expressly supplemented hereby, the Guarantee and Collateral Agreement shall remain in full force
and effect.
5.
Severability. In case any provision in this Agreement or any other Transaction Document shall be invalid, illegal or unenforceable,
the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions shall not in any way be affected or impaired thereby.
6.
Notices. All communications and notices hereunder shall be in writing and given as provided in Section 8.2 of the Guarantee
and Collateral Agreement. All communications and notices hereunder to the Additional Guarantor shall be given to it at the address set
forth under its signature below.
7.
Fees and Expenses. The Additional Guarantor agrees to reimburse the Trustee for its reasonable and documented out-of-pocket expenses
in connection with the execution and delivery of this Assumption Agreement, including the reasonable fees and disbursements of outside
counsel for the Trustee.
8.
Governing Law. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED AND INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF
NEW YORK WITHOUT REGARD TO CONFLICTS OF LAW PRINCIPLES (OTHER THAN SECTIONS 5-1401 AND 5-1402 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATIONS LAW OF THE STATE
OF NEW YORK).
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has caused this Assumption Agreement to be duly executed and delivered as of the date first above written.
|
[ADDITIONAL
GUARANTOR] |
|
|
|
By: |
|
|
Name: |
|
|
Title: |
|
|
Address: |
|
|
Attention: |
|
|
Email: |
|
AGREED
TO AND ACCEPTED |
|
|
|
UMB
BANK, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
in its capacity as Trustee |
|
|
|
By: |
|
|
Name: |
|
|
Title: |
|
|
Annex
1-A
GUARANTOR
OWNERSHIP RELATIONSHIPS
ENTITY |
|
OWNED
BY |
|
SUBSIDIARIES |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Exhibit
10.2
MANAGEMENT
AGREEMENT
Dated
as of November 21, 2024
by
and among
TWIN
HOSPITALITY I, LLC, as Issuer,
THE
OTHER SECURITIZATION ENTITIES PARTY
HERETO
FROM TIME TO TIME,
TWIN
HOSPITALITY GROUP INC., as the Manager,
and
UMB
BANK, N.A., as the Trustee
TABLE
OF CONTENTS
|
|
Page |
|
|
|
Article
I DEFINITIONS |
2 |
Section
1.1 |
Certain
Definitions |
2 |
Section
1.2 |
Other
Defined Terms |
13 |
Section
1.3 |
Other
Terms |
13 |
Section
1.4 |
Computation
of Time Periods |
13 |
Section
1.5 |
Controlling
Class Representative |
13 |
|
|
|
Article
II ADMINISTRATION AND SERVICING OF MANAGED ASSETS |
14 |
Section
2.1 |
Manager
to Act as Manager |
14 |
Section
2.2 |
Accounts |
15 |
Section
2.3 |
Records |
18 |
Section
2.4 |
Administrative
Duties of Manager |
19 |
Section
2.5 |
No
Offset |
20 |
Section
2.6 |
Compensation
and Expenses |
20 |
Section
2.7 |
Indemnification |
20 |
Section
2.8 |
Nonpetition
Covenant |
21 |
Section
2.9 |
Franchisor
Consent |
22 |
Section
2.10 |
Appointment
of Sub-managers |
22 |
Section
2.11 |
Insurance/Condemnation
Proceeds |
22 |
Section
2.12 |
Permitted
Asset Dispositions |
22 |
Section
2.13 |
Manager
Advances |
22 |
Section
2.14 |
Product
Sourcing Advances |
23 |
Section
2.15 |
Rebate
Agreements |
23 |
Section
2.16 |
Qualified
Equity Offering Proceeds |
23 |
|
|
|
Article
III STATEMENTS AND REPORTS |
23 |
Section
3.1 |
Reporting
by the Manager |
23 |
Section
3.2 |
Appointment
of Independent Auditor |
24 |
Section
3.3 |
Annual
Accountants’ Reports |
25 |
Section
3.4 |
Available
Information |
25 |
|
|
|
Article
IV THE MANAGER |
25 |
Section
4.1 |
Representations
and Warranties Concerning the Manager |
25 |
Section
4.2 |
Existence;
Status as Manager |
28 |
Section
4.3 |
Performance
of Obligations |
28 |
Section
4.4 |
Merger
and Resignation |
31 |
Section
4.5 |
Notice
of Certain Events |
32 |
Section
4.6 |
Capitalization
and Indebtedness |
33 |
Section
4.7 |
Maintenance
of Separateness |
33 |
Section
4.8 |
Non-Petition |
34 |
Section
4.9 |
Competition |
34 |
|
|
|
Article
V REPRESENTATIONS, WARRANTIES AND COVENANTS |
34 |
Section
5.1 |
Representations
and Warranties Made in Respect of New Assets |
34 |
Section
5.2 |
Assets
Acquired After the Closing Date |
37 |
Section
5.3 |
Securitization
IP |
37 |
Section
5.4 |
Restrictions
on Liens |
37 |
TABLE OF CONTENTS CONTINUED
|
Page |
Article
VI MANAGER TERMINATION EVENTS |
38 |
Section
6.1 |
Manager
Termination Events |
38 |
Section
6.2 |
Manager
Termination Event Remedies |
40 |
Section
6.3 |
Manager’s
Transitional Role |
40 |
Section
6.4 |
Intellectual
Property |
41 |
Section
6.5 |
Third
Party Intellectual Property |
41 |
Section
6.6 |
No
Effect on Other Parties |
42 |
Section
6.7 |
Rights
Cumulative |
42 |
|
|
|
Article
VII CONFIDENTIALITY |
42 |
Section
7.1 |
Confidentiality |
42 |
|
|
|
Article
VIII MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS |
43 |
Section
8.1 |
Termination
of Agreement |
43 |
Section
8.2 |
Survival |
43 |
Section
8.3 |
Amendment |
43 |
Section
8.4 |
Governing
Law |
44 |
Section
8.5 |
Notices |
44 |
Section
8.6 |
Acknowledgement |
44 |
Section
8.7 |
Severability
of Provisions |
45 |
Section
8.8 |
Delivery
Dates |
45 |
Section
8.9 |
Limited
Recourse |
45 |
Section
8.10 |
Binding
Effect; Assignment; Third Party Beneficiaries |
45 |
Section
8.11 |
Article
and Section Headings |
45 |
Section
8.12 |
Concerning
the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party |
45 |
Section
8.13 |
Counterparts |
45 |
Section
8.14 |
Entire
Agreement |
45 |
Section
8.15 |
Waiver
of Jury Trial; Jurisdiction; Consent to Service of Process |
46 |
Section
8.16 |
Joinder
of New Guarantors |
46 |
Exhibit
A – Power of Attorney
Exhibit
B – Joinder Agreement
MANAGEMENT
AGREEMENT
This
MANAGEMENT AGREEMENT, dated as of November 21, 2024 (the “Closing Date”) (as the same may be amended, supplemented
or otherwise modified from time to time in accordance with the terms hereof, this “Agreement”), is entered into by
and among the following parties:
|
a) |
Twin Hospitality I, LLC,
a Delaware limited liability company (together with its successors and assigns, the “Issuer”); |
|
|
|
|
b) |
Twin Restaurant N Irving
Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company (the “Brewery Guarantor”); |
|
|
|
|
c) |
Twin Restaurant Franchise,
LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, and Twin Restaurant International Franchise, LLC, a Texas limited liability company (each,
a “Franchise Entity” and together with their respective successors and assigns, the “Franchise Entities”); |
|
|
|
|
d) |
TP Franchise Austin, LLC,
a Texas limited liability company, TP Franchise Round Rock, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, TP Franchise Venture I, LLC,
a Delaware limited liability company, TP Texas Beverages, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Peaks Buyer, LLC, a Delaware
limited liability company, Twin Restaurant, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Amarillo, LLC, a Texas limited
liability company, Twin Restaurant Amarillo Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Amarillo Management,
LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Beverage - Texas, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant
Beverage Holding, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Broomfield, LLC, a Colorado limited liability company,
Twin Restaurant Burleson, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Burleson Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited
liability company, Twin Restaurant Burleson Management, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Centennial, LLC,
a Colorado limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Denver, LLC, a Colorado limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Denver,
LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Development, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant El Paso,
LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant EL Paso Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant
Frisco, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant
Grand Prairie Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie Management, LLC, a Texas limited
liability company, Twin Restaurant Holding, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Investment Company, LLC, a
Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Investment Company II, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant IP,
LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Lewisville, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant
Little Rock, LLC, an Arkansas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Live Oak, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant
Live Oak Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Live Oak Management, LLC, a Texas limited liability
company, Twin Restaurant LV -2 LLC, a Nevada limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Midland, LLC, a Texas limited liability company,
Twin Restaurant Midland Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant N Irving, LLC, a Texas limited
liability company, Twin Restaurant Oakbrook, LLC, an Illinois limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Odessa, LLC, a Texas limited
liability company, Twin Restaurant Odessa Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Park North, LLC,
a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Park North Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant
Park North Management, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant RE, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant
S Fort Worth, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant S Fort Worth Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability
company, Twin Restaurant San Angelo, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant San Angelo Beverage Holding, LLC, a
Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant San Angelo Management, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant San
Antonio, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant San Antonio Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company,
Twin Restaurant San Marcos, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant San Marcos Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited
liability company, Twin Restaurant San Marcos Management, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Sunland Park, LLC,
a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Sunland Park Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant
Viva Las Vegas, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Warrenville, LLC, an Illinois limited liability company,
Twin Restaurant Western Center, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Western Center Beverage Holding, LLC, a Texas
limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Westover, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Westover Beverage Holding,
LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant JV Holding, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, TPJV2, LLC, a Delaware
limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Brandon, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant FL Payroll, LLC, a
Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant JV Management, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Lakeland,
LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Live Oak RE, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant McKinney,
LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant McKinney Beverage Holding, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company,
Twin Restaurant McKinney RE, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Northlake, LLC, a Texas limited liability
company, Twin Restaurant Plano, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Sarasota, LLC, a Delaware limited liability
company, Twin Restaurant Sarasota RE, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Terrell, LLC, a Delaware limited
liability company, Twin Restaurant Terrell Beverage Holding, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Twin Restaurant Terrell RE,
LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, Barbeque Integrated, Inc., a Delaware corporation, Smokey Bones (Florida), LLC, a Delaware
limited liability company, GMR of Pennsylvania-SB Properties, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company and Integrated Card Solutions,
LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (together with the Brewery Guarantor, the Franchise Entities, each Additional Guarantor
that may join this Agreement pursuant to Section 8.16 hereof and each of their respective successors and assigns, the “Guarantors”
and, each, a “Guarantor”, and the Guarantors together with the Issuer, the “Securitization Entities”); |
|
e) |
Twin Hospitality Group Inc., a Delaware corporation,
as Manager (in its individual capacity and as Manager, together with its successors and assigns, the “Manager”);
|
|
|
|
|
f) |
UMB Bank, N.A., not in its individual capacity but
solely as the indenture trustee (together with its successor and assigns, the “Trustee”); and |
|
|
|
|
g) |
consented to by Citadel SPV LLC, as Control Party. |
Capitalized
terms used herein but not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to such terms or incorporated by reference in Annex
A to the Base Indenture (as defined below).
RECITALS
WHEREAS,
the Issuer has entered into that certain Base Indenture, dated as of November 21, 2024, with the Trustee (together with the Series Supplements
thereto, and as the same may be amended, restated, supplemented, or otherwise modified from time to time in accordance with the terms
thereof, the “Indenture” or the “Base Indenture”), pursuant to which the Issuer is issuing the
Series 2024-1 Class A-2-I Notes, Class A-2-II Notes, Class B-2 Notes, Class M-2 Notes, Class A2IIB2 Notes and Class A2IIB2M2 Notes, and
may issue additional series of notes from time to time (collectively, the “Notes”) on the terms described therein;
WHEREAS,
the Issuer has granted to the Trustee on behalf of the Secured Parties a Lien in the Collateral owned by it pursuant to the terms of
the Indenture;
WHEREAS,
from and after the Closing Date, all New Assets have been and will continue to be originated by the Securitization Entities;
WHEREAS,
each of the Securitization Entities desires to enter into this Agreement to provide for, among other things, the managing of the respective
rights, powers, duties and obligations of the Securitization Entities under or in connection with the Company Restaurants (including
the related Company Restaurant Assets), the Contribution Agreements, the Company Restaurant Leases, the Development Agreements, the Equipment
Leases, the Franchise Agreements, the Franchisee Notes, the Product Sourcing Assets, the Real Estate Assets, the Securitization IP, the
New Assets and each Securitization Entity’s equity interests in each other Securitization Entity owned by it and in connection
with any other assets acquired by or transferred to the Securitization Entities (collectively, the “Managed Assets”),
and to enforce such Securitization Entity’s rights and powers and perform such Securitization Entity’s duties and obligations
under the Managed Documents (as defined below) and the Transaction Documents to which it is party, all in accordance with the Managing
Standard (as defined below);
WHEREAS,
each of the Guarantors desires to appoint (or reappoint, as applicable) the Manager as its agent for providing comprehensive Intellectual
Property services, including filing for registration, clearance, maintenance, protection, enforcement, licensing, and recording transfers
of the Securitization IP in accordance with the Managing Standard and as provided in Section 2.1(c) and Section 4.3(b);
and
WHEREAS,
the Manager desires to enforce such rights and powers and perform such obligations and duties, all in accordance with the Managing Standard.
NOW
THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the mutual agreements hereinafter set forth, the parties hereto agree as follows:
Article
I
DEFINITIONS
Section
1.1 Certain Definitions. For all purposes of this Agreement, capitalized terms used herein but not otherwise defined herein shall
have the meanings ascribed thereto in Annex A to the Base Indenture. In addition, the following terms shall have the following
meanings:
“Acceptable
Exchange” means any of the following markets or exchanges on which the Pledged Shares are listed or quoted for trading on the
date in question: the Nasdaq Capital Market, the Nasdaq Global Market, the Nasdaq Global Select Market, the New York Stock exchange,
or the NYSE American or any other “national securities exchange” designated as such from time to time by the United States
Securities and Exchange Commission and acceptable to the “Controlling Class Representative” (as defined under the FBRH Indenture).
“Advertising
Fees” has the meaning set forth in Section 2.2(d).
“Advertising
Fund Account” has the meaning set forth in Section 2.2(d).
“After-Acquired
Securitization IP” means all Securitization IP acquired by a Guarantor after the Closing Date pursuant to an IP Licensing Agreement
or otherwise.
“Agreement”
has the meaning set forth in the preamble.
“Beer
Distributor” means Ben E. Keith Company, a Texas corporation.
“Branded
Restaurant” means collectively the Franchised Restaurants and the Company Restaurants.
“Change
in Management” will occur if more than 50% of the Leadership Team is terminated and/or resigns within 12 months after the date
of the occurrence of a Change of Control; provided, in each case, that termination and/or resignation of such officer will not include
(i) a change in such officer’s status in the ordinary course of succession so long as such officer remains affiliated with the
Manager or its Subsidiaries as an officer or director, or in a similar capacity, (ii) retirement of any officer or (iii) death or incapacitation
of any officer; provided further, and notwithstanding the foregoing, a “Change in Management” shall not be deemed to occur
if arising from or in connection with a Qualified Equity Offering.
“Change
of Control” means an event or a series of events by which (a) individuals who on the date hereof constituted the Board of Directors
of the Manager, together with any new directors whose election by the Board of Directors or whose nomination for election by the equity
holders of the Manager was approved by a majority of the directors then still in office who were either directors or whose election or
nomination for election was previously so approved, cease for any reason to constitute a majority of the Board of Directors of the Manager
then in office or (b) any “person” or “group” (as such terms are used for purposes of Sections 13(d) and 14(d)
of the Exchange Act) other than FAT Brands or its Affiliates is or becomes the “beneficial owner” (as such term is used in
Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange Act), directly or indirectly, of more than 50% of the total voting power of the issued and outstanding
voting stock of the Manager; provided, and notwithstanding the foregoing, a “Change of Control” shall not be deemed to occur
due to the reorganization transactions contemplated by the Manager prior to the Twin Peaks Listing Event as described in the Form 10
filed by the Manager on November 1, 2024.
“Company
Restaurant(s)” means any Branded Restaurant(s) that are owned and operated by one or more Securitization Entities, including
Branded Restaurants that a Securitization Entity reacquires from Franchisees from time to time.
“Company
Restaurant Account” has the meaning set forth in Section 2.2(h).
“Company
Restaurant Assets” means all of the assets owned by a Company Restaurant Guarantor associated with owning and operating the
Company Restaurants (such as furnishings, cooking equipment, cooking supplies and computer equipment).
“Company
Restaurant Collections” means all cash revenues (including gift card redemption amounts but excluding proceeds of the initial
sale of gift cards), credit card and debit card proceeds generated by Company Restaurants including Pass-Through Amounts.
“Company
Restaurant Guarantors” means (i) TP Franchise Austin, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (ii) TP Franchise Round Rock,
LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (iii) Twin Restaurant Amarillo, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (iv) Twin Restaurant
Broomfield, LLC, a Colorado limited liability company; (v) Twin Restaurant Burleson, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (vi) Twin
Restaurant Centennial, LLC, a Colorado limited liability company; (vii) Twin Restaurant Denver, LLC, a Colorado limited liability company;
(viii) Twin Restaurant Denver, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (ix) Twin Restaurant El Paso, LLC, a Texas limited liability company;
(x) Twin Restaurant Frisco, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xi) Twin Restaurant Grand Prairie, LLC, a Texas limited liability
company; (xii) Twin Restaurant Lewisville, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xiii) Twin Restaurant Little Rock, LLC, an Arkansas
limited liability company; (xiv) Twin Restaurant Live Oak, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xv) Twin Restaurant LV -2, LLC, a
Nevada limited liability company; (xvi) Twin Restaurant Midland, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xvii) Twin Restaurant N Irving,
LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xviii) Twin Restaurant Oakbrook, LLC, an Illinois limited liability company; (xix) Twin Restaurant
Odessa, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xx) Twin Restaurant Park North, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxi) Twin Restaurant
S Fort Worth, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxii) Twin Restaurant San Angelo, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxiii)
Twin Restaurant San Antonio, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxiv) Twin Restaurant San Marcos, LLC, a Texas limited liability
company; (xxv) Twin Restaurant Sunland Park, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxvi) Twin Restaurant Warrenville, LLC, an Illinois
limited liability company; (xxvii) Twin Restaurant Western Center, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxviii) Twin Restaurant Westover,
LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxix) TPJV2, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xxx) Twin Restaurant Brandon, LLC,
a Delaware limited liability company; (xxxi) Twin Restaurant JV Management, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xxxii) Twin Restaurant
Lakeland, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xxxiii) Twin Restaurant McKinney, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xxxiv)
Twin Restaurant Northlake, LLC, a Texas limited liability company; (xxxv) Twin Restaurant Plano, LLC, a Texas limited liability company;
(xxxvi) Twin Restaurant Terrell, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; (xxxvii) Barbeque Integrated, Inc., a Delaware corporation;
(xxxviii) Twin Restaurant Sarasota, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company; and (xxxix) any Additional Guarantor that is designated
as a “Company Restaurant Guarantor”.
“Company
Restaurant Leases” means the leases from landlords related to properties on which Company Restaurants are located that were
contributed to, distributed to or otherwise acquired by a Company Restaurant Guarantor on or prior to the Closing Date.
“Company
Restaurant Licenses” means any IP license granted by a Guarantor with respect to a Company Restaurant.
“Company
Restaurant Royalty Payments” means the royalty payments paid by the Company Restaurant Guarantors to the Concentration Account
pursuant to the Management Agreement in an amount equal to 5% of Company Restaurant Collections.
“Confidential
Information” means trade secrets and other information (including know how, ideas, techniques, recipes, formulas, customer
lists, customer information, financial information, business methods and processes, marketing plans, specifications, and other similar
information as well as internal materials prepared by the owner of such information containing or based, in whole or in part, on any
such information) that is confidential and proprietary to its owner and that is disclosed by one party to an agreement to another party
thereto whether in writing or disclosed orally, and whether or not designated as confidential.
“Controlled
Group” means any group of trades or businesses (whether or not incorporated) under common control within the meaning of Section
4001(b)(1) of ERISA that is treated as a single employer for purposes of Section 302 or Title IV of ERISA.
“Current
Practice” means, in respect of any action or inaction, the practices, standards and procedures of the Securitization Entities
or the Manager on their behalf as performed on or that would have been performed immediately before the Closing Date.
“Defective
New Asset” means any New Asset that does not satisfy the applicable representations and warranties of ARTICLE V hereof
on the New Asset Addition Date for such New Asset.
“Development
Agreement” means a development agreement for a Branded Restaurant pursuant to which a Franchisee, developer or other Person
obtains the rights to develop (in order to operate as a Franchisee) one or more Branded Restaurants within a designated geographical
area.
“Discloser”
has the meaning set forth in Section 7.1.
“Disentanglement”
has the meaning set forth in Section 6.3(a).
“Disentanglement
Period” means the period commencing on the (A) delivery of the Termination Notice to the Manager (or date of automatic termination,
upon the occurrence of any Manager Termination Event described in clauses (vi) or (vii) in the definition of Manager Termination Event)
or (B) delivery of a resignation notice by the Manager and ending on the date on which a Successor Manager or the re-engaged Manager
assumes all of the obligations of the Manager under this Agreement.
“Distribution
Agreement” means the Distribution Agreement, dated January 27, 2014, between the Beer Distributor and the Brewery Guarantor,
pursuant to which the Beer Distributor sells and distributes the Brewery’s beer to Branded Restaurants in the State of Texas.
“Distributor”
means any distributor (including the Beer Distributor) of Products to Franchisees, Company Restaurants or any other Persons.
“Equipment
Lease” means any equipment lease pursuant to which a Franchisee leases from a Securitization Entity equipment used to operate
a Branded Restaurant, together with any residual interest in the related equipment and any security interest in such equipment.
“Final
Offering Memorandum” means the offering memorandum, dated as of November 20, 2024.
“Franchise
Agreements” means a franchise agreement whereby a Franchisee agrees to operate a Branded Restaurant.
“Franchise
Entities” has the meaning set forth in the preamble.
“Franchised
Restaurant Leases” means (a) leases from landlords unaffiliated with the Securitization Entities in respect of which a Securitization
Entity is the prime lessee and a Franchisee or other Person is the sub-lessee executed or acquired by such Securitization Entity and
(b) leases or subleases in respect of which a Securitization Entity is the lessor or sublessor and a Franchisee or other Person is the
lessee or sublessee.
“Franchised
Restaurants” means a Branded Restaurant owned and operated by a Franchisee.
“Franchisee
Note” means any franchisee note entered into by a Securitization Entity or any other franchisee note or other franchisee financing
agreement entered into in order to finance the payment of franchisee fees or other amounts owing by a Franchisee.
“Guarantors”
has the meaning set forth in the preamble.
“Indemnitee”
has the meaning set forth in Section 2.7(a).
“Indenture”
has the meaning set forth in the recitals.
“Independent
Auditors” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.2.
“IP
License Agreement” means any license to or for the use of Intellectual Property to which a Guarantor is a party.
“IP
Services” means (i) performing and exercising each Guarantor’s rights and obligations under any IP License Agreement
(and any other agreements pursuant to which each Guarantor licenses the use of any Securitization IP); and (ii) acquiring, developing,
managing, maintaining, protecting, enforcing, defending, licensing, sublicensing and undertaking such duties and services as may be necessary
in connection with the Securitization IP and other intellectual property owned or held by each Guarantor, in each case in accordance
with and subject to the terms of the Management Agreement (including the Managing Standard, unless a Guarantor determines, in its sole
discretion, that additional action is necessary or desirable in furtherance of the protection of the Securitization IP, in which case
the Manager shall perform such IP Services and additional related services as are reasonably requested by such Guarantor), the Indenture,
the other Transaction Documents and the Managed Documents, as agent for the Guarantors, including the following activities: (a) searching,
screening and clearing After-Acquired Securitization IP to assess patentability, registrability and the risk of potential infringement;
(b) filing, prosecuting and maintaining applications and registrations for the Securitization IP in the applicable Guarantor’s
name throughout the world, including timely filing of evidence of use, applications for renewal and affidavits of use and/or incontestability,
timely paying of all registration and maintenance fees, responding to third-party oppositions of applications or challenges to registrations,
and responding to any office actions, reexaminations, interferences, “inter partes” reviews, post grant reviews, or other
office or examiner requests, reviews, or requirements; (c) monitoring third-party use and registration of Trademarks and taking actions
the Manager deems appropriate to oppose or contest the use and any application or registration for Trademarks that could reasonably be
expected to infringe, dilute or otherwise violate the Securitization IP or the applicable Guarantor’s rights therein; (d) confirming
each Guarantor’s legal title in and to any or all of the Securitization IP, including obtaining written assignments of Securitization
IP to the applicable Guarantor and recording transfers of title in the appropriate intellectual property registry in the United States;
(e) with respect to each Guarantor’s rights and obligations under the IP License Agreement and any Transaction Documents, monitoring
the licensee’s use of each licensed Trademark and the quality of its goods and services offered in connection with such Trademarks,
rendering any approvals (or disapprovals) that are required under the applicable license agreement(s), and employing reasonable means
to ensure that any use of any such Trademarks by any such licensee satisfies the quality control standards and usage provisions of the
applicable license agreement; (f) protecting, policing, and, in the event that the Manager becomes aware of any unlicensed copying, imitation,
infringement, dilution, misappropriation, unauthorized use or other violation of the Securitization IP, or any portion thereof, enforcing
such Securitization IP, including, (i) preparing and responding to cease-and-desist, demand and notice letters, and requests for a license;
and (ii) commencing, prosecuting and/or resolving claims or suits involving imitation, infringement, dilution, misappropriation, the
unauthorized use or other violation of the Securitization IP, and seeking monetary and equitable remedies as the Manager deems appropriate
in connection therewith; provided that each Guarantor shall, and agrees to, join as a party to any such suits to the extent necessary
to maintain standing; (g) performing such functions and duties, and preparing and filing such documents, as are required under the Indenture
or any other Transaction Document to be performed, prepared and/or filed by the applicable Guarantor, including (i) executing and recording
such financing statements (including continuation statements) or amendments thereof or supplements thereto or such other instruments
as the Guarantors or the Control Party may, from time to time, reasonably request (consistent with the obligations of the Guarantors
to perfect the Trustee’s lien only in the United States) in connection with the security interests in the Securitization IP granted
by each Guarantor to the Trustee under the Transaction Documents and (ii) preparing, executing and delivering grants of security interests
or any similar instruments as the Securitization Entities or the Control Party may, from time to time, reasonably request (consistent
with the obligations of the Guarantors to perfect the Trustee’s lien only in the United States) that are intended to evidence such
security interests in the Securitization IP and recording such grants or other instruments with the relevant Governmental Authority including
the PTO and the United States Copyright Office; (h) taking such actions as any licensee under an IP License Agreement may request that
are required by the terms, provisions and purposes of such IP License Agreement (or by any other agreements pursuant to which the applicable
Guarantor licenses the use of any Securitization IP) to be taken by the applicable Guarantor, and preparing (or causing to be prepared)
for execution by each Guarantor all documents, certificates and other filings as each Guarantor shall be required to prepare and/or file
under the terms of such IP License Agreement (or such other agreements); (i) paying or causing to be paid or discharged, from funds of
the Securitization Entities, any and all taxes, charges and assessments that may be levied, assessed or imposed upon any of the Securitization
IP or contesting the same in good faith; (j) obtaining licenses of third party Intellectual Property for use and sublicense in connection
with the Restaurant Business and the other assets of the Securitization Entities; (k) sublicensing the Securitization IP to suppliers,
manufacturers, advertisers and other service providers in connection with the provision of products and services for use in the Restaurant
Business; and (l) with respect to Trade Secrets and other confidential information of each Guarantor, taking all reasonable measures
to maintain confidentiality and to prevent non-confidential disclosures.
“Leadership
Team” means the persons holding the following offices immediately prior to the date of the occurrence of a Change of Control:
Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Chief Marketing Officer, or any other position that contains substantially the same
responsibilities as of any of the positions listed above.
“Licensees”
means, collectively, the Franchisees and the Company Restaurant Guarantors.
“Managed
Assets” has the meaning set forth in the recitals.
“Managed
Document” means any contract, agreement, arrangement or undertaking relating to any of the Managed Assets, including the Contribution
Agreements, the Franchise Documents, the Franchisee Notes, the Equipment Leases, the Product Sourcing Agreements and the IP License Agreements.
“Manager”
means Manager, in its capacity as manager hereunder, unless a successor Person shall have become the Manager pursuant to the applicable
provisions of the Indenture and this Agreement, and thereafter “Manager” shall mean such successor Person.
“Manager
Advance” means any advance of funds made by the Manager to, or on behalf of, a Securitization Entity in connection with the
operation of the Managed Assets.
“Manager-Developed
IP” means all Intellectual Property (other than Excluded IP) created, developed, authored, acquired or owned by or on behalf
of the Manager and related to (i) any of the Brands, (ii) products or services sold or distributed under any of the Brands, (iii)
the Twin Hospitality Systems, or (iv) the Restaurant Business.
“Manager
Termination Event” has the meaning set forth in Section 6.1(a).
“Managing
Standard” means standards that (a) are consistent with Current Practice or, to the extent of changed circumstances, practices,
technologies, strategies or implementation methods, consistent with the standards as the Manager would implement or observe if the Managed
Assets were owned by the Manager at such time; (b) are consistent with Ongoing Practice; (c) will enable the Manager to comply in all
material respects with all of the duties and obligations of the Securitization Entities under the Transaction Documents, the Managed
Documents and the Franchised Restaurant Leases; (d) are in material compliance with all applicable Requirements of Law; and (e) with
respect to the use and maintenance of the Guarantors’ rights in and to the Securitization IP, are consistent with the standards
imposed by the IP License Agreements.
“Monthly
Management Fee” means, with respect to each Monthly Allocation Date, the amount of $291,667.66, subject to successive three
percent (3%) annual increases; provided, with the consent of the Control Party, acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative,
such Monthly Management Fee can be increased in the event there is a Successor Manager; provided, further, that such fee shall be waivable
by the Manager in its sole discretion following the occurrence of a Twin Peaks Listing Event.
“New
Asset” means a New Franchise Agreement, a New Development Agreement, a New Real Estate Asset, New Company Restaurant (including
the related Company Restaurant Assets), a New Franchisee Note, a New Equipment Lease, a New Product Sourcing Asset or New Company Restaurant
Lease entered into or acquired by a Securitization Entity after the Closing Date or any other Managed Asset contributed or otherwise
entered into or acquired by the Securitization Entities after the Closing Date.
“New
Asset Addition Date” means, with respect to any New Asset, the earliest of (i) the date on which such New Asset is acquired
by the applicable Securitization Entity, (ii) the later of (a) the date upon which the closing occurs under the applicable contract giving
rise to such New Asset and (b) the date upon which all of the diligence contingencies, if any, in the contract for purchase of the applicable
New Asset expire and the Securitization Entity acquiring such New Asset no longer has the right to cancel such contract and (iii) if
such New Asset is a New Franchise Agreement, New Development Agreement, New Franchisee Note or New Equipment Lease, the date on which
the related Securitization Entity begins receiving payments from the applicable Franchisee in respect of such New Asset and (iv) if such
New Asset is a New Product Sourcing Asset, the date on which such New Product Sourcing Asset is acquired or becomes effective in accordance
with the terms thereof.
“New
Company Restaurant Leases” means all Company Restaurant Leases entered into by a Securitization Entity following the Closing
Date.
“New
Company Restaurants” means all Company Restaurants acquired by a Securitization Entity following the Closing Date.
“New
Leased Real Property” has the meaning set forth in Section 5.1(d).
“New
Development Agreements” means all Development Agreements and related guaranty agreements entered into by a Securitization Entity
following the Closing Date.
“New
Equipment Leases” means all Equipment Leases and related guaranty agreements entered into by a Securitization Entity following
the Closing Date.
“New
Franchise Agreements” means all Franchise Agreements and related guaranty agreements entered into by a Securitization Entity
following the Closing Date, in its capacity as franchisor for Branded Restaurants.
“New
Franchised Restaurant Leases” means all Franchised Restaurant Leases and related documents acquired by a Securitization Entity
following the Closing Date.
“New
Franchisee Notes” means all Franchisee Notes and related guaranty and collateral agreements entered into by a Securitization
Entity following the Closing Date.
“New
Owned Real Property” means all Owned Real Property and related agreements acquired by a Securitization Entity following the
Closing Date.
“New
Product Sourcing Agreement” means all Product Sourcing Agreements entered into by a Securitization Entity following the Closing
Date.
“New
Product Sourcing Assets” means all Product Sourcing Assets and related agreements entered into by a Securitization Entity following
the Closing Date.
“New
Real Estate Assets” means collectively, the New Owned Real Property, the New Franchised Restaurant Leases and the New Company
Restaurant Leases.
“Notes”
has the meaning set forth in the preamble.
“Offering
Memorandum” means, collectively, the Preliminary Offering Memorandum and the Final Offering Memorandum.
“Ongoing
Practice” means, in respect of any action or inaction, practices, standards and procedures that are at least as favorable or
beneficial as the practices, standards and procedures of any Company Restaurant Guarantor as performed with respect to any Branded Restaurant
so long as such practices, standards and procedures with respect to any Branded Restaurant are applicable and reasonably practical to
implement with respect to the Brands.
“Owned
Real Property” means the real property (including the land, buildings and fixtures) owned in fee (as of the Closing Date) by
a Securitization Entity.
“Pledge
Agreement” means that certain Pledge and Security Agreement, to be dated on or about November 21, 2024, by FAT Brands Inc.
in favor of UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee under the Base Indenture, dated as of July 10, 2023 (as amended, restated, modified or otherwise
supplemented from time to time, the “FBRH Indenture”), between FB Resid Holdings I, LLC and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee.
“Pledged
Shares” means the shares of Class A Common Stock, par value $0.0001 per share, of Twin Hospitality Group Inc. (or its successor)
that are owned by FAT Brands and not distributed to its shareholders at the time of the Twin Peaks Listing Event.
“Pension
Plan” means any “employee pension benefit plan,” as such term is defined in Section 3(2) of ERISA (other than a
Multiemployer Plan), which is subject to Title IV of ERISA and to which any company in the same Controlled Group as the Manager has liability,
including any liability by reason of having been a substantial employer within the meaning of Section 4063 of ERISA for any time within
the preceding five (5) years or by reason of being deemed to be a contributing sponsor under Section 4069 of ERISA.
“Post-Opening
Services” means the services required to be performed under the applicable Franchise Documents by the applicable Securitization
Entities after the initial opening of a Franchised Restaurant, in each case in accordance with and subject to the terms of this Agreement
(including, for the avoidance of doubt, the Managing Standard), the Indenture, the other Transaction Documents and the Managed Documents,
including, as may be required under the applicable Franchise Document, (a) meeting with the franchise association for each Brand; (b)
providing such Franchisee with the standards established or approved by the applicable Guarantor for use of the applicable Brand; (c)
establishing standards of quality, cleanliness, appearance and service at such Franchised Restaurant; (d) collecting and administering
the Advertising Fees received pursuant to the applicable Franchise Agreements and the development of all national advertising and promotional
programs for the applicable Brand and Branded Restaurants; (e) inspecting such Franchised Restaurant; (f) collecting and administering
amounts received under Franchise Agreements in respect of any Brand technology fund and the development of certain of restaurant-level
and above-restaurant-level technology systems; (g) providing such Franchisee with the Manager’s ongoing training programs and materials
designed for use in the Franchised Restaurants; and (h) such other post-opening services as are required to be performed under applicable
Franchise Documents; provided that “Post-Opening Services” provided by the Manager hereunder shall not include any “add-on”
type corporate services provided by Manager or any Subsidiary thereof to a Franchisee, whether pursuant to the related Franchise Agreement
or otherwise, the cost of which is not included in the royalties payable to the relevant Guarantor under such Franchise Agreement, including,
repairs and maintenance, gift card administration, employee training, point-of-sale system maintenance and support and development and
maintenance of restaurant-level and above-restaurant-level technology systems and other information technology systems, including via
any Franchisee supported Brand technology fund. The Manager provides very similar services after the opening of a Company Restaurant.
“Power
of Attorney” means the authority granted by a Securitization Entity to the Manager pursuant to a Power of Attorney in substantially
the form set forth as Exhibit A hereto.
“Preliminary
Offering Memorandum” means the preliminary offering memorandum, dated as of November 14, 2024.
“Pre-Opening
Services” means the services required to be performed under the applicable Franchise Documents by the applicable Securitization
Entities prior to the initial opening of a Franchised Restaurant, in each case in accordance with and subject to the terms of this Agreement
(including, for the avoidance of doubt, the Managing Standard), the Indenture, the other Transaction Documents and the Managed Documents,
including, as required under the applicable Franchise Document, (a) providing the applicable Franchisee with standards for the design,
construction, equipping and operation of such Franchised Restaurant and the approval of locations meeting such standards; (b) providing
such Franchisee with the Manager’s programs and materials designed for use in the Franchised Restaurants; (c) providing such Franchisee
with manuals, operating guidelines and similar materials, as applicable; and (d) providing such Franchisee with such other assistance
in the pre-opening, opening and initial operation of such Franchised Restaurant, as is required to be provided under applicable Franchise
Documents; provided that “Pre-Opening Services” provided by the Manager hereunder shall not include any “add-on”
type corporate services provided by Manager or any Subsidiary thereof to a Franchisee, whether pursuant to the related Franchise Agreement
or otherwise, the cost of which is not included in the royalties payable to the relevant Guarantor under such Franchise Agreement, including,
repairs and maintenance, gift card administration, employee training, point-of-sale system maintenance and support and development and
maintenance of restaurant-level and above-restaurant-level technology systems and other information technology systems, including via
any Franchisee supported Brand technology fund. The Manager provides very similar services prior to the opening of a Company Restaurant.
“Product
Sourcing Advance” has the meaning ascribed to such term in Section 2.14.
“Product
Sourcing Agreements” means all agreements for (a) the manufacture and production of Products and (b) the sale of Products to
Distributors including the Distribution Agreement for the manufacture and supply of products for re-sale to certain Franchisees, Company
Restaurants or any other Persons.
“Product
Sourcing Assets” means, with respect to each Guarantor, (i) the Product Sourcing Agreements and all Product Sourcing Payments
thereon; (ii) the New Product Sourcing Agreements and all Product Sourcing Payments thereon; (iii) all rights to enter into New Product
Sourcing Agreements and (iv) any and all other property of every nature, now or hereafter transferred, mortgaged, pledged, or assigned
as security for payment or performance of any obligation of any Person to such Guarantor under the Product Sourcing Agreements and all
guarantees of such obligations and the rights evidenced by or reflected in the Product Sourcing Agreements, in each case together with
all payments, proceeds and accrued and future rights to payment thereon.
“Product
Sourcing Payments” means all amounts payable to a Guarantor by Distributors with respect to purchases of Products.
“Products”
means any good sold by any Distributor to a Licensee or any other Person pursuant to current practices, a Product Sourcing Agreement
or otherwise.
“Qualified
Equity Offering” means a public or private offering or issuance by Twin Hospitality Group Inc. of its common equity securities
(including securities convertible into or exchangeable for its common equity securities) for cash, excluding (i) any offer, grant or
issuance of securities pursuant to a stock option or equity incentive plan approved by the Board of Directors of Twin Hospitality Group
Inc. for the benefit of its officers, directors or employees, (ii) any issuance of securities as consideration for the consummation of
any merger or acquisition, partnership, joint venture or strategic alliance for primarily non-capital raising purposes, and (iii) the
issuance of equity securities upon exercise or conversion of any options, warrants or convertible securities from time to time outstanding.
“Qualified
Equity Offering Proceeds” means amounts received from the net proceeds received by Twin Hospitality Group Inc. pursuant to
a Qualified Equity Offering.
“Real
Estate Assets” means the Owned Real Property, the Franchised Restaurant Leases and the Company Restaurant Leases.
“Real
Estate Services” means acquiring, developing, managing, maintaining, protecting, enforcing, defending, leasing and undertaking
such other duties and services as may be necessary in connection with the Real Estate Assets, on behalf of each Guarantor, in each case
in accordance with and subject to the terms of this Agreement (including, for the avoidance of doubt, the Managing Standard), the Indenture,
the other Transaction Documents and the Managed Documents, as agent for the Guarantors, including the following activities: (a) the negotiation,
execution and recording (as appropriate) of leases, subleases, deeds and other contracts and agreements relating to the Real Estate Assets;
(b) the management of the Real Estate Assets on behalf of each Guarantor, including (i) the management of the Owned Real Property and
New Owned Real Property, (ii) the enforcement and exercise of each Guarantor’s rights under each lease included in the Real Estate
Assets, (iii) the payment, extension, renewal, modification, adjustment, prosecution, defense, compromise or submission to arbitration
or mediation of any obligation, suit, liability, cause of action or claim, including taxes, relating to any Real Estate Assets and (iv)
the collection of any amounts payable to each Guarantor under the Real Estate Assets, including rent; (c) causing each Guarantor to (i)
acquire and enter into agreements to acquire Real Estate Assets and (ii) sell, assign, transfer, encumber or otherwise dispose of all
or any portion of the Real Estate Assets in accordance with the Management Agreement and the Indenture; (iii) conduct environmental evaluation
and remediation activities on any real property owned or leased by each Guarantor as deemed appropriate by the Manager or as otherwise
required under applicable Requirements of Law; (iv) obtaining appropriate levels of title and property insurance with respect to each
parcel of Owned Real Property and New Owned Real Property; provided that the level of title insurance maintained on the Closing Date
for each parcel of Owned Real Property or the New Owned Real Property owned by a Guarantor on the Closing Date will be deemed to be the
appropriate level of title insurance for such Owned Real Property and the New Owned Real Property (whether or not owned on the Closing
Date) on and after the Closing Date for purposes of this clause (c); (d) making or causing to be made all repairs and replacements to
the existing improvements and the construction of new improvements on the Real Estate Assets; (e) the employment of agents, managers,
brokers or other Persons necessary or appropriate to acquire, dispose of, maintain, own, lease, manage and operate the Real Estate Assets;
(f) paying or causing to be paid any and all taxes, charges and assessments that may be levied, assessed or imposed upon any of the Real
Estate Assets or contesting the same in good faith; and (g) all other actions or decisions relating to the acquisition, disposition,
amendment, termination, maintenance, ownership, leasing, sub-leasing, management and operation of the Real Estate Assets.
“Recipient”
has the meaning ascribed to such term in Section 7.1.
“Restaurant
Business” means the business of franchising, licensing or owning Branded Restaurants located in the United States, the manufacturing
and sale of Products for use at Branded Restaurants located in the United States and the provision of ancillary goods and services in
connection therewith.
“Restaurant
Operating Expenses” means (a) operating expenses that are incurred by or allocated, in accordance with the Managing Standard,
to Company Restaurants in the ordinary course of business relating to the operation of the Company Restaurants, such as the cost of goods
sold, labor (including wages, workers’ compensation-related expenses and other labor-related expenses for employees in respect
of Company Restaurants), repair and maintenance expenses, insurance (including self-insurance), (b) local advertising expenses and Advertising
Fees allocable to the Company Restaurants, (c) lease payments to third party landlords with respect to the Company Restaurants, (d) Pass-Through
Amounts with respect to the Company Restaurants, (e) debt service and other amounts required to be paid in respect of Prospective Company
Restaurant Properties and (f) amounts required to be paid with respect to the Company Restaurants in connection with the Company Restaurant
Royalty Payments, if any.
“Securitization
Entities” has the meaning set forth in the preamble.
“Services”
means the servicing and administration by the Manager of the Managed Assets, in each case in accordance with and subject to the terms
of the Management Agreement (including the Managing Standard), the Indenture, the other Transaction Documents and the Managed Documents
for the applicable Securitization Entity, including, without limitation: (a) calculating and compiling information required in connection
with any report or certificate to be delivered pursuant to the Transaction Documents; (b) preparing and filing all tax returns and tax
reports required to be prepared by any Securitization Entity; (c) paying or causing to be paid or discharged, in each case from funds
of the Securitization Entities, any and all taxes, charges and assessments required to be paid under applicable Requirements of Law by
any Securitization Entity; (d) performing the duties and obligations of, and exercising and enforcing the rights of, the Securitization
Entities under the Transaction Documents, including performing the duties and obligations of each applicable Securitization Entity under
the IP License Agreements; (e) taking those actions that are required under the Transaction Documents and Requirements of Law to maintain
continuous perfection (where applicable) and priority (subject to Permitted Liens and the exclusions from perfection requirements under
the Indenture) of any Securitization Entity’s and the Trustee’s respective interests in the Collateral; (f) making or causing
the collection of amounts owing under the terms and provisions of each Managed Document and the Transaction Documents, including managing
(i) the applicable Securitization Entities’ rights and obligations under the Franchise Agreements and the Development Agreements
(including performing Pre-Opening Services and Post-Opening Services) and (ii) the right to approve amendments, waivers, modifications
and terminations of (including extensions, modifications, write-downs and write-offs of obligations owing under) Franchise Documents
and other Managed Documents (which amendments to Franchise Agreements may be effected by replacing such Franchise Agreement with a New
Franchise Agreement on the then-current form of the applicable Franchise Agreement (which New Franchise Agreement may be executed by
a different Franchise Entity than is party to such existing Franchise Agreement)) and to exercise all rights of the applicable Securitization
Entities under such Franchise Documents and other Managed Documents; (g) performing due diligence with respect to, selecting and approving
new Franchisees, performing due diligence with respect to and approving extensions of credit to Franchisees pursuant to New Franchisee
Notes and New Equipment Leases and providing personnel to manage the due diligence, selection and approval process; (h) preparing New
Assets, including, among other things, adopting variations to the forms of agreements used in documenting such agreements and preparing
and executing documentation of assignments, transfers, terminations, renewals, site relocations and ownership changes, in all cases,
subject to and in accordance with the terms of the Transaction Documents; (i) evaluating and approving assignments of Franchise Agreements,
Development Agreements, Franchisee Notes and Equipment Leases (and related documents) to third-party franchisee candidates or existing
Franchisees and, in accordance with the Managing Standard, arranging for the assignment of Franchise Agreements and related Guarantor
Assets to a Non-Securitization Entity until such time as the applicable restaurant is re-franchised to a third party franchisee (a “Reacquired
Restaurant”); (j) preparing and filing franchise disclosure documents with respect to New Assets complying with franchise industry
specific government regulation and applicable Requirements of Law; (k) making Manager Advances and Product Sourcing Advances in its sole
discretion; (l) administering the Advertising Fund Accounts and the Management Accounts; (m) performing the duties and obligations and
enforcing the rights of the Securitization Entities under the Managed Documents, including entering into new Managed Documents from time
to time; (n) arranging for legal services with respect to the Managed Assets, including with respect to the enforcement of the Managed
Documents; (o) arranging for or providing accounting and financial reporting services; (p) administering payments from Franchisees and
Company Restaurant Guarantors for the development of restaurant-level and above-restaurant-level technology systems; (q) performing due
diligence with respect to, selecting and approving new manufacturers and distributors of Products and providing personnel to manage the
due diligence, selection and approval process; (r) preparing Product Sourcing Agreements, subject to and in accordance with the terms
of the Transaction Documents, and administering the purchase and sale of Products; (s) establishing and servicing supply chain programs
with respect to the Branded Restaurants; (t) establishing and/or providing quality control services and standards for food, equipment,
suppliers and distributors in connection with the Restaurant Business (including, without limitation, with respect to Product Sourcing
Agreements) and monitoring compliance with such standards; (u) performing services with respect to the Product Sourcing Assets and the
Brewery; (v) developing new products and services (or modifying any existing products and services) to be offered in connection with
the Restaurant Business and the other assets of the Securitization Entities; (w) in connection with the Restaurant Business, developing,
modifying, amending and disseminating (i) specifications for restaurant operations, (ii) manuals, operating guidelines and similar materials,
as applicable, and (iii) new menu items; (x) performing services with respect to the Real Estate Assets as described below; (y) performing
services with respect to the Company Restaurants and Company Restaurant Assets; (z) performing the IP Services; (aa) developing and administering
advertising, marketing and promotional programs relating to the Brands and Branded Restaurants; (bb) cooperating with all reasonable
requests of the Control Party and/or Back-Up Manager in connection with the performance by such parties of their respective obligations
under the Transaction Documents; (cc) obtaining and maintaining applicable liquor licenses and perform any other services that the Manager
deems necessary or advisable to operate the Company Restaurants; and (dd) performing such other services as may be necessary or appropriate
from time to time and consistent with the Managing Standard and the Transaction Documents in connection with the Managed Assets.
“Sub-manager”
has the meaning set forth in Section 2.10.
“Sub-managing
Arrangement” means an arrangement whereby the Manager engages any other Person (including any Affiliate) to perform certain
of its duties under this Agreement excluding the fundamental corporate functions of the Manager; provided that (i) area development agreements
and master franchise arrangements with Franchisees and temporary arrangements with Franchisees with respect to the management of one
or more Branded Restaurants immediately following the termination of the former Franchisee thereof, and (ii) any agreement between the
Manager and third-party vendors pursuant to which the Manager purchases a specific product or service or outsources routine administrative
functions shall not constitute a Sub-managing Arrangement.
“Term”
has the meaning set forth in Section 8.1.
“Termination
Notice” has the meaning set forth in Section 6.1(a).
“Trustee”
has the meaning set forth in the preamble.
“Twin
Peaks Listing Event” mean the date on which (i) the dividend of distribution of approximately 5% of the Class A common stock
of Twin Hospitality Group Inc. to the shareholders of FAT Brands, (ii) commencing of trading of the Class A common stock of Twin Hospitality
Group Inc. on an Acceptable Exchange, (iii) all filings related with respect to the foregoing required pursuant to the rules and regulations
of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission are effective, (iv) the deposit of the Pledged Shares into the account specified in the
Pledge Agreement and (v) the Pledge Agreement is in full force and effect.
Section
1.2 Other Defined Terms.
(a)
Each term defined in the singular form in Section 1.1 or elsewhere in this Agreement shall mean the plural thereof when the plural
form of such term is used in this Agreement and each term defined in the plural form in Section 1.1 shall mean the singular thereof
when the singular form of such term is used herein.
(b)
The words “hereof”, “herein”, “hereunder” and similar terms when used in this Agreement shall refer
to this Agreement as a whole and not to any particular provision of this Agreement, and article, section, subsection, schedule and exhibit
references herein are references to articles, sections, subsections, schedules and exhibits to this Agreement unless otherwise specified.
(c)
Unless as otherwise provided herein, the word “including” as used herein shall mean “including without limitation.”
(d)
All accounting terms not specifically or completely defined in this Agreement shall be construed in conformity with GAAP.
(e)
Where the character or amount of any asset or liability or item of income or expense is required to be determined, or any accounting
computation is required to be made, for the purpose of this Agreement, such determination or calculation shall be made, to the extent
applicable and except as otherwise specified in this Agreement or the other Transaction Documents, in accordance with GAAP. When used
herein, the term “financial statement” shall include the notes and schedules thereto. All accounting determinations and computations
hereunder shall be made without duplication.
Section
1.3 Other Terms. All terms used in Article 9 of the UCC as in effect from time to time in the State of New York, and not specifically
defined herein, are used herein as defined in such Article 9.
Section
1.4 Computation of Time Periods. Unless otherwise stated in this Agreement, in the computation of a period of time from a specified
date to a later specified date, the word “from” means “from and including” and the words “to” and
“until” each means “to but excluding.”
Section
1.5 Controlling Class Representative. To the broadest extent possible, the parties hereto agree and acknowledge that a Majority
of Controlling Class may operate as the Controlling Class Representative under this Agreement and the other Transaction Documents, and
any rights, powers, remedies or privileges of the Controlling Class Representative under this Agreement and the other Transaction Documents
may also be exercised, enforced, enjoyed and received by the Majority of Controlling Class, including but not limited to, the authority
to make decisions, provide consents, give directions, and take any other actions that the Controlling Class Representative is authorized
or permitted to undertake under this Agreement and the other Transaction Documents.
Article
II
ADMINISTRATION
AND SERVICING OF MANAGED ASSETS
Section
2.1 Manager to Act as Manager.
(a)
Engagement of the Manager. The Manager is hereby authorized by each Securitization Entity, and hereby agrees, to perform the Services
(or refrain from the performance of the Services) subject to and in accordance with the Managing Standard and the terms of this Agreement,
the other Transaction Documents and the Managed Documents. With respect to the IP Services, the Manager shall perform such IP Services
in accordance with the Managing Standard and the IP License Agreements, unless a Guarantor determines, in its sole discretion, that additional
action is necessary or desirable in furtherance of the protection of the Securitization IP, in which case the Manager shall perform such
IP Services and additional related services as are reasonably requested by such Guarantor. The Manager, on behalf of the Securitization
Entities, shall have full power and authority, acting alone and subject only to the specific requirements and prohibitions of this Agreement
and in accordance with the Managing Standard, the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents, to do and take any and all actions,
or to refrain from taking any such actions, and to do any and all things in connection with performing the Services that the Manager
determines are necessary or desirable. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, but subject to the provisions of this Agreement,
the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents, including Section 2.8, the Manager, in connection with performing the Services,
is hereby authorized and empowered to execute and deliver, in the Manager’s own name (in its capacity as agent for the applicable
Securitization Entity) or in the name of any Securitization Entity (pursuant to the applicable Power of Attorney), on behalf of any Securitization
Entity any and all instruments of satisfaction or cancellation, or of partial or full release or discharge, and all other comparable
instruments, with respect to the Managed Assets. For the avoidance of doubt, the parties hereto acknowledge and agree that the Manager
is providing Services directly to each applicable Securitization Entity. Nothing in this Agreement shall preclude the Securitization
Entities from performing the Services or any other act on their own behalf at any time and from time to time.
(b)
Actions to Perfect Liens. Subject to the terms of the Indenture, including any applicable Series Supplement, the Manager shall
take those actions that are required under the Transaction Documents and Requirements of Law to maintain continuous perfection and priority
(subject to Permitted Liens) of the Trustee’s Lien in the Collateral. Without limiting the foregoing, the Manager shall file or
cause to be filed with the appropriate government office the financing statements on Form UCC-1, and assignments of financing statements
on Form UCC-3 required pursuant to Section 7.13 of the Base Indenture, and other filings requested by the Securitization Entities,
the Control Party or the Back-Up Manager, to be filed in connection with the Contribution Agreements, the IP License Agreements, the
Securitization IP, the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents.
(c)
Ownership of Manager-Developed IP.
(i)
The Manager acknowledges and agrees that all Securitization IP, including any Manager-Developed IP arising during the Term, shall, as
between the parties, be owned by and inure exclusively to the applicable Guarantor. Any copyrightable material included in such Manager-Developed
IP shall, to the fullest extent allowed by law, be considered a “work made for hire” as that term is defined in Section 101
of the U.S. Copyright Act of 1976, as amended, and owned by the applicable Guarantor. The Manager hereby irrevocably assigns and transfers,
without further consideration, all right, title and interest in such Manager-Developed IP (and all goodwill connected with the use of
and symbolized by Trademarks included therein) to the applicable Guarantor. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Manager-Developed IP to
be transferred to the applicable Guarantor shall include rights to use third party Intellectual Property only to the extent (but to the
fullest extent) that such rights are assignable or sublicensable to the applicable Guarantor. All applications to register Manager-Developed
IP shall be filed in the name of the applicable Guarantor.
(ii)
The Manager agrees to cooperate in good faith with each Guarantor for the purpose of securing and preserving the Guarantor’s rights
in and to the applicable Manager-Developed IP, including executing any documents and taking any actions, at the Guarantor’s reasonable
request, or as deemed necessary or advisable by the Manager, to confirm, file and record in any appropriate registry the Guarantor’s
sole legal title in and to such Manager-Developed IP, it being acknowledged and agreed that any expenses in connection therewith shall
be paid by the requesting Guarantor. The Manager hereby appoints each Guarantor as its attorney-in-fact authorized to execute such documents
in the event that Manager fails to execute the same within twenty (20) days following the Guarantor’s written request to do so
(it being understood that such appointment is a power coupled with an interest and therefore irrevocable) with full power of substitution
and delegation.
(d)
Grant of Power of Attorney. In order to provide the Manager with the authority to perform and execute its duties and obligations
as set forth herein, the Securitization Entities shall execute and deliver on the Closing Date a Power of Attorney in substantially the
form set forth as Exhibit A hereto to the Manager, which Powers of Attorney shall terminate in the event that the Manager’s
rights under this Agreement are terminated as provided herein.
(e)
Franchisee Insurance. The Manager acknowledges that, to the extent that it or any of its Affiliates is named as a “loss
payee” or “additional insured” under any insurance policies of any Franchisee, it shall use commercially reasonable
efforts to cause it to be so named in its capacity as the Manager on behalf of the applicable Guarantor, and the Manager shall promptly
(i) deposit or cause to be deposited to the applicable Concentration Account or Collection Account any proceeds received by it or by
any Securitization Entity or any other Affiliate under such insurance policies (other than amounts described in the following clause
(ii)) and (ii) disburse to the applicable Franchisee any proceeds of any such insurance policies payable to such Franchisee pursuant
to the applicable Franchise Agreement.
(f)
Manager Insurance. The Manager agrees to maintain adequate insurance consistent with the type and amount maintained by the Manager
as of the Closing Date, subject, in each case, to any adjustments or modifications made in accordance with the Managing Standard. Such
insurance shall cover each of the Securitization Entities, as an additional insured, to the extent that such Securitization Entity has
an insurable interest therein.
Section
2.2 Accounts.
(a)
Collection of Payments; Remittances; Collection Account. The Manager shall maintain and manage the Management Accounts (and certain
other accounts from time to time) in the name of, and for the benefit of, the Securitization Entities. The Manager shall (on behalf of
the Securitization Entities) (i) cause the collection of Collections in accordance with the Managing Standard and subject to and in accordance
with the Transaction Documents, (ii) make all deposits to and withdrawals from the Management Accounts in accordance with this Agreement
(including the Managing Standard), the Indenture and the applicable Managed Documents, and (iii) make all deposits to the Collection
Account in accordance with terms of the Indenture.
(b)
Deposit of Misdirected Funds; No Commingling; Misdirected Payments. The Manager shall promptly deposit into the Concentration
Account, the Collection Account, an Advertising Fund Account or such other appropriate account within three (3) Business Days immediately
following Actual Knowledge of the Manager of the receipt thereof and in the form received with any necessary endorsement or in cash,
all payments in respect of the Managed Assets incorrectly deposited into another account. In the event that any funds not constituting
Collections are incorrectly deposited in any Account, the Manager shall promptly withdraw such amounts after obtaining Actual Knowledge
thereof and shall pay such amounts to the Person legally entitled to such funds. Except as otherwise set forth herein, in the Base Indenture
or in the Company Restaurant Licenses, the Manager shall not commingle any monies that relate to Managed Assets with its own assets and
shall keep separate, segregated and appropriately marked and identified all Managed Assets and any other property comprising any part
of the Collateral, and for such time, if any, as such Managed Assets or such other property are in the possession or control of the Manager
to the extent such Managed Assets or such other property is Collateral, the Manager shall hold the same in trust for the benefit of the
Trustee and the Secured Parties (or, following termination of the Indenture, the applicable Securitization Entity). Additionally, the
Manager, promptly after obtaining Actual Knowledge thereof, shall notify the Trustee in the Monthly Manager’s Certificate of any
amounts incorrectly deposited into any Indenture Trust Account and instruct in the Monthly Manager’s Certificate the prompt remittance
by the Trustee of such funds from the applicable Indenture Trust Account to the Manager. The Trustee shall have no obligation to verify
any information provided to it by the Manager in any Monthly Manager’s Certificate and shall remit such funds to the Manager based
solely on such Monthly Manager’s Certificate.
(c)
Investment of Funds in Management Accounts. The Manager shall have the right to invest and reinvest funds deposited in any Management
Account in Eligible Investments. All income or other gain from such Eligible Investments will be credited to the related Management Account,
and any loss resulting from such investments will be charged to the related Management Account.
(d)
Advertising Funds. The Manager may, but shall not be required to, maintain advertising fund accounts (each, an “Advertising
Fund Account”) in the name of the Manager (or a Subsidiary thereof) for fees payable by Franchisees and Company Restaurant
Guarantors to fund the national marketing and advertising activities and local advertising cooperatives with respect to each Brand (the
“Advertising Fees”). Any Advertising Fees received in the Concentration Account or the Company Restaurant Account
shall be transferred by the Manager to the applicable Advertising Fund Account. The Manager shall not make or permit or cause any other
Person to make or permit any borrowings to be made or Liens to be levied against the Advertising Fund Accounts or the funds therein.
The Manager shall apply the amount on deposit in each Advertising Fund Account solely to cover (a) the costs and expenses (including
costs and expenses incurred prior to the Closing Date) associated with the administration of such account, (b) general and administrative
expenses incurred by the Manager in respect of marketing and advertising activities for the applicable Brand to the extent reimbursable
from the Advertising Fees in accordance with the applicable Franchise Agreements, and (c) costs and expenses related to the national
and local marketing and advertising programs with respect to the Branded Restaurants. The Manager may make advances to fund deficits
in the Advertising Fund Accounts from time to time to the extent that it reasonably expects to be reimbursed for such advances from the
proceeds of future Advertising Fees, it being agreed that any such advances shall not constitute Manager Advances. The Manager, acting
on behalf of the Securitization Entities, may in accordance with the Managing Standard and the terms of the Franchise Agreements, the
Company Restaurant Licenses and the Management Agreement, as applicable, increase or reduce the Advertising Fees required to be paid
by the Franchisees and Company Restaurants, respectively, pursuant to the terms of the Franchise Agreements, the Company Restaurant Licenses
and the Management Agreement and in accordance with the Managing Standard.
(e)
Brand Technology Funds. The Manager may, but shall not be required to, establish and maintain for each Brand technology accounts
to hold certain amounts paid by Franchisees and Company Restaurants into any Brand technology fund for the development, maintenance and
support of restaurant-level and above restaurant-level technology systems, including, without limitation, point-of-sale system, back
of house, mobile order and/or mobile payment systems. The Manager shall not make or permit or cause any other Person to make or permit
any borrowings to be made or Liens to be levied against any such accounts or the funds therein. The Manager, acting on behalf of the
Securitization Entities, may in accordance with the Managing Standard and the terms of the Franchise Agreements, the Company Restaurant
Licenses and the Management Agreement, as applicable, specify or subsequently increase or reduce the amounts required to be paid by the
Franchisees and Company Restaurant Guarantors, respectively, into any such Brand technology fund pursuant to the terms of the Franchise
Agreements, the Company Restaurant Licenses and the Management Agreement and in accordance with the Managing Standard.
(f)
Gift Card Sales and Redemptions. The Manager will be responsible for administering the gift card programs of each Brand and will
collect the proceeds of the initial sale of gift cards that are sold on the internet, at Company Restaurants, at third party retail locations
or at other gift card vendors in one or more accounts in the name of the Manager (or a Subsidiary thereof). The Manager shall not make
or permit or cause any other Person to make or permit any borrowings to be made or Liens to be levied against any such accounts or the
funds therein. The Manager will reimburse the applicable Franchisee or Company Restaurant Guarantor with respect to the redemption of
gift cards sold at these locations or any portion thereof in accordance with the Manager’s normal practices and the Managing Standard.
The proceeds of the initial sale of gift cards sold at Branded Restaurants will be held in accounts in the name of selling Franchisee
or Company Restaurant Guarantor, and the Manager may engage a third-party vendor to administer reimbursements of the applicable Franchisee
or Company Restaurant Guarantor with respect to the redemption of gift cards sold at Branded Restaurants.
(g)
Tenant Improvement Funds. The Manager may, but shall not be required to, collect and administer tenant improvement allowances
and similar amounts, if any, received from landlords with respect to the New Franchised Restaurant Leases. Any such amounts received
from landlords shall be collected and maintained in one or more accounts in the name of the Manager, and will be utilized by the Manager
for improvements, renovations or other capital expenditures in respect of real property subject to New Franchised Restaurant Leases or,
to the extent any such funds represent a reimbursement of such expenditures previously made by the Manager, may be retained by the Manager.
The Manager shall not make or permit or cause any other Person to make or permit any borrowings to be made or Liens to be levied against
any such accounts or the funds therein. The Manager shall administer such amounts in accordance with the Managing Standard.
(h)
Company Restaurant Account. The Company Restaurant Guarantors shall maintain an account designated as the “Company Restaurant
Account” in the name and for the benefit of the Company Restaurant Guarantors (the “Company Restaurant Account”),
which is funded with Company Restaurant Collections and certain other amounts related to the Company Restaurants. The Manager shall cause
all revenue generated from the operation of the Company Restaurants to be deposited into the Company Restaurant Account as follows and
otherwise in accordance with the terms of the Transaction Documents:
(i)
all cash Company Restaurant Collections (other than gift card redemption amounts) generated by the Company Restaurants within two (2)
Business Days following the receipt thereof at such Company Restaurants;
(ii)
all credit card and debit card proceeds for Company Restaurant Collections at the Company Restaurants; provided that if such proceeds
are not deposited directly into the Company Restaurant Account (including any applicable credit card and debit card sub-account of such
Company Restaurant Account), such proceeds will be deposited into the applicable Company Restaurant Account within two (2) Business Days
following receipt of such credit card and debit card proceeds; and
(iii)
within ten (10) days of the redemption at the Company Restaurant of any gift card or any gift certificate or portion thereof under the
gift card program, the amount of any such gift card or gift certificate redemption.
The
Manager may withdraw available amounts on deposit in the Company Restaurant Account at any time in accordance with the Managing Standard
and as otherwise set forth in the Transaction Documents in order to pay (or to reimburse itself to the extent it has paid) the Restaurant
Operating Expenses. In consideration of the right to operate the Company Restaurants, each Company Restaurant Guarantor shall pay the
Company Restaurant Royalty Payments to the Concentration Account on a monthly basis. On a monthly basis, the Manager shall cause the
Guarantors to pay the Monthly Fiscal Period Company Restaurant Profits True-up Amounts and Monthly Fiscal Period Estimated Company Restaurant
Profits Amounts in accordance with the Indenture and other Transaction Documents.
Section
2.3 Records.
(a)
The Manager shall, in accordance with the Current Practice, retain all material data (including computerized records) relating directly
to, or maintained in connection with, the servicing of the Managed Assets at its address indicated in Section 8.5 (or at an off-site
storage facility reasonably acceptable to the Securitization Entities, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party) or, upon thirty (30)
days’ notice to the Securitization Entities, the Rating Agencies, if any, the Control Party, the Back-Up Manager and the Trustee,
at such other place where the servicing office of the Manager is located (provided that the servicing office of the Manager shall at
all times be located in the United States), and shall give the Trustee, the Control Party and the Back-Up Manager access to all such
data in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Transaction Documents; provided, however, that the Trustee shall not be obligated
to verify, recalculate or review any such data. The Manager acknowledges that the applicable Guarantor or applicable Franchise Entities
shall own the Intellectual Property rights in all such data.
(b)
If the rights of Manager, as the initial Manager, shall have been terminated in accordance with Section 6.1 or if this Agreement
shall have been terminated pursuant to Section 8.1, Manager, as the initial Manager, shall, upon demand of the Trustee (based
upon the written direction of the Control Party, acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), in the case of a termination
pursuant to Section 6.1, or upon the demand of the Securitization Entities, in the case of a termination pursuant to Section
8.1, deliver to the Successor Manager (or Interim Successor Manager, as the case may be) all data in its possession or under its
control (including computerized records) necessary or desirable for the servicing of the Managed Assets.
Section
2.4 Administrative Duties of Manager.
(a)
Duties with Respect to the Transaction Documents. The Manager, in accordance with the Managing Standard, shall perform the duties
of the applicable Securitization Entities under the Transaction Documents except for those duties that are required to be performed by
the equity holders, stockholders, directors, or managers of such Securitization Entity pursuant to applicable Requirements of Law. In
furtherance of the foregoing, the Manager shall consult with the managers or the directors, as the case may be, of the Securitization
Entities as the Manager deems appropriate regarding the duties of the Securitization Entities under the Transaction Documents. The Manager
shall monitor the performance of the Securitization Entities and, promptly upon obtaining Actual Knowledge thereof, shall advise the
applicable Securitization Entity when action is necessary to comply with such Securitization Entity’s duties under the Transaction
Documents. The Manager shall prepare for execution by the Securitization Entities or shall cause the preparation by other appropriate
Persons of all such documents, reports, filings, instruments, certificates, notices and opinions as it shall be the duty of the Securitization
Entities to prepare, file or deliver pursuant to the Transaction Documents.
(b)
Duties with Respect to the Securitization Entities. In addition to the duties of the Manager set forth in this Agreement or any
of the Transaction Documents, the Manager, in accordance with the Managing Standard, shall perform such calculations and shall prepare
for execution by the Securitization Entities or shall cause the preparation by other appropriate Persons of all such documents, reports,
filings, instruments, certificates, notices and opinions as it shall be the duty of the Securitization Entities to prepare, file or deliver
pursuant to applicable law, including, for the avoidance of doubt, securities laws and franchise laws. Pursuant to the directions of
the Securitization Entities and in accordance with the Managing Standard, the Manager shall administer, perform or supervise the performance
of such other activities in connection with the Securitization Entities as are not covered by any of the foregoing provisions and as
are expressly requested by any Securitization Entity and are reasonably within the capability of the Manager.
(c)
Duties with Respect to the Company Restaurant Guarantors. In addition to the duties of the Manager set forth in this Agreement
or any of the Transaction Documents, the Manager shall perform all of the duties and obligations of the Company Restaurant Guarantors
in connection with the operations and ownership of the Company Restaurants, including, without limitation, paying all applicable taxes,
collecting revenues generated by the Company Restaurants, maintaining appropriate levels of property and casualty insurance and performing
any other activities necessary or desirable for the operation of the Company Restaurants and the development, acquisition, closure and
disposition of Company Restaurants, in each case as permitted or required under the Transaction Documents. The Manager shall hire, train
and manage employees of the Company Restaurants, including the administration of personnel and human resources on behalf of the Company
Restaurant Guarantors and negotiate with vendors, suppliers, distributors and other third parties on behalf of the Company Restaurant
Guarantors in connection with the operation of Company Restaurants. Company Restaurant Assets such as furnishings, cooking equipment,
cooking supplies and computer equipment are required to be selected and acquired by the Manager on behalf of the Company Restaurant Guarantors
and disposed of in accordance with the terms of the other Transaction Documents. The Manager shall implement repairs, maintenance and
re-modeling projects at Company Restaurants on behalf of the Company Restaurant Guarantors. The Manager shall obtain and maintain applicable
liquor licenses and perform any other services that the Manager deems necessary or advisable to operate the Company Restaurants. The
Manager shall develop and implement new menu items to be served at Company Restaurants. The Manager shall perform the duties and obligations
and enforce the rights of the Company Restaurant Guarantors pursuant to the terms of the Transaction Documents.
(d)
Records. The Manager shall maintain appropriate books of account and records relating to the Services performed under this Agreement,
which books of account and records shall be accessible for inspection by the Securitization Entities during normal business hours and
upon reasonable notice, and by the Trustee, the Control Party, the Back-Up Manager and the Controlling Class Representative in accordance
with Section 3.1(e).
(a)
Resignation or Removal of Controlling Class Representative. Pursuant to Section 11.1(d) of the Base Indenture, upon the
resignation or removal of a Controlling Class Representative, the Manager shall assist the Issuer with appointing a successor Controlling
Class Representative in accordance with the definition of “Controlling Class Representative” set forth in the Base Indenture.
Section
2.5 No Offset. The payment obligations of the Manager under this Agreement shall not be subject to, and the Manager hereby waives,
in connection with the performance of such obligations, any right of offset that the Manager has or may have against the Trustee, the
Control Party, the Back-Up Manager or the Securitization Entities, whether in respect of this Agreement, the other Transaction Documents
or any document governing any Managed Asset or otherwise.
Section
2.6 Compensation and Expenses. As compensation for the performance of its obligations under this Agreement, the Manager shall receive
the Monthly Management Fee and the Supplemental Management Fee, if any, on each Monthly Allocation Date out of amounts available therefore
under the Indenture on such Monthly Allocation Date in accordance with the Priority of Payments. The Manager shall pay from its own funds
all expenses it may incur in performing its obligations hereunder. The Manager may, in its sole discretion, waive payment of any Monthly
Management Fee and/or any Supplemental Management Fee.
Section
2.7 Indemnification.
(a)
The Manager agrees to indemnify and hold the Securitization Entities, the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party, and their
respective members, officers, directors, managers, employees and agents (each, an “Indemnitee”) harmless against all
claims, losses, penalties, fines, forfeitures, liabilities, obligations, damages, actions, suits and related costs and judgments and
other costs, fees and reasonable expenses, including reasonable and documented fees, out-of-pocket charges and disbursements of counsel
(other than the allocated costs of in-house counsel), that any of them may incur as a result of (i) the failure of the Manager to perform
or observe its obligations under this Agreement or any other Transaction Document to which it is a party in its capacity as Manager,
(ii) the breach by the Manager of any representation, warranty or covenant under this Agreement or any other Transaction Document to
which it is a party in its capacity as Manager; or (iii) the Manager’s bad faith, negligence or willful misconduct in the performance
of its duties under this Agreement and or the other Transaction Documents; provided, that the Manager shall have no obligation of indemnity
to an Indemnitee to the extent any such claims, losses, penalties, fines, forfeitures, liabilities, obligations, damages, actions, suits
and related costs and judgments and other costs, fees and reasonable expenses are caused by the bad faith, gross negligence, willful
misconduct, or breach of this Agreement by such Indemnitee (unless caused by the Manager with respect to a Securitization Entity). In
the event the Manager shall make an indemnification payment pursuant to this Section 2.7(a) the Manager shall promptly pay such
indemnification payment directly to the applicable Indemnitee (or, if due to a Securitization Entity, shall deposit such indemnification
payment directly to the Collection Account). Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, no indemnification payment shall
be due from the Manager to the extent that it constitutes recourse for diminution in the market value of any Managed Assets from and
after the Closing Date, other than as may be attributable to any of the foregoing limited circumstances.
(b)
[RESERVED]
(c)
[RESERVED]
(d)
Any Indemnitee that proposes to assert the right to be indemnified under Section 2.7 shall promptly, after receipt of notice of
the commencement of any action, suit or proceeding against such party in respect of which a claim is to be made against the Manager,
notify the Manager of the commencement of such action, suit or proceeding, enclosing a copy of all papers served. In the event that any
action, suit or proceeding shall be brought against any Indemnitee, such Indemnitee shall notify the Manager of the commencement thereof
and the Manager shall be entitled to participate in, and to the extent that it shall wish, to assume the defense thereof, with its counsel
reasonably satisfactory to such Indemnitee (which, in the case of a Securitization Entity, shall be reasonably satisfactory to the Control
Party as well), and after notice from the Manager to such Indemnitee of its election to assume the defense thereof, the Manager shall
not be liable to such Indemnitee for any legal expenses subsequently incurred by such Indemnitee in connection with the defense thereof;
provided that the Trustee shall not be bound by this sentence except with its prior written consent, which may be withheld in
its sole discretion; provided, further, that the Manager shall not enter into any settlement with respect to any claim
or proceeding unless such settlement includes a release of such Indemnitee from all liability on claims that are the subject matter of
such settlement; and provided, further, that the Indemnitee shall have the right to employ its own counsel in any such
action the defense of which is assumed by the Manager in accordance with this Section 2.7(d), but the fees and expenses of such
counsel shall be at the expense of such Indemnitee unless (i) the employment of counsel by such Indemnitee has been specifically authorized
by the Manager, (ii) the Manager is advised in writing by counsel to such Indemnitee or the Control Party that joint representation would
give rise to a conflict of interest between such Indemnitee’s position and the position of the Manager in respect of the defense
of the claim, (iii) the Manager shall have failed within a reasonable period of time to assume the defense of such action or proceeding
and employ counsel reasonably satisfactory to the Indemnitee in any such action or proceeding or (iv) the named parties to any such action
or proceeding (including any impleaded parties) include both the Indemnitee and the Manager, and the Indemnitee shall have been advised
by counsel that there may be one or more legal defenses available to it which are different from or additional to those available to
the Manager (in which case, the Indemnitee notifies the Manager in writing that it elects to employ separate counsel at the expense of
the Manager, the reasonable fees and expenses of such Indemnitee’s counsel shall be borne by the Manager and the Manager shall
not have the right to assume the defense of such action or proceeding on behalf of such Indemnitee, it being understood, however, that
the Manager shall not, in connection with any one such action or proceeding or separate but substantially similar or related actions
or proceedings in the same jurisdiction arising out of the same general allegations or circumstances, be liable for such fees and expenses
of more than one separate firm of attorneys at any time for the Indemnitee). The provisions of this Section 2.7 shall survive
the termination of this Agreement or the earlier resignation or removal of any party hereto; provided, however, that no Successor Manager
shall be liable under this Section 2.7 with respect to any Defective New Asset or any other matter occurring prior to its succession
hereunder. Notwithstanding anything in this Section 2.7 to the contrary, any delay or failure by an Indemnitee in providing the
Manager with notice of any action shall not relieve the Manager of its indemnification obligations except to the extent the Manager is
materially prejudiced by such delay or failure of notice.
Section
2.8 Nonpetition Covenant. The Manager shall not, prior to the date that is one year and one day, or if longer, the applicable preference
period then in effect, after the payment in full of the Outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes of each Series, petition or otherwise
invoke the process of any court or governmental authority for the purpose of commencing or sustaining a case against any Securitization
Entity under any insolvency law or appointing a receiver, liquidator, assignee, trustee, custodian, sequestrator or other similar official
of such Securitization Entity or any substantial part of its property, or ordering the winding up or liquidation of the affairs of such
Securitization Entity.
Section
2.9 Franchisor Consent. Subject to the Managing Standard and the terms of the Indenture, the Manager shall have the authority,
on behalf of the applicable Securitization Entities, to grant or withhold consents of the “franchisor” required under the
Franchise Documents.
Section
2.10 Appointment of Sub-managers. The Manager may enter into Sub-managing Arrangements with third parties (including Affiliates)
(each, a “Sub-manager”) to provide the Services hereunder; provided, other than with respect to a Sub-managing Arrangement
with an Affiliate of the Manager, that no Sub-managing Arrangement shall be effective unless and until (i) the Manager receives the consent
of the Control Party, (ii) such sub-manager executes and delivers an agreement, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the
Control Party, to perform and observe, or in the case of an assignment, an assumption by such successor entity of the due and punctual
performance and observance of, the applicable covenants and conditions to be performed or observed by the Manager under this Agreement;
provided that such Sub-managing Arrangement shall be terminable by the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class
Representative) upon a Manager Termination Event and shall contain disentanglement and transitional servicing provisions substantially
similar to those provided in Section 6.3, (iii) a written notice has been provided to the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the
Control Party and (iv) such Sub-managing Arrangement, or assignment and assumption by such Sub-manager, satisfies the Rating Agency Condition,
if applicable. The Manager shall not enter into any Sub-managing Arrangement which delegates the performance of any fundamental business
operations such as responsibility for the franchise development, operations and marketing strategies for the Brands and Branded Restaurants
to any Person that is not an Affiliate without receiving the prior written consent of the Control Party. Notwithstanding anything to
the contrary herein or in any Sub-managing Arrangement, the Manager shall remain primarily and directly liable for its obligations hereunder
and in connection with any Sub-managing Arrangement.
Section
2.11 Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds. Upon receipt of any Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds, the Manager (on behalf of the Securitization
Entities) shall deposit or cause the deposit of such Insurance/Condemnation Proceeds to a Management Account which shall be administered
in accordance with the Indenture.
Section
2.12 Permitted Asset Dispositions. The Manager (acting on behalf of the Securitization Entities), in accordance with Section
8.16 of the Base Indenture and the Managing Standard, may dispose of property of the Securitization Entities from time to time pursuant
to a Permitted Asset Disposition. Upon receipt of any proceeds from any Permitted Asset Disposition, the Manager (on behalf of the Securitization
Entities) shall deposit or cause the deposit of such proceeds to a Management Account. Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement but
subject to the terms of the Indenture with respect to Asset Disposition Proceeds, at the election of the Manager (on behalf of the applicable
Securitization Entity) and so long as no Rapid Amortization Event shall have occurred and be continuing, the Manager (on behalf of the
Securitization Entities) may reinvest such proceeds in Eligible Assets within one (1) calendar year following receipt of such proceeds
(or, if any Securitization Entity (or the Manager on its behalf) shall have entered into a binding commitment to reinvest such proceeds
in Eligible Assets within one (1) calendar year following receipt of such proceeds, within eighteen (18) calendar months following receipt
of such proceeds) and/or may utilize such proceeds to pay, or to allocate funds to reimburse the Securitization Entities for amounts
previously paid, for investments in Eligible Assets made within the twelve (12) month period prior to the receipt of such proceeds.
Section
2.13 Manager Advances. The Manager may, but shall not be obligated to, make Manager Advances in an amount equal to $5,000,000 or
less, in its sole discretion, and in an amount greater than $5,000,000 with the approval of the Controlling Class Representative to,
or on behalf of, any Securitization Entity, in connection with the operation of the Managed Assets. Manager Advances will accrue interest
at the Advance Interest Rate and shall be reimbursable on each Monthly Allocation Date in accordance with the Priority of Payments.
Section
2.14 Product Sourcing Advances. In the event sufficient funds are not available for any Product Sourcing Payment, the Manager may,
but is not obligated to, make an advance (each, a “Product Sourcing Advance”) to fund such Product Sourcing Payment
to the extent that it reasonably expects to be reimbursed for such advances from the proceeds of future Product Sourcing Payments, it
being understood and agreed that any such advances shall not constitute Manager Advances. Each Product Sourcing Advance shall be repaid
solely from Product Sourcing Payments received after the date of such Product Sourcing Advance in accordance with the Priority of Payments.
Section
2.15 Rebate Agreements. In connection with the Rebate Agreements, the Manager agrees that it shall not, without the prior written
consent of the Control Party, amend the material terms of any Rebate Agreement or take or permit any action to be taken that would prevent
any payments made under the Rebate Agreements from being made to the applicable Guarantor under the Rebate Agreements.
Section
2.16 Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds. Within two (2) Business Days of the Manager’s receipt of Qualified Equity Offering
Proceeds, the Manager shall deposit 75% of any Qualified Equity Offering Proceeds into the Collection Account, until an aggregate amount
equal to $75,000,000 has been deposited thereto, for further distribution in accordance with the Indenture.
Article
III
STATEMENTS
AND REPORTS
Section
3.1 Reporting by the Manager.
(a)
Reports Required Pursuant to the Indenture. The Manager, on behalf of the Securitization Entities, shall furnish, or cause to
be furnished, to the Trustee and each recipient party specified in Article IV of the Indenture, all reports and notices required to be
delivered to the Trustee and such recipient parties by any Securitization Entity pursuant to the Indenture (including pursuant to Article
IV of the Base Indenture) or any other Transaction Document.
(b)
Delivery of Financial Statements. The Manager shall provide the financial statements of Manager and the Securitization Entities
as required under Section 4.1(g) and (h) of the Base Indenture.
(c)
Franchisee Termination Notices. The Manager shall send to the Trustee and the Back-Up Manager, as soon as reasonably practicable
but in no event later than fifteen (15) Business Days of the receipt thereof, a copy of any notices of termination of one or more Franchise
Agreements sent by the Manager to any Franchisee unless (i) the related Franchised Restaurant(s) generated less than $500,000 in royalties
during the immediately preceding fiscal year or (ii) the related Franchised Restaurant(s) continue to operate pursuant to an agreement
between the related Guarantor or the Manager on its behalf and such Franchisee.
(d)
Notice Regarding New Franchised Restaurant Leases. In the event that any Securitization Entity, or the Manager on behalf of any
Securitization Entity, receives any written notice from a lessor of any lease included in the Real Estate Assets regarding the lack of
payment or alleging any breach, violation or default under the applicable leases or action be taken to remedy a breach, violation or
default, excluding any such notice in respect of non-monetary breach, violation or default as to which the Manager is contesting or expects
to contest in good faith, the Manager shall promptly, but in any event within fifteen (15) Business Days from such receipt, notify the
Trustee and the Control Party.
(e)
Additional Information; Access to Books and Records. The Manager shall furnish from time to time such additional information regarding
the Collateral or compliance with the covenants and other agreements of Manager and any Securitization Entity under the Transaction Documents
as the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager or the Control Party may reasonably request, subject at all times to compliance with the Exchange
Act, the Securities Act and any other applicable Requirements of Law. Subject to the Disclosure Exceptions and to reasonable requests
of confidentiality including as required or imposed by law or by contract, the Manager will, and will cause each Securitization Entity
to, permit, at reasonable times upon reasonable notice, the Control Party, the Back-Up Manager, the Controlling Class Representative
and the Trustee or any Person appointed by any of them as its agent to visit and inspect any of its properties, examine its books and
records and discuss its affairs with its officers, directors, managers, employees and independent certified public accountants (so long
as the Manager has the opportunity to participate in such discussions with such accountants), and up to one such visit and inspection
by each of the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative, the Back-Up Manager and the Trustee, or any Person appointed by them
shall be reimbursable as a Securitization Operating Expense per calendar year, with any additional visit or inspection by any such Person
being at such Person’s sole cost and expense; provided, however that during the continuance of a Warm Back-Up Management Trigger
Event, a Rapid Amortization Event, a Default, or an Event of Default, or to the extent expressly required without the instruction of
any other party under the terms of any Transaction Documents, any such Person may visit and conduct such activities at any time and all
such visits and activities will constitute a Securitization Operating Expense. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Manager shall not be
required to disclose or make available communications protected by the attorney-client privilege. Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement
or any other Transaction Document to the contrary, in no event shall the Manager or any other Securitization Entity be required to disclose
or discuss, or permit the inspection, examination or making of extracts of, any records, books, information or account or other matter
that constitutes a Disclosure Exception.
(f)
Leadership Team Changes. The Manager shall promptly notify the Trustee and the Back-Up Manager of any termination or resignation
of any persons included in the Leadership Team that occurs within 12 months following a Change of Control.
Section
3.2 Appointment of Independent Auditor. On or before the Closing Date, the Securitization Entities appointed a firm of independent
public accountants of recognized national reputation that was reasonably acceptable to the Control Party to serve as the independent
auditors (“Independent Auditors”) for purposes of preparing and delivering the reports required by Section 3.3,
and such Independent Auditors continue to serve in such capacity as of the Closing Date. It is hereby acknowledged that the accounting
firm of CohnReznick LLP is acceptable for purposes of serving as Independent Auditors. The Securitization Entities may not remove the
Independent Auditors without first giving thirty (30) days’ prior written notice to the Independent Auditors, with a copy of such
notice also given concurrently to the Trustee, the Rating Agencies, if any, the Control Party and the Manager (if applicable). Upon any
resignation by such firm or removal of such firm, the Securitization Entities shall promptly appoint a successor thereto that shall also
be a firm of independent public accountants of recognized national reputation to serve as the Independent Auditors hereunder. If the
Securitization Entities shall fail to appoint a successor firm of Independent Auditors within thirty (30) days after the effective date
of any such resignation or removal, the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) shall promptly
appoint a successor firm of independent public accountants of recognized national reputation that is reasonably satisfactory to the Manager
to serve as the Independent Auditors hereunder. The fees of any Independent Auditors shall be payable by the Securitization Entities.
Section
3.3 Annual Accountants’ Reports. The Manager shall furnish, or cause to be furnished to the Trustee, the Control Party, the
Back-Up Manager (to the extent the Back-Up Manager is not providing such report) and the Rating Agencies, if any, within 120 days after
the end of each fiscal year of the Manager, commencing with the fiscal year ending in December 2024, (i) a report of the Independent
Auditors (who may also render other services to the Manager) or the Back-Up Manager summarizing the findings of a set of agreed-upon
procedures performed by the Independent Auditors or the Back-Up Manager with respect to compliance with the Quarterly Noteholders’
Reports for such fiscal year (or other period) with the standards set forth herein, and (ii) a report of the Independent Auditors or
the Back-Up Manager to the effect that such firm has examined the assertion of the Manager’s management as to its compliance with
its management requirements for such fiscal year (or other period), and that (x) in the case of the Independent Auditors, such examination
was made in accordance with standards established by the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and (y) except as described
in the report, management’s assertion is fairly stated in all material respects. In the case of the Independent Auditors, the report
will also indicate that the firm is independent of the Manager within the meaning of the Code of Professional Ethics of the American
Institute of Certified Public Accountants (each, an “Annual Accountants’ Report”). In the event such Independent
Auditors require the Trustee to agree to the procedures to be performed by such firm in any of the reports required to be prepared pursuant
to this Section 3.3, the Manager shall direct the Trustee in writing to so agree as to the procedures described therein; it being
understood and agreed that the Trustee shall deliver such letter of agreement (which shall be in a form satisfactory to the Trustee)
in conclusive reliance upon the direction of the Manager, and the Trustee has not made any independent inquiry or investigation as to,
and shall have no obligation or liability in respect of, the sufficiency, validity or correctness of such procedures.
Section
3.4 Available Information. The Manager, on behalf of the Securitization Entities, shall make available the information requested
by prospective purchasers necessary to satisfy the requirements of Rule 144A under the Securities Act and the 1940 Act, as amended. The
Manager shall deliver such information, and shall promptly deliver copies of all Quarterly Noteholders’ Reports and Annual Accountants’
Reports, to the Trustee as contemplated by Section 4.1 and Section 4.4 of the Base Indenture, to enable the Trustee to
redeliver such information to purchasers or prospective purchasers of the Notes.
Article
IV
THE
MANAGER
Section
4.1 Representations and Warranties Concerning the Manager. The Manager represents and warrants to each Securitization Entity and
the Trustee, as of (i) the Closing Date and (ii) each date on which Excess Amounts or Residual Amounts are distributed by the Issuer,
as follows:
(a)
Organization and Good Standing. The Manager (i) is a corporation, duly formed and organized, validly existing and in good standing
under the laws of the State of Delaware, (ii) is duly qualified to do business as a foreign corporation and in good standing under the
laws of each jurisdiction where the character of its property, the nature of its business or the performance of its obligations under
the Transaction Documents make such qualification necessary and (iii) has the power and authority (x) to own its properties and to conduct
its business as such properties are currently owned and such business is currently conducted and (y) to perform its obligations under
this Agreement, except in each case referred to in clause (ii) or (iii) to the extent that a failure to do so would not reasonably be
expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect on the Manager.
(b)
Power and Authority; No Conflicts. The execution and delivery by the Manager of this Agreement and its performance of, and compliance
with, the terms hereof are within the power of the Manager and have been duly authorized by all necessary corporate action on the part
of the Manager. Neither the execution and delivery of this Agreement, nor the consummation of the transactions herein, nor compliance
with the provisions hereof, shall conflict with or result in a breach of, or constitute a default (or an event which, with notice or
lapse of time, or both, would constitute a default) under, any order of any Governmental Authority or any of the provisions of any Requirement
of Law binding on the Manager or its properties, or the charter or bylaws or other organizational documents of the Manager, or any of
the provisions of any material indenture, mortgage, lease, contract or other instrument to which the Manager is a party or by which it
or its property is bound or result in the creation or imposition of any Lien upon any of its property pursuant to the terms of any such
indenture, mortgage, leases, contract or other instrument, except to the extent such default, creation or imposition would not reasonably
be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect on the Manager, the Collateral, or the Securitization Entities.
(c)
Consents. Except (i) for registrations as a franchise broker or franchise sales agent as may be required under state franchise
statutes and regulations, (ii) to the extent that a state or foreign franchise law requires filing and other compliance actions by virtue
of considering the Manager as a “subfranchisor”, (iii) for any consents, licenses, approvals, authorizations, registrations,
notifications, waivers or declarations that have been obtained or made and are in full force and effect and (iv) to the extent that a
failure to do so would not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect on the Manager, the Collateral or the Securitization
Entities, the Manager is not required to obtain the consent of any other party or the consent, license, approval or authorization of,
or file any registration or declaration with, any Governmental Authority in connection with the execution, delivery or performance by
the Manager of this Agreement, or the validity or enforceability of this Agreement against the Manager.
(d)
Due Execution and Delivery. This Agreement has been duly executed and delivered by the Manager and constitutes a legal, valid
and binding obligation of the Manager enforceable against the Manager in accordance with its terms (subject to applicable insolvency
laws and to general principles of equity).
(e)
No Litigation. There are no actions, suits, investigations or proceedings pending or, to the Actual Knowledge of the Manager,
threatened in writing against or affecting the Manager, before or by any Governmental Authority having jurisdiction over the Manager
or any of its properties or with respect to any of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement (i) asserting the illegality, invalidity
or unenforceability, or seeking any determination or ruling that would affect the legality, binding effect, validity or enforceability
of this Agreement or (ii) which would reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect on the Manager, the Collateral or
the Securitization Entities.
(f)
Compliance with Requirements of Law. The Manager is in compliance with all Requirements of Law except to the extent that the failure
to comply therewith would not, in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect on the Manager, the Collateral
or the Securitization Entities.
(g)
No Default. The Manager is not in default under any agreement, contract, instrument or indenture to which the Manager is a party
or by which it or its properties is or are bound, or with respect to any order of any Governmental Authority, except to the extent such
default would not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect on the Manager or the Collateral; and no event has occurred
which with notice or lapse of time or both would constitute such a default with respect to any such agreement, contract, instrument or
indenture, or with respect to any such order of any Governmental Authority.
(h)
Taxes. The Manager has filed or caused to be filed and shall file or cause to be filed all federal tax returns and all material
state and other tax returns that are required to be filed except where the failure to do so would not reasonably be expected to result
in a Material Adverse Effect. The Manager has paid or caused to be paid, and shall pay or cause to be paid, all taxes owed by the Manager
pursuant to said returns or pursuant to any assessments made against it or any of its property (other than any amount of tax the validity
of which is currently being contested in good faith by appropriate action and with respect to which reserves in accordance with GAAP
have been provided on the books of the Manager).
(i)
Accuracy of Information. No written report, financial statements, certificate or other written information furnished (other than
projections, budgets, other estimates and general market, industry and economic data) to the Control Party or the Back-Up Manager by
or on behalf of the Manager in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby or pursuant to any provision of this Agreement or
any other Transaction Document (when taken together with all other information furnished by or on behalf of the Manager to the Control
Party or the Back-Up Manager, as the case may be), contains any material misstatement of fact as of the date furnished or omits to state
any material fact necessary to make the statements therein not materially misleading in each case when taken as a whole and in the light
of the circumstances under which they were made; and with respect to its projected financial information, the Manager represents only
that such information was prepared in good faith based on assumptions believed to be reasonable at the time.
(j)
Financial Statements. As of the Closing Date, the consolidated financial statements of the Manager set forth in the Offering Memorandum
(i) present fairly in all material respects the financial condition of Manager and its Subsidiaries as of such date, and the results
of operations for the respective periods then ended and (ii) were prepared in accordance with GAAP (except as otherwise stated therein)
applied consistently through the periods involved subject, in the case of such quarterly financial statements, to the absence of footnotes
and to normal year-end audit adjustments.
(k)
No Material Adverse Change. Since the date of the Final Offering Memorandum, there has been no development or event that has had
or would reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect on the Manager or the Collateral.
(l)
ERISA. Except as would not reasonably be expected, individually or in the aggregate, to result in a Material Adverse Effect: (i)
neither the Manager nor any member of a Controlled Group that includes the Manager has established, maintains, contributes to, or has
any liability in respect of (or has in the past five (5) years established, maintained, contributed to, or had any liability in respect
of) any Pension Plan; (ii) any established Pension Plan presently complies and has been maintained in compliance with its terms and with
the requirements of all applicable statutes, rules and regulations, including ERISA and the Code; (iii) no “prohibited transaction”
(within the meaning of Section 406 of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code) has occurred with respect to any Pension Plan, other than transactions
effected pursuant to a statutory or administrative exemption; and (iv) each Pension Plan that is intended to be qualified under Section
401(a) of the Code is so qualified and nothing has occurred which would cause the loss of such qualification.
(m)
No Manager Termination Event. No Manager Termination Event has occurred or is continuing, and, to the Actual Knowledge of the
Manager, there is no event which, with notice or lapse of time, or both, would constitute a Manager Termination Event.
(n)
Location of Records. The offices at which the Manager keeps its records concerning the Managed Assets are located at the addresses
indicated in Section 8.5.
(o)
DISCLAIMER. EXCEPT FOR THE MANAGER’S REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES SET FORTH HEREIN AND IN ANY OTHER RELATED DOCUMENT,
THE MANAGER MAKES NO WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, EITHER IN FACT OR BY OPERATION OF LAW, STATUTORY OR OTHERWISE, WITH RESPECT TO THE
SUBJECT MATTER HEREOF TO ANY OTHER PARTY, AND EACH PARTY EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING WARRANTY OF TITLE, NON-INFRINGEMENT,
MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
Section
4.2 Existence; Status as Manager. The Manager shall (a) keep in full effect its existence under the laws of the state of its incorporation,
(b) maintain all rights and privileges necessary or desirable in the normal conduct of its business and the performance of its obligations
hereunder except to the extent that failure to do so would not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect and (c)
obtain and preserve its qualification to do business in each jurisdiction in which the failure to so qualify either individually or in
the aggregate would reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.
Section
4.3 Performance of Obligations.
(a)
Performance. The Manager shall perform and observe all of its obligations and agreements contained in this Agreement and the other
Transaction Documents in accordance with the terms hereof and thereof and in accordance with the Managing Standard.
(b)
Special Provisions as to Securitization IP.
(i)
The Manager acknowledges and agrees that each Guarantor has the right and duty to control the quality of the goods and services offered
under such Guarantor’s Trademarks included in the Securitization IP and the manner in which such Trademarks are used in order to
maintain the validity and enforceability of and its ownership of the Trademarks included in the Securitization IP. The Manager shall
not take any action contrary to the express written instruction of the applicable Guarantor with respect to: (A) the promulgation of
standards with respect to the operation of Branded Restaurants, including quality of food, cleanliness, appearance, and level of service
(or the making of material changes to the existing standards), (B) the promulgation of standards with respect to new businesses, products
and services which the applicable Guarantor approves for inclusion in the license granted under any IP License Agreement (or other license
agreement or sublicense agreement for which the Manager is performing IP Services), (C) the nature and implementation of means of monitoring
and controlling adherence to the standards, (D) the terms of any Franchise Agreements, the Product Sourcing Agreements or other sublicense
agreements relating to the quality standards which licensees must follow with respect to businesses, products, and services offered under
the Trademarks included in the Securitization IP and the usage of such Trademarks, (E) the commencement and prosecution of enforcement
actions with respect to the Trademarks included in the Securitization IP and the terms of any settlements thereof, (F) the adoption of
any variations on the Brands which are not in use on the Closing Date, or other new Trademarks to be included in the Securitization IP,
(G) the abandonment of any Securitization IP and (H) any uses of the Securitization IP that are not consistent with the Managing Standard.
The Guarantors shall have the right to monitor the Manager’s compliance with the foregoing and its performance of the IP Services
and, in furtherance thereof, Manager shall provide each Guarantor, at either Guarantor’s written request from time to time, with
copies of Franchise Documents, the Product Sourcing Agreements and other sublicenses, samples of products and materials bearing the Trademarks
included in the Securitization IP used by Franchisees, any manufacturer or distributor of Products and other licensees and sublicensees.
Nothing in this Agreement shall limit the Guarantors’ rights or the licensees’ obligations under the IP License Agreements
or any other agreement with respect to which the Manager is performing IP Services.
(ii)
The Manager is hereby granted a non-exclusive, royalty-free sublicensable license to use the Securitization IP solely in connection with
the performance of the Services under this Agreement. In connection with the Manager’s use of any Trademark included in the Securitization
IP pursuant to the foregoing license, the Manager agrees to adhere to the quality control provisions and sublicensing provisions, with
respect to sublicenses issued hereunder, which are contained in each IP License Agreement, as applicable to the product or service to
which such Trademark pertains, as if such provisions were incorporated by reference herein.
(c)
Right to Receive Instructions. Without limiting the Manager’s obligations under Section 4.3(b) above, in the event
that the Manager is unable to decide between alternative courses of action, or is unsure as to the application of any provision of this
Agreement, the other Transaction Documents or any Managed Documents, or any such provision is, in the good faith judgment of the Manager,
ambiguous as to its application, or is, or appears to be, in conflict with any other applicable provision, or in the event that this
Agreement, any other Transaction Document or any Managed Document permits any determination by the Manager or is silent or is incomplete
as to the course of action which the Manager is required to take with respect to a particular set of facts, the Manager may make a Consent
Request to the Control Party for written instructions in accordance with the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents and, to the
extent that the Manager shall have acted or refrained from acting in good faith in accordance with instructions, if any, received from
the Control Party with respect to such Consent Request, the Manager shall not be liable on account of such action or inaction to any
Person; provided that the Control Party shall be under no obligation to provide any such instruction if it is unable to decide between
alternative courses of action. Subject to the Managing Standard, if the Manager shall not have received appropriate instructions from
the Control Party within ten days of such notice (or within such shorter period of time as may be specified in such notice), the Manager
may, but shall be under no duty to, take or refrain from taking such action, not inconsistent with this Agreement or the Transaction
Documents, as the Manager shall deem to be in the best interests of the Noteholders and the Securitization Entities. The Manager shall
have no liability to any Secured Party or the Controlling Class Representative for such action or inaction taken in reliance on the preceding
sentence except for the Manager’s own bad faith, negligence or willful misconduct.
(d)
Limitation on Manager’s Duties and Responsibilities.
(i)
The Manager shall not have any duty or obligation to manage, make any payment in respect of, register, record, sell, reinvest, dispose
of, create, perfect or maintain title to, or any security interest in, or otherwise deal with the Collateral, to prepare or file any
report or other document or to otherwise take or refrain from taking any action under, or in connection with, any document contemplated
hereby to which the Manager is a party, except as expressly provided by the terms of this Agreement or the other Transaction Documents
and consistent with the Managing Standard, and no implied duties or obligations shall be read into this Agreement against the Manager.
The Manager nevertheless agrees that it shall, at its own cost and expense, promptly take all action as may be necessary to discharge
any Liens (other than Permitted Liens) on any part of the Managed Assets which result from valid claims against the Manager personally
whether or not related to the ownership or administration of the Managed Assets or the transactions contemplated by the Transaction Documents.
(ii)
Except as otherwise set forth herein and in the other Transaction Documents, the Manager shall have no responsibility under this Agreement
other than to render the Services in good faith and consistent with the Managing Standard.
(iii)
The Manager shall not manage, control, use, sell, reinvest, dispose of or otherwise deal with any part of the Collateral except in accordance
with the powers granted to, and the authority conferred upon, the Manager pursuant to this Agreement or the other Transaction Documents.
(e)
Limitations on the Manager’s Liabilities, Duties and Responsibilities. Subject to Section 2.7 and except for any
loss, liability, expense, damage, action, suit or injury arising out of, or resulting from, (i) any breach or default by the Manager
in the observance or performance of any of its agreements contained in this Agreement or any other Transaction Document to which it is
a party in its capacity as Manager, (ii) the breach by the Manager of any representation, warranty or covenant made by it herein or any
other Transaction Document to which it is a party in its capacity as Manager or (iii) acts or omissions constituting the Manager’s
own bad faith, negligence or willful misconduct, in the performance of its duties hereunder or under the other Transaction Documents
or otherwise, neither the Manager nor any of its Affiliates, managers, officers, members or employees shall be liable to any Securitization
Entity, the Noteholders or any other Person under any circumstances, including: (1) for any action taken or omitted to be taken by the
Manager in good faith in accordance with the instructions of the Trustee, the Control Party or the Back-Up Manager; (2) for any representation,
warranty, covenant, agreement or Indebtedness of any Securitization Entity under the Notes, any other Transaction Documents or the Managed
Documents, or for any other liability or obligation of any Securitization Entity; (3) for the validity or sufficiency of this Agreement
or the due execution hereof by any party hereto other than the Manager, or the form, character, genuineness, sufficiency, value or validity
of any part of the Collateral (including the creditworthiness of any Franchisee, lessee or other obligor thereunder), or for, or in respect
of, the validity or sufficiency of the Transaction Documents; and (4) for any action or inaction of the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager
or the Control Party or for the performance of, or the supervision of the performance of, any obligation under this Agreement or any
other Transaction Document that is required to be performed by the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager or the Control Party.
(f)
No Financial Liability. No provision of this Agreement (other than Sections 2.6, 2.7, 4.3(d)(i) and 4.3(e))
shall require the Manager to expend or risk its funds or otherwise incur any financial liability in the performance of any of its rights
or powers hereunder, if the Manager shall have reasonable grounds for believing that repayment of such funds or adequate indemnity against
such risk or liability is not compensated by the payment of the Monthly Management Fee and is otherwise not reasonably assured or provided
to the Manager. Further, the Manager shall not be obligated to perform any services not enumerated or otherwise contemplated hereunder,
unless the Manager determines that it is more likely than not that it shall be reimbursed for all of its expenses incurred in connection
with such performance. The Manager shall not be liable under the Notes and shall not be responsible for any amounts required to be paid
by the Securitization Entities under or pursuant to the Indenture.
(g)
Reliance. The Manager may, reasonably and in good faith, conclusively rely on, and shall be protected in acting or refraining
from acting when doing so, in each case in accordance with any signature, instrument, notice, resolution, request, consent, order, certificate,
report, opinion, bond or other document or paper reasonably believed by it to be genuine and believed by it to be signed by the proper
party or parties other than its Affiliates. The Manager may reasonably accept a certified copy of a resolution of the board of directors
or other governing body of any corporate or other entity other than its Affiliates as conclusive evidence that such resolution has been
duly adopted by such body and that the same is in full force and effect. As to any fact or matter the manner or ascertainment of which
is not specifically prescribed herein, the Manager may in good faith for all purposes hereof reasonably rely on a certificate, signed
by any Authorized Officer of the relevant party, as to such fact or matter, and such certificate reasonably relied upon in good faith
shall constitute full protection to the Manager for any action taken or omitted to be taken by it in good faith in reliance thereon.
(h)
Consultations with Third Parties; Advice of Counsel. In the exercise and performance of its duties and obligations hereunder or
under any of the Transaction Documents, the Manager (A) may act directly or through agents or attorneys pursuant to agreements entered
into with any of them; provided that the Manager shall remain primarily liable hereunder for the acts or omissions of such agents or
attorneys and (B) may, at the expense of the Manager, consult with external counsel or accountants selected and monitored by the Manager
in good faith and in the absence of negligence, and the Manager shall not be liable for anything done, suffered or omitted in good faith
by it in accordance with the advice or opinion of any such external counsel or accountants with respect to legal or accounting matters.
(i)
Independent Contractor. In performing its obligations as manager hereunder the Manager acts solely as an independent contractor
of the Securitization Entities, except to the extent the Manager is deemed to be an agent of the Securitization Entities by virtue of
engaging in franchise sales activities, as a broker, or receiving payments on behalf of the Securitization Entities, as applicable. Nothing
in this Agreement shall, or shall be deemed to, create or constitute any joint venture, partnership, employment, or any other relationship
between the Securitization Entities and the Manager other than the independent contractor contractual relationship established hereby.
Nothing herein shall be deemed to vest in the Manager title to any of the Securitization IP. Except as otherwise provided herein or in
the other Transaction Documents, the Manager shall not be, nor shall be deemed to be, liable for any acts or obligations of the Securitization
Entities, the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager or the Control Party (except as set forth in Section 2.7 hereof).
Section
4.4 Merger and Resignation.
(a)
Preservation of Existence. The Manager shall not merge into any other Person or convey, transfer or lease substantially all of
its assets; provided, however, that nothing contained in this Agreement shall be deemed to prevent (i) the merger into the Manager of
another Person, (ii) the consolidation of the Manager and another Person, (iii) the merger of the Manager into another Person or (iv)
the sale of substantially all of the property or assets of the Manager to another Person, so long as (A) the surviving Person of the
merger or consolidation or the purchaser of the assets of the Manager shall continue to be engaged in the same line of business as the
Manager and shall have the capacity to perform its obligations hereunder with at least the same degree of care, skill and diligence as
measured by customary practices with which the Manager is required to perform such obligations hereunder, (B) in the case of a merger,
consolidation or sale, the surviving Person of the merger or the purchaser of the assets of the Manager shall expressly assume the obligations
of the Manager under this Agreement and expressly agree to be bound by all other provisions applicable to the Manager under this Agreement
in a supplement to this Agreement in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee and the Control Party and (C) with respect
to such event, in and of itself, the Rating Agency Condition, if applicable, has been satisfied. For the avoidance of doubt and notwithstanding
any other provision of this Agreement, nothing in this Agreement shall prevent the Manager and/or its Affiliates from entering into a
Qualified Equity Offering.
(a)
Resignation. The Manager shall not resign from the rights, powers, obligations and duties hereby imposed on it except upon its
determination that (A) the performance of its duties hereunder is no longer permissible under applicable Requirements of Law and (B)
there is no reasonable action that the Manager could take to make the performance of its duties hereunder permissible under applicable
Requirements of Law. Any such determination permitting the resignation of the Manager pursuant to clause (A) above shall be evidenced
by an Opinion of Counsel to such effect delivered to the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party. No such resignation shall
become effective until a Successor Manager (other than Back-Up Manager) shall have been appointed by the Control Party (acting at the
direction of the Controlling Class representative) and shall have assumed the responsibilities and obligations of the Manager in accordance
with Section 6.1(a). The Trustee, the Securitization Entities, the Back-Up Manager, the Control Party and the Rating Agencies,
if any, shall be notified of such resignation in writing by the Manager. From and after such effectiveness, the Successor Manager shall
be, to the extent of the assignment, the “Manager” hereunder. Except as provided above in this Section 4.4 the Manager
may not assign this Agreement or any of its rights, powers, duties or obligations hereunder.
(b)
Term of Manager’s Obligations. Except as provided in Section 4.4(a) and Section 4.4(b), the duties and obligations
of the Manager under this Agreement commenced on the Closing Date and shall continue until this Agreement shall have been terminated
as provided in Section 6.1(a) or Section 8.1, and shall survive the exercise by any Securitization Entity, the Trustee
or the Control Party of any right or remedy under this Agreement (other than the right of termination pursuant to Section 6.1(a)),
or the enforcement by any Securitization Entity, the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager, the Control Party, the Controlling Class Representative
or any Noteholder of any provision of the Indenture, the Notes, this Agreement or the other Transaction Documents.
Section
4.5 Notice of Certain Events. The Manager shall give written notice to the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager, the Control Party and
the Rating Agencies, if any, promptly upon the occurrence of any of the following events that would reasonably be expected to result
in a Material Adverse Effect (but in any event no later than thirty (30) Business Days (or, for subclauses (f) and (g) below, five (5)
Business Days) after the Manager has Actual Knowledge of the occurrence of such an event): (a) the Manager, or any member of a Controlled
Group that includes the Manager, shall engage in a nonexempt “prohibited transaction” ( within the meaning of Section 406
of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code) with respect to a Pension Plan; (b) a failure to meet the “minimum funding standard”
requirements (as defined in Section 302 of ERISA), whether or not waived, shall exist with respect to any Pension Plan, or any Lien in
favor of the PBGC or a Pension Plan shall arise on the assets of the Manager; (c) a Reportable Event shall occur with respect to, or
proceedings shall commence to have a trustee appointed, or a trustee shall be appointed, to administer or to terminate, any Pension Plan,
which Reportable Event or commencement of proceedings or appointment of a trustee is likely to result in the termination of such Pension
Plan for purposes of Title IV of ERISA; (d) any Pension Plan shall terminate for purposes of Title IV of ERISA; (e) the Manager, or any
member of a Controlled Group that includes the Manager, is likely to incur any liability in connection with a complete or partial withdrawal
from, or the insolvency or termination of, a Multiemployer Plan (but in each case in clauses (a) through (e) above, only if such event
or condition, together with all other such events or conditions, if any, would reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse
Effect); (f) a Manager Termination Event, an Event of Default, a Hot Back-Up Management Trigger Event, a Warm Back-Up Management Trigger
Event or Rapid Amortization Event or any event which would, with the passage of time or giving of notice or both, would become one or
more of the same; or (g) any action, suit, investigation or proceeding pending or, to the Actual Knowledge of the Manager, threatened
in writing against or affecting the Manager, before or by any court, administrative agency, arbitrator or governmental body having jurisdiction
over the Manager or any of its properties either asserting the illegality, invalidity or unenforceability of any of the Transaction Documents,
seeking any determination or ruling that would affect the legality, binding effect, validity or enforceability of any of the Transaction
Documents or that would reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.
Section
4.6 Capitalization and Indebtedness. The Manager shall have sufficient capital to perform all of its obligations under this Agreement
at all times from the Closing Date and until the Indenture has been terminated in accordance with the terms thereof and shall not incur
any Indebtedness over $10,000,000 (plus up to $15,000,000 of additional Indebtedness for real property where the real property value
exceeds the value of such Indebtedness) without the approval of a Majority of Controlling Class.
Section
4.7 Maintenance of Separateness. The Manager covenants that, except as otherwise contemplated by the Transaction Documents:
(a)
the books and records of the Securitization Entities shall be maintained separately from those of the Manager and each of its Affiliates
that is not a Securitization Entity;
(b)
the Manager shall observe (and shall cause each of its Affiliates that is not a Securitization Entity to observe) corporate and limited
liability company formalities in its dealings with any Securitization Entity;
(c)
all financial statements of the Manager that are consolidated to include any Securitization Entity and that are distributed to any party
shall contain detailed notes clearly stating that (i) all of such Securitization Entity’s assets are owned by such Securitization
Entity and (ii) such Securitization Entity is a separate entity and has separate creditors;
(d)
except as contemplated under Sections 2.2(d), 2.2(e), 2.2(f) and 2.2(g), of this Agreement, the Manager shall
not (and shall not permit any of its Affiliates that is not a Securitization Entity to) commingle its funds with any funds of any Securitization
Entity; provided that the foregoing shall not prohibit the Manager or any successor to or assignee of the Manager from holding funds
of the Securitization Entities in its capacity as Manager for such entity in a segregated account identified for such purpose;
(e)
the Manager shall (and shall cause each of its Affiliates that is not a Securitization Entity to) maintain arm’s length relationships
with each Securitization Entity, and each of the Manager and each of its Affiliates that is not a Securitization Entity shall be compensated
at market rates for any services it renders or otherwise furnishes to any Securitization Entity, it being understood that the Monthly
Management Fee, the Supplemental Management Fee, this Agreement, and the Collateral Documents are representative of such arm’s
length relationship;
(f)
the Manager shall not be, and shall not hold itself out to be, liable for the debts of any Securitization Entity or the decisions or
actions in respect of the daily business and affairs of any Securitization Entities and the Manager shall not permit any Securitization
Entities to hold the Manager out to be liable for the debts of such Securitization Entity or the decisions or actions in respect of the
daily business and affairs of such Securitization Entity; and
(g)
upon an officer or other responsible party of the Manager obtaining Actual Knowledge that any of the foregoing provisions in this Section
4.7 has been breached or violated in any material respect, the Manager shall promptly notify the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager, the
Control Party and the Rating Agencies, if any, of same and shall take such actions as may be reasonable and appropriate under the circumstances
to correct and remedy such breach or violation as soon as reasonably practicable under such circumstances.
Section
4.8 Non-Petition. Until the date that is one year and one day after the date upon which the Securitization Entities have paid in
full all Series of Notes Outstanding (and the Transaction Documents have been terminated), the Manager will not institute against any
Securitization Entity, any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency, liquidation or receivership proceeding under any federal
or state bankruptcy, insolvency or similar law or consent to, or make application for or institute or maintain any action for, the dissolution
of any Securitization Entity under the Delaware LLC Act or any other applicable Requirements of Law.
Section
4.9 Competition. The Manager and its direct or indirect Subsidiaries shall not operate any restaurants outside of the Securitization
Transaction or add any brands similar to the Twin Peaks Restaurants outside of the Securitization Transaction.
Article
V
REPRESENTATIONS,
WARRANTIES AND COVENANTS
Section
5.1 Representations and Warranties Made in Respect of New Assets.
(a)
New Franchise Agreements. As of the applicable New Asset Addition Date with respect to a New Franchise Agreement acquired or entered
into on such New Asset Addition Date, the Manager represents and warrants to the Securitization Entities, the Trustee and the Control
Party that:
(i)
such New Franchise Agreement does not contain terms and conditions that are reasonably expected to result in (A) a material decrease
in the amount of Collections or Retained Collections constituting Franchisee Payments or Franchisee Lease Payments, taken as a whole,
(B) a material adverse change in the nature, quality or timing of Collections constituting Franchisee Payments or Franchisee Lease Payments,
taken as a whole, or (C) a material adverse change in the types of underlying assets generating Collections constituting Franchisee Payments
or Franchisee Lease Payments, taken as a whole, in each case when compared to the amount, nature or quality of, or types of assets generating,
Collections that could have been reasonably expected to result had such New Franchise Agreement been entered into in accordance with
the then-current Franchise Documents; (ii) such New Franchise Agreement is genuine, and is the legal, valid and binding obligation of
the parties thereto and is enforceable against the parties thereto in accordance with its terms (except as such enforceability may be
limited by bankruptcy or insolvency laws and by general principles of equity, regardless of whether such enforceability shall be considered
in a proceeding in equity or at law); (iii) such New Franchise Agreement complies in all material respects with all applicable Requirements
of Law; (iv) the Franchisee related to such agreement is not the subject of a bankruptcy proceeding; (v) royalty fees payable pursuant
to such New Franchise Agreement are payable by the related Franchisee at least monthly; (vi) except as required by applicable Requirements
of Law, such New Franchise Agreement contains no contractual rights of set-off; and
(ii)
except as required by applicable Requirements of Law, such New Franchise Agreement is freely assignable by the applicable Securitization
Entities.
(b)
New Franchisee Notes and New Equipment Leases. As of the applicable New Asset Addition Date with respect to a New Franchisee Note
or New Equipment Lease acquired or entered into on such New Asset Addition Date, the Manager represents and warrants to the Securitization
Entities, the Trustee and the Control Party that: (i) such agreement is genuine, and is the legal, valid and binding obligation of the
parties thereto and is enforceable against the parties thereto in accordance with its terms (except as such enforceability may be limited
by bankruptcy or insolvency laws and by general principles of equity, regardless of whether such enforceability shall be considered in
a proceeding in equity or at law); (ii) such agreement complies in all material respects with all applicable Requirements of Law; (iii)
the Franchisee related to such agreement is not the subject of a bankruptcy proceeding; and (iv) except as required by applicable Requirements
of Law, such agreement is freely assignable by the applicable Securitization Entities.
(c)
New Product Sourcing Assets. As of the applicable New Asset Addition Date with respect to a New Product Sourcing Asset acquired
or entered into on such New Asset Addition Date, the Manager represents and warrants to the Securitization Entities, the Trustee and
the Control Party that: (i) such New Product Sourcing Asset is genuine, and is the legal, valid and binding obligation of the parties
thereto and is enforceable against the parties thereto in accordance with its terms (except as such enforceability may be limited by
bankruptcy or insolvency laws and by general principles of equity, regardless of whether such enforceability shall be considered in a
proceeding in equity or at law) and (ii) such New Product Sourcing Asset complies in all material respects with all applicable Requirements
of Law.
(d)
New Owned Real Property. As of the applicable New Asset Addition Date with respect to New Owned Real Property acquired on such
date, the Manager represents and warrants to the Securitization Entities and the Trustee that: (i) the applicable Guarantor holds fee
simple title to the premises of such New Owned Real Property, free and clear of all Liens (other than Permitted Liens); (ii) such New
Owned Real Property is leased or expected to be leased to a Franchisee or (in the case of the site of a Company Restaurant) a Company
Restaurant Guarantor; (iii) the applicable Guarantor is not in material default in any respect in the performance, observance or fulfillment
of any obligations, covenants or conditions applicable to such New Owned Real Property, the violation of which could create a reversion
of title to such New Owned Real Property to any Person; (iv) to the Manager’s Actual Knowledge, the use of such New Owned Real
Property complies in all material respects with all applicable legal requirements, including building and zoning ordinances and codes
and the certificate of occupancy issued for such property; (v) neither the applicable Guarantor nor, to the Actual Knowledge of the Manager,
any Person leasing such property from the applicable Guarantor, is in material default under any lease of such property and no condition
or event exists, that, after the notice or lapse of time or both, would constitute a material default thereunder by such Guarantor or,
to the Actual Knowledge of the Manager, by any other party thereto; (vi) no condemnation or similar proceeding has been commenced nor,
to the Actual Knowledge of the Manager, is threatened with respect to all or any material portion of such New Owned Real Property; (vii)
all material certifications, permits, licenses and approvals, including certificates of completion and occupancy permits required for
the legal use, occupancy and operation of the Branded Restaurant on such New Owned Real Property, if such property is open for business,
have been obtained and are in full force and effect; and (viii) the Manager has paid, caused to be paid, or confirmed that all taxes
required to be paid by the applicable Guarantor in connection with the acquisition of such New Owned Real Property have been paid in
full from funds of the Securitization Entities.
(e)
New Leased Real Property. As of the applicable New Asset Addition Date with respect to New Franchised Restaurant Leases (“New
Leased Real Property”) acquired or entered into on such New Asset Addition Date, the Manager represents and warrants to the
Securitization Entities and the Trustee that: (i) if applicable, such New Leased Real Property is sub-leased by the applicable Guarantor
to a Franchisee or (in the case of the site of a Company Restaurant) a Company Restaurant Guarantor; (ii) if requested by the Trustee
or the Control Party in writing, the Manager will make available to the Trustee or Control Party, as applicable, full and complete copies
of the lease documents related to such New Leased Real Property; (iii) no material default by the applicable Guarantor, or to the Actual
Knowledge of the Manager, by any other party, exists under any provision of such lease, and no condition or event exists, that, after
the notice or lapse of time or both, would constitute a material default thereunder by such Guarantor or, to the Actual Knowledge of
the Manager, by any other party; (iv) to the Manager’s Actual Knowledge, such New Leased Real Property, and the use thereof, complies
in all material respects with all applicable legal requirements, including building and zoning ordinances and codes and the certificate
of occupancy issued for such property; (v) neither the applicable Guarantor, nor, to the Actual Knowledge of the Manager, the related
sub-lessee has committed any act or omission affording any Governmental Authority the right of forfeiture against such property; (vi)
no condemnation or similar proceeding has been commenced nor, to the Actual Knowledge of the Manager, is threatened with respect to all
or any material portion of such New Leased Real Property; (vii) all policies of insurance (a) required to be maintained by the applicable
Guarantor under such lease and (b) to the Actual Knowledge of the Manager, required to be maintained by the Franchisee under the related
sub-lease, if applicable, are valid and in full force and effect; and (viii) all material certifications, permits, licenses and approvals,
including certificates of completion and occupancy permits required for the legal use, occupancy and operation of the Branded Restaurant
on such New Leased Real Property, if such property is open for business, have been obtained and are in full force and effect.
(f)
The Manager has not since the Closing Date and will not enter into any lease included in the Real Estate Assets after the Closing Date
which (i) requires Manager or its Affiliates (other than the Securitization Entities) to provide a guaranty of any obligation of any
Securitization Entity or (ii) includes any event of default under such lease on the part of any Securitization Entity due to a bankruptcy
of Manager or its Affiliates (other than the Securitization Entities).
(g)
New Development Agreement. As of the applicable New Asset Addition Date with respect to a New Development Agreement acquired or
entered into on such New Asset Addition Date, the Manager represents and warrants to the Securitization Entities, the Trustee and the
Control Party that: (i) such New Development Agreement does not contain terms and conditions that are reasonably expected to result in
(A) a material decrease in the amount of Collections or Retained Collections, taken as a whole, (B) a material adverse change in the
nature, quality or timing of Collections, taken as a whole, or (C) a material adverse change in the types of underlying assets generating
Collections, taken as a whole, in each case when compared to the amount, nature or quality of, or types of assets generating Collections
that would have been reasonably expected to result had such New Development Agreement been entered into in accordance with the then-current
Franchise Documents; (ii) such New Development Agreement is genuine, and is the legal, valid and binding obligation of the parties thereto
and is enforceable against the parties thereto in accordance with its terms (except as such enforceability may be limited by bankruptcy
or insolvency laws and by general principles of equity, regardless of whether such enforceability shall be considered in a proceeding
in equity or at law); (iii) such New Development Agreement complies in all material respects with all applicable Requirements of Law;
(iv) the Franchisee related to such agreement is not the subject of a bankruptcy proceeding; and (v) except as required by applicable
Requirements of Law, such agreement is freely assignable by the applicable Securitization Entities..
(h)
New Company Restaurant. As of the applicable New Asset Addition Date with respect to a New Company Restaurant Lease acquired or
entered into on such New Asset Addition Date, the Manager represents and warrants to the Securitization Entities, the Trustee and the
Control Party that: (i) such New Company Restaurant Lease is genuine, and is the legal, valid and binding obligation of the parties thereto
and is enforceable against the parties thereto in accordance with its terms (except as such enforceability may be limited by bankruptcy
or insolvency laws and by general principles of equity, regardless of whether such enforceability shall be considered in a proceeding
in equity or at law) and (ii) such New Company Restaurant Lease complies in all material respects with all applicable Requirements of
Law.
(i)
New Company Restaurant Lease. As of the applicable New Asset Addition Date, with respect to each New Company Restaurant acquired
on such New Asset Addition Date, the Manager represents and warrants to the Securitization Entities, the Trustee and the Control Party,
that the applicable Guarantor owns full legal and equitable title to each such Company Restaurant, free and clear of any Lien (other
than Permitted Liens) and the addition of such Company Restaurant could not be reasonably expected to have a material adverse effect.
Section
5.2 Assets Acquired After the Closing Date.
(a)
The Manager has caused and shall continue to cause the applicable Guarantor to enter into or acquire each of the following, to the extent
entered into or acquired after the Closing Date: (a) all New Assets, (b) all Securitization IP and (c) all Real Estate Assets. The Manager
may, but shall not be obligated to, cause the Securitization Entities to enter into, develop or acquire assets other than the foregoing
from time to time; provided that the entry into, development or acquisition of any material assets that are not reasonably ancillary
to the restaurant business or the foodservice industry shall require the prior satisfaction of the Rating Agency Condition, if applicable,
and the prior written consent of the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative). Unless otherwise
agreed to in writing by the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), the entry into, development
or acquisition of assets by the Securitization Entities will be subject to all applicable provisions of the Indenture, this Management
Agreement, the IP License Agreements and the other relevant Transaction Documents.
(b)
Unless otherwise agreed to in writing by the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), any contribution
to, or development or acquisition by, any Guarantor of assets obtained after the Closing Date described in Section 5.2(a) shall
be subject to all applicable provisions of the Indenture, this Agreement (including the applicable representations and warranties and
covenants in Articles II and V of this Agreement), the IP License Agreements and the other Transaction Documents. Any Franchise
Agreement that is obtained after the Closing Date as described in Section 5.2(a) shall be deemed to be a New Franchise Agreement
for the purposes of this Agreement.
Section
5.3 Securitization IP. All Securitization IP shall be owned solely by the applicable Guarantor and shall not be assigned, transferred
or licensed out by the Guarantor or Franchise Entities to any other entity other than as permitted or provided under the Transaction
Documents.
Section
5.4 Restrictions on Liens. The Manager shall not, and shall not permit any of its Subsidiaries to, create, incur, assume, permit
or suffer to exist any Lien (other than Liens in favor of the Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties and any Permitted Lien set
forth in clauses (a), (b) or (j) of the definition thereof) upon the Equity Interests of any Securitization Entity.
Article
VI
MANAGER
TERMINATION EVENTS
Section
6.1 Manager Termination Events.
(a)
Manager Termination Events. Any of the following acts or occurrences shall constitute a “Manager Termination Event”
under this Agreement, the assertion as to the occurrence of which may be made, and notice of which may be given, by either a Securitization
Entity, the Back-Up Manager, the Controlling Class Representative, the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class
Representative) or the Trustee (acting at the direction of the Control Party):
(i)
any failure by the Manager to remit a payment required to be deposited from the Concentration Account to the Collection Account or any
other Indenture Trust Account, within three (3) Business Days of the later of (a) its Actual Knowledge of its receipt thereof and (b)
the date such deposit is required to be made pursuant to the Transaction Documents; provided that any inadvertent failure to remit such
a payment shall not be a breach of this clause (i) if in an amount less than $250,000 and corrected within three (3) Business
Days after the Manager obtains Actual Knowledge thereof (it being understood that the Manager will not be responsible for the failure
of the Trustee to remit funds that were received by the Trustee from or on behalf of the Manager in accordance with the applicable Transaction
Documents);
(ii)
the Interest-Only DSCR as calculated as of any Quarterly Calculation Date is less than or equal to 1.20x (for this purpose, clause
(C) of the definition of “Debt Service” shall not apply when calculating the Interest-Only DSCR);
(iii)
any failure by the Manager to provide any required certificate or report set forth in Sections 4.1(a), (c), (d),
(e), (f), (g) or (h) of the Base Indenture within three (3) Business Days of its due date;
(iv)
a material default by the Manager in the due performance and observance of any provision of this Agreement or any other Transaction Document
(other than as described above) to which it is party and the continuation of such default for a period of (A) 30 days after the Manager
has been notified thereof in writing by any Securitization Entity or the Control Party or (B) 5 Business Days in the case of Section
4.6; provided, however, that as long as the Manager is diligently attempting to cure such default (so long as such default is capable
of being cured), such cure period in the preceding clause (A) shall be extended by an additional period as may be required to cure such
default, but in no event by more than an additional 30 days;
(v)
any representation, warranty or statement of the Manager made in this Agreement or any other Transaction Document or in any certificate,
report or other writing delivered pursuant thereto that is not qualified by materiality or the definition of “Material Adverse
Effect” proves to be incorrect in any material respect, or any such representation, warranty or statement of the Manager that is
qualified by materiality or the definition of “Material Adverse Effect” proves to be incorrect, in each case as of the time
when the same was made or deemed to have been made or as of any other date specified in such document or agreement; provided that if
any such breach is capable of being remedied within 30 days after the Manager has obtained Actual Knowledge of such breach or the Manager’s
receipt of written notice thereof, then a Manager Termination Event shall only occur under this clause (v) as a result of such
breach if it is not cured in all material respects by the end of such 30-day period;
(vi)
an Event of Bankruptcy with respect to the Manager shall have occurred;
(vii)
any final, non-appealable order, judgment or decree is entered in any proceedings against the Manager by a court of competent jurisdiction
decreeing the dissolution of the Manager and such order, judgment or decree remains unstayed and in effect for more than ten days;
(viii)
a final non-appealable judgment for an amount in excess of $15,000,000 (exclusive of any portion thereof which is insured) is rendered
against the Manager by a court of competent jurisdiction and is not discharged or stayed within 60 days of the date when due;
(ix)
an acceleration of more than $15,000,000 of the Indebtedness of the Manager which Indebtedness has not been discharged or which acceleration
has not been rescinded and annulled;
(x)
this Agreement or a material portion thereof ceases to be in full force and effect or enforceable in accordance with its terms (other
than in accordance with the express termination provisions hereof) or the Manager asserts as much in writing;
(xi)
the occurrence of either (A) a Change in Management following the occurrence of a Change of Control or (B) an Event of Default under
Section 9.2(o) of the Base Indenture; or
(xii)
the Manager pays any dividends to FAT Brands or its Affiliates.
If
a Manager Termination Event has occurred and is continuing with respect to the Manager, the Control Party (acting at the direction of
the Controlling Class Representative) may (i) waive such Manager Termination Event (except for a Manager Termination Event described
in clauses (vi) or (vii) above) or (ii) direct the Trustee in writing to terminate the Manager in its capacity as such by the delivery
of a termination notice (a “Termination Notice”) to the Manager (with a copy to each of the Securitization Entities,
the Back-Up Manager and the Rating Agencies, if any); provided that the delivery of a Termination Notice to the Manager shall not be
required in the circumstances set forth in clause (vi) or (vii) above. If the Trustee, acting at the direction of the Control
Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), delivers a Termination Notice to the Manager pursuant to this
Agreement (or automatically upon the occurrence of any Manager Termination Event relating to the Manager Termination Events described
in clause (vi) or (vii) above), all rights, powers, duties, obligations and responsibilities of the Manager under this
Agreement and the other Transaction Documents (other than with respect to the payment of Indemnification Amounts or its obligations with
respect to Disentanglement), including with respect to the Accounts or otherwise, will vest in and be assumed by the Successor Manager
appointed by the Control Party (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative). If no Successor Manager has been appointed
by the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), pursuant to the terms of the Back-Up Management
Agreement, the Back-Up Manager will serve as the Interim Successor Manager and will work with the Control Party to implement the Transition
Plan (as such term is defined in the Back-Up Management Agreement) until a Successor Manager (other than the Back-Up Manager) has been
appointed by the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative). Notwithstanding anything to the contrary
contained herein or in any other Transaction Document, in no event shall the Trustee (A) be obligated to become (or be deemed to be)
the Manager or Successor Manager or (B) have any obligation or responsibility to perform any of the duties or obligations of the Manager
or Successor Manager. After the occurrence of a Hot Back-Up Management Trigger Event but prior to the Disentanglement Period, the Manager
shall, unless otherwise directed by the Trustee (acting at the direction of the Control Party acting at the direction of the Controlling
Class Representative) or the Majority of Controlling Class, continue to perform all management functions under the Management Agreement
and the other Transaction Documents other than those being performed by the Back-Up Manager as part of the Hot Back-Up Management Duties.
(b)
From and during the continuation of a Manager Termination Event, each Securitization Entity and the Trustee (acting at the direction
of the Control Party) are hereby irrevocably authorized and empowered to execute and deliver, on behalf of the Manager, as attorney-in-fact
or otherwise, all documents and other instruments (including any notices to Franchisees deemed necessary or advisable by the applicable
Securitization Entity or the Control Party), and to do or accomplish all other acts or take other measures necessary or appropriate,
to effect such vesting and assumption.
Section
6.2 Manager Termination Event Remedies. If the Trustee, acting at the written direction of the Control Party (acting at the direction
of the Controlling Class Representative), delivers a Termination Notice to the Manager pursuant to Section 6.1(a) (or automatically
upon the occurrence of any Manager Termination Event described in clauses (vi) or (vii) of Section 6.1(a)), all
rights, powers, duties, obligations and responsibilities of the Manager under this Agreement (other than with respect to the obligation
to pay any Indemnification Amounts or its obligations with respect to Disentanglement) and the other Transaction Documents, including
with respect to the Managed Assets, the Indenture Trust Accounts, the Management Accounts, the Advertising Fund Accounts or otherwise
shall vest in and be assumed by the Successor Manager.
Section
6.3 Manager’s Transitional Role.
(a)
Disentanglement. Following the delivery of a Termination Notice to the Manager pursuant to Section 6.1(a) or Section
6.2 above or notice of resignation of the Manager pursuant to Section 4.4(b), and for the duration of the Disentanglement
Period, the Manager shall fully and promptly, cooperate with the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party in connection with the implementation
of an approved Transition Plan and the complete transition to a Successor Manager (including in connection with any resignation of the
Manager), without interruption or adverse impact on the provision of Services (the “Disentanglement”). The Manager
will (i) use its commercially reasonable efforts during the Disentanglement Period to not materially reduce the existing staff and resources
of the Manager devoted to or shared with the provision of the Services prior to the date of such Termination Notice and (ii) allow reasonable
access to the Manager’s premises, systems and offices during the Disentanglement Period ((i) and (ii) being referred to as “Continuity
of Services”). The Manager will cooperate fully with the Control Party, Back-Up Manager, Successor Manager and Interim Successor
Manager, as the case may be, and otherwise promptly take all actions reasonably required to assist in effecting a complete Disentanglement
while providing Continuity of Services and, in connection therewith, will promptly follow any directions that may be provided by the
Back-Up Manager and the Control Party. The Manager will provide all information and assistance regarding the terminated Services required
for Disentanglement and Continuity of Services, including data conversion and migration, interface specifications, and related professional
services and provide for the prompt and orderly conclusion or transition of all work, as the Control Party and the Back-Up Manager may
reasonably direct, including completion or partial completion of projects, documentation of all work in progress, and other measures
to assure an orderly transition to the Successor Manager. All services relating to Disentanglement and Continuity of Services, including
all reasonable training for personnel of the Back-Up Manager (including in its capacity as Interim Successor Manager, as applicable),
the Successor Manager or the Successor Manager’s designated alternate service provider in the performance of the Services, will
be deemed a part of the Services to be performed by the Manager.
(b)
Fees and Charges for the Disentanglement Services. So long as the Manager continues to provide any Services during the Disentanglement
Period (including following any removal, resignation or other termination of the Manager), the Manager will continue to be paid the Monthly
Management Fee. Upon the Successor Manager’s assumption of the obligation to perform the applicable Services, the Manager will
be further entitled to reimbursement of its actual costs for the provision of any Disentanglement services other than those related to
Continuity of Services, which shall remain a separate obligation of the Manager.
(c)
Duration of Obligations. The Manager’s obligation to provide Disentanglement services and Continuity of Services will continue
during the Disentanglement Period.
(d)
Sub-managing Arrangements; Authorizations.
(i)
With respect to each Sub-managing Arrangement and unless the Control Party elects to terminate such Sub-managing Arrangement in accordance
with Section 2.10, the Manager shall: (x) assign to the Successor Manager (or such Successor Manager’s designated alternate
service provider) all of the Manager’s rights under such Sub-managing Arrangement to which it is party used by the Manager in performance
of the transitioned Services; and (y) procure any third party authorizations necessary to grant the Successor Manager (or such Successor
Manager’s designated alternate service provider) the use and benefit of such Sub-managing Arrangement to which it is party (used
by the Manager in performing the transitioned Services), pending their assignment to the Successor Manager under this Agreement.
(ii)
If the Control Party elects to terminate such Sub-managing Arrangement in accordance with Section 2.10, the Manager shall take
all reasonable actions necessary or reasonably requested by the Control Party to accomplish a complete transition of the Services performed
by such Sub-manager to the Successor Manager, or to any alternate service provider designated by the Control Party, without interruption
or adverse impact on the provision of Services.
Section
6.4 Intellectual Property. Within thirty (30) days of termination of this Agreement for any reason, the Manager shall deliver and
surrender up to the Guarantors (with a copy to the Successor Manager and the Control Party) any and all products, materials, or other
physical objects containing the Trademarks included in the Securitization IP or Confidential Information of the Guarantors and any copies
of copyrighted works included in the Securitization IP in the Manager’s possession or control, and shall terminate all use of all
Securitization IP, including Trade Secrets; provided that (for the avoidance of doubt) any rights granted to Manager and the other Non-Securitization
Entities as licensees pursuant to the Company Restaurant Licenses shall continue pursuant to the terms thereof notwithstanding the termination
of this Agreement and/or Manager’s role as Manager.
Section
6.5 Third Party Intellectual Property. The Manager shall assist and fully cooperate with the Interim Successor Manager to the extent
necessary to perform its obligations under the Back-Up Management Agreement and the Successor Manager or its designated alternate service
provider and take actions reasonably necessary to assist the Interim Successor Manager, such Successor Manager or its designated alternate
service provider in obtaining any necessary licenses or consents to use any third party Intellectual Property then being used by the
Manager or any Sub-manager. The Manager shall assign, and shall cause each Sub-manager to assign, any such license or sublicense directly
to the Successor Manager or its designated alternate service provider to the extent the Manager, or each Sub-manager, as applicable,
has the rights to assign such agreements to the Successor Manager or such service provider without incurring any additional cost.
Section
6.6 No Effect on Other Parties. Upon any termination of the rights and powers of the Manager from time to time pursuant to Section
6.1 or upon any appointment of a Successor Manager, all the rights, powers, duties, obligations, and responsibilities of the Securitization
Entities or the Trustee under this Agreement, the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents shall remain unaffected by such termination
or appointment and shall remain in full force and effect thereafter, except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement or in the
Indenture.
Section
6.7 Rights Cumulative. All rights and remedies from time to time conferred upon or reserved to the Securitization Entities, the
Trustee, the Control Party, the Back-Up Manager and the Noteholders or to any or all of the foregoing are cumulative, and none is intended
to be exclusive of another or any other right or remedy which they may have at law or in equity. Except as otherwise expressly provided
herein, no delay or omission in insisting upon the strict observance or performance of any provision of this Agreement, or in exercising
any right or remedy, shall be construed as a waiver or relinquishment of such provision, nor shall it impair such right or remedy. Every
such right and remedy may be exercised from time to time and as often as deemed expedient.
Article
VII
CONFIDENTIALITY
Section
7.1 Confidentiality.
(a)
Each of the parties hereto acknowledges that during the Term of this Agreement such party (the “Recipient”) may receive
Confidential Information from another party hereto (the “Discloser”). Each such party (except for the Trustee, whose
confidentiality obligations shall be governed in accordance with the Indenture) agrees to maintain the Confidential Information of the
other party in the strictest of confidence and shall not, except as otherwise contemplated herein, at any time, use, disseminate or disclose
any Confidential Information to any Person other than (i) its officers, directors, managers, employees, agents, advisors or representatives
(including legal counsel and accountants) or (ii) in the case of the Manager and the Securitization Entities, Franchisees and prospective
Franchisees, suppliers or other service providers under written confidentiality agreements that contain provisions at least as protective
as those set forth in this Agreement. The Recipient shall be liable for any breach of this Section 7.1 by any of its officers, directors,
managers, employees, agents, advisors, representatives, Franchisees and prospective Franchisees, suppliers or other services providers
and shall immediately notify Discloser in the event of any loss or disclosure of any Confidential Information of the Discloser. Upon
termination of this Agreement, Recipient shall return to the Discloser, or at Discloser’s request, destroy, all documents and records
in its possession containing the Confidential Information of the Discloser. Confidential Information shall not include information that:
(A) is already known to Recipient without restriction on use or disclosure prior to receipt of such information from the Discloser; (B)
is or becomes part of the public domain other than by breach of this Agreement by, or other wrongful act of, the Recipient; (C) is developed
by the Recipient independently of and without reference to any Confidential Information of the Discloser; (D) is received by the Recipient
from a third party who is not under any obligation to maintain the confidentiality of such information; or (E) is required to be disclosed
by applicable law, statute, rule, regulation, subpoena, court order or legal process; provided that the Recipient shall promptly inform
the Discloser of any such requirement and cooperate with any attempt by the Discloser to obtain a protective order or other similar treatment.
It shall be the obligation of Recipient to prove that such an exception to the definition of Confidential Information exists.
(b)
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in Section 7.1(a), the Parties may use, disseminate or disclose Confidential
Information (other than Trade Secrets) to any Person in connection with the enforcement of rights of the Trustee or the Noteholders under
the Indenture or the Transaction Documents; provided, however, that prior to disclosing any such Confidential Information:
(i)
to any such Person other than in connection with any judicial or regulatory proceeding, such Person shall agree in writing to maintain
such Confidential Information in a manner at least as protective of the Confidential Information as the terms of Section 7.1(a) and
Recipient shall provide Discloser with the written opinion of counsel that such disclosure contains Confidential Information only to
the extent necessary to facilitate the enforcement of such rights of the Trustee or the Noteholders; or
(ii)
to any such Person or entity in connection with any judicial or regulatory proceeding, Recipient will (x) promptly notify Discloser of
each such requirement and identify the documents so required thereby so that Discloser may seek an appropriate protective order or similar
treatment and/or waive compliance with the provisions of this Agreement; (y) use reasonable efforts to assist Discloser in obtaining
such protective order or other similar treatment protecting such Confidential Information prior to any such disclosure; and (z) consult
with Discloser on the advisability of taking legally available steps to resist or narrow the scope of such requirement. If, in the absence
of such a protective order or similar treatment, the Recipient is nonetheless required by law to disclose any part of Discloser’s
Confidential Information, then the Recipient may disclose such Confidential Information without liability under this Agreement, except
that the Recipient will furnish only that portion of the Confidential Information which is legally required.
Article
VIII
MISCELLANEOUS
PROVISIONS
Section
8.1 Termination of Agreement. The respective duties and obligations of the Manager and the Securitization Entities created by this
Agreement commenced on the Closing Date and shall, unless earlier terminated pursuant to Section 6.1(a), terminate upon the satisfaction
and discharge of the Indenture pursuant to Section 12.1 of the Base Indenture (the “Term”). Upon termination
of this Agreement pursuant to this Section 8.1, the Manager shall pay over to the applicable Securitization Entity or any other
Person entitled thereto all proceeds of the Managed Assets held by the Manager.
Section
8.2 Survival. The provisions of Section 2.1(c), Section 2.7, Section 2.8, Section 5.1, Article VI or Article VII and this Section
8.2, Section 8.4, Section 8.5 and Section 8.9 shall survive termination of this Agreement.
Section
8.3 Amendment. (a) This Agreement may only be amended from time to time in writing, upon the written consent of the Trustee (acting
at the direction of the Control Party, acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative), the Securitization Entities,
the Manager and the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative); provided that no consent of the
Trustee or the Control Party shall be required in connection with any amendment to accomplish any of the following:
(i)
to correct (without reducing) or amplify the description of any required activities of the Manager;
(ii)
to add to the duties or covenants of the Manager for the benefit of any Noteholders or any other Secured Parties, or to add provisions
to this Agreement in favor of the Secured Parties so long as such action does not modify the Managing Standard, adversely affect the
enforceability of the Securitization IP, or materially adversely affect the interests of the Noteholders;
(iii)
to correct any manifest error or to cure any ambiguity, defect or provision that may be inconsistent with the terms of the Base Indenture
or any other Transaction Document, or to correct or supplement any provision herein that may be inconsistent with the terms of the Base
Indenture;
(iv)
to evidence the succession of another Person to any party to this Agreement;
(v)
to comply with Requirements of Law;
(vi)
to take any action necessary and appropriate to facilitate the origination of new Managed Documents, the acquisition and management of
Real Estate Assets, or the management and preservation of the Managed Documents, in each case, in accordance with the Managing Standard;
or
(vii)
to provide for additional Services related to any Company Restaurants.
(b)
Any amendment that would adversely affect the Back-Up Manager’s rights, protections, liabilities, obligations, duties, indemnifications
or immunities under this Agreement shall require the prior written consent of the Back-Up Manager.
(c)
Promptly after the execution of any such amendment, the Manager shall send to the Trustee, the Control Party, the Back-Up Manager and
each Rating Agency, if any, a conformed copy of such amendment, but the failure to do so shall not impair or affect its validity.
(d)
Any such amendment or modification effected contrary to the provisions of this Section 8.3 shall be null and void.
Section
8.4 Governing Law. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, AND GOVERNED BY, THE INTERNAL LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW
YORK WITHOUT REGARD TO CHOICE OF LAW RULES (OTHER THAN SECTIONS 5-1401 AND 5-1402 OF THE NEW YORK GENERAL OBLIGATIONS LAW).
Section
8.5 Notices. All notices, requests or other communications desired or required to be given under this Agreement shall be in writing
and shall be sent by (a) certified or registered mail, return receipt requested, postage prepaid, (b) national prepaid overnight delivery
service, (c) telecopy or other facsimile transmission (following with hard copies to be sent by national prepaid overnight delivery service)
or electronic mail (of a .pdf or other similar file), or (d) personal delivery with receipt acknowledged in writing, to the address set
forth in Section 14.1 of the Base Indenture. If the Indenture or this Agreement permits reports to be posted to a password-protected
website, such reports shall be deemed delivered when posted on such website. Any party hereto may change its address for notices hereunder
by giving notice of such change to the other parties hereto, with a copy to the Control Party. Any change of address of a Noteholder
shown on a Note Register shall, after the date of such change, be effective to change the address for such Noteholder hereunder. All
notices and demands to any Person hereunder shall be deemed to have been given either at the time of the delivery thereof at the address
of such Person for notices hereunder, or on the third day after the mailing thereof to such address, as the case may be.
Section
8.6 Acknowledgement. Without limiting the foregoing, the Manager hereby acknowledges that, on the Closing Date, the Issuer has
pledged to the Trustee under the Indenture, all of its right and title to, and interest in, this Agreement and the Collateral, and such
pledge includes all of the Issuer’s rights, remedies, powers and privileges, and all claims against the Manager, under or with
respect to this Agreement (whether arising pursuant to the terms of this Agreement or otherwise available at law or in equity), including
(i) the rights of such Issuer and the obligations of the Manager hereunder and (ii) the right, at any time, to give or withhold consents,
requests, notices, directions, approvals, demands, extensions or waivers under or with respect to this Agreement or the obligations in
respect of the Manager hereunder to the same extent as such Issuer may do. The Manager hereby consents to such pledges described above,
acknowledges and agrees that (x) the Control Party shall be a third-party beneficiary of the rights of such Issuer arising hereunder
and (y) the Trustee and the Control Party may, to the extent provided in the Indenture, enforce the provisions of this Agreement, exercise
the rights of such Issuer and enforce the obligations of the Manager hereunder without the consent of such Issuer.
Section
8.7 Severability of Provisions. If one or more of the provisions of this Agreement shall be for any reason whatever held invalid
or unenforceable, such provisions shall be deemed severable from the remaining covenants, agreements and provisions of this Agreement
and such invalidity or unenforceability shall in no way affect the validity or enforceability of such remaining provisions, or the rights
of any parties hereto. To the extent permitted by law, the parties hereto waive any provision of law that renders any provision of this
Agreement invalid or unenforceable in any respect.
Section
8.8 Delivery Dates. If the due date of any notice, certificate or report required to be delivered by the Manager hereunder falls
on a day that is not a Business Day, the due date for such notice, certificate or report shall be automatically extended to the next
succeeding day that is a Business Day.
Section
8.9 Limited Recourse. The obligations of the Securitization Entities under this Agreement are solely the limited liability company
obligations of the Securitization Entities. The Manager agrees that the Securitization Entities shall be liable for any claims that it
may have against the Securitization Entities only to the extent that funds or assets are available to pay such claims pursuant to the
Indenture.
Section
8.10 Binding Effect; Assignment; Third Party Beneficiaries. The provisions of this Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to
the benefit of the respective successors and assigns of the parties hereto. Any assignment of this Agreement without the written consent
of the Control Party (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) shall be null and void. Each of the Back-Up Manager
and the Control Party is an intended third party beneficiary of this Agreement and may enforce the Agreement as though a party hereto.
Section
8.11 Article and Section Headings. The Article and Section headings herein are for convenience of reference only, and shall not
limit or otherwise affect the meaning hereof.
Section
8.12 Concerning the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, each of
the Trustee, the Back-Up Manager and the Control Party shall be afforded the rights, privileges, protections, immunities and indemnities
set forth in the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents as if fully set forth herein.
Section
8.13 Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed by the parties hereto in several counterparts (including by facsimile or other
electronic means of communication), each of which when so executed shall be deemed to be an original and all of which when taken together
shall constitute but one and the same agreement.
Section
8.14 Entire Agreement. This Agreement, together with the Indenture and the other Transaction Documents and the Managed Documents
constitute the entire agreement and understanding among the parties with respect to the subject matter hereof. Any previous agreement
among the parties with respect to the subject matter hereof is superseded by this Agreement, the Indenture, the other Transaction Documents
and the Managed Documents.
Section
8.15 Waiver of Jury Trial; Jurisdiction; Consent to Service of Process.
(a)
The parties hereto each hereby waives any right to have a jury participate in resolving any dispute, whether in contract, tort or otherwise,
arising out of, connected with, relating to or incidental to the transactions contemplated by this Agreement.
(b)
The parties hereto each hereby irrevocably submits (to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law) to the non-exclusive jurisdiction
of any New York state or federal court sitting in the borough of Manhattan, New York City, State of New York, over any action or proceeding
arising out of or relating to this Agreement or any Transaction Documents, and the parties hereto hereby irrevocably agree that all claims
in respect of such action or proceeding shall be heard and determined in such New York state or federal court. The parties hereto each
hereby irrevocably waive, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, any objection each may now or hereafter have, to remove
any such action or proceeding, once commenced, to another court on the grounds of forum non conveniens or otherwise.
(c)
Each party to this Agreement irrevocably consents to service of process in the manner provided for notices in Section 8.5. Nothing
in this Agreement shall affect the right of any party to this Agreement to serve process in any other manner permitted by law.
Section
8.16 Joinder of New Guarantors. In the event any Issuer shall form an Additional Guarantor pursuant to Section 8.34 of the
Base Indenture, such Additional Guarantor shall execute and deliver to the Manager and the Trustee (i) a Joinder Agreement substantially
in the form of Exhibit B and (ii) Power of Attorney in the form of Exhibit A, and such new Guarantor shall thereafter for
all purposes be a party hereto and have the same rights, benefits and obligations as a Guarantor party hereto on the Closing Date.
[The
remainder of this page is intentionally left blank.]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Agreement to be duly executed by their respective officers thereunto duly authorized
as of the day and year first above written.
MANAGER:
TWIN HOSPITALITY GROUP INC. |
|
|
|
By: |
/s/ Joseph Hummel |
|
Name:
|
Joseph
Hummel |
|
Title:
|
Chief
Executive Officer |
|
ISSUER:
TWIN
HOSPITALITY I, LLC |
|
|
|
By: |
/s/ Robert G. Rosen |
|
Name:
|
Robert
G. Rosen |
|
Title:
|
Chief
Executive Officer |
|
TRUSTEE:
UMB BANK, N.A. |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/ Michele Voon |
|
Name:
|
Michele
Voon |
|
Title:
|
Senior
Vice President |
|
[signatures
continue on next page]
[Management
Agreement]
GUARANTORS:
TP
FRANCHISE AUSTIN, LLC
TP
FRANCHISE ROUND ROCK, LLC
TP
FRANCHISE VENTURE I, LLC
TP
TEXAS BEVERAGES, LLC
TWIN
PEAKS BUYER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT AMARILLO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT AMARILLO BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT AMARILLO MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BEVERAGE - TEXAS, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BROOMFIELD, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BURLESON, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BURLESON BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BURLESON MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT CENTENNIAL, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT DENVER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT DENVER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT DEVELOPMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT EL PASO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT EL PASO BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT FRANCHISE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT FRISCO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT GRAND PRAIRIE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT GRAND PRAIRIE BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT GRAND PRAIRIE MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT INTERNATIONAL FRANCHISE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT INVESTMENT COMPANY, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT INVESTMENT COMPANY II, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT IP, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LEWISVILLE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LITTLE ROCK, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LIVE OAK, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LIVE OAK BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LIVE OAK MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LV -2 LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MIDLAND, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MIDLAND BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT N IRVING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT N IRVING BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT OAKBROOK, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT ODESSA, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT ODESSA BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT PARK NORTH, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT PARK NORTH BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT PARK NORTH MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT RE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT S FORT WORTH, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT S FORT WORTH BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANGELO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANGELO BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANGELO MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANTONIO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANTONIO BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN MARCOS, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN MARCOS BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN MARCOS MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SUNLAND PARK, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SUNLAND PARK BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT VIVA LAS VEGAS, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WARRENVILLE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WESTERN CENTER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WESTERN CENTER BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WESTOVER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WESTOVER BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT JV HOLDING, LLC
BARBEQUE
INTEGRATED, INC.
SMOKEY
BONES (FLORIDA), LLC
GMR
OF PENNSYLVANIA-SB PROPERTIES, LLC
INTEGRATED
CARD SOLUTIONS, LLC
TPJV2,
LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BRANDON, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT FL PAYROLL, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT JV MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LAKELAND, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LIVE OAK RE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MCKINNEY, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MCKINNEY BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MCKINNEY RE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT NORTHLAKE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT PLANO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SARASOTA, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SARASOTA RE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT TERRELL, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT TERRELL BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT TERRELL RE, LLC
By: |
/s/ Joseph Hummel |
|
Name:
|
Joseph
Hummel |
|
Title:
|
Authorized
Person of Barbeque Integrated, Inc., Smokey |
|
Bones (Florida), LLC, GMR of Pennsylvania-SB Properties, LLC and Integrated Card Solutions,
LLC and President of all other Guarantors |
|
[signatures
continue on next page]
[Management
Agreement]
CONSENT
OF CONTROL PARTY:
Citadel
SPV LLC, as Control Party, hereby consents to the execution and delivery of this Agreement by the parties hereto, and as Control Party
hereby directs the Trustee to execute and deliver this Agreement.
Citadel
SPV LLC, as Control Party |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Orlando Figueroa |
|
Name: |
Orlando
Figueroa |
|
Title: |
President |
|
[Management
Agreement]
EXHIBIT
A
POWER
OF ATTORNEY OF THE SECURITIZATION ENTITIES
Dated:
November 21, 2024
KNOW
ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that in connection with the Management Agreement, dated as of November 21, 2024 (as amended, restated,
supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, the “Management Agreement”; all capitalized terms used and not
otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings set forth in the Management Agreement), by and among Twin Hospitality I, LLC, a Delaware
limited liability company (together with its successors and assigns, the “Issuer”); each of the “Guarantors”
from time to time a party thereto (each, a “Guarantor” and together with their respective successors and assigns,
the “Guarantors” and, together with the Issuer, the “Securitization Entities”); Twin Hospitality
Group Inc., a Delaware corporation, as Manager (the “Manager”); and UMB Bank, N.A., as the indenture trustee; and
consented to by Citadel SPV LLC, as Control Party, the undersigned Securitization Entities hereby appoint the Manager and any and all
officers thereof as its true and lawful attorney in fact, with full power of substitution, in connection with the Services (as defined
in the Management Agreement) being performed with respect to the Managed Assets, with full irrevocable power and authority in the place
of each Securitization Entity and in the name of each Securitization Entity or in its own name as agent of each Securitization Entity,
to take any and all appropriate action and to execute any and all documents and instruments that may be necessary or desirable to accomplish
the foregoing, subject to the Management Agreement, including, without limitation, the full power to:
a.
perform such functions and duties, and prepare and file such documents, as are required under the Indenture and the other Transaction
Documents to be performed, prepared and/or filed by the Securitization Entities, including: (i) recording such financing statements (including
continuation statements) or amendments thereof or supplements thereto or other instruments as the Trustee and the Securitization Entities
may from time to time reasonably request in order to perfect and maintain the Lien in the Collateral granted by the Securitization Entities
to the Trustee under the Transaction Documents in accordance with the UCC; and (ii) executing grants of security interests or any similar
instruments required under the Transaction Documents to evidence such Lien in the Collateral; and
b.
take such actions on behalf of each Securitization Entity as such Securitization Entity or Manager may reasonably request that are expressly
required by the terms, provisions and purposes of the Management Agreement; or cause the preparation by other appropriate Persons, of
all documents, certificates and other filings as each Securitization Entity shall be required to prepare and/or file under the terms
of the Transaction Documents.
With
respect to the IP Services, the undersigned hereby further appoint the Manager and any and all officers thereof as its true and lawful
attorney in fact, with full power of substitution, in connection with the IP Services described below being performed with respect to
the Securitization IP, with full irrevocable power and authority in the place of the applicable Securitization Entity that is the owner
thereof and in the name of the applicable Securitization Entity or in its own name as agent of such Securitization Entity, to take any
and all appropriate action and to execute any and all documents and instruments which may be necessary or desirable to accomplish the
foregoing, subject to the Management Agreement, including, without limitation, the full power to perform:
c.
searching, screening and clearing After-Acquired Securitization IP to assess patentability, registrability and the risk of potential
infringement;
d.
filing, prosecuting and maintaining applications and registrations for the Securitization IP in the applicable Securitization Entity’s
name throughout the world, including timely filing of evidence of use, applications for renewal and affidavits of use and/or incontestability,
timely paying of all registration and maintenance fees, responding to third-party oppositions of applications or challenges to registrations,
and responding to any office actions, reexaminations, interferences, “inter partes” reviews, post grant reviews, or other
office or examiner requests, reviews or requirements;
e.
monitoring third-party use and registration of Trademarks and taking actions the Manager deems appropriate to oppose or contest the use
and any application or registration for Trademarks that could reasonably be expected to infringe, dilute or otherwise violate the Securitization
IP or the applicable Securitization Entity’s rights therein;
f.
confirming each Securitization Entity’s legal title in and to any or all of the Securitization IP, including obtaining written
assignments of Securitization IP to the applicable Securitization Entity and recording transfers of title in the appropriate intellectual
property registry throughout the world;
g.
with respect to each Securitization Entity’s rights and obligations under the IP License Agreements and any Transaction Documents,
monitoring the licensee’s use of each licensed Trademark and the quality of its goods and services offered in connection with such
Trademarks, rendering any approvals (or disapprovals) that are required under the applicable license agreement(s), and employing reasonable
means to ensure that any use of any such Trademarks by any such licensee satisfies the quality control standards and usage provisions
of the applicable license agreement;
h.
protecting, policing, and, in the event that the Manager becomes aware of any unlicensed copying, imitation, infringement, dilution,
misappropriation, unauthorized use or other violation of the Securitization IP, or any portion thereof, enforcing such Securitization
IP, including, (i) preparing and responding to cease-and-desist, demand and notice letters, and requests for a license; and (ii) commencing,
prosecuting and/or resolving claims or suits involving imitation, infringement, dilution, misappropriation, the unauthorized use or other
violation of the Securitization IP, and seeking monetary and equitable remedies as the Manager deems appropriate in connection therewith;
provided that each Securitization Entity shall, and agrees to, join as a party to any such suits to the extent necessary to maintain
standing;
i.
performing such functions and duties, and preparing and filing such documents, as are required under the Indenture or any other Transaction
Document to be performed, prepared and/or filed by the applicable Securitization Entity, including (i) executing and recording such financing
statements (including continuation statements) or amendments thereof or supplements thereto or such other instruments as the Issuer or
the Control Party may, from time to time, reasonably request (consistent with the obligations of the Securitization Entities to perfect
the Trustee’s lien only in the United States) in connection with the security interests in the Securitization IP granted by each
Securitization Entity to the Trustee under the Indenture and (ii) preparing, executing and delivering grants of security interests or
any similar instruments as the Issuer or the Control Party may, from time to time, reasonably request (consistent with the obligations
of each Securitization Entity to perfect the Trustee’s lien only in the United States) that are intended to evidence such security
interests in the Securitization IP and recording such grants or other instruments with the relevant Governmental Authority including
the PTO and the United States Copyright Office;
j.
taking such actions as any licensee under an IP License Agreement may request that are required by the terms, provisions and purposes
of such IP License Agreement (or by any other agreements pursuant to which the applicable Securitization Entity licenses the use of any
Securitization IP) to be taken by the applicable Securitization Entity, and preparing (or causing to be prepared) for execution by each
Securitization Entity all documents, certificates and other filings as each Securitization Entity shall be required to prepare and/or
file under the terms of such IP License Agreements (or such other agreements);
k.
paying or causing to be paid or discharged, from funds of the Securitization Entities, any and all taxes, charges and assessments that
may be levied, assessed or imposed upon any of the Securitization IP or contesting the same in good faith;
l.
obtaining licenses of third-party Intellectual Property for use and sublicense in connection with the Managed Assets and any other assets
of the Securitization Entities;
m.
sublicensing the Securitization IP to suppliers, manufacturers, advertisers and other service providers in connection with the provision
of products and services for use in the Restaurant Business; and
n.
with respect to Trade Secrets and other confidential information of each Securitization Entity, taking all reasonable measures to maintain
confidentiality and to prevent non-confidential disclosures.
THIS
POWER OF ATTORNEY IS GOVERNED BY THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK APPLICABLE TO POWERS OF ATTORNEY MADE AND TO BE EXERCISED WHOLLY WITHIN
SUCH STATE.
This
power of attorney is coupled with an interest. Capitalized terms used herein, and not defined herein shall have the meanings applicable
to such terms in the Management Agreement.
[The
remainder of this page is intentionally left blank.]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned parties hereto have caused this Power of Attorney to be duly executed by their respective officers thereunto
duly authorized as of the day and year first above written.
ISSUER:
TWIN
HOSPITALITY I, LLC |
|
|
|
By: |
|
|
Name:
|
Kenneth
Kuick |
|
Title:
|
Treasurer
and Chief Financial Officer |
|
[Signature
Pages Continue]
A notary public or other officer completing this certificate verifies only the identity of the individual who signed the document to which this certificate is attached, and not the truthfulness, accuracy, or validity of that document.
STATE OF CALIFORNIA |
) |
|
) ss. |
COUNTY OF LOS ANGELES |
) |
On
______________________ ___, 2024 before me, ____________________, Notary Public, personally appeared ________________, who proved to me on the basis
of satisfactory evidence to be the person whose name is subscribed to the within instrument and acknowledged to me that he/she executed
the same in his/her authorized capacity/ies, and that by his/her signature on the instrument the person, or the entity upon behalf of
which the person acted, executed the instrument.
I
certify under PENALTY OF PERJURY under the laws of the State of California that the foregoing paragraph is true and correct. WITNESS
my hand and official seal.
|
__________________________________ |
|
____________, Notary Public |
GUARANTORS:
TP
FRANCHISE AUSTIN, LLC
TP
FRANCHISE ROUND ROCK, LLC
TP
FRANCHISE VENTURE I, LLC
TP
TEXAS BEVERAGES, LLC
TWIN
PEAKS BUYER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT AMARILLO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT AMARILLO BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT AMARILLO MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BEVERAGE - TEXAS, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BROOMFIELD, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BURLESON, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BURLESON BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BURLESON MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT CENTENNIAL, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT DENVER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT DENVER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT DEVELOPMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT EL PASO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT EL PASO BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT FRANCHISE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT FRISCO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT GRAND PRAIRIE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT GRAND PRAIRIE BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT GRAND PRAIRIE MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT INTERNATIONAL FRANCHISE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT INVESTMENT COMPANY, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT INVESTMENT COMPANY II, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT IP, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LEWISVILLE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LITTLE ROCK, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LIVE OAK, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LIVE OAK BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LIVE OAK MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LV -2 LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MIDLAND, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MIDLAND BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT N IRVING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT N IRVING BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT OAKBROOK, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT ODESSA, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT ODESSA BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT PARK NORTH, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT PARK NORTH BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT PARK NORTH MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT RE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT S FORT WORTH, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT S FORT WORTH BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANGELO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANGELO BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANGELO MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANTONIO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN ANTONIO BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN MARCOS, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN MARCOS BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SAN MARCOS MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SUNLAND PARK, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SUNLAND PARK BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT VIVA LAS VEGAS, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WARRENVILLE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WESTERN CENTER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WESTERN CENTER BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WESTOVER, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT WESTOVER BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT JV HOLDING, LLC
BARBEQUE
INTEGRATED, INC.
SMOKEY
BONES (FLORIDA), LLC
GMR
OF PENNSYLVANIA-SB PROPERTIES, LLC
INTEGRATED
CARD SOLUTIONS, LLC
TPJV2,
LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT BRANDON, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT FL PAYROLL, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT JV MANAGEMENT, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LAKELAND, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT LIVE OAK RE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MCKINNEY, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MCKINNEY BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT MCKINNEY RE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT NORTHLAKE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT PLANO, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SARASOTA, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT SARASOTA RE, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT TERRELL, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT TERRELL BEVERAGE HOLDING, LLC
TWIN
RESTAURANT TERRELL RE, LLC
By: |
|
|
Name:
|
Joseph
Hummel |
|
Titles: |
Authorized
Person of Barbeque Integrated, Inc., Smokey |
|
Bones (Florida), LLC, GMR of Pennsylvania-SB Properties, LLC and Integrated Card Solutions, LLC President of all other Guarantors |
|
EXHIBIT
B
JOINDER
AGREEMENT
JOINDER
AGREEMENT, dated as of ___, 20______ (this “Joinder Agreement”), made by __________, a __________________ (the
“Additional Guarantor”), in favor of TWIN HOSPITALITY GROUP INC., a Delaware corporation, as Manager (the “Manager”),
and UMB BANK, N.A., as Trustee (in such capacity, together with its successors, the “Trustee”). All capitalized terms
not defined herein shall have the meaning ascribed to them in the Management Agreement (as defined below).
W
I T N E S E T H:
WHEREAS,
Twin Hospitality I, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “Issuer”), the Trustee and UMB Bank, N.A., as securities
intermediary, have entered into a Base Indenture dated as of the Closing Date, (as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified
from time to time, exclusive of any Series Supplements, the “Base Indenture” and, together with all Series Supplements,
the “Indenture”), providing for the issuance from time to time of one or more Series of Notes thereunder; and
WHEREAS,
in connection with the Base Indenture, the Issuer, the other Securitization Entities party thereto from time to time, the Manager and
the Trustee have entered into the Management Agreement, dated as of November 21, 2024 (as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise
modified from time to time, the “Management Agreement”); and
WHEREAS,
the Additional Guarantor has agreed to execute and deliver this Joinder Agreement in order to become a party to the Management Agreement;
NOW,
THEREFORE, IT IS AGREED:
2.
Management Agreement. By executing and delivering this Joinder Agreement, the Additional Guarantor, as provided in Section
8.16 of the Management Agreement, hereby becomes a party to the Management Agreement as a Guarantor thereunder with the same force
and effect as if originally named therein as a Guarantor and, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, hereby expressly assumes
all obligations and liabilities of a Guarantor thereunder. Each reference to a “Guarantor” in the Management Agreement shall
be deemed to include the Additional Guarantor. [The Additional Guarantor is designated as [a Franchise Entity] [an IP Guarantor] [a Company
Restaurant Guarantor].] The Management Agreement is hereby incorporated herein by reference.
3.
Counterparts; Binding Effect. This Joinder Agreement may be executed in counterparts (and by different parties hereto on different
counterparts), each of which shall constitute an original, but all of which taken together shall constitute a single contract. This Joinder
Agreement shall become effective when each of the Additional Guarantor, the Manager and the Trustee has executed a counterpart hereof.
Delivery of an executed counterpart of a signature page of this Joinder Agreement by telecopy shall be effective as delivery of a manually
executed counterpart of this Joinder Agreement.
4.
Full Force and Effect. Except as expressly supplemented hereby, the Management Agreement shall remain in full force and effect.
5.
Governing Law. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED AND INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF
NEW YORK WITHOUT REGARD TO CONFLICTS OF LAW PRINCIPLES (OTHER THAN SECTIONS 5-1401 AND 5-1402 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATIONS LAW OF THE STATE
OF NEW YORK).
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has caused this Joinder Agreement to be duly executed and delivered as of the date first above written.
|
[NAME OF ADDITIONAL GUARANTOR] |
|
|
|
|
By: |
|
|
Name: |
|
|
Title: |
|
AGREED
TO AND ACCEPTED
TWIN
HOSPITALITY GROUP INC., as Manager
UMB
BANK, N.A., in its capacity as Trustee
Exhibit
10.3
PLEDGE
AND SECURITY AGREEMENT
This
Pledge and Security Agreement (as amended, restated, waived, supplemented and/or otherwise modified from time to time, the “Agreement”),
dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among FAT Brands Inc., a Delaware corporation (the “Pledgor”), UMB Bank, N.A.,
not in its individual capacity but solely, in its capacity as the Trustee under the Indenture (as defined below) (the “Indenture
Trustee”) and UMB Bank, N.A. not in its individual capacity but solely as securities intermediary (together with its successors
and assigns, the “Securities Intermediary”). Each of the Pledgor, the Indenture Trustee and the Securities Intermediary
are referred to herein collectively as the “Parties” and individually as a “Party.”
RECITALS
WHEREAS,
the Pledgor is the direct or indirect owner of FB Resid Holdings I, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “Issuer”);
WHEREAS,
the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee have entered into the Indenture;
WHEREAS,
the Parties desire to further collateralize the Obligations (as defined in the Indenture) which each of the Pledgor and the Issuer deem
to be beneficial to their respective interests as set forth below;
WHEREAS,
the Pledgor intends to deposit in the Securities Account shares of Class A common stock, par value $0.0001 per share, of Twin Hospitality
Group Inc. (together with any successor entity, “Twin Hospitality”) in the amount specified on Schedule 1 hereto
(the “Pledged Shares”);
WHEREAS,
the Pledgor desires to grant a security interest in the Securities Account and all property from time to time credited thereto for the
benefit of the Indenture Trustee; and
WHEREAS,
the Parties desire to set forth the procedures for the distribution of any sale proceeds from the Pledged Shares;
NOW,
THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Parties agree as follows:
Section
1. Definitions, Rules of Construction. Capitalized terms not otherwise defined herein have the meanings set
forth in the Indenture, or, to the extent not defined therein, in the Securities Account Control Agreement.
As
used in this Agreement, the following capitalized terms shall have the meanings respectively assigned to them below, which meanings shall
be applicable equally to the singular and plural forms of the terms so defined:
“Applicable
Percentage” shall mean, (x) with respect to the first Proceeds up to and including $87,500,000, an amount equal to 40% and
(y) with respect to any additional Proceeds in excess of $87,500,000, an amount no less than 20% and no more than 40% equal to the quotient
of (i) the aggregate principal amount of the then-outstanding Class A-1A Notes and Class A-2A Notes, including any and all accrued and
unpaid interest thereon, divided by (ii) the total unencumbered value of all outstanding common stock of Twin Hospitality (or any successor
entity) included in the Securities Collateral, assuming for such purposes a per share value equal to the bona fide price in any such
sale of Securities Collateral; provided however, that notwithstanding (x) or (y), in the case of any Proceeds from any sale or disposition
of the Securities Collateral to parties other than Third Parties or during any applicable Grace Period, the Applicable Percentage shall
be 100%.
“Grace
Period” means, solely with respect to the first Event of Default to occur after the date of this Agreement (excluding any Event
of Default under Section 9.2(a) or Section 9.2(b) of the Indenture which shall not be subject to any such period), the sixty-day period
following such Event of Default during which the Issuer may attempt to cure such Event of Default.
“Indenture”
means the Base Indenture, dated as of July 10, 2023, by and between the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the Securities Intermediary,
as amended, restated, modified or otherwise supplemented from time to time including by the Omnibus Amendment, dated on or about the
date hereof, between, inter alia, the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee.
“Obligations”
has the meaning assigned to such term in the Indenture.
“Pledged
Shares” has the meaning set forth in the recitals hereto.
“Proceeds”
has the meaning specified in Section 8.
“Qualified
Equity Offering” means a public or private offering or issuance by Twin Hospitality of its common equity securities (including
securities convertible into or exchangeable for its common equity securities) for cash, excluding (i) any offer, grant or issuance of
securities pursuant to a stock option or equity incentive plan approved by the Board of Directors of Twin Hospitality for the benefit
of its officers, directors or employees, (ii) any issuance of securities as consideration for the consummation of any merger or acquisition,
partnership, joint venture or strategic alliance for primarily non-capital raising purposes, and (iii) the issuance of equity securities
upon exercise or conversion of any options, warrants or convertible securities from time to time outstanding.
“Qualified
Equity Offering Proceeds” means amounts received from the net proceeds received by Twin Hospitality pursuant to a Qualified
Equity Offering.
“Securities
Account” has the meaning assigned to such term in the Securities Account Control Agreement.
“Securities
Account Control Agreement” means the Securities Account Control Agreement, dated on or about the date hereof, among the Pledgor,
Indenture Trustee and the Securities Intermediary.
“Securities
Act” has the meaning specified in Section 5(d).
“Securities
Collateral” has the meaning specified in Section 2.
“Third
Party” shall mean any person or entity other than Twin Hospitality, Pledgor or any of their respective Affiliates. None
of the Initial Purchasers (as defined in the Indenture) or any of their respective Affiliates shall be Third Parties for purposes of
this Agreement.
For
purposes of this Agreement, unless otherwise specified herein: (1) accounting terms used and not specifically defined therein shall be
construed in accordance with GAAP; (2) terms used in Article 8 or Article 9 of the New York UCC, and not specifically defined herein,
are used therein as defined in such Article 8 or Article 9, as applicable; (3) the term “including” means “including
without limitation,” and other forms of the verb “to include” have correlative meanings; (4) references to any Person
include such Person’s permitted successors; (5) in the computation of a period of time from a specified date to a later specified
date, the word “from” means “from and including” and the words “to” and “until” each
means “to but excluding”; (6) the words “hereof”, “herein” and “hereunder” and words
of similar import refer to this Agreement as a whole and not to any particular provision of this Agreement; (7) the term “or”
means “and/or”; (8) the meanings of defined terms are equally applicable to the singular and plural forms of such defined
terms; (9) references to “Section”, “Schedule” and “Exhibit” herein are references
to Sections, Schedules and Exhibits in or to this Agreement; (10) the various captions (including any table of contents) are provided
solely for convenience of reference and shall not affect the meaning or interpretation of this Agreement; (11) references to any statute
or regulation refer to that statute or regulation as amended from time to time, and include any successor statute or regulation of similar
import; and (12) any reference in this Agreement to this Agreement or any Transaction Document means such document as amended, restated,
supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.
Section
2. Pledge and Grant of Security Interest. Subject in all respect to Section 8 of this Agreement, as security
for the payment and performance in full of all of the Obligations in accordance with their terms, Pledgor hereby pledges, assigns, transfers,
grants, hypothecates and sets over unto Indenture Trustee a first priority lien and security interest in, and delivers to Indenture Trustee,
all of Pledgor’s right, title and interest in, to and under the following personal property, in each case whether now existing
or hereafter acquired or created, and whether constituting financial assets, investment property, general intangibles, securities, security
entitlements, proceeds or otherwise: (a) all of the Pledged Shares; (b) all certificates, instruments, agreements and contract rights
relating to the Pledged Shares; and (c) all proceeds of the Pledged Shares (including all cash, cash equivalents, dividends, distributions,
instruments, securities of any successor entity to Twin Hospitality or other securities or property) at any time and from time to time
received, receivable, paid or otherwise distributed in respect of or in exchange for any of or all such Pledged Shares, whether in connection
with any increase or reduction of capital, reclassification, merger, consolidation, sale of assets, combination of membership interests
or other equity interests, or otherwise (the items referred to in clauses (a) through (c) being collectively called the “Securities
Collateral”). All Pledged Shares included in the Securities Collateral shall be deposited into the Securities Account in accordance
with the Securities Account Control Agreement. If and whenever an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing and, to the
extent the Grace Period is applicable, following such Grace Period, the Indenture Trustee, acting at the direction of the Controlling
Class Representative, shall be entitled to exercise all remedies provided under Section 9.3 of the Indenture, this Agreement or applicable
law, including, without limitation, selling or disposing of the Pledged Collateral, exercising any and all voting rights with respect
to the Pledged Collateral, foreclosing on the Pledged Shares and exercising its rights under the Securities Account Control Agreement.
Section
3. Termination of Security Interest and Release of Securities Collateral for Payment. This Agreement
shall terminate, and all security interests in the Securities Collateral shall automatically terminate and be completely released, when
all the Obligations have been fully paid and satisfied and the Indenture has been cancelled or terminated, at which time Securities Intermediary
shall reassign and deliver to Pledgor, or to such Person as Pledgor shall designate, against receipt, such of the Securities Collateral
(if any) as shall not have been sold or otherwise applied by Securities Intermediary pursuant to the terms hereof and shall still be
held by Securities Intermediary under this Agreement. Any such reassignment shall be without recourse to or representation or warranty
by Securities Intermediary and at the expense of Pledgor.
Section
4. Delivery and Redelivery of Securities Collateral. Pledgor agrees promptly to deliver, or cause to be delivered,
to Securities Intermediary any and all Securities Collateral pursuant to the terms of the Security Account Control Agreement.
Section
5. Representations and Warranties. Pledgor hereby represents, warrants and covenants to and with Securities
Intermediary, Indenture Trustee and Controlling Class Representative that:
(a)
Pledgor (i) is, and will at all times during the term hereof continue to be, the direct owner, beneficially and of record, of the Securities
Collateral, free and clear of all liens (except for the lien and security interest of Securities Intermediary pursuant to this Agreement
and except as set forth in the Indenture), (ii) will make no assignment, pledge, hypothecation, transfer or any disposition of, or create
any lien or other security interest in, the Securities Collateral, and (iii) will cause any and all Securities Collateral, whether for
value paid by Pledgor or otherwise, to be forthwith deposited with Securities Intermediary and pledged and assigned hereunder; provided,
however, that, so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing following the Grace Period, if applicable, and subject
to Section 8 hereunder, Pledgor shall be entitled to retain all cash dividends and distributions paid or payable with respect to the
Pledged Shares, free and clear of the lien and interest of this Agreement; provided further, that Pledgor may sell the Pledged Shares
in accordance with Section 5(a) and Section 5(b) of the Securities Account Control Agreement (subject in all respects to the terms and
conditions of this Agreement and the Securities Account Control Agreement) but shall not otherwise sell, dividend, distribute or dispose
of the Pledged Shares without the prior written consent of the Indenture Trustee (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative);
(b)
Pledgor (i) has good and indefeasible title, right and legal authority to enter into this Agreement and to pledge the Securities Collateral
in the manner hereby done or contemplated, and (ii) will defend its title or interest thereto or therein against any and all attachments,
liens, claims, security interests or other impediments of any nature;
(c)
no consent or approval of any governmental authority, any securities exchange, or other Person was or is necessary to the validity of
the pledge effected pursuant to this Agreement;
(d)
the Pledged Shares were duly authorized and validly issued, and were acquired in a transaction in compliance with and either registered
or exempt from registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”);
(e)
the pledge effected hereby is effective to vest in Indenture Trustee the rights of Pledgor in the Securities Collateral as set forth
herein without any notice to, consent of or filing with any Person or Governmental Authority;
(f)
this Agreement creates a valid security interest in favor of Securities Intermediary in the Securities Collateral; the taking of possession
by Securities Intermediary of the certificates, if any, representing the Pledged Shares, and all other certificates, documents and instruments
relating to the Securities Collateral and the entry into the Securities Account Control Agreement will perfect and establish the first
priority of Indenture Trustee’s security interest in all certificated Pledged Shares and such documents, certificates and instruments;
(g)
the Parties shall enter into the Securities Account Control Agreement in order to enable Indenture Trustee to perfect and preserve its
security interest in the Securities Collateral; upon entry into the Securities Account Control Agreement, the Indenture Trustee shall
have a perfected, first priority Lien in the Securities Collateral;
(h)
Schedule 1 sets forth all common stock of Twin Hospitality owned by the Pledgor on the date hereof; and
(i)
neither Pledgor, nor Twin Hospitality, nor any of their respective Affiliates or Subsidiaries (i) is, directly or indirectly, engaged
in discussions with any potential purchaser in respect of a sale of all or substantially all of the assets or capital stock of Twin Hospitality,
(ii) has provided any information to any potential purchaser of Twin Hospitality, or (iii) has sent or received any letter of intent,
indicative terms, commitment, exclusivity agreement or any other document in response to any person or entity in connection with the
potential purchase of all or substantially all the assets or capital stock of Twin Hospitality.
All
representations, warranties and covenants of Pledgor contained in this Agreement shall survive the execution, delivery and performance
of this Agreement until the termination of this Agreement in accordance with its terms and provisions.
Section
6. Additional Covenants.
(a)
Additional Securities, Rights, Grants or Issuances. Except as provided to the contrary in the Indenture or this Agreement including
Section 7, if Pledgor shall receive any: (i) equity interests representing a dividend or distribution in connection with any increase
or reduction of capital, reclassification, merger, consolidation, sale of assets, combination of membership interests or other equity
interests on account of the Securities Collateral; (ii) option or right, whether as an addition to, substitution for, or an exchange
for, any Securities Collateral or otherwise; (iii) dividends or distributions payable in membership interests or other equity interests
of Twin Hospitality Group Inc.; or (iv) distributions of membership interests or other equity interests in connection with a partial
or total liquidation, dissolution or reduction of capital, capital surplus or paid-in surplus of Twin Hospitality Group Inc., then Pledgor
shall receive such certificate, instrument, option, right or distribution in trust for the benefit of Indenture Trustee, shall segregate
it from Pledgor’s other property and shall deliver it forthwith to Securities Intermediary in the exact form received accompanied
by duly executed instruments of transfer or assignment in blank, in the form requested by Securities Intermediary or Indenture Trustee,
to be held by Securities Intermediary as Securities Collateral and as further collateral security for the Obligations. Pledgor shall
not perform or cause to be performed any acts or omissions that would effect any change, amendment, impairment, substitution, or any
of the events, transactions or circumstances in clauses (i) through (iv) above.
(b)
Sales on Market Terms. Each sale of the Securities Collateral by the Pledgor shall be for a bona fide business purpose (as determined
by Pledgor acting reasonably and in good faith) and, for the avoidance of doubt, not for the primary purpose of releasing such Securities
Collateral from the Lien created under this Agreement.
(c)
Books and Records. Pledgor agrees to mark its books and records (and to cause Twin Hospitality Group Inc. to mark its books and
records) to reflect the security interest of Securities Intermediary in the Securities Collateral.
(d)
Liens and Margin Loans. The Pledgor shall not create, incur, assume or permit to exist any Lien upon the Securities Collateral
(including any such Lien that is subordinate to the rights of the Securities Intermediary hereunder), other than (i) Liens in favor of
the Indenture Trustee and (ii) other Liens consented to by the Controlling Class Representative.
(e)
Grace Period. Without the prior written consent of the Controlling Class Representative, during the Grace Period, the Pledgor
shall not sell or otherwise dispose of any Securities Collateral or permit any dividends, distributions or issuance of any rights, warrants
or other consideration with respect to the Pledged Shares.
Section
7. Voting Rights.
(a)
Unless and until an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing and following the Grace Period, if applicable, only Pledgor
shall be entitled to give instructions to Securities Intermediary with respect to the voting or giving of written consents with respect
to any of the Pledged Shares. So long as no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing and following the Grace Period, if
applicable, the Securities Intermediary shall not have any right or obligation to vote or give any written consent with respect to any
of the Pledged Shares in the absence of an express written instruction from Pledgor.
(b)
Upon the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default and following the Grace Period, if applicable, all rights of Pledgor
to exercise the voting and consensual rights and powers it is entitled to exercise pursuant to Section 7(a) shall cease, and all such
rights shall thereupon become vested in the Indenture Trustee, which shall have the sole and exclusive right and authority to exercise
such voting and consensual rights and powers. After all Events of Default have been cured or waived, Pledgor shall have the exclusive
right to exercise the voting and/or consensual rights and powers that such Pledgor would otherwise be entitled to exercise pursuant to
the terms of Section 7(a).
(c)
So long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing (and during any applicable Grace Period) and subject to Section 8, Pledgor
shall be entitled to retain all cash dividends and distributions paid or payable with respect to the Pledged Shares, free and clear of
the lien and interest of this Agreement.
Section
8. Application of Proceeds.
(a)
Subject to Section 8(b), the proceeds of any sale or other disposal of the Securities Collateral, any dividend, distribution, rights,
warrants or other consideration with respect to any Securities Collateral and any proceeds of any loan or extension of credit secured
by the Securities Collateral (the “Proceeds”) shall be applied by Securities Intermediary in the following manner:
(A) the Applicable Percentage of such Proceeds shall be applied by the Indenture Trustee pursuant to the Quarterly Noteholders’
Report delivered under Section 4.1(c) of the Base Indenture to purchase the Class A-2A Notes at a purchase price of par plus any and
all interest paid in kind and accrued and unpaid interest as of the date of such purchase, until the aggregate principal amount of such
Class A-2A Notes is reduced to zero and then to purchase the Class A-1A Notes at a purchase price of par plus any and all interest paid
in kind and accrued and unpaid interest as of the date of such purchase until the aggregate principal amount of such Class A-1A Notes
is reduced to zero and (B) any remaining Proceeds shall be paid to an account designated by the Pledgor. Upon the occurrence of the foregoing,
the Pledgor agrees to cause the Issuer to provide to the Indenture Trustee the notice required pursuant to Section 3.5(f) of the Series
2023-1 Supplement to the Base Indenture, dated as of July 10, 2023 (the “Series 2023-1 Supplement”), between the Issuer and
the Indenture Trustee.
(b)
If at any time Twin Hospitality has not raised at least $25,000,000 in Qualified Equity Proceeds, and Twin Hospitality is sold, then
so long as either (1) Twin Hospitality I, LLC has repaid its debt in full or (2) Twin Hospitality I, LLC’s noteholders have otherwise
waived payment and approved such sale in writing, 50% of the Proceeds shall be applied by the Indenture Trustee (A) pursuant to the Quarterly
Noteholders’ Report delivered under Section 4.1(c) of the Base Indenture to purchase the Class A-2A Notes at a purchase price of
par plus any and all interest paid in kind and accrued and unpaid interest as of the date of such purchase, until the aggregate principal
amount of such Class A-2A Notes is reduced to zero and then to purchase the Class A-1A Notes at a purchase price of par plus any and
all interest paid in kind and accrued and unpaid interest as of the date of such purchase until the aggregate principal amount of such
Class A-1A Notes is reduced to zero and (B) any remaining Proceeds shall be paid to an account designated by the Pledgor. Upon the occurrence
of the foregoing, the Pledgor agrees to cause the Issuer to provide to the Indenture Trustee the notice required pursuant to Section
3.5(f) of the Series 2023-1 Supplement.
(c)
If Pledgor, any of Pledgor’s Affiliates or Indenture Trustee receives any Proceeds in violation of this Section 8, such Person
shall promptly transfer such Proceeds to the Indenture Trustee for application in accordance with this Section 8.
(d)
All security interests in any Securities Collateral sold in accordance with this Agreement shall automatically terminate and be completely
released upon the consummation of the sale of such Securities Collateral and application of the Proceeds of such sale in accordance with
the foregoing clauses (a) or (b) in accordance with the terms of the Indenture and, if applicable, this Agreement.
Section
9. Duty of Care.
(a)
Securities Intermediary’s Duty of Care. Other than the exercise of reasonable care to ensure the safe custody of the Securities
Collateral while being held by Securities Intermediary hereunder, Securities Intermediary shall have no duty or liability to preserve
rights pertaining thereto, it being understood and agreed that Pledgor shall be responsible for preservation of all rights in the Securities
Collateral, and Securities Intermediary shall be relieved of all responsibility for the Securities Collateral upon surrendering it or
tendering the surrender of it to Pledgor. Securities Intermediary shall be deemed to have exercised reasonable care in the custody and
preservation of the Securities Collateral in its possession if such Securities Collateral is accorded treatment substantially equal to
that which Securities Intermediary accords its own property, it being understood that Securities Intermediary shall not have responsibility
for (i) ascertaining or taking action with respect to calls, conversions, exchanges, maturities, tenders or other matters relating to
any of the Securities Collateral, whether or not Securities Intermediary has or is deemed to have knowledge of such matters, or (ii)
taking any steps or refraining therefrom to preserve rights against any other parties with respect to any of the Securities Collateral.
Section
10. Successors; Assignment. The terms of this Agreement shall be binding upon the Parties, and
shall inure to the benefit of, the Parties and their respective corporate successors or heirs and personal representatives who obtain
such rights solely by operation of law. Each Party may assign its rights hereunder only with the express written consent of each other
Party.
Section
11. Notices. Any notice, request or other communication required or permitted to be given under
this Agreement shall be in writing and deemed to have been properly given when delivered in person, or when sent by email or other electronic
means and electronic confirmation of error free receipt is received, or two days after being sent by certified or registered United States
mail, return receipt requested, postage prepaid, addressed to the Party at the address set forth below (provided, however, that notwithstanding
the foregoing, in no event shall any notice, request or other communication to the Securities Intermediary be deemed to be received by
it unless and until actually received by it). Any Party may change its address or email address for notices by provided notice of such
change to all other Parties in the manner set forth in this Section 11.
|
Pledgor: |
FAT
Brands Inc. |
|
|
9720
Wilshire Blvd., Suite 500 |
|
|
Beverly
Hills, CA 90212 |
|
|
Attention:
Chief Executive Officer |
|
|
Email:
|
|
|
|
|
Indenture
Trustee: |
UMB
Bank, N.A. |
|
|
100
William Street, Suite 1850
New
York, NY 10038 |
|
|
Attention:
Michele Voon |
|
|
|
|
Securities
Intermediary: |
UMB
Bank, N.A. |
|
|
100
William Street, Suite 1850
New
York, NY 10038 |
|
|
Attention:
Michele Voon |
|
|
Email:
|
|
|
|
Section
12. Termination; Resignation of the Securities Intermediary. The obligations of the Securities
Intermediary to the Indenture Trustee and the Pledgor pursuant to this Agreement shall continue in effect until the security interests
of the Indenture Trustee in the Securities Account have been terminated pursuant to the terms of this Agreement and the Pledgor (with
the consent of Indenture Trustee at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) has notified the Securities Intermediary of
such termination in writing. The Pledgor (with the consent of Indenture Trustee at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative)
agrees to provide such notice of termination to the Securities Intermediary upon the request of the Pledgor on or after the termination
of the Indenture Trustee’s security interest in the Securities Account pursuant to the terms of this Agreement. The Securities
Intermediary and any successor thereto may at any time resign by giving sixty (60) days’ written notice by registered, certified
or express mail to the Indenture Trustee and the Pledgor; provided that such resignation shall take effect only upon the effective date
of the appointment of a successor Securities Intermediary acceptable to the Indenture Trustee and the Pledgor, as evidenced by their
written consent and the acceptance in writing by such successor Securities Intermediary of such appointment and of its obligation to
perform its duties hereunder in accordance with the provisions hereof. Subject to the preceding sentence, if on the sixtieth (60th)
day after written notice of resignation is delivered by a resigning party as described above, no successor party or temporary successor
Securities Intermediary has been appointed in accordance herewith, the resigning party may petition a court of competent jurisdiction
in the State of New York for the appointment of a successor in accordance with Section 17.
Section
13. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Securities Intermediary. The Securities
Intermediary hereby makes the following representations, warranties and covenants:
(a)
This Agreement is the legal, valid and binding obligation of the Securities Intermediary, subject to (i) the effect of bankruptcy, insolvency
or similar laws and (ii) general equitable principles (whether enforceability of such principles is considered in a proceeding at law
or in equity).
(b)
The Securities Intermediary is duly organized and validly existing under the laws of the jurisdiction of its organization and, if relevant
under such laws, in good standing.
(c)
The Securities Intermediary has the power to execute this Agreement and any other documentation relating to this Agreement to which it
is a party, to deliver this Agreement and any other documentation relating to this Agreement that it is required by this Agreement to
deliver and to perform its obligations under this Agreement and has taken all necessary action to authorize such execution, delivery
and performance; and this Agreement has been, and each other document will be, duly executed and delivered by it.
(d)
The execution and delivery of this Agreement and the performance by the Securities Intermediary of the terms of this Agreement do not
conflict with or result in a violation of (i) any United States federal or State of New York regulation or law governing the banking
trust powers of the Securities Intermediary or (ii) the organizational documents of the Securities Intermediary.
(e)
No consent, approval, authorization or other action by or filing with any United States federal or New York State agency or other governmental
body under any United States federal or New York State regulation or law, having jurisdiction over the banking or trust powers of the
Securities Intermediary, is required in connection with the execution and delivery by the Securities Intermediary of this Agreement to
which it is a party, or performance of the Securities Intermediary’s obligations under this Agreement.
(f)
The Securities Intermediary is and shall at all times be a “qualified custodian” as defined under Section 17 of the Investment
Company Act of 1940, as amended.
(g)
The Securities Intermediary will comply at all times with the duties of a “Securities Intermediary” under Article 8 of the
UCC.
Section
14. Rights and Immunities; Indemnification, Fees and Expenses.
(a)
The Pledgor hereby agrees that the Indenture Trustee and the Securities Intermediary is released from any and all liabilities to the
Pledgor arising from the terms of this Agreement and the compliance of the Securities Intermediary with the terms hereof, except to the
extent that such liabilities arise from the Indenture Trustee’s or Securities Intermediary’s willful misconduct or gross
negligence, in each case, as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final non-appealable order. Without limitation to the
Indenture Trustee’s or Securities Intermediary’s rights, protections, immunities and indemnities under this Agreement, each
of the Indenture Trustee and the Securities Intermediary shall be entitled to the rights, protections, immunities and indemnities afforded
to the Indenture Trustee and the Securities Intermediary under the Indenture.
(b)
The Pledgor acknowledges and agrees that the Securities Intermediary and the Indenture Trustee shall be entitled to all applicable fees,
indemnities and reimbursements of costs and expenses set forth in this Agreement in connection with the execution, delivery and performance
of this Agreement and the exercise of their respective rights and remedies hereunder. UMB Bank, N.A., is entitled to be paid and reimbursed
pursuant to Section 8(a) of the Securities Account Control Agreement.
(c)
This Section 14 shall survive the termination of this Agreement for any reason whatsoever.
Section
15. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts (including by
e-mail), all of which shall constitute one and the same instrument, and any party hereto may execute this Agreement by signing and delivering
one or more counterparts.
Section
16. Certain Rights of Securities Intermediary.
(a)
This Agreement shall not subject the Securities Intermediary to any duty, obligation or liability except as is expressly set forth herein
and the Securities Intermediary shall satisfy those duties expressly set forth in this Agreement so long as it acts without, gross negligence
or willful misconduct. In particular (without implied limitation), the Securities Intermediary need not investigate whether any Party
is entitled under this Agreement, or otherwise, to give any Entitlement Order or any other directions, instructions or other orders in
any instance. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the Securities Intermediary shall not be subject to any fiduciary or
other implied duties and the Securities Intermediary shall not have any duty to take any discretionary action or exercise any discretionary
powers.
(b)
The Securities Intermediary may rely upon the contents of any notice, consent, instruction or other communication or document that the
Securities Intermediary believes in good faith to be genuine and from the proper person or entity, without any further duty of inquiry
or independent investigation on its part. The Securities Intermediary shall have no duty to inquire into the authority of the person
giving any such notice or instruction.
(c)
Except with respect to the existence of the security interest granted by the Pledgor in the Securities Account in favor of the Indenture
Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, the Securities Intermediary shall not be deemed to have any knowledge (imputed or otherwise)
of any of the terms or conditions of this Agreement or any other document referred to herein or relating to any financing arrangement
between the Pledgor and the Indenture Trustee, or of any breach thereof. The Securities Intermediary has no obligation to inform any
person of any breach or to take any action in connection with any of the foregoing, except such actions regarding the Securities Account
as are specified in this Agreement. The Securities Intermediary is not responsible for the enforceability or validity of any security
interest, whether with respect to the Securities Account or otherwise, or whether pursuant to the Securities Account Control Agreement,
this Agreement or otherwise, and is not responsible for the sufficiency of this Agreement for any purpose (including without limitation
its sufficiency to create or perfect any security interest; provided however that the foregoing shall not be construed to release the
Securities Intermediary from performing its enumerated duties set forth in this Agreement).
Section
17. Governing Law and Jurisdiction.
(a)
This Agreement and the Securities Account shall be governed by the law of the State of New York. Regardless of any provision in any other
agreement, for purposes of the UCC, New York shall be deemed to be the Securities Intermediary’s jurisdiction (within the meaning
of Section 8-110 of the UCC) and the Securities Account (as well as the security entitlements related thereto) shall be governed by the
law of the State of New York. To the extent that the Securities Account (into which cash is credited as set forth herein) is re-characterized
as a “deposit account” (within the meaning of Section 9-102(a)(29) of the UCC), New York shall be deemed to be the “bank’s
jurisdiction” (within the meaning of Section 9-304(b) of the UCC). The Parties covenant that no amendment with respect to the Securities
Account shall be entered into that would have the effect of changing the parties’ choice of law set forth in the previous sentence
without the prior written consent of each Party. In case any provision in this Agreement shall be invalid, illegal, or unenforceable
as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final non-appealable order, the validity, legality, and enforceability of the
remaining provisions shall not in any way be affected or impaired thereby.
(b)
With respect to any suit, action or proceedings relating to this Agreement or any matter between the parties arising under or in connection
with this Agreement (“Proceedings”), each Party irrevocably: (i) submits to the non-exclusive jurisdiction of the
Supreme Court of the State of New York sitting in the Borough of Manhattan and the United States District Court for the Southern District
of New York, and any appellate court from any thereof; and (ii) waives any objection that it may have at any time to the laying of venue
of any Proceedings brought in any such court, waives any claim that such Proceedings have been brought in an inconvenient forum and further
waives the right to object, with respect to such Proceedings, that such court does not have any jurisdiction over such Party. Nothing
in this Agreement precludes any Party from bringing Proceedings in any other jurisdiction, nor will the bringing of Proceedings in any
one or more jurisdictions preclude the bringing of Proceedings in any other jurisdiction. Regardless of any provision, in any other agreement,
for purposes of the UCC, with respect to the Securities Account, the State of New York shall be deemed to be the security intermediary’s
jurisdiction (within the meaning of Section 8-110 of the UCC).
(c)
Each Party agrees that service of process may be effected by mailing a copy thereof by registered or certified mail, postage prepaid,
to the applicable Party at its address specified in Section 11 of this Agreement, and the Parties irrevocably consent to service of process
given in the manner provided for notices in Section 11. Nothing in this Agreement will affect the right of any Party to serve process
in any other manner permitted by law.
(d)
EACH PARTY HEREBY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ANY RIGHT THAT IT MAY HAVE TO A TRIAL BY JURY IN RESPECT
OF ANY PROCEEDING.
(e)
Anything in this Agreement notwithstanding, in no event shall the Securities Intermediary be liable for special, indirect or consequential
loss or damage of any kind whatsoever (including but not limited to lost profits), even if the Securities Intermediary has been advised
of such loss or damage and regardless of the form of action.
Section
18. Cooperation
(a)
If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, Pledgor shall, and, if applicable, shall cause each of its Subsidiaries
to, take any action which Indenture Trustee may reasonably request in the exercise of its rights and remedies under this Agreement in
order to transfer or assign the Securities Collateral to Indenture Trustee or allow the Indenture Trustee to exercise voting rights with
respect to the Pledged Shares without breach of any applicable laws.
(b)
Without limiting the obligations of Pledgor hereunder in any respect, Pledgor further agrees that if an Event of Default shall have occurred
and be continuing and it or any of its Subsidiaries should fail or refuse for any reason whatsoever including any refusal to execute
and file any completed application necessary or appropriate to obtain any governmental authorization necessary or appropriate for the
exercise of any right of Indenture Trustee hereunder, Pledgor agrees that such application may be executed and filed on Pledgor’s
behalf by the clerk of any court of competent jurisdiction without notice to the Pledgor pursuant to court order.
Section
19. Patriot Act. In order to comply with the laws, rules, regulations and executive orders in
effect from time to time applicable to banking institutions, including, without limitation, those relating to the funding of terrorist
activities and money laundering, including Section 326 of the USA PATRIOT ACT of the United States (“Applicable Law”), the
Securities Intermediary is required to obtain, verify, record and update certain information relating to individuals and entities which
maintain a business relationship with the Securities Intermediary. Accordingly, each of the parties agrees to provide to the Securities
Intermediary upon reasonable request from time to time such identifying information and documentation as may be reasonably available
for such party in order to enable the Securities Intermediary to comply with Applicable Law.
Section
20. Indenture Trustee Appointed Attorney in Fact. Pledgor hereby appoints the Indenture Trustee
the true and lawful attorney-in-fact of Pledgor for the purpose of carrying out the provisions of this Agreement and taking any action
and executing any instrument that the Indenture Trustee may deem necessary or advisable to accomplish the purposes hereof which appointment
is irrevocable and coupled with an interest; such appointment shall not terminate until the payment in full in cash of all Obligations
and the termination of the Indenture. Without limiting the foregoing, the Pledgor hereby authorizes the Indenture Trustee (i) to prepare
and file financing statements provided for by the UCC without notice to the Pledgor and with all appropriate jurisdictions, and to take
such other action as may be required, in Indenture Trustee’s sole judgment (in each case acting at the direction of the Controlling
Class Representative), in order to perfect and to continue the perfection of Indenture Trustee’s Lien on the Securities Collateral
and (ii) if an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing and following any applicable Grace Period, to exercise all voting and
other consensual rights with respect to the Pledged Collateral.
[Signature
page follows]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties hereto have caused this Pledge and Security Agreement to be duly executed as of the date first above written.
FAT
BRANDS INC., as Pledgor |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Robert G. Rosen |
|
Name: |
Robert
G. Rosen |
|
Title: |
Co-Chief
Executive Officer |
|
|
|
|
UMB
BANK, N.A., as Indenture Trustee |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Michele Voon |
|
Name: |
Michele
Voon |
|
Title: |
Senior
Vice President |
|
|
|
|
UMB
BANK, N.A., as Securities Intermediary |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Michele Voon |
|
Name: |
Michele
Voon |
|
Title: |
Senior
Vice President |
|
[Signature
page to Pledge and Security Agreement]
SCHEDULE
1
PLEDGED
SHARES
“Pledged
Shares” means the shares of Class A Common Stock, par value $0.0001 per share, of Twin Hospitality Group Inc. (or any successor
to such entity) that are owned by Pledgor and not distributed to its shareholders at the time of the Twin Peaks Listing Event.
Exhibit
10.4
SECURITIES
ACCOUNT CONTROL AGREEMENT
This
Securities Account Control Agreement (as amended, restated, waived, supplemented and/or otherwise modified from time to time, the “Agreement”),
dated as of November 21, 2024, by and among FAT Brands Inc., a Delaware corporation (the “Pledgor”), UMB Bank, N.A.,
not in its individual capacity but solely, in its capacity as the Trustee under the Indenture (as defined below) (the “Indenture
Trustee”) and UMB Bank, N.A. not in its individual capacity but solely as securities intermediary (together with its successors
and assigns, the “Securities Intermediary”). Each of the Pledgor, the Indenture Trustee and the Securities Intermediary
are referred to herein collectively as the “Parties” and individually as a “Party.”
WHEREAS,
the Pledgor is the direct or indirect owner of FB Resid Holdings I, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “Issuer”);
WHEREAS,
the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee have entered into the Indenture;
WHEREAS,
the Parties have entered into that certain Pledge and Security Agreement, dated on or about the date hereof (the “Pledge Agreement”),
by and among the Pledgor, the Indenture Trustee and the Securities Intermediary. to further collateralize the Obligations (as defined
in the Indenture) which each of the Pledgor and the Issuer deem to be beneficial to their respective interests;
WHEREAS,
the Pledgor is establishing with the Securities Intermediary an account in respect of the Secured Obligations referenced in the Pledge
Agreement as securities account number 164496.1 (the “Securities Account”) in the name of Pledgor;
WHEREAS,
the Pledgor intends to deposit in the Securities Account the Pledged Shares; and
WHEREAS,
the Pledgor has granted a security interest in the Securities Account and all property from time to time credited thereto for the benefit
of the Indenture Trustee pursuant to the Pledge Agreement.
NOW,
THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Parties agree as follows:
Section
1. Definitions. Capitalized terms used but not defined in this Agreement shall have the meanings provided in the Indenture
or Pledge Agreement, as applicable. In addition, the following defined terms shall have the meanings provided below.
(a)
“Entitlement Orders” shall mean “entitlement orders” as such term is defined in Section 8-102(a)(8) of
the UCC.
(b)
“Indenture” shall mean the Indenture, dated as of July 10, 2023, by and between the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee
and the Securities Intermediary (as amended, restated, waived, supplemented and/or otherwise modified from time to time).
(c)
“Market Order” shall mean any Entitlement Order to purchase or sell any Pledged Shares intended to be executed in
a “brokers’ transaction” (within the meaning of Section 4(4) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended) on a Trading
Market, whether such transaction is executed by the Securities Intermediary or another clearing broker-dealer firm.
(d)
“Pledged Shares” means the shares of Class A Common Stock, par value $0.0001 per share, of Twin Hospitality Group
Inc. (or any successor to such entity) that are owned by Pledgor and not distributed to its shareholders at the time of the Twin Peaks
Listing Event.
(e)
“Trading Market” means, as of any date of determination, any Acceptable Exchange on which the Pledged Shares are listed
or quoted for trading on the date in question.
(f)
All other terms used herein which are defined in Article 8 or Article 9 of the UCC and which are not otherwise defined herein are used
herein as so defined.
Section
2. Appointment of Securities Intermediary. Each of Pledgor and the Indenture Trustee hereby appoints the Securities Intermediary
under this Agreement and the Securities Intermediary agrees to perform the duties of Securities Intermediary as hereinafter specified.
The Securities Intermediary is not a party to or bound by any agreement which may be evidenced by or arise out of the instructions in
this Agreement contained, except as to its duties as Securities Intermediary hereby expressly undertaken. The Securities Intermediary
is not responsible or liable in any manner for the sufficiency, correctness, genuineness or validity of any securities or instrument
deposited into the Securities Account with it hereunder, or with respect to the form or execution of the same, or the identity, authority,
or right of any person executing or depositing the same, or with respect to the legality of the sale of the Pledged Shares, or any such
securities or instrument by or for the Pledgor, or the proprietary of the amount for which the same may be sold.
Section
3. Establishment of Securities Account.
(a)
The Pledgor hereby directs the Securities Intermediary to establish, and the Securities Intermediary hereby does establish, the Securities
Account. The Securities Intermediary will maintain the Securities Account in the name of “FAT Brands Inc., subject to the lien
of the Indenture Trustee, for the benefit of the Secured Parties.”
(b)
The Securities Intermediary hereby confirms and agrees with the Pledgor and Indenture Trustee that:
(i)
the Securities Account and any rights or proceeds derived therefrom are subject to a security interest in favor of the Indenture Trustee
on behalf of the Secured Parties arising under the Pledge Agreement and the Securities Intermediary shall hold financial assets and cash
proceeds on deposit in the Securities Account for the sole benefit of the Indenture Trustee on behalf of the Secured Parties;
(ii)
subject to this Agreement, the Pledge Agreement and the Indenture, all securities or other property underlying any financial assets credited
to the Securities Account (other than cash) shall be registered in the name of Pledgor, indorsed to the Securities Intermediary or in
blank;
(iii)
the Securities Intermediary shall, without further action by any Party, credit to the Securities Account all interest, dividends and
other income received by the Securities Intermediary on the Pledged Shares;
(iv)
the Securities Account is a “securities account” as defined in Section 8-501(a) of the UCC in respect of which the Securities
Intermediary is a “securities intermediary” within the meaning of Section 8-102(a)(14) of the UCC;
(v)
each item of property (including any security, investment property or other financial asset or cash) credited to the Securities Account
shall be treated as a “financial asset” within the meaning of Section 8-102(a)(9) of the UCC;
(vi)
the Securities Intermediary shall not change the name or account number of the Securities Account or any component account or sub-account
thereof without the prior written consent of the Indenture Trustee (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative); and
(vii)
the Securities Intermediary shall promptly deliver copies of all statements, confirmations and other correspondence concerning the Securities
Account and/or any financial assets credited thereto simultaneously to each of the Pledgor and the Indenture Trustee in the manner set
forth for notices in Section 12 of this Agreement.
(c)
Nothing contained in this Agreement or in the Pledge Agreement shall or shall be deemed or construed to afford to Pledgor any right of
consent or any other right with respect to the Securities Account or any asset credited thereto if such right is inconsistent with or
contrary to, the Indenture Trustee having “control” over the Securities Account (within the meaning of Section 8-106 of the
UCC).
Section
4. Operation of the Securities Account.
(a)
Upon execution of this Agreement, the Securities Intermediary shall establish the Securities Account, and the Pledgor shall deliver or
cause to be delivered to the Securities Intermediary via DTC the Pledged Shares into the Securities Account.
(b)
Subject to Section 5, upon written direction from the Pledgor, the Securities Intermediary will comply with Entitlement Orders originated
by the Pledgor. For the avoidance of doubt, the Pledgor shall deliver Entitlement Orders with respect to the Pledged Shares solely in
accordance with this Agreement, the Pledge Agreement and Indenture.
(c)
With respect to any written disbursement direction, the Pledgor (i) certifies they have reviewed any wire instructions set forth herein
or therein to confirm such wire instructions are accurate, (ii) agrees to indemnify and hold harmless the Securities Intermediary from
and against any and all claim, demand, loss, liability, or expense sustained, including but not limited to attorney fees and expenses
resulting directly or indirectly as a result of making the disbursement requested, and (iii) agrees it will not seek recourse from the
Securities Intermediary as a result of losses incurred by it for making the disbursement in accordance with such disbursement direction.
Section
5. Entitlement Orders.
(a)
Market Orders. Subject to Section 5(c) and Section 5(d), the Securities Intermediary shall comply with all Market Orders originated
by the Pledgor without further consent or acknowledgment by any other Party. In no event shall the Securities Intermediary be liable
for determining that a Market Order that is substantially in the form of Exhibit C hereto.
(b)
Non-Market Orders. Subject to Section 5(c) and Section 5(d), the Securities Intermediary shall comply with any Entitlement Order
originated by the Pledgor that is not a Market Order, but only with the prior written consent of Indenture Trustee (at the direction
of the Controlling Class Representative); provided, no such consent shall be required for a non-Market Order that is (x) to be executed
at a price within five percent (5%) of the 5-trading day volume weighted average price and (y) is made with respect to Securities Collateral
with a value at least equal to $15,000,000 (based on the price referred to in clause (x)).
(c)
If at any time the Securities Intermediary shall receive any Entitlement Order from the Indenture Trustee (acting at the direction of
the Controlling Class Representative) directing transfer or redemption of any financial asset relating to the Securities Account, the
Securities Intermediary shall comply with such Entitlement Order without further consent by the Pledgor or any other person. If the Pledgor
is otherwise entitled to issue Entitlement Orders and such orders conflict with any Entitlement Order issued by the Indenture Trustee,
the Securities Intermediary shall follow the orders issued by the Indenture Trustee.
(d)
If, at any time, the Indenture Trustee (acting at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) delivers to the Securities Intermediary
a notice of sole control (a “Notice of Sole Control”) in substantially the form set forth in Exhibit D hereto,
the Securities Intermediary agrees that after receipt of such notice, it will take all instruction with respect to the Securities Account
solely from the Indenture Trustee, until such time as it receives a notice from the Indenture Trustee that such Notice of Sole Control
has been terminated.
(e)
Without limiting Section 9.3 of the Indenture, the delivery of any Notice of Sole Control and each other action by the Indenture Trustee
under this Section 5 shall be made at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative, and any delivery of a Notice of Sole Control
or other Entitlement Order by the Indenture Trustee shall be subject to the occurrence of an Event of Default and the terms of the Pledge
Agreement; provided, that the Securities Intermediary shall not have any obligation to confirm that the requirements of this Section
5(e) are satisfied.
Section
6. Cash Proceeds in Securities Account.
(a)
Unless and until a Notice of Sole Control shall have been delivered to the Securities Intermediary, all cash Proceeds (as defined in
the Pledge Agreement) shall be held by the Securities Intermediary, and distributed by the Securities Intermediary in accordance with
(i) the instructions of the Indenture Trustee in accordance with Section 8 of the Pledge Agreement, and that instructs Securities Intermediary
as to the disbursement of some or all of the cash proceeds or (ii) a final non-appealable order of a court of competent jurisdiction
(a “Final Order”) accompanied by a written certification of outside counsel attesting that such Final Order is final
and not subject to any further appeal or proceedings, along with an instruction letter from an Authorized Representative of the prevailing
Party given to all other Parties to effectuate such Final Order. The Securities Intermediary shall be entitled to conclusively rely upon
any such certification and instruction.
(b)
Following delivery of a Notice of Sole Control that has not been revoked by the Indenture Trustee, all cash proceeds of sales, pledges
and other dispositions of Pledged Shares from the Securities Account shall be held by the Securities Intermediary, and distributed by
the Securities Intermediary only in accordance with the instructions of the Indenture Trustee (acting at the direction of the Controlling
Class Representative).
(c)
Any instructions related to the transfer or distribution of monies, securities or other assets in the Securities Account must, in order
to be deemed delivered and effective, be in writing and executed by the appropriate Party or Parties as evidenced by the signatures of
the person or persons signing this Agreement or one of the designated persons as set forth on the Designation of Authorized Representatives
attached hereto as Exhibit B (each an “Authorized Representative”), and delivered to Securities Intermediary
only by email or other electronic means (with electronic confirmation of error free receipt) or as a Portable Document Format (“PDF”)
attached to an email only at the email address for notices provided for in Section 12 of this Agreement. Securities Intermediary shall
not be liable to any Party or other person for refraining from acting upon any instruction for or related to the transfer or distribution
of the Securities Account that does not satisfy the requirements herein.
(d)
Without limiting the foregoing, the Securities Intermediary shall be authorized to disburse any Proceeds and Pledged Shares if so directed
in a joint written instruction received by Securities Intermediary that is executed by an Authorized Representative of each of Pledgor
and the Indenture Trustee (at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) substantially in the form of Exhibit A attached
hereto (“Joint Payment Instructions”).
Section
7. Reserved.
Section
8. Other Levies.
(a)
The financial assets and other items deposited in or credited to the Securities Account will not be subject to deduction, set-off, banker’s
lien, or any other right in favor of any person other than the Indenture Trustee, except that the Securities Intermediary may set off,
free of the Indenture Trustee’s security interest (i) all amounts due to the Securities Intermediary in respect of customary fees
and expenses for the routine maintenance and operation of the Securities Account and (ii) the face amount of any checks or other deposit
items that have been credited to the Securities Account but are subsequently returned unpaid for any reason, including those returned
without collection because of uncollected or insufficient funds.
(b)
If the Securities Intermediary receives a levy or other governmental, regulatory or judicial instruction, other than a Final Order under
Section 6(a), to withdraw or disburse principal, cash or securities, or any combination thereof from the Securities Account, the Securities
Intermediary shall comply with such order and shall promptly notify each of the other Parties of the receipt of such order and the status
of its compliance therewith.
Section
9. Conflict with Other Agreements.
(a)
In the event of any conflict between this Agreement (or any portion thereof) and any other agreement now existing or hereafter entered
into, the terms of this Agreement shall prevail; provided that, in the event of any conflict between this Agreement (or any portion thereof)
and the Pledge Agreement (or any portion thereof), the terms of the Pledge Agreement shall prevail.
(b)
No amendment or modification of this Agreement or waiver of any right hereunder shall be binding on any party hereto unless it is in
writing, is signed by all of the parties hereto.
(c)
The Securities Intermediary hereby confirms and agrees that:
(i)
Other than the Pledge Agreement, there are no other agreements entered into between the Securities Intermediary and the Pledgor with
respect to the Securities Account;
(ii)
It has not entered into, and until the termination of this Agreement will not enter into, any agreement with any other person relating
to the Securities Account and/or any financial assets credited thereto pursuant to which it has agreed to comply with Entitlement Orders
of such other person; and
(iii)
It has not entered into, and until the termination of this Agreement will not enter into, any agreement with the Pledgor or the Indenture
Trustee purporting to limit or condition the obligation of the Securities Intermediary to comply with Entitlement Orders.
Section
10. Adverse Claims. Except for the claims and interest the Indenture Trustee in the Securities Account, and without independent
inquiry or investigation of any kind, an officer of the Securities Intermediary responsible for the administration of this Agreement
has not received written notice of any claim to, or interest in, the Securities Account or in any “financial asset” (as defined
in Section 8-102(a)(9) of the UCC) credited thereto. If any person asserts any lien, encumbrance or adverse claim (including any writ,
garnishment, judgment, warrant of attachment, execution or similar process) against the Securities Account or in any financial asset
carried therein, the Securities Intermediary will promptly notify each of the parties hereto upon receiving written notice or other actual
knowledge thereof.
Section
11. Successors; Assignment. The terms of this Agreement shall be binding upon the Parties, and shall inure to the benefit
of, the Parties and their respective corporate successors or heirs and personal representatives who obtain such rights solely by operation
of law. Each Party may assign its rights hereunder only with the express written consent of each other Party.
Section
12. Notices. Any notice, request or other communication required or permitted to be given under this Agreement shall be in
writing and deemed to have been properly given when delivered in person, or when sent by email or other electronic means and electronic
confirmation of error free receipt is received, or two days after being sent by certified or registered United States mail, return receipt
requested, postage prepaid, addressed to the Party at the address set forth below (provided, however, that notwithstanding the foregoing,
in no event shall any notice, request or other communication to the Securities Intermediary be deemed to be received by it unless and
until actually received by it). Any Party may change its address or email address for notices by provided notice of such change to all
other Parties in the manner set forth in this Section 12.
|
Pledgor: |
FAT
Brands Inc. |
|
|
9720
Wilshire Blvd., Suite 500 |
|
|
Beverly
Hills, CA 90212 |
|
|
Attention:
Chief Executive Officer |
|
|
Email: |
|
|
|
|
Indenture
Trustee: |
UMB
Bank, N.A. |
|
|
100
William Street, Suite 1850
New
York, NY 10038 |
|
|
Attention:
Michele Voon |
|
|
|
|
Securities
Intermediary: |
UMB
Bank, N.A. |
|
|
100
William Street, Suite 1850
New
York, NY 10038 |
|
|
Attention:
Michele Voon |
|
|
Email: |
Section
13. Termination; Resignation of the Securities Intermediary. The obligations of the Securities Intermediary to the Indenture
Trustee and the Pledgor pursuant to this Agreement shall continue in effect until the security interests of the Indenture Trustee in
the Securities Account have been terminated pursuant to the terms of the Pledge Agreement and the Pledgor (with the consent of Indenture
Trustee at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) has notified the Securities Intermediary of such termination in writing.
The Pledgor (with the consent of Indenture Trustee at the direction of the Controlling Class Representative) agrees to provide such notice
of termination to the Securities Intermediary upon the request of the Pledgor on or after the termination of the Indenture Trustee’s
security interest in the Securities Account pursuant to the terms of the Pledge Agreement. The Securities Intermediary and any successor
thereto may at any time resign by giving sixty (60) days’ written notice by registered, certified or express mail to the Indenture
Trustee and the Pledgor; provided that such resignation shall take effect only upon the effective date of the appointment of a successor
Securities Intermediary acceptable to the Indenture Trustee and the Pledgor, as evidenced by their written consent and the acceptance
in writing by such successor Securities Intermediary of such appointment and of its obligation to perform its duties hereunder in accordance
with the provisions hereof. Subject to the preceding sentence, if on the sixtieth (60th) day after written notice of resignation
is delivered by a resigning party as described above, no successor party or temporary successor Securities Intermediary has been appointed
in accordance herewith, the resigning party may petition a court of competent jurisdiction in the State of New York for the appointment
of a successor in accordance with Section 18.
Section
14. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Securities Intermediary. The Securities Intermediary hereby makes the
following representations, warranties and covenants:
(a)
This Agreement is the legal, valid and binding obligation of the Securities Intermediary, subject to (i) the effect of bankruptcy, insolvency
or similar laws and (ii) general equitable principles (whether enforceability of such principles is considered in a proceeding at law
or in equity).
(b)
The Securities Intermediary is duly organized and validly existing under the laws of the jurisdiction of its organization and, if relevant
under such laws, in good standing.
(c)
The Securities Intermediary has the power to execute this Agreement and any other documentation relating to this Agreement to which it
is a party, to deliver this Agreement and any other documentation relating to this Agreement that it is required by this Agreement to
deliver and to perform its obligations under this Agreement and has taken all necessary action to authorize such execution, delivery
and performance; and this Agreement has been, and each other document will be, duly executed and delivered by it.
(d)
The execution and delivery of this Agreement and the performance by the Securities Intermediary of the terms of this Agreement do not
conflict with or result in a violation of (i) any United States federal or State of New York regulation or law governing the banking
trust powers of the Securities Intermediary or (ii) the organizational documents of the Securities Intermediary.
(e)
No consent, approval, authorization or other action by or filing with any United States federal or New York State agency or other governmental
body under any United States federal or New York State regulation or law, having jurisdiction over the banking or trust powers of the
Securities Intermediary, is required in connection with the execution and delivery by the Securities Intermediary of this Agreement to
which it is a party, or performance of the Securities Intermediary’s obligations under this Agreement.
(f)
The Securities Intermediary is and shall at all times be a “qualified custodian” as defined under Section 17 of the Investment
Company Act of 1940, as amended.
(g)
The Securities Intermediary will comply at all times with the duties of a “Securities Intermediary” under Article 8 of the
UCC.
Section
15. Rights and Immunities; Indemnification, Fees and Expenses.
(a)
The Pledgor hereby agrees that the Indenture Trustee and the Securities Intermediary is released from any and all liabilities to the
Pledgor arising from the terms of this Agreement and the compliance of the Securities Intermediary with the terms hereof, except to the
extent that such liabilities arise from the Indenture Trustee’s or Securities Intermediary’s willful misconduct or gross
negligence, in each case, as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final non-appealable order. Without limitation to the
Indenture Trustee’s or Securities Intermediary’s rights, protections, immunities and indemnities under this Agreement, each
of the Parties shall be entitled to the rights, protections, immunities and indemnities afforded to them in the Pledge Agreement and
Indenture, as applicable.
(b)
The Pledgor acknowledges and agrees that the Securities Intermediary and the Indenture Trustee shall be entitled to all applicable fees,
indemnities and reimbursements of costs and expenses set forth in the Pledge Agreement in connection with the execution, delivery and
performance of this Agreement and the exercise of their respective rights and remedies hereunder.
(c)
This Section 15 shall survive the termination of this Agreement for any reason whatsoever.
Section
16. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts (including by e-mail), all of which shall constitute
one and the same instrument, and any party hereto may execute this Agreement by signing and delivering one or more counterparts.
Section
17. Certain Rights of Securities Intermediary.
(a)
This Agreement shall not subject the Securities Intermediary to any duty, obligation or liability except as is expressly set forth herein
and the Securities Intermediary shall satisfy those duties expressly set forth in this Agreement so long as it acts without, gross negligence
or willful misconduct. In particular (without implied limitation), the Securities Intermediary need not investigate whether any Party
is entitled under the Pledge Agreement, or otherwise, to give any Entitlement Order or any other directions, instructions or other orders
in any instance. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the Securities Intermediary shall not be subject to any fiduciary
or other implied duties and the Securities Intermediary shall not have any duty to take any discretionary action or exercise any discretionary
powers.
(b)
The Securities Intermediary may rely upon the contents of any notice, consent, instruction or other communication or document that the
Securities Intermediary believes in good faith to be genuine and from the proper person or entity, without any further duty of inquiry
or independent investigation on its part. The Securities Intermediary shall have no duty to inquire into the authority of the person
giving any such notice or instruction.
(c)
Except with respect to the existence of the security interest granted by the Pledgor in the Securities Account in favor of the Indenture
Trustee for the benefit of the Secured Parties, the Securities Intermediary shall not be deemed to have any knowledge (imputed or otherwise)
of any of the terms or conditions of the Pledge Agreement or any other document referred to herein or relating to any financing arrangement
between the Pledgor and the Indenture Trustee, or of any breach thereof. The Securities Intermediary has no obligation to inform any
person of any breach or to take any action in connection with any of the foregoing, except such actions regarding the Securities Account
as are specified in this Agreement. The Securities Intermediary is not responsible for the enforceability or validity of any security
interest, whether with respect to the Securities Account or otherwise, or whether pursuant to the Pledge Agreement, this Agreement or
otherwise, and is not responsible for the sufficiency of this Agreement for any purpose (including without limitation its sufficiency
to create or perfect any security interest; provided however that the foregoing shall not be construed to release the Securities Intermediary
from performing its enumerated duties set forth in this Agreement).
Section
18. Governing Law and Jurisdiction.
(a)
This Agreement and the Securities Account shall be governed by the law of the State of New York. Regardless of any provision in any other
agreement, for purposes of the UCC, New York shall be deemed to be the Securities Intermediary’s jurisdiction (within the meaning
of Section 8-110 of the UCC) and the Securities Account (as well as the security entitlements related thereto) shall be governed by the
law of the State of New York. To the extent that the Securities Account (into which cash is credited as set forth herein) is re-characterized
as a “deposit account” (within the meaning of Section 9-102(a)(29) of the UCC), New York shall be deemed to be the “bank’s
jurisdiction” (within the meaning of Section 9-304(b) of the UCC). The Parties covenant that no amendment with respect to the Securities
Account shall be entered into that would have the effect of changing the parties’ choice of law set forth in the previous sentence
without the prior written consent of each Party. In case any provision in this Agreement shall be invalid, illegal, or unenforceable
as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final non-appealable order, the validity, legality, and enforceability of the
remaining provisions shall not in any way be affected or impaired thereby.
(b)
With respect to any suit, action or proceedings relating to this Agreement or any matter between the parties arising under or in connection
with this Agreement (“Proceedings”), each Party irrevocably: (i) submits to the non-exclusive jurisdiction of the
Supreme Court of the State of New York sitting in the Borough of Manhattan and the United States District Court for the Southern District
of New York, and any appellate court from any thereof; and (ii) waives any objection that it may have at any time to the laying of venue
of any Proceedings brought in any such court, waives any claim that such Proceedings have been brought in an inconvenient forum and further
waives the right to object, with respect to such Proceedings, that such court does not have any jurisdiction over such Party. Nothing
in this Agreement precludes any Party from bringing Proceedings in any other jurisdiction, nor will the bringing of Proceedings in any
one or more jurisdictions preclude the bringing of Proceedings in any other jurisdiction. Regardless of any provision, in any other agreement,
for purposes of the UCC, with respect to the Securities Account, the State of New York shall be deemed to be the security intermediary’s
jurisdiction (within the meaning of Section 8-110 of the UCC).
(c)
Each Party agrees that service of process may be effected by mailing a copy thereof by registered or certified mail, postage prepaid,
to the applicable Party at its address specified in Section 12 of this Agreement, and the Parties irrevocably consent to service of process
given in the manner provided for notices in Section 12. Nothing in this Agreement will affect the right of any Party to serve process
in any other manner permitted by law.
(d)
EACH PARTY HEREBY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ANY RIGHT THAT IT MAY HAVE TO A TRIAL BY JURY IN RESPECT
OF ANY PROCEEDING.
(e)
Anything in this Agreement notwithstanding, in no event shall the Securities Intermediary be liable for special, indirect or consequential
loss or damage of any kind whatsoever (including but not limited to lost profits), even if the Securities Intermediary has been advised
of such loss or damage and regardless of the form of action.
Section
19. Patriot Act. In order to comply with the laws, rules, regulations and executive orders in effect from time to time
applicable to banking institutions, including, without limitation, those relating to the funding of terrorist activities and money laundering,
including Section 326 of the USA PATRIOT ACT of the United States (“Applicable Law”), the Securities Intermediary
is required to obtain, verify, record and update certain information relating to individuals and entities which maintain a business relationship
with the Securities Intermediary. Accordingly, each of the parties agrees to provide to the Securities Intermediary upon reasonable request
from time to time such identifying information and documentation as may be reasonably available for such party in order to enable the
Securities Intermediary to comply with Applicable Law.
[Signature
page follows]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties hereto have caused this Securities Account Control Agreement to be duly executed as of the date first above
written.
FAT
BRANDS INC., as Pledgor |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Robert G. Rosen |
|
Name: |
Robert
G. Rosen |
|
Title: |
Co-Chief
Executive Officer |
|
|
|
|
UMB
BANK, N.A., as Indenture Trustee |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Michele Voon |
|
Name: |
Michele
Voon |
|
Title: |
Senior
Vice President |
|
|
|
|
UMB
BANK, N.A., as Securities Intermediary |
|
|
|
|
By: |
/s/
Michele Voon |
|
Name: |
Michele
Voon |
|
Title: |
Senior
Vice President |
|
[Signature
page to Securities Account Control Agreement]
EXHIBIT
A
FORM
OF JOINT PAYMENT INSTRUCTIONS
UMB
Bank, N.A.
100
William Street, Suite 1850
New
York, NY 10038
Attention:
Michele Voon
Email:
[Date]
Re:
Securities Account No. 164496.1
Dear
Sir or Madam:
We
refer to that certain Securities Account Control Agreement (the “Control Agreement”), dated November 19, 2024, by
and among FAT Brands Inc., a Delaware corporation (the “Pledgor”), UMB Bank, N.A., a national banking association
(the “Indenture Trustee”) and UMB Bank, N.A., a national banking association (the “Securities Intermediary”).
Capitalized
terms in this letter that are not otherwise defined shall have the same meaning given to them in the Control Agreement.
Pursuant
to Section 6(a) of the Control Agreement, the Parties hereby instruct the Securities Intermediary to release and transmit monies from
the Securities Account, or the portion specified below, to the specified Party or Parties as instructed below:
Amount:
(In
writing)
Beneficiary:
City:
Country:
US
Instructions:
Bank
Name:
Bank
Address:
ABA
Number:
Credit
A/C Name:
Credit
A/C #:
Credit
A/C Address:
If
Applicable:
FFC
A/C Name:
FFC
A/C #:
FFC
A/C Address:
FAT
BRANDS INC., as Pledgor: |
|
|
|
|
By: |
|
|
Name: |
Robert
G. Rosen |
|
Title: |
Co-Chief
Executive Officer |
|
|
|
|
UMB
BANK, N.A., as Indenture Trustee: |
|
|
|
|
By: |
|
|
Name: |
|
|
Title: |
|
|
EXHIBIT
B
DESIGNATION
OF AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVES
The
undersigned, being the duly elected, qualified and acting Co-Chief Executive Officer of FAT Brands Inc. does hereby certify:
1.
That each of the following individuals is, as of the date hereof, an “Authorized Representative” of FAT Brands Inc., as such
term is defined in the Securities Account Control Agreement (the “Agreement”), dated as of November 21, 2024, by and
among FAT Brands Inc., a Delaware corporation (the “Pledgor”), UMB Bank, N.A., a national banking association (the
“Indenture Trustee”) and UMB Bank, N.A., a national banking association (the “Securities Intermediary”).
2.
That the signature appearing opposite each Authorized Representative’s name is the true and genuine signature of such Authorized
Representative, and that each Authorized Representative’s contact information is current and up-to-date at the date hereof.
3.
Each of the Authorized Representatives is authorized to issue instructions to the Securities Intermediary, confirm funds transfer instructions
by callback or email confirmation to the Securities Intermediary, and effect changes in Authorized Representatives, all in accordance
with the terms of the Agreement.
NAME |
|
SIGNATURE |
|
TELEPHONE,
CELL NUMBER and EMAIL ADDRESS |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Robert
G Rosen |
|
|
|
(ph) |
|
|
|
|
|
(cell) |
|
|
|
|
|
(email) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Kenneth
J. Kuick |
|
|
|
(ph) |
|
|
|
|
|
(cell) |
|
|
|
|
|
(email) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Allen
Z. Sussman |
|
|
|
(ph)
|
|
|
|
|
|
(cell) |
|
|
|
|
|
(email) |
|
FOR SECURITY, PLEASE CROSS OUT ALL UNUSED SIGNATURE LINES
4.
That pursuant to the Party’s governing documents, the undersigned has the power and authority to execute this Designation on behalf
of such Party, and that the undersigned has so executed this Designation as of the date set forth below.
[Signature
page follows]
FAT
BRANDS INC.,: |
|
|
|
|
By: |
|
|
Name: |
Robert
G. Rosen |
|
Title: |
Co-Chief
Executive Officer |
|
EXHIBIT
C
RESERVED
EXHIBIT
D
NOTICE
OF SOLE CONTROL
[Letterhead
of Lender]
[Date]
[Address]
|
Re:
|
Securities
Account Number: 164496.1 |
|
|
Notice
of Exclusive Control |
Ladies
and Gentlemen:
Reference
is made to the Securities Account Control Agreement dated as of November [_], 2024 (the “Agreement”) by and among
FAT Brands Inc., a Delaware corporation (the “Pledgor”), UMB Bank, N.A., not in its individual capacity but solely,
in its capacity as the Trustee under the Indenture (the “Indenture Trustee”) and UMB Bank, N.A. not in its individual
capacity but solely as securities intermediary (together with its successors and assigns, the “Securities Intermediary”)
regarding the above-described securities account (the “Securities Account”).
In
accordance with the Agreement, we hereby give you notice of our exercise of exclusive control over the Securities Account, and we hereby
instruct you to transfer collected and available funds to our account as follows:
|
Bank Name: |
|
|
|
Address: |
|
|
|
ABA
Routing: |
|
|
|
Account
No.: |
|
|
|
Reference: |
|
|
Very
truly yours,
UMB
Bank, N.A., |
|
|
|
|
By:
|
|
|
Name:
|
|
|
Title:
|
|
|
v3.24.3
X |
- DefinitionBoolean flag that is true when the XBRL content amends previously-filed or accepted submission.
+ References
+ Details
Name: |
dei_AmendmentFlag |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
xbrli:booleanItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionFor the EDGAR submission types of Form 8-K: the date of the report, the date of the earliest event reported; for the EDGAR submission types of Form N-1A: the filing date; for all other submission types: the end of the reporting or transition period. The format of the date is YYYY-MM-DD.
+ References
+ Details
Name: |
dei_DocumentPeriodEndDate |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
xbrli:dateItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionThe type of document being provided (such as 10-K, 10-Q, 485BPOS, etc). The document type is limited to the same value as the supporting SEC submission type, or the word 'Other'.
+ References
+ Details
Name: |
dei_DocumentType |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
dei:submissionTypeItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionAddress Line 1 such as Attn, Building Name, Street Name
+ References
+ Details
Name: |
dei_EntityAddressAddressLine1 |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
xbrli:normalizedStringItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionAddress Line 2 such as Street or Suite number
+ References
+ Details
Name: |
dei_EntityAddressAddressLine2 |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
xbrli:normalizedStringItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- Definition
+ References
+ Details
Name: |
dei_EntityAddressCityOrTown |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
xbrli:normalizedStringItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionCode for the postal or zip code
+ References
+ Details
Name: |
dei_EntityAddressPostalZipCode |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
xbrli:normalizedStringItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionName of the state or province.
+ References
+ Details
Name: |
dei_EntityAddressStateOrProvince |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
dei:stateOrProvinceItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionA unique 10-digit SEC-issued value to identify entities that have filed disclosures with the SEC. It is commonly abbreviated as CIK.
+ ReferencesReference 1: http://www.xbrl.org/2003/role/presentationRef -Publisher SEC -Name Exchange Act -Number 240 -Section 12 -Subsection b-2
+ Details
Name: |
dei_EntityCentralIndexKey |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
dei:centralIndexKeyItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionIndicate if registrant meets the emerging growth company criteria.
+ ReferencesReference 1: http://www.xbrl.org/2003/role/presentationRef -Publisher SEC -Name Exchange Act -Number 240 -Section 12 -Subsection b-2
+ Details
Name: |
dei_EntityEmergingGrowthCompany |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
xbrli:booleanItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionCommission file number. The field allows up to 17 characters. The prefix may contain 1-3 digits, the sequence number may contain 1-8 digits, the optional suffix may contain 1-4 characters, and the fields are separated with a hyphen.
+ References
+ Details
Name: |
dei_EntityFileNumber |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
dei:fileNumberItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionTwo-character EDGAR code representing the state or country of incorporation.
+ References
+ Details
Name: |
dei_EntityIncorporationStateCountryCode |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
dei:edgarStateCountryItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionThe exact name of the entity filing the report as specified in its charter, which is required by forms filed with the SEC.
+ ReferencesReference 1: http://www.xbrl.org/2003/role/presentationRef -Publisher SEC -Name Exchange Act -Number 240 -Section 12 -Subsection b-2
+ Details
Name: |
dei_EntityRegistrantName |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
xbrli:normalizedStringItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionThe Tax Identification Number (TIN), also known as an Employer Identification Number (EIN), is a unique 9-digit value assigned by the IRS.
+ ReferencesReference 1: http://www.xbrl.org/2003/role/presentationRef -Publisher SEC -Name Exchange Act -Number 240 -Section 12 -Subsection b-2
+ Details
Name: |
dei_EntityTaxIdentificationNumber |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
dei:employerIdItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionLocal phone number for entity.
+ References
+ Details
Name: |
dei_LocalPhoneNumber |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
xbrli:normalizedStringItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionBoolean flag that is true when the Form 8-K filing is intended to satisfy the filing obligation of the registrant as pre-commencement communications pursuant to Rule 13e-4(c) under the Exchange Act.
+ ReferencesReference 1: http://www.xbrl.org/2003/role/presentationRef -Publisher SEC -Name Exchange Act -Number 240 -Section 13e -Subsection 4c
+ Details
Name: |
dei_PreCommencementIssuerTenderOffer |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
xbrli:booleanItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionBoolean flag that is true when the Form 8-K filing is intended to satisfy the filing obligation of the registrant as pre-commencement communications pursuant to Rule 14d-2(b) under the Exchange Act.
+ ReferencesReference 1: http://www.xbrl.org/2003/role/presentationRef -Publisher SEC -Name Exchange Act -Number 240 -Section 14d -Subsection 2b
+ Details
Name: |
dei_PreCommencementTenderOffer |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
xbrli:booleanItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionTitle of a 12(b) registered security.
+ ReferencesReference 1: http://www.xbrl.org/2003/role/presentationRef -Publisher SEC -Name Exchange Act -Number 240 -Section 12 -Subsection b
+ Details
Name: |
dei_Security12bTitle |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
dei:securityTitleItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionName of the Exchange on which a security is registered.
+ ReferencesReference 1: http://www.xbrl.org/2003/role/presentationRef -Publisher SEC -Name Exchange Act -Number 240 -Section 12 -Subsection d1-1
+ Details
Name: |
dei_SecurityExchangeName |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
dei:edgarExchangeCodeItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionBoolean flag that is true when the Form 8-K filing is intended to satisfy the filing obligation of the registrant as soliciting material pursuant to Rule 14a-12 under the Exchange Act.
+ ReferencesReference 1: http://www.xbrl.org/2003/role/presentationRef -Publisher SEC -Name Exchange Act -Number 240 -Section 14a -Subsection 12
+ Details
Name: |
dei_SolicitingMaterial |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
xbrli:booleanItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionTrading symbol of an instrument as listed on an exchange.
+ References
+ Details
Name: |
dei_TradingSymbol |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
dei:tradingSymbolItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- DefinitionBoolean flag that is true when the Form 8-K filing is intended to satisfy the filing obligation of the registrant as written communications pursuant to Rule 425 under the Securities Act.
+ ReferencesReference 1: http://www.xbrl.org/2003/role/presentationRef -Publisher SEC -Name Securities Act -Number 230 -Section 425
+ Details
Name: |
dei_WrittenCommunications |
Namespace Prefix: |
dei_ |
Data Type: |
xbrli:booleanItemType |
Balance Type: |
na |
Period Type: |
duration |
|
X |
- Details
Name: |
us-gaap_StatementClassOfStockAxis=FAT_ClassCommonStockMember |
Namespace Prefix: |
|
Data Type: |
na |
Balance Type: |
|
Period Type: |
|
|
X |
- Details
Name: |
us-gaap_StatementClassOfStockAxis=FAT_ClassBCommonStockMember |
Namespace Prefix: |
|
Data Type: |
na |
Balance Type: |
|
Period Type: |
|
|
X |
- Details
Name: |
us-gaap_StatementClassOfStockAxis=FAT_SeriesBCumulativePreferredStockMember |
Namespace Prefix: |
|
Data Type: |
na |
Balance Type: |
|
Period Type: |
|
|
X |
- Details
Name: |
us-gaap_StatementClassOfStockAxis=FAT_WarrantsToPurchaseCommonStockMember |
Namespace Prefix: |
|
Data Type: |
na |
Balance Type: |
|
Period Type: |
|
|
FAT Brands (NASDAQ:FATBW)
Historical Stock Chart
From Nov 2024 to Dec 2024
FAT Brands (NASDAQ:FATBW)
Historical Stock Chart
From Dec 2023 to Dec 2024